Out of the Abyss (OCR, Bookmarked, Cropped) - Free Download PDF (2024)

Adventure Out of the Abyss...

OUT OF THE ABYSS

CREDITS

FOREWORD

This book was a collaboration between Wizards of the Coast and Green Ronin Publishing, Members of the Green Ronin creative team are marked with an asterisk. Story Creators: Christopher Perkins, Adam Lee, Richard Whitters Story Consultants: R.A. Salvatore, Troy Denning

To gel myself in the mindset of telling an Underdarkthemed story set in the Forgotten Realms, 1 went back and read Exile by R.A. Salvatore, one of my favorite Drizzt novels. It tells the story of the dark elfs initial ascent to the surface world. Along the way, Drizzt encounters weird Underdark characters, including a deep gnome with hammers for hands, a pech (a small earth creature) polymorphed into a hook horror, and a crazy wizard with a Daem's instant fortress. After reading the book again, I was reminded of Alice’s Adventures in Wonderland and Through the Looking Glass. That’s when I decided that ou r Underdark tale was going to draw inspiration from Lewis Carroll’s works. We would paint the Underdark as an insanely wondrous domain into which our heroes must descend. First, we needed a villain as deranged as the Queen of Hearts. Lolth was an obvious choice, as was Zuggtmoy. In researching the latter, I was reminded of the Demon Queen of Fungi’s ongoing feud withjuiblex. That’s when it occurred to me that we could be bold and tell an Underdark story featuring not just one demon lord, but several of them. Maybe even all of them. We knew that our demon-infested tale would have two Drizzt novels as bookends, so wc asked R.A. Salvatore to help us break the story. We also asked Troy Denning, another one of our talented authors, to join us, since he was writing a novel about Orcus. Out of those discussions came the Rage of Demons storyline, which wc presented to the folks at Green Ronin. Callooh, c.allay! They agreed to collaborate with us on a D&D adventure—this book you now hold in your hands. Have fun with it, and may the stories of your players’ harrowing exploits be as wonderful and unforgettable as any great novel! Christopher Perkins June 2015

Lead Adventure Designer: Steve Kenson* Designers: Cam Banks* Walter Ciechanowski,* Alex Melchor,* Christopher Perkins, Chris Pramas,* Robert J. Schwalb,* Matt Sernett, Rodney Thompson, Ray Winninger* Managing Editor: Jeremy Crawford Editors: Scott Fitzgerald Gray, Christopher Perkins, Tom Cadorette* Additional Proofreading: Peter Lee, Sean K Reynolds Producer: Greg Bilsland D&D Lead Designers: Mike Mearls, Jeremy Crawford Art Directors: Hal Mangold,* Kate Irwin, Shauna Narciso Cover Illustrator: Tyler Jacobson Interior Illustrators: Empty Room Studios, Sam Burley, Olga Drebas, Wayne England, llich Henriquez, David Hueso, William O'Connor, Claudio Pozas, Jasper Sandner, Craig Spearing, Bryan Syme, Carlos Nunez de Castro Torres, Francis Tsai, Anthony Waters, Richard Whitters, Ben Wootten, Kieran Yanner Cartographers: Jared Blando, Mike Schley Graphic Designer: Emi Tanji Project Management: Neil Shinkle, John Hay Production Services: Cynda Callaway, Jefferson Dunlap, David Gershman Brand and Marketing: Nathan Stewart, Liz Schuh, Chris Lindsay, Shelly Mazzanoble, Hilary Ross, John Feil, Laura Tommervik, Greg Tito, Kim Lundstrom, Trevor Kidd Playtesters: Robert Alaniz, Jay Anderson, Bill Benham, Stacy Bermes, Anthony Caroselli, Krupal Desai, Frank Foulis, Jason Fuller, Gregory L, Harris, Justin Hicks, Yan Lacharite, Jonathan Longstaff, Matt Maranda, Shawn Merwin, Lou Michelli, Mike Mihalas, Karl Resch, Kyle Turner, Arthur Wright, Keoki Young

Disclaimer: Before you lake on demon lords, consult a physician. Do not drink alcohol while taking on demon lords. Taking alcohol and demon lords may increase your risk of death. Other side effects of demon lords may include hallucinationsr mindless roge, g/utfony, greed, paranoia, self delusion, bestial urges, nihilism, hedonism, megalomania, a messiah complex, cannibalism, multiple personalities, and homicidal psychosis.

ON THE COVER Tyler Jacobson illustrates Demogorgon, the Prince of Demons, rampaging through Menzoberranzan after being ripped from the Abyss by the drow archmage Gromph Baenre. ■

teipr . ’

SflSfc -Mm '

■ jifit

L

m M :

n

mm T.'I / jt ’

flggffijpP M M

V

S

620B2439000001 EN ISBN: 9780-7869-6581-6 First Printing: September 2015 987654321

DUNGEONS & DRAGONS, D&D, Wizards of the Coast, Forgotten Realms, the dragon! ampersand, Out of the Abyss, Player's Handbook, Monster Manual, Dungeon Master's Guide, all other Wizards of the Coast product names, and their respective logos are trademarks of Wizards of the Coast in the USA and other countries. All characters and their distinctive likenesses are property of Wizards of the Coast. This material is protected under the copyright laws of the United States of America. Any reproduction or unauthorized use of the material or artwork contained herein Is prohibited without the express written permission of Wizards of the Coast, Green Ronin Publishing and the Green Ronin Publishing logo are trademarks of Green Ronin Publishing. Printed in the USA @2015 Wizards of the Coast LLC, PO Box 707, Renton, WA 98057 0707, USA. Manufactured by Hasbro SA, Rue Emile-Boechat 31, 2800 Ddemont, CH

CONTENTS

The Pudding Court................................Ill Ch. 15: The City of Spiders..........................189 Goals.............................................. 189 Battle for Blingdenstone.....................113 Going to Menzoberranzan..................190 Leaving Blingdenstone.......................115 Menzoberranzan...............................191 City Locations....................................193 Ch. 7: Escape front the Underdark... 116 Unexpected Allies..............................202 The Way Out.......................................116 Private Meetings................................ 203 Bidding Farewell........... . ..................117 A Change of Heart............................ 205 Confronting the Drow........................118 Sorcere.................*.........................205 Further Adventures.............................119 Developments.....................................207

Ch. 1: Prisoners of the Drow............................4 Escape!...................................................4 The Adventure Begins............................5 In the Slave Pen......................................5 The Prow............................................ 9 Velkynvelve ...................................... 11 Means of Escape..................................15 Leaving Velkynvelve............................16 XP Awards............................................16 Ch. 8: Audience in Gauntlgrym.................120 Summoned by Bruenor......................120 Gau ntlgrym.™............................... 121 Ch. 2: Into Darkness......................................17 Events in Gauntlgrym........................124 Where to Go?.......................................17 Forging an Alliance............................126 Underdark Travel.................................18 The Way Ahead................................ 129 Equipment............................................21 Madness................................................21 Death........................... ........................22 Ch. 9: Mantol-Derith....................................132 Eungi of the Underdark...................... 22 Fraz-lJrbluu's Gent.............................132 Narrating the journey...........................24 Reaching MantoLDcrith.....................133 Drow Pursuit........................................24 Mantol-Derith.....................................133 Random Encounters........................... 25 Summarizing Travel.............................30 Leaving Mantol-Derith.......................141 Set Encounters.................................... 31 The Silken Paths.................. ................31 Ch. 10: Descent into the Depths................143 Hook 1 lorror Hunt...............................32 Fellow Travelers............................... 143 The Oozing Temple.............................34 In Command.......................................144 Lost Tomb of Khaein............................37 Random Events..................................145 Underdark Outposts...........................147 Ch. 3: The Darklake.......................................39 Retracing Steps...................................147 Traversing the Darklake.......................40 Random Encounters.............................40 Sloobludop....................................... 43 Ch. 11: Gravenhollow..................................150 Going to Gravenhollow......................150 XP Awards............................................49 The Stone Library............................. 152 Ch. 4: Gracklstugh.........................................50 The Enemy of Our Enemy.................155 Going to Gracklstugh...........................50 Stonespcakcr Crystals........................156 Gracklstugh.........................................56 Returning to Vizeran........................... Darklake District..................................59 159 Laduguer's Furrow...............................64 Leaving Gravenhollow.......................159 West Cleft & East Cleft Districts........64 Halls of Sacred Spells..........................65 Cairngorm Cavern................................65 Ch. 12: The Tower of Vengeance...............160 Themberchaud’s Lair...........................65 Reaching the Tower............................160 Whorlstone Tunnels.,.,.........................67 Araj: Vizeran s Tower.........................161 Leaving Gracklstugh............................81 Hold of the Deepking,...„.....................82 Ch. 5: Neverlight Grove.................................83 Going to Neverlight Grove..................83 Arriving at the Grove...........................84 Neverlight Grove..................................86 Yggmorgus...........................................92 Leaving Neverlight Grove ..................94

Ch. 16: The Fetid Wedding...........................208 Wedding Invitation.............................208 Myconid March..................................209 Araumycos............ ............................210 Enter the Groom.................................211 Into the Gray Dream...........................212 Let Them Speak Now.........................213 Fighting the Faceless Lord.................214 Victory or Defeat................................214 Developments.....................................214 Ch. 17: Against the Demon Lords...............215 Readying the Plan..............................215 Enacting the Plan............... ..............215 Rage of Demons................................218 Against Demogorgon.........................219 Loose Threads....................................219 App. A: Modifying Backgrounds................221 Substitute Features............................221 Substitute Bonds................................221 App. B: Magic Items....................................222 App. C: Creatures.........................................224 Dcrro..................................................224 Ixitxachitl...........................................225 Creature Variations.............................226 Miscellaneous Creatures....................230 Nonplayer Characters.........................231 App. D: Demon Lords..................................234 Bap hornet..........................................234 Demogorgon.......................................236 Fraz-Urb’htu.......................................238 Graz’zt...............................................240 Juiblex................................................242 Orcus..................................................244 Yeenoghu............................................246 Zuggtmoy,..........................................248

Ch. 13: The Wormwrithings.........................166 The Worm Tunnels.............................166 Troglodyte Lair...................................168 Voice in the Dark...............................171 Worm Nursery................................ 172 The Dark Hunters...............................175 Afterword.....................................................250 The Vast Oblivium............................175

Ch. 6: Blingdenstonc......................................95 Ch. 14: The Labyrinth..................................178 Labyrinth Encounters.........................179 Going to Blirigdenstone.......................95 Adamantine Tower.............................180 Blingdenstonc Outskirts.......................99 Spiral of the Horned King..................181 Outer Blingdenstone...........................101 Filthriddens........................................182 Inner Blingdenstone......................... 102 March to Nowhere..............................183 Rockblight........................................ 107 Ycenoghu's Hunt............................... 184 Goldwhisker Warrens........................110 Gallery of Angels...............................185 The Maze Engine...............................186

CHAPTER 1: PRISONERS OF THE DROW Deep beneath the surface of the world lies the Underdark, a realm of endless labyrinthine tunnels and caverns where the sun never shines. The Underdark is filled with races and creatures too numerous to count or list, and foremost among these are the dark elves—the drow. Hated and feared even by their fellow dwellers in darkness, the drow raid other settlements in the Underdark as well as the surface world, taking prisoners back with them. Rendered unconscious with drow poison, then collared and shackled, these prisoners are eventually sold as slaves or entertainment in the dark elves’ subterranean cities. The adventurers have all had the misfortune of falling to such a fate. Captured by the drow, they are prisoners at one of the dark elves' outposts, awaiting transportation to Mcnzoherranzan. the City of Spiders. Whether they came into the Underdark seeking knowledge or fortune, or were just in the wrong place at the wrong time, they were ripe prey for a drow raid. The setup of Out of the Abyss is such that the characters need have no connections with events in the Underdark, or with each other, prior to the start of the adventure. They can meet and get to know each other as prisoners of the drow. Players who would like their characters to have a stronger Underdark connection can choose from the background options in appendix A.

“Prisoners of the Drow" assumes the characters start at 1 st level, and that they will achieve 2nd level (if not 3rd) by the end of this chapter of the adventure. Given the challenges of the adventure and the dangers of the Underdark, you can start the characters at a higher level (2nd or 3rd) to make things a bit easier for the players.

E SCAPE !

The characters’ goal in this chapter of the adventure is straightforward: escape from the drow outpost of Velkynvelve, with an eye toward escaping from the Underdark. However, this goal is complicated by the adventurers’ lack of familiarity with their surroundings. Even if the prisoners can get away from the drow. where will they go and how will they survive? RESTRAINTS All the draw’s prisoners, including Lhe characters, wear iron slave collars along wdth manacles connected to iron belts by a short length of chain. This leaves the prisoners restrained, but doesn’t affect their movement or speed. In addition to being manacled, spellcastcrs don't have any spell components or focuses, initially limiting their spellcasting ability, (Wizard characters don’t need their spellbooks to cast spells, but will be unable to change their prepared spells without them. As such, give wizard characters some leeway in determining which spells they had previously prepared before being captured.) Moreover, spellcasting isn’t possible inside the slave pen because of its magical wards (see area 11). Slipping out of manacles requires a successful DC 20 Dexterity check, while breaking them requires

a successful DC 20 Strength check. A character can unlock the manacles using thieves’ tools with a successful DC 15 Dexterity check. The manacles have 15 hit points. The iron collars can be broken with a successful DC 20 Strength check. The collars have 12 hit points. A character who fails a check to break a collar, break a set of manacles, or escape from a set of manacles can’t attempt checks of that kind again until he or she finishes a long rest. A character can still use the Help action to aid another character, however.

T HE A DVENTURE B EGINS

The characters begin the adventure in the slave pens of Velkynvelve. Stripped of everything but their underclothing, they are at the mercy of the dark elves and in the company of other prisoners, many of who aren’t what they seem. Captured by the drow! You wouldn't wish this fate upon anyone, yet here you are—locked in a dark cave, the cold, heavy weight of metal tight around your throat and wrists. You are not alone. Other prisoners are trapped in here with you, in an underground outpost far from the light of the sun. Your captors include a cruel drow priestess who calls herself Mistress llvara of House Mizzrym. Over the past several days, you've met her several times, robed in silken garments and flanked by two male drow, one of whom has a mass of scars along one side of his face and neck. Mistress llvara likes to impress her will with scourge in

I N THE S LAVE P EN

Velkynvclve's slave pen is closed with a heavy iron gate bolted into the stone. See area 11 for more information about the slave pen, including options for opening or breaking through the gate. The prisoners are provided with clay chamber pots, and one of the duties of slaves is to empty them into the pool during their shift. There are no other comforts in the slave pen. Prisoners must sit or lie on the stone floor, and are fed only once each day—a thin mushroom broth served in small clay bowls passed through gaps in the bars of the gate.

S C AVE NGE D P OSSE SS IO NS The player characters have not been idle during their captivity. Have each player roll a d20, and add the number of days (ldlO) that player’s character has been imprisoned in Velkynvelve. The result determines what, if anything, the character has in his or her possession when the adventure begins. S C AVE N C E D P O S S E S S I O N S Result Item 2-9 — 10-12 A gold coin A living spider the size of a tarantula

13-

16-18 A 5-foot-long strand of silk rope 19-21 A flawed carnelian gemstone worth 10 gp 22-24 A rusted iron bar that can be used as a club 25-27 A flint shard that can be used as a dagger 28-30 A hand crossbow bolt coated with drow poison (see “Poisons" in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide)

hand and remind you that your life now belongs to her. "Accept your fate, learn to obey, and you may survive.’’

F E L LO W P RISO NE RS

Her words echo in your memory, even as you plot your escape.

Assume that each player character has been a prisoner in Velkynvelve for ldlO days. (Roll separately for each character.) The characters spend most of this time locked in the slave pen, emerging occasionally under heavy guard to perform menial chores for their captors' amusement (see “Hard Labor’’). Feel free to play out any interaction between the drow. the player characters, and the other prisoners. This is an opportunity to reveal who the characters are and to flesh out their backgrounds and personalities through roleplaying, even as you introduce some of their fellow prisoners. Ilvara’s newest consort, Shoor, wants to impress his mistress, while Jorlan, her former consort, sullenly does his duty but casts a curious eye over the prisoners. Any hostile move is met with poisoned crossbow bolts from the drow, and possibly a strike from Ilvara’s scourge or a ray of sickness spell. The giant spiders attack and poison anyone who attacks the drow. The drow don't kill any of the prisoners (leaving them unconscious at 0 hit points) but have no compunction about beating them.

The characters are held with ten other prisoners, captured during various raids and likewise awaiting transportation to Menzoberranzan. Some can expect to be sold as slaves, while others await death at the hands of the drow or their pets. Regardless of what they might think of the adventurers and each other—outside the slave pens, all the NPCs have good reason to cooperate in order to escape and survive. PRISONERS OF THE DROW Buppido Prince Derendil

Ront Sarith Kzekarit Shuushar the Awakened

Talkative and cunning derro Quaggoth who claims to be a cursed elf prince Shield dwarf scout from Cauntlgrym Deep gnome with a gambling problem Ore bully Drow accused of murder Kuo-toa hermit and mystic

Stool

Myconid sprout

Topsy and Turvy

Deep gnome wererat twins

Eldeth Feldrun Jimjar

CHAPTER 1 : PRISONERS OF THE DROW

BUPPIDO A male de r ro , Buppido is surprisingly gregarious and

talkative, demonstrating a keen mind and a disarming manner. This pleasant facade conceals the soul of an insane killer. Buppido secretly believes he is the living incarnation of the derro god Diinkarazan—an avatar of murder offering bloody sacrifices to create a path of carnage through the Underdark for his people to follow to glory, lie rationalizes any setbacks (including his capture and imprisonment) as part of his “divine plan.” His killings are carefully ritualized, following an exacting process of cutting open the victims and arranging their organs. Although mad, Buppido is cunning and capable of hiding his true nature to serve his own ends. Because he believes he is a god, he is convinced that he can't be killed (or at least that the death of his mortal form means nothing to him), so he is completely fearless. He assumes everything is part of his divine plan, and enthusiastically participates in any plot to escape from the drow so he can continue his holy work. Buppido is happy to consider his fellow prisoners allies until such time as he no longer needs them, or becomes convinced that the omens point tow'ard the need for one or more of them to be sacrificed to his greater glory. PRINCE DERENDIL

This hulking quaggoth is the most menacing-looking prisoner in the slave pens, and the other prisoners give him a wide berth. If any of the characters speak to him, however, the quaggoth replies in urbane Elvish. He explains that he is not, in fact, a quaggoth, but a gold elf prince polymorphcd into quaggoth form by a curse. He claims to be Prince Derendil of the kingdom of Nelrindenvane in the High Forest, flis crown was usurped by the evil wizard Terrestor, who trapped him in this form and exiled him from his people. Although Derendil behaves like the highborn prince he believes himself to be, he responds to stress and particularly threats like a quaggoth: violently tearing foes limb from limb and rending their flesh with sharp claws and teeth. He comes back to himself only after battle, or when someone reinforces his “true identity" to snap him our of ii. Derendil laments that he is

slowly but surely losing himself to the savagery of his quaggoth form. In fact, Derendil is simply mad, touched by the delusions of the demon lord Fraz-Ufb’luu. The kingdom of Nelrindenvane doesn't exist, and all of “DerendiTs" recollections and personality are an illusion created by the Demon Prince of Deception. The quaggoth refuses to believe the truth, and any incontrovertible evidence as to his real nature sends him into a murderous rage. ELDETH FELDRUN

A female shield dwarf scout from Gauntlgrym, Eldeth is high spirited and proud of both her heritage and her people's achievement in reclaiming the ancient dwarven kingdom; she suggests Gauntlgrym as a destination to escape from the Underdark. Eldeth is stubborn and hates the drow and all other “corrupt dark dwellers” such as the derro and duergar. Eldeth wants to gel back home, but she is also defiant and self sacrificing—and therefore among the most likely prisoners to perish before getting the opportunity. If that happens, Eldeth asks a character she trusts to promise to carry word of her fate back to her family in Gauntlgrym, along with her shield and warhammer if they are recovered. This might win the characters the approval of Eldeth’s kin when they later visit Gauntlgrym. J l MJ A R

A male deep gnome spy, Jimjar is a feckless rogue with a devil-may-care attitude, a fondness for coin, and an obsession with betting on virtually anything and everything. Once he knows the characters, Jimjar regularly offers them bets on things from their own efforts (“I bet you ten gold you can't get past that sentry without being seen") to the outcomes of random events (“I bet you twenty gold this tunnel is the right way”). He sometimes uses betting to goad others into doing things, but characters can easily turn the tables knowing that Jimjar finds it difficult to refuse a wager. His behavior is unusual for the dour deep gnomes, and others of his kind (including Topsy and Turvy) find Jimjar annoying at best, and unstable and potentially mad at worst. Jimjar is always true to his word, and he manages to keep exact track of his debits and credits in his head.

CHAPTER 1 I PRISONERS OF THE DROW

€ * ______

J

CHAPTER 1 | PRISONERS OF THE OROW

J IMJAR

RONT

5ARITH

KZEKAR

paying up on his bets (or demanding payment) as soon as possible. He’s not above pocketing a little extra coin when no one is watching, and he has an amazing ability to secret significant wealth on his person. Jimjar feels as though there's something odd about the twins Topsy and Turvy, but he keeps his opinion to himself unless asked. He does his best to get along with everyone, although some find his gregariousness and constant wagers grating, RONT A male ore from the lceshield tribe. Ront fled from the slaughter of a band of ores at the hands of the dwarves, falling down a shaft and wandering in the Underdark before being captured by the drow. He’s ashamed of his cowardly act and knows that Gruumsh. the god of the ores, is punishing him. But he also doesn't want to die, or at least not in drow captivity. Ront is mean, stupid, and hateful, but he also knuckles under to authority and threats. He especially hates Eldeth. as his tribe is at war with her people. Ront engages in threatening behavior and bullying toward the other prisoners unless someone stands up to him. SARITH KZEKARIT

A male drow, Sarith is sullen and keeps to himself, rebuffing attempts to talk to him. He is disgraced by his imprisonment but is resigned to his fate, since there doesn't appear to be anything he can do about it. Sarith is accused of murdering one of his fellow drow warriors in a fit of madness, but he has no memory of it. He varies between believing the whole thing is a setup to discredit and destroy him. and fearing that it is all true—which, in fact, it is. He is being held until he can be sent back to Menzoberranzan as a sacrifice to Lolth and an example to others. Unknown even to the other drow. Sarith is infected with tainted spores from myconids corrupted by Zuggtmoy, the Demon Queen of Fungi. The initial infestation of the spores caused Sarith's bout of madness, and his health and sanity continue to deteriorate as the spores grow within his brain.

SHUUSHAR THE AWAKENED A kuo-toa. Shuushar is likely to be one of the more unusual creatures any of the adventurers have met. The aquatic hermit is a calm and peaceful presence. He is aware of his people's well-deserved reputation for madness, and claims to have spent a lifetime in contemplation and solitary meditation to overcome that legacy, He appears to have been successful, exuding an aura of enlightened balance. Shuushar is even calm and accepting of his current imprisonment, merely saying that it is what it is, and who can say what end it might eventually lead toward? Although Shuushar is by far the most sane, stable, and honest of the adventurers’ fellow prisoners, he is also the most useless to their immediate goals. The kuo-toa hermit is a complete pacifist. He doesn't fight or cause harm to any other creature, even refusing to defend himself or others. He gladly accompanies the party if permitted to do so. however, helping them in any way he can other than violating his most sacred vow. Shuushar is familiar with Sloobludop, the kuo-toa town near the Darklake. and has navigated the twisting routes of the Darklake for many years. He hopes to share his enlightenment with his fellow kuo-toa. although he isn't aware of recent events in Sloobludop (see chapter 3 for details). STOOL Stool is a myconid sprout captured by Sarith Kzekarit. Stool is lonely and frightened, wanting only to return to its home in Neverlight Grove. If befriended by the characters. Stool gladly offers to guide them to its home, promising them sanctuary with its folk, although it isn't aware of the dangers posed by Zuggtmoy's influence on the myconids (see chapter 5). Stool uses rapport spores to establish telepathic communication with other creatures, and it does so to communicate with characters who are kind and friendly toward it. The myconid will also help establish communication with Underdark denizens with whom the characters don't share a language. Once it becomes attached to one or more of the adventurers, Stool behaves somewhat like an enthusiastic and curious younger sibling, sticking close to the characters and

asking all kinds of questions.

S HUUSHAR T HE A WAKE NED

S TOOL

ToPSV ANO T URVY

TOPSY AND TURVY

W HAT T HE P R IS ONE R S K NOW Allow the characters to freely mingle and interact with Twin deep gnomes, Topsy and her brother Turvy are their fellow prisoners or even the drow guards, although originally from Blingdenstone in the Underdark. They the guards rarely talk to the “surface-dweller scum." Of were captured by the drow while out gathering all the prisoners, only Eldeth and Jimjar speak fluent mushrooms in the tunnels near their home. Like most Common. The others speak Undercommon (or at least other svirfneblin, Topsy has a stringy mop of hair while understand it). Ront knows some Common, while Turvy only has a few tufts of hair atop his otherwise bald Derendil speaks Elvish. Stool's rapport spores can head. Topsy is by far the more social of the two. Turvy establish telepathic communication to allow everyone to constantly mumbles and mutters darkly, with Topsy speak freely. The guards aren’t observant enough to repeating or translating what her brother says. notice. Topsy and Turvy hide the fact that they arc wererats. You might wish to consult the social interaction rules Infected with the curse of lycanthropy, neither deep in the Dungeon Master's Guide, in which case the other gnome has entirely embraced it yet, and they struggle to prisoners are initially indifferent toward the characters. control their wererat instincts and urges. They are fearful Handle the interactions using roleplaying, Charisma of what potential allies might do if they learn the truth, checks, or a balance of the two as best suits your group and are looking out for each other and their own and the way the adventure unfolds. survival. With their transformations controlled by the The characters can learn the following things from unseen cycle of the moon, you can use the twins' talking with their fellow prisoners, some of who have impending change as a wild card in the adventure. been captives of the drow for a tenday or two: They’ve been prisoners for less than a month, meaning the full moon is coming. • There are nineteen drow at the outpost, including IIvara, Shoor, and Jorlan, as well as another priestess A M OTLEY C REW named Asha. There are also a dozen quaggoths and a The other prisoners who manage to escape with the player number of giant spiders. characters are likely to become their companions for a substantial • Three drow guards watch the slave pen from the part of the adventure, so it is good to lay the groundwork for those hanging guard tower across the rope bridge, visible relationships early on. Some of the NPCs might not survive the initial escape attempt. Others might be lost to the dangers of the through the locked gate. Underdark—or might reveal their true colors and betray the party. A • The cell has some sort of antimagic effect on it (see few could become true companions. Keep in mind the other area 11 for details). prisoners have their own personalities and goals, but are generally • Jorlan the drow warrior suffered disfiguring injuries willing to cooperate for their own benefit. Their knowledge of the Underdark should encourage the player characters to keep them recently. Before then, he seemed more in Ilvara’s around at least initially. favor. Now Shoor seems to have displaced him. Since managing such a large cast of NPCs can be quite involved, • Jorlan used to have a wand that shot globs of sticky enlist the aid of the players if you wish, having each of them take material able to trap targets. Now Shoor carries it, as on the role of managing one or more of the party's companions. The player generally decides what that NPC is doing, with the another sign of their change in status. knowledge that you, as Dungeon Master, can overrule them as • It might be a matter of days or tendays before a continneeded by the story. Not only does this make the secondary gent from Menzoberranzan arrives to take prisoners characters easier to manage, it helps the players get to know them back to the drow city. and strengthens the bonds between the NPCs and the adventurers. Additionally, the drow Sarith Kzekarit knows the following: • A gray ooze lives in the pool. It's harmless, feeding off waste unless disturbed. • A supply patrol from Menzoberranzan is a few days overdue, which is unusual. CHAPTER 1 | PRISONERS OF THE DROW

8

H A R D L ABOR The drow divide their prisoners into three roughly equalsized groups and put them to work for a third of the day. supervised by the quaggoths. Their menial tasks include filling and hauling water barrels, operating the lift, cleaning any or all parts of the outpost (whether they need it or not), emptying chamber pots, food preparation and service, washing dishes, and laundry. The prisoners arc also given cruel or pointless tasks to occupy them, and for the dark elves' amusement. Such labors include moving or stacking rocks, coiling ropes, and organizing supplies, with prisoners forced to redo work that doesn’t meet the drow’s arbitrary standards. Characters might or might not work together, depending on how the drow split them up. Prisoners known to be friendly to each other are usually kept apart, and no more than two or three prisoners are allowed to work at a single task at once. The drow and quaggoths are cruel and capricious, but also somewhat bored and looking for amusement. The quaggoths are poor conversationalists, hateful and mistrustful toward the prisoners. The drow are more inclined to talk, if only to boast of their superiority. Characters might trick them into dropping useful bits of information, such as how long the journey to Menzoberranzan is expected to take, or that the outpost is relatively close to the Darklake.

B A D D R E AMS The characters’ sleep in the slave pen is troubled and fitful, filled with strange dreams and disturbing images. Dark shadows seetn to move and reach out toward them as the characters wander lost through endless mazes of tunnels. Oily tentacles slide to brush up against them, while a great buzzing and howling rises in the distance. Suppurating wounds burst open in clouds of spores or crawling masses of maggots or insects. At least one or more of the characters should wake in a cold sweat from these nightmares after every rest, feeling as though something is out there in the dark depths—something far worse than the drow. You need not explain the cause of these dreams and images at this time. Characters can chalk them up to the conditions in the slave pen. or to the aftereffects of drow poison, but they are omens of what is happening in the Underdark. Spellcastc.rs, particularly clerics and warlocks, might be most prone to these dreams, but they can visit any or all of the characters.

FIGHT! Most of the other prisoners aren't looking for trouble, and even killers such as Buppido are careful to bide their time. Still, both Derendil and Ront have quick tempers, and Sarith the drow is prone to bouts of violence as Zuggtmoy's spores take over his mind. It's possible the characters could provoke a fight. If they do, some of the prisoners (including the deep gnomes) egg on the fighters while others keep their distance or even try to break up the brawl.

Any violent conflict draws the attention of the drow guards, who initially order any prisoners to stand down from a fight, threatening them with hand crossbows from outside the gate. If necessary, they shoot prisoners with poisoned crossbow bolts to incapacitate them. (See chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide for information on drow poison.) The guards let any fight play out for their own amusement as long as the prisoners don't seem likely to actually kill one another.

F EE DIN G T IME If a prisoner becomes too much trouble, or if the drow need to mete out a lesson on the price of disobedience, they make a gruesome spectacle of feeding a malcontent to the giant spiders in the webs beneath Velkynvelve. Drow guards or quaggoth servants throw the bound prisoner over the edge into the webs, where the spiders quickly converge to bite the victim, injecting their venom. Once the victim is paralyzed, the spiders wrap their meal up in webbing. This event is a convenient opportunity to get rid of one or more of the other prisoners before the escape attempt if you don't want them around. As well, you can drive home the cruelty and threat of the drow by eliminating an NPC with whom the characters have formed a bond.

THE DROW The garrison at Velkynvelve consists of twelve drow. five drow elite warriors, a junior drow priestess named Asha (use the priest stat block in the Monster Manual, but add the Fey Ancestry, Innate Spellcasting, and Sunlight Sensitivity features of the drow stat block), and the outpost's commander, a senior drow priestess of Lolth named Tlvara. The drow have the assistance of a pack of twelve quaggoths and six trained giant spiders. P ROMINENT D ROW llvara Mizzrym Asha Vandree Shoor Vandree Duskryn

Drow priestess and commander of the outpost Junior priestess Drow elite warrior. Ilvara's lieutenant and lover, and Asha's distant cousin Jorlan Maimed drow elite warrior. Ilvara’s former lieutenant and lover.

ILVARA MIZZRYM

The commander of Velkynvelve is an ambitious drow priestess looking to rise in the esteem of Lolth and her house. She considers command of a mere outpost a stepping stone in her ascension. The posting is beneath her, and she treats both it and her prisoners with contempt. But she also knows the posting is temporary, and she intends to wring every advantage from it in the meantime. A member of a drow house with a long history as slavers, Ilvara is a cruel mistress who enjoys taunting and tormenting enemies and underlings alike. In addition to a scourge, she wields a tentacle rod. CHAPTER 1 I PRISONERS OF THE DROW

9

Although she has taken Shoor Vandree as her lover, Ilvara cares no more about him than she did about Jorlan Duskryn, the lover she discarded due to his crippling injuries.

CHAPTER 1 I PRISONERS OF THE DROW

10

R OLEPLAYING THE D ROW The drow are arrogant, cruel, and vicious, viewing their slaves as little more than livestock and treating them with cold disregard. Even the lowest drow understands the inferiority of other creatures, behaving toward the prisoners like sneering nobility. With their superiors, however, the drow are fawning sycophants with a passive-aggressive edge, The males defer to the females, the rankand-file warriors defer to the elite warriors, and everyone defers to the priestess llvara. I LVAR A M IZZ RYM

A SHA V ANDREE

A junior drow priestess under Ilvara's guidance. Asha initially considered llvara an example to emulate. That changed after she saw how llvara treated Jorlan Duskryn, a seasoned drow warrior who was the commander’s lover up until he was hadly wounded, llvara discarded Jorlan without a second thought, showing Asha the foolishness of expecting any reward for loyalty. Asha is ambitious enough to know she could assume command of the outpost if anything was to happen to llvara, but not courageous enough to challenge her superior openly. She also knows that she would have to impress her superiors in the City of Spiders for any such field promotion to become permanent. As such, Asha moves cautiously, fanning the fires ofjorlan’s hatred while keeping her own hands clean of any plotting. S HOOR V ANDREE

This drow elite warrior has assumed the role of Tlvara’s lieutenant and lover after the injuries suffered by his predecessor, Jorlan Duskryn. Shoor is relatively young and quite arrogant for a drow male, proud of his abilities and accomplishments. He is still flush with his success in winning the favor of llvara and advancing his position

Twithin the outpost, which shows in his swagger and the way he lords it over every' other male in Velkynvelve, particularly Jorlan. Still insecure in his position, Shoor feels the need to demonstrate his skill and effectiveness to his mistress and to find ways to please her. As Ilvara's lieutenant, Shoor carries a wand of viscid globs (see appendix B), which once belonged to Jorlan and is used to capture and restrain prisoners. J ORLAN D USKRYN

Jorlan turned a talent for inflicting pain into skill as a warrior, and a certain roguish charm into a way to ingratiate himself with his female superiors. He quickly made himself useful to llvara Mizzrym as both the field commander of the Velkynvelve garrison and as her lover, enjoying all the benefits that came with both roles. Jorlan thought that Lolth favored him, or at least that his charms had deflected her malice, until he had the misfortune of a run-in with a black pudding on an otherwise routine raid. Ilvara’s healing magic saved his life hut couldn't undo the terrible damage wrought by the ooze’s acid. With his once-handsome face melted and scarred, and his sword hand twisted and missing two fingers, Jorlan was no longer the warrior he once was. llvara relieved Jorlan of duty during his recuperation, replacing him with the young bravo Shoor Vandree. When she then took Shoor to her bed, Jorlan realized his recovery would never be sufficient to regain what he had lost. His heartbreak and loss has since become a virulent hatred for llvara and Shoor that slowly e.ats at him. Jorlan finds the idea of suicide or reckless selfdestruction beneath him, however—unless he can find a way to take llvara and her new lover with him. Jorlan knows full well that the sympathy the priestess Asha shows him is an attempt to manipulate him. But he’s willing to play along for the time being, hoping to draw Asha closer and potentially use her against llvara when the time is right. Because of his injuries, Jorlan has disadvantage on attack rolls, Dexterity checks, and Dexterity saving throws. D ROW W ARRIORS

The remaining drow males garrisoning Velkynvelve are named Balok. Bemeril. Guldor. Honemmeth, Imbros, Jaezred.Jevan, Kalannar, Malagar, Nadal. Nym, and Sorn.

CHAPTER 1 ! PRISONERS OF THE DROW

VELKYNVELVE The drow outpost is located high in a cavern, built 100 feet above the rocky floor. The outpost consists of a series of small caves in the cavern walls and four “hanging towers"—hollowed-out stalactites connected by walkways, stairs, and rope bridges. The towers are concealed by the thick webs of giant spiders stretched below them, so that only the lowermost parts of the stalactites are visible from the cavern floor. With the small amount of dim light used in the outpost shielded from the cavern floor below, one might walk the entire length of the cleft without becoming aware of the outpost overhead, hidden in the darkness above the range of torches and lanterns. The giant spiders also serve as guards, dropping down on their web strands to prey upon creatures that lind their way into the cavern. Similarly, drow warriors can drop to the cave floor on lines of spider silk to ambush enemies. Three caves and two hanging towers surrounding a platform make up the main part of the outpost for the drow warriors. The largest of the hanging towers is reserved for the priestesses and the shrine of Lolth, while the other is a guard tower opposite the cave used to hold slaves. North of the slave pen is the den of the outpost's quaggoth servants. Watch posts lie at either end of the outpost, near the northern and southern entrances to the cavern.

1. S OU T H E R N W ATC H P O ST Near the southern passage from the cavern is an alcove used as a watch post. Two drow are stationed here at all times, keeping watch over the passage and noting the approach of any creatures. The duty is long and dull, so the watchers are sometimes distracted. A successful Dexterity (Stealth) check made against the guards' passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 12 allows characters to pass unnoticed. Any light from the passage or the cavern below automatically draws the guards’ attention, however. The drow guards are under orders to report intruders immediately, and to keep them tinder observation. They take no other action unless ordered or unless they see signs of a significant threat. In that case, they blow a high, shrill note on a warning trumpet to alert the whole outpost.

2. B A R R A C K S

Stone steps lead from the watch post to a 1-foot-thick platform of zurkhwood (see “Fungi of the Underdark" earlier in this chapter) extending between two of the hanging lowers and into three adjoining caverns. The two southernmost caves serve as barracks for the rank and-file drow warriors of the outpost. Six warriors dwell in each barracks, each set up with a pallet, a small zurkhwood chest for holding personal possessions and equipment, and a side tabic. Spider silk rope webbing on the cavern walls is set with hooks for hanging lanterns and other items, but the barracks are rarely lit. One drow is present in each of the barracks caves at any time, resting in a meditative trance. A resting drow rises at any significant light or noise, ready to attack.

V ELKYNVELVE : G ENERAL F EATURES The following features apply throughout the outpost. Light. The interior spaces of the outpost are dimly illuminated by lanterns containing phosphorescent fungi, while the exterior is dark. Sound. A small waterfall pouring into the cavern creates a constant background noise, negating the cave’s tendency to amplify and carry sounds. Checks made to hear things in the cavern are made normally. Stain. These 5-foot-wide stairs are carved into the stone sides of the cavern between several of the cave entrances. Bridges. Bridges of spider-silk rope connect the walkways to the guard tower and the entrance to the priestess's tower. The swaying bridges are difficult terrain for non-drow. Falling. A creature pushed off the stairs, a bridge, or the edge of a platform must attempt a DC 10 Dexterity saving throw. On a failure, the creature falls, landing in the webs stretched beneath the outpost. On a successful save, a creature grabs hold of the edge and hangs there until it can climb back up with a DC 10 Strength (Athletics) check made as part of its movement. A failed Strength check means the creature is unable to move and must check again, while failure by 5 or more means a fall to the webs. Webs. The dense webs of giant spiders kept by the drow conceal the outpost from below. A creature falling into the webs becomes restrained. As an action, a restrained creature can attempt a DC 12 Strength check to break free from the webs. The webs can also be attacked and destroyed (AC 10, 15 hp per 10-foot section, vulnerability to fire, and immunity to bludgeoning, poison, and psychic damage). Each foot of movement in the webs costs 1 extra foot, and any creature other than a spider that enters the webs or starts its turn there must succeed on a DC 12 Strength or Dexterity check to avoid becoming restrained. Any movement in the webs attracts the attention of the giant spiders, which attack and feed on trapped creatures. A creature falling from the webbing to the cavern floor takes 10d6 bludgeoning damage. TREASURE

The equipment of the resting drow is stored under his pallet: a shortsword, a hand crossbow with a case of 20 hand crossbow bolts, a chain shirt, and a 100-foot coil of silk rope with a small grappling hook at the end. Each of the six chests in each barracks contains a flask of drow poison used to treat crossbow bolts (see "Poisons" in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide). One flask has enough poison to treat 20 bolts. Each chest also contains two sets of clothing and ld4 items from the Trinkets table in chapter 5 of the Player's Handbook.

3. M AIN H ALL This cave serves as a gathering and eating place for the drow warriors of the outpost. It has four circular tables carved from zurkhwood. each surrounded by five chairs. Part of the hall is used as a food preparation and storage area, containing stocks of dried and fresh fungi, dried fruits, cheeses, preserved meat, and a few clay jars of spices. A heavy iron brazier provides heat for cooking along with dim light, but much of the food is served cold. At any time, there is a 25 percent chance that ld4 drow are in the main hall eating or entertaining themselves with dice or card games. If any drow are

it

present. Id4 quaggoths are also on hand, serving and cleaning. If there are no drow in the main hall, there is a 25 percent chance that a lone quaggoth is here performing its duties. TREASURE

There is nothing of value in the main hall apart from what the drow have on them, but characters can loot the larder for the equivalent of up to 30 days of rations, limited by what they can carry. Each day of rations for one character weighs 2 pounds.

4. E LIT E B AR R A C K S The two hanging towers flanking the platform arc the quarters of the elite warriors of the outpost, except for the commander’s lieutenant (currently Shoor Vandree) who has his own quarters in the priestess's tower. Each hanging tower has two chambers, with a rope ladder running between the upper and lower chamber through a zurkhwood trapdoor. The elite warriors have finer furniture, including zurkhwood chairs and small tables around which they sit. One off-duty drow elite warrior rests in one of the chambers here at any given time. There is a 50 percent chance that one quaggoth is also present, carrying out chores such as cleaning up or delivering water. Either reacts hostilely to intruders, but they might choose to flee and warn the outpost rather than attack, depending on the odds. TREASURE

The equipment of the resting drow warrior is stowed beneath his pallet: a shortsword, a hand crossbow with a case of 20 bolts, a chain shirt, and a 100-foot coil of silk rope with a small grappling hook at the end. Each of the chests in the four chambers contains a flask of drow poison used to treat crossbow bolts. One flask has enough poison to treat 20 bolts. Each chest also contains two changes of clothing, 2d6 sp, ld8 gp, and 1d4 items from the Trinkets table in chapter 5, “Equipment," of the Player's Handbook.

5. L I FT Attached to the edge of the barracks platform is a winchand-basket device consisting of a large swinging arm that carries a thin cord of strong spider silk. The cord runs through a series of pulleys from a hand-cranked horizontal spool to a heavy woven basket suspended at the end. The basket is kept up on the platform except when it is in use. Two quaggoth attendants remain by the lift to watch for a signal from below for the basket to be lowered. They are on guard in case anyone other than a drow or one of their own kind approaches. USING THE LIFT

Up to four Medium creatures can fit somewhat snugly in the basket, which is swung out over the edge of the platform and lowered to the cavern floor below by turning the spool using attached handles. This requires a successful DC 18 Strength check, normally provided by CHAPTER 1 | PRISONERS OK THE DROW

12

two quaggoth servants (one of which makes the check while the other assists with the Help action). Once on the cave floor, the basket can be loaded with other passengers or up to 800 pounds of cargo, then lifted back up to the platform in the same way. It takes 4 rounds for the basket to move between the platform and the floor under normal operation.

6. S HR INE

TO L O LTH A steep rope bridge leads from the walkway ledge to the uppermost level of the largest hanging tower, called the priestess’s tower. The floor of this circular chamber is covered by dark silken mats with a pale web- strand pattern woven through them in silvery thread. In the middle of the chamber (at the center of the web) stands a broad pedestal carved front zurkhwood, with a 10-foot-high sculpted spider at its head. The carving is so lifelike that anyone initially entering the chamber and seeing it in dim light must succeed on a DC 12 Wisdom (Perception) check to recognize it. On a failure, a character mistakes it for a real giant spider. This place is a shrine to Lolth, the drow's spider goddess, and also serves as quarters for Asha, the junior priestess. She tends the shrine, overseeing routine rituals and offerings to Lolth. Roll a d6 when the characters enter the shrine to determine who they might meet. S H R I N E ACTIVITY d6 1-2 3-4 5-6

Activity Asha is in the room alone, resting Asha and ld4 drow are engaged in worship The shrine is empty

The back half of the chamber, behind the altar, is piled with a semicircle of pillows and cushions. Resting among these is a giant spider trained and kept by the priestesses. The cushions give the spider sufficient concealment to hide from anyone entering the tower from the front. A character must succeed on a Wisdom (Perception) check contested by the spider's Dexterity (Stealth) check to spot it before it moves. TREASURE

The altar is flanked by a pair of heavy silver candlesticks worth 25 gp each. They hold thick black candles, lit only when a ritual is being performed in the shrine. The eight "eyes" of the spider statue are eight pieces of polished jet—four small ones worth 5 gp each and four larger ones worth 10 gp each. Any non-drow who possesses these gems falls under a curse from Lolth. All spiders and spiderlike creatures attack the bearer of the stones on sight, and such creatures have advantage on checks to detect the possessor of the stones. The curse lasts until all the stones are given into the safekeeping of a drow worshiper of Lolth or the gems are subject to a remove curse spell.

7. I LVAR A ’ S Q UARTE R S _______________ A rope ladder leads down front the shrine into this

chamber, which serves as private quarters to Mistress Ilvara, priestess of Lolth and commander of Velkynvelve.

CHAPTER 1 | PRISONERS OK THE DROW

13

CHAPTER 1 I PRISONERS OF THF DtiOW

14

-

- :

-

■ *

i"

.

'

-

■ r—

:n:iling

- from a central spot on the ceAMgm to the walls. then draped down like curtains. ThrL awui ants cow the floor, while a low platform gcDtrcd with rush ions and pillows to make a broad. zr.i- v- :e ; line side of the chamber contains a hairs, while the other holds a small - ■ - r - to Lolth. draped in white silk. A heavy chest of statue ri zurkhwood sits at the foot of the bed. ! . ara retreats to her quarters for privacy, rest, and meditation. Roll a d6. On 1-2, the priestess is here. On a roll of 1. Shoor Vandree is also here with her. Ilvara is furious if anyone dares to enter her quarters unbidden. If the characters catch her here, she casts web, conjure animals, or insect plague to bedevil them while she flees and calls for help. If Shoor is with Ilvara. he attacks to cover her escape. T RAP

The chest is locked, and Ilvara keeps the key in a hidden pocket on the inside of her belt. The lock is trapped with a poison needle tipped with drow poison (see “Poisons" in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide), which is activated if any attempt is made to open the lock without lhe proper key. The victim takes 1 piercing damage and must succeed on a DC 13 Constitution saving throw or be poisoned for 1 hour. If the saving throw fails by 5 or more, the target is also unconscious while poisoned in this way. A successful DC 20 Intelligence (Investigation) check reveals the trap. A character using thieves' tools can make a successful DC 15 Dexterity check to disarm it. Picking the lock requires thieves' tools and another successful DC 15 Dexterity check. T REASURE

The side table holds a small silver-framed mirror worth 10 gp. The small shrine to Lolth is carved of zurkhwood and bone, and inlaid with semiprecious stones. It is worth 50 gp if the characters can find a buyer for it. The chest contains a variety of silken garments and personal items. There is a silver chain headdress set with small onyx stones, worth 50 gp, and a drawstring bag containing two potions of healing. A small leather purse contains 24 gp, 30 sp, and a small moonstone worth 20 gp. while another purse is Ilvara's spare spell component pouch. Additionally, the chest contains any valuables once held by the characters and NPCs. including any spellbooks, components, focuses, and magic items lost to the adventurers.

8. S HOOR ’ S Q U A RTE R S The lowermost and smallest chamber of the priestess's tower belongs to the commander’s lieutenant, the leader of the elite warriors of the outpost. Shoor Vandree. Ilvara's current favorite, is the present occupant. The area’s former occupant, Jorlan Duskryn, has been displaced to the elite barracks after his recent injuries. The chamber contains cushions laid out across floor mats, a small carved table with two chairs, and a sturdy

zurkhwood chest. Shoor spends most of his off-duty time in Ilvara's quarters, attending to his mistress or awaiting her. Unless you wish him to be found here, his quarters are unoccupied. TRAP

The chest is locked, and Shoor keeps the key in his belt pouch. The lock is trapped with a poison needle trap identical to the one in Ilvara's quarters. TREASURE

The table holds a pewter pitcher and a pair of matched goblets, worth a total of 1 gp. The chest contains Shoor’s personal items and clothing, as well as a small purse containing 20 gp, a black velvet mask stitched with silver thread in a spiderweb pattern (worth 25 gp), a set of bone dice engraved with Elvish characters (worth 10 gp), a small black velvet bag containing a spider-shaped onyx brooch (w'orth 50 gp), and a flask of strong, syrupy blue liquor (worth 10 gp). The liquor leaves anyone who drinks it pleasantly poisoned for ld4 hours.

9. W ATE R FALL Water vents through a crack in the ceiling near the eastern wall between the stalactites of the priestess's tower and the guard tower, creating a small waterfall that pours down to the cavern floor and forms a natural pool (see area 14). Quaggoths gather small barrels of water from the head of the waterfall to serve the outpost's needs. The water makes the stone wall within 10 feet of it difficult to scale. Any creature attempting to do so has disadvantage on checks made to climb. Any character who falls lands in the pool below, taking no damage.

10. G UAR D T OWE R The fourth hanging tower, connected by rope bridges to the slave pen and the walkway alongside the priestess's tower, serves as a guard tower for observing the cavern, the western passage, and the slave pen. The lower chamber of the tower is occupied by two drow and one drow elite warrior on guard duty. It contains a zurkhwood table and three chairs, a smaller side table, and spider-silk webbing set with hooks for hanging equipment. As at the watch posts, guard duty here is a dull affair, and the guards are usually distracted enough (talking or passing the time with dice games) that prisoners can move or act unnoticed with a successful Dexterity (Stealth) check contested by the guards' passive Wisdom (Perception) score. The tower’s upper chamber stores extra arms and armor for the outpost. Characters who gain entrance to the armory can easily loot it (see “Treasure”). TREASURE

The contents of the armory include the following: • 6 chain shirts • 6 suits of studded leather armor CHAPTER 1 I PRISONERS OF THE DROW

15

• 6 shields • 6 hand crossbows • 20 cases of hand crossbow bolts, each case containing 20 bolts • 6 shortswords and 10 daggers • 6 bags of caltrops (20 caltrops per bag) • 4 100-foot-long coils of silk rope • 2 building hammers (not usable as weapons) ■ 2 bags of iron spikes (10 spikes per bag)

11. SLAVE PEN__________________________ This cave is built to hold captives until they are sent to Menzoberranzan to be sold as slaves. The gate to the slave pen is kept locked. A character using thieves’ tools can pick the lock with a successful DC 20 Dexterity check. A character using makeshift tools can attempt the same check but has disadvantage. A lock-picking attempt might draw the attention of the guards, requiring a Dexterity (Stealth) check contested by the guards' passive Wisdom (Perception) score to carry it off without notice. Each of the guards on duty in the other areas of the outpost has a key to the gate hanging from a belt ring. Breaking the gate's lock and forcing it open requires a successful DC 20 Strength check. MAGICAL WARDS

The drow have placed powerful wards on the slave pen to inhibit spellcastcrs and shield the area against scrying attempts. Spells cast within the slave, pen have no effect, and any slot or magic item charge expended to cast such a spell is consumed. The wards don't suppress or negate spell effects that originate outside the slave pen. For example, a creature under the effect of an invisibility spell remains invisible when it enters the slave pen. Creatures inside the slave pen can't be targeted by any divination magic or perceived through magical serving sensors.

12. Q UAGGOT H D E N ___________________ Beyond the slave pen and down a set of stone steps, this cave is used as a den by the dozen quaggoths that serve the drow of Velkynvelve. The interior is littered with nest-like mounds of debris and the scattered bones of the quaggoths' past meals. These servants of the drow use the den only to sleep and eat. with ld4 quaggoths resting here at any given time. The quaggoths attack any creature that comes into their den ihat isn’t a drow. a spider, or one of their kind. They don't initially attack unknown quaggoths or drow on sight, hut they know all those assigned to the outpost and will question strangers. Derendil and Sarith’s status as prisoners is known to them.

13. N ORTHE R N W ATC H P O ST ___________ This small alcove just past and below the quaggoth den has the same features as the watch post at area 1. Two drow are stationed here on watch, typically hating that duty for its proximity to the quaggoth den.

CHAPTER 1 I PRISONERS OF THE DROW

16

the slave pen, and the pool. 14. P OOL Water pouring down from the waterfall at area 9 forms a 20-foot-deep pool before flowing out into an underground river that travels several miles before spilling into the Darklake. Since the drow take the water they need from the top of the waterfall, they use the pool to dump waste and garbage. Although this fouls the surface of the pool, the constant flow keeps the water beneath the surface clear. A gray ooze lurks in the pool's shallows, blending perfectly with the dark, wet stone. It feeds on the waste dumped into the pool, along with the occasional creature that finds its way into the cavern or falls into the pool. The inhabitants of Velkynvelve remain unaware that the recent arrival of the demon lord Juiblex in the Underdark has made this ooze particularly aggressive and malevolent. In addition to attacking any creature in the pool, the ooze surges up to 10 feet out of the pool to attack creatures at its edge. When it does so, creatures within 30 feet of the ooze tclcpathically sense a voice cry out. “Flesh for the Faceless Lord!"

MEANS OF ESCAPE

Unless they want to spend the rest of their lives as drow slaves, the characters should quickly begin looking for ways they can escape. Though the task will not he easy, the characters can take advantage of certain opportunities if they use their heads.

A C QUI SI T I ON S _________________________ One or more of the characters might have useful items' in their possession (sec “Scavenged Possessions”), and working outside the slave pen creates new opportunities for the characters to acquire and hide small items, including makeshift weapons or tools, or even lift a key to the slave pen from a guard. What they can acquire depends on the work they do and where they go. Use the description of the different locations throughout the outpost as a guide to opportunities. Taking something without being noticed requires a successful Dexterity (Sleight of Hand) cheek contested by the Wisdom (Perception) checks of any active observers, or using an observer's passive Wisdom (Perception) score as the base DC. A prisoner that fails the check is commanded to relinquish the item, on pain of death. What equipment and treasures the characters claim during their escape depend on how much of the outpost they arc able to explore before fleeing. For some characters, it might be a fun challenge to escape into the Underdark with little more than the clothes on their backs. For others (including spelRasters who need spellbooks or components), consider placing the party's captured equipment (normally in Ilvara’s quarters) in an alternate location if the characters are intent on escaping without exploring all of the outpost, such as the elite drow barracks (area 4) or the armory (area 10). J ORLAN ’ S G AMBIT When the initial contact between the adventurers and the

other prisoners has been played out, Jorlan Duskryn arranges to bring the prisoners their food during his guard duty. (Shoor delights in giving Jorlan such menial work). Standing at the gate to the slave pen and passing in bowls, he mutters to the nearest character: “If 1 could give you a means to escape from here, would you take it?” If the answer is affirmative, Jorlan quickly and quietly proposes to leave the gate to the slave pen unlocked, as well as to create a distraction during the changing of the guards on duty. He tells the characters about the armory, located in the chamber above the guard post in the hanging guard tower in front of the slave pen. The escapees can jump down into the webs below, then over the edge into the pool, making their escape from there. Jorlan doesn’t particularly care if the prisoners actually escape, which is why he doesn’t offer any further help or warn them about the gray ooze in the pool. It suits him just as well if the prisoners are killed during their attempt to flee. He simply wants to create an embarrassing incident for Shoor and llvara. Jorlan furtively glances around as he speaks quickly to the characters. If they question him or ask for changes to the plan, he insists it is all he can do. If they accept, he is true to his word, leaving the gate unlocked dose to the next guard shift change and delaying the replacement guards for a few minutes.

A F LIGHT

OF D EMONS During a guard change, the prisoners hear a horrible droning buzz echoing through the cavern, followed by inhuman shrieking. Alarm horns sound out as four chasme demons pursue a pair of vrock demons into the cavern from the northern passage. The demons swoop and buzz around, initially ignoring other creatures as both groups savagely assault each other. The demons’ arrival catches all of the drowr off guard. The drow rush to defend the outpost from a possible attack. The demons initially buzz past the hanging towers, leaving the walkways and caverns out of range of the effects of their droning and screeching. However, drow and quaggoths in the towers are close enough to be affected. The aerial battle eventually circles around the platform and the towers of the elite warriors as the demons savagely tear into each other. The drow move to engage the demons and defend the outpost, leaving the characters with an opportunity to escape. You can combine this event with Jorlan’s offer to leave the gate unlocked, making it easy for the characters to slip away. Alternatively (or if they refuse Jorlan's offer), the characters can use the distraction to engineer their own breakout, then decide how to get down to the cavern floor and where to go after that. Describe the chaos of the demon attack and the drow’s response as the escaped prisoners try to flee. The characters can follow Jorlan’s suggestion to drop into the webs and then dive into the pool, possibly dealing with a giant spider or two and the gray ooze along the way. Alternatively, they can look for another

way down. Reaching the lift requires getting past the drow clustered on the platform and then attempting to operate it during the attack, which might prove difficult. If you want to provide an additional challenge for the characters, a vrock tumbles almost in front of them as they reach the cavern floor or move toward their chosen exit. The demon is badly wounded, but even with only 11 hit points remaining and having expended its spores and stunning screech abilities, it is still quite dangerous. It screeches at the characters, but if they do nothing to threaten it for 1 round, the demon takes wing and launches itself back into the fight overhead. If the adventurers take on the fallen vrock and defeat or escape from it, award them a quarter of its usual XP value, or 575 XP, given its weakened state. Ifjorlan is alive when the demons attack, he might use the distraction to free the prisoners (as described in “Jorlan’s Gambit”). Any character who asks Jorlan about the demons gets a stern reply: “The demons are not my doing. Fight them at your own risk.”

LEAVING VELKYNVELVE

The characters have three choices for leaving Velkynvelve: the north, west, and south passages.

N ORTH P ASSAGE _______________________ This leads toward Menzoberranzan (see chapter 15) and, eventually, Blingdenstone (see chapter 6). Most of the characters’ fellow prisoners discourage travel toward the drow city, and the deep gnomes suggest Blingdenstone as a route out of the Underdark. The party can also follow a circuitous route westward toward the Darklake (see chapter 3).

W EST P ASSAGE

This leads most directly toward the Darklake (see chapter 3), although the party could eventually veer south toward Gracklstugh (see chapter 4).

S OUTH P ASSAGE _______________________ This leads toward Lhe duergar city of Gracklstugh (see chapter 4), following a south-westerly route. Characters might need to pass under the battling demons, but the cavern floor is well out of range of their droning and screeching. The demons locked in combat ignore the escaping prisoners, with the possible exception of a fallen vrock (see “A Flight of Demons”). Whichever route the characters take, chapter 2 covers their passage through the Underdark toward their eventual destination.

XP AWARDS

In addition to the XP awards earned for overcoming the creatures in this chapter, escaping from Velkynvelve earns the characters a special award of 150 XP (divided equally among all party members).

CHAPTER 1 I PRISONERS OF THE DROW

17

CHAPTER 2: INTO DARKNESS Once the adventurers escape from Velkynveive, they’ll want to escape the Underdark. Already miles beneath the surface, they must make their way through an endless maze of passages and caverns, avoid pursuit by the drow, and find a route to the world above all the while dealing with the dangers of the Underdark and struggling to find the resources they need to survive. This chapter presents guidelines for the characters’ travels between the various Underdark locales detailed in the other chapters of Out of the Abyss. Specific areas (including the Darklake region in chapter 3) offer modifications to these guidelines to suit those areas' particular qualities. This chapter also offers guidelines for the drow pursuit of the escaped prisoners, along with additional encounters you can place along the adventurers’ route as they travel.

WHERE TO GO?

The players' first question upon escaping from Velkynveive is likely, “Where do we go next?" The adventurers must find a way out of the Underdark and

back to the surface world. Their NPC companions have destinations of their own in mind, and are the ones best able to navigate the subterranean realms. As such, the adventurers will be dependent on their guidance. The NPCs can offer directions and suggestions as follows: • Buppido knows how to reach Gracklstugh from the southern route out of Velkynveive. He can also find a route to Gracklstugh from the Darklake. Buppido urges the characters to go to Gracklstugh to acquire better equipment, and out of a desire to return to his people. He also intends to murder the characters one by one along the wav. believing them to be divine offerings delivered into his hands. • Prince Derendil, the delusional quaggoth. can't offer any useful directions, but he gladly accompanies the party, eager to go to the surface world. • Eldeth Feldrun is unfamiliar with this region of the Underdark and can’t navigate, but she has a +5 bonus on Wisdom (Survival) checks and can help out in that regard.

CHAPTER 2 1 INTO DARKNESS r

7

O N T HEIR O WN In the event that none of the prisoners who manage to escape with the party can navigate in the Underdark—- or none that the characters are willing to heed at any 'ate— the adventurers will be forced to wander. The party remains iost until the characters encounter creatures able to give them directions or intent on capturing them. Such creatures can include kuo-toa from Sloobludop, duergar slavers or merchants from Gracklstugh, the goblins from the Silken Paths encounter, or even their drow pursuers intent on dragging them back to Velkynvelve.

• Jimjar can guide the party to Blingdenstone from the north route out of Velkynvelve. The svirfneblin city will give the characters access to the surface, although Jimjar is fine with visiting other interesting places along the way, as well as taking Stool back to its home. • Ront is unfamiliar with the Underdark and can’t navigate. He’s willing to stick with the adventurers as long as they seek a destination that gets him back to the surface world. • Sarith Kzekarit is the best potential guide in the group, but also the most deceptive. He can navigate to any region of the Underdark shown on the map, but will encourage the characters to travel to Ncverlight Grove (see chapter 5). He claims to want to take advantage of Stool’s offer of sanctuary, but it is actually the influence of Zuggtmoy’s demon-tainted spores upon his mind. • Shuushar can navigate through the Darklake once the party is within three miles of any part of it. He’s willing to travel with the characters and guide them, and suggests visiting the kuo-toa town of Sloobludop to acquire boats. Shuushar wishes to return to his own people in hopes of guiding them to the enlightenment he has achieved. • Stool can’t navigate and has no knowledge of the local area, but it desperately wants to return home to Neverlight Grove, pleading with the characters to take it there. It claims that its people will be grateful and offer the party shelter and aid, and describes its sovereign as wise in the hidden ways of the Underdark. • Topsy and Turvy can navigate to Blingdcnstone, but they’re reluctant to do so. As such, they are likely to support any suggestion that will not take them to their former home. Once they feel safer, they're likely to strike out on their own, just as they were before the drow captured them.

I8

CHAPTER 2 I INTO DARKNESS

UNDERDARK TRAVEL The Underdark is a vast network of caverns, tunnels, vaults, and passages stretching from one end of Faerun to the other. Its physical features are even more varied than those of the surface world. Subterranean rivers, fungus fields, deep gorges, underground cities, yawning chasms—the adventurers will have to deal with all these fealures and more. Much of the party’s travel through the Underdark is handled abstractly, using the rules and advice in chapter 8, “’Adventuring." of the Player’s Handbook, The following specific guidelines apply to travel in the Underdark during this adventure.

T RAVEL P ACE Travel pace in the Underdark is significantly slower than for overland travel. Not only are the tunnels and Pace Fast Normal Slow

Miles Per Day Effect 8 6 4

-5 penalty to passive Wisdom (Perception) scores; no foraging — improved foraging, or able to use Stealth

passages often difficult terrain with uneven surfaces, but routes in the Underdark are rarely direct, and the characters must follow available passages and their various twists and turns, climbs and descents. Creatures that can burrow through solid rock (such as purple worms) move at their normal burrowing speed, but this isn’t likely an option for the party. U NDERDARK T RAVEL P ACE

A fast pace makes it harder to spot ambushes or items of interest and prevents the characters from foraging, while a slow pace allows the characters to travel stealthily enough to surprise or sneak past creatures they encounter, and improves their chances of successful foraging for food and water. The Underdark Travel Times table shows the time to travel between the locations in chapters 1 through 6 of the adventure. These times assume that the party moves at a normal pace without stopping (other than for time spent resting or becoming lost). For a fast pace, reduce the travel times by one third; for a slow pace, increase them by one third.

U NDERDARK T RAVEL T IMES Location Velkynvelve —

Sloobludop

Velkynvelve Sloobludop

8 days

8 days —

Gracklstugh Neverlight Grove Blingdenstone Menzoberranzan

28 36 30 26

20 26 20 20

days days days days

days days days days

Gracklstugh 28 days 20 days — 12 days 20 days 27 days

Neverlight Grove

Blingdenstone

36 days 26 days

30 days 20 days

12 days —

20 days 16 days —

16 days 24 days

8 days

Menzoberranz an 26 days 20 days 27 days 24 days 8 days -

nlM!

:■' t -.'■ : 'V .V-

Uppeidark

Middledark Lowerdar k All Depths r^l hex = 24 mile:

W0m $ An.

E NCOUNTER S ETUP _____________________ When an encounter occurs during the adventurers’ journey, a number of factors will play into its setup and potential difficulty. S PACE

AND

M ARCHING O RDER

Ask the players to establish two marching orders for the characters—one for moving single file and one for moving two abreast. Then when an encounter occurs, roll a d6. On a roll of 1 2, the party is traveling through a narrow passageway, so position the adventurers in the single-file marching order. On a roll of 3-4, the characters are traveling through a standard passageway and can use the two-abreast marching order. On a roll of 5-6, the encounter occurs in a large open area, so allow the players to position the characters wherever they like. I LLUMINATION

Roil a d6 to determine how an encounter area is illuminated. On a roll of 1 -3, the area is dimly lit by the phosphorescent moss and lichen common in the Underdark, or by faerzress (see “Faerzress"). On a roll of 4-6, the area is dark except for whatever light sources the characters might have.

N OTICING T HREATS

The passive Wisdom (Perception) scores of characters in the party count toward noticing hidden threats only if both the following conditions are met: • The characters are able to see the threat (due to illumination or darkvision) or otherwise perceive it. • The characters aren’t engaged in other activities, including navigating or foraging. A fast pace imposes a -5 penalty to passive Wisdom (Perception) scores to notice threats. You might also decide that only characters in a particular rank of the marching order are able to notice a specific threat. S URPRISE

When an encounter occurs, determine if the adventurers or their foes are surprised, as normal. The adventurers can achieve surprise only if all the following conditions are met: • The encounter occurs while the party is moving (not stopped or camped). • The party elected the stealth option while moving at a slow pace. • At least one party member is capable of noticing the threat and communicating it to the rest of the group.

N AVIGATING Becoming lost is a serious risk in the twisting tunnels of the Underdark, and travelers can wander in circles without knowing it. Creatures unfamiliar with a given region of the Underdark are automatically lost, wandering in a random direction for every 4 hours of travel until they encounter an area they are familiar with (which could be a very long time). Even creatures that know the routes of the Underdark aren’t immune. For each day of travel, and any time the characters set out again after finishing a short or long rest, the party’s navigator makes a DC 10 Wisdom CHAPTER 2 I INTO DARKNESS

20

(Survival) check. If the party is moving at a slow pace, the navigator gains a +5 bonus to the check, while a fast pace imposes a -5 penalty. A failed check result means the characters become lost, wandering in a random direction for ld6 hours before the navigator can make a new check to find the right path.

M APPING

A character not focused on any other task - including watching for danger while traveling—can record the group’s progress through the Underdark and create a map of the route. Such a map can be a useful resource in later chapters of the adventure when the characters retrace their steps. Having a map allows the party to navigate that area without any chance of becoming lost.

F ORAGING Unless they obtain a supply of food and water, the adventurers must forage to survive on their journey. Finding sustenance in the Underdark is difficult but not impossible. Characters can gather food and water if the party travels at a normal or slow pace. A foraging character makes a Wisdom (Survival) check. The DC is typically 15, but might be as high as 20 in some parts of the Underdark. Food and water requirements for characters are described in chapter 8, “Adventuring,” of the Players Handbook. In addition to foraging, spells such as create food and water and goodberry can help provision the party, and there's always a chance for the characters to encounter others from whom they can buy or steal provisions. Additionally, many creatures the adventurers might meet and kill can be butchered, but the meat they yield spoils after a single day if uneaten. Eating spoiled meat might require a Constitution saving throw to keep the meal down, a Wisdom saving throw to avoid acquiring a level of madness from the awful experience (see “Madness" later in this chapter), or both. C REATURE F OOD Y IELD Creature Size Tiny Small Medium

Food Gained 1 lb. 41b. 16 lb.

Large

32 lb.

The characters’ need to forage and acquire supplies serves as a motivator to drive them to explore and visit different parts of the Underdark. The more desperate their need becomes—as levels of exhaustion rack up— the more risk players will likely be willing to take.

T IME -K EEPING

With no sunlight, visible sky, seasons, or weather in the Underdark, most characters can only track the passage of time based on their periods of rest. Most Underdark creatures do the same (if they care about timekeeping at all), unless there is a local means of keeping time.

F AERZRESS

C OMPONENTS

An unusual magical energy the drow call faerzress pervades much of the Underdark. The origin of this mysterious arcane power is unknown. Legend claims it is an ancient elven magic dating back to the time when the dark elves were first exiled from the world above. The drow and other Underdark creatures use the properties of areas suffused with faerzress to protect their settlements. Areas suffused with faerzress can range in size from a few dozen feet across to several miles in diameter, and feature the following effects: • Areas suffused with faerzress are always fi 1 led with dim light. • A creature in an area suffused with faerzress has advantage on saving throws against any divination spells. If a divination spell doesn't allow a saving throw, the caster must succeed on a DC 15 Constitution saving throw to cast the spell. Failing this save means the spell is wasted and has no effect. • Any creature attempting to teleport into, within, or out of a /aerzress-suffused area must succeed on a DC 15 Constitution saving throw. On a failed save, the creature takes IdlO force damage and the teleportation attempt fails. Even if the save succeeds, the teleportation attempt can suffer a mishap as if the destination was known only by description, regardless of how familiar the destination actually is. Sec the table in the teleport spell for more information. • Areas suffused with faerzress have become tainted by the chaos of the demon lords. When a spell is cast in a /aerzress-suffused area, the caster rolls a d20. On a roll of 1, the spell has an additional effect, determined by rolling on the Wild Magic Surge table in chapter 3, “Classes," of the Player’s Handbook. Though faerzress can't be dispelled, its effects are temporarily suppressed in the area of an antimagic field.

Spellcasters might be without material components for their spells (see "Components" in chapter 10 of the Player's Handbook). They can acquire component pouches and spellcasting focuses from defeated enemy spellcasters, settlements, and traders, or they can craft such items during their downtime activities while traveling.

EQUIPMENT

The equipment the characters have on hand will depend on what they were able to salvage or steal in their escape from Velkynvelve. Indeed, one of the primary reasons for the party to visit known settlements in the Underdark is to acquire proper equipment and provisions.

C RAFTING Characters can use downtime during their travels to craft equipment, provided they are proficient with the necessary tools and have access to them (see “Downtime Activities" in chapter 8 of the Player's Handbook). Having to improvise tools doubles the crafting time, and some items require materials that are hard to find in the Underdark, including wood and other surface-world plants. Leather, bone, or zurkhwood (see “Fungi of the Underdark" later in this chapter) might substitute in some cases. Crafting can include modifying scavenged or salvaged items to fit other needs, such as creating a makeshift suit of armor from gathered pieces of armor and other materials.

MADNESS At the best of times, the Underdark is a bizarre, alien, and inhospitahle world, but the influence of the demon lords has transformed it into a domain of madness and chaos. Faerzress acts as a catalyst, spreading the demon lords’ madness throughout the Underdark. Once the party escapes Velkynvelve and strikes out into the Underdark, begin taking into account the effects of demonic madness on the characters' sanity (see “Madness" in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide). At various times in the adventure, characters will be called upon to make a saving lhrowr to resist some madness-inducing effect. In addition, you can have one or more characters make a saving throw against madness whenever one of the following events occurs: • The characters encounter or witness something particularly alien or disturbing (such as a demon lord). • The characters stay in a /aerzress-suffused area for a long time (eight or more consecutive hours). • A character takes psychic damage, particularly in an area suffused with faerzress. In Out of the Abyss, madness is measured in three levels: M ADNESS L EVELS Level Effect 1 Bout of short-term madness (lasts IdlO minutes) 2 Bout of long-term madness (lasts IdlO x 10 hours) 3

Bout of indefinite madness (lasts until cured)

A creature's madness level starts at 0. When the creature fails a madness saving throw, its madness level increases by 1. and the creature immediately suffers the level’s effect (as determined by rolling on the ShortTerm Madness. Long-Term Madness, or Indefinite Madness table in the Dungeon Master’s Guide, as appropriate). When the effect ends, the creature's madness level doesn't change. Any time the creature's madness level increases, it suffers the effect of the new level. If a creature with level 3 madness fails a madness saving throw, its madness level becomes 1. In this way, characters can potentially accumulate multiple forms of madness. Bouts of short- and long-term madness can be cured as described in the Dungeon Master's Guide. Given the demonic source of the madness, remove curse and dispel evil are also effective as cures. A greater restoration spell or more powerful magic is needed to cure indefinite madness and also resets a creature's madness level to 0. CHAPTER 2 | INTO DARKNESS

DEATH

Allowing the chips to fall where they may in combat emphasizes the challenging nature of this adventure. However, if the characters start falling just as fast, you might want to give the players some opportunities to return dead characters to life during the lower levels of their progress through Out of the Abyss. • A spell scroll of raise dead can turn up among Some treasure, either when it is needed or for the characters to save for later. A successful DC 15 spellcasting ability check is required for a lower-level character to use such a scroll. • A strange faerzress effect can bring a fallen character back to life, but not without a cost. The restored character’s madness level increases by 1 upon being restored to life (see “Madness" earlier in this chapter). • If a fallen character's body is lost or left behind, the party’s drow pursuers find it. The drow high priestess casts raise dead on the corpse so that the character can be questioned. The character might escape later, or can be reunited with the other adventurers in a later chapter of the adventure when the drow catch up to them. If a player character is permanently slain, think about the ways a player might introduce a new' character to the party in the midst of a journey through the Underdark. • Convert one of the group’s existing nonplayer character allies -including fellow escaped prisoners from Velkynvetve —into a player character. Drow, dwarf, and deep gnome characters are all easily playable. You can even allow a player to take control of a more unusual NPC until a new character can join the group. This is particularly suitable if the player has already been managing that NPC (see “A Motley Crew” in chapter 1). • A creature encounter could reveal a potential new party member, such as a surface dweller lost in the Underdark or sent there to investigate rumors of strange happenings. An escaped slave from another Underdark settlement is another possibility. • A monster encountered by the party might be holding other victims or hostages (a giant spider with a stillliving victim wrapped up in its web. or troglodytes holding prisoners destined for their larder, for example). Once the monsters are defeated, a former captive might join the group. • Characters might meet up with new party members in any of the Underdark settlements they visit during the adventure, particularly visitors or locals with a strong reason to leave in a hurry.

FUNGI OF THE UNDERDARK The Underdark is home to a tremendous variety of fungi with a variety of different uses. Characters can encounter different examples of the Underdark’s flora in their travels. Identifying a species of fungi and its potential uses requires a successful DC 15 Intelligence (Nature) check, but Underdark inhabitants are familiar with many of these species automatically. CHAPTER 2 | INTO DARKNESS

22

E DIBLE F UNGI

Edible fungi provide food and water. Basic food and water requirements for characters arc covered in chapter 8, “Adventuring,” of the Player's Handbook. B ARRELSTALK

A barrelstalk is a large, cask-shaped fungus that can be tapped and drained of the fresh water stored within it. A single barrelstalk contains ld4 i 4 gallons of water and yields ld6 + 4 pounds of food. B LUECAP

Dubbed the “grain of the Underdark,” a bluecap is inedible, but its spores can be ground to make a nutritious, bland flour. Bread made from bluecap flour is known as sporebread or bluebread. One loaf is equivalent to 1 pound of food. F IRE L ICHEN

Pale orange-white in color, fire lichen thrives on warmth, so it grows in regions of geothermal heat. Fire lichen can be ground and fermented into a hot, spicy paste, which is spread on sporebread or added to soups or stews to flavor them. Duergar also ferment fire lichen into a fiercely hot liquor. RlPPLEBARK

Ripplebark is a shelf-like fungus that resembles a mass of rotting flesh. It is surprisingly edible. Though it can be eaten raw, it tastes better roasted. A single sheet of ripplebark yields ld4 + 6 pounds of food. T RILLIMAC

A trillimac is a mushroom that grows to a height of four to five feet, and has a broad gray-green cap and a light gray stalk. The cap’s leathery surface can be cut and cleaned for use in making maps, hats, and scrolls (its surface takes on dyes and inks well). The stalk can be cleaned, soaked in water for an hour, then dried to make a palatable food akin to bread. Each trillimac stalk provides ld6 + 4 pounds of food. W ATERORB

A waterorb is a bulbous fungus that grows in shallow water. A mature waterorb can be squeezed like a sponge, yielding a gallon of drinkable water and a pound of edible (if chewy and somewhat tasteless) food. ZURKHWOOD

Zurkhw:ood is a massive mushroom that can reach a height of thirty to forty feet. Its large grain-like spores arc edible and nutritionally equivalent to ld4 + 4 pounds of food, but zurkhwood is more important for its hard and woody stalks. Zurkhwood is one of the few sources of timber in the Underdark, used to make furniture, containers, bridges, and rafts, among other things. Skilled crafters can use stains, sanding, and polishing to bring out different patterns in zurkhwood.

E XOTIC F UNGI

The fungi species described in this section have strange properties but no nutritional value. N IGHTLIGHT

A nightlight is a tall and tube-shaped bioluminesccnt mushroom that grows to a height of ld6 + 4 feet and emits bright light in a 15-foot radius and dim light for an additional 15 feet. A nightlight that is uprooted or destroyed goes dark after 1 round. If a living nightlight is touched, either by a creature or an object, its light goes out until it is touched again. N ILHOGG ’ S N OSE

A Nilhogg's nose is a small mushroom that grants any creature that eats it advantage on Wisdom (Perception) checks based on smell for ld4 hours. However, the creature suffers disadvantage on saving throws against effects based on smell for the same amount of time. ORMU A bioluminescent green moss that grows in warm and damp areas, ormu is particularly common near steam tunnels and vents. It sheds dim light in a 5-foot radius, and can be harvested, dried, and made into a phosphorescent powder or pigment.

T IMMASK

Also known as "the devil's mushroom,” a timmask is a two-foot-tall toadstool with orange and red stripes across its beige cap. Uprooting or destroying a timmask causes it to expel a 15-foot-radius cloud of poisonous spores. Creatures in the area must succeed at a DC- 14 Constitution saving throw or be poisoned. While poisoned in this way, the creature is under the effect of a confusion spell with a duration of 1 minute. When the spell effect ends, the poisoned condition also ends. T ONGUE

OF

M ADNESS

Tongue of madness is an edible fungus that looks somewhat like a large human tongue. A creature that eats a tongue of madness must succeed on a DC 12 Constitution saving throw or compulsively speak aloud its every thought for the next hour. The effect can be ended with a lesser restoration spell or similar magic. T ORCHSTALK

A one- to two-foot-tall mushroom with a combustible cap, a single torchstalk burns for 24 hours once lit. There is a l-in-6 chance that a torchstalk explodes when lit, bursting into a cloud of fiery spores. Creatures within 10 feet of an exploding torchstalk take 3 (ld6) fire damage.

CHAPTER 2 I INTO DARKNESS

23

N ARRATING THE J OURNEY As the adventurers make their way through the Lnderdark. it helps to improvise descriptions of what they experience to add flavor to the journey. As you do, try to stress two key points. First, the trek is long and arduous. The party is traveling underground, over incredibly difficult and rough terrain, without any of the comforts of the surface world. Food and water are scarce. The darkness never ends. The players should feel as though their characters are in peril throughout their travels, never knowing when something is set to leap at them from the shadows. Second, the Underdark is an exotic, alien landscape unlike anything found on the surface world. Throughout its twisted passageways and impossibly large caverns, characters might find bizarre reminders of lost and forgotten civilizations, unearthly flora and fauna, and incredible geography. Little is as it seems, and much is difficult to explain, or even to describe.

D ROW P URSUIT A party of drow from Velkynvelve pursue their escaped prisoners into the Underdark. The drow priestess 11 vara becomes increasingly obsessed with the adventurers, believing they are involved in some secret conspiracy, or perhaps some test of her worthiness. The longer the pursuit, the more determined she is to retake them and have the opportunity to teach them the error of defying her. The drow party consists of Ilvara (drow priestess of Lolth). the drow elite warriors Jorlan and Shoor, and the junior priestess Asha Vandree (use the priest stat block in the Monster Manual, but add the Fey Ancestry, Innate Spellcasting, and Sunlight Sensitivity features of the drow stat block). The hunting party also includes four drow warriors who serve as forward scouts. If any of the drow NPCs did not survive chapter 1, replace them with newly arrived reinforcements from Menzoberranzan under the command of Ilvara, or another priestess of her caliber. NARROW ESCAPES If an encounter with the drow is going badly and you don't want the characters recaptured, you can always have fate intercede on their behalf with another encounter or event offering a distraction. For example, a wandering stone giant, a purple worm, or a pack of savage gnolls whipped into a frenzy byYeenoghu might show up just as the drow have the characters cornered, giving them a chance to run. Likewise, a minor earthquake (caused by instability from the demonic incursion or a wild magic surge) might cause a cave-in, cutting off a tunnel between the party and their pursuers, and dropping the pursuit level by 1 or 2. Don’t do this so often that the players feel they haven't earned it, but use it as an option to keep the pursuit going rather than coming to an anticlimactic conclusion.

T R AC KI NG

T HE P A RTY The drow must track the party through the Underdark on foot, as there are no mounts available at Velkynvelve and Ilvara doesn't wait for an already-late relief detachment from Menzoberranzan to arrive. This limits how quickly the dark elves can move to catch up. since they must seek out signs of their quarry's passage, occasionally doubling back to pick up their trail again. CHAPTER 2 | INTO DARKNESS

P UR SU IT L EV E L The closeness of the drow pursuit is measured by a pursuit level. It begins at 4, with the drow not far behind the characters. If the pursuit level reaches 5, the drow forward scouts catch up to them, and the drow leaders arrive not long thereafter (see “Catching Up”). If the pursuit level drops to 0, the party has eluded the draw until circumstances bring both factions into contact again (see “Eluding Pursuit"). Characters can increase or decrease the pursuit level in the following ways: • Decrease the pursuit level by 1 for each day the party travels at a fast pace. • Decrease the pursuit level by 1 if a character spends time covering up the party’s trail that day, requiring a successful DC 16 Wisdom (Survival) check. • Decrease the pursuit level by 1 each time the characters cross or traverse some fealure that obscures their trail, such as a subterranean river. • Decrease the pursuit level by 1 if the party splits into two or more groups. Each group becomes a separate party for purposes of determining random encounters and whether or not the group becomes lost. • Increase the pursuit level by 1 each time the party has a random encounter with one or more creatures, unless the encounter is bypassed or avoided entirely. • Increase the pursuit level by 1 for each day the adventurers travel at a slow pace. • Certain terrain encounters increase or decrease the pursuit level. See the individual descriptions in the “Random Encounters" section. The players might come up with additional ways of evading pursuit. Adjudicate these as you see fit. For example, if the characters convince a randomly encountered creature to let them pass by telling them about the wealthy drow following them, you might reduce the pursuit level by 1 as the drow are forced to deal with the encounter before they can resume tracking the party. Similarly, the adventurers could lay traps to slow down their pursuers, or they might convince a friendly creature to lie to the drow about which way the party went. If you choose to skip over a few days of travel (as described under "Summarizing Travel" later in this chapter), the pursuit level doesn’t change during that time. CATCHING UP

W'hen the pursuit level reaches 5. the drow forward scouts spot the party. At this point, the pursuit might become an encounter if the characters spot the drow and engage them. The characters might try to run, at which point a chase ensues (see “Chases” in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide), or they might stand and fight. They might even try to set up some sort of ambush, since the front ranks of the party are likely out of sight of the drow when they first catch up. If the adventurers flee and successfully escape, they lower the pursuit level to 4 and begin avoiding their pursuers again. If they fight the drow, run the encounter. The drow scouts focus on maintaining close pursuit and peppering the characters with poisoned hand crossbow

bolts. After ld6 + 4 rounds, the remainder of the drow party (Ilvara, Asha, Jorlan, and Shoor) catches up and joins the encounter. ELUDING PURSUIT

If the adventurers lower the pursuit level to 0, the drow lose the trail unless circumstances allow them to locate the characters again. This might include the characters spending a day or more in a place where they are recognized, or where they talk openly about their escape from Velkynvelve. If the characters pass through an area watched over by drow scouts or spies, Ilvara will inevitably hear word of the characters' location. When this occurs, increase the pursuit level to 1 and begin tracking it again as the drow pick up the trail once more.

CAPTURE The drow try to capture the escaped prisoners if at all possible, since Ilvara wants the pleasure of teaching them a lesson about disobedience. If the dark elves reduce any characters to 0 hit points, those characters are knocked out rather than dying (see “Knocking a Creature Out” in chapter 9 of the Player's Handbook). Even if one or more of the characters are accidentally killed. Ilvara is obsessed enough to cast raise dead to restore them to life (assuming the character’s soul is willing to return). Captured characters are disarmed, their hands bound with spider-silk rope, and gagged. The drow march them back to Velkynvelve unless Mcnzoberranzan is closer, in which case Ilvara takes them there instead. The characters will need to come up with a new plan of escape, ideally before Ilvara has the opportunity to torture them or sell them into slavery in the City of Spiders. If they escape her clutches again, the drow priestess continues her pursuit until she is dead or the party leaves the Underdark (see chapter 7).

RANDOM ENCOUNTERS d 2 0 Encounter 1-13 No encounter 14-15 Terrain (roll once on the Terrain Encounters table) 16-17 One or more creatures (roll once on the Creature Encounters table) 18-20 Terrain encounter featuring one or more creatures (roll once on the Terrain Encounters table, then roll once on the Creature Encounter table)

TERRAIN ENCOUNTERS The Underdark contains dangerous hazards and wondrous terrain. Special terrain rules are explained after the table. TERRAIN ENCOUNTERS

d20 1

2 3

Encounter Boneyard Cliff and ladder Crystal clusters

4 5

Fungus cavern Gas leak

6 7

Gorge High ledge

8 9

Horrid sounds Lava swell

10

Muck pit

11

Rockfall

12 13 14 15

Rope bridge Ruins Shelter Sinkhole

16

Slime or mold Steam vent

17

R ANDOM E NCOUNTERS

18 19

Underground stream

Each day of travel through the Underdark, check twice to see if the characters encounter anything unusual: once while they are traveling, and again while they are camped or resting. Roll a d20 and consult the Random Encounters table to determine what, if anything, they encounter. Characters might encounter special terrain, one or more creatures, or a combination of the tw'o. Any random encounter that occurs while Lhe party is camped is automatically a creature encounter, in which case determine the encounter by rolling a d20 and consulting the Creature Encounter table.

20

Webs

Warning sign

BONEYARD

The characters come upon an eerie cavern littered with countless bones of various creatures. Whether the site is a natural graveyard for some Underdark species or the former lair of a fearsome predator, the characters can potentially gather useful material for crafting among the bones. When the party enters a boneyard. roll a d20 and consult the table to determine what creatures, if any, are present. The undead rise up out of the bones and attack when the first characters are halfway across the cavern. B O N E YAR D E N C O U N T E R

d20

Encounter 1-14 No encounter 15-18 3d4 skeletons 19-20 ld3 minotaur

skeletons

CHAPTER 2 I INTO DARKNESS ^5

C LIFF

AND

L ADDER

A clill 2d4 ■ iO feet high blocks the party's passage, but a rolled-up rope ladder is visible at the top. If someone ■can climb the cliff requiring a successful DC 15 Strength (Athletics) check—and toss down the ladder, the characters can proceed. Otherwise, they lose a day's travel finding another route. If the characters remove the ladder once they are at the top, they decrease the drow pursuit level by 1. C RYSTAL C LUSTERS

The adventurers pass through a faerzress-suffused area containing fist sized chunks of quartz that shed dim light in a 10-foot radius. A sharp blow to one of the crystals, including throwing it so it impacts a hard surface, causes it to burst in a 10-foot-radius flash of blinding light. Any creature within the radius must succeed on a DC 10 Constitution saving throw or be blinded for 1 minute. A creature blinded by this effect repeats the Constitution saving throw at the end of each of its turns. On a successful save, it is no longer blinded. The characters can harvest up to twelve of the crystals in total, but taking the time to do so increases the drow pursuit level by 1.

successful one. Any open flames brought into the area cause the gas to explode. Each creature in the explosion must make a DC 15 Dexterity saving throw, taking 10 (3d6) fire damage on a failed save, or half as much damage on a successful one. G ORGE

The characters must make a difficult climb down a gorge 2d4 x 100 feet deep and up the other side, or find a way around it. Their travel pace for the day is slowed by half unless they come up with a plan to cross the gorge quickly. H IGH L EDGE

The characters must walk along an 18-inch-wide ledge I hat skirts a ravine 2d6 x 10 feet deep. The party's travel pace for the day is slowed by half, and each character must succeed on a DC 10 Dexterity saving throw to avoid a fall. Precautions such as roping everyone together let each character make the save with advantage. Increase the pursuit level of the drow by 1. H ORRID S OUNDS

The adventurers stumble upon a cavern filled with fungi and mushrooms of all sizes and types. See "Fungi of the

For hours, the party’s travel is plagued by terrible shrieks, moans, and incoherent gibbering echoing through nearby passages, without any apparent origin. Each character must make a successful DC 11 Wisdom saving throw. On a failed save, the character’s madness level increases by 1.

G AS L EAK

L AVA S WELL

F UNGUS C AVERN

The adventurers come upon a cavern with a dangerous natural gas leak. Any member of the party with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 14 or higher detects signs of the gas. The characters’ travel pace for the day is slowed by half as they circumvent the area, but there are no ill effects. If the gas goes undetected, each character in the area must make a DC 12 Constitution saving throw, taking 5 (Id 10) poison damage on a failed save, or half as much damage on a Underdark" and choose some interesting examples.

As the party traverses a long and winding corridor, a tremor opens up a lava-filled fissure behind them. Each character must make a DC 10 Dexterity saving throw to avoid the lava swell, taking 21 (6d6) fire damage on a failed save. Decrease the drow pursuit level by 1. M UCK P IT

The adventurers must wade through a broad. 3-footdeep pit of slimy muck. The muck is difficult terrain and characters have disadvantage on Dexterity saving throws while within it, but their travel pace for the day is slowed by half if they go around it. R OCKFALL

As the adventurers make their way through a long, twisting cavern, a tremor sets off a rockfall. Each party member must attempt three DC 12 Dexterity saving throws, taking 10 (3d6) bludgeoning damage on each failed save. Any incapacitated creature not moved out of the area is buried under rubble, taking an additional ld6 bludgeoning damage at the end of each of its turns until the creature is dug out or dead. Decrease the drow pursuit level by 1. R OPE B RIDGE

A ravine 2d4 * 10 feet wide and 2d4 x 10 feet deep cuts across the party's path, spanned by an old rope bridge. If the characters cut the bridge after they pass, the drow pursuit level decreases by 1.

RUINS The adventurers come across a small ruin hidden in the Underdark. This might he the creation of a subterranean race or a surface ruin that collapsed and sank long ago. If the characters search the ruins, there is a 50 percent chance of them finding ld4 trinkets (see chapter 5, “Equipment,” of the Player's Handbook). Roll on the Trinkets tabic or choose appropriate ones. S HELTER

The party stumbles upon a cave that is sheltered and easily defended. If the characters camp here, they can finish a long rest without any chance of an encounter while they are resting. SINKHOLE One random party member steps on and collapses a sinkhole, and must succeed on a DC 12 Dexterity saving Throw to avoid falling into a 20-foot-deep pit and taking 7 (2d6) bludgeoning damage. Climbing out of the pit requires a successful DC 15 Strength (Athletics) check. SLIME OR MOLD As the adventurers pass through a small cavern, they encounter a patch of slime or mold. Roll a d6 and consult the table to determine what type of slime or mold is present (see “Dungeon Hazards" in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master's Guide for details on these threats). SLIME OR MOLD ENCOUNTER d6 1-3 4-5 6

Encounter

Patch of green slime Patch of yellow mold Patch of brown mold

STEAM VENT A hot steam vent erupts beneath a random party member, who must succeed on a DC 12 Dexterity saving throw or take 7 (2d6) fire damage. U NDERGROUND S TREAM

A waterway 2d4 * 5 feet wide cuts across the party’s path. The stream is shallow and easily crossed, and the characters can drink and refresh their water supplies. Edible fish inhabit the stream, so that the DC of any roraging attempts for food in this area is reduced to 10. Crossing the stream reduces the drow pursuit level by 1. WARNING SIGN

The characters enter a cavern dotted with stalagmites nd stalactites. Those with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 11 or higher spot the following sigil carved into one of the stalagmites:

must make a DC 10 Wisdom saving throw. On a failed save, the creature's madness level increases by 1. If the characters take a long rest within one mile of the warning sign, roll a d20 and consult the tabic to determine what, if anything, they encounter at the end of their rest. WARNING SIGN ENCOUNTER d 2 0Encounter 1-14No encounter 15-161 invisible barlgura 17-183d4 dretches 19-20ld2 shadow demons WEBS

Sticky webs fills a passage (see "Dungeon Hazards" in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master's Guide). The webs extend for hundreds of feet. Unless the characters come up with a plan for clearing the webs quickly, the party’s travel pace for the day is halved as the characters are forced to cut their way through or find an alternate route. Check for an encounter when the party enters the webs. On a roll of 1-2 on a d6, the characters encounter ld4 giant spiders lurking among the webs.

CREATURE ENCOUNTERS__________________ Keep the party’s level in mind when fleshing out these encounters, and allow the characters to retreat from or avoid an encounter that is too great a challenge. Escape should come at a cost, however. Characters fleeing their camp to avoid a creature encounter might be forced to abandon food and water supplies, for example. C R E AT U R E E N C O U N T E R S d20 Encounter 1-2 Ambushers; reroll this encounter if the characters are 3

resting Carrion crawler

4-5

Escaped slaves

6-7 8-9

Fungi Giant fire beetles

10-11

Giant "rocktopus" Mad creature

12 13 14-15 16 17 18 19-20

Ochre jelly Raiders Scouts Society of Brilliance Spore servants Traders

A MBUSHERS

One or more creatures attempt to ambush the party as if makes its way through the Underdark. Roll a d20 and consult the table to determine what the characters encounter.

The sigil is a drow warning sign that means “Demons ahead!" Any tion-drow creature that touches the symbol CHAPTER 2 INTO DARKNESS

27

AMBUSHERS d 2 0 Encounter 1-2

1 chuul lurking in a pool of water

3 4-5 6-9 10-15 16-17 18-20

ld6 giant spiders clinging to the walls or ceiling 1 grell floating near the high ceiling ld4 gricks hiding in a crevice or fissure ld4 orogs perching on ledges ld6 piercers masquerading as stalactites 1 umber hulk bursting out of a nearby wall

If the ambush occurs in the monster's lair, there is a chance that characters searching the area find something of interest or value. Roll a d20 and consult the table below to see what, if anything, they find. AMBUSHER LAIR DISCOVERIES d20 Discovery 1-10 None 11-12 A humanoid skeleton or corpse clutching a salvageable, nonmagical weapon (your choice) 13-14 A humanoid skeleton or corpse wearing a salvageable suit of nonmagical armor (your choice) 15-17 ld6 50 gp gems 18-19 A humanoid skeleton or corpse carrying a random magic item (roll once on Magic Item Table B in chapter 7 of the

Dungeon Master's Guide) 20 A monster hoard containing 2d6 50 gp gems and one or more random magic items (roll 1 d4 times on Magic Item Table Cin chapter 7 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide)

CARRION CRAWLER

The characters encounter a carrion crawler scouring tunnels and caves for food. There is a 25 percent chance that the crawler is domesticated and outfitted with a leather saddle and harness, though there’s no sign of the rider. A character can approach and mount the carrion crawler wdthout being attacked by succeeding on a DC 13 Wisdom (Animal Handling) check. While in the saddle and harness, a rider can remain mounted on the carrion crawler as it crawls across walls and ceilings. ESCAPED SLAVES

These slaves have been wandering the Underdark since their escape from Grackistugh or Menzoberranzan. They are scrounging for food and water. Roll a d4 and consult the table to determine what the characters encounter. Elf, dwarf, and human slaves are friendly; if given food and water they'll join the party. Goblin slaves are hostile and likely to attack. E S C A P E D S L AVE S d4 1 2 3 4

Encounter ld2 moon elf commoners ld3 shield dwarf commoners ld4 human commoners ld6 goblins

FUNGI

Roll a d6 and consult the table to determine what kinds CHAPTER 2 | JNTO DARKNESS

28

of fungi the characters encounter. FUNGI d6 Encounter 1-2ld4 gas spores 3-4

ld4 shriekers

5-6

1d4 violet fungi

There’s a 25 percent chance that a gas spore carries a memory fragment from a dead beholder in its spores (see the gas spore's description in the "Fungi" entry of Monster Manual). This memory can be of anything you wish, or you can roll a d4 and consult the Beholder Memories table. BEHOLDER MEMORIES d4 Memory 1 A tense negotiation with drow, ending with the beholder agreeing to allow the drow safe passage through “the Vast Oblivium’’ in exchange for help ridding its lair of a deep gnome infestation 2 Chasing svirfneblin thieves through the tunnels of its domain to recover stolen gemstones 3 A fierce battle against a wizened drow archmage, ending with the beholder suffering a grievous injury 4 Spying on a drow ranger with two gleaming scimitars and a black, quadrupedal animal companion

G IANT F IRE B EETLES

The characters encounter 3d6 giant fire beetles scouring tunnels and caves for food. Characters in need of light sources can harvest the glowing glands of slain beetles. G IANT “R OCKTOPUS "

This creature is a giant octopus that has evolved to live and thrive on land. It can alter its coloration to appear as a rock formation, and it tends to lurk in crevices and fissures, attacking smaller creatures that wander near. It has a walking speed of 20 feet and a climbing speed of 10 feet, loses its Hold Breath feature, and replaces its Underwater Camouflage feature with the following feature: Camouflage. The octopus has advantage on Dexterity (Stealth) checks.

M AD C REATURE

The party encounters a creature driven insane by the influence of the demon lords. Roll a d4 and consult the table to determine what appears. Then roll on the Indefinite Madness table in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide to determine the nature of the creature’s madness. If cured of its madness, the creature behaves in accordance with its alignment.

M A D C R E AT U R E d4 Encounter 1 1 deep gnome 2 1 drow 3 1 duergar 4 1 stone giant

There is a chance that the mad creature has something of interest or value in its possession. Roll a d20 and consult the table below to see what, if anything, it has. The creature doesn't part with the item willingly. MAD C R E AT U R E P O S S E S S I O N S d 2 0 Possession 1-10

None

11-13 A 10 gp gem 14-15 A gold ring worth 25 gp 16-17 An obsidian statuette of Lolth worth 100 gp 18-19 A random magic item (roll once on Magic Item Table A in chapter 7 of the Dungeon Master's Guide) 20

A random magic item (roll once on Magic Item Table B in chapter 7 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide)

OCHRE JELLY

As the characters move through a series of caves, they attract the attention of a ochre jelly. The ooze follows the characters, attacking when they stop to take their next rest. Characters in the back rank of the marching order who have a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 14 or higher spot the ooze following them. RAIDERS

This group of raiders from the surface ventured into the Underdark looking for riches and got lost. Roll a d6 and consult the table to determine what appears. The raiders arc initially hostile toward the party, though clever characters might try bribing them for safe passage or information. RAIDERS d6 Encounter

1-2 3-4 5-6

2d4 goblins and 1 goblin boss ld6 ores and 1 ore Eye ofCruumsh

RAIDER LEADER POSSESSIONS 1-5 6-10 11-14 15-17 18-19 20

Each of these groups is in the Underdark on a secret mission. Roll a d6 and consult the table to determine what appears. SCOUTS d6 Encounter 12 1 drow 34 ld4 myconid adults 5-6 ld6 shield dwarf scouts

The drow scout is searching for escaped slaves. If he spots the party, he’ll attempt to avoid notice and take away information regarding the group’s location (see “Drow Pursuit"). The myconid scouts are indifferent toward the party and unwilling to discuss their mission or their travels with the adventurers. Shield dwarf scouts are friendly if the party includes one or more surface dwellers. They are willing to give the party a day or two’s worth of food and water rations. SOCIETY OF BRILLIANCE

The characters stumble upon a member of the Society of Brilliance, a sect of highly intelligent monsters that have banded together to solve all of the Underdark's problems. The society is investigating areas suffused with faerzress to ascertain whether it has something to do with what the society fears is some kind of "demonic incursion.” Roll a dlO to determine which society member the characters encounter. SOCIETY OF BRILLIANC E d l O Encounter 1-2 3-4

Y the derro savant (see appendix C) Blurg the orog

5-6 7-8

Grazilaxx the mind flayer Skriss the troglodyte

9-10

Sloopidoop the kuo-toa archpriest

ld6 human bandits and 1 human bandit captain

There is a chance that the leader of the group has something of interest or value. Roll a d20 and consult the table below to see what, if anything, the leader of the raiders has in its possession.

d20

SCOUTS

Possession None 2d6 10 gp gemstones in a pouch 2d6 50 gp gemstones in a pouch 1d4 torchstalks (see "Fungi of the Underdark”) 1d4 waterorbs (see "Fungi of the Underdark”) A random magic item (roll on Magic Item Table B in chapter 7 of the Dungeon Master's Guide)

Every member of the Society of Brilliance has an alignment of neutral, an Intelligence of 18 (+4), and fluency in multiple languages including Dwarvish, Elvish, and Undercommon (although Grazilaxx prefers to communicate using telepathy). Its statistics are unchanged otherwise. Members are erudite and talkative, preferring diplomacy and debate over violence (though they defend themselves if attacked). Each society member can cast the teleport spell once per day, but the intended destination must be within 30 feet of another society member. This teleport effect can be disrupted (see “Faerzress” earlier in the chapter), which is how society members sometimes end up in far corners of the Underdark, separated from their fellows. Members of the Society of Brilliance are aware that paths to the surface world exist but haven’t explored any of them (their concerns are with the Underdark, after all). If the characters seem intent on reaching the surface, a society member might suggest they look for a CHAPTER 2 I INTO DARKNESS 9

guide in one of the Underdark's larger settlements,

CHAPTER 2 I INTO DARKNESS 9

such as Blingdenstone or Gracklstugh. The society member can provide detailed verbal directions that characters can follow to reach whichever Underdark settlement they desire. However, the society member can't guarantee that the route is safe. If characters are searching for something else, the society member provides whatever assistance it can. S PORE S ERVANTS

One or more creatures killed and reanimated by Zuggtmoy's spores observe the characters as they pass by. The spore servants don't communicate and don't attack except in self-defense. Roll a dlO and consult the table to determine what the characters encounter. S P O R E S E R VAN T S d l O Encounter 1-3 ld4 drow spore servants (see appendix C) 4-6 ld6 duergar spore servants (see appendix C) 7-8 ld4 hook horror spore servants (see appendix C) 9-10 ld8 quaggoth spore servants

T RADERS

These traders ply the tunnels of the Underdark, traveling from settlement to settlement. Roll a d4 and consult the table to determine what appears. TRADERS d4 Encounter

1 2 3 4

2d4 deep gnomes

2d4 drow 2d4

duergar

2d4 kuo-toa

Deep gnome and drow traders have a 50 percent chance of having half their number in giant lizards as mounts and pack animals. Duergar traders have a 50 percent

CHAPTER 2 | INTO DARKNESS

30

chance of having half their number in male steeders (see appendix C) as pack animals. If there are male steeders present, there is a 50 percent chance that the traders are escorted by a duergar kavalrachni astride a female steeder (see appendix C for both). The traders carry goods worth 5d4 x 10 gp plus ten days of provisions per member of their party: they are willing to sell up to 20 percent of either. If drow traders see the adventurers and have the opportunity to report it, increase the drow pursuit level by 1.

S UMMARIZING T RAVEL Instead of checking for random encounters every day, you can skip over or summarize parts of the characters’ journey. Roll ld6 + 1 for the number of days between encounters, with the usual chance of the encounter being a terrain encounter, a creature encounter, or both (as described under "Random Encounters”). For example, if roll a result of 4, you would tell the players: '‘You’ve been making your way through the tunnels and passages for four days ..." before describing the circumstances of the encounter to them. With this approach, encourage players to describe what their characters do or even sec and experience during the intervening time. In addition to downtime activities such as crafting, characters have plenty of opportunities for interaction. If the players arc handling the roles of some or all of their nonplayer character companions (see "A Motley Crew" in chapter 1), ask them to elaborate on the activities of those characters as well, filling in details as you sec fit. Players can also suggest and spin out stories about things their characters have experienced during the intervening time, including arduous climbs, swinging across gorges, or dodging piercers, and you can do the same. This additional storytelling aspect adds color and background to the journey while keeping the pace relatively brisk.

S ET E NCOUNTERS You can use the following four encounters during the party’s travels in the Undcrdark between the locations in chapters 3 through 7, inserting them as desired. They provide more detailed challenges for the characters, as well as giving them chances to encounter some potential allies. If the characters need an XP boost as they work through subsequent chapters, these encounters can help provide it.

T HE S ILKEN P ATHS The Silken Paths are a network of spider webs crisscrossing a 500-foot-deep. 2.000-foot-wide chasm that stretches for nearly five miles. The major strands of the webs are traversable but, due to the fact that old webs disintegrate over time and the giant spiders inhabiting the chasm are constantly spinning new ones, the Silken Paths are ever-changing. The chasm has numerous passages at varying heights leading away from it. It is rare for a web strand to connect one opening with another on the same “level." Characters navigating the Silken Paths need to follow sloping strands as well as climb and cross over several strands to reach their intended destination. This is quite hazardous, but there simply isn't any easy way around the chasm. The characters can easily get lost in the mass of strands stretching across the chasm unless they have help.

THE WEB RUNNERS

The Web Runners are a pair of thrill-seeking goblins named Yuk Yuk and Spiderbait. They have lived in the I’nderdark for as long as either can remember, with much of their time spent treasure hunting and surviving in the Silken Paths. The goblins are prone to daring (and often foolish) stunts. That cither of them is still alive is a testament to their luck and skill. Modify their 'tatistics as follows: • Both goblins are neutral. • Add Acrobatics +6 and Athletics +3 to the goblins’ list of skills. • The goblins have advantage on checks made to avoid being surprised. The goblins notice the adventurers as they approach the Silken Paths and are willing to act as guides and helpers for a fee, of course. They’ll settle for 2 gp per day each, but Yuk Yuk (who does all the negotiating) is just as likely to ask for something flashy belonging to one of the characters. He might also ask for some unspecified favor, to be paid when the goblins and the adventurers get to wherever they're going and part ways. He might ask for first pick of any loot the party uncovers in the Silken Paths, and will expect and ask for a share of the treasure regardless. Yuk Yuk and Spiderbait each carry a gourd of grease, which they apply to their feet so that they can “surf the webs." While sliding down webs, they move at twice their normal walking speed. The Web Runners arc as good as their word when it comes to their services, and they can teach the

characters a thing or two. While they travel with the two goblins, the characters have advantage on checks made to avoid being surprised. The goblins know the Silken Paths well enough not to become lost in them. If the adventurers make a good impression on the Web Runners and if the party's goals appear to offer interesting opportunities to do new and dangerous things, the goblins offer to stay on after crossing the Silken Paths, and to help guide the characters through the Underdark. The two won't leave the Underdark, however. Yuk Yuk will try to negotiate a suitable fee, but the goblins might simply tag along, content to earn any fair share of whatever the party acquires. S I L K E N PATHS: G E N E R A L F E AT U R E S As characters traverse the Silken Paths, keep in mind the following features. Difficult Terrain. Any creature with a climbing speed can walk along the webs at that speed. For all other creatures, the webs are difficult terrain. Any creature that falls can potentially become entangled in the webs (see “Falling”). Falling. Whenever a creature takes damage while traversing the Silken Paths, or whenever the webs upon which it is walking break, the creature must make a DC 15 Dexterity saving throw. On a successful save, the creature manages to avoid a fall by grabbing nearby web strands. On a failure, the creature falls ldlO * 10 feet. If the distance fallen is less than the distance to the chasm floor, the creature becomes entangled in webs and restrained; otherwise, it hits the floor and takes damage from the fall as normal. A restrained creature can make a DC 12 Strength saving throw at the end of each of its turns, freeing itself and ending the restrained condition on a success. Another creature can use its action to help a restrained creature within its reach, granting advantage on that creature’s next saving throw to end the effect. Light. The chasm is dark. Carrying a light source attracts hostile creatures, increasing the chance of an encounter to 1-3 on a d6. Fire. Webs burn away when exposed to any attack or effect that deals fire damage. This causes several strands to break, and all creatures within 30 feet of the affected area must make a saving throw to avoid falling (see “Falling").

CHAPTER 2 I INTO DARKNESS 3'

S ILKE N P ATH E N C O U N T E R S For every 500 feet the party travels through the webs, check for a random encounter by rolling a d6. An encounter occurs on a roll of 1 unless one or more party members are carrying light sources, in which case an encounter occurs on a roll of 1- 3. Roll on the Silken Paths Encounters table or choose a suitable encounter when one occurs.

Freed from its service to a long-dead drow wizard, this mad aberration now floats through the web-filled chasm, it communicates with the characters telepathically, warning them about "demons rising in the dark.” The creature becomes increasingly paranoid and convinced that the characters are themselves demons, come to bind it into servitude, at which point it attacks and tries to destroy them.

S I L K E N P AT H S E N C O U N T E R S dl2 Encounter

WEB BREAK

1 2 3 4-8 9

Cocooned lightfoot halfling ld4 darkmantles ld4 drow and ld4 quaggoth slaves 2d4 giant spiders 1 mimic

10 1 spectator 11-12 Web break

COCOONED HALFLING The

characters find a still-living lightfoot halfling cocooned in webbing. He is poisoned and paralyzed for the next hour. Fargas Rumblefoot was a member of an adventuring band looking for a iong-lost tomb when they were attacked by a pack of mad gnolls. Fargas escaped, got lost in the Silken Paths, and was attacked by the spiders. If rescued, he promises to show the characters the way to the tomb in exchange for a share of its treasures (see “Lost Tomb of Khaem” later in this chapter). Fargas is a chaotic good halfling spy. In addition to his armor and weapons, he carries a potion of invisibility. DARKMANTLES

These subterranean hunters swoop down and attack the party. DROW

AND

Q U A G G O T H S L AVE S

These hateful drow and their murderous quaggoth slaves are navigating the Silken Paths on their way through the Underdark. If Derendil is with the party, he can use an action to make a DC 15 Charisma check, turning the quaggoth slaves against their drow masters on a success. If the drow are disposed of, Derendil can repeat the check to turn the surviving quaggoths into his followers. Should Derendil perish, these quaggoths can't be controlled and fight to the death. If any drow escape the encounter, increase the pursuit level of the party’s drow pursuers by 1. GIANT SPIDERS

Giant spiders are the most common inhabitants of the Silken Paths, and they are drawn to vibrations in the webs that indicate potential prey. MIMIC

This creature pretends to be an iron chest entangled in Lhe webs. When the characters draw close to examine it, die mimic attacks.

3=

S P E C TATO R

CHAPTER 2

1

INTO DARKNESS

A strand of web under one randomly determined party member snaps. Each creature walking on that web strand must make a DC 15 Dexterity saving throw as described under “Falling" in the “Silken Paths: General Features" sidebar. Immediately check for another encounter after the saving throws are resolved.

HOOK HORROR HUNT The characters enter an area where a band of gnolls lured to the Underdark by the demon lord Yeenoghu are hunting a mated pair of hook horrors. Having left guards at the main entrance to the lair (area 5), the gnoll pack lord has split its remaining hunters into two groups, both of which are attempting to flush out the hook horrors to win the right to tear them apart. The adventurers wander into the area from a second entrance to the caverns (area 1) and become embroiled in the hunt. Whether they choose to avoid the hunting party, aid the hook horrors, or negotiate their way out of the situation is up to the players,

1. H OOK H OR R OR S The characters hear clacking noises as they approach this point in the passageway. Suddenly, two hook horrors dash from the side passage, moving from area 2A toward area 3. The hook horrors attack only in selfdefense and are more afraid of the giggling, rampaging gnolls than they are of the characters. The gnolls are two chambers behind the hook horrors, reaching this point on the following round, unless the characters move toward them (in which case the two groups converge in area 2A).

2A. G NOLL H UNT E R S

Four gnolls move into this area the round after the hook horrors move past the party, then follow their quarry into area 1 on the following round. The gnolls can’t resist attacking any other creatures that cross their path while shrieking “Sacrifices for Yeenoghu!” in their own tongue. (Even if no one in the party speaks Gnoll, the name of the demon lord is clearly recognizable.) DEVELOPMENT

Sounds of combat or calls from the gnolls might attract their pack mates in areas 2B and 5.

2B. G NOLL H U N T E R S

The rest of the. gnoll hunters race through these caverns in search of the hook horrors. Unless they are drawn elsewhere, four gnolls and a gnoll pack lord are here. TREASURE

The gnoll pack lord carries two bloodstones worth 50 gp each and a brown tourmaline worth 100 gp. 3. C OR NE R E D The fleeing hook horrors make their way here, where they wait in ambush for any creatures that follow them. The passage is narrow enough that Medium creatures must move single file through it. The cave appears to be a dead end, and the hook horrors fight to the death against any creatures that enter. Characters who take the time to search the cave spot a hole in the 10-foot-high ceiling (marked C on the map), which requires a successful DC 12 Strength (Athletics) check to climb up into. It leads to area 4.

4. H OOK H OR R OR N E ST The sandy floor of this cavern holds a clutch of four 1foot-diameter eggs with rocky outer shells, all half- buried in a shallow pit. These are hook horror eggs, and any character that touches an egg can feel it trembling. Each hour, there is a 10 percent chance that one of the eggs hatches. The infant hook horror that emerges imprints on the first creature it secs. It thereafter follows that creature around like its parent, demanding to be fed. If the characters manage to keep the hook horror alive, it eventually reaches adulthood after six months. Track its growth using the Hook Horror Maturation table. H O O K H O R R O R L A I R : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

As characters explore the hook horror lair, keep in mind the following features. Light. The tunnels are completely dark, which doesn’t hinder either the gnolls or the hook horrors. Tight Passages. Tunnels marked “P” on the map are narrow enough that Large creatures such as the hook horrors must squeeze through them, spending 1 extra foot of movement for every foot of passage. Medium or smaller creatures can move through such areas normally.

CHAPTER 2 I INTO DARKNESS

33

but hotter magical effects consume 1 hour of air per die of fire damage per round. For example, a Jireball spell that deals 8d6 fire damage consumes 8 hours of air, while afire bolt that deals 1 d 10 fire damage consumes 1 hour of air per use. Water. In addition to running low on air, the characters become aware that the tunnels and chambers are filling with water flowing in from area 6. The water rises at a rate of 1 foot per hour, meaning most of the tunnels and chambers will be completely flooded within 10 hours. Areas filled with waist-deep water are difficult terrain for the characters. Once the water is over their heads, they have to swim.

5. G N O L L C A M P The gnolls have a small camp set up here to prevent the hook horrors from fleeing in this direction. Three gnolls guard the camp and attack any creatures emerging from the tunnels that are not of their kind.

THE OOZING TEMPLE

A tremor causes a cave-in and traps the adventurers in a maze of tunnels with no obvious way out. With a dwindling air supply and water rising in the tunnels, the characters are forced to find a means of escape. Complicating matters, part of the maze belongs to a forgotten temple that now serves as the lair of servants of the demon lord Juiblex. G LAB BAGOOL

1. B OX E D I N

T H E O O Z I N G T E M P L E : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

As characters explore the Oozing Temple, keep in mind the following features. Light. Except where specified otherwise, the tunnels and chambers are dark. Air. The air is stale and perceptibly thin. The temple contains enough air for the oozes, plus 160 hours of breathable air for one creature, divided by the number of creatures present. For example, a party of four adventurers has 40 hours of air. Characters who are at rest and not undertaking activities such as moving or fighting consume half as much air. Once half of the breathable air is consumed, the characters suffer one level of exhaustion (see appendix A of the Player’s Handbook). For each additional 10 percent of the air used up, the characters suffer one additional level of exhaustion. At 90 percent, the characters are unable to move. When the air is used up, they die. Once the first level of exhaustion sets in, the characters become aware that they are running out of air, and know roughly how much they have left. A lit torch or its equivalent uses up air as a character does. Briefer H O O K H O R R O R M ATU R ATI O N

3t

Age

Size

Infant (up to 1 month)

Tiny

Notes

AC 10; 4 (1 d4 + 2) hit points; speed 10 ft., climb 10 ft.; Str 9 (-1); no effective attacks; Challenge 0 (0 XP) Young Small AC 11; 11 (2d6 + 4) hit points; (1-3 months) speed 15 ft., climb 15 ft.; Str 12 (+1); hook attacks are +3 to hit, have a reach of 5 ft., and deal 3 (ld4 + 1) piercing damage on a hit; Challenge 1/4 (50 XP) Medium AC 13; 39 (6d8 + 12) hit points; Juvenile (3-6 months) speed 20 ft., climb 20 ft.; Str 15 (+2); hook attacks are +4 to hit, have a reach of 5 ft., and deal 5 (ld6 CHAPTER 2 | INTO DARKNESS + 2) piercing damage on a hit; Challenge 2 (450 XP) Adult Large See the Monster Manual (6+ months)

As the characters make their way through a 10-foot-high tubular passage, a tremor shakes the area and drops part of the ceiling on them. Each party member must succeed on a DC 13 Dexterity saving throw or take 5 (ldlO) bludgeoning damage from falling debris. Once the dust clears, the characters realize that fallen rock has buried both ends of the passageway. However, a new passage has opened in one of the walls, offering a possible escape route. It's clear that the route the party was following has been permanently blocked by tons of rubble, and runs the risk of triggering another collapse if the characters attempt to dig out.

2. D R IP P ING D E ATH Whether finished stone or rough rock, the wails of these 10-foot-high areas glisten with dark, dripping water. Each of these keyed areas holds a gray ooze that pours through cracks in the ceiling to attack any creatures that enter.

3. G LAB BA GO O L This area contains the skeletal remains of a drow, along with a dark metal mace and a scattering of coins. However, the characters are quick to notice that these items appear to hover above the stone floor. All the visible items are trapped within the body of a gelatinous cube named Glabbagool—or at least, that's what it has chosen to call itself. Unlike most gelatinous cubes, this monster has an Intelligence of 10 (+0) and telepathy out to a range of 60 feet (see the Monster Manual introduction for telepathy rules). Juiblex’s arrival in the Underdark has granted Glabbagool sentience and awareness. The ooze is genuinely curious about other creatures and wants to learn more about the world. It defends itself if attacked, but doesn't otherwise try to harm the characters, instead asking who they arc, where they come from, and why they have come to the temple. Other oozes won’t attack Glabbagool, so it can block a passageway to help the adventurers fend them off. However, the cube can't safely move past characters in a passageway. Glabbagool might ask to accompany the adventurers if it likes or is intrigued by them. Unfortunately, the ooze's speed of 15 feet means

that characters accompanied by it can travel only at a slow place (see “Travel Pace” at the beginning of this chapter). TREASURE

Glabbagool’s body contains a mace along with 14 ep and the mostly digested body of a drow. It will disgorge the items for the characters if they win its trust. The mace is a common magic item. While attuned the weapon, its wielder can use an action to make the head of the mace alight with green flame, or use an action to extinguish the flame. While the mace is “lit," it glows as brightly as a torch and deals an extra 1 fire damage on a hit.

4. P UDD ING P IT S This chamber is divided into four hallways and floored with heavy flagstones, the walls carved with worn and faded bas-reliefs. These show strange, swirling shapes that might be waves, tentacles, or some combination thereof. TRAP

The squares marked on the map have been undermined, leaving a 10-foot-deep pit beneath each one. A

CHAPTER 2 1 INTO DARKNESS

35

successful DC 15 Wisdom (Perception) check enables a character to notice that the stone is weakened. More than 50 pounds of weight on an undermined area causes it to collapse. A creature standing in the area must succeed on a DC 11 Dexterity saving throw to grab the edge of the pit, after which the creature must succeed on a DC 11 Strength (Athletics) check to scramble out. On a failed saving throw or a failed check, the creature falls into the pit and takes ld6 bludgeoning damage. At the bottom of each pit is a black pudding, which attacks any creature that falls in. If denied a victim, or if it devours a fallen creature quickly, the pudding climbs up the sides to attack any dangling creatures, or to move into the hallway in search of prey.

5. F OUNTAIN

O F M A D N E SS This room contains a stone fountain with a raised edge. The basin contains shallow, brackish water. At the center of the pool, the rubble of a broken statue rest atop a pedestal. All that remains recognizable are a pair of flawed stone feet clutching the pedestal's top. Carved into the walls are seven niches. Water seeps into one niche through a crack in the wall. The two niches that

36

CHAPTER 2 I INTO DARKNESS

flank it are empty. Strange, formless sculptures occupy the four remaining niches. The “sculptures” are actually four gray oozes held in magical stasis. They liquefy and attack when any one of them is touched or damaged. TREASURE

Hidden beneath the dark waters of the fountain are 112 sp, 41 gp, three green-gold bracelets worth 25 gp each, a drowT +1 dagger (the hilt has a spider design), a potion of greater healing, and a vial containing oil of slipperiness.

6. W ATE R C HAM BE R Characters approaching this rough-walled cave hear the sound of pouring water. The water enters through cracks in the 10-foot-high ceiling. Given the rate at which the water Hows in, the characters can easily conclude that the cracks were caused by the tremor they experienced, and it's only a matter of time before the water floods the entire complex. The water rises at a rate of 1 foot per hour until the tunnels are completely flooded. However, chipping away at any of the cracks causes more of the ceiling to collapse, doubling the amount of water pouring into the complex but also revealing a diverted underground river

that is the source of the water. Once the water level rises to the ceiling, the flow is slowed and the characters can swim upward for 30 feet to reach the water’s surface. They find themselves in a larger cavern from which they can resume their journey. DEVELOPMENT

If Glabbagool is with the party, the intelligent gelatinous cube floats upward as the water rises and squeezes through a crack in the ceiling to escape the flooded temple and remain with the characters.

LOST TOMB OF KHAEM In ages past, at the height of Faerun's great empires of magic, the half-elf sorcerer Brysis of Khaem was interred in a floating tomb. After the fall of the empire of Netheril and its flying cities, Brysis's tomb plummeted into a crevasse and wound up in the Underdark, where it has remained for centuries. The rise of the demon lords has awakened Brysis from the eternal sleep of death as a wraith, served by specters who were once her loyal retainers. Brysis yearns to accumulate enough iife force to leave the confines of her tomb, to which her spirit is hound. The adventurers might discover the tomb by accident or with the aid of Fargas Rumblefoot, the halfling from the Silken Paths encounter. Either way, when they're nearby, read the following to the players: •

A soft feminine voice sounds out in your mind suddenly, faint and distant. "Hello? Is someone there ... ? Oh please, I need your help! I have been trapped in the dark for so long ... so very long. Please, won't you help to free me?" •

The characters receive an impression of the direction to the entrance of the tomb, but the mysterious voice doesn't respond to any queries. As they follow the voice, a narrow side passage takes them to a dirty marble wall with a deep-set door made of bronze-encased stone, green with age (see the "Lost Tomb of Khaem: General Features’’ sidebar).

^E N T R ANC E R OO M A stone diorama stands to the right of the entrance, depicting the sorcerer Brysis Khaem as a Netherese r.oble in her prime, surrounded by attendants, slaves, .-.nd other trappings of wealth and power. A vista of fantastic floating cities covers the wall to the left of the entrance. A N D L A N D I N G Across from the entrance, empty stone torch sconces "ank a dusty staircase descending 20 feet to a landing. Set into the back wall of the landing is a Netherese alendar stone. Beyond this landing, the staircase resumes its descent, stopping at three more landings f bare stone and descending a total of 100 feet before arriving at area 2.

S TAI R C A S E

L OS T T OM B OF K HAE M : G E NE RA L FE ATU RE S

mind the following features. Ceilings. Room ceilings are 15 feet high. The hallways connecting them are 10 feet high. D o o r s . Each door in the tomb is a 10-foot-by-10-foot slab of solid marble encased in a thin layer of beaten bronze. The bronze has turned green with age. The door pivots on a central axis, creating narrow openings on either side while open. The door is also heavy and tight- fitting, requiring a DC 15 Strength (Athletics) check to open or close. Light. Except as otherwise noted, the interior of the tomb is dark. Chaotic Magic. The tomb was crafted during an age of high magic, and it has become suffused with faerzress. The ancient and chaotic energy now permeating the structure causes any spell cast within the tomb to trigger a roll on the Wild Magic Surge table in chapter 3, “Classes," of the Player's Handbook.

2. S HR INE The stairs lead down to this shrine, where shreds of dusty tapestries lie scattered across the floor. Friezes on the walls are defaced with deep gouges, making them unrecognizable. An altar of pale gray marble stands gouged and cracked against one wall. A successful DC 13 Intelligence (Investigation) check reveals that the damage to this room is relatively recent, and that the creatures that caused it left no tracks of any kind in the layer of dust on the floor.

3. S E RVANT S ’ S AR C OP HAGI Four stone sarcophagi mark the resting places of Brysis's most faithful servants. The lid of each sarcophagus bears the sculpted image of a robed human figure in repose. Brysis’s four servants have arisen at her command as specters. If anyone touches or otherwise disturbs a sarcophagus, all four specters emerge from their sarcophagi, howling in fury, and attack. The specters can pursue their prey beyond the confines of the tomb, if necessary. Opening a sarcophagus lid requires a successful DC 17 Strength check and reveals treasure within (see “Treasure”). A character inspecting the northeast sarcophagus and succeeding on a DC 15 Wisdom (Perception) check notices that the sarcophagus is built on hidden stone rollers. It can be moved aside with a successful DC 10 Strength check to reveal a 4-foot-square hole in the floor, and in the ceiling of a similarly sized chamber directly below this one (area 5). If the characters move the sarcophagus but leave the chamber without exploring the tomb below, they hear the same telepathic voice that called out to them initially, saying, “Please! Don't leave! I'm here, below!" TREASURE

Each sarcophagus contains mummified remains, the tattered remnants of ancient burial garments, and treasure of Netherese origin.

As characters explore the Lost Tomb of Khaem, keep in

CHAPTER 2 I INTO DARKNESS

37

The northeast sarcophagus contains two gold bracelets worth 50 gp each and a ceremonial wand (nonmagical) made of chiseled ivory worth 25 gp. The northwest sarcophagus contains an onyx ring worth 50 gp and a silver necklace set with two azurites and a carnelian worth 250 gp. The southwest sarcophagus contains a ewer made of beaten gold worth 25 gp and a walking stick worth 75 gp. The walking stick is made of varnished yew with a golden handle shaped like a scorpion. The southeast sarcophagus contains a gold censer with platinum filigree worth 250 gp.

4. F ALSE T O M B Stone blocks standing against the western and eastern walls are carved with niches, inside which rest a dozen clay canopic jars containing desiccated organs. These organs belong to Brysis’s servants, who are entombed in area 4. In the middle of the room rests a wide stone sarcopha gus atop a black marble bier. The lid of the sarcophagus is inlaid with dust-covered mosaics depicting great floating cities high above a beautiful landscape. The lid

of the sarcophagus looks incredibly heavy but is made lighter by an ancient spell that has survived to this day. The lid can be pushed aside with a successful DC 10 Strength check. The sarcophagus contains a lifesized statue of Brysis. sculpted and painted to make it appear that she is sleeping comfortably. The statue is affixed to the inside of the sarcophagus with sovereign glue and can’t be moved. There is no treasure to be found. TRAP

Opening the sarcophagus triggers a magic mouth spell that calls out in a booming voice, “You have disturbed the tomb of Brysis of Khaem! Accursed are you, most miserable of creatures!” Each creature in the room, whether it hears the booming voice or not, must make a DC 15 Charisma saving throw. On a failure, the creature is cursed with disadvantage on attack rolls and saving throws. The creature can repeat the saving throw after 24 hours have elapsed, ending the effect on itself with a successful save. Otherwise, a remove curse spell ends this effect, as does destroying the wraith in area 5. If Brysis’s wraith is destroyed, both the magic mouth and the curse on the sarcophagus cease to function.

5. T R UE T OMB Brysis’s true tomb is hidden below area 3 and has murals on the walls decorated with rich pigments and inlays of semiprecious stones. A gilded sarcophagus stands atop a stone bier along the west wall. An invisible stone chest rests at the foot of the sarcophagus. Characters searching the area thoroughly locate the chest. The chest becomes visible within an antimagic field, and a successful dispel magic (DC 19) also ends the invisibility effect. Brysis of Khaem has arisen as a murderous wraith, bound to her tomb until she can steal enough life force to leave it. She arises from within 1 the sarcophagus and attacks when creatures enter this chamber. She gloats about how the characters' deaths will free her from this prison, and how her victims will serve her even in death. On initiative count 1 in the round in which Brysis attacks, the characters hear the telepathic voice that first called to them. "In the sarcophagus! I can help you!” See “Treasure” for more information. TREASURE

The thin gold sheath covering Brysis’s sarcophagus can be pried loose and is worth 250 gp. Inside the stone sarcophagus, lying atop Brysis’s withered and mummified corpse, is a magic sword called Dawnbringer (see appendix B). This intelligent weapon is the source of the telepathic messages. The stone chest is unlocked and contains the other treasures Brysis took with her into the afterlife: 4.000 sp, 1,200 gp. eleven zircons (worth 50 gp each), a

necklace of fireballs, a philter of love, and a potion of greater healing.

CHAPTER 3: THE DARKLAKE Though its name might evoke images of a single subterranean body of water, the Darklake is a network of underground rivers, natural tunnels, and canals that connect innumerable water-filled caverns and chambers. This vast waterway stretches over a hundred miles across, with ceilings that are miles high in some places and depths that are unfathomable. Long ago. duergar engineers extended and widened many of the interconnecting passages of the Darklake. They also constructed locks for raising and lowering watercraft to different levels within it, opening up large portions of the network for travel. Many Underdark creatures are experienced in navigating the Darklake, including the kuo-toa—fishlike humanoids known for their insane obsession with unraveling the secret patterns of the Underdark. Still, better to trust a kuo-toa guide than attempt to traverse the Darklake alone and

become lost within it forever.

The adventurers can use the Darklake to reach many destinations in the Underdark. More importantly, water travel makes it difficult for their drow pursuers to track them. The kuo-toa town of Sloobludop is located on the eastern edge of the Darklake, and is a potential source of watercraft and navigational aid. But as they seek out these resources, the characters learn of terrible powers loose in the Underdark worse than the drow, the kuotoa, or any other threat of this dark realm.

T RAVERSING THE D ARKLAKE The adventurers need to find a way to cross the Darklake on the way to their ultimate destination- out of the Underdark and back to the surface world. They might attempt to find a guide or hire passage in Sloobludop, but other possibilities could also present themselves.

M O DE S

O F T R AVE L The adventurers might find different ways to cross the Darklake, depending on how long they traverse it and who or what they encounter along the way. Since there is no wind in the Underdark, all water travel involves either rowing at 1 IA miles per hour, or floating with prevailing currents at 1 mile per hour. Characters can work in shifts to row more than 8 hours per day, but crewing a boat for longer than that is considered a forced march (see chapter 8 of the Player’s Handbook). BOAT

Most craft navigating the waters of the Darklake are zurkhwood vessels piloted by the kuo-tua or the duergar. These boats are equivalent to keelboats (see the Airborne and Waterborne Vehicles table in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide). T H E D A R K L A K E : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

The following features commonly apply to the Darklake region. Darkness. True to its name, most of the Darklake exists in pitch blackness. The only light available is whatever the characters are able to provide. Caves and Tunnels. The Darklake is a giant labyrinth of lakes, waterways, and canals that connect myriad caverns and chambers. Some of these caverns are massive, with immeasurably deep water and vaulted ceilings far outside the range of any light. Others are narrow, with only a few feet of space between the ceiling and the surface of the water. Some are completely submerged, navigable only by those able to breathe underwater. Navigation. Without the sky or the stars to navigate by, any successful passage of the Darklake relies on one's familiarity with its intricate network of caverns, passages, and currents. Experienced navigators know how to find and read ancient duergar runes carved along the Darklake's tunnels, though most of these “road signs” are nearly worn away by the passage of time. Such

ICollision 2 3 4 5

8 9 10

Falls or locks Island Low ceiling Rockfall 6 Rough current Run aground Stone teeth Tight passage Whirlpool

COLLISION This terrain encounter occurs only if one or more party —ambers are traveling by raft or boat, and there’s a - r mg current. Have everyone aboard the vessel make r DC 13 group Dexterity check to avoid hitting a wall or ther large obstacle directly ahead. If the group check CHAPTER 3 I THE DARKLAKE

40

knowledge is something that takes years, if not decades, of wandering the Darklake to acquire. Those without the skill to navigate the Darklake (including the adventurers) must employ maps or guides. If the characters manage to acquire a map, they can make Wisdom (Survival) checks normally to avoid becoming lost. Foraging. The characters can forage for food while traversing the Darklake, primarily by fishing and gathering edible fungi (see “Fungi of the Underdark" in chapter 2). Much of the water of the Darklake is unsafe to drink, making it important to seek out springs and other clean sources of water feeding into it.

MAKESHIFT RAFT

Characters can also construct makeshift rafts using materials at hand. For example, the cap of a giant zurkhwood mushroom can be hollowed out to make a coracle equivalent to a rowboat, but with half a rowboat's hit points (see the Airborne and Waterborne Vehicles table in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide). This is a downtime crafting activity requiring one day’s work per raft. An even more makeshift craft might involve a character sitting in a floating barrel or other watertight container, cither steering with a paddle or flowing with the current. Such a vessel has a speed of 1 mph, requires a crew of 1, allows for no passengers or cargo, and has AC 11. hp 20, and damage threshold 0. SWIMMING

Swimming in the Darklake is a poor choice given the number of dangerous creatures inhabiting it. Check for a creature encounter each hour that characters are swimming, rather than every 4 hours of travel. A swimming character must succeed on a DC 10 Constitution saving throw for each hour of swimming or gain one level of exhaustion. Characters not actively swimming but simply clinging to something that floats (including the wreckage of a boat or raft) can drift with the current at a speed of 1 mph. Check for creature encounters each hour that characters float in the water, and call for Constitution checks against exhaustion for every 8 hours of travel. OTHER OPTIONS

Travelers can mix and match modes of travel, and a sizable party might need multiple boats or rafts. A creature with a swimming speed (including a polymorphed character) can travel without risk of fatigue for up to 8 hours, and can even serve as a mount for a creature smaller than it. Water-breathing (or nonbreathing) creatures can swim underwater or even walk across the bottom of shallow sections of the Darklake, but need darkvision or a source of light to see.

R ANDOM E NCOUNTERS Every 4 hours that the characters are on the Darklake, roll a d20 and consult the Darklake Random Encounters table to determine what, if anything, they encounter. If the characters aren't moving—anchored or ashore, for example—any encounter is automatically a creature encounter. DARKLAKE RANDOM ENCOUNTERS d 2 0 Type of Encounter

1-13 No encounter 14-15 Terrain (roll a dlO and consult the Darklake Terrain Encounters table) 1617 One or more creatures (roll a d!2 and consult the Darklake Creature Encounters table) 18-20 Terrain encounter featuring one or more creatures (roll a dlO and consult the Darklake Terrain Encounters table, then roll a dl2 and consult the Darklake Creature Encounter table)

CHAPTER 3 I THE DARKLAKE

41

D AR KLAKE T E R R A IN E N C O U N T E R S

I 1

succeeds, the collision is avoided. Otherwise, the vessel takes 2dl0 bludgeoning damage from the collision, and everyone aboard must succeed on a DC 10 Strength or Dexterity saving throw to avoid falling overboard. FALLS OR LOCKS

ISpecial terrain rules are explained after the table. DARKLAKE TERRAIN ENCOUNTERS dlO Terrain

Any character with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 12 or better can hear the roar of a waterfall ahead. A successful DC 14 group Strength (Athletics) check is necessary to steer or swim away from the falls. Otherwise, the characters go over, falling ld6 x 10 feet into a pool or river ld6 * 5 feet deep. A creature swept over the falls must succeed on a DC 11 Dexterity saving throw or take ld6 bludgeoning damage per 10 feet fallen. A successful save indicates that the creature avoids a hard landing in the water below. There is a 50 percent chance that any waterfall area contains a duergar-built lock designed to traverse it, in which case there is no risk of going over the falls. It takes a successful DC 11 Intelligence (Investigation) check to figure out how to operate the lock. Once a lock is opened, it takes 1 hour for the water level to lower so the party can proceed. CHAPTER 3 I THE DARKLAKE

ISLAND

A small island rises from the water ahead. An island with no hostile creatures makes a good place for the party to take a long rest. There is a 50 percent chance that the island has one or more types of fungi growing atop it (see “Fungi of the Underdark" in chapter 2). Otherwise, the island is barren rock.

Low

CEILING

The clearance of the cave or passage lowers suddenly to 3 feet above the water's surface. Each Medium character must succeed on a DC 10 Dexterity saving throw or take ld4 bludgeoning damage from hitting the ceiling before the passage ends. ROCKFALL

Loose rocks fall from the ceiling above. Each character must succeed on a DC 12 Dexterity saving throw or be hit by a chunk of falling stone for 2d6 bludgeoning damage. If the characters are traveling in a boat or raft, their vessel takes 2d6 bludgeoning damage for each successful save; in other words, each rock that misses a character hits the boat or raft instead. Roll the damage for each rock striking a vessel separately to sec if it overcomes the vessel's damage threshold. ROUGH CURRENT

The waters here are especially turbulent. If the characters are traveling by boat or raft, the crew must succeed on a DC 13 group Dexterity check to maintain control. If the group check fails, the vessel takes 2d6 bludgeoning damage, and each occupant must succeed on a DC 10 Strength or Dexterity saving throw to avoid falling overboard. RUN AGROUND

This terrain encounter occurs only if one or more party members are traveling by raft or boat. The vessel hits a shallow area or sandbar and runs aground. The characters can push the vessel back into the water with a successful DC 10 group Strength (Athletics) check. While characters arc pushing their boat free, there is a 50 percent chance that one or more creatures attack them; in this event, roll on the Darklake Creature Encounters table to determine what attacks. STONE TEETH

This terrain encounter occurs only if one or more party members are traveling by raft or boat, and there's a strong current. Stalagmites jutting up from the bottom of a tunnel are hidden just below the waterline. Spotters must succeed on a DC 13 Wisdom (Perception) check to notice the “stone teeth,” allowing the vessel's crew to attempt a DC 12 group Dexterity check to navigate through them. If the group check succeeds, the vessel passes through unscathed. Failure to notice or navigate through the stone teeth deals 6d6 piercing damage to the boat or raft. TIGHT PASSAGE

The adventurers encounter an especially tight passage, requiring a successful DC 12 group Dexterity check to navigate a boat or raft through it. If the group check CHAPTER 3 | THE DARKiAKE

42

succeeds, the boat slips through. Otherwise, the boat gets stuck, requiring a successful DC 14 group Strength (Athletics) check to push it free. While characters are pushing their boat free, there is a 50 percent chance that one or more creatures attack them; in this event, roll on the Darklake Creature Encounters table to determine what attacks. WHIRLPOOL An underwater crevasse or drain creates a small vortex in this area, much like the whirlpool effect of the control water spell (save DC 14).

D AR KLAKE C R E ATUR E E NC OUNT E R S

The sections that follow the table provide additional information to help you run each creature encounter. D A R K L A K E C R E AT U R E E N C O U N T E R S

dl2 1 2 3 4

5 6-7

8 9 10 11

12

Encounter 1 aquatic troll 2d4 darkmantles ld4 + 2 duergar in a keelboat 1 green hag 1 grell ld6 + 2 ixitxachitl (see appendix ld4 kuo-toa in a keelboat ld4 merrow 3d6 stirges 1 swarm ofquippers 1 water weird

AQUATIC TROLL

An aquatic troll swims up from the depths. It has the abilities of a normal troll, but can also breathe water and has a swimming speed of 30 feet. DARKMANTLES

These creatures cling to the ceiling as the adventurers approach, cloaking themselves in darkness as they unfurl and attack. A creature in a boat or on a raft that tries and fails to detach a darkmantle from itself or another creature must succeed on a DC 10 Dexterity saving throw or fall out of the vessel and into the water. DUERGAR

A keelboat crewed by duergar is traversing the Darklake on business. The gray dwarves parley with the adventurers—or attack them if the opportunity looks ripe to capture them and sell them as slaves in Gracklstugh. If the duergar surprise all the characters, they turn invisible, making it appear that their boat is abandoned so as to lure the adventurers on board before they attack. Roll a d20 and consult the Duergar Keelboat Cargo table to determine what, if anything, the duergar are transporting in their keelboat. D U E R G A R K E E L B O AT C A R G O 620 Cargo I- 10 None II- 13 ld20 x 100 pounds of unrefined iron ore 14-16 ld4 zurkhwood crates filled with mining tools 17- 19 2d4 zurkhwood casks of harvested fungi (see

“Fungi of the Underdark" in chapter 2) 20 A locked iron chest containing 3d6 x 100 gp and a random magic item (roll once on Magic Item Table B in chapter 7 of the Dungeon Master's Guide).

GREEN HAG Nanny Plunk is a green hag who likes to taunt and lead travelers astray. She might instead bargain with the characters with her knowledge of the Darklake, especially if her life or freedom is at stake. If this encounter occurs again, it might be with Nanny or one of her sisters. Maven Delve or Dame Spidcrwort. GRELL A grell descends from the cavern ceiling, attempting to grab and paralyze one parly member, then fly off with its victim. IXITXACHITL These creatures attack any party members in the water. Otherwise, they follow the party and wait for an opportunity to strike. If denied a meal for too long, they begin to gnaw on the hull of a boat or the underside of a raft, hoping to sink it (this tactic is ineffective against craft with a high damage threshold). KUO-TOA These kuo-toa pole a keelboat toward Sloobludop (or away from the town if it has been attacked: see the end of this chapter). If the characters have not been to Sloobludop, the kuo-toa might try to capture them and bring them there. See “The Day’s Catch” for details. Roll a d20 and consult the Kuo-toa Keelboat Cargo table to determine what, if anything, the duergar are transporting in their keelboat. K U O - T O A K E E L B O AT C A R G O d 2 0 Cargo 1-15 None 16-17 ld4 nets; each net has a 50 percent chance of containing 3d6 dead, edible quippers 18- 19 ld4 nets; each net has a 50 percent chance of containing ld4 living stirges 20 ld4 pieces of broken, barnacle-encrusted statuary, each worth 50 gp; each weighing ld4 x 5 pounds; and each depicting a weird alien creature, a long- forgotten god, or fragment thereof.

MERROW These worshipers of Demogorgon have been driven into a frenzy by his arrival in the Underdark. They immediately attack, trying to capsize or wreck boats as they utter the war cry, "Blood and salt for the Prince of Demons!” in Abyssal. A merrow can use its action to capsize a boat or raft within 5 feet of it. Anyone in the boat can thwart the merrow by using a reaction to make a Strength check contested by the merrow's Strength check. If the merrow wins the contest, the vessel capsizes.

These stirges cling to the ceiling like bats. If the party is aware of the stirges, the characters can make a DC 13 group Dexterity (Stealth) check to slip past the stirges without disturbing them. If the group check succeeds, the stirges ignore the party. Otherwise, the stirges descend and attack the nearest party members. SWARM OF QUIPPERS A swarm of quippers keeps pace with the characters, attacking anyone in the water. If an hour passes and no meal has presented itself, the quippers stop following the party. WATER WEIRD Bound to some long-lost site beneath the surface of the water, this neutral evil elemental rises to attack when the characters pass by. Roll a d6 and consult the Weird Discoveries table to determine what the water weird is guarding. WEIRD DISCOVER IES d 6 Discovery 1-2 Sunken altar dedicated to a forgotten deity 3-4 Sunken statue with 500 gp black pearls for eyes; a thief who removes one or both gems becomes the target of a contagion spell (save DC 14). 5-6 Sunken, sealed sarcophagus containing a mummy and ld4 art objects (roll on the 250 gp Art Objects table in chapter 7 of the Dungeon Master's Guide)

S LOOBLUDOP Population: 500

kuo-toa Government: The archpriest Ploopploopeen once ruled in the name of the Sea Mother, the goddess Blibdoolpoolp. He was recently challenged and displaced by his daughter Bloppblippodd, archpriest of Leemooggoogoon the Deep Father. Defense: All kuo-toa rally to the village’s defense, including whips and monitors serving the priesthood. Commerce: The kuo-toa trade with various races of the Underdark near the Darklake, in addition to providing ferry service and navigation. Organizations: Two major shrines and several other minor ones. Sloobludop is a kuo-toa village on the eastern edge of the Darklake. From a distance, it looks like a massive tangle of reeds stretching up into the darkness, lit by glowing spots of phosphorescence. Upon closer approach, a series of rickety towers can be seen, lashed together by rope and plank bridges set in haphazard patterns. Even above ground, the kuo-toa build in line with their three-dimensional aquatic sensibilities, constructing their “great city” as if it were underwater.

STIRGES CHAPTER 3 I THE DARKLAKE

43

Sloobludop simmers with religious fervor and sectarian tension. While many of the kuo-loa still worship the goddess Blibdoolpoolp, a faction has shifted its worship to Leemooggoogoon the Deep Father, a vision influenced by the manifestation of the demon prince Demogorgon from the depths of the Darklake. Initially, the archpriest of Blibdoolpoolp tolerated this— but then his own daughter declared herself an archpriest of Leemooggoogoon, and the cult began to grow.

S LOUC H IN G T O WAR D S LO O B LU D O P The characters can choose to go to Sloobludop for several reasons: • They need a boat (and possibly a guide) to navigate the Darklake. Travel along the waterways of the Darklake is an excellent way to throw off their draw pursuers (see chapter 2 for details). • Staying a short while in Sloobludop can provide a respite from pursuit, since the draw arc reluctant to provoke the kuo-toa needlessly. Reduce the pursuit level by 1 while the characters consider their next move. • The characters need supplies and equipment, and hope the kuo-toa might be willing to trade for whatever they can offer. Alternatively, the characters might try to steal what (hey need from the kuo-toa. • Shuushar might point out any of the previous reasons, or wish to go to Sloobludop to rejoin his people, feeling he has important guidance to offer them. • Shuushar might not be the only one with "higher guidance." One or more characters might experience dreams or visions guiding them toward S L O O B L U D O P : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

Sloobludop spreads out along the rocky shore of the waters of a broad cavern lake, with high fences of woven netting to the north and south of the village boundaries. Light. Sloobludop's cavern is almost entirely dark except for a few spots of dim light from phosphorescent fungus and coral, or from glowing cave-fish glands. The kuo-toa recoil from areas of bright illumination, becoming hostile if bright light is brought among them. Bridges and Platforms. Bridges and platforms are haphazardly strung throughout the city, connecting various levels of structures with each other as well as crisscrossing open spaces. Characters can move at a normal pace across the platforms and bridges, but this puts strain on their poor construction. Whenever one or more characters move at normal speed across a bridge or platform, roll a d6. On a roll of 1, a bridge flips or breaks to drop characters to the platform below, or a platform tilts to tip the characters into the water. These areas can be navigated safely by treating them as difficult terrain. Language. None of the inhabitants of Sloobludop speak Common or any surface-world language, which might present a challenge for the characters. The fish-folk speak Undercommon, and Stool the myconid sprout can establish communication using its rapport spores if it is present. Shuushar the kuo-toa monk can also translate if he accompanies the party.

Sloobludop—not realizing that such dreams are simply further manifestations of the madness growing in the Underdark.

CHAPTER 3 | THE DARKLAKE *4

N OTAB LE K UO - TOA

IN S LOO BLUD OP A number of important kuo-toa have the ability to influence the adventurers' fate in Sloobludop. PROMINENT KUO-TOA Archpriest of the Blibdoolpoolp the Sea Ploopploopeen Mother (“Ploop") Bloppblippodd {“Blopp")

Ploopploopeen’s daughter, now calling herself the archpriest of Leemooggoogoon the Deep Father; demon tainted

Glooglugogg (“Gloog")

Ploopploopeen's son, kuo-toa whip, and loyal worshiper of the Sea Mother

Klibdoloogut (“Klib”)

Kuo-toa whip and keeper of the altar of the Deep Father

SHUUSHAR CONNECTION If Shuushar accompanies the party, the kuo-toa monk can be helpful in communicating with his people at Sloobludop. Ffowever, keep in mind that Shuushar is either a heretic or a holy man depending on which kuotoa he’s speaking to, and how they view things at that particular moment. The mysterious monk could serve as an ace in the hole to help the party out, or he could just as easily cause trouble with his stubborn refusal to acknowledge his fellow kuo-toa’s religious obsessions R O L E P L AYI N G T H E K U O - TO A

Though the kuo-toa are mad, at least some of that madness comes from an utterly alien mind-set. Although amphibious air dwellers, the kuo-toa still largely behave as aquatic creatures. Thus, much of what they do on land is a bizarre approximation of life under the water. Kuo-toa names are a long series of gargling syllables, and their voices have a bubbly, gargling quality. However, the kuo-toa communicate as much through gesture as speech. They have difficulty standing still, and are prone to quick, darting movements. They pace constantly, walking in circles around creatures talking to them. A kuo-toa priest speaking to a group of followers doesn’t stand at a podium but wanders aimlessly while the crowd follows like a school offish. Kuo-toa prefer their leaders to be physically above their subordinates. (If no dais or platform is available for leaders, they have been known to literally stand on top of prostrate underlings.) However, leaders tend to dwell on the lowest levels of buildings because these are considered the safest areas in a settlement, due to their proximity to the water. Since the kuo-toa are fishlike, they lack eyelids. This isn’t only unnerving in conversation (a kuo-toa never blinks), but it also means that kuo-toa all look the same sleeping as awake—and virtually all kuo-toa sleepwalk, making things even more confusing. There is a 25 percent chance that any individual kuo-toa the party encounters in Sloobludop is sleepwalking, ignoring everyone around it and moving in a shuffling gait from place to place.

as anything other than “dangerous illusions," combined with his preference for nonviolent solutions.

T HE D AY ’ S C ATC H ____________________ When the adventurers come within an hour’s travel of Sloobludop, they encounter a party of eight kuo-toa led by a kuo-toa monitor. The fish-folk immediately attack, but their tactics show that they are attempting to capture the characters. The kuo-toa leave any fallen opponents unconscious at 0 hit points, intending to bring them back to Sloobludop as live offerings to the Deep Father. They bind prisoners with tough cords of gut. each with 2 hit points and requiring a successful DC 17 Strength check to break. THE ENEMY OF MY ENEMY On the way to Sloobludop after the previous encounter, the characters run into another kuo-toa patrol, this one : lade up of six kuo-toa and two kuo-toa monitors, ed by the kuo-toa archpriest Ploopploopeen. If the characters are prisoners of the first kuo-toa patrol, the newcomers ambush them and fight to free the haractcrs. Otherwise (or after the fight), Ploopploopeen attempts to communicate in Undercommon. then casts

tongues if none of the characters speak it. Read the

following: “1 am Ploopploopeen, archpriest of the Sea Mother Blibdoolvpoolp. She answers my prayers by delivering you. Help us. and you will be rewarded for your service,”

If the characters talk with Ploopploopeen. the archpriest explains his intentions as the kuo-toa escort the party to Sloobludop, If the characters refuse, the kuo-toa attempt to capture them, as with the previous patrol, Ploopploopeen explains that the inhabitants of Sloobludop have lived in harmonious service to the will of the Sea Mother for some time. Oh. there were occasional “visionaries" who stirred up trouble (at this, he might cast a walleyed glance at Shuushar) but nothing of any great concern. A few weeks ago, Bloppblippodd, Ploopploopeen’s own daughter, experienced a powerful vision of “Leentooggoogoon the Deep Father," proclaiming him the new god of her people. She has backed up her claims with a great increase in her magical power, and new followers have flocked to her.

4,6

CHAPTER 3 | THE DARKI.AKE

A KUO-TOAN K O A N The kuo-toa are aquatic creatures. As such, they have no real need for the boats they use to ply the Darklake, even as boating remains a significant part of their culture. It might well be that the kuo-toa's former masters—the mind flayers—used them as ferry pilots and navigators in the Underdark, and the fish-folk continue to do so out of habit or some deep-seated need. Certainly, their relative usefulness to the other races of the Underdark has served the kuo-toa well. Only the duergar have shown any interest in navigating the waters of the Darklake on their own, and not even they do it as well as the kuo-toa. There is a persistent myth among the inhabitants of Sloobludop that the maze of tunnels, passages, and pools of the Darklake is a kind of meditation—a spiritual journey. Kuo-toa who navigate that maze long enough will awaken to a great revelation for their people. As with many of the strange beliefs of the kuo-toa, this one might only need time to become a reality.

"We are split in two,” Ploopploopeen explains, "fighting among ourselves.” The followers of the Deep Father have been making an increasing number of offerings on his altar killing blood sacrifices then casting bloody chum into the waters of the Darklake, where it is consumed by ... something. BAITING THE HOOK

The archpriest of the Sea Mother tells the characters he wants to use them as bail. The archpriest of the Deep Father needs humanoid sacrifices, and the party represents a prize collection in that regard. Ploopploopeen will offer the characters as a “token of peace and reconciliation" to get closer to the archpriest of the Deep Father—except the adventurers will not be helpless prisoners, but infiltrators. Ploopploopeen wants the characters to disrupt the upstart faction’s rituals, allowing his true believers of the Sea Mother to cut off the head of the cult. The archpriest promises that the characters will be “well rewarded” for their aid. ff the characters refuse, Ploopploopeen tries to turn them over anyway, still using them as bait to get his own kuo-toa loyalists closer to his daughter’s cult. However, he no longer depends on or supports the characters as allies, leaving them to survive on their own. No matter whether the characters approach the final encounter as willing participants or prisoners, the kuotoa make no effort to bind them or take their weapons, believing in the power of their superior numbers and the divine might of their competing gods.

1. G ATE Sloobludop is enclosed to the north and south by outer “walls” of heavy netting with sharp bone hooks woven into them. In the middle of each wall is a gate through which creatures can safely pass. Any creature wishing to crawl through the netting can do so with a successful DC 15 Dexterity (Acrobatics) check. On a failure, the creature takes ld8 piercing damage and becomes restrained in the netting, requiring a successful DC 12 Strength check as an action to break free. Stationed outside each gate are four kuo-toa whips. They confront anyone who approaches. Party members escorted by other kuo-toa can pass through the gate unchallenged. If the characters are unescorted, any kuotoa they meet attempt to capture them, Poll a d20. On a 17, captives are taken to area 3. On an 8 18,

captives are taken to area 4. On a 19-20. the guards are evenly split and immediately begin to brawl for the right to take the characters as prisoners.

2. D OC KS A half-dozen kuo-toan keelboats are moored here. Although kuo-toa will negotiate terms for ferrying the characters across the Darklake, none leave without permission (see below). Party members can attempt to steal one or more of the boats, but doing so requires a successful DC 16 Dexterity (Stealth) check (and the kuo- toa are able to sense invisible creatures). The kuotoa pursue any stolen boats, intending to capture the thieves as offerings to appease their gods. Five groups of three kuo-toa monitors led by a kuotoa whip patrol the platforms at the water’s edge. They ensure no vessel enters or leaves without submitting to "auguries” to determine if a crew’s actions are pleasing to the god of the hour—in this case, the Deep Father. The auguries consist of a half-hour ritual, during which the whip casts bones, shells, and other tokens and reads the resulting omens. Roll a d20. On 1—8, the whip finds the omens favorable; on 9 18, he finds them unfavorable; and on 19-20, the auguries are unclear, and the whip feels the need to consult the archpriest of the Deep Father (area 4). If the characters met or spoke with the archpriest of the Deep Father before coming here, the whip automatically refuses their request to leave,

3. S HR INE

OF T HE S E A M OT HE R When the characters arrive here, on their own or escorted, read the following to the players: A nine-foot-tall statue stands here. Its body is roughly carved from some kind of wood in the shape of a humanoid female, its head and forearms formed from the severed head and claws of a giant albino crayfish. These parts are lashed on with strands of gut, and emit an overpowering stench of rotting shellfish. Shells, brightly colored stones, mushrooms, and rotting fish are piled at the statue's feet and strung in garlands around its neck. Four stern kuo-toa slowly circle the statue, alert and on guard, while a few others mill about, gazing up at the statue and bowing repeatedly while chanting.

All creatures that come here are expected to make an offering to the Great Sea Mother Blibdoolpooip. A successful DC 13 Intelligence (Religion) check recalls that Blibdoolpooip is a scavenger goddess, meaning that discarded and recovered items arc worthy offerings— and the more personal the better. Regurgitating at the goddess's feet is considered a sincere show of faith (and a behavior faithful kuo-toa might display if the characters wait long enough).

Four kuo-toa monitors guard the statue at all mes, and there are always 2d4 kuo-toa worshipers around it offering prayers. Currently the shrine is -.ended by Glooglugogg, a kuo-toa whip and son of Plooppioopeen. the archpriest of the Sea Mother. The guards are wary of anyone, including other kuo-toa, due to recent tensions. Plooppioopeen claims a small hovel adjacent to the -brine, where he is attended by four kuo-toa. This is A here he brings the characters if they are his “guests.” TREASURE The home of the archpriest contains a closet full of 'offerings" taken from less fortunate travelers or culled from the depths of the lake. This includes 500 cp. 2.000 sp, 150 gp. 27 pp. a strand of matched pearls worth 1 000 gp total, two potions of healing, a potion of water zreathing, and a spell scroll of light.

4. A LTAR

OF T HE D EE P F ATHE R When the characters visit the altar of the Deep Father, read the following to the players: The idol to Leemooggoogoon the Deep Father consists of a large hide cut roughly in the shape of a manta ray and stretched out on cords between two support poles. A dead, splayed-out manta ray is pinned to the center of the hide. Two dead octopuses are draped across the top, their tentacles pinned and artfully arrayed, their heads tied together and painted with red and blue pigments. The idol reeks of decay, and the broad stone altar below the idol is stained dark with blood.

Six kuo-toa work at the altar, cleaning up and arranging offerings. Klibdoloogut, a kuo-toa whip dedicated to the Deep Father, stands in front of the altar with two kuo-toa monitors. Offerings are usually living creatures killed on the altar, although an offering of one’s own blood also satisfies the whip. Humanoids other than kuo-toa are immediately taken into custody to be brought before the archpriest of the Deep Father, who summarily condemns them to be sacrificed. Bloppblippodd. a female kuo-toa archpriest of the Deep Father, lives on the bottom floor of a squat hovel near the altar. She is a bloodthirsty sadist absolutely assured that her divine vision will raise her in glory to rule her people. Bound and gagged against the far wall is a duergar prisoner (see “The Offering"). TREASURE

Bloppblippodd's hovel contains wealth accumulated since her rise to power: 1,000 cp, 500 sp, 290 gp, an embroidered silk handkerchief with a spider design worth 25 gp. three azurite gems worth 10 gp each, a duergar-made bronze cup worth 25 gp, and a silver choker with a spider design worth 30 gp.

T HE O FFE R IN G If allowed to do so, Ploopploopeen brings the characters to his quarters near the Shrine of the Deep Mother. There they meet Glooglugogg, who loudly tells his father in Undercommon that he sees no need for outsiders to be involved in sacred matters. The archpriest dismisses his son’s concerns with a negligent wave, telling Glooglugogg that he must flow with the currents of the goddess’s visions. The whip relents but throws the characters a hostile glare. Within the hour, twelve kuo-toa led by a kuo-toa monitor arrive at Ploopploopeen’s quarters. The archpriest of the Sea Mother admits the monitor and informs him that he, his whip, and the prisoners will accompany them to see the archpriest of the Deep Father. They are escorted to the altar of the Deep Father near the docks, where Bloppblippodd awaits them. Describe the scene to the players as given in that area, then read the following boxed text: if none of the characters speak Undercommon, the exchange is gibberish to them, though Shuushar can translate. The archpriest of the Sea Mother steps forward across the span of the altar toward the kuo-toa waiting for him there. "The time has come,” he says, “for us to acknowledge your divine vision and welcome it. I have brought these as offerings.” He gestures toward all of you, standing within a circle of guards behind him. "Will you not accept them?” “You are wise, father," the younger archpriest replies. “I accept your offering in the name of the Deep Father. May their blood nourish and strengthen him!" A burbling cheer goes up from the surrounding kuo-toa, their fists raised in the air.

The followers of the Deep Father are already preparing to sacrifice a bruised and bedraggled duergar named Hemeth—an arms smuggler who was looking to cut a CHAPTER 3 I THE DARKLAKE 4-8

deal with one or both factions of the kuo-toa, but instead found himself captured for his trouble. He’s willing to cooperate with the characters to save his own skin, and will even return the favor given the opportunity (see chapter 4, “Gracklstugh").

T HE R IT UAL Kuo-toa parade around the altar in a wide circle as they chant. Part of their path sends them splashing and wading through the shallows of the Darklake. The characters quickly can’t tell one faction of fish-folk from the other, but they see the archpriest of the Sea Mother and his whip moving toward the altar. Bloppblippodd calls for the sacrifices to be brought forth, and one kuo-toa per character jumps to do her bidding. They prod the characters with their spears to herd them toward a slight depression 20 feet from the altar, with a large grate at its center. The characters can see that the stonework of the depression is stained with the blood of innumerable sacrifices, and they can hear the gentle lapping of the Darklake coming up through the grate. The chanting grows louder. When the sacrifices are brought forward, Bloppblippodd gestures toward the altar, whereupon her father suddenly attacks, striking her with his scepter. Kuo-toa loyal to him surge forward to attack, while the guards that brought the characters forward stand in shock. They are surprised and can’t move or take an action on their first turn of the combat, and they can’t take reactions until that first turn ends. As the two archpriests and their followers fight, the characters can intervene on either side or attempt to slip away during the melee. On round 3 of the fight, characters notice kuo-toa crying out and flailing in the shallows of the Darklake. Several are pulled under or strike at unseen foes beneath the surface. The water foams red with blood. Dozens of ixitxachitl (see appendix C) are responsible for the attacks in the water. They have been drawn by the kuo-toa ritual and feast on any creatures they can reach, including party members in the water. The sudden frenzy sets a wave of panic through the kuo-toa. The young archpriest calls out “Leemooggoogoon!” just as her father strikes a final, fatal blow, dropping her before the profane altar. (If any character is also engaging the archpriest of the Deep Father, allow that character to strike the final blow.)

D E MOGOR GON R ISE S !_________________ Although Bloppblippodd falls, the ritual still achieves a terrible success. Read the following:

Another sound rises above the burbling cries of the kuo- toa. The dark surface of the water farther out bubbles I and begins to foam. A thick, oil/ tentacle bursts forth, followed by another. Then two monstrous heads break the surface, both resembling hideous, angry baboons with wickedly curved tusks. Both heads are attached to a single torso, and the monster's red eyes burn with bloodlust and madness. The creature rising from the Darklake must stand thirty feet tall or more, with water cascading down its back and shoulders. Upon reaching its full height, the great demon throws back both its heads and roars! •

The kuo-toa offerings and the fervor of his worshipers in the Darklake have drawn the attention of Demogorgon see appendix D). Upon witnessing the rise of the Prince of Demons, each party member must succeed :>n a DC 13 Charisma saving throw or gain a level of madness (see “Madness" in chapter 2). The kuo-toa become incapacitated for Id 10 minutes, crying out “Leemooggoogoon!” over and over again. Demogorgon wades toward Sloobltidop. heads roaring and gibbering, tentacles flailing and smashing the water. In 4 rounds, he comes within reach of the shoreline and lashes out, smashing docks and sending bodies flying w ith each sweep of his tentacles. When the demon lord attacks, some kuo-toa recover their w'its enough to flee, while others cower, paralyzed with fear.

they confront him, they are almost certainly doomed. Fortunately for them. Demogorgon is focused on smashing the kuo-toa settlement and pays little heed to the puny creatures fleeing from him. The characters thus have a good chance of getting away if they act quickly. They might first need to deal with companions overcome by bouts of madness, however, and they need to decide how they intend to escape. Escape by Land. Fleeing by land requires dodging terrified kuo-toa. and even fighting fish-folk driven to a killing frenzy against the characters for having drawn this doom down upon them. Roll a d20. On a 17 20, 2d4 kuo-toa attack the characters during their escape. Escape by Water. The adventurers can steal boats from the docks and paddle them along the shore away from the attacking demon lord. The ixitxachitl attack anyone in the water, but most are occupied with slaughtering kuo-toa fleeing into the Darklake. A near miss from one of Demogorgon's tentacles might require each character to make a DC 10 Strength or Dexterity saving throw (player's choice), with failure indicating that the character has been thrown overboard by a wave. DEVELOPMENT

The adventurers end this chapter with a terrible realization: Demogorgon is loose in the Underdark! Initially, they might blame the kuo-toa ritual or the ixitxachitl. But as they learn more about what has happened, the need to escape the Underdark becomes even more urgent.

XP AWARDS ESCAPING THE DEMON LORD

Hopefully, the players exercise the better part of valor and flee as soon as they see the demon lord. If

CHAPTER 4- | CRACKI.STUGH

In addition to the XP awards earned for the creatures the party overcomes in this chapter, the characters earn 400 XP (divided equally among all party members) for

surviving the encounter with the Cult of the Deep Father and their brush with the Prince of Demons.

CHAPTER 4: GRACKLSTUGH Visitors to the duergar city of Gracklstugh are greeted by its hot and acrid air. followed by the angry red glare of the eternally burning smelters fueling the city’s metal works, its clanging heart, and the forges kept alive by the flames of Themberchaud. the red dragon that holds the title of Wyrmsmith. Gracklstugh toils endlessly, its smiths churning out the best armor and weapons among the Underdark races. Those who do business here refer to Gracklstugh as “the City of Blades." As merciless as it can be, Gracklstugh is a major bastion of civilization in the Underdark with active trade routes. For the characters, this means a potential chance to find a way back to the surface world—and just as importantly, to shake off the drow that pursue them. However, the adventurers will quickly realize that the power of the demon lords is a threat even here, getting an even closer glimpse of the Underdark's decay as the madness of the Abyss continues to spread. Built within the walls of a deep cavern southwest of the Darklake, Gracklstugh is the commercial, political, and spiritual center of the duergar, all of whom look to

the Dcepking with respect. The city has an open shore

along the Darklake, while several caverns and passages connect Gracklstugh to other parts of the Underdark to facilitate travel and trade. The characters have a chance to witness and shape events in the city that point toward the danger Gracklstugh faces—and how unprepared the city is for it. But with each moment the characters spend in the City of Blades, they run the risk of having escaped the drow only to be enslaved by the duergar.

GOING TO GRACKLSTUGH Despite its dangers, Gracklstugh does have a few things to offer ... or at least that's what some of the characters’ fellow escapees tell them. Buppido {see chapter 1) and Hemeth (see chapter 3) are the only NPCs who actively suggest going to Gracklstugh. They know that duergar have no love for the drow, and their draconian laws keep all foreigners in check, which should provide some measure of sanctuary from drow pursuit. Gracklstugh is as good a place as any in the Underdark to sell stolen gear and

buy more useful equipment. Additionally, the duergar trade actively with other subterranean and surfacedwelling races. Gracklstugh’s Blade Bazaar might be the ideal place to find traders or explorers heading to the surface world. If Buppido or Hemeth isn’t with the party, others can provide the above information. Sarith resists plans to travel to the city at first, conscious of the low regard the duergar have for drow. He changes his mind quickly, however, as Zuggtmoy’s spores drive him to seek a densely populated area where he can spread his contagion. It's also possible the party arrives at Gracklstugh involuntarily. Duergar slavers scour the Underdark in search of new “merchandise,” and they might deceive or iuiright capture the characters and bring them to their Ity’s slave markets. The random encounters in chapters 2 and 3 can easily set up this scenario.

by merchants, mercenaries, and other :: feigners who can offer information about traveling

G R AC KLST UG H

R ANDOM E NC OUNT E R S

A N D D R O W P U R SU IT Taking refuge in Gracklstugh has its advantages. Each day they spend in the duergar capital, the characters can suernpt a DC 16 gruup Dexterity (Stealth) check to move j; round cautiously, with success indicating that they avoid drawing attention to themselves. The characters -an also attempt a DC 13 group Wisdom (Insight) check to assess the mood in the city, with success allowing them to avoid trouble before it starts. Characters who lie low for the day have advantage on this Wisdom check. Success with either check reduces the party’s pursuit evel by 1 (see “Drow Pursuit” in chapter 2).

A R R IV ING

IN G R A C K LST U G H The Darklake District is a likely entry point to the city for the characters, whether they arrive via the water or travel one of the many tunnels leading to the district’s gates. Non-ducrgar arriving from tunnels that lead to tther districts are stopped and escorted to the Darklake District under heavy guard, as every other district is normally off limits to outsiders, and trespassers risk :: ng confronted by an invisible patrol of four duergar. The party's fellow escapees know that trying to enter through the main entrances is a sure way to get n -laved, unless one of the characters is an epic liar who can convince the guards the party is a legitimate diplomatic or trade delegation. Anyone with a merchant or criminal background has heard rumors that the Zhentarim trade in the Underdark, but posing as Zhentarim has its own risks, as such claims are bound K be questioned. A character who is actually a member of the Zhentarim can buy the adventurers a couple of days inside the city before Lhe duergar slavers start --iking their measure. Arriving by way of the Darklake Docks is easier and more discreet. If the characters arc traveling by boat. Buppido can guide them to a deserted pier where they ran dock quietly. He warns them that they have to keep a low profile and head directly to the only inn in the city devoted to outsiders. The Ghohlbrorn's Lair - frequented

G R A C K L S T U C H : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

Sweltering heat and cloying smoke ding to every comer of the duergar city, spewing from smelters housed inside massive stalagmites and stalactites. These protrude from the cavern’s floor and ceiling like the teeth of some great maw. L i g h t . Gracklstugh's glowing forges and smithies operate continuously. Most of the city is dimly lit by a hellish red glow, with patches of darkness here and there. N o i s e . The clanging and clacking of hammers and machinery echoes constantly throughout the city. Wisdom (Perception) checks made to listen in Gracklstugh have disadvantage. Smoke and Haze. Despite vents dug into the walls and ceiling of the city's great cavern, fumes from smelters and forges linger at ground level (as does the gas tapped in Laduguer’s Furrow). Visitors might contract the illness known as grackle-lung (see the Grackie-lung sidebar).

elsewhere in the Underdark—or perhaps even to the surface world.

With routine patrols of heavily armed gray dwarves who can turn invisible. Gracklstugh is a relatively safe place for those who know where they belong and stay there. However, tensions are rising because of the influence of Demogorgon, and the characters have many opportunities to participate in events unfolding in the city. At the end of each long rest, roil a d20: on a roil of 1720, an encounter takes place. Roll another d20 and consult the Random Encounters in Gracklstugh table: if the characters are outside (he Darklake District, treat any entry marked with an asterisk as a "Duergar Patrol” encounter instead. RANDOM ENCOUNTERS IN GRACKLSTUGH

d20

Encounter

1-2

Abusive duergar guards Deep gnome merchant* Derro rioters*

3-4 5-7

8-9 Drow emissary* 10-12 Duergar patrol 13-14 Mad duergar 15-16 Ore mercenaries* 17-18 Slave caravan 19 Steeder handlers 20

Themberchaud

A BUSIVE D UERGAR G UARDS

The characters come upon two duergar guards beating a duergar merchant and shouting accusations of heresy. Any Underdark native accompanying the party urges the characters not to intervene on the merchant’s behalf, telling them this isn't their business and warning them that any interference might get them arrested or killed. Bystanders look a little surprised or concerned but don't intervene, not even to aid the unconscious merchant once the guards leave. If the characters investigate the circumstances leading to lhe assault, bystanders tell them that one of the guards

CHAPTER 4 | GRACKLSTUGH

51

noticed a golden pin the merchant was

CHAPTER 4 | GRACKLSTUGH

52

wearing inside his collar. Though adornment for adornment’s sake is something duergar society frowns upon, the guards’ violent response was unnatural a hint of the growing madness festering inside the City of Blades. A female deep gnome named Ariana and her earth elemental bodyguard approach the party. Ariana aims to deliver a cargo of gemstones, but she can’t find the duergar merchant she's supposed to meet. She assumes the characters are smugglers and tries to unload her goods: ten sparkly garnets worth 100 gp each. Ariana keeps the gems in a bag of holding, which isn’t for sale. The merchant whom Ariana is looking for was recently arrested and executed for selling stolen jewelry. You can decide whether Ariana's interest in the characters attracts the attention of a duergar patrol. Subsequent occurrences of this encounter are with other deep gnome merchants who ignore the characters unless approached. They carry nothing of value. DEEP GNOME MERCHANT

DERRO RIOTERS

A mob of derro (see appendix C) rampages through the streets. Five of them detach from the mob to attack the characters. Four duergar patrols (see “Duergar Patrol") arrive when the characters kill the last derro, but they simply nod at the characters before repressing the rest of the mob. Word quickly spreads that the characters helped the city guard control the unruly derro scum. At your discretion, give the characters advantage on checks R O L E P L AYI N G T H E D U E R G A R A N D D E R R O

The gray dwarves are dour, joyless, and all business. They live by a simple but exacting code of law, honor, hard work, and seeing all non-duergar as lesser creatures. Duergar are ruthless but not unnecessarily cruel, and pragmatism drives their every decision. Though they treat the adventurers with contempt, their first thought is to enslave them or use them rather than kill them. The duergar of Gracklstugh are beginning to suffer the effects of the arrival of the demon lords—and specifically the influence of Demogorgon. Many are developing tics, habits, and behaviors that fly against their core beliefs, including guards flaunting their corrupt behavior, the use of adornment for adornment’s sake, and disloyalty to their clans. Of late, the folk of Gracklstugh have become increasingly more violent, abandoning their characteristic cunning and stoic pragmatism for wanton malice and petty displays of self-entitlement. Unlike the disciplined duergar, the derro are sloppy, erratic, and utterly insane. Their temperament is fickle, and their speech hard to follow. The one guaranteed emotion they have when interacting with others is seething hatred, and they make no effort to hide it. Their eyes are shifty, their teeth grind, and they look as though they would rather be somewhere else. They hate everyone and everything, but surface-dwellers are particular targets of their loathing. Their inherent insanity means that the derro suffer no ill effect from the demon lords' presence, their minds already too volatile and mercurial.

made to interact with any duergar in the city until such time as the benefit no longer seems appropriate. DROW EMISSARY

A drow proudly wearing the insignia of a drow house travels with an entourage of ld4 + 1 quaggoth slaves. The drow is in Gracklstugh to retrieve a cargo of duergar metalwork and knows nothing about the recent CHAPTER 4 | GRACKLSTUGH

53

events in Velkynvelve. Roll a d6 and consult the Drow House Loyalty table to determine the house to which the drow is affiliated. DROW HOUSE LOYALTY d6

House

1-2 3-4 5-6

House House House

Baenre Faen Tlabbar Xorlarrin

House Faen Tlabbar and House Mizzrym are bitter rivals. If the drow emissary belongs to House Faen Tlabbar and the characters divulge that they are enemies or former prisoners of House Mizzrym, the drow warns the party about Xalith (see “Signs of Pursuit" later in the chapter). House Baenre and House Xorlarrin are current allies of House Mizzrym. A drow emissary allied with House Mizzrym who knows that the characters are escaped prisoners from Velkynvelve seeks out Xalith and warns her that the characters are in Gracklstugh. D U E R G A R P AT R O L

A patrol consists of ld4 + 2 duergar, all but two of whom are invisible. Invisible duergar can sneak up on a character by making a Dexterity (Stealth) check with advantage, contested by the character’s passive Wisdom (Perception) score. MAD DUERGAR

The characters encounter a duergar afflicted with a form of indefinite madness. Roll a dlO and consult the Mad Duergar table to determine what the party encounters. MAD DUERGAR dio NPC 1-2 A merchant desperate to sell his wares, convinced that his life depends on it. 3-4 A street sweeper who hounds the characters while accusing them of being spies working for the drow. 5-6 A cloaked guard who thinks he’s Deepking Horgar Steelshadow V drafts the party to help him slay Themberchaud, convinced that the dragon is possessed by a demon lord. 7-8 A merchant who accuses the characters of theft and calls out for a duergar patrol to arrest them. 9-10 A weaponsmith convinced that one of the characters is a long-lost member of her clan and who insists on giving the party food and shelter.

O RC M ERCENARIES

These ld4 + 1 ores have come to Gracklstugh as caravan guards, and see the characters as a chance to bully some surface dwellers. The ores try to goad the characters into striking iirst, then quickly stand down, knowing that a patrol (see “Duergar Patrol") will arrive 1 d6 rounds after combat starts. S LAVE C ARAVAN

The characters come across a group of ld4 + 1 duergar Cavers herding unarmed slaves (roll a dl2 and consult :he Slaves table). The slaves wear iron collars and manacles similar to the ones worn by the characters in \ clkynvelve (see “Restraints" in chapter 1). SLAVES

characters, he might take an interest in them. See “Themberchaud’s Lair" for information on the Wyrmsmith's motivations and possible setups for an additional encounter with the red dragon.

I MP ORTANT NPC S The characters might encounter one or more of the following NPCs during their stay in Gracklstugh. G R A C K L S T U G H NPC S Gorglak

Xalith Errde Blackskull

dl2 1-2 3-4

Slaves 2d4 human commoners 3d4 shield dwarf commoners

5-6 7-8 9-10 11-12

2d4 strongheart halfling commoners 3d6 goblins 2d6 grimlocks 3d6 kobolds

S TEEDER H ANDLERS

A group of ld4 + 1 duergar teamsters herd a clutch f 2d6 male steeders (see appendix C). There is a 50 percent chance that ld4 of the steeders attack nearby characters or bystanders. The duergar keep the rest of the clutch in check, but they clamor for the characters' arrest if even one of the arachnids is killed. A nearby patrol (see “Duergar Patrol") hears the teamsters'

Themberchaud

Female duergar captain of the 5tone Guard with a side quest for the party The city’s Wyrmsmith, an adult red dragon with a possible mission for the party

Gartokkar Xundorn

Male duergar Keeper of the Flame with

Ylsa Henstak

a side quest for the party Female duergar merchant with a side

Droki

Werz Saltbaron Stonespeaker Hgraam

Tam or and arrives ld6 rounds later. Narrak SECRETS OF GRACKLSTUGH

'■Vary outsiders visiting Gracklstugh quickly learn the most important details of life in the city. Unseen Sentries. The duergar power of invisibility plays a significant role in their society. The potential presence of unseen spies everywhere enforces honesty among duergar. Slaves rarely, if ever, talk or act against their masters, never snowing who might be watching. A City Divided. Not only is the layout of Gracklstugh divided, so are its people. Nearly five hundred years ago, the derro launched a Uniting War against the Deepkingdom, but were swiftly crushed, and the survivors brought back to Gracklstugh in chains. Though their status as slaves was eventually set aside, the derro have always been second-class citizens, living in squalor and scrounging food and resources, even as their leaders on the Council of Savants live in secret opulence. Frugal and Monolithic. The gray dwarves value efficiency, stoicism, and hard work, and these values are exemplified in their capital. Everything the duergar make or build has a purpose and function; the only aesthetic they value in architecture is imposing vastness, and even that is secondary to a building's structural function. The only ornamentations found in Gracklstugh are iconic ^presentations of rank and function within duergar society, and the only music is the ceaseless rhythmic nammering in the forges. The duergar consider art a •Tvolous pursuit, and only rarely appreciate or create it.

T HEM

Corrupt male duergar on duty at the gate where the characters first arrive in Gracklstugh Female drow scout charged with recapturing the characters for llvara

BERCHAUD

quest for the party Male derro courier in the employ of both the Gray Ghosts and the Council of Savants, and the subject of different possible side quests Male duergar merchant with a mission for the party Male stone giant leader with a side quest for the party Male derro savant, junior member of the Council of Savants and leader of a cult dedicated to Demogorgon

F AC T IONS

OF G R AC K LST UGH The Deepkingdom is a feudal state with the Deepking as the absolute monarch, who passes the crown to descendants or relatives in his Steelshadow clan. Each clan is led by a laird, who rules over his or her own holdings and directs the clan in dedicating its efforts toward a particular trade or craft. A caste of priests called thuldar officiate all rituals and record the Deepkingdom's lore. However, ultimate political and religious power is held by the Deepking and the lairds. D EEPKING H ORGAR S TEELSHADOW V Deepking

Horgar V ascended to the throne in 1372 DR. He is a ruthless and canny ruler who engages in secret meetings with all the city's councils and clans to keep their members guessing what he's tip to, hands out favors out of the blue, and lets it be known that

The adult red dragon is out on his regular rounds, keeping the city’s forges aflame. Themberchaud has long been keeping his eye out for mercenaries in the city that could be bent to his service. If he spots the CHAPTER 4 | GRACKLSTUGH

54

he’ll use any trick to maintain his hold on power. This includes hiring assassins through third parties to take care of potential troublemakers (see “Empty-Scabbard Killers,” below). This strategy keeps all the city’s factions at each other's throats and out of Horgar’s way. COUNCIL OF LAIRDS

This advisory body represents the interests of the different clans that have pledged allegiance to the Deepking. The lairds hold council to resolve disputes and discuss future plans. Each clan has its own holdings in Gracklstugh and specializes in a certain craft or service. DUERGAR CLANS

Smithing

Clan Steelshadow (weaponsmiths), Clan Ironhead (weaponsmiths), CianThrazgad (armorsmiths), Clan Firehand (smelters), Clan Anvilthew (toolmakers) M e r c a n t i l e Clan Thuldark (metalworks and jewels), Clan Henstak (food). Clan Muzgardt (brewers) Mining Clan Coalhewer (coal miners), Clan Xardelvar (gas miners), Clan Saltbaron (salt miners) Other Clan Parlynsurk (clothing manufacturers), Clan Hammercane (construction engineers), Clan Xundom (steeder breeders). Clan Burakrinwurn (dock operators), Clan Xornbane (scouts and prospectors), Clan Blackskuli (stonemasons), Clan Bukbukken (farming), Clan Thordensonn (jewelers)

COUNCIL OF SAVANTS

The Council of Savants is a circle of derro savants who enjoy all the privileges and trappings of a governing body while the rest of their people live in squalor. Only the best thirty-six savants are admitted into the council, and succession almost always includes an incumbent member's demise. The savants control members of some duergar clans through magic and guile, and are always looking for ways to expand their influence. M ERCHANT C OUNCIL

The lairds and merchants who sit at this council make sure that trade and commerce flow smoothly. They employ slave labor to maintain trade routes in the dangerous Underdark, and are always open to hiring explorers to check out leads on potential new routes. Expendable outsiders hired as caravan guards always take point and receive little aid or support from the caravan masters. Despite these unfair assignments, the duergar always live up to their bargains, paying survivors as promised. G RACKLSTUGH M ILITARY

In addition to the clans' regular armies, Gracklstugh trains specialized warriors whose oaths of service always supersede their original loyalties. See appendix C for more information. Stone Guard. This force of five hundred veteran warriors serves the Deepking as bodyguards, elite troops, and secret police. Darkhafts. Members of the Deepking’s secret corps of psionic agents, the darkhafts often travel with duergar merchants as overseers and spies. Kavalrachni, The vicious kavalrachni ride giant tarantulas known as steeders (see appendix C). Most kavalrachni come from Clan Xundom. Xarrorn. These specialists train with deadly flame lances forged in Gracklstugh. Most xarrorn come from Clan Xardelvar. GRACKLE-LUNG

D U ERG AR

The constant smog in Gracklstugh causes grackle-lung in living, breathing creatures, resulting in persistent, wracking coughs and the spewing of thick, black phlegm. Whenever a living, breathing creature finishes a long rest in Gracklstugh, it must make a DC 11 Constitution saving throw. On each failed save, the creature gains one level of exhaustion as its airways become increasingly clogged. A creature that reaches level 6 exhaustion dies, as normal. A creature with one or more levels of exhaustion brought on by grackle-lung must succeed on a Constitution check to take the Dash action. If the check fails, the action cannot be attempted. If the creature attempts to cast a spell with a verbal component, it must succeed on a Constitution check or be unable to complete the spell, causing the spell to fail with no effect. The DC for each check is 10 + the creature’s current exhaustion level. If a creature’s exhaustion level drops below 1, it no longer suffers the effects of grackle-lung and becomes immune to it for the next week. Duergar and derro are inured to grackle-lung, making Constitution checks against it with advantage. Any spell or effect that cures disease also cures grackle-lung, effectively removing all levels of exhaustion brought on by the affliction.

CHAPTER t I GRACKLSTUGH

55

Despite reports that the darkhafts and the Stone Guards have received about the growing crisis outside tite city’s walls, hubris and the onset of madness prevents them from mounting any sort of response or campaign, blind to the corruption that festers around them. C LAN C AIRNGORM

The stone giants of Clan Cairngorm lead quiet lives fart and contemplation in Gracklstugh. Although reclusive and averse to conllict, the giants have sworn an ancient oath of loyalty to the Deepking, and have been serving his line for as long as any can remember. This oath, however, was given only to the Steelshadow lan. If the throne passes to another dynasty, the stone Gants will cease to be the city’s allies. The leader of the stone giants is Slonespeaker Hgraam. a priest of Skoraeus Stonebones, the god of his people. Hgraam is wise and knowledgeable, lie has sensed that some great evil has broken into the L nderdark, but isn't aware of the threat's danger or extent. The giants will rise to defend Gracklstugh if any demons dare to invade, but they are unaware of the danger creeping into the city from within. K EEPERS

OF THE

F LAME

This order of psionic clerics tends to Themberchaud's needs, enjoying great influence and helping Horgar V stay ahead of the machinations of the Council of Savants. The Keepers of the Flame are currently distracted by their ongoing vendetta against the Gray Ghosts, who recently stole a valuable dragon egg that would have hatched Themberchaud’s eventual successor. ■ duplicating matters, Themberchaud himself is growing stronger and more resistant to the clerics' oaxing, appeasement, and psionic manipulation. THE W YRMSMITH This adult red dragon keeps the city's smelters and forges ablaze, receiving treasure, free meals, and constant pampering in exchange. Themberchaud doesn't know that, like other Wyrmsmiths before him. he is doomed to be slain before he grows too strong, replaced by a new red hatchling. However, the line of succession was interrupted when the Gray Ghosts stole a red dragon egg from the Keepers of the Flame. The Wyrmsmith is beginning to chafe under the Keepers’ control. He now wonders why he is content with a mere trickle of gold and a paltry handful of slaves, when he could simply force the entire city to bend knee to him and give him everything he desires. For now, his actions are limited by how little he cares about the duergar and how much the Keepers speak "on his behalf." But he has begun taking an interest in the affairs of Gracklstugh and the opportunity to recruit new servants from outside the Keepers of the Flame, using his outings to rekindle forges and smelters as a means to keep an eye out for promising subjects.

T HEMBERCHAUD

T H E D O W N WAR D S P I R A L

The madness of the demon lords has not reached Gracklstugh in full, but it already has a foothold through the

work of the derro and their savants. A splinter group ofthe Council of Savants began worshiping Demogorgon even before the current crisis, and their foul rituals accelerated the spread of madness in the city. To make things worse, the divided nature ofthe city, both geographically and socially, resonates strongly with the dual aspect of Demogorgon. The derro cultists plan to offer the entire city to their newly arrived master. Many duergar NPCs the characters interact with are showing the first signs of infection. Though their madness has not yet overwhelmed them, it manifests in behavior such as Errde Blackskull’s conspiracy theories, Gorglak's corruption, and Gartokkar Xundorn’s paranoia. GRAY GHOSTS

The Gray Ghosts are the only true thieves' guild in Gracklstugh and the Deepkingdom. Its members are duergar and derro outcasts, plus the odd escaped slave. The Keepers of the Flame caught and executed the Gray Ghosts' previous leader, who stole their red dragon egg but never revealed its whereabouts. The relentless vendetta forced the thieves into hiding and restricted their activities, but they persevere thanks to the three renegade derro savants who are their current leaders: Uskvil and the twin sisters Aliinka and Zubriska. E MPTY -S CABBARD K ILLERS The Farak-Erach-Naek (“Empty-Scabbard Killers" in

Common) are a folktale in Gracklstugh, their name derived from an ancient, obscure Dwarvish dialect. They are an order of psionic assassins practicing disciplines unknown to even the savviest derro or the wisest priest. More than a myth, these killers have been plying their trade for centuries, their motives unknown and their methods inscrutable. The Empty-Scabbard Killers are duergar soulblades (see appendix C) who roam the streets of Gracklstugh searching for psionically gifted children to abduct and train. They also keep an eye out Tor worthy calassabrak (see below), offering them a chance to join a new community from which they can strike back at those who cast them out.

L I FE

IN T HE C IT Y O F B LADE S The duergar are called gray dwarves not only because of the color of their skin, but also because of their drab and joyless lifestyle. While they make no time for merriment, the duergar have a culture as rich and complex as any other, and nowhere is this so evident as in Gracklstugh. Work never stops in the City of Blades, and the gray dwarves take pride in efficiency and perfection even as they abhor waste and carelessness. They are merciless masters to the derro and slaves who toil and suffer under them. S TRICT H IERARCHY

By appearance and bearing, all duergar know their place and where they belong. Whether as individuals, families, or entire clans, duergar below other duergar in the social order don’t seek to bring their rivals down

through intrigue and deceit. Rather, they roll up their sleeves and work harder to increase their prestige through the fruits of their labor. All the honor and honesty the duergar apply among themselves doesn't apply to outsiders. The gray dwarves constantly try to manipulate contracts to take advantage of foreign merchants, looking for any excuse to enslave random visitors who appear weak or vulnerableincluding adventurers. Though they aren't moved by vanity, duergar are extremely proud of their work, and praising the quality of duergar crafting can sometimes help outsiders in their dealings with the gray dwarves. S UBSISTENCE

Duergar clans use caverns under Gracklstugh and choice outlying caves to farm a variety of plants and fungi. These crops are complemented by meat from Underdark beasts and fish from the Darklake. Not even the duergar risk drinking water from the Darklake, however, and with clean streams in short supply, the people of Gracklstugh cover this scarcity with Darklake Stout, the signature ale brewed by the Muzgardt clan. O UTCASTS The bottom rung in Gracklstugh society is mostly occupied by the underclass of the derro. Enslaved by the duergar centuries ago, then freed, the derro aren’t allowed to hold honest jobs, and their rights are hardly ever recognized by the duergar. Even slaves are held in higher regard. Derro scuttle about like vermin and are mostly confined to hovels built along the walls of Laduguer’s Furrow in the West Cleft District and East Cleft District. Another kind of outcasts are those duergar who dishonor their clans so grievously they are stripped of all but their lives: the calassabrak, meaning "the flawed who aren’t to be trusted" in Dwarvish. They are shunned by other duergar, many eventually taking their lives rather than face an existence apart from family and clan. Those who live on become bitter and tough, with many leaving Gracklstugh as hermits or adventurers, or turning to crime and a life in the shadows. Members of both the Gray Ghosts and the Empty-Scabbard Killers include a significant number of calassabrak, no longer bound by oath, honor, and duty. R ELIGION Duergar don’t pray, but their religion is tightly woven into their everyday life. Deities worshiped in Gracklstugh include the following. Laduguer. The patron of the duergar is a god of selfreliance, defense, and survival. His clerics have access to the War domain. Deep Duerra. Laduguer’s mortal daughter who then ascended. Deep Duerra is the goddess of cooperation and dominance. War is her domain as well. Diirinka. The patron of the derro betrayed his twin brother Diinkarazan to escape with the secrets of magic. He embodies cruelty, insanity, and cleverness. His clerics have access to the Trickery domain. S6

CHAPTER A I GRACKLSTUGH

Skoraeus Stonebones. Stone giants revere the King of the Rock, god of buried things, whose clerics can access the Knowledge and Life domains. Stonespeaker Hgraam, a powerful spellcaster, is Skoraeus’s only priest in Gracklstugh. L AW

AND

O RDER

Minor crime is relatively rare in Gracklstugh. The duergar live by a strict code of honor, and their laws are few, simple, and practical. Both guards and regular citizens can be invisible and watching, which keeps any potential criminals and dissenters uncertain and fearful. A laird may punish any member of his or her clan who commits a crime, but offenses between clans are immediately brought before the Gouncil of Lairds, which resolves matters swiftly and harshly. The code of punishment is simple. Because dishonor, mutilation and imprisonment are. a waste of resources and create weakness in society, a duergar who intentionally commits any crime receives a death sentence. Accidental crime by a duergar is compensated by goods or work equivalent to the damages. Derro, slaves or outsiders caught committing any crime can be executed on the spot by any duergar present.

G RACKLSTUGH Population: 10,000 duergar, 2,000 derro, 50 stone giants, and an unknown number of slaves (quaggoths, grimlocks, ores, shield dwarves, svirfneblin, and a few koboldsand goblinoids) Government: Absolute monarchy Defense: Large standing army with specialized corps; every duergar is trained for battle, and the citizens of the city create a formidable militia Commerce: Weapons and armor of high quality; various fungi, molds, and exotic creatures for food: trade from across the Underdark and the surface world Organizations: The Council of Lairds, the Council of Savants, the Merchant Council, the Keepers of the Flame. Clan Cairngorm, the Gray Ghosts, and others The cavern housing Gracklstugh is split in two by a rift called Laduguer’s Furrow, after the duergar patron god. The north half comprises North furrow District, where common workers and the dans devoted to minor crafts make their home, and Darklake District, open to foreigners and where the city's merchants engage in trade with visitors. As befits a major settlement in a dangerous realm, Gracklstugh places no restrictions on the weapons or gear characters can carry or trade. Twelve stone bridges lead to Southfurrow District, and then farther south to Flowstone District. These boroughs are reserved for the more prestigious clans and the largest smelters and forges Themberchaud ignites during his flights. The Wyrmsmith’s lair and the cavern complex the stone giants of Cairngorm Clan call home both connect to these districts.

'." ELCOME

TO THE C ITY OF B LADES -tering the city is the first major hurdle the characters iust surmount in Gracklstugh, Unless they heed -ppido’s advice to arrive byway of the Darklake (or me up with the idea on their own), the characters raeh one of the gates. (See “Arriving in Gracklstugh" ariier in this chapter.) ~ ITY G ATES I -- pragmatic

nature of the duergar means that all Sracklstugh’s entrance gates are similar in design, for rise of maintenance and the training of guards. -

-e ground at your feet has been getting smoother and

•‘;rter. a welcome respite from the uneven passages to *ich you have grown wearily accustomed. Eventually, ::one tiles become more noticeable, turning the path -to a proper road. You can see spots of light in the P stance, blue-white and too regularly placed to be r^ospborescent mushrooms. ^he lights are proper lamps flanking two massive stone rates blocking the tunnel. Before you get a chance to e*amine the intricate carvings on the gates’ surface, a -arsh voice hisses from a slit on the cavern wall that was -a! there before.

"State your names and business!" the voice orders in Dwarvish. Other similar slits open, revealing the tips of a dozen crossbow bolts. Behind you, a metallic din announces a group of six heavily armored dwarves appearing out of thin air, their swords leveled at you from behind sturdy metal shields.

When the characters first reached the road, six duergar watching invisibly started following them at a safe distance. Twelve more duergar soldiers are stationed in guardhouses concealed within the rocky walls of the cavern, all of them aiming heavy crossbows at the party. The duergar arc hostile, and the guard who spoke follows up on every answer the characters give. One character can take the lead in the interrogation by speaking for the party and making a DC 15 Charisma check (Deception anti Persuasion apply; Intimidation or Performance are met with scorn). Depending on how believable the party’s story is and how the other adventurers behave during the questioning, you might allow the character to make the check with advantage or impose disadvantage. The guard grudgingly lets the characters pass if the check succeeds, and refuses them entrance if it fails. If the check fails by 5 or more, the guard gives the order to arrest the characters, announcing that they are now

CHAPTER 4 | GRACKLSTUGH

57

slaves of the duergar (see “Getting Captured’’ below).

CHAPTER 4 | GRACKLSTUGH

58

The first time the characters are allowed inside the city or turned away from a gate, a secret door on the wall opens, revealing Gorglak, a duergar Stone Guard (see appendix C). “Wei!" The duergar removes bis heimet, revealing the gray skin of his kind. He musses his white beard as he walks closer, switching to Common as he lowers his voice. There is a discomfiting glint in his eyes and his smile. "You are clearly lying. I ought to just send you to the slave pens, but... you amuse me. What do you have that is worth your freedom?" The duergar waits for your answer, his gaze touching on each of you in turn as He smiles in anticipation.

If they are with the party, Topsy and Turvy. Sarilh Kzekarit,Jimjar, and Buppido can whisper to the characters that few duergar are so blatantly corrupt as Gorglak seems to be, A successful DC 12 Wisdom (Insight) check lets a character notice that Gorglak is eying the adventurers' weapons (especially any drow

weapons or magic weapons they might have), and that there's something odd about his behavior. The madness creeping into Gracklstugh has made Gorglak obsessed with rare weapons. He's willing to go to great extents to acquire new weapons of exquisite design for his growing collection. Offering Gorglak a worthy weapon for his collection gets the characters through the gate. Any other bribe requires one of the characters to succeed on a DC 13 Charisma (Persuasion) check, or Gorglak is insulted and has the party arrested. Tf the characters are too open about the negotiation, Gorglak has them arrested and pretends he didn’t say anything. If Gorglak finds the characters' bribe appealing, he refuses to accept it then and there, instead directing them to find one Werz Saltbaron in the Darklake Docks and hand the bribe to him. Gorglak tells the characters that he will check with Werz at the end of his shift, and will find the characters and arrest them if they have not paid by then. Characters allowed through the gate are escorted to the Darklake District by four duergar guards, two of whom are invisible. Once the party reaches the edge of the district, the guards leave and return to the posts. CHAPTER 4 I CRACKI.STUGH

59

D ARKLAKE D OCKS

Arriving at the Darklake Docks requires a combination of skill, ingenuity, and luck. Vigilance is a little more relaxed here because the guards at Overtake Hold can spot any obvious threat coming from the waters. •

law to this part of the city. A wave of heat slams against you as an acrid smog rises to choke the air out of your lungs. The Darklake spreads out beyond a jumble of buildings and streets, reflecting the lights

1

After hours of tense navigation, you glimpse an orange I glow in the distance. Soon you hear faint metallic echoes, growing louder as you come closer. Firelight illuminates massive columns with structures built

of countless fires burning across the city within hollowed-out columns and stalagmites. Though the streets are crowded, you move easily within the surging throng of buyers, merchants, and slaves. You aren’t

around their bases. The cold air of the Underdark is becoming

the only outsiders here, as you spy draw, svirfneblin, derro,

warmer even at this distance, and you can now see a variety of

ores, and other races in the crowds. The shouting of people

piers made from zurkhwood, stone, and plain rock jutting out

blends with the sound of distant hammering to create a

along the edge of a huge cavern.

constant, distracting din.

As the characters draw closer, they can see that the eastern docks are the least crowded. If Buppido is with them, he guides them to a natural rock pier on the eastern edge of the cavern. Otherwise, the characters must make a successful DC 14 group Dexterity (Stealth) check or a DC 15 group Wisdom (Survival) check to guide their boat safely and inconspicuously to an empty dock. If the group check fails, nearby guards notice the •-'naracters but don’t immediately identify them as a threat. However, you can choose to impose disadvantage on any checks the characters make to remain inconspicuous during their first day in Gracklstugh. G ETTING C APTURED

Even after making it inside the city, the characters must tread carefully, as the duergar use the slightest pretext to arrest them. Even trying to haggle with a duergar merchant might inspire a call for the guards to take the characters away. Getting caught stealing is punishable fc\ death on the spot, but guards or the offended party might see some value in enslaving the culprits instead, so the characters can be shackled and shipped beyond the Darklake District. Resisting arrest is a truly bad idea: every duergar around is reinforcement. If the characters get arrested, you can interrupt their transfer with a random encounter or lead them to other planned encounters. The “Rampaging Giant” encounter which takes place in the Darklake District) is the most likely event to interrupt a prisoner transfer. Alternatively, an agent of the Keepers of the Flame can stop the guards before they take the characters to Overtake Hold (see ‘Themberchaud's Lair” for information regarding the keepers' interest in foreign mercenaries). Possible offers of employment in the Blade Bazaar can also be turned into timely rescues for the adventurers. Otherwise, they end up in Overlake Hold, interrogated by Emle Blackskull.

D ARKLAKE D ISTRICT

The Darklake District gives an illusion of openness. The streets are relatively wide to allow for merchant carts and wagons to pass, and the buildings aren’t as crowded around stalagmites as in the southern districts. Openness doesn't mean welcoming, however. The duergar who ply their trades here are wary of all the foreigners confined by

Behind the forbidding walls separating the Darklake District from the rest of the city stand the docks, markets, and shops where Gracklstugh's commerce and trade are conducted. The many duergar merchants— along with drow, svirfneblin, ores, and others—pay little attention to the characters unless they are looking to do business. Guards posted at the gates make it clear to the characters that non-duergar are restricted to the Darklake District, and the characters have better luck asking other outsiders for directions rather than trying to engage the duergar locals. They are directed to the Blade Bazaar if they wish to sell anything they might be carrying with them. For gossip and a meal, the Shattered Spire tavern is recommended, while lodging for non-duergar can be had at the Ghohlbrorn's Lair inn. At any point during which the characters move from point to point in the Darklake District, they can witness one or more of the following events. R A M PAG I N G G I A N T This encounter triggers possible side quests through which the characters can learn about the influence of Demogorgon in Gracklstugh. You can use this event any time during the party's stay in the city. Holding it for later use gives characters a chance to notice the little things wrong among the duergar, while using it right away can help characters avoid being enslaved if they are arrested at any point during their visit. The rhythmic hammering of the city's forges is drowned for a second by a thundering roar and the sound of crumbling rock. Duergar and visitors alike turn to look as a two-headed, grayskinned giant bursts through a gate, howling madly and lashing out left and right, littering the plaza with rock and stone debris. As he bellows, one of his swings connects with a duergar soldier, whose broken body flies through the air and crashes near you with a sickening crunch.

A stone giant from Cairngorm Cavern has succumbed to a demonic curse that has caused him to grow a disfigured second head. A successful DC 12 Wisdom (Insight) check reveals that the giant is crazed and terrified. Use the stone giant stat block with the following modifications: • The giant has advantage on Wisdom (Perception) checks and on saving throws against being blinded, charmed, deafened, frightened, stunned, or knocked unconscious. • The giant is unarmed. As an action, it can make two unarmed strikes (+9 to hit, reach 10 ft., one target). On a hit, the giant deals 13 (2d6 + 6) bludgeoning damage. The rampage happens in a broad plaza, so there is plenty of space for the different combatants to maneuver. The giant moves in the characters' direction and lashes out. Two duergar guards and two duergar xarrorn (see appendix C) respond to the giant's roaring, racing in to join the fight in the second round. They are well trained and do their best to help, but to avoid additional complexity during the encounter, assume that the duergar act at the end of the initiative order and deal a flat total of 10 damage to the giant each round. Bystanders take cover at once, but duergar citizens are ready to jump in if the guards fail to contain the threat. The giant ignores characters attacking from range and attacks opponents in melee at random, including the duergar. Both the giant and the guards fight until they drop to 0 hit points. D EVELOPMENT

Without the characters’ help, the guards and assisting citizens bring down the stone giant with few casualties. If the characters are prisoners under escort when the giant attacks, the guards who engage the giant are their escort. The characters can use this chance to escape, or they can help, albeit with disadvantage on attack rolls if they are shackled. The duergar arc pragmatists and release characters who help them deal with the giant’s threat, but they attempt to arrest them again after the combat is over. Once the crazed giant is put down, another stone giant comes through the shattered gate, but this one looks perfectly sane. He reaches the fallen giant at the same time as a squad of three duergar Stone Guards (see appendix C). The guards who fought alongside the characters explain the situation, neither downplaying nor exalting the characters’ actions. The characters can speak to the newly arrived giant while the duergar confer. The giant introduces himself as Dorhun, apprentice to Stonespeaker Hgraam. He reveals that the fallen giant's name is Rihuud. and that he was another of the Stonespcaker’s apprentices. Rihuud was “communing with the stone” in Cairngorm Cavern when he went mad, sprouted a second head, and stormed out. If the party was not previously arrested and didn't participate in the fight, the Stone Guards start questioning bystanders, who eventually point out the characters as new arrivals to the city.

6o

CHAPTER 4 1 GRACKLSTUGH

If the characters knocked Rihuud unconscious instead of dealing a lethal blow, a grateful Dorhun asks them to visit Cairngorm Cavern before they leave the city, informing the Stone Guards of this. The importance of the Stonespeaker means that the Stone Guards will escort the party across the city to meet with him, though they don't hide their displeasure at doing so.

XP A WARDS Divide 1,740 XP equally among the characters if they cooperate with the guards to defeat the two-headed stone giant.

G UESTS

OF THE S TONE G UARD Whenever circumstances see the Stone Guards develop an interest in the party (including being arrested or witnessing the giant's rampage without taking part), the characters are ordered to follow a squad of duergar to Overlake Hold for further questioning. From this point, the adventure can take different paths depending on how you want to proceed. Talk to the players about their preference, or decide on your own what happens next: • Gartokkar Xundorn intervenes on behalf of the Keepers of the Flame, which can lead to a meeting with Themberchaud (see “Themberchaud's Lair"). • The characters can continue to Overlake Hold and meet with Captain Errde Blackskull (see “Overlake Hold"). • The drow scout Xalith approaches the Stone Guards, claiming the characters as escaped properly other mistress, Ilvara (see “Signs of Pursuit" in the “Blade Bazaar” section). The Stone Guards arrest the characters and take them to Overlake Hold, pending negotiations with the drow. At this point, they also meet Captain Errde Blackskull. • Droki (see “Droki” in the “Blade Bazaar” section) accidentally bumps into the patrol, creating a distraction that allows the characters to escape. • A successful DC 15 Charisma (Persuasion) check convinces the Slone Guards not to arrest the characters, provided the characters agree to visit Overlake Hold once their business in Gracklstugh is concluded. The party remains under watch at all times by an invisible duergar Stone Guard (sec appendix C). If it seems like the characters have done what they came to do, the invisible duergar reminds them to make good on their promise to visit Overlake Hold.

B LADE B AZAAR

This marketplace is named after the most abundant goods the duergar offer, but the shops here sell almost everything available in the city, along with stalls set up by visiting merchants. The din of people arguing, mostly in Dwarvish, nearly drowns out the hammering coming from the city’s forges, and the crowds here offer a good chance to slip away from pursuers. Characters can unload some of the treasures they might be carrying. Nonmagical weapons, armor, and shields can be purchased in the Blade Bazaar.

MERCHANT MADNESS

Characters who look around the bazaar notice a number f odd things: • A duergar merchant can't stop insulting customers when they are trying to sell something, but becomes a picture of politeness when they want to buy. • A number of duergar merchants give different prices to buy or sell every time they are asked about the same items, and insist that the characters dealing with them are the ones changing their terms. • \ duergar merchant suddenly turns invisible in the middle of a transaction, but keeps speaking as if nothing has happened. • A duergar merchant threatens to kill the characters as a haggling technique, then denies ever saying so. • A duergar merchant constantly asks the opinion of a nonexistent twin brother, claiming that he is invisible. Y LSA ’ S D EAL

Visa Henstak is a female duergar member of the Merchant Council, She’s a canny caravan master and prides herself on always arriving at her destination = head of schedule. If the characters ask around for merchants who know how to reach the surface, they are directed to Ylsa. Thougti she has no caravans scheduled anytime soon, she does make the characters an offer. Ylsa invites the characters into her well-guarded : 'Tice, where she shows them a pile of coins and jewelry from all over the surface world. The hoard consists of - gp in mixed coinage, three gold rings worth 25 gp ■mch, and two gem-inlaid necklaces worth 250 gp each. | She has tracked the pieces to derro, who use them to pay for food. If the characters can figure out how the rerro are getting surface currency and jewelry, Ylsa will provide the adventurers with directions for at least the aext stage of their journey, including valuable advice , an routes to Biingdenstone (sec chapter 6) and the Aormwrithings (see chapter 12).

I Yartokkar Xundorn (see “Themberchaud’s Lair”), but p sf the characters pursue the courier openly, he flees for me West Cleft District. Pursuing characters quickly lose I sight of the derro as he vanishes into the crowd. See 'Ending Droki” in the “Whorlstone Tunnels" section

D ROKI

Attentive characters can spot a curious figure darting between the stalls and shops of the Blade Bazaar. Every time they roam the market, they have a 20 percent chance to see a derro dressed in rags styled as an mutation of a fancy jacket, wearing a wide-brimmed hat with two tentacles from a displacer beast sewn into the bat town. A large satchel hangs from his shoulder, and he’s always muttering to himself. Duergar merchants glare scornfully at this derro, and aone will discuss him with the characters. If a character asks about him in the Ghohlbrorn's Lair, a successful [ DC 12 Charisma (Persuasion) check yields up the name "Droki” and identifies the wily derro as a courier and -cypher of goods who works for disreputable employers. Z atching Droki (see appendix C) is the objective of guests from Errde Blackskull (see “Overtake Hold’’) and

CHAPTER 4 I GRACKLSTUGH

6i

for more information on what Droki is carrying if the characters catch him. S IGNS OF P URSUIT If I he characters arrive in Gracklstugh with a drow pursuit level of 3 or higher (see “Drow Pursuit” in chapter 2), llvara has already sent a party ahead of them, guessing correctly that the escaped prisoners might seek refuge with the duergar. Characters with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 15 or higher spot six drow watching them in the Blade Bazaar. One of them is Xalith Masq'il’yr, a female drow allied with House Mizzrym. Any of the party’s NPC companions who know the duergar well can guess that these drow won't want to attract the duergar's attention to their “lost property." Doing so would likely involve having to pay the gray dwarves a reward for the adventurers’ capture. This gives the characters a chance to evade their pursuers, but they need to stay out of sight. Xalith speaks to the duergar only if the characters are arrested. Otherwise, she sends a messenger to llvara and makes sure the characters don’t go anywhere without her knowing. If the characters fail to lose themselves in the city (see “Gracklstugh and Drow

CHAPTER 4 I GRACKLSTUGH

6i

BUPPIDO’S ESCAPE

Buppido has a secret agenda in Gracklstugh. If he is still with the party, the derro looks for the first opportunity to slip away and return to his hidden lair and “shrine” in the Whorlstone Tunnels (see “Whorlstone Tunnels").

Pursuit" earlier in this chapter), their pursuit level increases by 1 every ld4 days until llvara arrives. Alternatively, the adventurers might decide to turn the tables on the drow. Characters might figure out a way to quietly neutralize Xalith and her squad, perhaps tricking them into damaging a duergar merchant’s property or forcing them outside Darklake District, where even drow are forbidden to go. Doing so decreases the pursuit level by 2. However, if combat ever breaks out between the characters and the drow, a squad of five duergar Stone Guards (see appendix C) and five duergar warriors arrive within ld4 rounds and arrest the lot of them (see “Getting Captured"). DARKLAKE BREWERY

This huge, ramshackle brewery is built of stone blocks stacked to make walls between the petrified stems of a small forest of gigantic mushrooms. Big copper vats steam within, filling the air with a heavy, yeasty stink. Dozens of copper kegs stand nearby, and burly gray dwarves swarm over the place, mashing fungus, mixing fermenting masses, and filling casks with freshly brewed ale. This complex is the workplace and home of Clan Muzgardt, the duergar clan in charge of brewing Darklake Stout and in control of the brewing and importation of other spirits. Non-duergar aren't welcome inside the brewery. DARKLAKE DOCKS

These busy docks are used primarily by flat-bottomed rafts made of zurkhwood and lacquered puffball floats. Some of these ramshackle barges come with oars or paddle wheels. The rafts look ungainly, but each can carry tons of trade goods. The characters land at the easternmost inlet if they arrive at Gracklstugh by way of the Darklake, near the Ghohlbrorn's Lair inn. If they instead arrived through a gate and successfully bribed Gorglak. they might come here looking for his contact, Werz Saltbaron. A SSASSINS I NTERRUPTED

The characters spot a male duergar merchant at the end of a pier. Suddenly, two invisible duergar appear next to him and stab him viciously with glowing swords. The assassins’ faces are masked and hooded. The characters have 2 rounds to distract the two duergar soulblades (see appendix C) before they finish off the merchant. The merchant is Werz Saltbaron. If the characters save him, he is grudgingly grateful and says he has no idea why the assassins targeted him. A successful DC 12 Wisdom (Insight) check suggests he’s lying. He flees the scene, but not before telling the characters to meet him at the Shattered Spire the following day so he can

CHAPTER 4 | GRACKLSTUGH

62

reward them properly. The characters have 1 minute to search the assassins before a patrol of four duergar arrives. The glowing weapons wielded by the assassins are nowhere to be found, but one of the assassins has a piece of fish-skin parchment bearing Werz’s likeness drawn in charcoal. A CCESS

TO THE

W HORLSTONE T UNNELS

Hidden next to the easternmost pier, a disabled drainage pipe is the Gray Ghosts’ access point to a secret cavern system beneath Gracklstugh (see “Whorlstone Tunnels”). It takes a successful DC 15 Wisdom (Perception) check to notice the pipe beneath piles of refuse. Within, loose bars block the 5-foot-wide passage, but removing them activates an alarm that warns the Gray Ghosts inside the caverns. A character can notice the alarm's trigger—a thin wire connected to the top of one of the bars with a successful DC 14 Wisdom (Perception) check, and can disable it with a successful DC 12 Dexterity check using thieves’ tools. Nearly 100 feet into the pipe, a hatch on the floor opens into a rough-hewn well. A ladder extends down 80 feet to another hatch on the floor, which leads to area 8 in the Whorlstone Tunnels. OVERLAKE HOLD Dunglorrin Torunc, which translates as Overtake Hold, is

a fortress and temple dedicated to Laduguer carved into the heart of a massive stalagmite on the shore of the Darklake. It is also the home of the Deepking and the center of government. Dunglorrin Torune bristles with forge chimneys from which smoke billows and ledges from which catapults can hurl stones at waterborne invaders. (If necessary, use the mangonel statistics in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide.) C ONSCRIPTED

BY THE

S TONE G UARD

If the characters are arrested, they are taken to the hold’s dungeons, where they receive a chance to earn their freedom by serving the Stone Guard. After waiting a long while in a dungeon cell carved out of impressively thick stone, you are taken to a dark office and met by an imposing female gray dwarf. She is fully armored and bears an insignia you have not seen on any other duergar. She is flanked by two Stone Guards who remain by the door. “I am Captain Errde Blackskull, commander of the Stone Guard,” she says, giving each of you a calculating look. “Let me start by saying you are worth nothing here in Gracklstugh. Most of those in my command would sell you off in a heartbeat as the cheapest manual labor. However, I've learned to make much better use of adventurers like you.”

Search for Droki. Errdc explains that her guards have been tracking the movements of a derro named Droki. Despite his presence in the Darklake District, the derro has managed to avoid capture, as if he somehow knows in advance where the duergar patrols will be invisible or otherwise. All the Stone Guards know is that Droki lives in the West Cleft District, a place the duergar enter only in force and where their presence would likely provoke a chaotic uprising. Errde wants the characters to follow Droki, see what he does and where he goes, and report back. Or if they see an opportunity, seize him and either bring him in for questioning, or kill him and bring back evidence of his activities. Errde’s tone turns dark as she voices her suspicions that Droki is linked to a conspiracy involving the Council of Savants, and maybe even elements among the clan lairds. She describes in detail how discovering the conspiracy and purging the corrupt will earn her great favor with the Deepking. Errdc swears (truthfully) that she will arrange for the characters to get safe passage out of Gracklstugh if they do as she asks. Search for Corruption. Errdc’s suspicions of conspiracy have her looking for signs of corruption creeping among the people of Gracklstugh. She rewards the characters if they bring her evidence of such corruption that has escaped the eyes of her warriors. The characters can build a case if they witness odd events throughout Gracklstugh, such as some of the random encounters and the behavior of merchants in the Blade Bazaar. For every three such events they -“port, the characters can attempt a DC 15 group Charisma (Persuasion) check, but they only need to succeed once to convince Errde and complete this quest. Errde then promises to outfit the characters with supplies and gear when they leave Gracklstugh, from the Stone Guards' own armory. Each character can -li;m a total of 350 gp worth of equipment, including weapons, armor, and common potions and scrolls. D EVELOPMENT

If *he characters refuse Errde’s offer after being j-rested, they spend a few days imprisoned and then ire sold back to the drow. Xalith and her squad meet op with Ilvara and then return to Velkynvelve. if the characters can’t manage to escape from their captors. If the characters accept Errde's offer, she gives them insignias allowing them to move as far south as Lsdugucr's Furrow without being accosted by guards. The *f%enturcrs need only to show the insignias discreetly when confronted, and should keep them hidden otherwise. They are then released without fanfare. Errdc knows about the stone giants’ invitation if the characters spared the twoheaded giant’s life, and advises the characters to heed it before looking for Droki. The characters' pursuit level is reduced to 0 and remains so while they are in Errde’s employ inside Gracklstugh. If they end their employment, the Stone Guards stop covering for them and their pursuit level

iorreases as normal if Xalith is in town (see “Signs of Pursuit" in the “Blade Bazaar" section). Otherwise, it remains at 0 until some other action raises it again. FLASHING BADGES

Working for either the Stone Guard or the Keepers of the Flame grants characters a degree of freedom in Gracklstugh, as they can show the insignia given to them by each faction if they are detained. At least one character in the party must succeed on a DC 14 Charisma (Persuasion) check to convince duergar not to detain the party any longer, but characters who show the insignia have advantage on the check.

T H E S H ATT E R E D S P I R E

A broken stalagmite juts out from the Darklake about forty feet from the shore, forming the foundation of a tavern built with fungi stalks in a manner similar to a log cabin. A bridge woven of rothe wool allows patrons to cross the water to visit. M EETING W ERZ

If the characters rescued Werz Saltbaron from the assassins (see “Darklake Docks"), he meets them at the Shattered Spire at the designated date and time. As modest thanks for saving him, he gives each character an obsidian gemstone worth 10 gp. He then offers them a job. delivering a sack full of raw gemstones (worth 100 gp total) to a svirfneblin named Kazook Pickshine in Blingdenstone, no questions asked. Jimjar, Topsy, and Turvy know of Kazook Pickshine and can provide basic information about the gnome alchemist (see chapter 6). The deep gnomes also recognize that Wcrz’s gems resemble empty spell gems. similar to those used in the defense of Blingdenstone. The gems, mundane in their current form, are actually raw stones used in the crafting of spell gems. Werz met Kazook in Mantol-Derith (see chapter 9), and the two have been trading recently behind their superiors’ backs. He declines to mention this, though, deflecting any questions by mentioning that Blingdenstone is a good place to find a way out of the Underdark. B AR F IGHT

While the characters are in the tavern, two duergar who had been just talking business suddenly fly into a rage and start brawling. If the characters don't intervene to stop the fight, other patrons do. No guards appear unless weapons or spells come out. and the fight stops as soon as any of the brawlers is restrained or knocked unconscious. Neither of the duergar remember why they started fighting. THE GHOHLBRORN’S LAIR

This inn is the only establishment in Gracklstugh that accepts non-duergar guests. “Ghohlbrorn" means “bulette" in Dwarvish, and the inn is built inside a small cavern complex beneath the Blade Bazaar at the northern end of the Darklake District. Its halls are cold and damp. A central chamber serves as a dining room, branching out into different small, twisting halls along which the rooms arc excavated. It's dark, cramped, and

CHAPTER 4 | GRACKLSTUCH

63

uncomfortable, but safe and defensible. R UMOR M ILL

The inn’s dining hall gives characters a chance to mingle with non-duergar who are visiting Gracklstugh. Characters seeking information can, with a successful DC 10 Charisma (Persuasion) or Intelligence (Investigation) check, find out the following information, or you can simply roleplay their interactions with random patrons. The general gist of the information is that trade routes out of Gracklstugh have become more dangerous recently. The fauna and more primitive denizens of the Underdark are all riled up about something. Among the tales told by the travelers, second-hand stories about demons attacking isolated settlements are common.

L ADUGUER ’ S F URROW Long ago, an earthquake split the cavern that houses Gracklstugh, leaving a rift nearly two hundred feet deep and five hundred feet wide. Laduguer's Furrow has a packed-gravel floor and extends roughly a quarter mile beyond the natural walls of the city in both directions. Each end of the rift has a steeply sloping floor, carved with a set of stairs and a wide ramp for both pedestrians anti wagons. Vents along the walls release potent gases that sappers of Clan Xardelvar tap for industrial applications, including the crafting of the magical (lame lances used by xarrorn warriors. The chasm is Gracklstugh's main residential zone, with homes built on the top part of its north and south sides. Outsiders are normally forbidden from this area.

A BA ND ONE D G U A R D H O U SE S Near the western gate of Laduguer’s Furrow, the duergar built a scries of guardhouses to keep an eye on derro slaves living in the West Cleft. These were abandoned when Deepking Tarngardt, grandfather of the current monarch, liberated the derro, allowing them to spread from the West Cleft District into the East Cleft District. The guardhouses now stand empty, providing an ideal place to lie low and keep an eye on traffic in and out of the eastern derro boroughs.

G RE AT ^G ATE S

The openings that Laduguer’s Furrow creates in the walls of Gracklstugh's cavern are blocked by massive structures of bars and scaffolding, each set with several gales. Gates are guarded by two visible duergar soldiers and ld4+ 3 invisible ones. CHASING DROKI

If the characters decide to wait for Droki to enter the West Cleft or somehow follow him here, use the chase rules in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide, adapting the results for urban complications to a cave full of hateful derro. If Droki loses them, the characters must resort to less convenient means of finding the Whorlstone Tunnels. If the characters do manage to catch Droki in the West Cleft, he drops limp and babbles, but is suspiciously amenable and shows the characters the entrance to the tunnels. See the “Whorlstone Tunnels” section for how to roleplay Droki.

CHAPTER 4 | GRACKLSTUGH

64

W EST C LEFT AND E AST C LEFT D ISTRICTS East and west of Laduguer’s Furrow gates are areas that serve as home to Gracklstugh’s unwanted derro population. The West Cleft District was the original abode for the city's derro slaves and remains a dark and dangerous ghetto. The East Cleft District was more recently settled after the derro earned their freedom, though it is only slightly less rough than West Cleft. The homes of the derro are mostly burrows carved into the walls and simple structures piled atop one another. The dirty and cluttered streets of both districts formed as dwellings spread and came together, and not as a product of planning. The derro population is much greater and their tunnels extend much farther than the duergar believe. The derro are close to mounting an insurrection, held back only by their own lack of organization and by their leaders in the Council of Savants having grown too used to their privileges to foment rebellion.

E NTE R IN G D ER R O T ER R ITORY

The derro are automatically hostile toward anyone entering their warrens, especially surfacers. As you pass through the gates, the stench in the air changes from acrid and metallic to fetid and repugnant, the fires of industry replaced by squalor. The homes in this part of Gracklstugh are crudely carved from the rock or are just holes in the walls, arranged in no apparent order. The chatter in the air is unnerving, with hundreds of derro muttering, screaming at each other, and otherwise reveling in their insanity. Those who spot you look at you with a burning hatred.

At the end of each hour the adventurers stay inside either derro area, there is a 25 percent chance that 2d4 derro (see appendix C) attack without warning. If the characters kill any derro, the chance of another attack becomes 50 percent every half hour. Sneaking through the senseless arrangement of the burrows is relatively easy, as the derro are normally too preoccupied with their own mad scheming to notice a group trying not to attract attention. The characters can attempt a DC 10 group Dexterity (Stealth) cheek, with success negating the need to roll for a possible attack at the end of each hour or half hour. Other means of subterfuge such as illusions, climbing along the walls, or using flying or levitation magic automatically avoid detection, but invisibility of any kind activates magical wards placed by derro savants to guard against duergar intrusion. When a ward activates in response to the presence of an invisible creature, nearby derro fly into a frenzy, creating a chaotic mob meant to drive away invisible duergar patrols. Derro make active W’isdom (Perception) checks contested by

the characters’ Dexterity (Stealth) checks if a wrard is

CHAPTER 4 | GRACKLSTUCH

65

activated. Characters using detect magic actively can spot the invisible sensor of a ward before it activates. Otherwise, invisible characters encounter a ward every 15 minutes they move through derro territory. A CCESS TO THE W HORLSTONE T UNNELS Between a cluster of hovels in West Cleft lies the most well-used entrance to the Whorlstone Tunnels (see ‘Whorlstone Tunnels”). A narrow fissure in the chasm wall is hidden by scraps of cloth, gray sheets of canvas, and moldy boxes. The fissure is tall and wide enough for a Medium creature to squeeze through the first 10 feet, and then continues for 50 feet at an average 5 feet in width, with a gentle downward slope. Ever since the foul irruption of the demon lords tnto the Underdark, the fissure is easier to find, as it sometimes leaks wisps of eerie fog created by faerzress. Otherwise, finding it requires careful searching and a successful DC 15 Wisdom (Perception) check. Each character can make this check at the end of each hour the party spends in the West Cleft warrens looking for the Whorlstone Tunnels' entrance. Any attempt to question the locals without an effective means of disguise or manipulation, such as enchantment or illusion magic, is doomed to fail, as the derro are more likely to attack the characters than answer their questions. Even then, the derro are often incoherent, and a successful DC 15 Charisma (Persuasion) check is needed to obtain -rs to the west, the duergar turn invisible and attack c - soon as the characters arrive. At the start of combat, two duergar use their Enlarge anion while the third opens the valve on the copper tank and aims its nozzle at the characters. During the s- ond round of combat on the same initiative count as he duergar, the duergar alchemist from area 8 joins tr- tight. If the other duergar fall, the alchemist turns -. :sible and tries to escape. FUNGI PIT

The pit is 5 feet deep and filled with various kinds i fungi. It is difficult terrain for Small and Medium cr-atures. and Tiny creatures have half cover while 2tnid the fungi. A crack in the east wall forms the mouth of a narrow mnnel that leads from the floor of the pit to area 6; see the "Whorlstone Tunnels: General Features" sidebar for to re information on narrow tunnels. The abundance of fungi in the thicket makes it easy ic forage here. Among the common, inedible fungi are die following edible and exotic fungi, most of which are described in chapter 2: • • • -

Id6 barrelstalks 3d6 bluecaps M6 Nilhogg's noses Ido sheets of ripplebark Id6timmasks Id6 torchstalks 2d6 trillimacs 2d6 bigwigs (sec "Faerzress-Suffused Fungi”) 2d6 pygmy worts (see “Faerzress-Suffused Fungi")

A character proficient and equipped with a poisoner’s ki' an also collect ld6 doses of assassin's blood poison - m the fungi pit (see “Poisons" in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide).

8 '

\'

SPRINKLER TANK

The copper tank is a sprinkler used by the duergar to fertilize the fungi in the pit. The copper pipe that extends from the tank is 10 feet long and can be turned so that its nozzle points in any direction. The nozzle is pointed toward the pit by default. Any creature can use an action to open or close a valve on the lank, releasing a cloud of pungent fertilizer that fills a 30-foot cube. The cloud grows 10 feet per side each round the valve remains open. The cloud has the same effect as a stinking cloud spell (save DC 12). but the effect ends ld4 + 1 rounds after the valve is closed or the tank runs out of fertilizer. The tank contains enough fertilizer to spray for 10 rounds. As an action or a bonus action, a creature can turn the pipe 90 degrees in any direction.

C RATES

The crates along the north wall are made of zurkhwood and stacked 5 feet high, and climbing on top of them costs 5 feet of movement. Most of the crates are empty, but four of them contain harvested, edible fungi. Each crate of fungi weighs 50 pounds, contains the equivalent of 20 days of rations, and can be sold in Gracklstugh or another Underdark settlement for 25 gp. D EVELOPMENT

If the characters keep any duergar alive for questioning, it takes a successful DC 16 Charisma (Intimidation) check to gain an answer to a single question. The characters can ask only three questions total before the surviving duergar become incoherent and start frothing at the mouth—a form of madness brought on by demontainted faerzress. Any spell or effect that cures indefinite madness also restores a duergar’s sanity (see “Madness” in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide). The duergar stationed here are tasked with protecting the fungi garden and helping the alchemist in his work. They use a trapdoor in area 8 to move between the Whorlstone Tunnels and the Darklake Docks in Gracklstugh. They have been ordered not to explore the rest of the Whorlstone Tunnels, though their leaders sometimes go farther into the tunnels on unknown business.

8. G RAY ALCHEMIST The Gray Ghosts have claimed this cave as both a safe house and a laboratory, where their alchemists can work in relative peace and isolation. This area is surprisingly clean and orderly, split into two levels connected by a ramp made from zurkhwood planks. The upper level contains a fully furnished laboratory, while the lower level has two bunk beds, The wall of the lower level is set with a closed door.

Unless he is drawn to sounds of combat in area 7, a duergar alchemist (see the sidebar) named Lorthio Bukhukkcn works on the upper level of this area. Uorthio’s laboratory contains a work tabic, a desk, a case of shelves lined with vials, and a dome-shaped oven. All furnishings are made of zurkhwood except the oven, which is made of stone. DUERGAR ALCHEMIST

A duergar alchemist carries two vials of acid and two flasks of alchemist’s fire. It uses the normal duergar stat block but replaces the Javelin attack option with the following attack options: Acid Vial. Ranged Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, range 20 ft., one target. Hit: 7 (2d 6) acid damage. Alchemist's Fire. Ranged Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, range 20 ft., one target. Hit: 2 (ld4) fire damage at the start of each of the target’s turns. A creature can end this damage by using its action to make a successful DC 10 Dexterity check to extinguish the flames.

The lower level is 10 feet below the laboratory and contains two bunk beds and two small chests, all made CHAPTER 4 | GRACKLSTUGH

76

of zurkhwood (See “Treasure" below for information on the contents of the chests). The door is barred on this side and has closed peepholes at dwarf's-eye height. Opening the peepholes allows one to see into the room beyond. The bar is easily lified from this side, but breaking down the door requires a successful DC 20 Strength check. The room east of the door is empty except for an iron ladder that climbs 60 feet to a stone trapdoor embedded in the ceiling. The trapdoor is unlocked, and above it a narrow, spiraling tunnel leads to the Darklake Docks. D EVELOPMENT

Sounds of combat here alert the duergar in area 7. They use their Enlarge actions before heading this way. T REASURE

If the characters spend 1 hour ransacking the lab, they can assemble two herbalism kits, one poisoner’s kit, and ten healer’s kits. In the (unlocked) zurkhwood chests, they find ld6 vials of acid, ld6 flasks of alchemist’s fire, two potions of healing, one potion of greater healing, one potion of fire breath, and one potion ofpsychic resistance. Depending on whether or not Droki delivered his parcel and took his payment, the desk contains either a lump of black metal or a holy symbol of Laduguer made of mithral (see "Finging Droki”). The desk also holds alchemical recipes scrawled in Dwarvish on torn strips of parchment. A character who studies these scraps for an hour and succeeds on a DC 15 Intelligence (Arcana) check can piece together the formulas for crafting vials of acid and flasks of alchemist’s fire. The character can gather enough ingredients in the laboratory to craft ld4 of each. The character who knows the recipe and has the proper ingredients can craft a vial of acid or flask of alchemist’s fire in 1 hour. A character who searches the desk and succeeds on a DC 12 Intelligence (Investigation) check also finds a letter hidden in a secret compartment. The letter is written in Dwarvish on a patch of lizard hide: I

don’t need your poison anymore. I’ll deal with

Werz Saltbaron myself. Bring me an elf blade, one with the swirlies carved on the steel, and I’ll forget you failed me. And I don't want to see any of your goons near my post. The captain is poking around, and I could use a scapegoat. -Gorglak

If the characters capture Forth io and question him about the letter, he reveals one of the following bits of information each time a character succeeds on a DC 13 Charisma (Intimidation) check: • Gorglak is a warrior of the Stone Guard stationed at one of the outer gates near the Darklake District. • Gorglak is an avid collector of weird weapons. • Gorglak is easily bribed.

XP A WARDS

Presenting Gorglak's letter to Captain Errde Blaekskull -irns each character 50 XP for retrieving evidence of ■rruption within the ranks of the Stone Guard.

9. F OUNTAIN

OF E VIL ___________________ Foul water from the Darklakc spills into this cave, forming a pool. See the “Whorlstone Tunnels: General Features" sidebar for the effects of drinking foul water. The ceiling in this cave is 80 feet high. •

10. C ULTIST P ENS The insane derro cubists have been buying cave bears from Underdark hunters and smuggling them through Gracklstugh. For what purpose is anyone's guess. A large gate made of iron bars blocks the northwest entrance and is usually locked. One of the derro cultists carries the key. The lock can be opened with a successful DC 15 Dexterity check using thieves’ tools. A creature with a Strength of 20 or higher can force the gate open with a successful DC 25 Strength check.

1

T

he chamber splits into two paths surrounding a large

I oool, filled by water trickling from stalactites along the ceiling. The western path forms a ramp above the

The first thing you notice as you enter the room is a heavy, unpleasant musk in the air, coming from cages assembled

pool's s jrface, while the eastern path runs level with

from scrap iron on both sides of the chamber.

the water and continues into a tunnel opening. The

A spiral path circles into the center of the room, marked

water turns marker toward the center of the pool, where

off by small stone pylons.

it transforms from a gentle swirl into a churning vortex.

Two derro stand by a large cauldron in front of a

#

tent near the cave’s center. Both are talking while

• water weird bound to the pool years has been a erupted by the demonic influence infecting these runnels, turning it evil and giving it a dark hunger. The western path slopes upward to a maximum height of 60 feel above the pool's surface. If the characters take this upper path, the water weird attacks them when they are 30 feet above the surface of the pool, as it was bound here Lo protect the path leading to area 16. The water weird can command the pool’s water to erupt tike a geyser, effectively lifting the water weird up to the characters' level and putting them within its reach. Any character the water weird successfully grapples i dropped in the pool, taking no damage from the fall. The pool is 30 feet deep in the middle and 5 feet deep oear the shore, if the characters follow Droki into this chamber, they see him sneaking carefully along the eastern path. They can attempt to follow him with a group Dexterity Stealth) check contested by the water weird's passive W :sdom (Perception) score. If more than half the characters fail the check, the water weird notices them and attacks. If the characters are attacked by the water weird while following Droki, the wily derro realizes he’s being shadowed and makes a run for it.

apparently ignoring each other. In the cages, three hulking brown bears appear to be resting.

The two derro (see appendix C) are cultists. One of them is complaining about “the master” while the other talks about something he once fished out of the Darklake. The three cave bears (use the polar bear statistics) are alert, despite appearances to the contrary. Characters hoping to sneak past them must succeed on Dexterity (Stealth) checks contested by the bears’ passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 13. On their first turn, the cultists move to free the bears. Each cage is closed with a simple bolt that can be unlatched with an action. Once the first two bears are set free, the third bear breaks out of its cage on its own. A crack in the south wall leads to a narrow tunnel that wends toward area 12. Medium and larger creatures are too big to fit through this narrow tunnel (see the "Whorlstone Tunnels: General Features” sidebar). S PIRAL P ATH

This path helps to channel the ritual magic the cultists use to tame the cave hears. Though the ritual is currently inactive, the area radiates a faint aura of enchantment under the scrutiny of a detect magic spell. T REASURE

Inside the tent are two flea-rirlden bedrolls, a zurkhwood bucket containing edible fungi (the equivalent of two days of rations), and a wineskin full of Darklake Stout.

11. Q UASIT P LAYGROUND Some of the cult's more powerful derro savants keep quasits as familiars, and the wee demons discovered this tunnel network. They use the tunnels as shortcuts to deliver messages across the areas of the Whorlstone Tunnels controlled by the cultists, or simply to hide from their duties. Shrinking down allows the characters lo more easily navigate this area.

CHAPTER L | GRACKLSTUGH

77

The narrow tunnel is lit by the same dim, ambient light

The smell of brimstone and foul chemicals emanates

found throughout this complex. Ahead, you hear the high-

from this large chamber. The light of campfires

pitched cackling of several creatures.

shows a natural platform where five derro are droning a cacophonous chant. A two-headed dog stirs

Four quasits are wrestling each other farther along in the tunnel. If they notice the characters, they attack. When two quasits are reduced to 0 hit points, the two remaining ones turn invisible and flee. However, they make enough noise in doing so for the characters to follow them by sound. If any quasit escapes, the cultists in area 12 can’t be surprised and prepare an ambush.

inside a cage, while another derro nearby plays with

D EVELOPMENT

to take the form of a second head.

If the characters manage to capture and interrogate a quasit, the creature readily surrenders the name of Narrak—the derro savant leading the cultists in the Whorlstone Tunnels (see area 12). In exchange for its life, the quasit reveals that the cult plans to curse Gracklstugh's stone giants wilh madness as a means to sowing chaos in the city. XP A WARDS

Each character earns a special awrard of 50 XP if the party learns of Narrak’s plans from a quasit.

12. C U LTIS T H ID E O U T Droki enters this cavern from the east, via a narrow tunnel that comes up through a crack in the cavern floor (see the “Narrow Tunnels" section of the “Whorlstone Tunnels: General Features” sidebar). West of the cavern is a shricker that serves as an alarm system (see “Fungi Patches") and a pit trap (see “Trap”).

a crossbow and watches the dog nervously. A green glow rises suddenly from a magic circle at the center of the platform, where a small humanoid statue is the focus of the chanting ritual. As you watch, a lump sprouts from the statue’s neck, enlarging and reshaping itself with each unholy verse

Narrak. a derro savant, belongs to a fringe group within the Council of Savants using demonology as a path to power. Since the arrival of the demon lords, he has gathered and bullied several apprentices to participate in rituals aimed to sow chaos in Gracklstugh. Narrak knows the stone giants are a pillar of the Deepking’s power, and that cursing them with Dcmogorgon’s madness will be an appropriate first step toward delivering the entire city to the demon lord. The cage by the tunnel holds a death dog. watched over by a nervous derro cultist. Atop the platform, Narrak and four more derro cultists are performing a ritual around the statue at its center. (Statistics for Narrak and the derro can be found in appendix C.) The cultists’ chanting is punctuated with Narrak calling out the name “Demogorgon!" Also atop the platform, resting comfortably in an fungi-filled alcove (and initially out of the party's view), is Narrak’s bodyguard—a female ettin named Grula-Munga.

SHRIEKER FITTRAP

When intruders appear, the eultists cease their chanting and take up positions along the edge of the platform as Grula-Munga rises to her feet and picks up her weapons. At the same time, the cultist standing next to the cage releases the death dog. Narrak continues his part in the ritual until the characters kill the death dog or one of the eultists, at which point he joins the battle. The door to the death dog's cage is held shut with a simple clasp and requires an action to open. If any of the quasits escaped from area 11. they warn the eultists that intruders are near. Otherwise, the characters might catch the eultists by surprise. The quasits remain invisible and stay close to Narrak. F UNGI P ATCHES

Fungi is rampant throughout this area, growing in large patches on the floors and walls. Two thick fungi patches grow by each wall in the western tunnel. Clinging to the north wall is a shrieker that party members can recognize with a successful DC 12 Intelligence (Nature) check. The shrieker starts screaming as soon as anyone comes within 30 feet of it. The crack in the floor by the cast wall is surrounded by a thick fungus patch that is difficult terrain for Small and Medium characters, and provides half cover for Tiny creatures. Growing among the common fungi are 2d6 bigwigs and 2d6 pygmyworts. P LATFORM

The cavern floor rises to form a natural 5-foot-high platform. A glowing ritual circle dominates the top of the platform. Any non-derro that enters or touches the circle must succeed on a DC 13 Wisdom saving throw or gain one level of madness (see "Madness" in chapter 2). Whether the save succeeds or fails, the creature can’t be affected by the circle in this way again. In addition, nonevil creatures within the circle have disadvantage on attack rolls and saving throws. The statue within the ritual circle is 2 feet tall, weighs 100 pounds, and looks vaguely like a crouching stone siant with a lump on its neck where a second head is beginning to form. The statue is engraved with profane symbols, with the name “Dorhun" scribed in Dwarvish into its back. A successful DC 16 Intelligence (Arcana or Religion) check allows a character to recognize the profane symbols as being related to Dcmogorgon. A search of the platform uncovers a similar but broken ~:atue near a locked iron chest and a pile of books 'see "Treasure" for more information on the chest and books). The broken statue is similar to the statue in the circle, except it has the name “Rihuud” carved into its back and its second head is fully formed. If Rihuud :s dead, the broken statue turns to dust when the characters touch it. If the characters spared Rihuud's iife. a successful DC 12 Intelligence (Arcana or Religion) check reveals that the second head is a conduit for the curse’s magic, and that removing it and returning it to Stonespeaker Hgraam in Cairngorm Cavern will allow the elder giant to end Rihuud's curse.

T RAP

The tunnel west of this cavern contains a hidden pit (see "Sample Traps” in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master's Guide). Debris conceals the lid. which is made of thin zurkhwood that breaks when a creature weighing 50 pounds or more steps on it. (A character of reduced size might not weigh enough to break the lid.) The pit is 10 feet deep, and its floor is covered by a patch of green slime (see “Dungeon Hazards" in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide). Any creature that falls into the pit takes ld6 bludgeoning damage and automatically fails its Dexterity saving throw to avoid the slime. T REASURE

If the characters return the broken statue (or, at the very least, its second head) to Stonespeaker Hgraam, he gives them an emerald worth 500 gp as a reward, as well as his promise to vouch for them in anything they seek to accomplish in Gracklstugh. Narrak has a key around his neck that opens the lock on the iron chest, which can also be picked with thieves’ tools and a successful DC 17 Dexterity check. The chest contains a jar of Keogh tom s ointment and a small leather bag containing 45 gp and 15 sp. The books have pages made from trillimac caps (see “Fungi of the Underdark" in chapter 2). They contain the mad scribblings of Narrak and his fellow derro savants. A character proficient in Arcana, Investigation, or Religion can spend 8 hours poring through them: subtract ld4 hours if the character reads Dwarvish. At the end of this time, the character knows that the books outline two rituals: one that causes a one-headed creature to sprout a second head, and another that allows the grafting of a severed head onto a living creature. The notes fail to mention that the ritual's caster must be suffering from some form of madness to perform either ritual successfully. Tucked in one book are two scrolls: one that bears a list of six stone giant names (including Rihuud's and Dorhun’s) and another that is actually a letter written in broken Dwarvish: Narrak— Need more scrolls! Stonespeaker Hgraam has traps traps traps. But Droki is wily too and very small! I can hear talk, and in talk they say names, and I hear names and write names and give you names so you give me time. But you have to give me more scrolls. Magicky spelly scrolls! — Droki

XP A WARDS

Award 100 XP to each character for discovering Demogorgon’s influence on the eultists. The characters can complete a quest by turning over the books, scrolls, and letter to Errde Blackskull. Award 150 XP to each character when they deliver the items. If the characters ask Errde about Narrak. she tells them that he was a junior member of the Council of Savants.

CHAPTER -t I GRACKLSTUGH /

79

13. DUMPING PIT_________________ Victims of Narrak’s experiments arc dumped here. Exposure to the faerzress has begun to animate the corpses.

This cavern is one enormous pit that reeks of death and

long ago. However, shards of the obelisk that appear throughout the Underdark are magically absorbed into it as soon as they touch its metal surface. The leaders of the Gray Ghosts are obsessed with finding missing shards and completing this monolith, but not even they know what will happen when the obelisk is made whole again.

decomposed flesh. The glow of faerzress is everywhere, seeming to flow like fog around dark shapes shambling across the pit floor. A single derro watches from atop a 15-foot-high ledge. A crack in the southeast wall of the pit leads to a narrow tunnel and is flanked by mounds of fungi and offal.

After a steady upward climb, the tunnel opens Into a huge, well-lit chamber. The glow of faerzress and bioluminescent fungi compete with shafts of white light that fall upon naturally formed shelves along the walls as well as a rocky mesa at the center of the cavern. Crudely formed ramps connect the different

The pit is 15 feet deep, and the ledge that overlooks it is lined with pointy bits of scrap metal to make any climbing attempt perilous. A crealure trying to reach the lop of the ledge must succeed on a DC 12 Strength (Athletics) check. On a failed check, a creature takes 3 (ld6) slashing damage and remains in the pit. The pit's floor is difficult terrain due to the many corpses and body parts strewn around. A single derro stands on the ledge overlooking the pit, which contains seven shambling zombies—three duergar ami four grimlocks. The grimtock zombies are drawn to noise, while the duergar zombies attack any living creatures they see in the pit. Meanwhile, the derro uses its crossbow to take shots at any living creatures it sees. A crawling claw wearing an obsidian ring on one stubby finger (see "Treasure") lurks amid the offal mounds. These mounds are difficult terrain to Small and Medium creatures, and the fungi growing atop them provide cover to Tiny creatures. The shriveled gray hand once belonged to Pelek the svirfneblin (see “Development''). The crack in the southeast wall between the mounds leads to a narrow, meandering tunnel, the floor of which is sunk below a foot of foul water. See the “Whorlstone Tunnels: General Features” sidebar for rules on narrow tunnels and foul water. TREASURE

Faerzress has transformed Pelek's obsidian ring into a

single-use magic item. When a living creature puts it on, the ring disappears, and the creature’s skin becomes as hard as obsidian for the next hour. For as long as the effect lasts, the creature gains the benefit of a stoneskin spell. DEVELOPMENT

If the characters capture and interrogate the derro, he talks willingly if they agree to spare him. He knows as much as the quasits in area 11. Killing the crawling claw and burying its remains in Blingdenstone lays Peiek's spirit to rest (see area lb).

14. OBELISK____________________ The Gray Ghosts believe that the mysterious obelisk in this cavern is an important source of magical power, and they are intent on rebuilding it. The obelisk was broken CHAPTER 4 I GRACKLSTUGH 8o

levels of the mesa up to the height of its two topmost tiers, which are linked by a sturdy bridge. Atop one of those tiers sits a large red egg. Atop the other stands a 50-foot-tall obelisk made of smooth black metal with a few noticeable imperfections, as though small parts of it were somehow chipped away. A female derro stands close to the obelisk, gently patting and stroking its surface. The obelisk flashes once, the glow offaerzress around the cavern flaring in response. The derro squeals with glee as she snatches an object up from the ground, then writes something down in a small notebook.

The chamber is brightly lit, as if by sunlight. The sunlight is just a natural trick caused by crystal growths reflecting and amplifying the light of the bioluminescent fungi growing on the walls. The characters realize this if they climb near the ceiling of the cavern, where the optical trick is easy to discern. The different levels of the mesa are separated by 10foot-high cliffs. Climbing a cliff requires a successful DC 12 Strength (Athletics) check. Pliinki, a mad derro savant (see appendix C), stands atop of the mesa. Hidden on a shelf above the cavern’s entrance, a spectator tasked with guarding this area sees the characters as soon as they walk 15 feet into the cavern. The spectator screeches an alarm and attacks, killing non-derro with glee. As it fights, it projects telepathic ramblings into the characters’ minds, mostly dealing will) how exciting it is to have intruders to kill and how even more exciting things will be when the obelisk is complete. Pliinki shouts crass obscenities at the characters in a raspy voice while commanding the spectator to dispose of them. Both she and the spectator fight to the death. O BELISK

Made from a black metal of alien origin, this monolith is perfectly smooth except for the cracks and chipped-off edges where it was splintered by some unknown force. The obelisk is 15 feet per side at its base, stands 50 feet tall, and tapers slowly to a pyramidal cap. Any character proficient in Arcana can tell that the obelisk’s fractures are leaking quasi-magical energy. The character further understands that feeding magical

energy into the obelisk might activate its latent magir. Spending a spell slot of any level while touching the belisk activates it and teleports everyone on the mesa to a location in the Underdark just outside the northwest . te of Gracklstugh. The character who expended the spell slot knows the teleport effect can be repeated, but that this power is inly temporary a fluke due to the recent disruption of faerzress throughout the Underdark. Both the potency _:nd the nature of the effect could change within a week r two. and this teleport effect likely hears no relation to the obelisk's actual purpose. If the characters took the lump of metal from Droki or rhe Gray Ghosts, they notice the obelisk is made from ihe same material. If the lump is touched to the obelisk, it is instantly absorbed, repairing a crack on its surface. RED DRAGON EGG

The egg atop the northeast mesa is an unhatched dragon - gg that the Gray Ghosts stole from the Keepers of the Flame. The 4-foot-tall, 3-foot-diameter egg weighs '.30 pounds, and without fire to keep it warm, the egg a n't hatch. If and when the egg does hatch, a red dragon wyrmling emerges and bonds with the first creature it sees. 1 REASURE The derro savant carries a single gold coin, a stick of harcoal. and a battered notebook with pages made from trillimac (see “Fungi of the Underdark" in chapter 2 The coin is a shilmaer. an ancient gold coin traded among surface elves. The notebook contains Dwarvish writing, specifically a long list of random items, mostly .: ins and jewelry. There are no dates, but some entries ,-rpear in different handwriting. The last entry describes the "miraculous” appearance of the gold coin. DEVELOPMENT

li the characters capture and interrogate Pliinki. she laughs at their folly as she tells them that the horlstone Tunnels are nowhere near the surface. She believes the obelisk was hidden here by Diirinka, the :■ rro god. and that it contains “unimaginable power." ?iiinki and her fellow savants hope to harness the -disk's power and use it to conquer Gracklstugh. If the characters take the dragon egg to Themberehaud, he destroys it and rewards the party with a magical potion or oil plucked from his hoard. If :he characters return the egg to the Keepers of the r iame, Gartokkar Xundorn promises them safe passage through Gracklstugh if they mention nothing about the „ to Themberehaud. XP A WAR D S

7 iking the coin and the notebook to Ylsa Henstak in the Blade Bazaar fulfills her quest and earns the characters '.00 XP each. If the characters describe the obelisk to Gartokkar Xundorn, he assumes that is what the Gray Ghosts are using to wreak havoc in Gaumlgrym and dispatches a force to study it. Each character earns 100 XP for completing the task set for them by the Keepers. Award each character an additional 150 XP if the party

delivers the red dragon egg to either the Keepers or to Themberehaud.

14A. F U N G I -C O V E R E D

DOORS

A set of double doors are hidden by a patch of fungi that includes 2H6 bigwigs and 2d6 pygmyworts. Characters west of the doors must succeed on a DC 15 Wisdom (Perception) check to notice the doors behind the fungi. The doors are fashioned from planks of zurkhwood and barred from the east side. A successful DC 20 Strength check allows a character to break through the doors, hut this alerts the derro savant and the spectator in area 14.

LEAVING GRACKLSTUGH The characters can gain the means to leave the city— and information to guide them on their journey—from a number of different sources, depending on the NPCs they interact with and the quests they undertake. F.rrde Blackskull is true to her word, and she lets the characters leave the city freely if they fulfilled the tasks she set for them. Working for Themberehaud or the Keepers of the Flame leaves the characters in a position where they can at least avoid arrest in the city. Deciding the next step for the characters depends on what information or quests the characters picked up in Gracklstugh. Heading for Neverlight Grove (see chapter 5) or Blingdenstone (see chapter 6) are the obvious next steps, as both places hold the promise of a route to the surface world. Alternatively, the characters can try their luck in the Labyrinth or the Wormwrithings. Some of the quests the characters complete have the potential to change the power structure of Gracklstugh. For example, aiding Errde Blackskull and the Stone Guards might grant the characters the privilege of an audience with King Horgar Steelshadow Val some later time. If the characters press Errde. Gartokkar, or Stonespeaker Ilgraam fora meeting with the Deepking,

use the following section to run an encounter in the Deepking’s palace.

CHAPTER 4 I GRACKLSTUGH 8o

HOLD OF THE DEEPKING The Hold of the Deepking stands south of Laduguer’s Furrow and north of Themberchaud’s lair. When the characters first lay eyes on it, read the following boxed text aloud to the players. The Hold of the Deepking is a dark and foreboding edifice

AUDIENCE

WITH THE

DEEPKING

Characters who befriend Stonespeaker Hgraam or complete quests for Errde Blackskull or Gartokkar Xundorn can use their newfound influence to gain an audience with the Deepking. Characters escorted to the palace by Hgraam. Errde, or Gartokkar arc admitted inside and led past rows of invisible duergar guards to the Deepking’s throne room.

lodged between two great columns that rise up into thick clouds of smoke that conceal the cavern ceiling. Giant

Lava pours down troughs cut into the black basalt

basalt braziers filled with molten lava bathe the palace

walls of this vast hall. The heat is oppressive, and the

facade in a hellish glow, and the thick stone walls bristle

air reeks of sulfur. Thick black columns support the

with iron turrets and battlements.

heavy ceiling, and at the far end of the hall stands an iron throne atop a polished obsidian dais. A crowned

There appears to be no one guarding the palace, but this is an illusion. All of the palace guards are invisible, and characters who observe the palace for some time can hear duergar guards in heavy armor marching to and fro. Two hundred invisible duergar Stone Guards (see appendix C) protect the palace and its king. Fifty stand at attention in perfect rows before the palace, ready to cut down anyone who approaches the palace gates unescorted. Another fifty watch from the turrets and battlements. One hundred more stand guard in the palace and comprise the Deepking’s honor guard.

duergar encased in armor sits on the throne. Next to him stands a royal consort wearing a gown made of gold coins.

An invisible wall of force stands between the Deepking’s dais and the characters. Whether the Deepking is of a mind to fight the demon lords is up to you, although like many other duergar in the city, Horgar Steelshadow V has been touched by the demon lords' madness. Roll on the Indefinite Madness table in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide to determine Horgar’s flaw. Tf the characters attack the Deepking, use the knight statistics in the Monster Manual to represent him, with the following modifications: • • • • • • • •

Horgar is lawful evil. He speaks Draconic, Giant, and Dwarvish. He has AC 20 and wears dwarven plate. He has advantage on saving throws against poison, spells, and illusions, as well as to resist being charmed or paralyzed. While in sunlight, he has disadvantage on attack rolls, as well as on Wisdom (Perception) checks that rely on sight. He has the Enlarge and Invisibility action options of a duergar (see the Monster Manual). He wears gauntlets of ogre power, giving him a Strength score of 19 (+4). He wields a +2 warhammer instead of a greatsword: +8 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target. Hit: 10 (1 dS + 6) bludgeoning damage, or 11 (ldlO + 6) bludgeoning damage if used with two hands. While Horgar is enlarged, the damage increases to 15 (2d8 + 6) or 17 (2d 10 + 6) bludgeoning damage, respectively.

The Deepking’s royal consort is a succubus in the guise of Shal, a female duergar. The succubus is a loyal servant of the demon lord Graz’zt (see appendix D). Her only task is to make sure no one tries to rid Horgar of his madness. The gown she wears was a gift from Horgar. It weighs 75 pounds and is worth 750 gp. D EVELOPMENT

If the characters expose the succubus as a fiendish spy and help restore Horgar's sanity, the Deepking becomes friendly toward them and tries to set them against the CHAPTER 4 | GRACKLSTUGJt

82

drow, whom he blames for the spreading madness.

CHAPTER 4 | GRACKLSTUGJt

83

CHAPTER 5: NEVERLIGHT GROVE Communities of myconids can be found throughout the Underdark. These intelligent, vaguely humanoid fungi lead lives of work and shared contemplation, providing shelter and safe passage to any who approach them peacefully. The relative isolation of Neverlight Grove, its abundance of food and water, and the welcoming nature of its inhabitants might bring the characters here to rest, recuperate, and resupply. While in the grove, they can consult with the colony's myconid sovereigns about possible ways back to the surface world, while enjoying a much-needed respite from the brutal and harrowing conditions of the Underdark. However, this particular myconid haven isn’t as safe as it might appear. One of their sovereigns has fallen under the sway of Zuggtmoy. the Demon Queen of

Fungi, who wasted no time building herself a stronghold in a colossal mushroom called Yggmorgus. There, she works on a malevolent scheme to claim all the Underdark as her domain. More and more myconids are slowly becoming unwitting thralls under her control, and characters who linger in Neverlight Grove might find themselves in great peril.

GOING TO NEVERLIGHT GROVE

Because so few Underdark travelers have ever stumbled upon Neverlight Grove, it rarely appears on any maps. Nearly all the routes leading to it are dangerous and difficult to navigate, although many streams flow into and through the grove. If the characters enter the general area of the grove and stay close to or travel along— these waterways, they eventually find their way

here. Alternatively, three of the party's companions can guide Ihem to Neverlight Grove. Stool, the characters' fellow prisoner from chapter 1, is a myconid sprout from the grove, captured by the drow before Zuggtmoy began exerting her influence over the myconids here. Although not knowledgeable about the Underdark, Stool has an innate sense of where its home lies and can guide the party toward it. Upon its return. Stool is greatly disturbed by the changes it encounters in the grove. It isn't well acquainted with either sovereign, but finds itself drawn toward Basidia. The former drow prisoner Sarith Kzckarit might also become the party's guide, owing to his extensive knowledge of the Underdark. Though the party doesn't realize it, Sarith is infected with Zuggtmoy’s spores, which now control his mind, lfe Iries to steer the party toward Neverlight Grove, citing it as a place of safety in which the adventurers can decide their next move. In reality, he unknowingly leads the characters to become slaves of the Demon Queen of Fungi. If the characters already visited Gracklstugh, Sarith might have gone with the infected myconids in the Whorlstone Tunnels, leaving Rumpadump with the party. A myconid sprout traveling with a troupe of infected myconids, Rumpadump has avoided infection and can also lead characters to the grove. He also expresses concern that the corrupted spores of its previous traveling companions might have also infected its home. R A N D O M E N C O U N T E R S _________________________

Characters traveling to and from Neverlight Grove encounter evidence of Zuggtmoy’s growing influence in the region. Whenever the party is within four days of Neverlight Grove, use the Encounters around Neverlight Grove table instead of the random encounter tables in chapter 2 to determine what, if anything, they encounter. ENCOUNTERS AROUND NEVERLIGHT GROVE d20 Encounter 1-8 No encounter 9-16 Fungi patch (see below) 1718 ld4nothics 19-20 1 chasme demon crawling on the ceiling or 1 vrock demon perched on a ledge (your choice)

FUNGI PATCH If the characters are camped or resting, treat this encounter as “no encounter.” Otherwise, the characters stumble upon a large fungi patch growing in a damp cave or tunnel. The fungi patch is difficult terrain and consists of many common but inedible species of giant fungi. Roll a dlO and consult the Fungi Patch Discoveries table to determine what else the characters find here. See “Fungi of the Underdark" in chapter 2 for more information on edible and exotic species of fungi. Entries marked with an asterisk are further described after the table. F U N G I P ATC H D I S C O V E R I E S d20

84

Fungi or Creatures

CHAPTER 51 I NEVERLIGHT GROVE 1 d6 barrelstalks

2 3

2d6 bluecaps ld3 carrion crawlers

4 5 6 7

ld4 drow spore servants* (see appendix C) and ld4 quaggoth spore servants* Fire lichen growing near a thermal vent 3d6 giant fire beetles 1 d4 myconid adults*

8 9

1 d 6 nightlights 1 otyugh hidden under a mound of offal

18 19

Patch of brown mold (see “Dungeon Hazards’’ i chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide) ld4 awakened zurkhwoods* (see appendix C) 2d4 sheets of ripplebark growing on the walls ld4 shriekers* 2d4 timmasks ld6 tongues of madness 2d6 torchstalks 2d6 trillimacs ld4 violet fungi 2d4 waterorbs growing near a freshwater spring

20

ld4 zurkhwoods*

10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17

Drow and Quaggoth Spore Servants. These spore servants tend the fungi patch on behalf of the myconids and ignore the party unless attacked or interfered with, in which case they defend themselves. Myconid Adults. These gentle creatures tend to the fungi patch and mind their own business, attacking only in self-defense. If the characters establish communication with the fungus folk and ask for directions to Neverlight Grove, the myconids offer to escort them to the grove and introduce them to their exalted leader. Sovereign Phylo. Sentinel Mushrooms. These giant animated mushrooms guard the fungi patch, attacking if they are harmed or if the characters try to harvest any of the fungi. Shriekers. The shrieking of these fungi has a 50 percent of attracting a nearby chasme or vrock demon (your choice), which arrives ld6 + 4 rounds later and fights until killed. Zurkhwoods. There is a 50 percent chance that one of the zurkhwoods has ld4 + 4 stirges nesting in its cap. The stirges are drawn to light sources.

ARRIVING AT THE GROVE While many passages lead to Neverlight Grove, most are little more than narrow fissures riven by trickles of water. Only one natural tunnel is fit for relatively easy travel by Medium creatures, formed by a drying underground stream and dimly lit by glowing lichen. Upon entering the cavern of the grove, characters leave the horrors of the Underdark behind. They find themselves in a hidden enchanted place, strangely alien but serenely beautiful. The access tunnel opens above the grove’s main floor, providing the

and their behavior is cause for concern among the unaffected, including Sovereign Basidia and its allies.

characters a panoramic view of a mushroom forest that covers every surface including the ceiling and illuminates the darkness with brilliantly colorful bioluminescent patterns. On the other side of this exotic forest, the cavern narrows into a ravine. Tn a cavern beyond the ravine, a glimpse of a majestic mushroom tower can be seen, although the poor light and a rising mist makes it impossible to discern its details.

Two S OV E R E IGNS

DROW PURSUIT IN NEVERLIGHT GROVE

Though the characters don't know it yet, a drow scout patrol arrived in Neverlight Grove ahead of them, anticipating that the escaped adventurers might seek shelter among the myconids. Unfortunately for the drow scouts, an encounter with one of Zuggtmoy's servants led them to a grisly fate. See area 5, “The Garden of Welcome,” for more information. While the characters remain in Neverlight Grove, their pursuit level remains unchanged, as Ilvara waits to near from the missing patrol. The drow pursuit resumes when the party leaves the grove. See chapter 2 for more information.

Myconid communities normally have only a single sovereign—the largest among them, who stands alone and outside of any circle (sec below). Two years ago. Sovereign Basidia arrived in the grove with its two circles, and Sovereign Phylo welcomed the new myconids gladly, grateful for Basidia’s offer to share the burdens of leading all the circles in the grove. The two sovereigns have been close friends ever since, sharing authority and responsibilities with no conflict. Each knows that an individual myconid has only so much time in the cycle of life, and that when both have passed, a single sovereign will take their place after their bodies are returned to nourish the soil.

I M P ORTANT NPCS

The adventurers might interact with the following characters and creatures in Neverlight Grove, N EVERLICHT G ROVE NPCs Sovereign Phylo One of the two rulers of Neverlight Grove, in thrall to Zuggtmoy Sovereign Basidia The other ruler of Neverlight Grove, free ofZuggtmoy's influence and suspicious of Phylo Loobamub Leader of the Circle of Hunters,

SOV E

IGN

loyal to Basidia, with tasks for the Leader of the Circle of Explorers and loyal to Basidia; knows of routes to the surface world Mutated leader of the Circle of Masters and Zuggtmoy's monstrous servant

Rasharoo

Yestabrod

Xinaya

Drow scout trapped in a horrible fate

A D AY

IN N EV ER LI G H T G R OV E The myconid way of life is simple, contemplative, and cyclical. Myconids work for eight hours farming their fungi fields, scouting for resources, and maintaining •heir defenses. After their labors, they spend eight hours in telepathic communion with each other in what they all “melding." They then rest for eight hours before starting the cycle anew. Many of the myconids in the grove are more extroverted than might be expected of their normally { shy species. Characters who communicate with the myconids by way of their rapport spores note that the creatures seem to be preparing for a celebration of some sort, proclaiming “The day of joy is nigh!” and exhorting thers to “Rejoice in the true union that will meld us ail!" These are the myconids affected by Zuggtmoy, CHAPTER 5 I NEVERLIGHT GROVE _____________________________ ______—

85

CIRCLES__________________________ The circles in Neverlight Grove arc divided by specialized function, with each circle performing a specific role in the colony. Seven circles are present in the grove, each containing an average of twenty myconids the Circle of Hunters, the Circle of Explorers, the Circle of Sowers, the Circle of Builders, the Circle of Growers, plus the recently formed Inner Circle and Circle of Masters. Each circle gathers around a circle mound a pile of rocks and soil upon which mold, lichen, and mushrooms are encouraged to grow. The myconids of a circle gather around their own mound to meld and sleep. After becoming enthralled by Zuggtmoy. Phylo decided the myconids would meld exclusively within their own circle, and only the circle leaders would meld with the other circle leaders and the sovereigns. Phylo asserted that this would make all the circles' meldings far more efficient, thereby making the tending of the grove that much easier. Most of the grove’s myconids have gone along with this new and unusual concept, swayed by Fhylo’s claims that a higher level of communal harmony will be achieved. Basidia believes that Phylo’s separation of the circles is contrary to the unity and harmony of the myconid way of life, and that this segregation isolates individuals from the experiences of others outside their circle. Basidia has likewise expressed concern about the unnaturalness of the Inner Circle and the Circle of Masters. However, Basidia’s views are either dismissed or ignored by Phylo and its allies, who zealously claim that exciting changes arc coming for the grove. A more recent development has Basidia even more disturbed when the adventurers arrive in Neverlight Grove. Yestabrod, the leader of the Circle of Masters, has not attended an Inner Circle melding for several R O I E P L AYI N G T H E M Y C O N I D S

Myconids lead lives completely unlike the experiences of any surface dweller. The only things they have in common with humanoids are the need for sustenance, the desire to live, and the joy of socialization, although they practice each ofthese things in different ways than humanoids. Truly alien creatures, myconids have difficulty telling flesh- and-blood humanoids apart. Myconids are innocent about matters of ethics and morality, their lives centered on living fully each day and worrying little about the future and nothing at all about the past. Despite the communal nature oftheir existence, they are individuals with their own unique interests and distinct personalities. They gravitate toward simple, shared joys, living by the wisdom and insight their melding provides. Because of their naive and sharing ways, as well as their fungal nature, they are extremely vulnerable to the corrupting influence of Zuggtmoy. The myconids of Neverlight Grove are beginning to reel from the Lady of Decay’s influence, with many blissfully welcoming her madness, while others bravely try to resist it. Myconids affected by Zuggtmoy abandon the growth of life as the core oftheir being in favor of decay and death. More horrifying is that they do so with childlike innocence, reveling in the corruption of all life with a sense of wonder and joy, unable to grasp the evil they have

embraced.

days now. instead sending a representative (see “The Circle of Masters" in area 5). Times in Neverlight Grove are strange and worrisome indeed.

M E LDI NG Myconids share everything through melding. Rapport spores carry a tiny bit of all myconids to the other myconids in their circle, to be absorbed and reside within them, and creating a telepathic familial bond. When the myconids of a circle gather to meld, they share their individual insights, fears, hopes, and dreams. Through the melding, all myconids join together to form ihe heart and sou! of a colony. Z UGGTMOY ’ S I NFLUENCE

Initially weakened by the summoning ritual that wrenched her from the Abyss, Zuggtmoy found her way to Neverlight Grove, drawn by the strength of its fungal vitality. Upon her arrival, she quickly assessed the situation, realizing the shortest path to gain control of the grove would he to sway and corrupt its original sovereign to serve her until she recovered her strength. After being welcomed to the grove by Phylo, Zuggtmoy melded with the sovereign in secret, seducing it with the promise of a paradise for the mushroom folk if Phylo would lead them to become her followers on rhe Material Plane. Its mind completely lost inside the demon queen’s insidiously mad vision, Phylo became enthralled by the promise of plentifnl soil and moisture, perpetual rot, and beautiful transcendent dreams to be shared in a never-ending communal melding—all offered to the grove’s folk as generous and wondrous gifts from the Lady of Decay. Everyday melding has now become a subtle ideological war between supporters of the two myconid sovereigns. Phylo is slowly convincing the mushroom folk to follow the new path. Basidia and its dwindling supporters argue against the new way, even as they lose ground (and allies) each time the circles of the grove share consciousness. As more and more myconids unwittingly become vessels for Zuggtmoy's spores, Neverlight Grove becomes a more extravagantly festive place. The quiet, contemplative joy of the mushroom folk’s way of life is being inexorably replaced by decadent, enraptured euphoria and the madness that euphoria hides.

NEVERLIGHT GROVE

Population: 150 myconids and spore servants Government: Organized circles ruled by larger specimens called circle leaders: even larger specimens called sovereigns rule the entire colony Defense: Spore servants and awakened zurkhwoods Commerce: None Organizations: Seven myconid circles; Zuggtmoy's servants Myconids have lived in Neverlight Grove for untold generations, experiencing little or no change in their lives until recently. Now their world is being altered

faster than many of the fungus folk can keep up

with -as is their world view, twisted by the chaotic and orrupting influence of the Demon Queen of Fungi. Upon her arrival in the Underdark, Zuggtmoy found Neverlight Grove and took up residence there. The myconids welcomed her. sealing their fate. Through telepathically shared dreams, corruption has taken root deep within the colony, warping the myconids’ normally placid and peaceful nature into something restive and rapturous. A few realize what is happening and try to resist, but internal strife is alien to the myconids they will not prevail without outside aid to save them.

1. F UNGA L W I LD S

The myconids cultivate this stretch of wilderness as -heir first line of defense, creating a living palisade. Fungal creatures and wild Underdark beasts form a rich ecosystem here. 9

1

cultivating certain fungi. Water trickling from the walls of this vast cavern are channeled into a crude but effective terraced irrigation system. A thick, sweet smell fills the air from the thousands of fungi of all colors and sizes, many glowing with a strange, inviting light. C IRCLE OF B UILDERS

This circle is found in the middle terrace, but its members travel to the top and the edges of the cave to harvest the resilient fungi used in their craft. Gasbide. The builders’ circle leader is a pioneering would-be architect and a supporter of Sovereign Phylo. Already driven mad by Zuggtmoy's spores, Gasbide dreams of bizarre, elaborate structures no myconids would ever need, inspired by visions of Abyssal palaces.

Pale cream and beige stalks grow thick and tall, N E V E R L I G H T G R O V E : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

resembling a surface world forest. Fungi grow in profusion everywhere, and it’s hard to find anything resembling a path between them. The giant caps of zurkhwood mushrooms obscure your view of the cavern's ceiling, but luminescent fungi there give off a shimmering aura. With each step taken on the soggy ground, a rank scent of decay rises around you. •

C IRCLE OF H UNTERS

A circle mound sits at the edge of the wilds but still inside them. It belongs to the Circle of Hunters— myconids that pursue creatures in the wilds. In spite of ■heir name, the hunters don’t kill their prey, but merely -rack down creatures that have died near the grove. The hunters bring the remains of such creatures back to be reanimated by their sovereigns, until they are eventually allowed to rot and join the cavern’s detritus bed. Loobamuh. The circle, leader of the hunters, this tall and lean myconid shares Basidia's concerns about Phvlo’s new way, though it is still capable of resisting Phvlo’s corrupted meldings when it joins with the Inner ircle. Loobamuh keeps its opinions to itself, but its wariness spreads to the other hunters when they meld. ementing their loyalty to Basidia. Loobamuh redirects the spore servants and awakened zurkhwoods Phylo creates away from its circle’s territory. Loobamuh is happy to enlist the party's aid in dealing with a few unwelcome monsters that have found their way into the fungal wilds. In particular, the circle leader —,s the adventurers to kill a grick alpha and then take s carcass to Basidia for rcanimation. A shambling mound is also exhausting the soil in the grove and needs to be pul down for the good of the colony. These encounters can occur wherever you wish.

2. N ORTHE R N T E R R A C E S

_____

Visitors encounter the following features throughout Neverlight Grove. Underground Marsh. Water trickles into the large cavern from many places, forming terraces, pools, and streams. This creates an underground marsh ideal for the growth of fungi and the myconids. Abundant Fungi. Mushrooms, molds, and fungi grow in abundance in Neverlight Grove, creating a bizarre yet beautiful tapestry of color. Quiet Cacophony. Myconids don’t speak. They communicate telepathically by emitting their rapport spores. As a result, they live quiet lives. Strange music and singing echoes from the large cavern behind the grove, just loud enough to be noticeable. Otherworldly Light. Luminescent lichen grows across the cavern and spreads to the larger mushrooms, bathing the grove in soft hues of yellow, blue, and violet. Dim light suffuses the entire grove and lends the grove a dreamlike quality. Sentinel Mushrooms. To defend themselves, myconids have cultivated and guided the growth of awakened zurkhwoods (see appendix C) to serve as a kind of palisade around the grove. Zuggtmoy’s Spores. This malevolent disease is spread by myconids transformed by Zuggtmoy’s demonic influence (see "Myconids" in appendix C). A transformed myconid can release the spores in a cloud that fills a 10-foot-radius sphere centered on it, and the cloud lingers for 1 minute. Any flesh-and-blood creature in the cloud when it appears, or that enters it later, must make a Constitution saving throw. The save DC is 8 + the myconid's Constitution modifier + the myconid's proficiency bonus. On a successful save, the creature can't be infected by these spores for 24 hours. On a failed save, the creature is infected with a disease called the spores of Zuggtmoy and also gains a random form of indefinite madness (determined by rolling on the Madness of Zuggtmoy table in appendix D) that lasts until the creature is cured of the disease or dies. While infected in this way, the creature can't be reinfected, and it must repeat the saving throw at the end of every 24 hours, ending the infection on a success. On a failure, the infected creature’s body is slowly taken over by fungal growth, and after three such failed saves, the creature dies and is reanimated as a spore servant if it’s a type of creature that can be (see the "Myconids” entry in the Monster Manual).

The terraces lining the northern walls are suffused with teerzress, and the myconids reserve these areas for

CHAPTER 5 I NEVTERJ_IGHT GROVE

88

If Gasbide interacts with the characters using rapport spores, it demands descriptions of surface-world structures, bristling with an excitement seldom seen in myconids. It asks for exasperatingly minor details such as the precise dimensions of bricks or the density of lumber. Gasbide reveals through the rapport that it dreams of building a fungal tower “even greater than Yggmorgus." It hopes to break through the Underdark to the surface world, possibly “with the aid of Araumycos." Gasbide has no conscious knowledge of what Araumycos is, sensing only that it is part of the great celebration to come. See “Yggmorgus” (at the end of this chapter) and chapter 16. “The Fetid Wedding," for more information. C IRCLE OF G ROWERS

The circle mound of the growers is on the top terrace, near the cavern wall. The growers are the colony’s farmers, ensuring the soil beneath the pools remains fertile and tending the fungi there. Hebopbe. The leader of the growers doesn't care much for Phylo's new ideas. But though it misses mass meldings, Hebopbe doesn't see Basidia’s protests as worthy of concern. Hebopbe is infected by Zuggtmoy’s spores, but isn’t yet under her control.

3. C E NT R AL B A SIN This depression in the cavern floor is the main part of the myconid colony. The central circle mound was only recently created, and is now a kind of “town square" where all the grove’s myconids gather for mass meldings. These have become rare, however, reserved for when Phylo wants to stoke the myconids' enthusiasm for the celebration that only those infected by Zuggtmoy know about. This leaves the uninfected confused but happy that something joyous is about to happen. Beyond the mud and mushrooms that spread across the cavern, a large, clear pool sits in the midst of the fungal grove. A central mound seems to be the only dry spot in sight, though a small cliff rises above the cavern floor far across the clearing, with giant mushrooms visible in the distance. Bioluminescent fungi trace strange constellations along the cavern's ceiling and walls, showing the darkness of the ravine and a mist-shrouded smaller cavern beyond.

I NNER C IRCLE

The central mound is the base of the colony’s two myconid sovereigns. Phylo and Basidia. They hold court together with three myconid adult councilors named Brelup, Posbara. and Breberil. Ten awakened zurkhwoods (see appendix C) protect the mound and obey either of the sovereigns. Sovereign Phylo. The sovereign towers above the other myconids, its multiple caps swaying with the sinuous shifting of its thick stalk as it moves. Once it spreads its rapport spores, Phylo welcomes the characters with honest enthusiasm doubly so if they have returned Stool and Rumpadump to their home.

“You are safe, friendly softers. You arrive at a wondrous time, for Neverlight Grove is on the verge of something great, something marvelous! Celebrate, as the day of joy is nigh!

Phylo invites the characters to stay as long as they wish, inviting them to explore and enjoy the many delights of Neverlight Grove. He politely asks that they avoid the eastern plateau because the Circle of Masters is preparing “a wondrous and glorious surprise” in the Garden of Welcome. Phylo offers to give them a peek the next day if they want. If Sarith is with the characters, he suggests they accept this offer, saying that keeping on the sovereign's good side will help the party in the long term. In truth, he is attempting to deliver the adventurers to Zuggtmoy. Phylo goes on about how “the Great Seeder” who lives beyond the garden can answer any questions they have. The sovereign describes this entity in favorable terms, using “she” and “her” as it does so. Because myconids have no concept of gender, this unusual speech is further indication of Phylo's madness. However, the sovereign dodges any question about who the Great Seeder actually is, saying it is important for the characters to experience her first hand. Sovereign Basidia. A successful DC 12 Wisdom (Insight) check reveals that Sovereign Basidia is uncomfortable with Phylo’s behavior. Stool and Rumpadump can easily discern that the harmony between Phylo and Basidia is off. At the earliest opportunity, Basidia volunteers to show the characters around, or finds another opportunity to rapport with them privately. When alone with the characters, Basidia warns them about staying in Neverlight Grove too long. It tells them another group of "softers" (the name myconids use for fleshy creatures) arrived not too many cycles ago and accepted Phylo's offer. They were taken to the Garden of Welcome and Basidia hasn't seen them since, nor has Phylo made any further mention of them (see “Questions for the Sovereigns”). Basidia also tells the characters that the Circle of Masters is taking most of the carcasses the Circle of Hunters bring in, and are sending groups of myconids outside the grove without telling anybody. If Basidia rapports with Sarith or any other nonmyconid infected with Zuggtmoy’s spores, it senses the alien nature of the demon lord’s corruption. It can't identify Zuggtmoy’s spores, but knows only that it has not encountered them before. This is unusual, Basidia tells the party, since most myconid sovereigns recognize all spores produced by myconids throughout the Underdark. Questions for the Sovereigns. If the characters ask the sovereigns to help them return to the surface world, both are apologetic that they know of no routes. However, Basidia notes that during its colony's migration, the many travelers from the surface world CHAPTER 5 INEVERLIGHT GROVE

89

they encountered were mostly merchants on

CHAPTER 5 | NEVERLIGHT GROVE

90

ifiiuaSi i :heir way to or from Blingdenstone, Gracklstugh, or Menzobcrranzan. If the adventurers ask the sovereigns about any drow in the area, Basidia tells them about a drow patrol that just recently arrived. However. Phylo immediately interrupts, telling the characters that the drow were here a few days ago. but left shortly after Phylo showed them the Garden of Welcome. A successful DC 12 Wisdom (Insight) check reveals that Basidia seems puzzled by Phylo's answer. If pressed, Basidia simply says it didn't know the drow had already left. Quest: Into the Garden. Basidia offers to give the party a guided tour of all the circles in areas 1 through 4. where it introduces them to the respective circle leaders, pointing out which leaders support it, and which ones support Sovereign Phylo. Basidia uses this time away from Phylo to express its fear that Phylo has contracted some sort of “diseased spore." Basidia hinks that a clue to the spore’s nature might be found in the Garden of Welcome, Basidia asks the characters to investigate the garden, fearing to do so itself in case :t also falls victim to Phylo’s disease. As a sign of friendship, Basidia gives the characters a moldy scroll case containing a scroll of protection .-.gainst fiends. Basidia promises an additional reward see “Treasure”) if the characters investigate the

Garden of Welcome on its behalf. Basidia can also brew potions out of the different molds and fungi in the grove, storing them in hollow gourd-like mushrooms. Basidia can craft a common or uncommon potion in eight hours, or a rare potion in two days. T REASURE

If the characters complete Basidia’s quest, the myconid sovereign digs up a small box buried in the earth and gives it to them. The box contains curiosities Basidia has collected from dead travelers over the years. The box is unlocked, made of fine wood inlaid with silver, and worth 25 gp by itself. It contains three amethysts (100 gp each), four small diamonds (50 gp each), and one large diamond (500 gp). If the characters kill the grick alpha, the umber hulk, or the shambling mound in the Fungal Wilds and bring the carcasses to Basidia, the sovereign rewards each character with a potion of greater healing stored in a hollow gourd-like mushroom. C IRCLE OF S PORERS

This circle mound is devoted to sporing new' myconids. Freshly spored myconids are only a few7 inches tall and have no awareness, but they grow7 quickly into myconid sprouts. CHAPTER 5 INEVERLIGHT GROVE

91

4. S OUT HE R N T E R R AC E S _____________

The terraces along the southern rim of the cavern are narrower and not as fertile as the northern ones. These terraces are quiet and calm. The only sounds here are soft, “ploopy" splashes as water drips from stalactites above onto the caps of oversized mushrooms sprouting from mushy earth.

C IRCLE OF E XPLORERS

This circle is the smallest in Neverlight Grove, since it is merely the temporary home for restless myconids that brave the Underdark as scouts, patrols, and pathfinders. Rasharoo. This circle leader is loyal to Basidia. Frequent trips outside the grove have allowed Rasharoo to notice the changes in Phylo and the entire colony more sharply, and it now trusts nothing and no one except Basidia. Its paranoia isn't the product of Zuggtrnoy’s corruption, however, but of the rising madness gripping the Underdark from the intrusion of the demon lords. If the characters demonstrate sympathy with Basidia or if the sovereign is with them. Rasharoo discloses it has a few escape plans ready, and has nutrient caches hidden along exit tunnels in case Basidia decides it is better to abandon the grove and return to a nomadic lifestyle. Characters can climb the eastern corner of the top terrace to reach area 5. and Rasharoo gladly helps them if they head to the Garden of Welcome at Basidia’s request. Yrberop. The circle leader is infected by Zuggtmoy’s

madness. It is always swaying to music only it can hear, but those in rapport with Yrberop can hear a faint echo of its internal cacophony. Yrberop is enthusiastic about Phylo’s plan to spread the happiness brought by the Great Seeder to everyone in the Underdark and beyond. For that to happen, the colony needs many more sprouts. If the characters confer with Basidia, Stool, or Rumpadump, these myconids tell them this push to expand the population is unusual, given the balance that the myconids have endeavored to maintain in Nevcrlight Grove for so long. Yrberop loses track of any conversation after a short while and begins talking to the newly spored myconids instead. Characters who communicate with Yrberop in rapport and succeed on a DC 13 Wisdom (Insight) check can make out some of the words and impressions in the circle leaders lullaby. It sings of the Great Seeder and “her’ wedding to the Great Body, and how every rrtyconid is invited, bringing joy to all in the world below and above. ChuulSpore Servants. Behind the myconid breeding grounds is a narrow path leading up to a plateau and the Garden of Welcome (area 5). Two chuul spore servants (see appendix C) guard this path. They don't allow anyone to pass without Yrberop’s permission, which the circle leader doesn’t grant, even at Basidia’s request.

D EVELOPMENTS

Among the myconids. Rasharoo and its circle are the adventurers' best hope of finding a way back to the surface. Rasharoo knows many promising paths, but since myconids have no interest in the sunlit world, it has never followed them all the way there. The circle leader helps the characters only after they complete Basidia’s quest, assigning one of its explorers to guide the characters to their destination.

5. G AR DE N

OF W E LC OME Phylo has converted this unused terrace for the exciting new ideas that Zuggtmoy has inspired in it—ideas that are ’’too incredible” for the rest of the colony to absorb at once. This so-called garden is just a sample of the horrors that Zuggtmoy, the Demon Queen of Fungi, intends to bring to the Underdark. This plateau rises higher than the other terraces, screened by a natural fence of soaring zurkhwood stalks. Muffled murmuring can be heard from atop the plateau.

C IRCLE OF M ASTERS

The newest circle in the colony, the Circle of Masters is formed exclusively by myconids touched by Zuggtmoy. These myconids share Phylo’s vision of happiness spread through Zuggtmoy's spores, experimenting on the carcasses brought to them by the hunters—or on live prisoners they hunt in their own expeditions outside the grove. Their mound lies at the center of an obscene garden. Yestabrod. Mutated by Zuggtmoy's spores, the circle leader has become an abomination. No longer recognizable as a myconid, it looks like a fungal larva slithering along the ground. Mold and lichen grow in hypnotic patterns along its ringed stalk, and it puffs clouds of spores from a slit resembling a mouth. It can use this orifice to actually speak, rather than depending on rapport spores. It no longer attends melds with the other leaders, instead sending its representative. G ARDEN

OF

H ORROR

As the characters enter the garden, they make a frightening discovery. The low muttering grows louder as you reach the top,

“Welcome, travelers." The aberrant myconid's voice gurgles and spits as it speaks both aloud and in your minds at once. “Are you here for the wedding rehearsal? Friends of the bride or her intended? No matter! Let the love of the Great Seeder embrace you as you become one with her chosen, the Great Body!”

As the garden comes alive with screams from its buried victims, Yestabrod raises two drow spore servants (sec appendix C). At the same time, twro myconid adults from the Circle of Masters emerge from the surrounding growth, all of the creatures following the circle leader as he attacks. If Sarith Kzekarit (see chapter 1) is still with the party, he screams in agony as Yestabrod attacks. The characters can only watch as the drowns head splits open, releasing a cloud of infecting spores and turning him into another drow spore servant that joins the fight. If Yestabrod is slain and there are still drow spore servants active, they go limp and stop attacking, at which point the myconids from the Circle of Masters attempt to flee.

turning into a symphony of moans, cries, and hisses.

T REASURE

The only light comes from a few glowing mushrooms along

Xinaya's equipment is piled in a heap not far from where she was buried. Characters searching the pile find a suit of +2 studded leather armor, a +2 shortsword, and a hag of holding containing two spell scrolls (remove curse and spider climb), 40 days of rations, and 320 sp. The drow spore servants wear chain shirts and carry shortswords. All of the armor and weapons found here are of drow construction (see the “Drowcraft Items" sidebar in appendix B).

the edge, but even in the gloom, you can't miss the source of the sounds. The heads of creatures of a dozen humanoid Underdark races peek from the ground, mold and fungi growing around them. One voice calls out loudly in Undercommon—a female drow fighting to speak. “Please ... for your gods of light. , , kill me!" She manages to stir within her living grave, raising a spider medallion half-embedded in the bloated growth that was once her hand. Half her face is rotten and pustulate, a bed for the sprouting of scores of tiny mushrooms. "The Great Seeder... trap ... she's here ... the Lady of Decay ... Zuggtmoy ...”

XP A WARDS

[n addition to the normal creature XP for this encounter, the characters earn a special award of 1,000 XP (divided equally among all party members) for defeating Yestabrod and its minions.

WEDDING REHEARSAL____________________ The drow is Xinaya, a young acolyte of Lolth. She w!as leading a routine scouting patrol O U L of Velkynvelve before llvara contacted her with a sending spell. The patrol was ordered to search near the grove for the characters, anticipating that the escapees might seek shelter among the peaceful mushroom folk. Upon her arrival, Xinaya made the mistake of accepting Phylo's invitation to visit the Garden of Welcome, where she and her patrol quickly became victims of the myconids’ madness. She begs the adventurers to end her suffering and warn her people ahoul the presence of the Demon Queen of Fungi in the Underdark, unaware of the madness that has already erupted in Menzoberranzan and throughout the L'nderdark (see chapter 15). Xinaya is too far gone to he saved, and any amount of damage kills her. Alter the characters speak with Xinaya, Yestabrod appears (see appendix C). The master of the foul garden rakes delight in toying with trespassers.

After the confrontation with Yestabrod, the characters can hear sound and movement from the cavern to the northeast. Read the following boxed text if the characters investigate.

The moans of the garden’s victims suddenly take on a new tone of fear as something moves across the foul ground. A disgusting larval creature rises up before you, showing only vestigial fungal growths that hint that it might once have been a myconid. CHAPTER 5 I NEVERLIGHT GROVE

93

The tableau of the mock wedding is replaced by a vision of Echoes spill from the misty cavern beyond, a cacophony of

the inside of a great tower. Spiraling stairs and balconies

wheezing voices that wrap together like some kind of

are carved into its walls, with the interior lit by

discordant music. The remaining heads planted in the

phosphorescent patches of mold growing in whorls. In the

Garden of Welcome begin to croak and groan, joining the

center of the open space floats a humanoid figure,

horrible song.

womanlike in form, but made entirely of fungi and mold.

Through the mist that shrouds the smaller cavern,

She is easily three times the height of the fungal

you see the parade of creatures responsible for the

bridesmaids that move up and down the spiraling stairs,

melody. Their bodies are only vaguely humanoid, with

tending to their giant mistress. They croon a strange,

clusters of luminescent lichen and tumescent growths

soothing song as they weave the substance of the giant

forming chaotic patterns on their decaying flesh, their

figure into delicate lichen veils and a long, mycelium train

voices stabbing into your minds, both insane and

like a bridal gown.

gleeful in equal parts; From rocky bed the toadstool rose, From chaos dark, her love She shows. Wish! Yearn! Laugh! The Lady will be wed! CraveI Hunger! Dance! Her joyous spores will spread! Youth is gone, beauty rots, Araumycos and Zuggtmoy! Joined together, heart to heart, Becoming one 'til death do part! Hail! Hail! Hail!

The entourage is composed of twelve bridesmaids of Zuggtmoy and six chamberlains of Zuggtmoy (see appendix C for both), all of which are lost in their own reverie. They are in the midst of conducting an obscene ritual of some sort—like a parody of a wedding ceremony. Zuggtmoy's thralls make their way to Yestabrod’s garden, attacking only if the characters stand in their way. Any character reduced to 0 hit points in this encounter is knocked unconscious rather than killed. If all the characters are knocked unconscious, the party wakes up in a fungi-tilled cave ld6 t 4 miles away from Neverlight Grove, with or without their NPC companions (at your discretion). Their drow pursuit level decreases by 1, and each character is infested with Zuggtmoy’s spores (see the “Neverlight Grove; General Features” sidebar). D EVELOPMENT

If left alone, the thralls enact a mock wedding, with a chamberlain and a bridesmaid standing in for Araumycos and Zuggtmoy. Yestabrod, if alive, assumes the role of priest to preside over the vows. If Yestabrod is dead, three spore servants rise from the garden and carry its corpse, moving it like a puppet to play out the part of priest. At this point of the ceremony, any onlookers experience a vision.

CHAPTER 5 I NEVERLIGHT GROVE

94

The vision ends when the ceremony does, after which the creatures file solemnly back to Yggmorgus. Characters witnessing the wedding rehearsal and the accompanying vision must succeed on a DC 10 Wisdom saving throw or gain one level of madness (see “Madness" in chapter 2). If the characters share their experience with Basidia, the sovereign leads the two circles loyal to it out of Neverlight Grove before it is too late. Alternatively, the characters can follow the wedding procession into Yggmorgus and witness the further horrors waiting for the Underdark if Zuggtmoy rises in power. XP A WARDS

In addition to the XP gained for defeating Zuggtmoy's bridesmaids or chamberlains, each characters gains 100 XP for witnessing the wedding rehearsal.

YGGMORGUS When Zuggtmoy arrived in the. Underdark, she was immediately drawn to Neverlight Grove and its fungal riches. She cultivated Yggmorgus, a mushroom of titanic proportions, from the rich, rotting soil. Conveniently secluded from the rest of the Underdark. Yggmorgus is a perfect base of operations for the Demon Queen of Fungi. She has completely enthralled Phylo. and the hapless sovereign is growing a myconid and spore servant army for her. Zuggtmoy has also become aware of Araumycos, the largest fungal life form- and possibly the largest creature of any kind in the world, Araumycos is a vast fungus colony with a single mind, which tills the caverns and tunnels of the Underdark in an area the size of the High Forest. Araumycos is so interwoven with the fabric of the world that control of it would grant Zuggtmoy nearly unlimited power in her new home. Though Yggmorgus can't be seen clearly from the main cavern of Neverlight Grove, the unholy lights and sounds there can be discerned and sometimes even felt. Characters who ask the myconids about it receive mixed responses. Sovereign Phylo and those loyal to it enter a state of near bliss when they speak about Yggmorgus, as if it was a paradise. Sovereign Basidia and its followers give wary answers. Phylo’s secrecy means that they aren't sure what lies beyond the ravine.

GIANT MUSHROOM TOWER

The cavern around Yggmorgus is huge, and the giant mushroom nearly fills it from floor to ceiling. You have no clear reference to judge the towering mushroom's size at this distance. Thousands of smaller fungi ding to the main stalk, which itself splits into several lesser stalks, each long enough with a cap big enough to be the top of a great tower. The cavern floor surrounding the stalk is covered by a carpet of fungi. An eerie luminescence pours through slitted windows carved into the trunk, with the same cacophony of atonal music heard earlier echoing within. A stench of rot and decay wraps around you, seemingly threatening to penetrate your flesh and pervade your soul.

Yestabrod’s Garden of Welcome is a pale reflection of the true horrors surrounding Yggmorgus. A 20-foot- high crescent-shaped ledge hugs the cavern wall and gradually slopes down to the lower basin. The ledge is covered with a carpet of moss and fungi, scores of variously sized lumps, and pockmarks where pools of vile fluids suppurate and ooze, some drying out and scabbing over. The entire ledge is difficult terrain. Characters venturing this close to Yggmorgus must succeed on a DC 11 Wisdom saving throw or gain one level of madness (see "Madness” in chapter 2). Characters can discern the shapes of writhing creatures inside each lump. Most of these arc humanoids, though a few of the lumps arc occupied by what appear to be gricks, nothics, and giant spiders. This is the Great Garden of Rot. nourished both by the creatures subsumed within it and the faerzress pervading this cavern. As if on cue, one of the lumps closest to the characters bubbles up and bursts. A dense cloud of spores and dark, reeking fluid explodes outward, even as the characters hear a piercing scream of agony and terror. Inside the pockmark left behind by the burst Is one of Xinaya's draw scouts—or at least what’s left of him. Other than a face, long white hair, and a breastplate, it is impossible to distinguish where the drow ends, and the rot and fungi consuming him begins. The drow feebly thrashes, his screams rising ever higher in pitch, until he locks eyes writh one of the characters and abruptly stops screaming. A brief moment of lucidity replaces his terror, even as his eyes roll back into his head in some kind of bizarre euphoria as he goes limp and slowly sinks back down into the fungal muck. Characters witnessing this must succeed on a DC 13 Wisdom saving throw or gain one level of madness. Throughout the entire cavern, loud moans and cries of agony answer the draw's screams in a terrifying and deafening chorus, drowning out all other sounds until eventually winding down into a low susurration f groans and burbles. The entire

stalk of the giant mushroom seems to shudder, almost as if in delight.

Characters who descend to the cavern's lower basin Whether they politely avoid Phylo’s invitation or flee witness the next spectacle of unspeakable horror spawned by for their lives and sanity from the Demon Queen of the Lady of Decay. Fungi, the adventurers can easily receive the aid of Sovereign Basidia and the circles still loyal to it. Where MAD DANCE the characters go next is up to them—a decision Scores of deformed creatures dance around the base of the dependent upon where they have been, the pursuing giant fungal tower. The revelers are a motley collection of humanoids and various other creatures, all sporting tumors, drow, and whatever they have acquired (food, potions, treasure from the doomed drow patrol, and so on) cankers, and putrid patches of flesh all over their bodies. during their visit to the grove. They are joined by dancing fungi vaguely shaped and Depending on how the characters interacted with the twisted into forms resembling humanoids. Some of these myconids and what tasks they accomplished for their creatures are spore servants enthralled to the Demon Queen hosts, they might depart in the company of a myconid of Fungi. Others are myconids and other fungal life forms guide, or even two whole circles of myconids fleeing infested with Zuggtmoy’s spores. the grove before Zuggtmoy’s madness takes them. The dancing creatures pay no attention to trespassers Sovereign Phylo doesn't stop the characters or unless they are attacked. In that event, ld6 drow spore Sovereign Basidia from leaving, still convinced the servants and ld6 hook horror spore servants (see appendix C cause it embraces is one of joy and prosperity for its for both) stop dancing and turn on their attackers. people. Voices can be heard cackling and chatting amiably about In all probability, the characters leave the fungal Sovereign Phylo’s success at "bringing so many new guests grove with dire and horrific news. They have witnessed to attend the party!” The characters see drow dancing as if the effect a single demon lord can have on the Material their bones were melting, duergar roaring with mock Plane—and they realize far more and worse things are merriment and vomiting slime, and even nothics laughing coming. madly as they leap and caper. Regardless of how many battles the characters might If the characters observe the mad dance for a few rounds, have had inside Neverlight Grove, discovering that a they see a form rising up out of the fungal muck. It is the demon lord is on the loose on the Material Plane is a drow scout whose terrible end they just witnessed, wading major revelation. Moreover, if they were in Sloobludop out to join the other revelers in their mad dance. A character to witness the rise of Dcmogorgon. they now know that who witnesses this grotesque moment must succeed on a DC more than one demon lord is at large, hinting at the 15 Wisdom saving throw or gain one level of madness. magnitude of the threat. If the adventurers simply passed through the grove GREAT PALACE Yggmorgus is the home that Zuggtmoy, the Demon Queen and enjoyed the hospitality of the doomed myconids, of Fungi, has carved for herself inside the great mushroom. they leave with only suspicions about their odd The general layout is simple enough, with the hollowed stalk behavior, which can help them later in piecing together of the mushroom making a towering central hall in which the greater mystery in the Underdark. Zuggtmoy floats, surrounded by spiraling balconies where If the adventurers learned nothing about the presence her growing number of bridesmaids attend her, singing as of Zuggtmoy or her plans, you might pass the they weave her bridal gown to prepare for the fateful information on to them by having a friendly myconid wedding day. such as Stool or Rumpadump come to them just as they If the adventurers enter Yggmorgus. they come face to are leaving. The myconid enters rapport and shows face with Zuggtmoy (see appendix D). attended by twelve them a vision of the Garden of Welcome and bridesmaids of Zuggtmoy (see appendix C). Fortunately for Yggmorgus, saying these images come from the minds them, Zuggtmoy is deep in meditation as her gown and veil of other myconids in the grove, and asking what these are being prepared. She doesn't move, although she can “strange dreams” mean. speak and use her other abilities. Her bridesmaids attempt to chase off intruders, wailing and scolding them about how it is unlucky for them to see the bride before it is time. If the characters don’t withdraw immediately, Zuggtmoy awakens and uses her Mind Control Spores ability to send them away, using her Infestation Spores only if the characters insist on engaging the demon lord here and now. Dozens of spore servants and myconids respond to Zuggtmoy's telepathic call if their mistress is in danger, attacking the characters heedless of their own safety. Any attack that successfully deals damage to Zuggtmoy damages her gown, driving the demon queen into a rage to attack the intruders. CHAPTER 5 | NEVERLIGHT GROVE

LEAVING NEVERLIGHT GROVE 94

Leaving the myconid enclave is easier than finding it.

. *1

C H A P T E R 6: B L I N G D E N S T O N E Blingdcnstone, once called the City of Speaking Stones, is a deep gnome settlement founded more than two millennia ago. The deep gnomes, insular and secretive by nature, care little about histories and legacies, and thus most of the ruined city’s past is lost to time. For centuries, Blingdenstone remained hidden and isolated from the rest of the Underdark, thanks to a combination of misdirection and magic. It wasn’t until they provided shelter to a drow exile named Drizzt Do’Urden that the deep gnomes began to take a more active interest in the world outside their caverns. Perceiving the threat the drow represented to all the peoples of the Underdark, the deep gnomes abandoned their isolation when they came to the defense of the dwarves of Mithral Hall, defeating an invading drow force from Menzoberranzan. This alliance, however, would spell Blingdenstone’s doom. The vengeful drow bided their time, rebuilt their forces, and sent their armies out to strike back hard against the svirfneblin, returning in great force to lay siege to Blingdenstone. The deep gnomes were no match

for the drow army. Thousands of svirfneblin were

CHAPTER 6 I BLINGDENSTONE

95

slaughtered, and those survivors who didn't escape to \. Mithral Hall or the surface world were dragged back in chains to Menzoberranzan as slaves. Within the past decade or so. the deep gnomes have returned to reclaim, resettle, and rebuild their city. The ultimate success of their efforts, however, hangs by a slender thread. Most of the ruined city is a dangerous place and remains closed off. with tunnels and chambers barricaded with gates or deliberately caused cave-ins. The svirfneblin must contend with incursions by wererat squatters, insane elementals, ghosts, and a plague of invading oozes controlled by the Pudding King—a mad deep gnome under the influence of the demon lord Juiblex. Before they can offer the party any help, the deep gnomes likely need some themselves.

GOING TO BLINGDENSTONE Blingdenstone is an obvious destination for characters seeking refuge from their drow pursuers and a way out of the Underdark. The deep gnomes continue to have regular dealings with the surface world.

CHAPTER 6 I BLINGDENSTONE

96

Among die party's fellow escapees, the deep gnome Jimjar is the most enthusiastic about visiting Blingdenstone, and he can lead the adventurers there. Topsy and Turvy also know the way, but they are noticeably less willing to go to the settlement because of the fear and shame they feel regarding their lycanthropic. affliction. The shield dwarf scout Eldeth Feldrun isn’t sure how to reach the gnome settlement, but is in favor of going (here if it offers a route to the surface or to Gauntlgrym. if the characters allow Glabbagool (the sentient gelatinous cube from “The Oozing Temple" in chapter 2) to accompany them, it feels a certain pull toward Blingdenstone, and is curious enough to guide the characters there.

C HANGING S VIRFNEBLIN ATTITUDES

D R OW P UR SU E R S ______________________

R ANDOM E NC OUNT E R S IN B LI NG DE NST ONE ______________________

The svirfneblin settlement is a haven for the characters. For good reason, the deep gnomes rarely allow drow into Blingdenstone, and only then with a heavily armed escort. A drow character must succeed on a DC 15 Charisma (Persuasion) check to enter escorted. However, if any deep gnomes are traveling with the party, having them vouch for the drow allows the escort to be waived at your discretion. The party's drow pursuers won’t attempt to follow the characters into Blingdenstone. The party’s pursuit level (see “Drow Pursuit" in chapter 2) doesn’t change while they are in the svirfneblin settlement. If the party’s pursuit level is 3 or higher when they arrive at Blingdenstone. llvara and her party are watching the tunnels leaving the settlement. The pursuit level increases to 5 when the characters leave Blingdenstone. possibly leading to a chase or straight into chapter 7, “Escape From the Underdark."

The general attitude of deep gnomes toward strangers is hostile—not necessarily opposed, but deeply suspicious. This attitude can be shifted to indifferent and then friendly as the characters help the svirfneblin openly (see “Social Interaction’’ in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide). Some deeds in Blingdenstone reward the characters with an automatic attitude shift, while others require a DC 15 group Charisma (Persuasion) check. If the group check succeeds, the attitude of the svirfneblin shifts by one. If characters are rude or act in a way to make the deep gnomes more suspicious toward them, they must also make another group check. If this group check fails, the deep gnomes' attiiude worsens by one.

Once per day while the characters are exploring the deep gnome settlement, roll a d20 and consult the Blingdenstone Encounters table to determine what, if anything, they encounter. BLINGDENSTONE ENCOUNTERS dZO 1-10 11 12 13 14 15

Encounter No encounter ld4 + 1 animated drow statues ld4 + 2 cave badgers Dungeon hazard Elemental vagabonds ld4 + 2 fiendish giant spiders

16 17 18 19

1 ghost

20

1 xorn

Mephit gang Roaming ooze ld4 + 1 svirfneblin wererats

A R R IV ING

AT B LIN G D E N STON E Blingdenstone has a reputation for being a dangerous ruin inhabited only by monsters and other undesirables. Others ANIMATED DROW STATUES Once part of a expedition from Menzoberranzan, these think of it as a budding settlement well on ils way to recovery. Once the characters reach the gates, they can see drow were petrified by a medusa and later animated by Ogremoch’s Bane (see “Settlers, Squatters, and Invaders” that the truth lies somewhere in between. later in this chapter). They have the statistics of animated armor, except ihey are elcmentals instead of constructs. R O L E P L AYI N G T H E S V I R F N E B L I N Deep gnomes are a dour lot, reserved and careful in their dealings with outsiders. They make the assumption that every non-svirfneblin C AVE B ADGERS means to do them harm—which is understandable given their history. The svirfneblin use these beasts as part of their digging They speak softly in caves and tunnels where sound carries, eyes workforce. Cave badgers are giant badgers with AC 12 darting furtively, looking for signs of danger. (natural armor), tremorsense out to a range of 60 feet, and Despite their harsh outlook, svirfneblin are still gnomes, and many a burrowing speed of 15 feet. When they burrow, they are as benevolent and joyful as their surface cousins. They reveal leave tunnels behind them. these aspects most easily among their own kind, and to those they come to trust. The svirfneblin assign defined roles to each gender but hold D UNGEON H AZARD females and males in equal standing. It is ancient custom for there to The characters approach a section of Blingdenstone in be both a king and a queen with equal responsibilities. Svirfneblin horrible disrepair. If they explore the area, roll a d6 males are hunters, explorers, laborers, and warriors, while females are managers, judges, politicians, and caretakers. Deep gnomes sometimes forget this is not the case with other races, and that males are capable of careful thought just as much as females can fight.

The characters must prove their goodwill to ihe deep gnomes before they are allowed inside. Once the characters win the gnomes' trust, they are welcomed into Inner Blingdenstone, and to what food and comfort the locals can readily provide. CHAPTER 6 | BUNGDF.NSTONL

and consult the Dungeon Hazards table to determine what the characters encounter. See “Dungeon Hazards” in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide for more information on each hazard.

svirfneblin wererats are Small and have the following additional features.

D UNGEON H AZARDS d6

Innate Spellcasting. The wererat’s innate spellcasting ability is

1-3

Patch of brown mold

4-

5

6

Hazard

Patch of green slime

Patch of yellow mold

Cnome Cunning. The wererat has advantage on Intelligence, Wisdom, and

Charisma saving throws against magic. Intelligence (spell save DC 11). It can innately cast the following spells, requiring no material components: At will: nondetection (self only) 1 /day each: blindness/deafness, blur, disguise self

E LEMENTAL V AGABONDS

Stone Camouflage. The wererat has advantage on Dexterity (Stealth)

A dust mephit guides an earth elemental through the caverns and passages of Blingdenstone. If approached peacefully, they can point the way to Entemoch's Boon (see “Blingdenstone Outskirts" later in this chapter).

checks made to hide in rocky terrain.

F IENDISH G IANT S PIDERS

Former servants of the draw, these spiders burn with baleful energy. Treat them as giant wolf spiders with a challenge rating of 1/2 (100 XP). resistance to cold, fire, and lightning damage, and immunity to poison damage. They arc also immune to the poisoned condition. G HOST

Some of the svirfneblin who perished during the drow invasion didn’t go easily, and their ghosts linger. When the characters encounter one of these ghosts, roll a d20 and consult the Ghost’s Attitude table to determine the attitude of the ghost. G HOST ’ S A TTITUDE d20 Attitude 1-6 Indifferent and unaware of the characters until it is attacked by them 712 Indifferent but aware of the characters 1317 Friendly 1820 Hostile

XORN

This creature leaves the characters alone if they feed it as least 50 gp worth of gems or precious metals. Otherwise, it follows them around Blingdenstone, hoping that they leave behind something it can eat. The xorn is antisocial and doesn’t help the party in anyway. I M P O RTAN T NPC S

When the characters visit Blingdenstone, they can meet one or more of the following svirfneblin. B LINGDENSTONE NPC S Dorbo Diggermattock Leader of the mining expeditions Senni Diggermattock Leader of the settlers Nomi Pathshutter Earth elemental wrangler with a task for the party Curnik Tapfinger Priest of Callarduran Smoothhands with a task for the party Kazook Pickshine Alchemist and ore specialist who receives and gives quests Chipgrin Goldwhisker Leader of the wererat colony Burrow Warden (adger Undead leader of the burrow wardens The Pudding King Insane deep gnome enthralled by the demon lord Juiblex

M EPHIT G ANG

A mephit gang consists of ld4 dust mephits and ld4 mud mephits. If encountered in Inner Blingdenstone or Rockblight. they are insane and attack immediately. Otherwise, they mock the party but don't fight except in self-defense. R OAMING O OZE

The presence of the Pudding King (see “The Pudding Court” later in this chapter) is drawing oozes to Blingdenstone. Roll a d4 and consult the Roaming Ooze table to determine what appears.

C ORNERED R ATS If they are with the party, Topsy and Turvy do their best to conceal and resist their lycanthropic curse if the adventurers have not already learned of it. In the time since they were imprisoned in Velkynvelve, the two have likely undergone their wererat transformation at least once. When the decision is made to go to Blingdenstone, the twins might come clean about leaving home because of their curse, or they could abandon the adventurers and strike out on their own. In any event, they might fall in with the Goldwhisker clan of wererats, either on their own or with the adventurers’ help.

R OAMING O OZE d4

Encounter

1

1 black pudding

2

1 gelatinous cube

3

ld4 + 1 gray oozes, one of which is a psychic gray ooze variant (as described in the Monster Manual) 4 ld2 ochre jellies S VIRFNEBLIN W ERERATS These wererats belong to Clan

Goldwhisker and are searching for new places to settle within the ruins of the former city. They’re always hostile and attack the party if they can’t flee. Use the wererat stat block in the Monster Manual with a few modifications: CHAPTER 6 i BLINGDENSTONE

97

S E TT LE R S , S Q U ATT E R S , AND I NVAD E R S The current citizens of Blingdenstone are a different breed than their forebears. They aren’t simply hard workers and resourceful miners, but also settlers, explorers, and—above all—survivors. OF B LINGDENSTONE By deep gnome tradition, Blingdenstone is governed jointly by a king and queen, but the svirfneblin have had no true sovereigns while living as refugees for the good part of a century. Dorbo and Senni Diggermattock are talented miners, but they have become even more capable as community leaders. They spent years planning an expedition to Blingdenstone. paying adventurers to scout and keep an eye on the territory while they organized their people across the dwarven holds and surface-world cities that had received them. After a decade of careful and determined planning, the Diggermattocks led a force back to Blingdenstone to reclaim it. While they have not yet been crowned,

L EADERS

Svl BFNEBLIN G HO S TS

settlement. Chief Dorbo oversees rebuilding industry, opening mines, and organizing patrols to explore parts of the ruined city that remain uninhabited by the svirfneblin. He is also responsible for rebuilding and commanding Lhe new settlement's defenses. Like most svirfneblin, Dorbo is serious and aggressive when dealing with outsiders: for all of that, however, he is also a loving and caring husband and a thoughtful leader of his people, devoted to the vision that he and his wife share of a Blingdenstone rebuilt and reborn. Quartermaster Senni takes the count and measure of everything, ensuring her husband’s efforts are well supported and efficient. She oversees the trade efforts and caravans to Mithral Hall, Gaunllgrym, and Mantol-Derith. She manages and helps to maintain Blingdenstone’s magical infrastructure, and is intimately familiar with security conditions across the settlement. As quartermaster, she assigns homes to the ever-increasing numbers of svirfneblin returning to Blingdenstone. M INERS ’ G UILD

The svirfneblin base most of their economic subsistence on their ability to mine ores and gems. The settlement is largely self-sufficient, but it still relies on the duergar of Mantol-Derith for tools, weapons, and supplies.

Because the Blingdenstone economy depends on mining, the Miners' Guild holds a lot of power in Blingdenstone. Led by the Pickshine family, the Miners' Guild oversees all of Blingdenstone's mines, as well as the mining, cutting, and enchanting of spell gems (see appendix B), both for the settlement’s defense and for trade export. S TONEHEART E NCLAVE

everybody treats them as the de facto rulers of the

This group of svirfneblin spellcasters once trained under the Emerald Enclave but eventually splintered off. choosing to focus solely on earth elemental magic. After doing so, they absorbed the surviving priesthood serving the deep gnome deities Segojan Earthcaller (the god of deep earth and nature) and Callarduran Smoothhands (the god of stone and mining). The Stoneheart Enclave is in charge of summoning earth elementals to help defend Blingdenstone. They also use their magic to aid in various engineering tasks, such as widening burrows, closing off tunnels, or establishing spell gem emplacements and defensive measures. When needed, the spellcasters of the Stoneheart Enclave serve as extraplanar diplomats, forging occasional agreements with xorn and galeb duhr to aid Blingdenstone. The enclave’s leader is Yantha Coaxrock, a young female mage who splits her time and energy between conducting magical research in Blingdenstone, aiding the

svirfneblin enclave in Mantol-Derith (see chapter 9), and working with the rest of the Stoneheart Enclave. B URROW W ARDENS CHAPTER 6 I BLINGDENSTONE

98 \ ^___________________________

Most of the honored protectors of the svirfneblin died during the drow invasion, and the rest perished while protecting their people during their flight from

Blingdenstone to Mithral Hall. Only the memory of their valiant effort remains today—and even that is fading due to the deep gnomes7 penchant for forgetting their own history. In the last year, a handful of svirfnehlin youths have been training in secret under the rather terrifying care of the veteran Burrow Warden Jadger, who lingers on as a ghost. In life, Jadger was an expert in the Undcrdark and its many denizens, as well as how to tight them. He is grooming his brightest student, Trisk Adamantelpiece, to command the new burrow wardens, who are preparing to announce their existence to the Diggcrmattocks and demand recognition as the new Burrow Wardens of Blingdenstone. OF B LINGDENSTONE Although not truly organized, the ghosts of the svirfncblin killed during the drow attack are an undeniable presence. The settlers have been wise enough to mark haunted burrows off from their reclamation plans. But as new svirfnehlin arrive and need accommodation, space is starting to become a problem. There are far more ghosts in the ruined settlement than anyone expected, and each ghost is different. Some are harmless, appearing only as echoes of the event that led to their deaths. Others are fully aware—and often hostile and dangerous.

G HOSTS

O GREMOCH ' S B ANE

Ogremoch’s Banc is a drifting cloud of transparent, magical dust that first appeared in Blingdenstone over a century ago. Believed to be sentient, it is found roaming the Rockblight section of the settlement. Elemental creatures touched by the cloud fall under its control. The cloud's origin remains a mystery, but it is known to have something to do with Qgremoch, Prince of Evil Earth. A medusa named Neheedra serves Ogremoch’s Bane and leads some of the elemental creatures that have become enslaved by the evil cloud (see the "Rockblight" section and area 19 in particular). C LAN G OLDWHISKES

After Blingdenstoiie's fall, a gang of wercrats tried to make a home in the ruined city. The last handful of svirfnehlin hiding in Blingdenstone after the drow armies abandoned the city managed to kill or drive off the wererats, but many of the deep gnomes became infected with lycanthropy. Today, deep gnome wererats claims a large chunk of the ruins under the name of Clan Gold whisker, holding territory against new settlers and engaging in urban warfare against them. The pack leader is the cunning snd charismatic Chipgrin, whose concern for his pack’s safety has him hoping to negotiate a truce with the Diggermattocks and stop his svirfnehlin cousins from seeing his people as dangerous monsters fit only for extermination. Chipgrin is all too aware of the threat posed by Ogremoch's Bane and the oozes plaguing the settlement, and he hopes that making common cause against those threats will force the other svirfnehlin to recognize Clan Goldwhisker's right to remain in Blingdenstone.

T HE P UDDING K ING ’ S “C OURT ”

The so-called Pudding King holds court in the deepest sections of Blingdenstone. He was part of the first settler mission led by the Diggermattocks, but the other svirfnehlin soon shunned him for his many disturbing habits, among them his preoccupation with capturing and studying oozes, and his penchant for stealing and hoarding food until it rotted ... and then talking to it. The shunned deep gnome eventually struck out on his own. He spent years living among the oozes of the region, eventually subjugating a black pudding he calls “Princess Ebon mire" and a gray ooze he calls “Prince Livid." When the demon lords arrived in the Underdark, he followed the oozes drawn by juiblex’s presence, immediately throwing himself down before the Faceless Lord and pledging his eternal loyalty. His previous name and existence ended in that moment, and now there is only the Pudding King. Juiblex granted the Pudding King the power to summon and command oozes, then ordered him to return to Blingdenstone and claim it as part of the Faceless Lord's new domain. The Pudding King slipped back into the closed-off areas of Blingdenstone and set up court, summoning all manner of oozes along the way and rendering portions of the ruined city uninhabitable and dangerous to outsiders. Utterly insane and channeling a terrible power, the Pudding King sits upon his throne with his “children" at his side, summoning ever more loyal subjects with each passing day. When he is ready, he will send them forth to cover and devour everything, transforming Blingdenstone and its people into one giant mound of slime and goo formed in the image of his master, the Faceless Lord.

B LINGDENSTONE O UTSKIRTS The quarries, mines, mushroom fields, and forges of Blingdenstone are located outside the settlement, accessible by tunnels and passages beyond the main gate. Trade caravans headed toward Blingdenstone are cither re-routed to the outlying mines, farms, and forges, or they arc stopped at the city gate, where their cargo is searched, unloaded, and distributed by agents of Quartermaster Senni. This keeps unwanted riffraff out of the city proper and protects Blingdenstone's security. The deep gnomes working in the mines, farms, and forges outside the settlement spend less time enjoying the leisure and company of their kin and friends back home. The rising madness of the demon lords affects these brave pioneers more than those who live within the relative security of the reclaimed parts of Blingdenstone. Svirfnehlin in the outskirts are more curt with strangers, and a few might even try to steal from them. Taskmasters at each location are now feeling themselves driven to the point of near tyranny, demanding that their workers toil ever harder. Some miners pocket gemstones they dig out, while others are drawn to possess things

CHAPTER 6 ; BL1NGOENSTONE

99

the adventurers are carrying.

CHAPTER 6 ; BL1NGOENSTONE

100

PROBLEMS CUBED

If the gelatinous cube Giabbagool travels with the party {see chapter 4), its presence poses a few challenges in Blingdenstone. The recent ooze attacks have the deep gnomes rattled, and an intelligent, telepathic gelatinous cube is something beyond their understanding. The characters have to convince the svirfneblin to allow their unusual companion inside, or tell it to remain outside the settlement. If left outside, Giabbagool might eventually find its way in through the wererat warrens, giving the characters insight into how the other oozes are getting in, or appearing in the nick of time to help the characters if they find themselves in peril.

E NT E MOC H ’ S B O O N This large cavern is located west of Blingdenstone (see the map of Underdark regions and locations in chapter 2) and has always been a closely guarded secret. Most svirfneblin who knew of it perished during the draw invasion of Blingdenstone. A few members of the Stoneheart Enclave have heard of its existence, but have either dismissed it as legend or have simply been too preoccupied with the reclaiming and rebuilding of Blingdenstone to search for it. The cave is two days’ walk of the settlement, its entrance a small tunnel leading to a ledge high above the cavern floor. The cave is lined with stalagmites and stalactites, but the dominant feature is the summoning circle at its center. The circle was once used by the svirfneblin to summon Entemoch. a prince of elemental earth, and his energies suffused the entire cavern, empowering elemental summoning within its confines. If the circle is used to cast a spell that summons an earth elemental, the spell’s duration becomes ld4 + 6 days and the spell requires no concentration. The summoned elemental never becomes hostile toward the spell’s caster or its companions. To gain these benefits, the caster must provide material components in the form of gems with a total value of 10 gp per Hit Die of the elemental summoned. FINDING ENTEMOCH’S BOON

Locating the tunnel that leads to Entemoch’s Boon is a great service for the svirfneblin, and might be a quest set for the adventurers (see “Uniting Blingdenstone” later in this chapter). Despite how close the cavern is to Blingdenstone, finding it is no easy task. Characters can search for the tunnel by traveling at a slow pace in its general vicinity. Each day they search, have the characters make a DC 20 group Intelligence (Investigation) or group Wisdom (Survival) check. If the group check succeeds, the characters find a curious way marker: a small pyramid of carefully stacked stones next to the mouth of an otherwise unassuming tunnel. After locating the waymarker and following the tunnel next to it, the party can make a DC 20 group Intelligence (Investigation) or Wisdom (Survival) check. On a failure, the party wastes a day searching for the next waymarker. If the group check succeeds, the characters find their next lead after 2d6 hours: a tunnel whose entrance is flanked by the sculpted faces of a male and female deep gnome. This tunnel features many CHAPTER 6 I BLINGDENSTONE

side tunnels concealed by rock formations. The party must make a DC 20 group Intelligence (Investigation), Wisdom (Perception), or Wisdom (Survival) check. If this group check succeeds, the party finds Entemoch’s Boon; if the check fails, the characters waste a day of exploration searching for it. Finding Entemoch’s Boon allows the characters to make a check to improve the attitude of the deep gnomes (see “Changing Svirfneblin Altitudes"). Random Encounters. For each day of exploration, check for random encounters using the tables in chapter 2 and adjust the drow pursuit level as necessary. THE BEASTS OF ENTEMOCH’S BOON

Characters who explore the cavern find shattered bits of statuary. A successful DC 17 Intelligence (Investigation) check confirms that the stone bits are the remains of petrified cave vermin. Unless they leave the cavern immediately, the characters are accosted by a mated pair of b a s i l i s k s that call Entemoch’s Boon home. Once the basilisks are defeated, characters can resume their exploration of the cave and find three basilisk eggs in a nest made of pulverized stone. Each egg is a 6-inchdiameter, 20-pound sphere with a pebbled-gray shell as hard as stone. Left alone, Lhe eggs hatch in ld4 + 1 months. An infant basilisk that emerges imprints on the first creature it sees. It thereafter follows that creature around like its parent, demanding to be fed. If the characters manage to keep the basilisk alive, it reaches adulthood after twelve months. Track its growth using the Basilisk Maturation table. B ASILISK M ATURATION Age

Infant (up to 3 months)

Young (3-12 months)

Adult

Size Tiny

Notes AC 11; 4 (ld4 + 2) Hit points; speed 10 ft.; Str 10 (+0); no Petrifying Gaze; bite attack is +2 to hit and deals 1 piercing damage plus 1 poison damage on a hit; Challenge 0 (10 XP) Small AC 13; 22 (4d6 + 8) hit points; speed 15 ft.; Str 13 (+1); Petrifying Gaze has a range of 15 feet; bite attack is +3 to hit and deals 3 (ld4 + 1) piercing damage plus 2 (ld4) poison damage on a hit; Challenge 1 (200 XP) Medium See the Monster Manual (12+ months)

W HIT E SHE LL M INE Blingdenstone’s largest salt mine is half a day’s travel to the south. Like many of Blingdenstone’s resource sites, the road to the mine is easy to miss by casual travelers, but sentries hiding along the way can recognize friendly visitors (such as those in the company of Jimjar, Topsy, or Turvy) and guide them along the proper tunnels.

too

CHAPTER 6 DL1NCIJENSTONE

Whiteshell Mine is an interconnected network of small caverns dug into the vast salt veins lining this area of the Underdark. The mine produces enough salt to supply both the Blingdenstone settlers and sell in the market hub of Mantol-Derith. The mine has a cavern devoted to keeping the giant cave lizards the svirfncblin use as beasts of burden. The deep gnome Perigrog Scrapedust runs ihe mine with a fair but demanding hand. He believes that the more the mine produces, the more he can export, and the quicker Blingdenstone can be returned to its former glory.

P IC K SHI NE M IN E S Renamed after the largest and most influential family in the Miners’ Guild, the Pickshine Mines comprise several mines scattered in a wide circle around Blingdenstone. The deep gnomes have engineered the access tunnels in such a way that only one known entrance leads to the mine complex, and this entrance is defended by four galeb duhr disguised to look like ordinary boulders and a dozen deep gnomes. The largest mine shafts include veins of common metals such as iron and copper, as well as many veins of rarer minerals such as mithral and adamantine. The mines also hold crystal caverns where the svirfneblin harvest all manner of gems. All the main routes to Blingdenstone intersect near the mine complex's main entrance, meaning the characters are likely to pass it before arriving in Blingdenstone. If they stop there, they meet Dasco Pickshine, the deep gnome overseer in charge of general operations. Dasco is willing to let the characters tag along with a cargo of ores heading for Blingdenstone, happy to have the extra security.

S TONE HE ART Q U A R RY ___________________ The Stoneheart Enclave has its headquarters in this cavern suffused with faerzress and elemental energy. This quarry doesn’t provide stone for construction, since Blingdenstone builders need only take a pick to any wall to find their building materials. Rather, this cavern provides the small army of earth elementals aiding the settlers, and its magical stone is used in the creation of items such as earth elemental gems, rings of earth elemental command, and stones of controlling earth elementals. Elementals entering into the Material Plane here, whether by spell or other means, have an additional 2 Hit Dice. Normally, Yantha Coaxrock leads the operations in the quarry. While she is in Mantol-Derith (see chapter 9). her apprentice Nomi Pathshutter is in charge of the druids and wizards of the Stoneheart Enclave. E LEMENTAL H EALING

Nomi Path shutter is aware of Ogremoch's Bane and has made it her life’s work to protect elementals from its iniluence. She studies samples of corrupted elementals as part of her efforts, and rewards characters who bring her a sample from any out-of-control earth elemental creature found in the unexplored areas

DOORS OF BLINGDENSTONE

Heavy stone doors reinforced with steel or adamantine are found throughout the deep gnome settlement. Unless otherwise indicated, a door in Blingdenstone has AC 18, 40 hit points, a damage threshold of 15, resistance to thunder damage, and immunity to poison and psychic damage.

of Blingdenstone. She pays 10 gp per Hit Die of the creature from which the sample was taken.

O UTER B LINGDENSTONE

Everything in Outer Blingdenstone was designed to thwart would-be invaders.

1. S TAI R S _____________________________

Rising up to a broad terrace before the gate, these wide stairs are built for gnomish feet. They are difficult terrain for Medium and larger creatures. 1 A . C ART L IFT

At the top of the stairs is a large entrance on the west wall, where wagons are secured on stone sleds pulled by a chain up a steep slope. The hoisting mechanism is at the top of the lift is operated by an earth elemental, although any creature with a Strength of 20 or any group of creatures with the combined strength to lift 600 pounds can operate it. The lift’s tunnel is wide enough for the sleds but has little clearance above them. The floor is part of the mechanism and is difficult terrain. Climbing in and out of a sled costs 10 feet of movement.

2. M AIN G ATE The main gate of Blingdenstone is a door made of steel and mithral. inlaid with a secret magic-resistant alloy and plated with adamantine. The gate has AC 23. 60 hit points, a damage threshold of 20. resistance to thunder damage, and immunity to poison and psychic damage. The terrace between the top of the stairs and the gate has a slight upward slope. The slope imposes disadvantage on checks made to ram the gate. Eight deep gnomes guard the gate. One of them carries a spell gem (see appendix B) that contains a see invisibility spell and uses it to scan for invisible creatures when the party arrives. Arriving characters are questioned to determine their intentions. The guards are thorough but not threatening; as long as the characters seem benign, they are granted entry. Four of the guards escort them through the maze (area 3) and the gauntlet (area 4) to Inner Blingdenstone. Havingjimjar, Topsy. or Turvy in the party helps smooth the characters' entrance to Blingdenstone. This is especially important if the party contains one or more drow, whose presence would otherwise demand an armed escort at all rimes within the settlement. If the characters reveal that they are fleeing the drow, the guards decide that Chief Dorbo Diggcrmattoe.k should hear their tale. The armed escort that brings the characters into the settlement leads them to an audience with die chief in area 14.

tor

T UNNEL

The tunnel has a 30-foot-high ceiling, and embedded in its walls are spell gems spaced 30 feet apart and 15 feet above the rough-hewn floor. The gems are set in sockets and held in place with sovereign glue, and each gem contains a symbol spell. Any deep gnome who can see a gem can activate the spell within it by using its action to speak the proper command word. Any attempt to pry a spell gem from the wail destroys the gem. At the north end of the tunnel is a smaller door made of stone reinforced with adamantine (see the “Doors of Blingdenstone” sidebar). Fifteen-foot-high ledges in alcoves flank the door. The ledges are currently unguarded, and the stone door opens easily to reveal the caves of Inner Blingdenstone beyond.

I NNER B LINGDENSTONE Population: 300 deep gnomes (svirfneblin) Government: Work collective led by Dorbo and Senni

Diggcrmattock Defense: Militia, summoned earth elementals Commerce: Salt, gemstones, and rare minerals Organizations: The Miners’ Guild, the Stoneheart Enclave

3. M AZE Between the gate and Blingdenstone proper, the svirfneblin built the maze: a twisting and turning path that runs between 10-foot-high walls studded with nails. Climbing a nail-studded wall requires a successful DC 13 Strength (Athletics) check. Even with a successful check, a creature must succeed on a DC 13 Dexterity saving throw to avoid the nails, taking ld4 piercing damage on a failed save. The path slopes up and down, so sections can be flooded or inundated with poisonous smoke. At certain points, the path narrows to allow Small creatures through; Medium creatures must squeeze, and Large creatures can't fit through at all unless they have an amorphous form. A second path is inaccessible from the main gate, traveling above the winding path. This upper path is festooned with towers and battlements where defenders can fire freely at creatures attempting to make their way along the lower path. A paved road runs along the western wall of the cavern, onto which wagons and draft animals are hoisted so they can bypass the maze. The hoist mechanism can be destroyed with the single pull of a lever if invaders manage to hijack it.

The defenses in Outer Blingdenstone paint a picture of a paranoid people under siege, but once past the final gates, the true character of the settlement is revealed. Warm, cozy, and welcoming, Blingdenstone is a rarity in the Underdark, Read the following boxed text when the characters first arrive in Inner Blingdenstone, omitting the second paragraph if they arrive unescorted. You leave the dark tunnel behind and step into what looks like another world. These aren’t sinister drew caverns or harsh, bare stone, but a subterranean land of warm colors and welcoming smells. The deep gnomes you see going about their business glance up at you with suspicion, but you instinctively understand that you face no threat here. One of the guards escorting you abandons his severe frown to give a deep nod as he prompts you past the inner gate. "Welcome to Blingdenstone, travelers."

5. R EC E PT ION H A LL

Blingdenstone’s last line of defense is a wide, winding tunnel behind a gate similar to the one in area 1.

This busy cavern welcomes visitors to Blingdenstone and connects the most important chambers of the new settlement. Two sealed tunnels here lead to the Goldwhisker Warrens. One is closed off by a deliberately caused cave-in to the south, and the other by reinforced, locked, and guarded gates.

G ATE T OWERS

6. B AR R AC KS

4. G AUNT LE T

Flanking the gate are two stone towers embedded in the cavern walls. Peering through shuttered windows in each tower arc four deep gnomes, eight in all. These gnomes operate winches that open and close the gate. If the characters are traveling with a deep gnome escort, the gates open as they approach, allowing access to the tunnel beyond. If the characters arrive here unescorted, the gnomes refuse to open the gate.

102

CHAPTER 6 ! BLINGDENSTONE

This chamber is above the main level of Blingdenstone, and houses off-duty svirfneblin currently assigned to defend the entrance.

7. TRADERS’ GROTTO____________________ This cavern serves as Blingdenstone's central market. All manner of fungi once grew in the moist grotto, but a miscast spell turned them to stone centuries ago. Blingdenstone’s merchants gather here in makeshift stalls amid the stone stalks to hawk their wares and barter with one another. Arriving caravans lower their cargo to warehouses carved out beneaLh the grotto. KAZOOK PICKSHINE

If the characters accepted Werz Saltbaron’s errand in Gracklstugh (see chapter 4), they can deliver Werz's sack of gems to Kazook Pickshine. who has a stall in the Traders’ Grotto. Kazook is a deep gnome. If the characters approach him openly and present the sack to him. he muffles a gasp as he looks around, then quickly ushers the characters into the stall, admonishing them to talk quietly and not be so open. He inspects the geins, weighs them by hand while looking at the characters with suspicion, then pays them for the delivery with a zircon worth 50 gp. The first time the characters visit the Traders’ Grotto without an escort, a clanging bell sounds near the main entrance. When this happens, read the following boxed text to the players. G E L AT I N O U S C U B E I N C U R S I O N

The deep gnomes around you all draw weapons and retreat as you see a guard stumble back, then rise up in the air. A strange shimmer around him reveals the surface of the gelatinous cube that has engulfed him. •

Two gelatinous cubes seep through a collapsed tunnel between the Traders’ Grotto and area 24 of the Goldwhisker W'arrcns. Both cubes advance, attempting to engulf and consume any other creatures in their paths until they are destroyed. The trapped svirfneblin is named Mev Flintknapper use the veteran statistics in the Monster Manual, but also give Mev the Stone Camouflage. Gnome Cunning, rnd Innate Spellcasting features of a deep gnome). He has already taken 10 acid damage and takes another 21 (6d6) acid damage at the start of each of the cube’s turns until pulled free with a successful DC 12 Strength :heck. The attempt requires an action, and any creature making the attempt takes 10 (3d6) acid damage is it reaches into the cube. If Glabbagool is with the characters, it attempts to intimidate the other cubes by interposing itself r etween them and the characters. At your discretion, allow Glabbagool to use the Help action to assist the characters’ attacks. Treasure. Once destroyed, the hostile cubes spill their contents on the ground: 12 gp and a +1 shortsword of drow manufacture (see the "Drowcraft Items” sidebar in appendix B).

Chambers. Blingdenstone is not a single cavern, but a network of interconnected caves and pockets the svirfneblin have widened and worked for use as homes, workshops, vending stalls, places of worship, storerooms, and the like. Other than the private homes of svirfneblin families, all chambers are tall enough for Medium creatures to walk around without difficulty, and common areas are even larger. It is rare for cavern walls to be bare in Blingdenstone. The walls of large caverns are studded with stairs and ramps leading to balconies and Hollows serving as storage or shops. The largest caverns are crisscrossed by walkways allowing svirfneblin and visitors to reach connecting tunnels high above the floor. Light. The caverns of Inner Blingdenstone are brightly lit with a mix of bioluminescent fungi, caged giant fire beetles, and magic. The light from these chambers spills into short connecting tunnels lacking their own illumination, creating areas of dim light. Longer tunnels have their own light, usually magically produced, Connecting Tunnels. Svirfneblin and other Small races can walk through tunnels with ease, but Medium or larger creatures must duck and squeeze—a feature intended to control invaders’ movements. Most tunnels have smooth floors, but those around the periphery of the reclaimed areas are strewn with rubble and debris. Some of the connecting tunnels in Blingdenstone are trappedThe most common traps are collapsing roofs and spiked pits (see "Sample Traps” in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master's Guide). Many tunnels slope down before rising up again, allowing the gnomes to flood them. All tunnel traps are inactive in Inner Blingdenstone, but the svirfneblin can quickly activate them in case of emergency.

DEVELOPMENT

After the gelatinous cube encounter, svirfneblin inform the characters that incursions by oozes are becoming more frequent. In every case, it seems as though the oozes are trying to make their way toward the abandoned northwest section of the city (labeled “The Pudding Court” on the map of Blingdenstone). XP AWARDS

The characters gain a special award of 100 XP each for delivering Werz's sack of gems to Kazook Pickshine. If the characters managed to rescue Mev, or made a sincere effort to do so, award each of them 50 XP, and allow the characters to make a group Charisma check to improve the deep gnomes’ attitude (see “Changing Svirfneblin Attitudes”).

8. THE RUBY IN THE ROUGH______________ The Stoneheart Enclave agreed to join the Diggemiattock effort to resettle Blingdenstone in exchange for help reclaiming this temple known as the Ruby in the Rough. The temple is dedicated to Segojan Earthcaller, the svirfneblin god of deep earth and nature. The rituals and day-to-day duties of the temple are overseen by a deep gnome named Glyphic Shroomlight, a nervous young novice doing his best in a situation requiring a much older and more experienced

I N N E R B L I N C D E N S T O N E : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

inner Blingdenstone covers the areas the svirfneblin have recovered from supernatural squatters and other dangers, now secured by mundane and magical means.

CHAPTER 6 I BLINGDENSTONE

103

cleric (use (he acolyte statistics in the Monster Manual, but also give Glyphic the Stone Camouflage, Gnome Cunning, and Innate Spellcasting features of a deep gnome). Despite the desecration of the drow invasion and the decades of scavenging and raiding in its aftermath. T H E W AY H O M E

The svirfneblin know of routes from Blingdenstone to both the surface world and Gauntlgrym. If you want to keep the characters adventuring in the Underdark, Blingdenstone should either be their last destination after having explored the other areas in the initial chapters of the adventure, or they should be kept busy with other commitments and quests before returning to the surface world. These quests could come either from the deep gnomes or from earlier chapters of the adventure. The svirfneblin won’t help the party reach the surface world until their attitude toward the characters is friendly. The characters can achieve this through minor acts and services (see “Changing Svirfneblin Attitudes" earlier in this chapter), as certain svirfneblin ask for their help. If the characters leave the svirfneblin without providing them assistance in dealing with their troubles, the deep gnomes' attitude toward the characters is hostile if they ever return to Blingdenstone.

CHAPTER 6 | BLINGDENSTO.Nf

the old city's honored dead still rest securely in the catacombs beneath the temple. A passage on the east side of the cavern leads down into this network of small linked caverns accessible only through the temple. The catacombs are built along a mostly regular grid, making it easy for characters to find their way among standing statues and funerary niches. If the characters come here following rumors of ghosts, it's only a matter of time before they meet Burrow Warden Jadger, a ghost from the time of the drow invasion. If the characters recovered Pelek’s severed hand in the “Whorlstone Tunnels" section of chapter 4, they can lay Pelek's spirit to rest by placing his remains in the catacombs. If they do this, the ghost of Burrow Warden Jadger appears before them. Jadger's ghost greets the characters but disappears through a wall if they attack. (Word quickly gets around the settlement of the adventurers’ rudeness, negatively shifting the gnomes’ attitude toward the characters.) Jadger speaks candidly about who he is and what happened to him. After gaining any sense that the characters are seeking information from the svirfneblin, he asks them to perform two tasks involving laying other svirfneblin spirits to rest: B URROW W ARDEN J ADGER

• Destroy Vazuk. a deep gnome who is mad with grief and a threat to the other residents of Blingdenstone. His specter can be found haunting his old home in area 12a. • Recover the remains of a deep gnome named Udhask and bring them to the catacombs. Jadger knows that the deep gnome died somewhere in Rockblight, the northeast section of Blingdenstone. Jadger tells the characters he will answer one question for each ghost laid to rest (including Pelek from Cracklstugh, if the characters have returned his hand here). His knowledge of the Underdark is considerable, though somew'hat outdated.

XP

A WARDS

If the party returns Pelck's remains to the catacombs, each character gains a special award of 100 XP.

9. C U LTIVATI O N C AVE

This cavern complex is devoted to the cultivation of useful fungi the svirfneblin use in their cooking and crafting, including the following edible and exotic fungi: • • • • •

3d6 barrelstalks 6d6 bluecaps 3d6 Nilhogg’s noses 3d6 torchstalks 3d6 trillimacs

Two blocked-off tunnels lead north and northeast to areas that have not been resettled. All elementals are kept away from the passages because the Stoneheart Enclave believes they lead to the caverns w'here Ogremoch’s Bane lurks.

10. S TAGI NG A RE A This cave is fortilied with barricades and defended by eight deep gnomes and four cave badgers (see "Random Encounters in Blingdenstone"). There arc no earth elementals reinforcing security here because the passage on the north wall sealed at either end with a locked door—leads to areas where the deep gnomes have confirmed the influence of Ogremoch's Bane. U NSEEN E VIL

The leader of the guards is a wryly cynical svirfneblin named Sark Axebarrel, who warns the characters of reports of a medusa lurking in the caverns beyond the doors, in a section of the old city that the gnome refers to as Rockblight. If they decide to explore Rockblight, Sark asks them to find out whatever they can about the medusa and kill her if they are able. He offers a payment of 50 gp per character for useful information, plus a diamond worth 1,000 gp if they bring back proof that the medusa is dead.

11. C AVE S

OF C LATT E R _______ This cluster of caverns on the eastern end of the settlement serves as a workspace for weaponsmiths and armorsmiths. Traditional svirfneblin arms, including picks, darts, and daggers, along with ring mail, scale mail, and chain mail shirts, are forged and traded here. Less common equipment such as sw'ords and shields can be custom ordered. Prices for weapons and armor are double those listed in the Player’s Handbook. The passages leading to area 17 are sealed off by steel walls that can’t be opened.

12. R E SIDE NT IA L C AVE S

These caverns branch off into smaller caves serving as hovels for families of svirfneblin. Tunnels lead to secondary chambers that branch out into more hovels. Deep gnome hovels have no doors. The locals are willing to talk with the characters, pointing them toward a particular cave that was recently evacuated, A “ghost” manifested there and chased out a family trying to settle within (see area 12a). 12 A . V AZUK ’ S H OME

Vazuk was a simple leatherworker who died in the draw invasion. His spirit awoke when a family moved into what used to be his home, then began to throw fits and terrorize any creatures coming near. Vazuk is a specter (use the poltergeist variant). He can't be turned while inside his former home. He attacks the characters as soon as they enter the house, all the while screaming “Mine! My stuff! Not yours!" Treasure. A character who searches the hovel and succeeds on a DC 15 Wisdom (Perception) check spots a concealed hole in the floor. The hole contains a small zurkhwood chest holding eight tiny rubies worth 250 gp each.

XP

A WARDS

In addition to the XP earned for defeating Vazuk, each character earns 50 XP if they inform Burrow Warden Jadger (see area 8) that the spirit has been dealt with.

13. S PE AKIN G S TON E S A circle of stone menhirs predating Blingdenstone stands at the center of this small cavern. The gnomes believe this henge is a cluster of truly ancient galeb duhr, venerated as manifestations of the gods. The more religious members of the Stoneheart Enclave cast augury and commune spells within the circle, interpreting the responses to their entreaties through subtle changes in the vibrations in the bedrock below. Gurnik Tapfinger, head priest of Callarduran Smoothhands in the Stoneheart Enclave, approaches the characters if they show any interest in the Speaking Stones (use the priest statistics in the Monster Manual, but also give Gurnik the Stone Camouflage, Gnome Cunning, and Innate Spellcasting features of a deep gnome). lie asks them to undertake a task in a closed- off area of the old city known as Rockblight, where the temple of his god stands desecrated. If the characters agree, he gives them a ruby spell gem (see appendix B) containing the hallow spell and asks them to place the gem in the Steadfast Stone’s menhir (see area 22). Gurnik warns them that once they place the gem, Ogremoch's Bane will send its servants to stop them. They must defeat these servants until the gem awakens three temple guardians, at which point the temple will be cleansed and the characters can leave. Once the characters accomplish this task, Gurnik channels the power of the cleansed temple, bestowing a blessing of protection or a blessing of weapon on each of the characters (each player's choice); see “Other Rewards” in chapter 7 of the Dungeon Master's Guide for more information on blessings. C LEANSE THE S TEADFAST S TONE

14. D IGGE R M ATTOC K H A LL This is the home of Dorbo and Senni Diggermattock as well as the “palace” of the provisional government of Blingdenstone. Characters are escorted here if they reveal to the guards in area 1 that they are fleeing from the drow. Two dozen or so svirfneblin occupy this well-lit cavern, some moving briskly with messenger pouches in hand while others huddle around several stone tables covered in maps and other papers, talking in hushed, serious tones. The back of the room is dominated by a dais carved from the rock of the cavern, atop which rest two stone desks facing each other. Two svirfneblin—one male, one female —sit behind the desks, conferring with advisers and each other. They turn their attention to you as you enter.

The de facto rulers of Blingdenstone are interested in everything the characters have to say about their adventures, especially if they've witnessed any events

related to demonic influence in their visits to other parts of the Underdark. The Diggermattocks offer characters a safe haven on the condition they cause no trouble in the community. If asked about reaching the surface, Dorbo says he’d like to help, but Blingdenstone is under severe pressure and he can't spare anyone to guide them. Moreover, the gnomes don’t allow strangers to buy or borrow their maps. Both Dorbo and Senni become evasive and angry if the characters press the issue, at which point the characters must succeed on a group DC 15 Charisma check or have the attitude of the svirfneblin worsen. If the adventurers offer to help the beleaguered settlement, the svirfneblin leaders mention things the characters can do to help take the pressure off the community and free up its resources. Each task the characters successfully undertake shifts the attitude of the svirfneblin (see “Changing Svirfneblin Attitudes”). "O PERATION : O OZE T HERE ?”

The Diggermattocks relay rumors that some monster or magic in the northwestern part of the settlement might be responsible for the growing number of oozes in Blingdenstone. If the characters return with information about the Pudding Court and the threat lurking therein, the Diggermattocks pay them with an empty spell gem of the highest spell level a spellcaster in the party can cast. “O PERATION : E XTERMINATE ?”

The wererats of the Goldwhisker clan are a point of contention among the Diggermattocks. Dorbo wants them out of the warrens to free up living space for hardworking svirfneblin. He also wants to recover the House Center he believes is still in the wererats’ grasp (see area 28). Senni argues that the wererats are descendants of Blingdenstone citizens and deserve to stay and rejoin their community. Since the wererats are as territorial and defensive as the svirfneblin, any attempt to parley has been met with violence. Senni asks the characters to venture into the warrens and talk with whomever is in charge. The characters’ report will determine whether the svirfneblin step up their efforts to eliminate the wererats or work toward an agreement. If Topsy or Turvy are with the party, they want to learn more about the wcrcrat community. If their own nature as wererats is revealed to the Diggermattocks or other deep gnomes, the twins are given the choice of going into the wererat-controlled part of Blingdenstone or being cast out of the settlement altogether, which might encourage the characters to meet and talk with the Goldwhisker clan.

15. S INGI NG S TONE S

This elevated cavern near one of Blingdenstone's main residential areas holds a variety of rocks and crystals in the middle of its bowl-shaped floor. Svirfneblin minstrels skilled in the art of stone singing can alter the

pitch of the vibrations emitted by the individual stones, creating an effect similar to an assemblage of harpplaying bards. When the characters initially come here, a deep gnome named Garra Songstone is playing the crystals for an appreciative audience of 3d4 deep gnome children (noncombatants).

16. T HE F O A M IN G M U G The Foaming Mug was built as an inn to house foreign guests visiting Blingdenstone. It was abandoned after the drow invasion but has recently reopened. While its supply of surface foods and beverages is meager, the rooms arc sized for Medium guests, with comfortable beds and two separate hot springs used for bathing and relaxation. There are no other guests currently, so party members who stay here have the inn to themselves. Many svirfneblin frequent the inn's taproom after work, keeping the place lively. The tavern serves Darklake Stout, an ale that the svirfneblin purchase from duergar traders in Mantol-Derith (see chapter 9). Tappy Foamstrap, a bored deep gnome, runs the inn. The characters' arrival is the most exciting thing that has happened in months, so she peppers them with questions about their lives and adventures, pushing free drinks and food on them. R UMOR AND H EARSAY

The svirfneblin community is tight-knit, so rumors spread quickly. Characters who engage w ith the tavern's patrons while the gnomes' general attitude is indifferent or friendly learn the following information. • Blingdenstone’s ghost problem is getting worse, and there are even spirits haunting the catacombs. • There was a crazy svirfneblin back in the first days of reclamation who disappeared. Some of the scouts claim to have seen him, skulking around the unrecovered areas of the settlement. (The scouts don’t know that this gnome is the Pudding King.) • The Stoneheart Enclave is closing in on a solution to the threat of Ogremoch’s Bane (untrue). The gnomes call a large unclaimed area in the northeast of the settlement '‘Rockblight," as earth elementals go mad whenever they go near it. • People are divided as to what to do about the wererats living in the southwest caverns. Some want them out. while others propose an alliance of mutual defense. • A merchant from Gracklstugh says there’s an influx of surface-world coins there, but nobody knows where they come from. (See chapter 4 for more information.) • A svirfneblin caravan returning from Whiteshell Mines encountered a parade of dancing myconids. Through their rapport spores, the myconids told the gnomes about a ‘‘wedding celebration.” which is strange considering that myconids don’t celebrate or have weddings. (See chapter 5 for more information.) The characters can spend a few hours socializing in the taproom of the Foaming Mug. If they do. they gain advantage on their next group Charisma check made to

improve the deep gnomes' attitude.

R O C K B L I G H T : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

Unlike the reclaimed parts of Blingdenstone, Rockblight is barren, cold, and hostile. Light. All parts of Rockblight are dark except for whatever light sources the characters bring with them. Caverns and Corridors. The caverns and connecting tunnels in this part of Blingdenstone are of the same construction seen in Inner Blingdenstone, but are empty and strewn with rubble. Humidity. A few shallow pools and streams run through the area, making the air damp and chill. Pools are difficult terrain.

R OCKBLIGHT When the drow attacked Blingdenstone. Ogremoch's Bane retreated to the far corners of the ruined city, waiting for the time to reemerge and seek out earth elementals to corrupt. The malevolent entity didn’t have to wait long, as the drow sent teams of scavengers to loot the treasures the deep gnomes left behind, bringing their own elemental creatures with them. Ogremoch’s Bane haunted the drow with the same relentless cruelty it did the svirfneblin, turning their elemental servants against them. Eventually, the drow armies departed the city, but when they did. a drow priestess of Lolth named Neheedra Duskryn stayed behind. Neheedra was obsessed with collecting spell gems for their power and beauty, intent on making herself the regal and powerful master of her own underground realm. She commanded a force of drow servants and soldiers with unabashed cruelty, relentlessly driving them to seek out spell gems and increase her own wealth and power. Overcome by her own greed and vanity, Neheedra engaged in dark rituals designed to secure her hold on power, imagining that Blingdenstone would one day become a drow enclave with her as its immortal leader. Unfortunately, the magical pacts she struck eventually transformed the vain priestess into a medusa. Enraged by her fate, Neheedra turned her servants to stone and descended into madness. Over decades, she petrified any creature she encountered, eventually

catching the attention of Ogremoch's Bane. Now, the medusa works in concert with the fell entity, creating stone servants animated by its power. Since the return of the svirfneblin to Blingdcnstone, the deep gnomes have studiously avoided sections of the old city that Ogremoch’s Banc and Neheedra inhabit, blocking it off from the rest of the settlement and giving it the name “Rockbltght.”

17. A BAND ONE D R E SID E N C E S This large cavern mirrors the residential areas of Inner Blingdenstone, except there is no warmth or joy here— only darkness and signs of carnage. Every step echoes against walls beyond your circle of light. The air is cold and damp, and you can hear a waterfall somewhere in the blackness, along with

The echoes of battle are always in the darkness beyond the range of the characters' light and darkvision. As characters move toward the apparent source, the echoes become more distant, as though originating somewhere else. Unless the characters quickly retreat whence they came, the ghost of a svirfneblin named Udhask appears. It uses Horrifying Visage, then attacks with his Withering Touch. If it takes any damage, the ghost shouts “They are coming! Everyone must hide!" It then flees. The characters can follow the fleeing ghost to an old burrow1, where it disappears. Within the burrow, Udhask's skeletal remains lie next to a stone bed. There’s no evidence that he died a violent death. In fact, when the drow attacked Blingdenstone, Udhask had a heart attack and died while reaching for his loot (see “Treasure"). P OOL AND W ATERFALL

A waterfall fed by an underground freshwater stream pours into a 100-foot-diameter, 10-foot-deep pool that dominates the east end of the cavern. Flanking the pool are two wide, rough-hewn staircases that climb 30 feet to an overlooking cave filled crystals and fungi (area 18). The stream runs through the higher cave before pouring into this one. T REASURE

Udhask’s skeleton appears to be reaching under the stone bed. A character who searches under the bed and succeeds on a DC 15 Wisdom (Perception) check finds a hidden compartment in the floor. Within the compartment is a rotted pouch containing six 100 gp gems and a potion of invisibility. D EVELOPMENT

Collecting Udhask’s bones and taking them to Burrow Warden Jadger's ghost in area 8 completes one of Jadger’s tasks.

"■ , CHAPTER 6 | BLINGDENSTONE

108

faint echoes of battle.

18. O V ER LOOK

gaze. However, the creature makes attack rolls with disadvantage.

A shallow, swiftly flowing stream bisects this cave. Crystalline formations sprout from the floor on both sides of the stream, and rough-hewn staircases at the back of the cave climb 30 feet to a barren stone ledge with a pair of winged statues perched atop it.

The “winged statues" on the ledge are two gargoyles. If the characters attack the gargoyles or move within 30 feet of them, the monsters swoop down and attack. In the second round of combat, an insane earth elemental rises from the stone floor and joins the fight. The stream that flows through the cave originates from a naturally formed culvert in the northeast wall, beneath the ledge. The stream is only 3 feet deep. The crystal formations growing throughout the cave are large enough for characters to hide behind, but they are neither magical more valuable. T REASURE

Among the remains of the earth elemental, the characters can find an earth elemental gem. Before they can use it, however, it must receive a remove curse spell from a priest of the Stoneheart Enclave, Otherwise, the elemental summoned by the gem is always hostile toward its summoner. The characters can also harvest samples from the bodies of the corrupted elemental and the gargoyles for Nomi Fathshutter (see “Stoneheart Quarry" in the “Blingdenstone Outskirts” section),

19. C RYSTAL G A R D E N Light from bioluminescent fungi refracts through large crystal formations erupting from the floor, creating a kaleidoscope of colors on the surrounding walls. The crystals are semitransparent, slightly distorting images seen through them. A statue of a gnome cowers near a crystal outgrowth, holding a broken crystal in its hands.

Six nightlights (see “Fungi of the Underdark” in chapter 2) illuminate this cave. Tunnels in this area climb up to area 20 and down to area 21, and two sets of stairs carved from the walls lead up to area 22. The statue is actually a deep gnotne named Vort, who wras turned to stone by Neheedra the medusa. He tried to use one of the crystals to block the medusa's gaze but failed. Anyone examining the statue notices that the gnome seems to be raising the crystal toward his face, as if to look through it. The crystals here can be used as countermeasures against Neheedra’s gaze. A creature with one hand free can hold a crystal to its eyes, gaining advantage on the Constitution saving throw made against Neheedra’s

CHAPTER 6 I BLINGDENSTONE

109

20. N E HE E DR A ’ S L A IR ________________ Ncheedra Duskryn was part of the expedition sent to loot Blingdenstone of its spell gems. Her abode reflects the richness and elegance of the drow monarch she yearned to be. T The adornments in this chamber would be more at home in a drow city. Spider-themed tapestries, fine zurkhwood furniture, and racks of expensive clothing fill the area, all of it old and rotted. At the center of the chamber, a female drow sits upon a zurkhwood throne. She stands, eyes closed and arms crossed as if in meditation or prayer. Then her white hair writhes, and you see it is formed of pale, hissing snakes,

i The medusa attacks intruders without hesitation. Neheedra's curse has driven her mad, and reasoning with her isn't an option. T REASURE

Five of the dresses in Neheedra's rack are made of spider silk shaped by drow magic. They are worth 200 gp each if sold in the markets of the Underdark. The drow magic on a dress fades when the garment is exposed to sunlight, causing it to fall apart. D EVELOPMENT

If the characters divulge the medusa's location to Sark Axebarrel in area 10, they receive the promised reward of 50 gp each, ff they deliver Neheedra’s head to Sark, he also gives them the 1,000 gp diamond he promised them.

XP

A WARDS

The characters gain 50 XP each if they successfully report back to Bark, whether they defeat the medusa or not. Upon earning this award, the characters can make a group Charisma (Persuasion) check to improve the gnomes’ attitude (see “Changing Svirfneblin Attitudes").

21. D R OW S TATU E S

This cave is filled with thirty statues of drow warriors, all standing as if on guard. In her madness, Neheedra turned these, warriors of her house to stone. Over long years, Ogremoeh's Bane has used its power to animate these statues, turning them into elemental creatures. When the characters step inside the chamber, six of the statues animate and attack. The statues have he statistics of animated armor, except that they are elementals instead of constructs. The statues attack until destroyed but don't leave this area. If the characters spend 1 round or longer in the chamber after defeating the last statue, six more statues animate. This process repeaLs until either all of the statues are destroyed or until the characters leave the cave. A statue also animates and attacks if touched or otherwise disturbed. O GREMOCH ’ S B ANE

If every statue in this cave is destroyed, Ogremoeh's Bane appears. As the last statue crumbles, a cloud of dust erupts from its shattered remains and expands to fill the cave.

The cloud is Ogremoeh's Bane. Characters within the cloud can sense its malevolence, and a successful DC 15 Intelligence (Arcana) check confirms that the cloud is of extraplanar origin. The cloud has a flying speed of 20 feet and is impervious to all damage and spells except the following. • A gust of wind spell or similar magic can forcibly move the cloud. • Casting a banishment spell on the cloud sends it back to the Elemental Plane of Air if it fails its Charisma saving throw (it has a +4 modifier to the roll). A dispel evil and good spell is equally effective and doesn’t require a successful attack roll; however, the caster must be in contact with the cloud. Creatures native to the Elemental Plane of Earth (including earth elementals, galeb duhr. gargoyles, and xorn) that come in contact with Ogremoch’s Bane instantly fall under the cloud’s sway. The effect lasts as long as the enslaved elementals and Ogremoeh's Bane are on the same plane of existence.

XP

A WARDS

If Ogremoeh's Bane is banished back to the Elemental Plane of Earth, award each character 150 XP.

22. S T E AD FAST S TONE ________________ Once a temple of Callarduran Smoothhands. the deep gnomes' god of stone and mining, this cavern was named after its long-lost galeb duhr protectors—the dharum suhn (the “Hearts of Steadfast Stone’’).

The floor of this cavern is worn smooth, but the walls are rough. A great menhir carved from a stalagmite stands in the center of the chamber, pockmarked with dozens of empty sockets that might once have held gems.

Characters with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 14 or higher notice that the roughness of the walls outlines several large, vaguely humanoid shapes. C LEANSING

THE

T EMPLE

If the characters accepted Gurntk Tapfinger’s task (see area 13), they can place the ruby spell gem he gave them into one of the sockets in the menhir. When they do so, the elementals in the walls begin to stir. As the ruby begins to glow against the menhir, the walls begin to rumble. Part of one wall shifts, detaches, and charges toward you.

CHAPTER 6 I BLINGDENSTONE

110

An earth elemental materializes out of the wall and attacks. When the elemental is reduced to 0 hit points, it crumbles, and a galeb duhr emerges from the ground near the menhir in an unoccupied space. The galeb duhr faces outward in a guarding pose, but doesn’t move or respond. Another earth elemental then emerges from the wall of the chamber and attacks, when it is destroyed, a second stoic galeb duhr appears. This summoning process repeats once more, until the third earth elemental appears and is destroyed. The clementals ignore the galeb duhr, which continue to stand motionless throughout the light. When the characters reduce three earth elementals to 0 hit points and summon three galeb duhr. a white light shines from the menhir, producing a hallow effect protecting the galeb duhr from the influence of Ogremoch’s Bane. The galeb duhr then animate and acknowledge the characters with a grave nod, before settling down in their boulder guise around the menhir. Gurnik delivers his promised blessings when the characters return to notify him of their success in the temple. He can sense whether or not the temple has been restored to its former glory, so if the characters fail to cleanse the temple but tell him they succeeded, he knows they're lying, and the deep gnomes' attitude toward the party worsens. If the characters accomplish Gumik’s lask, they can make a DC 15 group Charisma check to improve the gnomes' attitude, with all characters making the check with advantage. D EVELOPMENT

A wide, descending staircase ends before a wall of collapsed stone that blocks access to the tunnels and caves that constitute the Pudding Court. The debris can be cleared with a few days of work. However, if the characters want to use this passage as an entry point to attack the Pudding King, they can use a volatile concoction brewed by Kazook Pickshine to quickly clear the debris (see “Battle for Blingdenstone” later in this chapter). XP AWARDS

Each character gains 200 XP for restoring the temple. G O L D W H I S K E R W A R R E N S : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

One of the first things lycanthropy cost the svirfneblin was their fastidious tidiness. The wererat warrens are messy, with several areas smelling of mushrooms too ripe for any normal person to eat. Light. The wererats light their warrens with nightlight fungi and torchstaiks {see "Fungi of the Underdark" in chapter 5). Traps. The wererats have rigged traps throughout the warrens. All wererats know where the traps are and how to avoid them. The traps are marked with russet squares on the map. The first time a party member enters one of these areas, he or she triggers a trap unless the trap has been detected and disarmed. Roll a d6 to determine the type of trap: 1-2, spiked pit (10 feet deep and lined with zurkhwood spikes); 3-4, collapsing roof; or 5-6, poison darts. See “Sample Traps” in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master's Guide for information on each trap.

CHAPTER 6 | BLINGDENSTONE

G OLDWHISKER W ARRENS

The svirfneblin wererats of the Goldwhisker clan don’t remember having lived anywhere but in the ruins of Blingdenstone. They descend from survivors of the drow invasion who became infected with lycanthropy after an unfortunate encounter with a pack of wererats. For decades, the Goldwhisker svirfneblin have lived and thrived in these caverns, avoiding drow and crazed clementals. and securing their homes in cunning and vicious ways. They aren’t willing to leave just because the cowards who fled Blingdenstone when it needed them most have now returned.

23. M AIN E NT R ANC E _____________

The svirfneblin installed locked doors to close off this section of the warrens. West of the doors, the wererats have installed a trap (see the “Traps" section in the “Goldwhisker Warrens: General Features" sidebar). Four svirfneblin wererats (see “Random Encounters in Blingdenstone") attack when the characters trigger, disarm, or avoid the trap. The wererats avoid biting their enemies to minimize the risk of giving them the “gift” of wererat lycanthropy. If the characters kill two of the wererats, the survivors retreat to area 25. D EVELOPMENT

Sounds of battle here alert every other wererat in the warrens. Thereafter, the wererats can't be surprised.

24. R E FU SE P ILE The characters notice a foul stench as they approach this cave. This chamber used to be a small residential area, with homes dug into the walls at various heights, but no one dwells here now. The pile of refuse dominates the cave. It contains decomposing matter, including a pair of slimy, partially digested svirfneblin corpses. A successful DC 12 Intelligence (Investigation) check reveals that the gnomes were victims of some kind of ooze.

25. H ALL

O F M INE R S During Blingdenstone’s heyday, this cavern held the old city's smelters and marketplace for ore and uncut gems. It's now the main square of the wererat warrens. A small crowd has gathered here. Most of the assembled creatures are deep gnomes, but some have ratlike features —including a fat specimen standing in front of the others, smiling at you with jagged buckteeth. “Peace," the big wererat says. He takes a step forward, arms extended and hands open. “Chipgrin's the name. I'm chief of the Goldwhisker dan. Shall we talk?”

Forty svirfneblin wererats (see “Encounters in Blingdenstone”) are gathered here, making combat a dangerous proposition and likely inspiring the characters to accept Chipgrin’s peaceful parley. The

no

CHAPTER 6 | BLINGDENSTONE

wererat boss climbs a set of stairs to the top of a natural rise (area 26), bidding the characters to follow him. Chipgrin is a svirfneblin wererat with 45 hit points and AC 14 (studded leather).

\23

£r£,?A

26. C HIP GR I N ’ S R ISE _________________

The leader of the Goldwhisker clan claims this plateau as his personal retreat and also entertains guests here. Stairs lead to the top of this rise, where the floor is covered with a soft and well-manicured carpet of green moss. The wererat chief sits on a stone chair flanked by two giant rats. Draped over the chair's back is a cave badger pelt. "Let's get down to brass hobnails, then. You were sent by

smart and can help the characters connect the dots if they’ve heard of Juiblex and its unending hunger. If either Topsy or Turvy are with the characters, Chipgrin is pleased to welcome them to the Goldwhisker clan. The twins accept the offer unless their bond of friendship with the characters inspires them to remain with the party.

the Diggermattocks 'cause they want us out, right? Right?! Well, they might get their wish soon enough, but in a way they ain't likely to cheer about."

The wererats face constant attacks by the oozes and are close to fleeing the settlement and leaving the other deep gnomes to fend for themselves. However, Chipgrin has learned of the mysterious figure controlling the oozes, and he hopes to use that information to strike a bargain. If the characters are willing to hear what he has to say, Chipgrin goes on to describe the creature he refers to as "the Pudding King." “I remember him from when he worked in the tunnels, and my kin saw him when he returned. I know who he is, what he’s doing, and—most of all— where he can be foundl If you and the Diggermattocks want, I can take you straight to him —he what calls himself the Pudding King.”

The wererat leader remains civil, but he refuses to tell the characters anything more about the Pudding King until he has secured a meeting with the Diggermattocks. If there is any hint of violence, he calls for help. If the characters decide to fight, all forty svirfneblin wererats in the surrounding cavern (area 25) rush to attack, in addition to Chipgrin and his two giant rats. Chipgrin orders his fellow wererats to take down clerics first, then any other spellcasters, and to keep melee combatants locked down. He doesn't kill the characters, but makes sure they are infected with wererat Ivcanthropy before dumping them in the maze in Outer Blingdenstone (area 3). During any negotiation, Chipgrin is affable hut firm in his demands. He also asks the characters if they’ve noticed anything odd among the svirfneblin. The wererats have noticed the greed and aggression growing among their cousins living outside Blingdenstone see "Blingdenstone Outskirts”). However, they are unaffected by it themselves, given their bestial natures. Chipgrin doesn't know about demon lords, but he’s

D EVELOPMENT

This encounter tests the characters' skills as diplomats and peacemakers. If they take Chipgrin's message to the Diggermattocks and arrange an audience, Chipgrin suggests that they stick around long enough to see what comes from "all this chit-chat and howdy-do!”

27. S EC R E T T UNNE L The wererats use this secret tunnel to enter and leave their warrens. Oozes have also been using this route to enter Blingdenstone and join the Pudding King's court. The secret doors are well hidden and require a successful DC 18 Wisdom (Perception) check to spot.

T HE P UDDING C OURT The Pudding King sel up his court in the northwest corner of Blingdenstone, slipping through the wererat warrens with his beloved "children," Princess Ebonmire and Prince Livid (see the "Royal Oozes" sidebar). Since his return, the Pudding King has been using the power granted him by Juiblex to summon and command every ooze in the region.

28. H OUSE C E NT E R This cavern was once the heart of Blingdenstone’s government—a large space with a rocky sphere in its center. The sphere is hollowed out and contains the royal chambers from which the old kings and queens ruled. All of it has been transformed by the presence of the Pudding King. R O YAL O O Z E S

Princess Ebonmire is a black pudding with an Intelligence of 6 (-2) and the ability to hurl blobs of its substance as a ranged weapon attack out to a range of 30 feet This attack has the same attack bonus, damage, and effect as the black pudding's Pseudopod attack. Prince Livid is a gray ooze with 30 hit points (use the psychic gray ooze variant).

CHAPTER 6 ! BLINGDENSTONE

111

The walls of this great cavern are covered in slime—

The sound of dripping water fills this dark cave, and

dripping, sickening green slime. Echoes of dripping

various oozes slither across the walls and floor. Some sort

water also fill the cave, in the center of which is a

of fungal wall or partition once divided the cave, but that

large spherical structure is held up off the floor by

barrier has been destroyed. Beyond it lies more wreckage

stone pillars. Around these pillars crawl dozens of

and debris scoured clean by the oozes.

living oozes, heaving forward while reaching out with grasping pseudopods. The sphere’s surface, like the cave walls, is covered with slime. Black slime swirls with yellow and gray slime in a disgusting soup, the unearthly patterns in the movements of the slime straining your eyes and tugging at your mind. Ad isembodied voice fills the cave. "What’s this, what’s this? Visitors? Now? Not yet! We're not ready! Co away, pests! I will call upon thee and all of Blingdenstone to announce our glad tidings of the Faceless Lord to come at the proper time! Begone!” ii

Hundreds of ooze creatures congregate here, drawn by the will of the Pudding King. They include dozens of black puddings, gray oozes, and ochre jellies, as well as the occasional gelatinous cube. If the characters intend to rush this deadly tide, warn them that retreat is a better option, and that this is a fight they aren’t likely to survive without strategy and aid. See the “Battle for Blingdenstone” section for the ways the characters can return here and have a chance to triumph. If Glabbagool is with the party, it attempts to communicate with the other ooze creatures, telling the characters that others of its kind are calling for it to join them. The adventurers can convince the gelatinous cube not to go, but even if it does, Glabbagool might still serve as an ace in the hole during the battle for Blingdenstone. The cavern is damp and has a 180-foot-high ceiling lined with dripping stalactites. The walls are covered with patches of green slime (see “Dungeon Hazards” in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master's Guide). Any creature that comes into contact with a wall takes damage as normal. R OYAL S PHERE

The hollowed-out stone sphere is 150 feet in diameter and elevated 10 feet off the ground, such that the top of the sphere is 20 feet below the cave ceiling. Stone ramps without railings climb 30 feet to four small, open doorways in the sides of the sphere. A patch of green slime (see “Dungeon Hazards" in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide) hangs above each door. The chambers the fill the sphere’s interior have been scoured by the ooze creatures, leaving nothing but bare corridors and empty chambers. Even the metalwork has been corroded and eaten away. There is nothing of interest or value within.

29. R UINE D S TOC K A D E

This cavern was once a shrine for Baervan Wildwanderer, the gnomish deity known as the Father of Fish and Fungus. Now it belongs to the Pudding King. CHAPTER 6 | BLINGDENSTONE

This area once contained a stockade fashioned from zurkhwood and trillimac fungi. Here, the deep gnomes kept their deep rothe (Underdark cattle). The place was ransacked during the drow invasion, and the Pudding King's oozes have dissolved most of what the drow left behind, including the bones of the slaughtered rothe. Two freshwater pools form along the west wall. Dozens of ooze creatures—black puddings, gray oozes, and ochre jellies—inhabit this cavern. However, they don’t attack intruders unless they are harmed or commanded to do so by the Pudding King. This cave is also home to a gibbering mouther that isn’t under the sway of Juiblex or the Pudding King. It crept into this cave and hides among the oozes, occasionally feeding on them. It looks like a pool of reddish-brown slime in the middle of the cave until one or more characters touch it, whereupon it opens its eyes and attacks.

30. T HR ONE R OOM Phosphorescent lichen illuminates this cave, the floor of which is covered with pools of green slime. More green slime clings to the ceiling and forms hideous drapes along the walls. In the middle of the cave, facing east, is a slimecovered throne.

The Pudding King (see appendix C) holds court here, attended by his royal “children,” Princess Ebonmire and Prince Livid (see the “Royal Oozes” sidebar). The Pudding’s King's throne is made of chiseled stone and sculpted with lidless eyes and gaping mouths. A patch of green slime covers it (see "Dungeon Hazards" in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide). More patches of green slime hang from the ceiling and form pools on the floor. The pools are easily avoided, while the patches on the ceiling don’t fall unless the Pudding King commands them to. The Pudding King can use a bonus action to make a patch of green slime fall from the ceiling onto a creature below. In front of the throne is a footstool made from a squat, petrified mushroom. The mushroom's cap can be removed, revealing a hollow compartment in the stem where the Pudding King hides his treasure. T REASURE

The hidden compartment in the Pudding King’s fungal footstool contains 55 gp, 30 ep, a potion of poison in a gourd, two spell scrolls written on sheets of dried trillimac (conjure minor elemcntals and speak with plants), and a varnished nothic eye that functions as a crystal ball of true seeing that can be used only once.

n

CHAPTER 6 BLINGDENSTONE

>13

BATTLE FOR BLINGDENSTONE Once the characters see how overwhelming the opposition is inside the Pudding Court, they have little choice but to retreat and report their findings to the Diggermattocks. The deep gnome leaders grimly thank them for their efforts, asking them to wait and attend a council meeting the following day. The council meeting takes place in Diggermattock Hall (area 14) and includes Chief Dorbo and Quartermaster Senni, Nomi Pathshutter and Gurnik Tapfinger representing the Stoneheart Enclave, Kazook Pickshine representing the Miners' Guild, and Burrow Warden Jadger’s ghost or Trisk Adamantelpiece representing the Burrow Wardens. If the characters talked with Chipgrin Goldwhisker and agreed to take his offer to the Diggermattocks. Dorbo and Senni invite him to attend as well. Senni asks the characters to inform everyone about what they saw, after which the council debates what to do. If nobody suggests it first. Jadger's ghost says that Blingdenstone has no hope to defeat this threat if the settlement stands divided. That means counting the Goldwhisker were rats as allies and recognizing their right to rejoin the community. Give the characters a chance to ask questions of the svirfneblin regarding what each faction can bring to the table (see "Blingdenstone Factions"). BLINGDENSTONE FACTIONS The following sections describe what each deep gnome faction has to offer in the Battle of Blingdenstone. T HE D IGGERMATTOCKS

If the characters don’t suggest it, the deep gnome leaders note that fighting all the oozes might not be necessary. If the adventurers can get to the Pudding King and destroy him. the oozes might be reduced to their typically mindless and disorganized state. A large force can serve as a distraction, while the characters sneak in from an alternate route. Dorbo Diggermattock wants the main force to attack from the temple of the Steadfast Stone. Before the battle can get underway, the temple must be cleansed (see area 22). Meanwhile, Senni Diggermattock gives Kazook Pickshine the materials he needs to create an alchemical concoction that can clear the debris blocking the way into the domains of the Pudding King. T HE G OLDWHISKER C LAN

Chipgrin doesn't know about the Pudding King’s deal with Juiblex, but he knows the Pudding King can command the oozes as if they were intelligent. If the characters help convince Dorbo Diggermattock that the Goldwhisker clan belongs in Blingdenstone, the svirfneblin wererats participate in the battle and prove sturdier than the average deep gnome, taking point on any attack.

THE STONEHEART ENCLAVE

Stone is a resilient defense against oozes, making earth elementals the perfect force to combat them. Nomi Pathshutter suggests that if EntdmoclTs Boon could be found and its summoning circle put to use. the likelihood of victory would increase greatly. Gurnik Tapfinger says that with Ogremoch's Bane still lurking, any elemental brought to the battle runs the risk of being driven insane. Nomi and Gurnik agree that if the Steadfast Stone is cleansed and Ogremoch's Banc is banished, the Stoneheart Enclave can protect its elementals during the battle. T HE M INERS ’ G UILD

Kazook Pickshine can concoct an oil to protect weapons and armor from acid corrosion, but he needs a large quantity of ingredients from Neverlight Grove. If the characters have already been in Neverlight Grove and witnessed the horror of Zuggtmoy, they can discard this idea or brave a stealthy return to the corrupted my con id haven. Another option is to send a shipment of salt to Gracklstugh to trade for high-quality weapons. The characters could escort the caravan if they have already visited the City of Blades and have unfinished business. S VIRFNEBLIN S PIRITS

If the characters have not already completed Burrow Warden Jadger’s tasks, doing so convinces Jadger’s ghost to rally the other benevolent ghosts of Blingdenstone and join the battle.

TASK LIST________________________ The success of any plan to rid Blingdenstone of the Pudding King and his minions is more likely if the characters complete the following tasks: • Convince Dorbo Diggermattock that the Goldwhisker clan deserves to live in Blingdenstone.

• Find Entemoch’s Boon. • Cleanse the Steadfast Stone (area 22). • Travel to Neverlight Grove and harvest a wagon load of ingredients among its fungal pools and fields. • Escort a salt shipment to Gracklstugh to trade for duergar-made weapons. • Complete one or both tasks set forth by the ghost of Burrow Warden Jadger (see area 8). Let the players come up with other ideas that might help, such as asking for aid from the stone giants of Gracklstugh or stealing magic weapons from the drow. Some quests might take time to complete, since they require travel through the Underdark. See the “Benefits for Completing Tasks” sidebar for benefits that the characters gain during the Battle of Blingdenstone if they complete certain tasks. C RY H AVO C ! When the characters feel that they have attained their goals and secured their resources, the battle for Blingdenstone can begin. Earth elementals under the control of the Stoneheart Enclave lead the charge, followed by the wererats of Clan Goldwhisker. Svirfneblin under Chief Dorbo Diggermattock form the rearguard and provide ranged support. If the ghosts participate, they attack from above and below. The plan is to get the characters to the Pudding King while the other factions hold the oozes at bay. To reach the Pudding King, the characters must face ld4 + 2 encounters, minus one encounter per goal achieved in the “Task List” section. Roll a d6 and consult the Battle of Blingdenstone Encounters table to determine each encounter. BENEFITS FOR COMPLETING TASKS Completing certain tasks in Blingdenstone can provide the characters with benefits and allies in the final battle. ■ If the characters find Entbmoch's Boon and share its location with the svirfneblin, or if they cleanse the temple of Callardurran Smoothhands (area 22), an earth elemental aids them. If the characters completed both tasks, the elemental has 15 additional hit points. • If the characters fetch the ingredients from Neverlight Grove, their metal equipment is immune to the corrosive effects of oozes. • If the characters procure weapons in Gracklstugh, they can call for ranged artillery support during the Battle of Blingdenstone. Each character deals 2 extra damage with each attack during the “Cry Havoc!" encounters, representing covering fire from svirfneblin using duergar-made crossbows. • If the characetrs complete the tasks set before them by Burrow Warden Jadger, each character can reroll one attack roll or saving throw during the Battle of Blingdentone as a ghost emerges from the ground to distract foes. • If the characters befriended Glabbagool and brought it to Blingdenstone, the intelligent gelatinous cube joins the battle as their ally, If Glabbagool left the party previously, it can reappear as a surprise ally during the battle.

B ATT L E O F B L I N G D E N S T O N E E N C O U N T E R S

d6 Encounter 1-2 1 black pudding and 2 gray oozes 3 1 gelatinous cube and 1 ochre jelly 4-5 3 gray oozes and 1 ochre jelly 6 2 black puddings

During the battle, the voice of the Pudding King can be heard through the layers of oozing miasma, crying out “Fight for your king!" and “Glory to the Faceless Lord!” O O Z I N G R O YALTY When the characters defeat the last group of oozes, but before they reach area 30, the Pudding King appears. The insane, slime-covered deep gnome points at you and cackles. “Devour them, my precious children! Make your father proud!” He then bolts as two oozes drop from the ceiling in front of you, their dark forms flowing in your direction with unsettling awareness and malevolence.

The characters must contend with Princess Ebonmire and Prince Livid (see the “Royal Oozes” sidebar). These dimly intelligent oozes defend their master to the death, blocking the characters from reaching the Pudding King as he retreats to his throne room (area 30). Princess Ebonmire engages in melee, protecting Prince Livid as it uses its Psychic Crush attack. Prince Livid prefers to slink and hide while its Psychic Crush attack recharges. T REASURE

When Princess Ebonmire dies, the black pudding disgorges a pair of spellbooks with covers made from troglodyte hide and pages made from trillimac fungus (see “Fungi of the Underdark” in chapter 2). The covers and pages are coated with a magical varnish that renders them immune to acid damage, protecting them from the pudding’s digestive juices. The varnish also protects against water damage. A svirfneblin arch mage named Lesla Carrowil authored both spellbooks. The wizard spells contained in each book are listed below; feel free to swap out any spell with another of the same level. The first spellbook, titled Underland Magick, contains the following spells; 1st level; alarm, color spray, comprehend languages, find familiar grease, identify, jump, Tosha's hideous laughter, unseen servant 2nd level: alter self blur, crown of madness, gust of wind, invisibility, knock, magic weapon, phantasmal force, spider climb 3rd level: blink, dispel magic, gaseous form, major image, protection from energy, slow, tongues, water breathing 4th level: blight, fabricate, f re shield, hallucinatory terrain, locate creature, phantasmal killer, polymorph, stoneskin

The second spellbook. titled Magick from Beyond the Mirror, contains the following spells:

5th level: Bigby's hand, cloudkill, hold monster, legend lore, passu/all, Rary's telepathic: bond, telekinesis, wall of stone 6th level: chain lightning, disintegrate, Drawmij's instant summons, eyebite, flesh to stone, Otto’s irresistible dance, true seeing 7th level: forcecage, mirage arcana, Mordenkainen's magnificent mansion, prismatic spray, reverse gravity, teleport 8th level: antimagic field, feeblemind, incendiary cloud, maze, power word stun, telepathy

THE PUDDING KING The mad svirfneblin waits for the characters in his disgusting throne room. If the characters haven’t seen the throne room before, read the boxed text description of the room (see area 30) and add the following: The Pudding King cowers behind his slime-covered throne and chortles in his joy. “Callooh! Callay! Now you can join the party!” he cackles. “You can be one with the Faceless Lord. Just let yourselves be eaten and disgorged!"

The Pudding King (see appendix C) prefers to cast spells while using the throne for cover. As a bonus action on his turn, he commands a patch of green slime to drop from the ceiling onto one randomly determined party member (see "Dungeon Hazards" in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide for the rules and effects of green slime). When one or more of the characters dose to within reach of the Pudding King, he laughs madly as he tears away his humanoid guise and transforms into an ooze. When he reaches 0 hit points, he shrieks as he dissolves into a dense puddle of goo. Read the following boxed text as he expires: “You haven't won! No! We will rise from our

LEAVING BLINGDENSTONE The characters can leave Blingdenstone as heroes of the svirfneblin. If they express interest in visiting other Underdark locations, the deep gnomes give them whatever help they can. including placing them in a caravan to Gracklsfugh or Neverlight Grove. If the characters ask for help reaching the surface world, the gnomes guiding them to a tunnel that leads there (eventually). They also provide enough food, water, and other basic supplies for the party’s journey. The characters achieve a great victory if they defeat the Pudding King, but their victory is incomplete. The Pudding King’s death is a small setback for Juiblex, and the demon lord might send another minion to command the remaining oozes in Blingdenstone until they are destroyed. The ‘'banquet" the Pudding King referred to is the demonic rite of domination through which Zuggtmoy plans to transform the Underdark into her new abyssal domain. See chapter 16. “The Fetid Wedding.” for more information.

THE PUDDING KING

children! We will be reborn from the Faceless Lord! Juiblex will consume the banquet of the Queen of Fungi and we ... will... all ... grow ... !"

With the Pudding King gone, the oozes lose their organization, but they are still too many and the svirfneblin sound the call to retreat. Three galeb duhr led by the ghost of Burrow Warden jadger arrive to take the characters to safety. If the svirfneblin of Blingdenstone didn't already have a friendly attitude, they become friendly toward the characters after the battle. D EVELOPMENT

Back in Diggermattock Hall, the gnome leaders make good on their promise, giving the characters a sfone of controlling earth elementals along with the gratitude of their people. XP A WARDS If the characters participated in the battle, they gain a special awrard of 200 XP each.

CHAPTER 6 | BLINGDENSTONE

____________________________i “S

CHAPTER 7: ESCAPE FROM THE UNDERDARK This chapter marks the midpoint of Out of the Abyss and sees the characters finally make their way out of the Underdark. Before their final push to freedom, however, the vengeful drow pursuing the adventurers catch up to them, intent on dragging them back to their domain of perpetual darkness. If they survive this final confrontation, the characters reach the surface in a place of your choosing. After all their arduous adventures, they are finally safe to return to their homes, and must say goodbye to many of the NPCs who've been traveling with them. Though the characters don't yet know it, their exploits in the Underdark will bring them to the attention of the dwarves of Gauntlgrym, setting the stage for chapter 8 and a new call to adventure. By the time they reach this point, the characters should be at least 7th level, having overcome countless challenges in their wild and dangerous journey through the locations described in chapters 1 through 6. They should also have reached a terrible conclusion: multiple demon lords of the Abyss are at large in the Underdark and could soon threaten the surface world.

THE WAY OUT Since their escape from Velkynvelve in chapter 1, the characters have sought a way out of the Underdark. Given the somewhat free-form nature of chapters 2 through 6, which the characters can undertake in any

order, it's up to you to determine how and where the adventurers finally find their escape route, as best suits the story of their journey through the Underdark.

F I N D I N G T H E W AY Escaping the Underdark is no simple matter. Characters who try to find their own way out might wander for years without stumbling upon the right series of passages to take them to the surface. As the DM, you determine where and when they find the way out. The characters can visit the places described in chapters 3 through 6, using the interconnecting material in chapters 2 and 3, in virtually any order. This makes it problematic to put the. way to the surface world in a particular place, since the adventurers could just as easily bypass it as stumble upon it prematurely. Instead, the characters’ escape is made possible by a set of conditions that you can implement when the time is right. B LINGDENSTONE

The deep gnome settlement (see chapter 6) has the most dealings with the surface world of any community in this region of the Underdark, and the adventurers can find the resources there to guide them out. However, the deep gnomes are dealing with a number of looming threats to their settlement, and they can’t afford to help the characters unless the characters help them first. Since Blingdenstone is the most obvious and reliable location from which to find a way out of the Underdark, you might want to steer the campaign to other locations first. This can be done by treating the other chapters as side adventures to the characters’ main journey, with many of those side adventures focused on the characters helping their NPC companions return to their homes in the Underdark.

G RACKLSTUGH

The duergar of Gracklstugh have fewer dealings with the surface world compared to other Underdark races, relying more on trade flowing through Mantol-Derith (see chapter 9). The paranoid duergar are reluctant to share known routes to the surface world, so the adventurers need to cultivate considerable influence with the gray dwarves to earn such a prize. T HE W ORMWRITHINGS

The drow of Mcnzoberranzan know of several tunnels in this region of the Underdark that lead to the surface world. Characters lucky enough to find one eventually emerge in the Lurkwood, a forest south of the Spine of the World mountains. For more information on the Wormwrithings, see chapter 13. F ARTHER AFIELD

Various other tunnels and passages wend their way to the surface in places around the Evermoors or even more remote locations. You can place these wherever you like, if an opportune, time for the characters to depart comes along before exploring any of the previous options. P ORTALS

A number of ancient portals can be found in the Underdark. A functional portal is a magical doorway leading to some other specific location in Faerun. If the characters' choices during the adventure leave them unable to secure escape with the help of the NPCs they meet, you could place a portal in or near one of the locations explored in chapters 2 through 6. If the portal is damaged, the characters might need to repair it. The characters also need to figure out how to activate the portal, or find the key or spell necessary to activate it. A portal can be one-way only and send the adventurers anywhere you want. GAIN ING ACCESS By the time they have visited the locations detailed in the previous chapters, the characters should have knowledge of a route to the surface world and a map or guide to help them navigate it. These two goals should serve as tools to help motivate the players throughout the earlier chapters of the adventure. As a reward in one chapter, the characters might learn of the existence of a potential route out, leading them to another location in the Underdark where it is supposed to he. Then they need to find a map or guide for the potential route, which could involve them in what is happening in the new location. To complicate the search, they might then discover that a route or guide isn't all they had hoped for, but instead leads them to more promising options. As an example, the characters might hear of a potential route to the surface from Gracklstugh. They go to the duergar city and become embroiled in events unfolding there, only to be denied access by the gray dwarves. However, meeting a group of wandering myconids in the city reveals that the myconids of Xeverlight Grove know a great deal about the hidden ways of the Underdark. Clues and leads should become more plentiful and

substantial as the characters approach 7th level, leading them toward their eventual escape route—and with many adventures and encounters happening along the way, Tf you hand out these hints and opportunities carefully, the characters’ path through the Underdark should feel like a smoothly escalating series of discoveries, no matter what order they chose to explore the locations and deal with the challenges of the previous chapters.

BIDDING FAREWELL

When the characters finally reach the surface, it’s likely that some of their subterranean eompanions will choose to remain in the Underdark rather than face the perils of the surface world. U N D E R D A R K N ATI V E S ________________________ Knowing that many of their NFC companions have homes in the Underdark can be an important part of the decision-making process that guides the characters through the early chapters of this adventure. The Underdark is a dangerous place, and characters might be reluctant to let their newfound friends fend for themselves. Helping some of them return home makes a good incentive to visit locations in the Underdark. Shuushar, Topsy. Turvy, Stool, Rumpadump, and Glabbagool would rather remain in the Underdark than suffer sunlight. S U R FAC E D W E L L E R S __________________________ Companions such as Eldeth and Ront, who prefer to live on or near the surface, gladly follow the characters all the way out if they can. Eldeth wishes to return to Gauntlgrym. and her presence there can provide a connection for the characters when they visit the dwarven settlement in chapter 8. If Eldeth didn't survive, she might have charged the characters with returning her body or effects to Gauntlgrym. Ront might wish to rejoin his tribe or seek a new home elsewhere, based on how the events in the earlier chapters of the adventure have influenced him. Depending on how he was treated, the ore most likely parts from the characters in peace out of respect for their battle prowess, if nothing else. W I T H F R I E N D S L I K E T H E S E ... Buppido, Prince Dcrendil, and Sarith might be gone well before the adventurers are ready to return to the surface, having already revealed their dark secrets and treacherous natures. If Buppido or Sarith are still around, cither NFC could go mad and attempt to kill the adventurers before they reach the surface world. Derendil might still hold to his delusion of heing an elf prince wanting to return to his forest kingdom. However, the quaggoth is poorly suited to travel on the surface, needing shelter from the light during the day. He becomes increasingly irrational and erratic, seeing enemies and plots everywhere, until he eventually accuses the characters of colluding with his enemies and attacks in a mad fury.

C H A P T E R 7 I ESCAPE F R O M THE U N D E R D A R K

CONFRONTING THE DROW The drow from Velkynvelve have pursued their escaped prisoners throughout the first half of the adventure. Along the way. they might have engaged the characters in combat or set up a number of near-miss encounters. At times, the adventurers might have believed they had D R O W C H A S E C O M P L I C ATI O N S d20 Complication 1

2

3 4

5

6

7

Uneven ground threatens to slow your progress. Make a DC 10 Dexterity (Acrobatics) check to navigate the area. On a failed check, the ground counts as 10 feet of difficult terrain. A fissure, rocky outcropping, or debris threatens to trip you up. Make a DC 10 Dexterity (Acrobatics) check. On a failure, you fall prone. You disturb a swarm of bats that makes one attack against you before quickly scattering. A colony of piercers hangs 20 feet overhead. As you pass, one of them drops and makes an attack against you. You have to dodge around stalagmites and columns. Make a DC 10 Dexterity (Acrobatics) check. On a failure, you take ld4 bludgeoning damage from running into an obstacle. A mass of webbing blocks your path. Avoiding it requires a successful DC 12 Dexterity (Acrobatics) check. On a failure, you are caught in the web and restrained. As an action, you can make a DC 12 Strength check, bursting the webbing on a success. The webbing can also be attacked (AC 10; hp 5; vulnerability to fire damage; immunity to poison and psychic damage). A patch of green slime drops from the ceiling, requiring a successful DC 10 Dexterity saving throw to avoid. On a failure, you are struck and take 5 (ldlO) acid damage. You take 5 (ldlO) acid damage again at the start of each of your turns until the slime is scraped off or destroyed (see "Dungeon Hazards’’ in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master's Guide).

8

The floor beneath you is smooth and slick with moisture, requiring a successful DC 10 Dexterity saving throw to navigate. On a failed save, you fall prone. 9 The floor beneath you is littered with sharp rocks and debris, and you must succeed on a DC 10 Dexterity saving throw to cross it. On a failure, you take ld4 piercing damage and the ground counts as 10 feet of difficult terrain. 10 The chase kicks up a cloud of dust, sand, or spores. You must succeed on a DC 10 Constitution saving throw to pass through the cloud. On a failure, you are blinded until the end of your turn. While blinded in this way, your speed is reduced by half. 11-20 No complication.

shaken off their pursuers for good, only to have the drow show up unexpectedly. The characters’ departure from the Underdark offers the final opportunity for them to ti8

CHAPTER 7 I ESCAPE FROM THF. UNDERDARK

confront their pursuers and settle the score. The possibility that her prey might escape drives Ilvara onward. In turn, she relentlessly pushes those under her command to redouble their efforts to catch the characters. At this point, the pursuit level tracking set out in chapter 2 is no longer relevant. Ilvara and her warriors catch up to the adventurers just before they reach the uppermost level of the Underdark. The adventurers can choose to lead the drow on a risky chase, or stand and fight. DROW CHASE If the adventurers flee from the drow, use the chase rules in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide to play out the pursuit. The drow are on foot. If she gets close enough to do so, Ilvara tries to cut off the party’s escape by casting web across the tunnel ahead. In addition to giving chase, the drow in the pursuit party pepper the characters with poisoned crossbow bolts, hoping to render some of them unconscious. C HASE C OMPLICATIONS

Each participant in the chase rolls a d20 at the end of its turn and consults the Drow Chase Complications table. The result (if any) affects the next chase participant in initiative order. If the characters escape from the drow, they can exit the Underdark unopposed. Ilvara returns in disgrace with nothing to show for her considerable efforts, although she and others from Velkynvelve might reappear when the adventurers return to the Underdark (see chapter 15, “The City of Spiders”). If you want to extend the chase, the drow could pursue the characters onto the surface, which places them at a disadvantage once the sun comes up (see “Evening the Odds”). Tf the drow catch up with the characters, the chase becomes a combat (see “Stand and Fight”). S T AN D

AND

FIGHT

If the characters stand and fight, or if the drow catch them, they're in for a tough battle. Ilvara alone is a challenge for a group of 8th-level characters, and she is accompanied by her most powerful servants. The attacking drow force consists of the following: • Ilvara, drow priestess of Lolth, armed with a tentacle rod in addition to the usual equipment • Asha, junior drow priestess (use the priest stat block in the Monster Manual, but give Asha the Fey Ancestry, Innate Spellcasting, and Sunlight Sensitivity features of a typical drow) • Shoor and Jorlan, drow elite warriors (Jorlan has disadvantage on attack rolls, Dexterity checks, and Dexterity saving throws) • Four drow warriors If any of the named drow were killed in chapter 1, they have been replaced by other drow with similar statistics.

On her first turn in combat, Ilvara casts conjure animals to summon two giant spiders to fight alongside the drow, while Asha casts spirit guardians on herself and concentrates to maintain it. The other drow cast darkness to hinder ranged attackers before closing to melee. Shoor protects Ilvara, while Jorlan makes no effort to protect his fellow drow. Ilvara prefers to strike from a distance with her tentacle rod. or cast spells such as poison spray and ray of sickness. If Ilvara loses more than half her hit points, she attempts to summon a yochlol demon. E VENING THE O DDS

The characters might have a couple NPC companions around to help them defeat the drow (see "Bidding Farewell”), but if they need more assistance, consider the following options: ■ Having pushed themselves to catch up to their prey, the drow all have one level of exhaustion. ■ Ilvara and Asha have already expended some of their spell slots. • The characters make it to the surface before being intercepted by the drow. and the dark elves follow them into daylight. Under the light of the sun, the drow have disadvantage on their attack rolls and on Wisdom (Perception) checks relying on sight. The drow can pursue the characters for 1 hour before their armor and weapons are destroyed by the sunlight. • Asha chooses the confusion of combat as the moment to betray Ilvara, attacking while the elder priestess's back is turned. Ilvara instantly turns her attention to eliminating the traitor, distracting her and weakening the drow side if she succeeds. • Wanting to deny Ilvara the triumph of recapturing the adventurers, Jorlan turns against his fellow drow, attacking them until he's slain. If he survives, he turns against the characters in his self-destructive fury once all the drow are dead. ■ One or more NPC companions whom the characters left behind in the Underdark show up to help, having spotted the pursuing drow and followed them. T REASURE

The characters can claim any equipment and treasure carried by the drow, although droweraft items don’t survive exposure to sunlight (see the “Droweraft Items” sidebar in appendix B). In addition, if the characters fled Velkynvelve without retrieving specific magic items or valuables, Ilvara can be carrying those items, allowing the adventurers to finally reclaim their property. XP A WARDS Each character earns 300 XP if the party makes it to the surface.

FURTHER ADVENTURES The end of this chapter of Out of the Abyss forms a break between the first half of the adventure and the second half, which begins when the characters are summoned to an audience with King Brucnor Battlehammer of

Gauntlgrym (see chapter 8). You can use the break between the two halves of the adventure to deal with any or all of the following. O VERLAND T RAVEL

Once they reach the surface, the characters must still travel some distance to reach civilization. Most of the tunnels that connect to the Underdark in this region lie in or near the Evermoors or the Ltlrkwood—wild regions filled with ruins and monsters. You can choose to narrate as much of the party's overland travel as you wish, setting up encounters en route. If Eldeth is still with the characters, she wants to set off for Gauntlgrym as soon as possible. If the characters accompany her, this journey can easily form part of the bridging material between this chapter and chapter 8. R ECOVERY

AND

D OWNTIME

After their harrowing experiences in the Underdark, the characters might need time to recuperate, ridding themselves of madness and find the means to break curses and cure diseases. Other downtime activities are also possible (as determined by you, the Dungeon Master). For more information oil downtime activities, see the "Downtime Activities” sections in chapter 8 of the Player's Handbook and chapter 6 of the Dungeon Master's Guide.

R ESUPPLY

Characters can visit a surface community or trading post to acquire proper equipment and supplies in exchange for some of the treasures they bring out of the Underdark. By the beginning of chapter 8. they should be properly and fully equipped for the first time since the start of the adventure. WARNINGS The events the characters have witnessed during their harrowing escape are likely to make them want to warn the world that demon lords have come to the Underdark. It's only a matter of time before these fiends find their own way out of the depths, threatening the existence of the surface world. Characters belonging to factions might feel compelled to report to their superiors. Others can share what they've learned with well-connected NPCs who can get the word out. The attention gained by the characters as a result leads into the events of chapter 8. L EVEL ADVANCEMENT

The characters should be 8th level by the start of the next chapter. If they're not there yet. plan additional encounters so that the characters can earn more experience points during their overland journey to Gauntlgrym. If you’d rather skip the encounters and jump ahead to chapter 8. assume that the characters survive a fewharrowing encounters en route (which you can describe or not) and gain enough XP to advance to 8th level by CHAPTER 7 I ESCAPE FROM THE UNDERDARK rt9

the time they reach Gauntlgrym.

ti8

CHAPTER 7 I ESCAPE FROM THF. UNDERDARK

C HAPTER 8: A UDIENCE

IN

G AUNTLGRYM

Come at once to Gauntlgrym for an audience with King Bruenor Battlehammer, to discuss matters of grave importance concerning your experiences in the Underdark.

CHAPTER 8 I AUDIENCE IN CAUNTLGRYM

120

After their escape from the Underdark in chapter 7, the

adventurers have time to rest, recuperate, and reorient

themselves back in the surface world from which they were taken. Some three months after their return, they receive a summons to the dwarf kingdom of Gauntlgrym in the North. King Bruenor Battlehammer desires an audience with them regarding their experiences in the Underdark. Representatives of several factions with an interest in what is happening in the Underdark will also be in attendance. Following the audience, Bruenor extends an offer to the characters, who are tasked with returning to the Underdark once more on a perilous mission.

whatever method best suits the story, depending onwhere they go and what they are doing following their return to the surface world. It can be in the form of a #

messenger carrying a handwritten letter bearing the king’s seal, or even an animal messenger or sending spell focused on one or more of the adventurers. Regardless of how it gets to them, the message is simple and clear:

S UMMONED BY B RUENOR King Bruenor has learned of the characters’ exploits from dwarf merchants and couriers recently returned from the Underdark. (If Eldeth Feldrun was part of the adventurers' successful escape and returned safely to Gauntlgrym, word of the party’s heroics came to Bruenor through her. See “Gauntlgrym Connections.’’) King Bruenor's summons reaches the characters by

CHAPTER 8 I AUDIENCE IN CAUNTLGRYM

121

Characters belonging to any of the factions involved in the meeting at Gauntlgrym (see “Forging an Alliance”) might receive a summons from their faction as well, and could even travel with the representative of that faction to the dwarf hold if circumstances permit. Otherwise, the choice to make the journey is up to the characters, although ignoring Bruenor's request leads the dwarf king to send ever more insistent messages.

G AUNTLGRYM C ONNECTIONS

If Eldeth Feldrun survived and escaped from the Underdark with the characters, she is eager to return home to Gauntlgrym, and does so at the first opportunity. In that case. King Bruenor’s summons might come in the form of a personal message or a visit from her, and it’s likely Bruenor has heard all about the Underdark exploits from Eldeth. If Eldeth didn't survive, she might have charged the characters with returning either her remains or her warhammer and shield to her home. This errand can bring the characters to Gauntlgrym of their own volition even before Bruenor's summons. Either aiding Eldeth's return or honoring her memory enhances the party’s reputation with the dwarves of Gauntlgrym. It also reinforces King Bruenor's opinion that these adventurers are the right people to do the job of investigating the happenings in the Underdark. A RRIVAL

Once the characters arrive at the gates of Gauntlgrym, they are welcomed as the king's guests and escorted into the underground city, through the Vault of Kings (see below), and shown to guest quarters. The dwarves of Gauntlgrym take matters of hospitality seriously, ensuring that the adventurers are offered food, drink, and a chance to rest and refresh themselves before their audience with the king (see “Audience with Bruenor” under “Events in Gauntlgrym"). The characters' arrival is noteworthy, and the dwarves of Gauntlgrym treat them in a manner befitting great dignitaries. You can also have one or two of the faction representatives described under “Forging an Alliance" pass the characters in the corridors of the city, giving them curious looks and perhaps even making a brief introduction—before moving on.

G AUNTLGRYM In ages past, the subterranean city of Gauntlgrym was the capital of the ancient dwarven Delzoun Empire. Its cavernous halls—some large enough to contain entire surface villages—were carved with unerring precision, their ceilings soaring scores of feet overhead. Towering statues of dwTarven gods and heroes stood vigil over chambers and thoroughfares, the least of which was wide enough to march fifty dwarves standing abreast. The mines of Gauntlgrym produced endless tides of iron, silver, gold, and mithral, and booming trade brought goods and wealth to the city from across Faerun. But it was the Great Forge that was the burning heart and true treasure of the city. Deep beneath the settled levels of Gauntlgrym, dwarven crafting and elven magic bound the slumbering primordial Maegera, a being of lire and destruction, harnessing its incredible powers to heat the forge. On anvils of adamantine blessed by priests of Moradin, great items of power were forged, their base material infused with a splinter of Maegera's essence. The unceasing wonders flowing from these

forges helped make Gauntlgrym into one of the most magnificent cities Faerun has ever known. Relations between the great empires of the elves, dwarves, and humans soured as the centuries passed. And so when numberless hordes of ores smashed into the north, each empire stood alone. The wrar was brutal and devastating. Gauntlgrym was swarmed by rampaging armies of ores, and the empire of Delzoun was overrun in the terrible fighting. Ultimately, the dwarves of Delzoun drove back the ores, but at great cost. The once-mighty dwarven empire was left crippled, never to recover, and the great city of Gaundgrym was left in the control of an ore horde. It was humans from nearby Illusk who finally drove the ores from Gauntlgrym, but their hold on the city proved just as short-lived, as foul creatures from the Underdark swarmed from the depths to claim Gauntlgrym as their own. Over the next thousand years, history turned to legend, and mighty Gauntlgrym was all but forgotten on the surface world, lllithids, duergar. drow. and aboleths vied for control of the fallen city, its treasures, and the primordial still bound within its core. The drow House Xorlarrin eventually took Gauntlgrym, establishing a new city they called Q'Xorlarrin. producing weapons at the forge that they traded and used to pay tribute to Menzoberranzan. In recent years, the dwarf hero Bruenor Battlehammer was able to seize the fabled city back from its drow masters. Bruenor, along with his companions Wulfgar, Cattie-brie, Rcgts, and Drizzt Do’Urden, gathered many allies from the surface world and nearby Underdark communities and retook the city. They prevented Maegera from being unleashed upon Faerun. and set about attempting to restore the city to its former glory. Bruenor now sits upon the Great Throne of Moradin, working to rebuild the city and keep it safe—even as a new threat looms in the depths of the Underdark. The following areas within Gauntlgrym might be of some importance during this part of the adventure, although they don’t represent the full measure of the city by any means. A detailed description of every level, chamber, and vault of Gauntlgrym would take up an entire volume of its own, and the characters have limited time to see the wonders of the dwarven city.

THE VAULT OF KINGS_______________ Large enough to enclose a small town, this highceilinged chamber rises above a network of bridges, stone towers, and sturdy walls carved from rock and sheathed in iron and mithral. Dozens of smaller chambers lead out from the Vault of Kings, including sprawling residential areas not yet filled by Gauntlgrym’s new occupants. The vault is on the same level as the city's main gates and can be reached from there, though a system of smaller gates and checkpoints has been set up to keep potential invaders from reaching as far as the throne room. That section of the vault, where the king spends a considerable amount of his time, is a large hall lined w

CHAPTER 8 I AUDIENCE IN GAUNTLGRYM

ith pillars and benches, intended as a meeting place as much as a seat of rulership. The Great Throne of Moradin is protected by powerful magic, and forcefully ejects anyone but the rightful king who attempts to sit upon it. While so seated. Bruenor has advantage on all

CHAPTER 8 I AUDIENCE IN GAUNTLGRYM

Intelligence, Wisdom, and Charisma checks—a divine blessing granted to the king of Gauntlgrym by Moradin and the other dwarven gods. The majority of the city’s current inhabitants live and work within the vault, happy to share tales of the city's reclamation and praise Bruenor's leadership at any opportunity. This is where the characters reside as Bruenor’s guests, and where the representatives of the five factions are likely to be found. Here, residents and guests alike enjoy access to well-lit passages, comfortable quarters, and substantial amounts of food and drink. G A U N T L G R Y M : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

Gauntlgrym is a city carved out of the living rock, with halls and passages wide enough for the largest dragons to walk through. There are hundreds of levels, twisting stairs, functioning elevators, and a system of mine carts crossing in and out of the central hub of the Iron Tabernacle. The players should feel their characters are in a place of great antiquity, poised on the edge of reclaiming its ancient glory. By no means is the city fully occupied. Indeed, given the relatively small size of Bruenor's occupying force, keeping track of anyone within Gauntlgrym is nearly impossible. Light. In the upper levels and around the Iron Tabernacle and Vault of Kings, Gauntlgrym is brightly lit. Driftglobes, phosphorescent fungi, and huge braziers and troughs of burning coals fill most hallways and chambers. Lights in many parts of the city are dimmed somewhat during the nighttime hours, so that its residents can mark the passage of time on the surface world. In the lower reaches, around the Great Forge, light isn’t as ubiquitous. Farther down, and in parts of the city yet to be reclaimed from the ruins of the past, there is no light other than whatever visitors bring with them. Mine Carts. Mining was one of Gauntlgrym’s primary sources of wealth and materials. To facilitate the movement of ore, as well as the great quantities of stone used to construct and expand the city, the dwarves laid miles of track traversed by mine carts propelled by enchantments woven into their wheels. Even after thousands of years, the tracks remain largely intact and the magic of the carts has not faded. Where the carts trundle steadily throughout the city, Gauntlgrym’s residents use them for travel, hopping on and off along the system's wide range of routes. While in Gauntlgrym, the characters can also make use of this convenient transportation system. All tracks eventually lead to a switching station in the Iron Tabernacle. There, posted operators manipulate levers and gears to transfer carts from one track to another. Chosts. The shades of long-deceased inhabitants of the city, from the time of the Delzoun of old, haunt many of the tunnels and hallways of Gauntlgrym. These spectral remnants are seen passing through ruined sections of the city as if those sections were still intact, following habitual routes, engaging in silent conversation with one another, and generally keeping out of the way of the living. From time to time, the characters might run into a dwarven ghost who warns them away from a place of danger, or confront a less beneficial creature such as a shadow or specter. King Bruenor has decreed the restless dead be left alone for now unless they cause problems.

The Vault of Kings is heavily patrolled and guarded by shield dwarf veterans traveling in squads of six. It is the safest part of the city, and the characters can probably depend upon its security enough to rest without interruption in one of the guest suites provided to them, CHAPTER 8 : AUDIENCE IN GAUNTLGRYM

122

barring any unusual occurrences (see “Events in Gauntlgrym”). THE IRON TABERNACLE The Iron Tabernacle is Gauntlgrym’s spiritual and cultural heart as well as its physical center. More than a temple, the tabernacle is an entire section of the city larger than some surface towns, devoted to the faith of the former Delzoun Empire and of the dwarves who answered Bruenor's call to reclaim the city. Vast cathedrals of stone once echoed with the paeans of a thousand chanting voices. Great sculptures in honor of a multitude of gods gazed across an array of shrines and altars. Priests stood ready by night and day to tend to the spiritual needs of their people, and hundreds of stone tablets trumpeted the holy words of Moradin. Like so much else of ancient Gauntlgrym, the Iron Tabernacle isn’t what it once was. The intricate patterns and knotwork have faded from the walls, some of the statues have begun to crumble, and many passages are blocked with rubble. The devilish duergar, once in control of the mines below, took delight in defiling the holy icons of the absent dwarves. They defaced statues, tore down altars, and carved obscenities into the sacred tablets. Anything of value, such as silver or mithral trim, gold icons, and hallowed weapons, has been completely scavenged. R EBUILDING F AITH

Shield dwarf priests have begun the long task of rebuilding, revitalizing, and restoring the Iron Tabernacle to its former glory. The area is vast, and its halls are numerous and multileveled. The dwarf priests have restored many shrines and altars, and have cleared paths through the cracked and broken hallways to the Vault of Kings so that Bruenor can make personal visits to the main shrines and offer thanks to the gods. This procession often includes Bruenor's visitors or those ambassadors from the surface who come to Gauntlgrym to seek counsel with the king. Bruenor leads these processions not only to show off the city and its sheer size, but also to take measure of his guests' endurance and patience in matters of spirit. A LL R OADS L EAD H ERE

As the heart of Gauntlgrym. the Iron Tabernacle is the central hub of the city's passageways and railways. Broad corridors, winding stairs, iron rails, roadways carved into the earth—nearly all the city’s major byways pass through the tabernacle. Every part of Gauntlgrym can be reached from this area, albeit sometimes indirectly. Notably, the Vault of Kings is about a mile to the north of the Iron Tabernacle, and the Great Forge is several hundred feet below it and a half mile to the south.

S LUMBER OF ANCIENTS

The lowest level of the Iron Tabernacle is a seemingly endless collection of crypts. Laid out according to patterns or traditions now lost to time, the tombs contain thousands of Gauntlgrym’s honored dead. Some crypts are simple biers; others are intricate sarcophagi. All include names, titles, and lineage carved into the stone. A number of scholars have been drawn to Gauntlgrym in response to Bruenors call, hoping to record a complete lineage of the great families of Gauntlgrym, including their possible connections to modern bloodlines, from an exhaustive study of the records carved in the crypt's stones. Unlike the rest of the Iron Tabernacle, the tombs are unmarred. Spectral dwarves are common in this area, though their spirits remain quiet as long as visitors are respectful of the dead. If any creatures attempt to deface or steal from the sarcophagi, a mob of dwarven ghosts quickly attacks. Start with a total number of ghosts equal to the number of intruders present, then add two new ghosts for each ghost destroyed. I RON T ABERNACLE R ANDOM E NCOUNTERS

The Iron Tabernacle is close enough to some of the lower reaches and fissures in the Underdark that monsters from below' occasionally find their way in and set up lairs in one shrine or another. The dwarves impress upon the characters to be on their guard, or to take guards with them, if they visit. From time to time, the sound of combat rings through the tabernacle hallways, a contrast to the chanting voices of the priests and a sure sign that something unwelcome has made its way into this most sacred of places. Check for a random encounter once every hour of travel in the Iron Tabernacle by rolling a d20 and consulting the tabic below to determine what, if anything, the characters meet. IRON TABERNAC LE ENCOUNTERS d20 Encou nter 1-12 13 14

No encounter 1 cloaker ld2 driders

15 16 17

1 dwarf ghost (friendly unless attacked) Patrol consisting of six shield dwarf

18 19

ld6 + 1 gargoyles 1 grick alpha and ld4 + 1 gricks

20

ld4 rust monsters

THE

veterans

1 shield dwarf priest and ld4 + 1 shield dwarf acolytes

GREAT FORGE

The Great Forge is a cavernous chamber divided into smaller sections housing furnaces and anvils. Some areas of the cavern are raised on daises of stone, while others stand in shallow pits. Layers of stone catwalks crisscross the chamber, providing not only vantage points but also anchors for pulleys transporting buckets

of ore and water throughout the forge. The Great Forge is about a half mile south of the Iron Tabernacle and several hundred feet below it, and can be reached by mine cart or on foot. It was said of old that the Iron Tabernacle was Gauntlgrym's heart, the Vault of Kings its mind, and the Great Forge its mighty hands. Here, on adamantine anvils blessed by Moradin’s priests, wonders were hammered from iron, mithral, silver, and steel. When Gauntlgrym thrived, the forge echoed with the hammering and songs of a hundred smiths working at once. In time, it might do so again. It was the furnaces of the Great Forge that made this place the apex of the dwarf smiths’ art, for those furnaces are driven by the power of Maegera the Dawn Titan a primordial imprisoned below them. Slumbering within the stone, Maegera exudes an unnatural heat that the dwarves tap into by winding coils of copper and adamantine throughout the forge like webs and using them as conduits to transfer magical heal to their furnaces. Runes of power carved into the walls and etched into the coils allow them to withstand the intense energy. Metals melt almost instantly in the furnaces of the Great Forge, and tools cast from those metals are enchanted with rnofes of primordial essence. When Maegera awoke in the last century, the earth shook, and many of the furnaces’ conduits were severed. Today, lengths of twine-thin metal hang limp and broken throughout the rubble of the Great Forge, which lies upon the bones of those unable to escape the collapse of bridges and walls. Other coils remain in place, and the furnaces to which they are linked burn as hot today as they did in centuries gone by. T HE F IERY P IT

Heat and ruddy light emanate from a pit in the depths of Gauntlgrym. Chambers and tunnels lead away from this chasm at different heights. Despite channels built into the walls to carry water to the magma below, the heat from the pit is ferocious. Gouts of steam billow up through cracks in the stone to fill the chambers above this area, and the earth rumbles in a pulse like labored breathing. The Fiery Pit is the prison of the primordial known as Maegera, who slumbers fitfully in its depths. The only sign of ihe entity's presence is a whirlpool of white-hot magma that resembles a great eye, set in the center of the lake of molten rock at the pit's bottom. Maegera sleeps and dreams, half conscious of its surroundings and half delirious with whatever dreams haunt a being of pure destruction. When the mages of the Arcane Brotherhood first tapped into Maegera’s power, they used water magic to bind elemental that cooled the primordial's rage and kept it asleep. This bond lasted for centuries until the channels of water were closed through trickery by agents of Thay. With the pit’s cooling mechanism shut down. Maegera stirred in its slumber, and its dream of ruination was enough to destroy Gauntlgrym. In the years following, Maegera groggily awoke from CHAPTER 8 | AUDIENCE IN GAUNTLGRYM

123

time to time, causing earthquakes throughout the region. Eventually, the primordial was returned to ils slumber through the efforts of Bruenor, Drizzt

CHAPTER 8 | AUDIENCE IN GAUNTLGRYM

124

Do’Urden, Jarlaxle, and other heroes. Where Maegera sleeps now, the intense heat it generates once again fires the Great Forge of Gauntlgrym. B ACK

IN

O PERATION

Under Bruenor’s watchful governance, the Great Forge has again begun to produce metalworks. If the characters are in the market for any metal goods (including arms and armor), or have any such goods in need of repair or replacement, the dwarves of the Great Forge are happy to help. No magic weapons or armor are available for sale, although damaged magic items can be repaired. The king has left the day-to-day running of the Great Forge to a pair of experienced smiths: Helgrim Candlewick and Rollo Summergold (both shield dwarf veterans). G REAT F ORGE R ANDOM E NCOUNTERS The Great

Forge is always occupied by either Helgrim or Rollo. their apprentices and assistants (2d4 shield dwarf commoners), and shield dwarf veterans working in squads of six to guard the active furnaces. The characters might also encounter other creatures if they explore the unoccupied areas of the Great Forge. Check for such an encounter once per hour of travel or rest outside the protected areas of the forge by rolling a d20 and consulting the Great Forge Encounters table to determine what, if anything, comes out of the darkness. If the heroes call for help, four shield dwarf veterans arrive in ld4 + 1 rounds to aid them. G R E AT F O R C E E N C O U N T E R S d8 Encounter 1-14 No encounter 15 ld4 + 1 doppelgangers disguised as shield dwarves 16 ld2 fire elemental and 3d6 magmins 17 1 salamander and ld4 + 1 fire snakes 18 1 spirit naga 19 3d 6 troglodytes 20 1 wraith leading ld6 + 1 specters

E VENTS IN G AUNTLGRYM This chapter is dominated by negotiation, social activity, and diplomacy—first directed at the characters, then directed by them. The adventurers must first hear what King Bruenor has to say as he entreats them to head back into the Underdark to find out more about the rising threat of the demon lords. Then the characters must help convince the other factions summoned to Gauntlgrym to aid them on their mission. This section of the adventure has some opportunity for action, but players who enjoy plotting, making plans, and pitting NPCs against one another can shine here. Take note of your players’ preferences. If they’re not much for long periods of conversation with NPCs, you might want to move things along a little more quickly. On the other hand, you can really bring to life not just the faction representatives and the dwarf king in this chapter, but also highlight the personalities and goals of the characters and any NPCs who remain with them.

CHAPTER 8 | AUDIENCE IN GAUNTLGRYM

A UDIENCE

WITH

B RUENOR

After the characters arrive and are shown to guest accommodations, they are allowed some time to refresh and prepare themselves. They are then called to an audience with Bruenor Battlehammer, the king of Gauntlgrym. Read or paraphrase the following: You are taken to a mighty hall in which a red-haired dwarf of fierce and proud demeanor sits upon a massive stone throne, flanked by a number of guards and advisors. Although a long stone table has been set to one side, laid out with refreshments, there do not appear to be any other guests. “Welcome, friends," says the king. “I’ve a mind to know about the rumblings and rumors about goings-on in the depths outside my city. If ye relate to me what ye know, we can talk about what ye might want to do next.”

King Bruenor listens carefully to what the adventurers have to say. Once the adventurers have told their talc, Bruenor might have a few questions, particularly concerning the threat of the demon lords. The dwarf king answers questions from the characters if they have any. However, if asked about his overall plans, he says simply that he must consider all the information presented to him and consult with advisors. With the audience at an end, Bruenor tells the characters he will consider all they have told him, and that they will speak again at a welcoming feast later thal night. G UESTS

AT THE

F EAST

After the characters have had a chance to speak with Bruenor and take care of any personal business, the Vault of Kings plays host to a memorable feast. In attendance are representatives of different factions from the surface world, who have come to Gauntlgrym following rumors of bizarre events in the Underdark. If any of the adventurers belong to a faction, representatives of that faction might even be following up on information provided by the characters themselves. See “Forging an Alliance” for more information. The celebration serves both to welcome the adventurers, who are seated at the high table with Bruenor, and to provide an opportunity for the representatives of the different factions to gather socially and be officially introduced to the adventurers. In addition to the king and his allies, a number of dwarves from Bruenor's court and important citizens of Gauntlgrym are also present. The feast is also an opportunity for you to include NPCs of your choice who might either be from or visiting Gauntlgrym, or part of the entourage of one of the representatives. This is a free-form scene, which you can play out as best suits your group. It can range from a detailed roleplaying session, with characters mixing and mingling with their potential allies and members of Gauntlgrym society, or just a brief description of the

event and the characters’ initial impressions of the faction representatives, before their later efforts to negotiate with those representatives for the factions' aid. If you want to add some intrigue or action, consider having one of the options from “Enemies Among Us" interrupt the feast, giving the characters an opportunity to demonstrate their abilities in front of their potential patron and allies. Rogue fire elementals roaring out of the hearth or a disguised assassin poisoning one or more of the representatives can completely change the scene. B RUENOR ’ S P LAN

Once the feast winds down, Bruenor excuses himself as the guests depart. Shortly thereafter, a servant comes to collect the characters and takes them to a private chamber where the king of Gauntlgrym awaits them. His previously friendly manner has turned grave.

B R U E N O R B ATT L E H A M M E R

The legendary Bruenor Battlehammer is a good dwarf and king, and always has the best interests of his people and home at heart. He is drawn to help characters who follow a strong moral and ethical code, and often seeks their help in return. Use his good humor and folksy demeanor to help endear him to the players. The more the players grow to like him, the easier it is for them to respect his advice and request—and to gain more resources and assistance from him in turn.

If the characters are agreeable, the king tells them the next step is to bring the various factions on board. One of the reasons he is looking to the adventurers to lead a new mission into the Underdark, apart from their experience, is that they can serve as brokers among all the various parties with an interest in the mission. They need to meet with the different faction representatives, emphasizing the importance of getting the Zhentarim to agree to grant access to Mantol-Derith. Otherwise.

“I’ve told the allies ye met tonight what ye told me,” he says. “I invited them here to learn what is happening, to share what we know, and to get their backing for what it is I propose. Ye have braved the Underdark and lived to tell the tale. Ye know, better than anyone, what it is we face, but we need to know more. “The Zhentarim have a stake in a secret Underdark trading post called Mantol-Derith. If ye can get them on our side, they’ll guide ye there, where ye can meet with one of their agents, Ghazrim DuLoc, He can provide ye with a map to Gravenhollow. It's a legendary place built by the stone giants long ago, satd to contain all the knowledge of the depths. If there’s answers to be found for what has happened, ye might find them there. If ye are willing to go back, that is. "I don’t propose to send ye into the dark unprepared, and I hope ye make an impression on those gathered here so they’ll support our cause and your mission. From all I've seen and heard, there's no one better to do what needs be done. “So, what say ye?"

Paraphrase Bruenor’s speech as needed to handle interjections by the characters. The king provides honest answers to any questions. He truly does believe the characters represent the best option to find out more about the demonic threat, unless they've given him any reason to think otherwise. Bruenor assures the adventurers they will have his gratitude and that of all Gauntlgrym—indeed, of all Faerun—if they are successful. If the i characters press for details or try to negotiate M compensation for their service, the king points out that Gauntlgrym has considerable space, and he can offer them titles, property, and the ™ products of the Great Forge as rewards. Such mercenary negotiation lowers Bruenor’s opinion of the adventurers a bit, but he never loses his genial manner.

B R U E N O R B ATT L E H A M M E R

CHAPTER 8

I

AUDIENCE IN GAUNTLGRYM

125

the journey to locate Gravenhollow is likely to be much longer and more difficult. E NEMIES AMONG

US

Even Gauntlgrym isn't entirely safe, nor is it immune to the influence of the demon lords. During the characters’ time in the city, you can implement one or more of the following threats to challenge them and to potentially disrupt their negotiations with the factions. • One of the characters’ traveling companions is revealed as a traitor or succumbs to madness. This NPC secretly serves one of the demon lords and turns against the adventurers. • If any of the party’s drow pursuers survived from the previous chapter, they might slip into Gauntlgrym and look to slay their quarry. • A dwarf assassin belonging to a demon-worshiping cult steals into Gauntlgrym to kill one or more of the faction representatives. Hoping to cast suspicion onto the adventurers, the assassin frames them as demonic agents. • A doppelganger spy poses as one of the faction representatives and tries to arrange a private meeting with one or more of the characters, hoping to discover additional information regarding the looming threat. The doppelganger might serve a faction of the Underdark or a surface world faction Bruenor didn’t invite (such as the Arcane Brotherhood or the Red Wizards of Thay), or might simply be an opportunist looking to sell information to the highest bidder. • Maegera roars within its prison, stirred by the madness and chaos growing within the depths of the Underdark. As a natural reaction to this new stress upon itself, the primordial spawns a trio of fire elementals that attack the Vault of Kings, setting fire to marketplaces and unleashing chaos upon the dwarven residents. If defeated or somehow convinced to return to the Fiery Pit, the elementals dissipate peacefully and Maegera falls dormant once again ... for now.

F ORGING AN A LLIANCE King Bruenor has called representatives of the Harpers, the Order of the Gauntlet, the Emerald Enclave, the Lords’ Alliance, and the Zhentarim to Gauntlgrym to hear about the state of things in the Underdark and to court their aid in finding out more about the situation. The representatives of each faction receive a briefing on what the characters told Bruenor, and all have an opportunity to converse with the adventurers before making their decisions as to whether they will support Bruenor’s plans. To play out these meetings, use the social interaction rules provided in chapter 8, “Running the Game," of the Dungeon Master’s Guide. Some representatives are fine with meeting the adventurers in the Vault of Kings, but you might have others request a private or even clandestine meeting—perhaps in the characters’ quarters, in an out-of-the-way alcove of the Iron Tabernacle, or in

126

CHAPTER 8 I AUDIENCE IN GAUNTLGRYM

the Great Forge. King Bruenor is the original proponent of the adventurers returning to the Underdark to gather

additional information, but he knows that success requires the support of the other factions—particularly the Zhentarim. He doesn't, however, have the power to command the factions to help—and in some cases, can’t even openly negotiate with them. As King of Gauntlgrym, he can't be seen to favor one faction over another. He is therefore relying on the characters to do the legwork of getting the different factions on board. If the characters are already involved with one or more factions, and especially if they have previously contacted the factions with news of developments in the Underdark, adjust the information presented below as needed. T HE H ARPERS

Members of this clandestine network of spellcasters and spies pride themselves on being incorruptible defenders of the greater good and champions of the oppressed. Harper agents are trained to act alone and rely on their own resources. When they get into scrapes, they don't count on fellow Harpers to rescue them. Sometimes Harper agents must band together to face world- threatening foes, at which point the deep friendships between them forge the kind of fighting force needed to overthrow tyranny and eradicate evil. Harper scouts engaged in charting and blocking off Underdark passages leading to the surface world have recently brought back the terrifying news of the demon lords’ incursion into the Underdark. Word has spread quickly through their network, and the finest mages in their ranks are researching how to defeat the demon lords and their kind. For long years, the Harpers have sworn to put an end to unbridled evil in all its forms—especially evil that wields dark magic. They know the demon lords seek to prey on the weak and corrupt the innocent. The Harpers feel this is the moment they have trained for, and their conscience now calls them to act. L ORD Z ELRAUN R OARINGHORN Lawful neutral male human wizard

Ideals: Freedom, opportunity, civilization Personality: Proud, self-assured, fickle, spendthrift Potential Resources: Shield guardian Lord Roaringhorn hails from a Watcrdhavian noble family, with all the self-assurance and pride that entails. He pursued his talent for the arcane arts, but never forgot his roots or lost his fondness for spending his family’s considerable income on the finer things in life. He's a confident sort who likes to gamble. Winning over Roaringhorn requires a willingness to dine, drink, and potentially game with him. Lord Roaringhorn is accompanied by a shield guardian and holds its control amulet. The shield

CHAPTER 8 I AUDIENCE IN GAUNTLGRYM

127

guardian currently has a lightning holt spell stored within it. A character can gain use of the shield guardian by winning a game of chess against the Harper wizard. Zelraun suggests a match after dinner. A chess match takes 1 hour, and the outcome is determined by a best-of-three Intelligence check contest. Zelraun's experience gives him a +9 modifier to his Intelligence checks. Zelraun loans the shield guardian and its control amulet to the first character to beat him at the game. If Zelraun proves unbeatable, you can decide that Zelraun. ever the gracious winner, loans the shield guardian and amulet to the party on the provision that the characters vow to redeem themselves with a rematch upon their return from the Underdark. If a character obtains Zelraun’s shield guardian and control amulet, photocopy the Shield Guardian stat card at the end of this chapter and give it to the player whose character has the amulet. If the amulet changes hands, so too does the shield guardian and its stat card. If the characters attack Zelraun, use the archmage statistics in the Monster Manual to represent him. T HE O RDER G AUNTLET

OF THE

The Order of the Gauntlet is a dedicated, tightly knit group of holy-minded crusaders driven by a finely honed sense of justice and honor. Friendship and camaraderie are important to members of the order, and they share a trust normally reserved for siblings. They seek to uphold justice as best they can, and to continually test their mettle against the forces of evil. There are few, if any, lone operatives in this organization. Working in pairs and small groups reinforces the bonds of friendship and helps keep members from straying off the path of righteousness. The Underdark has always been a proving ground for candidates of the order, as well as a frequent destination for veteran paladins, monks, and clerics looking to smite evil. It hasn’t taken long for reports of new threats rising in the Underdark to reach the order. The demon lords embody the kind of evil the Order of the Gauntlet is sworn to destroy. All members of the order see the evolving situation as an opportunity to deal a mighty blow to the forces of the Abyss. They want to send the demon lords howling back into the pit, proving the worth of the order as well as testing their own valor and bravery. S IR L ANNIVER S TRAYL

Lawful good human fighter Ideals: Faith, devotion, justice, duty Personality: Patient, determined, witty Potential Resources: Order of the Gauntlet veterans

128

CHAPTER 8 I AUDIENCE IN GAUNTLGRYM

A devout follower of Tyr and a member of the Order of the Gauntlet, Sir Lanniver is the most respected figure

among the factions in Gauntlgrym. Little surprises him at this point in his life, and he accepts what comes with a wry wit and an unshakable faith that things will always work out—provided those of good intent do what must be done. If most of the characters in the party are of good alignment. Sir Lanniver is supportive of their mission and wants them to succeed. However, a party of mostly neutral or evil characters will need to work to gain his support. If he's of a mind to provide aid. Sir Lanniver pledges five human veterans of the order to the party's mission. The veterans’ names are Thora Nabal, Sylrien Havennor, Olaf Renghyi, Elias Drako. and Tamryn Tharke. Sir Lanniver can also offer a member of the party a +1 warhammer, one of a handful of treasures held in trust by the order. He prefers to bestow this weapon on a goodor neutral-aligned cleric or paladin. Feel free to swap this magic weapon with another magic item more useful to the adventurers. If the veterans accompany the party, make five photocopies of the Veteran of the Gauntlet stat card at the end of this chapter. If you don't want to control the veterans yourself, you can distribute the stat cards among the players and let them run the MFCs. Should Sir Lanniver come under attack, use the knight statistics in the Monster Manual to represent him. In addition to the veterans mentioned above. Sir Lanniver travels with a young but able squire (female human guard) named Rhiele Vannis. T HE E MERALD E NCLAVE

Members of the Emerald Enclave are spread far and wide across the Sword Coast and the North. They usually operate in isolation, relying on their own abilities and instincts to survive. Living deep in the wilderness demands great fortitude and the mastery of certain fighting and survival skills. Down in the Underdark, far from the wild lands, the Emerald Enclave must remain ever vigilant to avoid being blindsided by unnatural forces. Some members of the enclave engage with the people of the world as protectors, emerging from the wilderness to help others survive its perils. Some are charged with defending sacred glades and preserving the natural balance. At times, however, all members of the order are called together to combat foes great enough to disrupt or destroy the natural order. The demon lords are one such threat. Druids and scouts of the Emerald Enclave have recently witnessed the corruption spreading through of the flora and fauna of the Underdark. In particular, they have tracked this corruption back to Zuggtmoy and Juiblex, with the demon lords both infecting different parts of the subterranean realm. The Emerald Enclave fights tirelessly against the corruption of nature. Its members are well aware that

CHAPTER 8 I AUDIENCE IN GAUNTLGRYM

129

the newly seen demonic corruption will not be contained within the Underdark for long. Eventually it will break through to the surface and threaten all Faerun—and by the time it does, it might be too late to stop it. M ORISTA M ALKIN

Neutral good shield dwarf scout

Ideals: Loyalty, nature, the dwarven people Personality: Stern, stubborn, insightful Potential Resources: Emerald Enclave scouts and giant lizard mounts Morista Malkin is the only faction representative who currently resides in Gauntlgrym. Originally from the Silver Marches, she heard Bruenor’s call to reclaim the glory of the ancient line of Delzoim and followed him to Gauntlgrym, Here, she balances her work with the Emerald Enclave and her loyalty to her people and their cause. Stern and stubborn, Morista sees it as her duty to protect the people of Gauntlgrym from the often savage nature of the Underdark and to remind them of its natural beauty. She serves King Bruenor as an advisor and both admires and respects him. Morista spends some of her time training elite scouts to reconnoiter the Underdark passages near the city. A few months ago. one of her scouts—a wood elf named Sladis Vadir—disappeared while on a mission in the Underdark, Hopeful that the characters might stumble upon Sladis and see him safely back to Gauntlgrym, Morista pledges a team of three shield dwarf scouts to accompany them, along with a giant lizard mount for each enclave scout and each player character. The scouts are named Brim Coppervein, Thargus Forkbeard, and Griswalla Stonehammer. If the characters accept the Emerald Enclave’s support, make three photocopies of the Emerald Enclave Scout stat card at the end of this chapter as well as photocopies of the Giant Riding Lizard stat card (one for each enclave scout and player character). If you don't want to control the scouts and giant lizards yourself, you can distribute their stat cards among the players and let them run the NPCs. Should Morista come under attack, use the scout statistics in the Monster Manual to represent her. T H E L O R D S ’ AL L I A N C E The Lords’ Alliance is a political and economic coalition of cities spread throughout the North and the Sword Coast. The alliance owes its success to effective cooperation and diplomacy between its members, who work to align their separate settlements toward a mutual purpose. This cooperation is easier during times of crisis, making the Lords’ Alliance a powerful force when threats require a united front. The agents of the Lords’ Alliance work to maintain the delicate network CHAPTER 8 | AUDIENCE IN GAUNTLGTtYM

130

of information and diplomacy that sustains their order, alert for anything that might threate.n the alliance’s interests. Recent reports of unusual activity from the Underdark might mark one such threat. The alliance has noted how many Underdark sites near their settlements have gone quiet. Routine forays and raids onto the surface world have come to a halt, as has the flow of trade and information. Rumors have reached the Lords’ Alliance of demon-worshiping cults and chaos around places such as Blingdenstone and Menzoberranzan, though they have little confirmation. The possibility that the demon lords of the Abyss are active in the Underdark is a threat the Lords’ Alliance can’t ignore. L ORD E RAVIEN H AUND

Lawful neutral half-elf noble

Ideals: Order, society, peace, stability Personality: Charming, sly, worldly Potential Resources: Lords’ Alliance guards and spies The representative of the Lords’ Alliance is a noble of Tethyrian and moon elf heritage, his youthful looks belying his actual age and experience. Although he hails from Waterdeep, Lord Eravien often travels to other alliance settlements. He’s a charming and sly courtier, able to immediately size up any social situation, but his fondness for socializing often distracts him from what’s important. As a result, Eravien has heard relatively little of the recent events in the Underdark, and he is initially unconvinced of the importance of the party’s mission. If they can convince him otherwise, Lord Eravien arranges for some agents of the Lords' Alliance to join the expedition: * Five dwarf guards from the alliance city of Mirabar, Their names are Nazrok Blucaxe, Kirsil Mantlehorn. Anzar the Brazen. Gargathine Truesilver, and Splinter Darkmorn. • Three human spies from the alliance city of Yartar. Their names are Farryl Kilmander, Zilna Oakshadow and Hilvius Haever, If the party accepts these NPCs into its ranks, make five photocopies of the Lords’ Alliance Guard and three photocopies of the Lords’ Alliance Spy stat cards at the. end of this chapter. If you don't want to control these NPCs yourself, you can distribute their stat cards among the players and let them run the NPCs. Eravien knows that the Lords’ Alliance has a deepcover operative in the Underdark. Khelessa Draga, a high elf from Silverymoon, was sent to spy on the drow over a year ago. Eravien knows that Khelessa uses magic to disguise herself as a dark elf and warns the characters not to attack any drow they encounter until they can confirm the target isn't Khelessa in disguise. The Lords' Alliance lost contact with Khelessa months ago, so Eravien doesn’t know where she is. Should Lord Eravien come under attack, use the noble statistics in the Monster Manual to represent him He travels with three servants (strongheart halfling commoners) and three well-paid human guards.

"

T H E Z H E N T AR I M Members of the shadowy Black Network consider themselves part of an extended family, and rely on the larger organization for resources and security. The Zhentarim recognizes and rewards ambition, granting its members autonomy to pursue their own interests and gain some measure of personal power or influence. In this way, the organization is a meritocracy. The Zhentarim welcomes dangerous times as opportunities. When a merchant caravan needs an escort, a noble needs bodyguards, or a city needs trained soldiers, the Zhentarim provides the best-trained fighting forces money can buy. Zhentarim agents traveling to and from MantolDerith have recently passed on information and rumors concerning demonic activity in the Underdark. The organization's members have yet to realize the full extent of the threat, as corruption and madness have already infiltrated their secret outpost since those initial reports (see chapter 9). However, even the most cautious member of the Zhentarim knows that demons at large in the world are bad for business. The organization thus views the possible presence of the demon lords in the Underdark with the same concern as any other external threat to their way of life. Zhentarim bonds of oath and honor hold the network together and galvanize its members in united purpose. More importantly, those bonds reflect the pattern of tight control that the leaders of the Zhentarim hope to one day see imposed across the North and beyond. The organization is thus willing to commit to stop the demon lords from breaching the surface knowing that such a fate would destroy the Zhentarim’s plans for control of Faerun.

the plan, and though she ultimately won't withhold that access from the adventurers, she intends to make sure it's not given away for free. Davra deals with the

D AVRA J ASSUR

Lawful evil human assassin

Ideals: Order, discipline, ambition Personality: Driven, focused, ruthless Potential Resources: Zhentarim thugs Graceful and elegant as a blade, Davra Jassur ostensibly recruits promising new talent for the Zhentarim. But she also deals with internal problems, ensuring those problems are nipped in the bud before they can reveal any weakness within the organization. The pragmatic Davra values order and discipline as well as drive and ambition, and she embodies all those traits. The Zhentarim's intelligence-gathering resources and access to an established Underdark ouLpost give the organization the strongest hand of any of the factions, and Davra knows it. Access to Mantul-Derith is key to CHAPTER 8 AUDIENCE IN GAUNTLGRYM

131

adventurers directly—and privately, if possible— asking for a full share of any treasure the characters claim during their next incursion into the Underdark, and a full reporting to her of all information given to Bruenor or the other faction leaders. If one of the characters is a member of the Zhentarim, Davra tries to make the deal for information with that character alone. In addition to access to the hidden trading post of Mantol-Derith, Davra Jassur can provide Zhentarim mercenaries to fill out the expedition. These eight human thugs proudly wear the crest of the Black Network on their armor. If these NPCs join the party, make eight photocopies of the Zhentarim Thug stat card at the end of this chapter. If you don't want to control these NPCs yourself, you can distribute their stat cards among the players and let them run the NPCs. The thugs' names are Nero Kelvane, Lenora Haskur. Aligor Moonwhisper, Gorath Torn, Saliyra Dalnor, Primwin Halk, landro Alathar, and Lhytris Ilgarn. All of them know the route to Mantol-Derith, Davra is an assassin. In addition to her weapons, she carries dust of disappearance and wears goggles of night while roaming the dark halls of Gauntlgrym.

T HE W AY A HEAD Depending on how negotiations go, the characters are cither an advance force to scout and soften up opposition in the Underdark while looking for valuable strategic information, or a diversionary expedition meant to buy time for the surface world to organize a stronger response. Faction representatives not impressed by the adventurers' cause might return to their factions convinced that the characters have little chance of succeeding—or surviving. The others are confident that the characters can live up to the promise they demonstrated in escaping from the drow and the Underdark. King Bruenor convenes a final gathering of his inner circle of advisors and the adventurers, giving the characters his thanks for their commitment to the light against the demon lords. “Ye all know the dangers and threats o f the world below, and have bought that knowledge with bravery and guile. Even more, in diplomacy have ye forged the first of the connections that will seethe North prepared for what might come. If we survive the coming onslaught, we'll have ye to thank, and no dwarf of Gauntlgrym will soon forget it. Ye all have the courage and conviction of heroes. Aye, I'll even say ye remind me of other heroes I’ve known. From a previous life. ..."

The characters have at least a few days before they must venture into the Underdark again—time they can spend to shape their plans, gather resources, and prepare for the threats that stand ahead of them. When they are ready to CHAPTER 8

132

I AUDIENCE

IN CAUNTLGRYM

brave the Underdark once again, they can start the long and dangerous journey to Mantol-Derith (see chapter 9),

NAME:

SHIELD GUARDIAN

Large construct, unaligned

VETERAN OF THE GAUNTLET

Armor Class 17 (natural armor) Hit Points 142 (lSdl0 + 60) Speed 30

Medium humanoid (human), lawful good

ft. STR

18 (+4)

DEX

8 (-1)

CON

18 (+4)

INT

7 (-2)

WIS

10 (+0)

CHA

3 (-4)

Senses blindsight 10 ft., darkvision 60 ft., passive

Perception 10

Damage Immunities poison Condition Immunities charmed, exhaustion, frightened,

paralyzed, poisoned Languages understands commands given in any language but can't speak Challenge 7 (2,900 XP)

Armor Class 17 (splint) Hit Points 58 (9d8 + 18) Speed 30 ft. STR DEX CON INT WIS CHA

16 (+3)

13 (+1)

14 (+2)

10 (+0)

11 (+0)

10 (+0)

Skills Athletics +5, Perception +2 Senses passive Perception 12 Languages Common, Dwarvish Challenge 3 (700 XP)

A CTIONS ________________________________________________ Bound. The shield guardian is magically bound to an amulet.

Multiattack. The veteran makes two longsword attacks. If it

As long as the guardian and its amulet are on the same plane of existence, the amulet’s wearer can telepathically call the guardian to travel to it, and the guardian knows the distance and direction to the amulet. If the guardian is within 60 feet of the amulet's wearer, half of any damage the wearer takes (rounded up) is transferred to the guardian.

has a shortsword drawn, it can also make a shortsword attack. Longsword. Melee Weapon Attack: +5 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target. Hit: 7 (ld8 + 3) slashing damage, or 8 (IdlO + 3) slashing damage if used with two hands.

Regeneration. The shield guardian regains 10 hit points at the

target. Hit: 6 (1 d6 + 3) piercing damage. Heavy Crossbow. Ranged Weapon Attack: +3 to hit, range 100/400 ft., one target. Hit: 5 (IdlO) piercing damage.

start of its turn if it has at least 1 hit point. Spell Storing. A spellcaster who wears the shield guardian’s

amulet can cause the guardian to store one spell of 4th level or lower. To do so, the wearer must cast the spell on the guardian. The spell has no effect but is stored within the guardian. When commanded to do so by the wearer or when a situation arises that was predefined by the spellcaster, the guardian casts the spell stored with any parameters set by the original caster, requiring no components. When the spell is cast or a new spell is stored, any previously stored spell is lost. A CTIONS

______________________________________

Shortsword. Melee Weapon Attack: +5 to hit, reach 5 ft., one

NAME:

EMERALD ENCLAVE SCOUT Medium humanoid (dwarf), lawful

neutral

Armor Class 16 (breastplate) Hit Points 19 (3d8 + 6) Speed 25 ft.

Multiattack. The guardian makes two fist attacks. Fist. Melee Weapon Attack: +7 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target. Hit:

11 (2d6+4) bludgeoning damage. R EACTIONS _______________________________________________ Shield. When a creature makes an attack against the wearer of

the guardian’s amulet, the guardian grants a +2 bonus to the wearer's AC if the guardian is within 5 feet of the wearer.

STR

DEX

11 (+0)

14 (+2)

CON

14 (+2)

INT

n (+o)

WIS

CHA

13 (+1)

11 (+0)

Skills Nature +4, Perception +5, Stealth +6, Survival +5 Damage Resistances poison Senses darkvision 60 ft., passive Perception 15 Languages Common, Dwarvish Challenge 1/2 (100

XP) Dwarven Resilience. The scout has advantage on saving throws

against poison. Keen Hearing and Sight. The scout has advantage on Wisdom

(Perception) checks that rely on hearing or sight. A CTIONS _________________________________________________ Multiattack. The scout makes two melee attacks. War Pick. Melee Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target.

Hit: 7 (ld8 + 3) piercing damage. Heavy Crossbow. Ranged Weapon Attack: +3 to hit, range 100/400

ft., one target. Hit: 5 (IdlO) piercing damage.

CHAPTER 8 AUDIENCE IN GAUNTLGRYM

133

N AME :

| N AME : I 1

LORDS’ ALLIANCE GUARD

i ZHENTARIM THUG

Medium humanoid (dwarf), chaotic good

Armor Class 16 (chain shirt, shield) Hit Points 11 (2d8+2) Speed 30 ft. STR 14 (+2)

DEX CON 12 (+1) 12 (+1)

INT 10 (+0)

WIS 11 (+0)

1 l

CHA 10 (+0)

Skills Perception +2 Damage Resistances poison Senses darkvision 60 ft., passive Perception 12 Languages Common, Dwarvish Challenge 1/4 (50 XP)

Dwarven Resilience. The guard has advantage on saving throws

! Medium humanoid (human), neutral i ! Armor Class 11 (leather armor) ! Hit Points 32 (5d8 + 10) ! Speed 30 ft. 1 ! STR j 15 (+2)

DEX 11 (+0)

CON 14 (+2)

! i i ! INT 10 (+0)

WIS 10 (+0)

CHA ! 11 (+0) j

1 1 i Skills Intimidation+2 ' 1 1 ' Senses passive Perception 10 ' Languages Common • Challenge 1/2 (100 XP) i i [ Pack Tactics. The thug has advantage on an attack roll against J | a creature if at least one of the thug’s allies is within 5 feet of [ ! the creature and the ally isn’t incapacitated. [

against poison. A CTIONS Halberd. Melee Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, reach 10 ft., one target. Hit: 7 (ldlO + 2) slashing damage.

! ACTIONS I _ 1

Multiattack. The thug makes two melee attacks i i J Mace. Melee Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target. | [ Hit: 5 (ld6 + 2) bludgeoning damage. |

N AME :

LORDS’ ALLIANCE SPY

J

i

1

! Heavy Crossbow. Ranged Weapon Attack: +2 to hit, range ! 100/400 ft., one target. Hit: 5 (ldlO) piercing damage. 1

Medium humanoid (human), neutral

1 Armor Class 13 (leather armor) Hit Points 27 (6d8) Speed 30 ft. STR 10 (+0)

DEX CON 15 (+2) 10 (+0)

INT 12 (+1)

WIS 14 (+2)

CHA 16 (+3)

1

G

R

■ IANT IDING j Large beast, unaligned ■

LIZARD i

Class (natural !| Armor Hit Points 1912 (3dl0 + 3) armor) [ Speed 30 ft., climb 30 ft. 11

! STR DEX CON INT WIS Skills Deception +5, Insight +4, Investigation +5, Perception ! 15 (+2) 12 (+1) 13 (+1) 2 (-4) 10 (+0) +6, Persuasion +5, Sleight of Hand +4, Stealth +4 Senses passive Perception 16 Languages Common, Dwarvish i Senses darkvision 30 ft., passive Perception 10 Challenge 1 (200 XP) i Languages — ! Challenge 1/4 (50 XP)

!! ! CHA 5 (-3)

|

Cunning Action. On each of its turns, the spy can use a bonus

action to take the Dash, Disengage, or Hide action. Sneak Attack (I/Turn). The spy deals an extra 7 (2d6) damage

! !

I

lizard canclimb difficult surfaces, including | [ upside down on ceilings, without needing to make an J ability check. ! |

Spider Climb. The

|

when it hits a target with a weapon attack and has advantage on the attack roll, or when the target is within 5 feet of an ally I ACTIONS 1 Bite. Melee Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target. of the spy that isn’t incapacitated and the spy doesn’t have [ Hit: 6 (ld8 + 2) piercingdamage. disadvantage on the attack roll. 1 ACTIONS

Multiattack. The spy makes two melee attacks. Shortsword. Melee Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target.

Hit: 5 (ld6+ 2) piercing damage. Hand Crossbow. Ranged Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, range 30/120 ft., one

CHAPTER 8 I AUDIENCE IN GAUNTI-CRYM

1 J

:

1

target. Hit: 5 (ld6 + 2) piercing damage.

CHAPTER 9: MANTOL-DERITH Mantol-Derith has endured for centuries as a neutral outpost where drow, duergar, svirfneblin, and surface dwellers can meet and trade without fearing for their lives. Despite its usefulness and the safety it enjoys. Mantol-Derith has never become a proper town. Those who maintain it as a trade hub have resisted any urge for expansion, apart from installing basic infrastructure to assist with commercial activities. The Zhentarim took over the holdings where surface dwellers conducted business and quickly cornered the market for surface goods, gaining the organization a foothold in the Underdark. This presence grew into a power base that serves the Black Network well, and which is now being made available to the characters. Upon arrival, however, the characters discover there is no safe haven anywhere in the Underdark with the demon lords running rampant. The safety of MantolDerith has been shattered by the demon lord

Fraz-Urb’luu, who has turned the trading outpost's various factions against one another. The characters must navigate and overcome the madness dominating Mantol-Derith in order to find their Zhentarim contact, Ghazrim DuLoc. He has the means for them to reach the stone giant library of Gravenhollow (see chapter 11). whose vast lore might provide some clue as to what has brought the demon lords to the Underdark.

F RAZ -U RB ’ LUU ’ S G EM Having previously been imprisoned for many mortal lifetimes on the Material Plane, Fraz-Urbluu had taken steps to bind himself to his layer of the Abyss. As soon as he felt the tug of Gromph's spell, Fraz-Urb'luu transferred his evil life force to a specially crafted, magically protected receptacle a black jewel. However, the spell proved irresistible, and the precious receptacle was cast into the Underdark. As a further indignity, Ffaz-Urb’luu found himself trapped within the gem, unable to escape while on the Material Plane.

I*

is >f v •'

*

..■ *5r

\

I

CHAPTER 9 | MANTOL-DERITH

‘33

Anyone who touches the gem risks falling prey to delusional madness. A ducrgar ale merchant named Krimgol Muzgardt found the gem and took it to MantolDerith. By the time he arrived, Krimgol had succumbed to the delusion that he was a caJassabrak a duergar without honor. He paid Yantha Coaxrock. an honest svirfneblin mage, to appraise the jewel, hoping that he could use it to buy back the goodwill of his clan. Touched by the gem's madness, Yantha lied to Krimgol and told him the gem was worthless. She offered a lump of gold in exchange, whereupon Krimgol suspected treachery and demanded the gem's immediate return. While Krimgol and Yantha argued, one of Yantha’s apprentices tried to hide the gem for his mistress but succumbed to its evil power. The apprentice, Flink, took the gem to the drow enclave, hoping to trade it for some rare spell components that he imagined Yantha needing to make Krimgol go away. A gargoyle assigned to watch for thieves spotted the gem and wrested it from Flink. who hid for fear of incurring Yantha’s wrath. Soon thereafter, the delusional gargoyle laid eyes on a drow assassin named Kinyel Druu’giir and was instantly smitten by her. The gargoyle gave her the black gem as a token of its devotion, which she, in her madness, mistook as a payment from the drow enclave to assassinate Lorthtiun, a maimed beholder allied with the Zhentarim. Yantha's theft of the gern led Krimgol to leave and return with duergar reinforcements. They attacked the sviffneblin enclave and captured Yantha, triggering open conflict between the two enclaves. With the fragile truce in Mantol-Derith finally broken, the drow are preparing to take out the weakened duergar and -virfneblin forces. Meanwhile, Druu’giir has infiltrated a drow delegation sent to meet with representatives of ■he Zhentarim enclave to discuss how best to divvy up Mantol-Derith between them. Finding and destroying the gem prevents others from falling prey to Fraz-Urb'luu’s madness. While imprisoned inside the gem, Fraz-UrbTuu retains his alignment and senses (see appendix D). but loses all of his other attributes and can’t take actions. The gem is as big as a human fist and has AC 10, 1 hit point, immunity to poison and psychic damage, and immunity to bludgeoning, piercing, and slashing damage from nonmagical weapons. It is also immune to any spell effect that requires a saving throw. White inside the gem, the demon lord can't be attacked, harmed, coerced, or heard. He can be contacted via telepathy, however. Shattering the gem releases Fraz-Urb'luu's life force, which instantly returns to the demon lord’s body in the Abyss. Any creature that touches the gem must succeed on a DC 23 Charisma saving throw' or succumb to a form of indefinite madness, as determined by roiling on the Indefinite Madness of Fraz-Urb'luu table in appendix D. A creature that succeeds on the saving throw is immune to the madness-inducing effect of the gem for the next 24 hours. The madness lasts until cured.

If the characters destroy Fraz-Urb'luu's gem, award each of them 1,000 XP. M A N T O L - D E R I T H : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

Characters encounter the following features inside MantolDerith. Climate. Mantol-Derith is chilly and damp thanks to the waterfalls and streams flowing through the cavern and into the Darklake. Light. Mantol-Derith is brightly lit by continual flame spells and crystals in the walls that reflect the light. A network of walkways and small plazas crisscross the rocky ground of the outpost, paved with crushed crystals that also reflect light. ->*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

w-

R EACHING M ANTOL -D ERITH If the characters reached an agreement with Davra Jassur in chapter 8, they can travel to Mantol-Derith along one of the many routes the Zhentarim use to move merchandise to the trade hub from the surface world. The Black Network doesn't reveal the shortest route for security reasons. Instead, its representatives lead the adventurers to a remote cave in the Surbrin Hills, about 180 miles east of Gauntlgrym. Black Network sentries (six human veterans) guard the cave, which leads to a series of tunnels. These tunnels descend sharply as they wind their way east for another 200 miles. Check for random encounters as the party's expedition makes its way to Mantol-Derith, using the tables in chapter 2. If the characters are traveling with faction representatives (see chapter 8). these NPCs help the characters overcome random encounters. Whenever a random encounter check yields a “no encounter" result, use that opportunity to roleplay some of these NPCs and develop their personalities as you see fit. Mantol-Derith abuts the Darklake and is roughly six days' travel from Blingdenstone and Menzoberranzan, and 22 days from Gracklstugh via the Darklake locks (see the overview map of the Underdark in chapter 2). Characters accompanied by Zhentarim guides approach Mantol-Derith via a subterranean rift. A narrow trail winds up the side of the rift, ending at a secret door in the northwest corner of the trade hub (area la).

M ANTOL -D ERITH Population: Approximately 140 (drow, duergar, humans, and svirfneblin) Government: Informal council comprised of four chief negotiators (one per enclave), recently dissolved Defense: Private guards Commerce: Rare and exotic goods: see each enclave for information on the goods traded by the duergar, the drow, the svirfneblin, and the Zhentarim Organizations: The drow. duergar, svirfneblin, and Zhentarim enclaves Thousands of years' worth of trickling water carved out the cavern where the drow-. the duergar, and the svirfnehlin established Mantol-Derith. Four warehouses have been excavated at the corners of the cavern, each controlled by an enclave and containing offices and

temporary lodgings for its merchants.

I

equally straightforward: the violator is wrapped in Few of Mantol-Dcrith’s denizens are permanent chains and tossed into the Darklake. Recent events in residents. Even the chief negotiators of each enclave Mantol Derith have rendered these rules moot. return to their centers of power periodically, leaving representatives to conduct business. Everyone in Mantol-Derith is there to trade, negotiate, and, of course, spy on their counterparts in the other enclaves. Sladis Vadir The arrival of Fraz Urb'luu has upset the balance of power in Mantol-Derith (see "Fraz-UrbTuu's Rystia Zav Peebles Gem”), resulting in open conflict between the duergar and svirfneblin. The drow are poised to Zilchyn Q’Leptin eliminate both, thus reducing by two the number of Yantha Coaxrock enclaves in Mantol- Derith. The drow arc simultaneously hoping to preserve the truce with Flink Thunderbonk their Zhentarim neighbors. However, a delusional Cabbie Dripskillet drow assassin threatens to turn the drow and Chuldur Flagonfist Zhentarim enclaves against one another. The location of Mantol-Derith is a well-guarded secret, and the influence and power merchants gain Sirak Mazelor from access to it isn’t something they want to share. Normally, life in Mantol-Derith is regulated by three Kinyel Druu'giir simple covenants: no stealing of goods from fellow Ghazrim DuLoc merchants, no disguising of goods by any means, Lorthuun and no use of magic during negotiations and haggling. The punishment for breaking any covenant is

CHAPTERS | MANTOL-DERITH

134

IMPORTANT NPCS____________________________j The following NPCs have key roles in this chapter of the adventure. M A N T O L - D E R I T H NP C S High elf druid of the Emerald Enclave Human spy for the Harpers Svirfneblin spy working for Xazax the Eyemonger Drow mage and kleptomaniac Svirfneblin mage and leader of the Stoneheart Enclave Yantha’s svirfneblin apprentice Svirfneblin chief negotiator Duergar and chief negotiator from Gracklstugh Drow and chief negotiator from Menzoberranzan Drow assassin The characters’ contact and chief negotiator of the Zhentarim Maimed beholder

CHAPTERS | MANTOL-DERITH

135

K EYED E NCOUNTERS

The following encounters arc keyed to the map of Mantol-Derith.

1. S E C R ET E NT R A N C E S ________________ Mantol-Derith is hidden behind 10-foot-square secret doors carved to resemble walls of natural stone, A creature within 5 feet of a secret door can make a DC 15 Wisdom (Perception) check to spot it. Each secret door has an arcane lock spell cast on it. Speaking the proper password within 5 feet of a secret door opens it. Opening a secret door by any means other than the correct password triggers a magical disintegration trap on whichever side the door is opened from. Each creature in the 20-foot-square area directly in front of the secret door must succeed on a DC 15 Dexterity saving throw, taking 55 (lOdlO) force damage on a failed save, or half as much damage on a successful one. A creature reduced to 0 hit points by this trap is disintegrated, leaving only its possessions behind. LA.

N O RTH W E S T E NT R AN C E

Characters guided by representatives of the Zhentarim arrive at Mantol-Derith via this route a subterranean rift with a rough hewn path carved into one wall. This entrance is also used by svirfnebiin from Blingdcnstone and drow from Menzoberranzan. The switchback path ends at the secret door whose password is “im'yat." a svirfnebiin word meaning "darkness.” LB.

N O RTH E N T R AN C E

The password to open this secret door is “belaern," a drow word meaning “wealth." If the characters are being guided by members of the Black Network, they are led through this secret door into the trench that bisects Mantol-Derith (area 2).

lc.

N O RTH E AS T E N T R AN C E

This secret door stands at the back of a naturally formed ledge overlooking the Darklake. The password to open it is “ssussun," a drow word meaning “light." When the characters first gaze upon the ledge, read the following boxed text to the players. An elf with long red hair and a backpack sits on a ledge overlooking a vast, water-filled cavern. The elf is dressed in the finest attire and is dipping his bare feet in the murky water. “Care to join me?” he asks with a wry smile.

The figure dipping his feet in the water is Sladis Vadir, a high elf druid and member of the Emerald Enclave. Use the druid statistics in the Monster Manual to represent him, with the following modifications: • Sladis is neutral good. • He has dark vision out to a range of 60 feet. • He speaks Common, Elvish, and Undercommon. • His fey ancestry gives him advantage on saving throws against being charmed, and magic can't put him to sleep. ■ He can cast the prestidigitation cantrip at will and uses it to make his dirt-stained garments look clean. Sladis Vadir has always felt a strange attraction to the Underdark, but the demonic incursion has broken his sanity. He kills and eats other humanoids he encounters or, as he calls it, “culls the herd to maintain the natural order." This is considered a form of indefinite madness (sec “Madness" iri chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide).

Sladis happily accompanies the party and graciously offers his services as a guide. He knows how to get to Ncverlight Grove, Blingdenstone, Gracklstugh, and Menzoberranzan, but not Gravenhollow. If the characters invite Sladis to accompany them, he thanks them by offering them some "food" (see “Treasure"). Treasure. In addition to his quarterstaff and spell components, Sladis carries a blood-caked flint knife that he uses to cut up his victims, as well as a Heward's handy haversack stuffed full of severed limbs and eviscerated organs—the uncooked remains of his svirfnebiin, grimlock. quaggoth. and drow victims. XP Awards. If the characters cure Sladis Vadir's madness, award each of them 100 XP. If he is safely returned to Morista Malkin in Gauntlgrym (see chapter 8). award each character 150 XP. ID. SOUTH ENTRANCE

AND

SHORE

This secret door to Mantol-Derith lies halfway down a dead-end tunnel stemming from a rocky shoreline that hugs the Darklake. Ducrgar traders from Gracklstugh use this entrance. The password to open the secret door is “groht," an archaic Dwarvish word meaning “stone." When the characters first gaze upon the shore, read the following boxed text to the players. Someone has pitched a small tent on this pebbled beach overlooking a vast underground lake, Above the sound of water lapping at the shoreline, you hear a soft, feminine voice humming an unfamiliar tune. The voice comes from inside the tent, which is illuminated from within.

The tent belongs to the figure inside it: a female human named Rystia Zav. Rystia is a chaotic good Harper spy from Nesme who descended into the Underdark two years ago to find Mantol-Derith and infiltrate the Zhentarim enclave there. She got lost in the depths and has no idea how close she's come to finding what she’s been looking for. She also has no idea how to get to the CHAPTER 9 I MANTOL-DERITH

136 S LAD15 V A O I B

surface. Fear, loneliness, and the demonic incursion have driven her mad. She now believes that everyone she encounters is out to kill her. This is considered a form of indefinite madness (see “Madness” in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide). Traps. Rystia has planted four spring-loaded hunting traps under the pebbles around her tent. A creature within 15 feet of the tent can spot the hidden traps with a successful DC 15 Wisdom (Perception) check. Any creature that approaches within 10 feet of the tent and is unaware of the traps steps on one (see chapter 5. "Equipment,” in the Player's Handbook for hunting trap rules). Treasure. In addition to her weapons and traps, Rystia possesses a satchel made from carrion crawler hide, inside which are ten pounds of edible fungi. She also carries a full waterskin and three torchstalks (see “Fungi of the Underdark” in chapter 2), one of which is already lit. XP Awards. If the characters cure Rystia's madness, award each of them 100 XP. 1E. ZHENTARIM SECRET DOOR The password to open this secret door is “eyebite.” The tunnel leading away from Mantol-Derith winds steadily upward, and branches leading to other areas of the Underdark have been sealed off with wall of stone spells, leaving a single navigable passage. This passage is clear of monsters, but the Zhents have installed trip wires and pressure plates at irregular intervals. These are triggering mechanisms for collapsing roofs, poison darts, and rolling spheres (see “Sample Traps” in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide). The passage ends at a dungeon complex under a ruined walchtower overlooking the Surbrin River, north of the Evermoors. The Zhentarim have guards stationed throughout the dungeon to keep surface dwellers from finding their way to Mantol-Derith via this route. If the characters find this secret door and use it to make their way back to the surface world, design and populate the Zhentarim dungeon as you see fit.

2. T RE NC H This 20-foot-wide. 50-foot-deep trench bisects MantolDerith from north to south, with a secret door at each end (areas lb and Id, respectively). A shattered platform of crystal sits in the middle of the trench an old magic device once used to lift caravans up into the main cavern of the outpost and back down into the trench. It now lies broken, its magic spent. The duergar and drow collaborated to replace the crystal lift with a system of four mechanical lifts, two on each side of the shattered platform. These lifts use magic to power their winches and lighten the loads on the lifts. Each lift is designed for easy use and can be operated as an action simply by pulling on a lever. The trench's walls sport numerous handholds and can be climbed with a successful DC 10 Strength (Athletics) check.

3. M AIN C AVE R N

When the characters exit the trench, they find the normally quiet outpost in chaos. •

The trench bisects an enormous cavern with a 30-foothigh ceiling supported by naturally formed stone columns. Continual flame spells cast on stone lampposts reflect off

crystals embedded in the walls and ceiling, illuminating myriad fountains, waterfalls, streams, and pools. Water drips from stalactites onto leather tarps covering clusters of merchant stalls west and east of the trench. Beyond these marketplaces are well-tended gardens of mold and fungi, crystal walkways, and stone bridges. The tranquil beauty of Mantol-Derith is undone by sounds of combat to the northeast, where you hear the thunderous boom of metal against stone and see panicked svirfneblin running from 8-foot-tall duergar. «

The marketplaces of Mantol-Derith have been closed ever since the duergar attacked the svirfneblin. The duergar are killing any svirfneblin they encounter and breaking into the svirfneblin warehouse (see area 6a). 3A. WEST MARKETPLACE The drow and Zhentarim markets are clustered here, on the west side of the trench. However, the tents, stalls, and pens stand empty, the merchants having retreated to their respective enclaves with their goods and livestock. A stream runs nearby, crossed by two stone bridges leading to the drow and Zhentarim enclaves. The stream is 5 feet deep and fed by the Darklake. The water isn't fit for drinking. 3B. EAST MARKETPLACE The svirfneblin and duergar markets are clustered on the east side of the trench. Most of their tents and stalls have been knocked over, and various goods (see “Treasure”) are strewn upon the cavern floor amid the slaughtered corpses of giant lizards and steeders. Characters approaching the market see two enlarged duergar chasing a pair of deep gnomes who have cast blur spells on themselves. A third unarmed deep gnome is hiding in plain sight under the wreckage of a zurkhwood stall. He has a pale leather bag tucked under one arm. If the characters rescue the blurry svirfneblin, they reveal that more duergar are trying to smash into the svirfneblin warehouse (area 6b), and that Yantha Coaxrock, a svirfneblin mage, has been captured and taken to the duergar warehouse (area 5b). The svirfneblin don’t know why the duergar broke the peace in Mantol-Derith. If a duergar is captured and interrogated, he or she reveals that Yantha stole a valuable gemstone from a duergar merchant and refused to return it.

CHAPTER 9 I MANTOL-UER1TH

137

Peebles. The svirfneblin holding the bag is Peebles. He came to Mantol-Derith to investigate rumors of a beholder living here. He claims to be fascinated by aberrations, beholders in particular. He has confirmed rhat there are no beholders in the duergar or svirfneblin enclaves, but he hasn’t yet been able to explore the drow or Zhentarim enclaves. Peebles is the deranged, neutral evil servant of Xazax the Eyemonger, a beholder that hunts other beholders, takes their eyestalks, and grafts them to its own body. Peebles is Xazax's private surgeon. Once he has confirmed the presence of a beholder in Mantol-Derith. Peebles plans to find his "master" and share the news of his discovery. He suggests that the characters take him to the drow or Zhentarim enclave, under the pretense of having information about the duergar attack. Once he has found Lorthuun the beholder, Peebles tries to leave Mantol-Derith at once. If the characters delay his departure, he gets angry at them and claims to be an expert Llndcrdark guide, promising to lead them wherever they wish to go. If they accept his offer, he leads them to Xazax the Eyemonger (see chapter 10 for more information). Peebles's bag is made from stitched quaggoth hide and contains a pair of sharpened flint knives, a spool of thread made from roper gut, a thin iron needle, two pounds of barrelstalk flesh, and a copper canteen containing a half gallon of water. Pool. The large pool east of the market is fed by small waterfalls pouring through cracks in the cavern ceiling. The water is fresh and safe to drink. Growing along the shore are 3d6 waterorbs (see “Fungi of the Undcrdark”). Treasure. Characters who search the marketplace find a total of 2d6 50 gp gems scattered about.

4. D R O W E NC LAVE The drow use Mantol-Derith to trade exquisite and exotic goods according to their rarefied tastes. Rare perfumes, potions, distilled beverages, and other alchemical products are some of their regular goods, as well as common and uncommon magic items. House Baenre controls the flow of merchandise here, placing and removing chief negotiators as their efficiency wanes. Sirak Mazelor is the current drow representative. A sophisticated merchant, she deals in luxury items from drow artisans: gems of high value, incense, art objects, various magical treasures, and exotic spices and spirits exclusive lo the Underdark, 4-A. DROW FUNGI GROVE This is where the drow cultivate edible and poisonous fungi. In the heart of the fungi grove is a stunted ztirkhwood mushroom. 20 feet tall, with a thick stalk and a wide cap that forms a dome, keeping the area underneath dry. The dark elves use the mushroom as a pavilion, and this is where Sirak Mazelor coiiducts business with visiting traders. Six gargoyles perch on natural ledges overlooking the fungi grove. They attack any creature unaccompanied by a drow that approaches the stone double doors leading to the drow warehouse (area 4b). Standing in front of

CHAPTER 9 I MANTOL-DERITH

138

ZfLCMYN PEEBLES

Q ' l- EP T IN

the double doors are two female drow elite warriors that do the same. Zilchyn Q'Leptin. Sitting on a zurkhwood bench under the giant zurkhwood mushroom is a male drow mage named Zilchyn Q'Leptin. Trained as a wizard in Menzoberranzan. “Zilch" was forced to flee the drow city after a rash of spell component thefts was traced back to him. He can't control his kleptomania, which is considered a form of indefinite madness (see “Madness” in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide). This madness befell Zilch long before the demon lords arrived, and has only gotten worse since. Zilch lost his spellbook during his escape from Menzoberranzan. and an unfortunate encounter with a black pudding left him with acid scars covering the left side of his body, including his face. In addition to his staff, which doubles as a walking stick, the drow carries a purple bag made of kuo-toa skin that contains handdrawn maps of the Undcrdark on sheets of trillimac, material components for all of Zilch's prepared spells, and ld4 + 3 stolen trinkets (roll on the Trinkets table in chapter 5 of the Player's Handbook). Characters can use Zilch's maps to get to Menzoberranzan, Gracklstugh, or the Wormwrithings from Mantol-Derith. Zilch doesn’t know what caused the duergar to attack the svirfneblin. but he knows the drow merchants have withdrawn to the warehouse and that the drow are waiting to see how the violence plays out. If the characters seem approachable. Zilch offers to help them get inside the drow warehouse. If the characters take a short or long rest and Zilch is with them, he attempts to steal something from one randomly determined party member. Far from being a skilled thief. Zilch must succeed at a Dexterity check contested by the passive Wisdom (Perception) scores of every character with line of sight to him. If he wins the contest. Zilch hides the stolen item in his bag and feigns innocence if questioned about the item’s disappearance. Flink Thunderbonk. Huddled against a stone column at the edge of the fungi grove is a cowardly deep gnome named Flink. He suffers from a form of indefinite madness (see “Madness" in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide) that makes him want to please his mistress, Yantha Coaxrock, and also causes him to be

deathly afraid of her. He uses his Stone Camouflage feature to blend in with the rocky terrain, afraid that the drow and the gargoyles might attack him. If he sees the characters, he runs toward them in a panic, babbling about a stolen gem. A successful DC 15 Charisma (Intimidation or Persuasion) check or calm emotions spell allows Flink to speak coherently, whereupon he reveals the following information: • A duergar ale merchant named Krimgol Muzgardt asked Flink’s mistress, Yantha Coaxrock, to appraise a large black gemstone. For reasons unknown to Flink, Yantha didn’t want to give the gemstone back to the duergar and instead offered him a lump of gold in trade. An argument ensued. • Yantha entrusted the gemstone to Flink. He took it to the drow enclave to buy an eyelash encased in gum arabic the component for an invisibility spell, knowing that's what Yantha would want him to do. Before he could complete this task, a gargoyle snatched the gemstone from Flink's grasp. Flink is afraid Yantha will punish him for losing the gemstone. • Flink has been spying on the gargoyles to find the one that took his gem, but that gargoyle isn’t among the ones currently guarding the drow enclave. 4B. DROW WAREHOUSE The drow warehouse is both a fortress and a residence. The stone double doors leading to it have an arcane lock spell cast on them, which only Sirak Mazelor and her elite warrior guards can bypass. Characters who gain entry find the warehouse occupied by two female drow elite warriors, eighteen drow merchants, nine quaggoth slaves, and six giant lizards fitted with saddles (use the giant riding lizard statistics in chapter 8). The 30-foot-high ceiling of the warehouse is hidden with thick webs that conceal a dozen giant spiders loyal to the drow. The warehouse’s denizens attack the party unless the characters are accompanied by a drow. The merchants have been instructed to remain in the warehouse until Sirak Mazelor returns. The drow chief negotiator and her entourage have gone to the Zhentarim enclave (area 7) to meet with representatives of the Black Network, in the hopes of forging an alliance against the unruly duergar and svirfneblin enclaves. The drow sleep in cots arranged in neat rows, while the merchants store their valuable wares in three stone buildings. The door to each building is protected by a glyph of warding (save DC 14) that triggers an explosive runes effect (5d8 thunder damage) when a creature other than a drow opens it. Treasure. Each storage building contains 2d6 crystal vials of exotic perfume worth 100 gp each, 3d6 crystal bottles of distilled beverages worth 25 gp each. Id4 magic items (determined by rolling on Magic Item Table A in chapter 7 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide), and 2d6 vials of carrion crawler mucus (see “Poisons" in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide). Characters also find 1 d 10 * 10 pounds of food and ldlO x 5 gallons of water stored in each building. CHAPTER 9 | MANTOL-DERITH

139

5. D UE R GAR E NC LAVE The gray dwarves trade mostly in armor and weapons of superior craftsmanship, but their enclave also deals in other metalwork, raw ores, and uncut gemstones. The duergar chief negotiator is Ghuldur Flagonfist, who sells armor, arrowheads, locks, mining and smithing equipment, and smoked Darklakc fish. Ghuldur is friends with Krimgol Muzgardt, a gray dwarf merchant who sells frothy Darklake Stout ale. 5A. DUERGAR FUNGI GROVE An iron-wrought fence encloses this fungal grove, through which the duergar have carved narrow aisles. The grove contains a host of edible fungi and is illuminated by six nightlight mushrooms (see “Fungi of the Underdark’’ in chapter 2). A tunnel in the south wall leads to a set of double stone doors. Guarding the fungi grove are four invisible duergar that attack intruders on sight. Four more invisible duergar stand in front of the double doors and attack any non-duergar that come into view. 5B. DUERGAR WAREHOUSE The stone double doors to the warehouse are unlocked and open to reveal a 40 foot-high, rough-hewn chamber containing thirty duergar merchants and twelve male steeders (see appendix C) used as pack animals. These duergar aren't spoiling for a fight and parley with intruders, sharing the following information: • A svirfneblin mage stole a gemstone from a duergar ale merchant named Krimgol Muzgardt. Krimgol is a good friend of Mantol-Derith's duergar chief negotiator, Ghuldur Flagonfist. • When the svirfneblin mage refused to return the stolen gem, Flagonfist sent invisible duergar to the svirfneblin enclave to capture her and bring her to him for questioning. • Other svirfneblin tried to free the mage, leading to the first of several armed confrontations. Flagonfist has since sent his duergar guards to storm the neighboring enclave and wipe out the deep gnomes. A 20-foot-high stone building stands in the northeast corner of the warehouse. Inside this unlocked building. Ghuldur Flagonfist and Krimgol Muzgardt (a pair of male duergar) are interrogating Yantha Coaxrock, an unarmed female deep gnome suffering from a form of indefinite madness (see “Madness” in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide) that makes her tell lies, even at the risk of harming herself and others. The duergar have dressed her in a robe sewn with gemstones (see “Treasure" below) and suspended her above the mouth of Ghuldur's “pet”—a hungry xorn. Ghuldur grasps the rope from which she hangs and is threatening to feed her to the xorn unless she divulges the location of the gem she stole from Krimgol. Yantha Coaxrock. Yantha is the leader of the Stonchcart Enclave based in Blingdenstone (see chapter 6). She is bound with rope and spinning an elaborate lie about how the drow must've charmed her and taken Krimgol's gem. She has an Intelligence of 16 (+3) and the following additional feature:

'-v.

Spellcasting. Yantha is a 5th-level spellcaster. Her spellcasting

ability is Intelligence (spell save DC 13). She has the following -.vizard spells prepared. Cantrips (at will): dancing lights, friends, mending, prestidigitation 1st level (4 slots): comprehend languages, detect magic, Tenser's floating disk 2nd level (3 slots): detect thoughts, hold person 3rd level (2 slots): sending

Treasure. Thr storage building contains IdlO x 10

pounds of foot!. Id 10 * 5 gallons of water, thirty zurkhwood casks of Darklake Stout ale worth 50 gp each, and a plethora of finely crafted metalworks: • • • • • ■ • ■ • • ■

2d6 battleaxes 2d6 glaives 2(16 lances 2d6 longswords

2d6 morningstars 2d6 war picks 2d6 warhammers ld6 suits of half- plate

ld6 suits of chainmail ld6 suits of splint mail ld6 suits of plate mail

An iron safe stands in a corner of the storage building. The safe weighs 1.000 pounds, is locked, and contains ld4 magic items (determined by rolling on Magic Item Table B in chapter 7 of the Dungeon Master's Guide). CHAPTER 9 | MANTOL-DERITH

140

Ghuldur knows the combination to unlock the safe, which otherwise requires a knock spell or similar magic to open. Yantha s gem-studded robe is worth 750 gp. Development. If the characters cure Yantha’s madness, she confesses to giving Krimgol's black gem to her apprentice, Flink Thunderbonk. She doesn't know Flink’s current whereabouts but can use a sending spell to contact him. whereupon she learns that he's "trapped" in the drew enclave (area 4). She then asks the characters to rescue him. Restoring Yantha's sanity doesn't placate Ghuldur or Krimgol. The characters can only appease Krintgol by finding his gem and returning it to him. If he and his pet xorn are defeated in combat, Ghuldur can be persuaded to call off the duergar attacking the svirfneblin enclave (see area 6a). XP Awards. If the characters rescue Yantha, award each of them 100 XP. If they cure her madness, award an additional 150 XP to each character.

6.

S V I R F N E B L I N E N C L AVE

The deep gnomes look for any opportunity to corner the market on goods their competitors are in short supply of. Gabble Dripskillet. the svirfneblin chief negotiator, used to sell salt, gemstones, and rare minerals from a stall in the eastern market (area 3b). hut she and several other

svirfneblin merchants were forced to retreat to their warehouse (area 6b) when the duergar attacked.

CHAPTER 9 | MANTOL-DERITU

141

6 A . S VIRFNEBLIN F UNGI G ROVE

The fungal grove in the deep gnome enclave has been left to grow wild. Strewn about the grove are the corpses of a dozen dead svirfneblin, all of whom were killed by duergar. Set into the northeast wall is a set of stone double doors that the svirfneblin have barred from within. Four enlarged duergar are breaking through the doors with war picks, and it's only a matter of time before they reduce the doors to rubble. Eight more invisible duergar stand nearby, ready to storm the svirfneblin warehouse as soon as the doors crumble. Treasure. Each dead svirfneblin carries a pouch that contains ld4 50 gp gems. In addition to species of edible fungi, the svirfneblin grove contains the following exotic fungi (as described in the “Fungi of the Underdark” section of chapter 2): • 2d6 barrelstalks • 3d6 bluecaps • 3d6 Nilhogg’s noses • 2d6 tongues of madness • 2d6 torchstalks • 2d6 trillimacs 6B. SVIRFNEBLIN WAREHOUSE

Twenty-two deep gnomes, including Gabble Dripskillet, are holed up in this chamber, which is shaped like a cube. The ceiling is 100 feet high, and the walls are lined with niches that serve as residences and storage spaces. Levitating crystal platforms throughout the warehouse allow the deep gnomes to reach these compartments. Each crystal platform can move up, down, or side-to-side on command, but only the deep gnomes know the command words to activate them. Most of the svirfneblin have retreated to their residential niches. Gabble Dripskillet is the only one at floor level, and she’s prepared to negotiate with whoever or whatever breaks through the doors. If the characters deal with the duergar, Gabble is grateful and offers them a reward (see “Treasure" below). Gabble doesn't know what provoked the duergar into attacking her enclave, but she is friends with Yantha Coaxrock and would like to see the svirfneblin mage returned safely. Treasure. Stored throughout the warehouse are sixty 10pound sacks of salt worth 5 gp each, thirty sacks of precious minerals worth 25 gp each, twenty-four quartz gemstones worth 50 gp each, a dozen amethysts worth 100 gp each, and six peridots worth 500 gp each. Half way up the southeast wall is a hidden compartment. Finding it requires a successful DC 19 Wisdom (Perception) check. The compartment contains ld4 magic items (determined by rolling on Magic Item Table C in chapter 7 of the Dungeon Master's Guide). Gabble keeps a crystal coffer in her niche. The coffer is worth 100 gp, and iL contains a black sapphire pendant on a silver chain worth 5,000 gp. She offers the pendant as a reward to the party for saving her enclave. 7. Z HE NTAR I M E N C LAVE The Zhentarim found great profits in Mantol-Derith by

bringing in products impossible to obtain in the Underdark. Items as innocuous as sugar and fresh spices are treasures in high demand here. The surface dwellers trade mostly in raw materials, including wood, fine fabrics, and leathers, but also maintain stocks of perfumes, alcoholic beverages, confectionery, paper, and clothing made by surface artisans with surface materials. The human Ghazrim DuLoc leads the Zhentarim enclave in Mantol-Derith and also holds the key to finding the library of Gravenhollow. 7 A . Z HENTARIM E NCAMPMENT

Zhentarim traders cut down most of the fungi grove outside the entrance of their warehouse, keeping only a few small gardens for decoration. In its place they erected a huge pavilion and several smaller tents. Water dripping from the ceiling runs off the tents to form puddles everywhere. The pavilion is where Ghazrim DuLoc conducts business, while the smaller tents are set aside for fifteen Black Network merchants (all human commoners). Perched on a ledge overlooking the pavilion is a gargoyle touched by the madness of Fraz-Urb’luu’s gem. Characters with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 13 or higher spot the creature. It’s waiting for Kinyel Druu’giir, its “true love," to emerge from the pavilion. Inside the pavilion are four drow: Sirak Mazelor (a female drow mage and the chief negotiator of the drow enclave), two female drow elite warriors, and a female drow assassin posing as another elite warrior. The assassin. Kinyel Druu'giir, has Fraz-Urb'luu's gem on her person. She also has the Fey Ancestry, Innate Spellcasting, and Sunlight Sensitivity features of a drow elite warrior. These drow await the arrival of the Zhentarim’s chief negotiator, Ghazrim DuLoc. A table covered with food and wine stands in the middle of the pavilion, although the drow refuse to partake. Development. If the characters keep their distance and spy on the Zhentarim enclave for a few minutes, Ghazrim DuLoc, Lorthuun, and six human thugs emerge from the nearby warehouse (area 7b) to meet with the drow delegation. Before Sirak can negotiate an alliance. Kinyel attacks the beholder. Unless the characters intervene, Kinyel escapes with 19 hit points remaining. Everyone else is killed in the crossfire. If the characters confront the drow before Ghazrim and Lorthuun arrive, Sirak orders them to leave at once. If they refuse, she and her warriors attack as Kinyel cuts a gash in the back wall of the pavilion with her sword and finds a place to hide until the beholder appears. If the characters pursue Kinyel. the gargoyle attacks them to protect her. Ghazrim and his entourage arrive ld4 + 2 rounds after the battle is joined. Kinyel was forced to leave Menzoberranzan in disgrace after failing to assassinate a house rival. Fraz- Urb'luu’s gem has afflicted her with a form of indefinite madness (see “Madness” in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide). She is convinced that the gargoyle who gave her the gem is a messenger from House Druu’giir, and that killing Lorthuun will redeem her.

7 B . Z HENTARIM W AREHOUSE

The double doors leading lo the Zhentarim warehouse are made of thick zurkhwood reinforced with iron bands. A window' slit at eye level allows two human veterans stationed inside the doors to peer out into the cavern. They will not open the doors to strangers without Ghazrim DuLoc’s permission. The doors are barred from the inside. They have AC 15. 80 hit points, and a damage threshold of 10. They can also be forced open with a I)C 25 Strength check. The Zhentarim warehouse contains a dozen iron storage sheds filled with neatly sorted merchandise. Two more sheds serve as quarters for Ghazrim DuLoc (a human noble) and his guards. Ten human thugs (minus any killed in area 7a) are asleep in their bunks but rise quickly if the warehouse comes under attack. Lorthuun, a maimed beholder, also guards the warehouse. Years ago, Lorthuun got into a terrible fight with a behir and lost four of its eyestalks. Its spherical body is also covered with scars from the hehir's claws and breath weapon. Lorthuun has the statistics of a normal beholder, except that it no longer has its sleep, petrification, disintegration, or death rays. The beholder’s adjusted challenge rating is 9 (5.000 XP). Ghazrim and Lorthuun both serve the Zhentarim, but they rarely see eye to eye. They bicker and insult each other like an old married couple, and only their dedication to the Black Network keeps them from turning against one another. Born into a wealthy family, Ghazrim has the typically smarmy demeanor of the Amnian aristocracy coupled with a biting sense of humor that he uses to diffuse tense situations. He’s not afraid of a good fight but is averse to attacking a superior force. If he realizes the characters arc in league with the Black Network, he offers them food, wine, and whatever else they need to complete their mission (see “Treasure”). Ghazrim's Shed. The door to this shed is locked, and Ghazrim carries the only key. In addition to his comfortable bed, Ghazrim has a morbid collection of tiny, malformed creatures in pickle jars on a shelf. Secret Door. A secret door in the west wall opens to reveal a wide tunnel beyond (area le). The secret door makes a lot of noise when opened, alerting the warehouse's occupants. Storage Sheds. The contents of the twelve storage sheds are described below: Shed 1 contains the Zhcnts’ supplies, consisting of 2dl0 x

10 pounds of food in the form of dried meats, plucked chickens, fresh fruit and vegetables, and loaves of baked bread. There are also six casks of wune worth 50 gp each. Shed 2 holds Id 10 backpacks, 2dl0 bedrolls. 2d 10 blankets, 2d6 climber's kits, and 2d6 healer's kits. Shed 3 contains 3d6 hooded lanterns, 3d6 flasks of oil, 3d6 50foot coils of hempen rope, 3d6 grappling hooks, and 3d6 tinderboxes. Shed 4 holds five crates, each one containing Id20 days of rations. Shed 5 contains 2d 10 empty glass hottles, 2d6 scroll cases, 2dl0 copper tankards, 2d 10 iron pots, 2dl0 empty sacks, and 2dl0 empty w'aterskins. Shed 6 holds 2d 10 empty wooden chests with iron fittings and 2d 10 locks with keys. Shed 7 contains 2d6 jars of ink. 3dl2 blank pieces of parchment. 3d6 boxes of candles (12 candles per box), and 2d6 ink pens. Shed 8 holds 3d6 crowbars, 3d6 hammers, and 3d6 miner’s picks. Shed 9 is locked, and Ghazrim DuLoc carries the only key. The lock is also trapped with a poison needle (see "Sample Traps" in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide). The shed contains 250 pp. 1.800 gp, 3,300 sp. 6,0 cp, and thirty 100 gp gems in a loose pile. Shed 10 contains 3d6 jars of spices worth 10 gp each. 2d6 10-pound sacks of cinnamon worth 20 gp each, and 3d6 boxes of soap (12 bars of soap per box). Shed 11 holds four wooden chicken coops, each one containing ld6 + 1 live chickens. Sacks of chicken feed are stored on a shelf above the coops. Shed 12 is currently empty. Treasure. Ghazrim carries a key that unlocks shed 9. He also wears a gold ring fitted with a star ruby (worth 1.0 gp). A detect magic spell reveals that the gem radiates a faint aura of divination magic. The gem’s starshaped core is a magical compass that guides the ring's wearer along the safest, shortest route to Gravenhollow. Ghazrim is aware of the ring’s property and gives the ring to the characters if they claim to be headed that w'ay.

LEAVING MANTOL-DERITH

If Ghazrim DuLoc dies, characters can remove the ring from his dead hand and use it to find their way to Gravenhollow. If the characters deduce that Kinyel's gem is responsible for the havoc in Mantol-Derith and inform B EH O L D ER E Y E S TAL K S

If Lorthuun is killed, ld4 of its eyestalks survive intact. Should Peebles the svirfneblin happen upon the beholder’s remains, he uses a flint knife to remove the intact eyestalks, then tucks them in his bag for safe delivery to Xazazthe Eyemonger (see ‘'Follow-Up Encounters").

CHAPTER 9

1

MANTOL-DERITH 14-1

KINYEL DRUU'GIIR

the chief negotiators of this fact, the ones who are still alive are thankful enough to share disturbing news from their home settlements of Blingdenstone, Gracklstugh. and Menzoberranzan, respectively (see chapter 10, “Descent into the Depths").

F O LLO W -U P E NC O U N T E R S Having Sladis Vadir (see area lc), Peebles (see area 3b), or Zilchyn Q'Leptin (area 4a) join the party can lead to special follow up encounters in the vicinity of MantolDerith, as described below. C RICKET C ATCHER

If Zilchyn Q'Leptin is with the party as it leaves MantolDerith, he insists on visiting a nearby cave to retrieve his secret stash of potions. Zilch’s cave lies one day’s travel west of MantolDerith. along the same route the characters must travel to reach Gravenhollow. The cave is swarming with bats and infested with dozens of giant albino cave crickets that feed on the bat guano. The crickets are as big as halflings yet harmless. A happy-go-lucky kuo-toa named Ougalop is also here, trying to catch the giant crickets in a homespun net. When he sees other intruders, Ougalop waves at them and continues with his cricket catching. He poses no threat and has no interest in joining the party. The kuo-toa lives in Sloobludop (see chapter 3) and is blissfully unaware of recent events there. Treasure. On a 30-foot-high shelf overlooking the cave is an old grick nest. Hidden here are three potions of vitality. Climbing the wall to reach the shelf requires a successful DC 10 Strength (Athletics) check. A MARITH ’ S Z OO

• She wields a warhammer instead of a longsword (ld8 + 3 bludgeoning damage on a hit, or ldlO + 3 bludgeoning damage if using the weapon with two hands). Amarith's cavern contains a dozen stalagmites which have been hollowed out and fitted with iron bars to serve as monster cages. Locked in three of these cages are a rust monster, a winged kobold. and a fire snake. Amarith charges 3 cp per person to tour her “zoo.” If the characters ask Amarith to join them, she gathers up her belongings and does just that, lamenting that "the zoo business is tough!” Her gear includes a backpack, a bedroll, a lantern with no oil, a linderbox, an iron pot. ten days of rations (edible fungi), a pouch containing 3 cp, a 50-foot coil of hempen rope with a grappling hook tied to one end, a net. a miner’s pick, and a 10-foot pole. XAZAX THE EYEMONGER

If Peebles or the characters harvest Lorthuun's eyestalks (see the “Beholder Eyestalks” sidebar), Peebles asks to join the party as it leaves Mantol- Derith. After traveling with them for a tenday, Peebles urges the characters to deviate from their preferred route, claiming that they’re dangerously close to a nest of purple worms. Peebles uses this lie to propose an alternate route. If the characters follow this detour, Peebles leads them to the cavern of Xazax the Eyemonger, a terrifying beholder that kills others of its kind and grafts their eyestalks to its body. Peebles heads to Xazax's cave regardless of whether the characters follow him or not. Xazax’s cavern has a 30-foot-high ceiling and is unremarkable save for a 20-foot-wide, 100-foot-dccp shaft in the middle of the floor. Upon arriving, Peebles calls out, "Master! I’ve returned!" Moments later, Xazax rises up from the shaft. Xazax has eight extra eyestalks grafted to its body, giving it a total of eighteen, but it can’t fire rays from the grafted eyes. If the characters took one or more of Lorthuun's eyestalks, Peebles demands that the characters surrender them at once. Whether they do or not. Xazax becomes enraged and attacks. Both Xazax and Peebles fight to the death. Treasure. At the bottom of the beholder's shaft, buried among the shattered remains of petrified foes, is a flame tongue longsword. Scaling the shaft requires a successful DC 10 Strength (Athletics) check.

If Sladis Vadir joined the party and is still around when the characters are ready to leave Mantol Derith, he offers to guide them to a cavern roughly eight days' travel west of Mantol-Derith, along the same route the characters must travel to reach Gravenhollow. Sladis claims that the cave is home to another member of the Emerald Enclave: a dwarf named Amarith Coppervein. This news will interest characters searching for Amarith on behalf of Morista Malkin (sec chapter 8). Amarith Coppervein is a shield dwarf veteran with the following statistical modifications: Amarith's alignment is neutral good. She has darkvision out to a range of 60 feet. Amarith's dwarven resilience gives her advantage on saving throws against poison, and she has resistance against poison damage.

AMARITH C OP P E RVE I N

OUGALOP

CHAPTER 9 I MANTOL-DERITH

142

XAZAX THE EVEMONGEI

CHAPTER 10: DESCENT INTO THE DEPTHS Having survived Mantol-Dcrith and obtained Ghnzrim DuLoc's ring, the adventurers and their allies continue on into the Underdark. This time, rather than escaped prisoners looking for a way out, they arc at the head of an expeditionary force ready to challenge whatever the Underdark has to offer. Much of this middle section of the adventure is freeform. dictated largely by the characters' decisions and tactics. The adventurers' immediate destination is the legendary library of Gravenhollow (see chapter 11), where they gain information that likely takes them to the tower of Araj, home of the mysterious drow archmage Vizeran DeVir. However, the characters are free to explore and visit different places before and after they explore Gravenhollow and unlock its secrets. The events described in chapters 13 through 16 can be interspersed among the material in this part of the adventure, as the characters work to fully understand the new menaces that have appeared in the Underdark, seek new allies and information, and ultimately attempt to create a plan to end the demon lord threat. Character advancement through this section of the

adventure is important. The journey from Mantol-Dcrith

to Gravenhollow should involve sufficient encounters and challenges for the characters to reach 10th level by the time they visit the stone giant library. As the characters travel from place to place, check for random encounters as normal (see chapter 2), but swap out the creature encounters with ones presented in this chapter. Ideally, the characters should be 14th level by the time they crash Zuggtmoy’s wedding (chapter 16. “The Fetid Wedding”), and 15th level for the final showdown against the demon lords (see chapter 17. "Against the Demon Lords”).

FELLOW TRAVELERS The characters initially traveled through the Underdark as a small group, perhaps joined by a few of their fellow prisoners from Velkynvelve and other allies they met along the way. Now, they return to the subterranean realm at the head of a group of allies that might outnumber the adventurers four-to-one, depending on how many NPCs were recruited from the factions in Gauntlgrym (see chapter 8). This changes some of the conditions described in "Underdark Travel” in chapter 2.

A T TAC K I N G I N F O RC E

When dealing with combat between large groups of creatures—either the adventurers’ allies or their foes— you might wish to use the guidelines under “Handling Mobs" in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide. In some cases, you can simply match forces on one side with those on the other and assume they neutralize each other— for example, a band of shield dwarves fighting for the adventurers against a band of ores. During such combat, the force on the losing side is wiped out while the winning force suffers a few casualties—anywhere from 10 to 50 percent—based on how difficult you judge the combat was for them.

MARCHING ORDERS

The tunnels and passages of the Underdark aren't easy routes through which to lead a large group of NPCs. When the characters set out. have the players describe how their expeditionary force is arrayed while traveling in single file, two abreast, and in open formation in wide-open spaces. Also ask the players if any of the NPCs are scouting ahead or serving as a rear guard (see ‘‘Scouting,’' below) or if the larger party remains in close formation at all times. The marching order affects where and how different encounters might occur, particularly if they happen while characters are marching single file or two abreast. A threat approaching from above, below, or the flank could strike the middle of the expanded party, making it difficult for the characters at either end to reach it. Likewise, spellcasters must be aware of the allies around them at all times when casting area spells that don’t solely target enemies. T R AVE L P A C E

The pace of Underdark travel remains as outlined in chapter 2, and the characters move no slower for traveling with a larger party. Although a portion of the expeditionary force might be mounted on giant lizards, die lizards travel at the pace of the rest of the party unless they move out ahead. As noted in chapter 2, a fast pace makes it harder for characters Lo spot ambushers or items of interest, and prevents characters from foraging. A slow pace improves chances of foraging. However, even while traveling at a slow pace, the characters and the NPCs can’t use stealth, since they are too large a group to go unnoticed. Stealth is an option only for a smaller scouting party traveling away from the main force (see “Scouting”). N AVI G ATI N G

While traveling as part of a larger group, the characters have an easier time navigating their way through the Umlerdark than they did during their initial escape. The characters' own experience, plus that of their followers, along with maps and other information they might have acquired in Gauntlgrym or elsewhere, give all members of the expanded parly advantage on any Wisdom (Survival) checks to avoid becoming lost (see chapter 5, “Adventure Environments," of the Dungeon Master's Guide).

SCOUTING

A portion of the expanded parly can break off in order to iravel some distance ahead, scouting for the right path while remaining on the lookout for potential hazards. A smaller group might also lag behind, serving as a rearguard watching for threats coming up behind the characters as they travel. NPCs can serve as scouts or members of a rearguard as the players wish. Some of tlie adventurers might choose to do so as well. A smaller scouting group can make use of stealth to travel unnoticed. If a random encounter occurs during the journey, characters in the scorning party discover it first and can choose whether to avoid or deal with the encounter. If characters in the scouting party notice the encounter without being seen themselves, they can retreat back to the main force to inform the other characters. Similarly, if a random encounter escapes the scouting characters’ notice, the encountered creatures can lie in wait for the rest of the characters in order to ambush them.

I N C OMMAND No longer a ragtag hand of survivors and prisoners, the adventurers are now in command of a dedicated force of NPC followers. In addition to Lhe advantages that brings, the characters must assume leadership roles as they deal with allies who might not entirely trust or respect them—or each other. Add in the dangers of the Underdark, along with the unpredictable influence of demonic madness, and the characters have several new challenges that must be faced. PERSONALITIES

Although the NPCs the characters lead are ostensibly allies, many belong to different factions, and old grudges and differences in ethos aren’t easily set aside. Personality conflicts might arise among the followers in the expanded party, and the adventurers would he well advised to head off potential trouble. For example, having Lords’ Alliance troops acting as scouts while keeping Zhentarim mercenaries close at hand will help keep those factions from fighting. HEART

OF

DARKNESS

In this phase of the campaign, the characters arc moving toward the demon lords and their influence rather than away from it, even as the Underdark sinks deeper into madness and chaos. The characters will make saving throws against acquiring levels of madness, as called for in different encounters and whenever you feel it is appropriate. (See chapter 2 of the adventure for more information on madness.) The NPCs following the characters into the Underdark are just as vulnerable to demonic madness. However, rather than make saving throws or track madness levels for each individual NPC, use the Random Events table in this chapter to determine when madness appears among those followers. When madness appears among the NPCs, use it not

just for its mechanical effects but to create real

complications for the adventurers. For example, if the Random Events table indicates that one member of the expanded party suffers long-term madness, you might decide to bestow extreme paranoia on that NPC. In addition to the effect of Wisdom and Charisma checks, that character might believe that the adventurers are actually agents of the demon lords, and are intent on leading the NPCs to their doom. L O YALTY

Having the adventurers leading an expanded party gives you the opportunity to use the optional loyalty rules in chapter 4, "Creating Nonplayer Characters.” of the Dungeon Master's Guide. You can track the loyalty scores of groups of NPCs. such as those belonging to each faction, rather than having to track NPCs individually. The characters must balance the goals and bonds of their followers in order to maintain and improve their loyalty. PROVISIONS

The factions in GauntIgrym see to it that the expeditionary force is well provisioned with whatever the characters' expeditionary force can carry. Food and water aren't easy to come by in the Underdark, as the characters know ail too well, and supplies must be managed and safeguarded. If the expeditionary force needs to supplement or replace supplies while traveling, the amounts that characters are able to find become more important with a larger group to support. See “Foraging" in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide, as well as the guidelines in chapter 2 of tiiis adventure. TREASURE

Just as they must ensure sufficient supplies for all the NPCs, the characters need to think about how best to share the spoils of encounters and adventures with their followers. Although the NPCs all accompany the adventurers out of loyalty to their factions—and on orders from their superiors in Gauntlgrym—the characters’ treatment of the NPCs influences the loyalty of those followers during the mission into the Underdark. The characters should come up with some means for dividing any treasure taken on the expedition between the NPCs. As long as the division is reasonably fair, most of the followers will be content. However, the NPCs will complain if all the choice pieces of treasure go to the adventurers. The characters might also need to contend with the problem of theft, whether NPCs stealing from spoils not yet divided, stealing from the adventurers, or stealing from each other. Such theft might be driven by sheer greed, or it could be a manifestation of madness. A bout of long-term madness could easily lead to obsession with particular items of treasure—especially magic items—with an obsessed NPC willing to steal or even kill to obtain them.

M A I N TAI N I N G O R D E R __________________________

The adventurers are in command of their NPC followers, and that means they are responsible for welding together disparate forces and maintaining discipline. The characters have a bit of an advantage in this regard, in that the NPCs placed under their command are all well-trained faction operatives, not raw recruits or mercenaries. However, some of these seasoned personnel might question the right of a ragtag band of adventurers to command them, even if their superiors seem to trust the player characters. Likewise, though the individual factions are typically disciplined within their own ranks, members of any faction might bristle at having to work alongside (much less take orders from) members of other factions. C HAIN OF C OMMAND

In addition to deciding how the expedit ionary force is organized and distributed (see “Marching Orders”), the players must also institute a clear chain of command. One or more of the adventurers might he the field commanders of the expanded party, while others serve as lieutenants. Likewise, the adventurers might appoint some of the NPCs to command positions. Without a clear chain of command, information might not go to the right people, and decisions might not gel made quickly enough—or at all. Adding to the challenge of maintaining discipline is the ever present threat of demonic madness growing among the ranks, creating problems even for seasoned and professional troops (see “Heart of Darkness”). Tf the expeditionary force is made up of diverse factions, the players also need to decide how much latitude to give those factions. For example. Zhentnrim mercenaries might be eager to torture prisoners for information unless the characters put a slop to it. and members of the Emerald Enclave might place a higher priority on maintaining the balance of nature in the IJnderdark than on political struggles.

R ANDOM E VENTS The adventurers must contend with a variety of events as they lead their forces through the Underdark. Every other day of travel or camping in the Underdark, an event automatically occurs. Roll a d20 and consult the Random Events table, or choose a suitable event. For the rules on madness, see chapter 2 of this adventure and chapter 8. “Running the Game." in the Dungeon Master’s Guide. S P L I TT I N G TH E P A RTY

You can change up the feel of these later chapters of Out of the Abyss by allowing the players to take on the roles of their faction allies as well as their regular characters. This can range from letting each player control the overall actions of the NPCs in a single faction, to creating multiple subgroups so that characters can split off and have their own adventures. While this involves a good deal more coordination among the game group, it can add a lot of detail, intrigue, and interaction to the campaign.

CHAPTER 10 | DESCENT INTO THE DEPTHS

_________ _

__________l *45

RANDOM EVENTS d20

Event

1-2 3-6

Battle aftermath Creature encounter

7-9 Demon encounter 10-11 Discipline problem 12-13 Disease 14-15 Madness 16-17 Poisoned NPCs 18-19 Spoiled supplies Vanishing NPCs 20

A discipline problem is revealed among the NPCs. Roll a d6 and consult the Discipline Problems table to determine what transpires. DISCIPLINE PROBLEMS d6 Problem 1-2 A loud argument that has a 50 percent chance of attracting nearby monsters (roll on the Creature Encounters table in chapter 2) 34 Theft or dispute over the division of spoils 56 Brawl or other outbreak of violence

DISEASE

One or more NPC party members contract a disease. Roll a d4 to determine how many NPCs arc affected, then roll a The party stumbles upon the remains of one or more d6 and consult the Diseases tabic to determine which creatures slaughtered by rampaging demons. Roll a dlO disease is contracted. See in chapter 8. “Running the and consult the Corpses table to determine what they find. Game,” in the Dungeon Master’s Guide for descriptions of A thorough search of the area yields no treasure. cackle fever, sewer plague, and sight rot. B ATT L E A F T E R M ATH

CORPSES dlO 1 24-5 6-7 810

DISEASES

Corpse Present d6 Disease 1 dead behir 1-2 Cackle fever 3 ld4 dead drow and ld4 - 1 dead giant lizards 3- 4 Sewer plague 3d8 dead giant fire beetles (their glands are no 5 Sight rot longer glowing) 6 Zuggtmoy’s spores (see chapter 5, 2d4 dead gricks "Neverlight Grove") 9 2d4 dead kuo-toa 1 dead purple worm MADNESS

Roll a d6 and consult the Scavengers table to determine what scavengers, if any, are feasting on the remains. S C AVE N G E R S d6

Scavengers

1-2 3-4

ld3 black puddings ld4 carrion crawlers

5 6

ld6 gnolls and ld6 hyenas 1 otyugh

One NPC party member goes mad. To determine the kind of madness, roll a d6 and consult the Madness table below. To determine the madness effect, roll percentile dice and consult the appropriate tabic in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide. MADNESS d6 1-3 4-

Madness Short-term madness 5 Long-term madness

6 Indefinite madness

C R E ATU R E E N C O U N T E R

Roll on the Creature Encounters table in chapter 2 or the Darklake Creature Encounters table in chapter 3, depending on where the party is traveling. DEMON ENCOUNTER

Roll a d20 and consult the Demon Encounters table to determine what appears. If the characters stumble upon Juiblex and flee immediately, the demon lord doesn’t pursue or attack them. DEMON ENCOUNTERS d20

Encounter

1-4 5-8

1d4 barlguras ld4 chasmes

9-10 ld2 hezrous 11-14 ld4 shadow demons 15-18 ld3 vrocks 19-20 juiblex (see appendix D)

DISCIPLINE PROBLEM CHAPTER 10 | DESCENT INTO THE DEPTHS

POISONED NPCS

One or more NPC party members are poisoned for Id 10 x 10 hours by eating tainted food or poisonous Underdark mushrooms. Roll a dl2 to determine how many NPCs are poisoned in this way. SPOILED SUPPLIES

The party’s provisions become infested with Undcrdark vermin or infected with spores that render them poisonous. Unless the characters have access to purify food and drink or similar magic, the party must dispose of 3d6 days of rations. VANISHING NPCS

One or more NPC party members go missing and are never seen again. Roll a d4 to determine how many NPCs vanish in this way. Efforts to find them or magically contact them turn up no trace.

U NDERDARK O UTPOSTS Characters can clear out Underdark areas and create defensible outposts where they and their followers can store supplies and take refuge. To ensure that an outpost isn’t overrun and looted, guards must be assigned to the outpost while the characters are away. Outposts not only allow scouts to easily backtrack through the Underdark, carrying messages and information to the characters’ allies, but also allow additional supplies and reinforcements to reach the expeditionary force with relative ease. Characters without outposts must rely on magic to send messages or receive supplies and reinforcements once their expeditionary force is more than a tenday’s travel away from Mantol-Derith. N E W D O W N T I M E A C T I V I T Y : E S TAB L I S H

AN

O U T P O S T ____________________________________

Establishing an Underdark outpost is a new downtime activity available to characters in this adventure. An outpost requires a total of 150 hours of work to build, assuming its location is clear of creatures and hazards. Multiple characters can combine their efforts to reduce the completion time. Each Underdark outpost is basically a fortified encampment. It can take one of the following forms:

gratitude for the adventurers' aid. they offer to reinforce the party's expeditionary force with twelve deep gnomes. Chief Dorbo Diggermattock can also be persuaded to lend additional aid and troops, if the heroes presenL a compelling case. Use the information in chapter 6 to guide any negotiations or arrangements the adventurers attempt to make with the svirfneblin.

THE DARKLAKE____________________ To move their expeditionary force across the Darklake, the characters must build rafts or coracles from Underdark materials, or seek out duergar or kuo-toa ferries for hire. Each ferry they find can transport up to eight members of the expeditionary force. Chapter 3 contains information on navigating the Darklake. If Lhe expeditionary force splits up, check for random encounters with each group separately. F ALLEN S LOOBLUDOP

If the characters visit Sloobludop, they find the kuo- toa community in ruins. Demogorgon smashed and crushed many of the structures of the settlement, killing about half the kuo-toa community in the process. The survivors have fallen prey to madness and the predations of Undcrdark monsters in the time since. Obscene altars and shrines arc everywhere, many of them depicting elements of Demogorgon's twisted • A small cave, roughly 20 feet square, with one or more iconography—spirals and "Y” shapes, two-headed gated or barricaded exits creatures, manta rays, and tentacles. Other shrines show ■ A walled compound, up to 20 feet square, within a much the influence of other demon lords, including piles of larger cavern skulls and bones, strange maze patterns, spore clouds, and • A island with boats or rafts fetid pools of ooze. Conflicts are rapidly rising between • A hard-to-reach ledge, pinnacle, or promontory the various “sects" that have formed. accessed by ladders and/or ropes If Shuushar the Awakened (see chapter 1) was not killed in a previous chapter of the adventure, thp characters find ETRACING TEPS him among Sloobludop's survivors. This section addresses what happens if the characters visit He is the sole point of calm and reason in the ruined places they skipped during their escape from the settlement, and the various factions of the kuo-toa show Undcrdark, and what mighl have changed or shifted in him respect. Shuushar mediates disputes between the kuotheir absence. toa and supervises the allocation of their dwindling resources. Even so. the kuo-toa monk isn’t sure how long B L I N C D E N S T O N E ________________________________ he can sustain his people and keep them from destruction. Tf the adventurers encountered the Pudding King and GRACKLSTUGH uncovered evidence ofjuiblex’s presence near Blingdenstone, they might want to return there to confirm If the characters visited Gracklstugh previously, the that the svirfneblin settlement remains safe from the duergar response to their return is dictated by the gray demon lord's influence. dwarves’ prior experience with the characters. The duergar Alternatively, if the characters didn't previously visit are cautious—if not downright alarmed—at the sight of an Blingdenstone. news of the challenges faced by the deep armed expeditionary force from the surface world at their gnomes can reach them while they travel through the gates. They likely refuse entry to the full party, allowing Underdark. Deep gnome merchants headed to Mantolonly a select few characters into the Darklake District. Derith bring word of oozes infesting the settlement, giving Invisible duergar guards keep watch on characters in the the characters an opportunity to face off against the city at all times, and might even infiltrate the expeditionary force, attempting to eavesdrop on Pudding King. conversations to learn the adventurers’ intentions. At some point after the Pudding King is dealt with. Juiblex and its servants make their way toward the caverns of Araumycos to crash Zuggtmoy’s wedding (see chapter 16. “The Fetid Wedding"). If the Pudding King is among the survivors, he leads the mad march to confront Zuggtmoy and her fungal followers.

R

S

R EINFORCEMENTS

The deep gnomes of Blingdenstone are valuable allies. In CHAPTER 10 1 DESCENT INTO THE DEPTHS •47

D ARK P LOTS CHAOS IN THE CITY

The influence of the demon lords grows ever stronger in Gracklstugh. Paranoia and fear are rampant, with duergar barricading themselves in their homes and strongholds, afraid to venture out into the streets- even invisibly. Rumors abound of creatures active in the Darklake, and of secret rituals and offerings made to the dark waters to appease them. A number of foreigners have disappeared, and incoming trade to the city has slowed as outsiders depart or stay away. Conflict between the Keepers of the Flame and the Gray Ghosts thieves' guild comes to a boil. Each side blames the other for recent happenings in the City of Blades and believes it can use the situation to its advantage. Keepers turn up dead, murdered by mysterious assailants, while agents of that order use increasingly brutal methods to ferret out and eliminate the Gray Ghosts —or anyone believed to associate with them. Whether due to the intervention of the adventurers, the recent events in the Underdark, or both. Themberchaud the Wyrmsmith knows that the Keepers are deliberately oppressing him, and he plots to thin their ranks and weaken their power. Though the dragon knows that he is effectively trapped in the caverns of Gracklstugh even if he wins his freedom, he hungers for it nonetheless, just as he hungers for revenge against those who oppose him.

If the characters spend much time in Gracklstugh, they become caught up in a rush of destructive events. A secret alliance of factions within the Council of Savants and the Keepers of the Flame, driven by demonic madness, comes to the conclusion that Gracklstugh's salvation lies in eliminating Themberchaud before he becomes a bigger threat. In the process, both factions plan to acquire a new and far more powerful patron. The duergar and derro hatch a scheme to sacrifice Themberchaud as an offering to Demogorgon, drawing the demon prince to their city and pledging themselves to the Prince of Demons, A few of them even have delusions that they can somehow bind or influence the demon lord's power, or that the demon lord will lead them in conquering the whole of the Underdark. Meanwhile, rumors mount that the drow of Menzoberranzan are behind the demonic incursion. Tales range from the drow raising a mighty army of demons to a summoning spell gone terribly wrong. A demonic rampage is said to have nearly destroyed the City of Spiders, and characters with knowledge of the situation in Menzoberranzan are of great interest to all the factions of Gracklstugh. Any evidence that the drow are responsible for the presence of the demon lords stokes the already blazing embers of animosity against the dark elves, with the more militant factions of Gracklstugh calling for a renewed war of vengeance —against Menzoberranzan.

M E N Z O B E R R A N Z A N _____________________________

orders her own force to attack. If the characters leave Aljanor behind or allow him to die. members of the party's The characters might decide to visit Menzoberranzan before heading to Gravenhollow, either to learn what the expeditionary force in league with the Order of the Gauntlet who make it back to Gauntlgrym report the drow know about the arrival of the demon lords or to incident to Sir Lanniver Stray! (see. chapter 8). assess their involvement in recent events. Ryzliir and Velgor are mounted on giant riding lizards M ARCH ON M ENZOBERRANZAN (see the end of chapter 8 for statistics), and Aljanor rides If the characters advance their expeditionary force toward behind Velgor. Ryzliir commands a force of six drow the drow city, word of their approach reaches warriors, twelve bugbear slaves, and sixty goblin slaves. Menzoberranzan two days before their arrival, and the If all the drow arc killed, the gobltnoids flee as their drow dispatch a well-armed defense force to destroy the morale breaks. surface dwellers. Racing ahead of this drow force is a high Sir Aljanor has made his peace with Tyr and expects to elf from Silverymoon named Khalessa Draga. die. He is disappointed if good lives are lost in a A deep cover agent of the Lords' Alliance. Khalessa has been spying on the drow for years - so long, in fact, that foolish attempt to rescue him. If he survives, he her superiors are beginning to wonder if she’s a defector. accepts any offer to join the party's expeditionary Khalessa is a loyal alliance spy with the following force and is quick to assume a leadership role. statistical modifications: • • • •

Khalessa’s alignment is neutral. She has darkviSton out to a range of 60 feet. She speaks Common. Elvish, and Undercommon. Khalessa's fey ancestry gives her advantage on saving throws against being charmed, and magie can’t put her to sleep. • She can cast the dancing lights cantrip at will. • She owns a hat of disguise, which she uses to appear as a female drow while in the company of drow. and she wears a piwafwi (see appendix B). Khalessa urges the characters to turn back. If they don't, she fears that the drow force will overwhelm them. Having blown her cover to warn the characters, she asks to stay with them until they reach Gauntlgrym or an alliance settlement. The leaders of the drow force are a female elite drow warrior named Ryzliir Symrywin and her consort, a male drow mage named Velgor Zolond. They arc joined by a prisoner in manacles—an unarmed and unarmored male human knight of the Order of the Gauntlet named Aljanor Keenblade. Sir Aljanor was captured during a surface raid months ago. and the drow have beaten him such that he has only 3 hit points remaining. Members of the order traveling in the party's expeditionary force recognize Sir Aljanor instantly and are surprised: they assumed he had been killed. Ryzliir vows to execute Aljanor unless the characters withdraw their expeditionary force immediately. Under no circumstances will she willingly release her prisoner. If the characters refuse to turn back. Ryzliir kills Aljanor and

NEVERLIGHT GROVE ______________________________________________

If the characters return to Neverlight Grove, myconids lova! to Sovereign Basidia (including Stool and Rumpadump if they remained behind) try to intercept them before their arrival and warn them off. The myconids say that matters have become grave, and that the characters should avoid the grove at all costs. If the adventurers don't leave immediately, six myconid adults, four quaggoth spore servants, and four awakened zurkhwoods (see appendix C) loyal to Sovereign Phylo cut off their retreat. They surround the characters and their followers, offering to escort them to Phylo as the sovereign’s honored guests. Sovereign Phylo is friendly and offers all visitors food and drink; however, his offerings are poisoned. Each creature that consumes the food or drink must succeed on a DC 13 Constitution saving throw or become poisoned for 8 hours. The creature is also unconscious while poisoned in this way. Any creature that remains unconscious in the grove for 1 hour or more is afflicted by Zuggtmoy’s spores, as described in chapter 5. If the characters take Basidia’s advice and turn back, the myconid sovereign promises to contact them again when “the time is right to oppose Zuggtmoy” (as described in chapter 16. "The Fetid Wedding"). V E L K Y N V E LVE

If the adventurers return to the drow outpost where they were imprisoned, they find Velkynvelve under the command of a drow mage named Servan Llarabbar. Six male drow report to him. while three more male drow and one female drow elite warrior have been locked in the slave pen. The prisoners are afflicted with various forms of indefinite madness (roll on the Indefinite Madness table in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide). Even Servan is beginning to show' heightened megalomania and paranoia, seeing enemies everywhere. He has delusions of grandeur and fantasies about declaring Velkynvelve independent of Menzoberranzan, rallying followers to CHAPTER 10 I DESCENT INTO THE DEPTHS

A LJ AN O R K EEN B LAD E K H ALES S A D R AG A

149

his side and eventually toppling the matriarchs of the great houses.

CHAPTER 10 I DESCENT INTO THE DEPTHS

150

CHAPTER 11: GRAVENHOLLOW The library of Gravenhollow is a bastion of peace and order in an Underdark gone mad. Carved out long ago from the bones of the. world and protected by ancient and potent magic, the library possesses a kind of awareness. It blocks and misdirects those unworthy of reaching its gates, even as it facilitates finding the way for those who need it. The adventurers need to find the library in their quest to learn what has happened in the Underdark. Before obtaining the answers they seek, however, they must come to understand Gravenhollow and its keepers— three stone giants who reside within the library. These librarians arc tasked with recording and maintaining the lore of their own kind, as well as all the echoes of the past, present, and future haunting the library’s halls. Gravenhollow is a place where visitors will most certainly find answers. However, those answers might not be the ones the characters wanted—or might even be things they never wanted to know.

G OING TO G RAVENHOLLOW The objective of the adventurers' return to the Underdark is to find Gravenhollow. Ancient legends state that every event that has ever occurred in the Underdark is recorded on the countless tablets and cylinders in Gravenhollow s halls. As such, it might be the key to discovering the cause of the demon lords’ arrival. The stone library lies west of the Wormwrithings, 360 miles from Mantol-Derith and 120 miles from Gauntlgrym. Only one tunnel leads to the library, and the magic surrounding Gravenhollow can change where the tunnel’s entrance appears among the surrounding passageways, even as that magic allows visitors to locate its entrance. Fortunately for the characters, the library's awareness—in tune with all events in the Underdark— knows that they are coming. As such, the ring obtained from the Zhentarim in Mantol-Derith (see chapter 9) allows them to find the secret site. The journey from Mantol-Derith to Gravenhollow takes 60 days. If the characters teleport back to Gauntlgrym and start there, the trip takes 20 days. See chapters 2 and 10 for information on traveling in the Underdark.

-

2

FINDING

THE

W AY _____________________________

The characters can find the route to Gravenhollow using Ghazrim DuLoc’s ring. If they don’t have the ring, there are a couple other options available to them. CHAZRIM ’S RING

The star ruby in Ghazrim's ring has a white, star-shaped core that guides its wearer along the safest, shortest route to Gravenhollow. SOCIETY

OF

BRILLIANCE

If one or more members of the Society of Brilliance arc traveling with the party (sec the “Society of Brilliance" random encounter in chapter 2), they can find the way to Gravenhollow. having found it once before. Any Society of Brilliance member who comes within a day’s travel of the library can make a DC 15 Intelligence check to find the passage leading to Gravenhollow. If its check fails, it can try again after 8 hours of searching and contemplation. S TONE G IANT G UIDE

If the characters don't have the ring to guide them, a duergar NPC (for example. Ghuldur Flagonfist in Mantol-Derith) might suggest that they talk to Stonespeaker Hgraam in Gaunllgrym. If the characters helped the stone giants by putting an end to the horrid derro rituals in the Whorlstone Tunnels (see chapter 4) , Stonespeaker Hgraam is willing to assign them a guide—a stone giant named Jaal—who can lead them to Gravenhollow. As he guides the expeditionary force through the Underdark, Jaal periodically stops to press his hands against ancient stone, as though communing with the rock itself. His mystical connection to the Underdark allows him to find the safest, shortest route to the stone library. V E L D Y S K A RTH E B A S I L I S K

When the characters are within a day's travel of Gravenhollow, they hear someone singing strange tunes in various languages, the voice echoing down adjacent tunnels. Approaching the sound reveals a basilisk named Veidyskar resting in an intersection. No ordinary basilisk, Veidyskar has an Intelligence of 10 (+0) and speaks Common. Dwarvish, Giant, and Undercommon. A small group of characters scouting can sneak up on Veidyskar with a successful DC 10 group Dexterity (Stealth) check. Any characters who observe the basilisk can note that it keeps its eyes downcast, as if consciously trying to control its petrifying gaze. When Veidyskar becomes aware of the characters, he calls them over, speaking in all the languages he knows until he determines that the characters understand Common.

spoken to. and his answers are brief. With the basilisk as their guide, it takes the characters another eight hours to reach the gates of Gravenhollow'. Untold years ago, a visiting stone giant druid presented the librarians with a gift: Veidyskar. an intelligent basilisk trained to serve the keepers as a guardian and general-purpose helper. The basilisk adapted readily to the timeless nature of the library and embraced his new duties with great dedication. Veidyskar is committed to the protection of the library and its librarians. If trouble arises, his philosophy is to petrify first and ask questions later. Initially, this presented a problem for the stone giant librarians, as the basilisk had some difficulty reconciling his temper and bestial nature with the recognition of w'hat trouble might actually look like. The stone giants taught Veidyskar how to cast greater restoration, w'hich the basilisk can do once per day to restore anyone who crosses him. G ATE S

OF

G R AVE N H O L L O W

A pair of massive basalt doors mark the entrance to Gravenhollow, flanked by stone giant statues that arc actually stone golems. The doors are opened simply by pushing, after which the entire expeditionary force can enter along with the characters. The golems turn their heads to watch new arrivals but otherwise remain still. The basilisk Veidyskar guides the characters in through the gates, instructs them to continue straight ahead, then quickly disappears down a side passage. Walking across the threshold of Gravenhollow is like stepping into another realm. The oppressive gloom of the Underdark is replaced by light and a sense of openness that brings back memories of the surface world. The corridor beyond the gates is wide enough for ten people to walk side by side, and the ceiling's height reminds you of the great halls of Gauntlgrym. The corridor opens into a central well, with walkways crossing its span to the opposite side. You can barely see the ends of the level to your right and left, with doors opening into so many rooms that you doubt you could explore them all in a single day. The ceiling is bright, with rainbows trapped in hundreds of crystal formations combining to create a warm and inviting illumination. Looking down is a dizzying experience. Staircases connect to different levels below, and you soon lose count of how far down they go. A stout, rocky creature detaches from the perfectly smooth wall to your left, leaving an imprint of its body in the wall that quickly smooths out and fades from sight.

A many-legged reptile stretches out as if it has been

“Trravelerrrrsss. I am Hourm. The masterrrsss arre

sitting for a long while, avoiding your eyes as it looks

occupied. Therre arre rroomsss forrall of you. Choose

to the rocky floor at your feet. ‘‘About time you lot

yourr own. The rresourreesss of Grravenhollow arre at

arrived! Come! The library bid me guide you to the

yourr disssposssa! You need onlyasssk."

gates, and I've waited too long for you already."

After his initial greeting, Veidyskar speaks only if

Hourm. a friendly galeb duhr. answers any questions the characters have about Gravenhollow to the best of its ability, including how navigate its levels, and how to access the library’s knowledge. After leading the party to living quarters one level below the library’s main level, it merges into another wall and disappears.

T HE S TONE L IBRARY When the characters first enter Gravenhollow, the library appears to be a simple arrangement of great cavernous halls carved out from the stone of the Underdark. However, the library is suffused with magic that warps the space within it, and which makes navigating and exploration a unique challenge (see the "Gravenhollow: General Features’’ sidebar). Each room on each level of Gravenhollow is part of either the Archives of the Past, the Archives of the Present, or the Archives of the Future. Galeb duhr THE LIBRARIANS

assistants pick up tablets as Gravenhollow’s three stone giant librarians carve and catalog them, but the classification system the giants use to organize the library's information is known only to them. RESIDENTS

The library is quiet and peaceful, and visitors are free to move within it as they wish. If anyone has a need to find any other character within Gravenhollow (including one of the librarians), the library subtly directs the character toward its target within minutes. The three stone giants who serve as Gravenhollow's librarians don't specifically welcome visitors—or even notice their comings and goings—unless the library directs them to do so. The characters need to seek the keepers out. U LTHAR

Ulthar is the Keeper of the Past. He sorts and files ancient texts, maintaining the immeasurably vast catalog that organizes them. When not cross- referencing his expanding collection, he composes epic poetry and is responsible for curating and restoring wall carvings throughout the library. Ulthar is infinitely patient, always welcoming any chance to discuss history with visitors. Of the three librarians, he is the most willing and likely to spend time with the library’s guests. He treats surface dwellers as if they were figments out of dreams, but makes it obvious he believes that such dreams have wisdom to share. U RMAS

Urmas, the Keeper of the Present, is the busiest of all the librarians. He commands a vast network of magically augmented subterranean beasts, which he uses as messengers, bringing and sending news from giants throughout the Underdark and sometimes from the “dream” of the surface world. Urmas exchanges messages with Stonespeaker Hgraam (see chapter 4), keeping abreast of events as they pertain to the stone giant community in the duergar city of Gracklstugh. Though Urmas is patient, it quickly becomes obvious that he suffers the characters’ questions and presence out of duty and politeness, seeking to return to his work as soon as possible. The giant is distracted by the increasingly dire news brought in by his messengers, including reports from stone giant mystics, as well as elemental servitors such as galeb duhr and xorn. However, if the characters bring news about the demon lords in the Underdark, they have Urmas’s immediate and full attention. USTOVA

The Keeper of the Future, Ustova is a seer who spends most of her time in constant meditation, transcribing her visions onto stone tablets as she experiences them. Like Urmas, she focuses her efforts on the fate of the different giant communities and clans, sorting through the various threads of destiny and possibility for omens presaging the resurgence of the giants’ once-great civilization.

The irruption of the demon lords into the Underdark has sent powerful ripples of indescribable chaos through Ustova’s visions. All she sees of the future is tire, blood, and death, shot through with signs and portents based upon the natures of the demon lords—the bloody spirals and twin-forked symbols of Demogorgun, the excessive growth and rot of Zuggtmoy, visions obscured and clouded by the slime ofjuiblex. and so on. She gladly helps any characters who can offer clarity in what she is seeing, treating such information as beneficial visions from the dream that is the world outside the Underdark. G A L E B D U H R A S S I S T AN T S

The library draws in elemental spirits to animate earth and stone, forming galeb duhr to serve as assistants for the keepers. These creatures are humorless but diligent. ECHOES

Gravenhollow ‘'remembers” all who have walked its halls, as well as those who will visit the library in the future. As the characters explore the library, apparitions constantly flicker in and out of existence around them the echoes of those who have come or will come to Gravenhollow in search of knowledge. The time-displaced echoes in Gravenhollow are a prime opportunity to introduce great NPCs of Faerun in a way that will not negatively impact the story you want to tell, nor steal the spotlight from the characters. The echoes offer characters the chance to receive advice from experienced adventurers and heroes, and for the players to interact with some of their favorite characters from the Forgotten Realms. An echo is a quasi-real duplicate of the original creature, except it has 1 hit point and can't attack or cast spells. An echo reduced to 0 hit points vanishes. It’s impossible to tell at a glance whether an echo is from the past or the future. Clothing and equipment might help, or characters can simply ask. Interacting with an echo is the same as interacting with the original creature, but because most echoes are in the midst of their own search for knowledge, they prefer to be left alone. Echoes appear so often that the characters find one every time they go looking for any information in the library. Use the Echoes in Gravenhollow table to determine who the characters encounter, or place echoes as you see tit. E C H O E S I N G R AVE N H O L L O W d20 Echo 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 9-10

Alustriel Silverhand Andarin Zarith Bruenor Battlehammer Elminster Graz’zt

11-12 13-14 15-16 17-18

Hgraam Jalynfein Obiodra Society of Brilliance Xetzirbor

19-20

Yauln

ILLUSTRIOUS VISITORS

The time-displaced echoes in Gravenhollow are a prime opportunity to introduce some of the great adventurers and personalities of FaerOn in a way that will not negatively impact the story you want to tell, nor steal the spotlight from the characters. The echoes offer them the chance to receive advice from experienced adventures and heroes, and for the adventurers to meet some of their favorite characters from the world of the Forgotten Realms. The echoes belong to those who managed to find Gravenhollow, coming there to seek knowledge for whatever all-important purpose or quest drove them there. Each echo is also from a specific point in time (possibly including the future).

A LUSTRIEL S ILVERHAND

This legendary wizard and leader appears as a human female in her early twenties. She interacts with the characters with kindness and a certain whimsy, but doesn't disclose what time period she’s from, admonishing characters who try to learn too much of the past or future. A NDARIN Z ARITH

This human Red Wizard of Thay will visit Gravenhollow nearly a century in the future. He treats the characters as annoying apparitions and refuses to deal with them, B RUENOR B ATTLEHAMMER

The dwarf king’s red hair has turned mostly white, and he leans heavily on a thick crystal cane. He is old, frail, and quite senile, and he can’t remember why he came to Gravenhollow or what he's looking for. E LMINSTER

This echo of the future claims to be searching for a longforgotten spell. If the characters ask the venerable human archmage about the demonic incursion. Elminster reveals that the demonic incursion was the unintended result of a spell cast by Gromph Baenre, a former Archinage of Menzoberranzan. Elminster doesn't reveal what happened to Gromph, for he's reluctant to divulge too much information about the future. If the characters press him for details, Elminster says only that many great heroes were lost to the demonic tide, but several powerful demon lords were driven back to the Abyss. G RAZ ’ ZT

This echo of Graz'zt (see appendix D) is gathering all the information it can about the Underdark. The Dark Prince asks the characters what part of the Underdark they come from. If they mention the surface world. Graz’zt eyes widen as his curiosity is piqued. H GRAAM

This younger version of Stonespeaker Hgraam (see chapter 4, "Gracklstugh") treats the characters as spirits and asks them philosophical questions about the nature of dreams. If the characters engage him in conversation, he bids them farewell with the words, " I will remember you." J ALYNFEIN O BLODRA

This young male drow was cast out of Menzoberranzan after he lost his sight, yet he survived and found his way CHAPTER 11 I G RAVEN HOLLO W

153

here. The blind drow came to the library hoping to overcome his blindness and take revenge on his family. Characters familiar with drow lore or history know, with a successful DC 14 Intelligence (History) check, that House Oblodra was all but wiped out years ago. S OCIETY

OF

B RILLIANCE

The characters encounter echoes of all five members of the Society of Brilliance (see the “Society of Brilliance" random encounter in chapter 2). Any members of the society traveling wuth the party know that these are echoes from the past. The Society of Brilliance came to Gravenhollow years ago on a pilgrimage of enlightenment. If the characters mention the demonic incursion and postulate a theory of drow involvement, the Society of Brilliance echoes confirm that such an event is inevitable, “given the drow propensity for demon summoning and the inherent unpredictability of faerzress." These echoes don’t have much else to offer, although they can explain how the library works (see the “Gravenhollow: General Features” sidebar). X ETZIRBOR

This mind flayer regards the characters writh interest. Xetzirbor refuses to disclose its timeline but hints that it knows about the demonic incursion. The mind flayer tries to entice the characters into telling it what they have discovered, but of its own purpose. Xetzirbor reveals only that it came to Gravenhollow to find a way to save a dying elder brain it calls Cyrog. Y AULN

A male stone giant from an ancient past. Yauln came to Gravenhollow to seek answers on whether his clan should enter an alliance with the bearer of the Cairngorm Crown (see chapter 4, “Gracklstugh"). L I V I N G Q U A RT E R S _____________________________

Each level of Gravenhollow features rooms reserved for habitation. The galeb duhr keep the rooms clean, and can provide food and drink magically created by the library if asked. L IBRARIANS ’ Q UARTERS

Urmas and Ustova live on the top level of the library, taking up all the living quarters at either end of that level. Their rooms reflect their duties and personalities. Urmas’s quarters contain a collection of carved tablets, as well as actual books and scrolls found nowhere else in the library. Ustova’s quarters feature a collection of musical instruments and divination tools, including crystal orbs, bags of bones, and a large mithral basin. Ulthar lives on a lower level that he claims is “near the bottom of the library," though such a distinction is meaningless given how distorted distance and direction can be in the library (see the “Gravenhollow: General Features” sidebar). His quarters are a work of art, covered with murals and wall carvings of his own design, along with workshops where he engages in crafting. G UEST Q UARTERS CHAPTER 11 | GRAVENHOLLOW

154

The guest quarters appear bare until a visitor chooses a room. The next time that room is entered, it is fully furnished according to the character’s taste and needs. Characters don't need to make any check to find Lheir guest rooms after exploring the library: they need only wish to return, and the next set of stairs they come to leads them to the appropriate level. W A L K WAYS The walkways that surround the central well are wide and mostly empty, with the occasional galeb duhr or visitor echo wandering about. Each level consists of a well opening surrounded by a wide walkway connecting the rooms dug into the surrounding wall. Bridges cross the well at regular intervals, and also connect to stairs to the levels above and below. No matter how far down visitors go, there always appear to be more levels below. ARCHIVES Gravenhollow’s records are organized by rooms attuned to the past, the present, or the future. Each level has a random number of rooms, arranged without any apparent system other than the library’s intuitive ability to direct visitors to where they want to go—or to where the library thinks they need to go. A CCESSING

THE

R ECORDS

The library keeps its records on stone and crystal slabs monoliths, and stelae fitting neatly in niches carved into the walls of every room. Thanks to the library’s comprehend languages effect, anyone can easily decipher and understand the runes and glyphs carved into the stone. These records contain only what the librarians were able to write down. Even with their network of messengers and informants, and the visions they receive using the powers of the library, the stone giants are still mortal creatures. As such, the giants' own understanding might limit the characters' ability to locate information in the library. The library’s written records deal only with events in the Underdark and the history of giants. Like most stone giants, the librarians consider the surface world a realm of dreams, and what happens there is deemed less important than events in the Underdark. To acquire information not inscribed in the records (including any events outside the Underdark), the characters need a stonespeaker crystal (see appendix B), after which they must find an appropriate archive to query events in the past, present, or future. A RCHIVES

OF THE

P AST

Every room devoted to the records of the past has the same inscription carved above the doorway in runes that anyone who knows Dwarvish or Giant understands The past is a crystal, for it can be seen from many facets yet it always remains the same.

These rooms contain crystals of many colors. Ulthar and his assistants periodically move tablets, cylinders, and stelae from the Archives of the Present into these rooms.

Some of the records here date back to the mythic times of the earliesi giant gods. Annals of History. Characters can research the backgrounds of the primary settlements of the Underdark and any well-known characters who dwell there. This lets them know what to expect if they visit those sites in the future, or to better understand some of the events that occurred during a previous visit. For example, they can learn more information about Themberchaud, about the drow siege and demonic assault of Blingdenstone, or any other part of the wellknown history of Faerun. OF THE P RESENT The rooms that contain the works of Urmas have inscriptions carved above the doorway that anyone who knows Dwarvish or Giant can translate:

A RCHIVES

The present is like sand, ever flowing and escaping one's grasp without mercy or respite.

The records in these rooms detail the current state of the Underdark and the giant kingdoms. Current Affairs. Reading the tablets in these archives provides a good overview of what is going on in the Uriderdark at the present time. The latest news has a delay of a few days and is often incomplete, becoming more detailed as Urmas obtains more information from his messengers and informants. The reports about the demons" invasion are sketchy and incomplete, but characters can still get a rough idea about which demon lord arrived where. They can learn that Zuggtmoy might be on the move to an undisclosed location, or follow the ravaging paths of Yeenoghu and Baphomet as they gather and rally the races that worship them. Unlike the bits and pieces of news about the other demon lords, a significant amount of information is known about the cults of Demogorgon festering under Gracklstugh, as events there directly affect the resident stone giant clan. A RCHIVES

OF THE

F UTURE

The rooms with Ustova's prophetic writings have inscriptions above the doorways that anyone who knows Dwarvish or Giant can decipher: The future is a song we remember, but we cannot rush to its end lest we destroy the melody.

Unlike the other rooms in the library, these archives echo with the sound of running water. The wall niches containing the stone cylinders Ustova favors for scribing are also fountains, where water shimmers over crystals as it falls. Prophetic Visions. The information in the Archives of the Future is uncertain, not only because Ustova focuses on prophecies but also because her visions

Power Node. Gravenhollow was carved from a titanic geode whose crystals are imbued with magic that concentrates faerzress. The magic that suffuses the library profoundly affects time and space, altering the perceptions and reality of all beings within its walls. Bigger on the Inside. The notion of space works strangely in Gravenhollow. The interior of the library continually expands as lore is added to it, but visitors can still traverse all its floors and chambers with ease. Only the most absentminded and scatterbrained become lost in Gravenhollow. Universal L a n g u a g e . While in Gravenhollow, all creatures gain the benefit of the comprehend languages spell. Hidden from Magic. Gravenhollow is a window into the passage of time and history, and the magic permeating the library blocks it off from the real world around it. Though divination magic works normally within the library, no divination effect used outside the library can discern any creature, object, or location within it, A Place of Peace. Visitors to the library of Gravenhollow are expected to conduct themselves with decorum, and to refrain from arguments and violence. Creatures that incite conflict quickly draw the attention of the basilisk Veldyskar, who is quick to use his Petrifying Gaze on troublemakers. If a threat arises that Veldyskar can’t handle, the library generates 3d6 galeb duhr to assist him. Willful Navigation. Finding anything in Gravenhollow is an effort of will. Whenever a character seeks a specific location in the library (a particular floor or period of history, for example), the character must make a successful DC 14 Wisdom check to find that location. On a failure, the character takes a wrong turn and must make additional checks until successful. If led by one of the library’s keepers, characters don’t need to make checks to find the location they seek.

detail potential futures, not definite outcomes. Urmas and Ustova compare notes often to validate their visions. The prophecies in these rooms are limited to the future of giantkind—and the trials still to come for those oncegreat races—because this is Ustova's sole interest.

T HE E NEMY OF O UR E NEMY

As the characters explore the library, ideally after encountering an echo or two, they meet the venerable draw archmage Vizeran DeVir. accompanied by Kleve. a death slaad bodyguard in its natural form. Vizcran is an archmage with the following statistical modifications: • Vizeran’s alignment is neutral evil. • Vizeran’s fey ancestry gives him advantage on saving throws against being charmed, and magic can't put him to sleep. • Vizeran can innately cast the following spells, requiring no material components: dancing lights ai will, darkness once per day, faerie lire once per day (spell save DC 15), and levitate (self only) once per day. • While in sunlight, Vizeran has disadvantage on attack rolls, as well as on Wisdom (Perception) checks that rely on sight.

G R AVE N H O L L O W : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

Not even the current librarians know who built Gravenhollow. All they know is that the library has existed since the dawn of giantkind. CHAPTER 11 | GRAVENHOLLOW

155

When the characters first encounter Vizeran and Kleve, read the following boxed text to the players. Two figures approach—a withered drow clad in dark flowing robes, and a hulking gray-skinned monster resembling a spiky humanoid toad, its wide mouth full of razor-sharp teeth. The drow's pinched and lined face speak to his great age, and his red eyes narrow and appraise you carefully as he approaches.

Vizeran greets the adventurers cautiously, introduces himself and his companion, and asks what business brings them to Gravenhollow. He remains cool and polite, trying to avoid any tension for fear of inciting violence in this place. If the characters are willing to talk to him, Vizeran tells them he has opposed the tyranny of Lolth and her priestesses for centuries. He believes that some kind of demonic invasion of the Underdark is underway, and he has come to Gravenhollow to confirm his suspicions and make plans to combat it. The drow archmage suggests that the adventurers make their own inquiries—and that they look in particular into Menzoberranzan and its archmage, Gromph Baenre. Vizeran then returns to his quarters, telling the adventurers how to seek the librarians if they don’t already know how to do so.

STONESPEAKER C RYS TAL

meet with Vizeran several times to exchange notes. The drow archmage already knows a lot of what has transpired since the demon lords arrived. He isn’t, however, using the library to delve into specific events, so he welcomes the characters’ input while remaining tight-lipped about his own intentions and goals. If the characters threaten Vizeran, Kleve looms menacingly nearby even as the archmage tries to keep things civil, pointing out that there is nothing to be gained by fighting. If the adventurers attack him or Kleve, Vizeran casts time stop and departs before Veldyskar shows up (see “A Place of Peace" in the “Gravenhollow: General Features” sidebar). Kleve becomes invisible and follows his master out of Gravenhollow. Despite their attack upon him, the archmage contacts the characters again in an attempt to forge an alliance (see chapter 12, “The Tower of Vengeance”). APPROACHING

THE

LIBRARIANS

If the characters set out to find a librarian, Ulthar is the one they find first. He and Urmas agree that current events in the Underdark are a serious concern, but their roles as record keepers prevent them from acting in any way other than to provide information. Ulthar will speculate that this is likely why the library allowed Vizeran and the characters to find it so easily. Urmas has been following recent events that might have led to the current crisis. He bids the characters to tell him about their own experiences in the Underdark— specifically, their encounters with the demon lords. Ulthar offers the characters one of the library’s stoncspeaker crystals if they don’t have their own, instructing them on how to attune to it. He warns the characters to not let themselves become lost in the visions they will experience.

S TONESPEAKER C RYSTALS A creature attuned to a stonespeaker crystal (see appendix B) gains the ability to peer through the veils of time and receive visions of the past, present, and future—but only while in Gravenhollow. A creature attuned to a stonespeaker crystal gains the following additional benefits while in the library:

During their time in the library, the characters can

CHAPTER 11 GRAVENHOLLOW

• While standing in the Archives of the Past with the crystal in hand, the creature can choose to experience a vision of the past. After receiving this vision, the creature can’t experience another vision of the past until it finishes a long rest. • While standing in the Archives of the Present with the crystal in hand, the creature can choose to receive] a vision of something happening at that moment. After receiving this vision, the creature can’t experience another vision of the present until it finishes a long rest. • While standing in the Archives of the Future with the 1 crystal in hand, the creature can choose to receive a glimpse of what might happen if the demon lords aren’t stopped. After receiving this vision, the creatund

can't experience another glimpse of the future until it finishes a long rest. • While standing in the appropriate archive, the creature can expend 2 of the crystal's charges to ask a question pertaining to the past, present, or future and receive a truthful answer in the form of a vision. Characters can expend charges to confirm suspicions, fill in gaps in their knowledge, and see for themselves the events that brought the demon lords into the world. Such research might take several days. Ulthar doesn’t give them another stonespeaker crystal to speed up the process, but the characters can try to steal one, as the trusting librarian keeps them on a shelf in his quarters. The giant discovers the theft in ld4 days, at which point the characters are confronted by Veldyskar and a host of galeb duhr, who politely ask them to leave Gravenhollow at once. POSSIBLE VISIONS

The following are the most relevant visions the characters can receive as answers to their questions. Elaborate upon or modify these as needed, and improvise visions for other questions the characters ask based on the information in the adventure. G ROMPH ’ S F OLLY

If the characters inquire about Gromph Baenre or the arrival of the demon lords, they receive a vision of how everything started.

A cavern of peculiar beauty opens up before you, with lights of every color shining from the pure essence of life, diffused and amplified by the glow of faerzress. The glow pulses, and you can feel the life in the cavern rotting away, bursting with infection. A mushroom grows in the center of the cave, ever larger and taller, pustules forming and seeping as its stem thickens and its cap reaches to the cavern's ceiling, forming a vast fungal tower. Two myconids approach the site in awe, not minding the carpet of rot under their feet. You sense their minds come alive in wonder, and as they kneel in worship, you know they are doomed. A voice sounds out within clouds of spores that fall like snow. The voice tells the myconids to prepare for a gift unlike any they have ever known.

If the characters visited Neverlight Grove, they recognize one of the myconids as Sovereign Phylo, while somehow knowing that the other is Yestabrod before it became mutated. As much as the characters learned from fighting the Pudding King in Blingdensrone. they might decide to seek more knowledge of the mad svirfneblin or his fiendish master. Juiblex the Faceless Lord. JUIB LEX AND THE PUDDING KlNG

A deep gnome spurned by others ofhis kind weeps as he wanders the dark tunnels, talking to the things that crawl and seep from the walls. You see him adopt two slick

An imperious drow archwizard in spider-silk robes casts a

patches of ooze, sensing his innate power over them. He

mighty conjuration spell. As the ritual draws toward its

plays with them as if they were children, chasing them

conclusion, a web of faerzress energy expands outward. The

through the gloomy depths.

wizard seems alarmed by this, his efforts to complete the spell growing more crazed as he realizes he's lost control. And then, madness! Rifts open in the web of energy

Something changes, and the oozes flow away. The deep gnome runs after them, fearful of being alone once again. You feel a great hunger seize him. He experiences visions

around him. These cracks stretch and widen, and

that pass into your vision, showing what appears as a

through them come horrific fiends that scream, shriek,

paradise to him but an oozing nightmare for all others. The

and howl as they are wrenched from the Abyss and

great hunger speaks to him, his already broken mind a

cast into the Underdark.

shield against the hunger's shattering power. That power

A woman’s deep, dark laugh echoes in your mind as the drow wizard shrinks away from the demonic hordes he has unwittingly unleashed.

seems to recognize and acknowledge something in the gnome that will serve it well, The great hunger has a name—Juiblex. And its power.. . oh, such great and terrible power! It grants the gnome the

If a character receiving this vision has a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 13 or higher, he or she sees a drow insignia on the wizard. If the character is a drow or otherwise familiar with the iconography of Menzoberranzan’s drow houses, he or she recognizes the symbol as representing House Baenre. The character can also recall the symbol well enough to draw it, so that another more knowledgeable character can discern its significance.

ability to command the little hungers—his children—so that they can return to the place that cast them out and devour it all!

SUNDERED BLADES

The corruption in Gracklsiugh slowly rots duergar society from within, leading it toward a brutal fate.

Z UGGTMOY ’ S A RRIVAL

The characters can inquire about Zuggtmoy or the events in Neverlight Grove. CHAPTEK it GRAVEN HOLLOW

____________________________/ 15

You see a circle of small hooded figures, their forms

In the heart of a alien cavern glistening with slime, scores

hunched and emaciated. Their gestures and movements are

of mind flayers gather around an enormous brain resting in

jerky, indicative of the madness possessing them.

a pool. The brain is dead. You can hear the illithids'

They are chanting, swaying to their own words. And then

incomprehensible thoughts as they mourn its passing.

they stop as the glow of faerzress rises around them,

One word echoes louder than the others: Cyrog.

whispering to them in unintelligible sounds. The derro

Suddenly, faerzress bathes the dark and twisted hall in

cackle and dance, their hands glowing with a power that

purplish light. A rift opens, and a hulking, horned figure

isn’t theirs. The vision shifts, and suddenly gray dwarves

that reeks of putrescence steps out. It raises a skull- tipped

stare down at the red-hot metal on their anvils. The

wand and points it at the dead elder brain. The elder brain

constant rhythm of their hammering falters. Suddenly,

begins to pulsate, and you see intermittent flashes of purple

brother turns against brother as minds turn inward upon

light under its rotting flesh. The mind flayers are aghast as

themselves. Sparks fly and a city burns.

the elder brain speaks to them once more, telling them that

i

Orcus has saved Cyrog, and commanding them to follow it

D EMOGORGON ’ S ALTAR

into undeath.

One of the first brushes the characters might have had with the demon lords was in Sloobludop. where they witnessed the rise of Demogorgon. the so-called “Deep Father” of the mad kuo-toa. You see a kuo-toa swimming in the gloomy depths of a dark, subterranean lake, uncertain. It turns left and right, trying to find something, even as it's surrounded by a fanged creatures resembling manta rays. The kuo-toa smiles, its needle teeth gleaming even in the darkness. It has seen something. It understands a new secret, and its already unhinged mind plunges further into madness.

The librarians of Gravenhollow know that Cyrog is the name of distant mind flayer settlement. Vizeran DeVir and every member of the Society of Brilliance also knows that Cyrog is named after an ancient elder brain that commands the settlement, which lies deep in the Underdark, thousands of miles to the east. B APHOMET ,

THE

H ORNED K ING

The demon lord Baphomet doesn't play a significant role in this adventure. However, a character seeking clues to the Horned King’s whereabouts receive the following vision.

The kuo-toa curls in on itself, arms extended in worship. Then from the circle of rays, two tentacles emerge—

The smell of blood fills your nostrils as you wander a maze

followed by two howling baboon heads.

of Underdark tunnels, moving with purpose as your giant hooves crush stones underfoot. Faerzress light reveals that

F RAZ -U RB ’ LUU

AND THE

G EM Characters might be

your shadow is monstrous, suggesting a hulking beast with

curious to know more about the source of the discord in Mantol-Derith, leading to a revelation about FrazUrb'luu.

a crown of horns. With your bloody glaive, you carve a swath through a forest of towering zurkhwood mushrooms that stands in your way. The tunnels beyond would confuse an ordinary mind, but you instinctively know the path you

A rift formed by faerzress opens wide, illuminating a dark

must walk. Every step brings you closer to a magma-filled

tunnel. The rift spits out a black gem that clatters as it

chasm, lodged in which is an enormous contraption of

tumbles across the tunnel floor. The gem is picked up by a

metal and stone—a weapon capable of reshaping the

gray-skinned dwarf, who inspects it closely. The vision shifts to a brightly lit cavern full of crude merchant stalls, where the duergar hands the gem to a svirfneblin for appraisal. The gnome refuses to return the gem, instead giving it to one of her svirfneblin apprentices. The young apprentice skulks away with the gem in his clutches, but is ambushed by a gargoyle. The gargoyle snatches the gem, flies away, and gives it to a female drow. The drow gazes into the black gemstone and sees a hideous demonic face looking back at her. Thoughts of murder and carnage fill her thoughts as she hides the gemstone on her person, draws her shortsword, and coats the blade with poison.

C YROG L IVES ! H AIL O RCUS !

Although Orcus doesn't have a significant role in this adventure, players might wonder what the Demon Lord of Undeath is up to. CHAPTER 11 | GRAVENHOLLOW

158

Underdark itself. ,.

This vision provides a brief glimpse of the Maze Engine, an arcane device located in the heart of the Labyrinth (see chapter 14). S PAWN

OF

Y EENOGHU

A character that tries to learn more about Yeenoghu, the Demon Lord of Gnolls, receives the following unsettling vision.

'

A hunched and rotting creature with the head of a fiendish hyena swings a tripie-headed flail at a beholder, crushing it. As the eye tyrant falls to the floor, a pack of hyenas leaps onto the corpse and tears off its eyestalks while the demon lord licks the gore off his weapon. As the hyenas feed, they transform into slavering, cackling gnolls before your eyes.

L OLTH , D EMON Q UEEN OF S PIDERS

If the characters inquire about Lolth, they receive a vision of her home in the Demonweb Pits, confirming that at least one demon lord didn't escape the Abyss. You behold the true form of the Demon Queen of Spiders— that of a black, bloated arachnid with the head of a female draw. Nestled in the webs all around her are thousands upon thousands of gray eggs. Lolth knows she is being scried, her fury tangible as her mind reaches out to find you. Her shriek of rage as she's shut out by the powerful wards of Gravenhollow echoes in your mind as the vision is suddenly tom away to darkness.

This vision offers a glimpse of Lolth’s plan to drive her rivals out of the Abyss and repopulate its layers with her own demonic offspring. The character experiencing the vision must succeed on a DC 16 Wisdom saving throw or gain one level of madness (see "Madness" in chapter 2). O THER V ISIONS

The other visions the characters might look for depend on what they experienced during their escape from the Underdark, and what you want the adventure to focus on (including the activities of other demon lords).

R E T U R N IN G TO V I Z E R A N When the characters have discovered all they are looking to find out, they can go to Vizeran. If they don't, he seeks them out, having finished his own research. "That fool Gromph brought the demon lords down upon us, with his demon queen pulling his strings all the while. He

insists his goal is the same as the characters' own, and he doesn’t ask them to involve themselves in his other plans. He points out that he is by far the most inconsequential of the many evils that the characters must contend with. Vizeran invites the adventurers and their NPC followers to Araj, his tower and stronghold, where they can discuss the matter further. There, he can demonstrate what he intends to do and why he needs the heroes’ help. He refuses to discuss plans in detail in Gravenhollow, saying, “The walls here literally have ears, and echoes linger forever." Only his home is secure enough to serve as the place from which to plan the demon lords’ defeat.

L E AVIN G G R AVE N H O L LO W As long as the characters remain respectful guests, the librarians don't mind them staying in Gravenhollow as long as they like. However, the library stops providing new visions after the characters learn the most essential information. If the players persist beyond that point, their elforts prove fruitless, and the librarians or their assistants suggest there is no more they can learn at this lime. The characters can travel with Vizeran, or he provides them with a map and precise directions to guide them to Araj if they want to deal with other matters in the Underdark first. He emphasizes that time is of the essence. Every day the characters tarry allows the demon lords’ power and influence in the Underdarkto grow. See chapter 12, "The Tower of Vengeance," for more information about Araj. The last favor the library provides for the adventurers is to have the tunnel out directly connect with routes leading to the characters' desired destination, whether that destination is Araj, Blingdcnstone, Menzoberranzan, Gracklstugh. Mantol-Derith, the edge of the Darklake. or somewhere else. X P A WAR D S

The characters should leave Gravenhollow with a clear picture of what is happening in the Underdark under (he influence of the demon lords, and the roles that Gromph Bacnrc and Lolth have played in creating the crisis. Each character gains 5,000 XP for learning the truth.

has given Lolth free reign in the Abyss. My own research leads me to believe Gromph usedfaerzress to achieve such a summoning, though I am sure he didn't intend this result. Imbecile! “I can save you months of research—time we clearly don’t have. The information I found here has confirmed my theories, and I know how to banish the demon lords back to the Abyss. We can do this only ifwe work together, if you are willing and daring enough to directly challenge the demon lords. Or perhaps foolhardy is the better word.”

If the characters seem hesitant to work with Vizeran, he reminds them of the peril facing the surface world should the demon lords escape from the Underdark, If the characters accuse Vizeran of having ulterior motives, the drow smiles thinly and agrees. Still, he CHAPTER )! I GlfAVENHOLLOW >59

CHAPTER 12: THE TOWER OF VENGEANCE Offered an alliance by the drow archmage Vizeran DeVir. the adventurers travel to his tower in the depths of the Underdark. There, they learn more about what he knows of the threat posed by the demon lords—and potentially forge a pact with him to deal with that threat. They must be cautious, however, as their potential ally has his own interests at heart and his own agenda where his fellow drow are concerned. If the characters rebuffed Vizeran’s overtures to an alliance in Gravenhollow (see chapter 11), the drow archmage subsequently sends Grin Ousstyl (see later in this chapter) as a peace envoy, renewing the offer and leading the characters to Araj if they accept it. Further exploration of the Underdark on their own might convince the adventurers to at least hear what Vizeran has to say. If they find the means to communicate his offer to their allies on the surface world, those allies encourage the characters to forge an alliance with the drow archmagc.

REACHING THE TOWER Vizeran's lower lies on the edge of the Wormwrithings, about ten days from Menzoberranzan. The map and directions the archmage provides the adventurers in chapter 11 allow them to find the cavern where the tower stands without getting lost. Use random encounters from chapter 13, "The Wormwrithings,” on the way to the tower. The final stretch to reach the tower is through a narrow passage off a side tunnel, concealed by a

160

CHAPTER 12 | THE TOWER OF VENGEANCE

magically protected secret door. If Vizeran’s map comes within 10 feet of the door, soft purple light outlines the word "Araj” a drow word for “vengeance”— across its surface in spidery Elvish script. Touching the map to the door causes it to open for 1 minute or until the map is more than 100 feet away from it. If the characters travel with Vizeran, the secret door opens on his command. The adventurers can travel to Araj with the full complement of their expeditionary force. Vizeran allows only the player characters within the tower, though the cavern around it offers space to camp and no risk of encounters. However, if the characters are riding giant lizards or other mounts, those mounts are unable to navigate the narrow route to the tower, and a separate camp farther from the tower will need to be establishedThe passage behind the secret door is narrow enough that you need to move through it single file, occasionally turning sideways to squeeze. It takes about an hour to navigate its pitch-black darkness, and the journey is filled with a constant echo of distant sounds. The passage then widens, opening out into a cavern whose far walls and ceiling are out of sight in the darkness. Bits of quartz and mica in the stone glimmer as they catch the light, showing a footpath worn into the stone floor. At the end of that path, a vast, dark shape rises—an enormous stalagmite carved into a bleak, black tower.

ARAJ: VIZERAN’S TOWER Vizeran’s tower is a enormous stalagmite, carved with a spiraling series of chambers leading up to its peak. The center of the stone spike is hollowed out to form an open vertical shaft. A stone staircase spirals around the shaft, with landings leading to chambers on the upper levels: Level 1 has a broad antechamber and audience hall. Level 2 contains kitchens, storage, and currently disused servants’ quarters. Level 3 houses guest bedchambers and a torture chamber for “special guests.” Level 4 contains Vizeran's library and laboratory. Level 5 contains the archmage’s private chambers. Level 6 is Vizeran's sanctum at the tower’s peak, where he spends his time in contemplation and study. The sanctum features a permanent teleportation circle that Vizeran can use to return to his home if his need is great. (He uses it only as a last resort, however, given the risks involved in teleporting in the Underdark; see “Faerzress” in chapter 2.) Vizeran doesn't reveal this circle’s existence to outsiders unless absolutely necessary, and he never gives away its sigil sequence. MEETING

WITH

VIZER AN

Assuming the adventurers arrive as Vizeran's guests, they find the door to the tower open to them. If they arrive under other circumstances, see “Stealing into Araj" at the end of this chapter. Past the heavy iron door that is the tower’s only visible entrance, a short tunnel extends through five feet of solid rock into a cool, dark chamber. As you enter, a floating orb of pale violet light brightens before you, revealing an opening in the vaulted ceiling and a spiral stone staircase with no railing, climbing up into darkness. Around the stairs, the light reveals a circular audience chamber with cold, unlit lanterns hanging from brackets set into the stone wall, heavy carpets covering the smooth stone floor, and a throne-like stone chair on a raised dais to the left of the entrance. The ball of violet light floats to a stop beneath the center of the open shaft, beyond the foot of the stairs. It then hovers there as if waiting for you.

The orb of magical light attempts to guide the characters up the shaft to Vizeran's sanctum at the top of the tower. Characters can climb the stairs if they wish, but any creature that steps past the stairs and into the open shaft activates a magical levitation effect imbued into the shaft (see the “Vizeran’s Tower: General Features” sidebar). If the adventurers arrive in Vizeran’s company, he informs them of the command words for the levitation effect.

as House DeVir was wiped out not long thereafter by its rival, House Do'Urden. Consigned to solitude in the Underdark, Vizeran didn’t perish as most assumed he would. Instead, he put his arcane powers to work to create a safe haven for himself, and spent the following centuries in isolated study, furthering his mastery of the magical arts. He has watched from afar as countless events unfolded in the Underdark and across Faerun, gathering information and making plans for his eventual return. After waiting for centuries, Vizeran now believes that time has come. Vizeran harbors a thirst for vengeance against his only living rival—Gromph Baenre, the drow Archmage of Menzoberranzan. As a follower of the Elder Elemental Eye, Vizeran also despises Lolth and her influence over the drow. He would like nothing more than to show up Gromph and prove to the drow that Lolth has used them for her own gain. Of course, he also wants to learn whatever arcane secrets have allowed Gromph to tap into magic powerful enough to summon the demon lords to the Underdark. Vizeran makes a powerful but dangerous ally. His plans and goals are entirely self serving, and he will sacrifice the characters without hesitation to further his schemes. Moreover. Vizeran isn’t as immune as he believes to the demonic madness growing in the Underdark, which has been feeding his megalomania and his thirst for vengeance against his fellow drow. Vizeran is an archmage with the following statistical modifications: • Vizeran’s alignment is neutral evil. • Vizeran’s fey ancestry gives him advantage on saving throws against being charmed, and magic can't put him to sleep. • Vizeran can innately cast the following spells, requiring no material components: dancing lights at will. darkness once per day. faerie fire once per day (spell save DC 15), and levitate (self only) once per day. • While in sunlight, Vizeran has disadvantage on attack rolls, as well as on Wisdom (Perception) checks that rely on sight. KLEVE

Vizeran holds the control gem of a death slaad he calls “Kleve." The slaad serves as the archmage's bodyguard, and is close by at all times. Kleve can change its form to appear as any Small or Medium humanoid, sometimes taking on the appearance of a deep gnome servant or a drow assistant to Vizeran if it wants to blend in. It can also cast invisibility to observe silently from hiding, and relies on its true form when it wants to intimidate other creatures. Although cruel by nature, Kleve takes no action to harm anyone without Vizeran’s permission. Kleve’s control gem is a smoky crystal that Vizeran wears on a chain around his neck, beneath his robes.

VIZERAN DEVIR

Vizeran DeVir is one of the greatest magical talents produced by the drow city of Menzoberranzan. Unfortunately for him, his rise to power came at the same time as one of the other great arcane talents of the City of Spiders, Gromph Bacnrc. A scion of the First House and as gifted a schemer as he is a mage, Gromph engineered Vizeran’s disgrace and exile as an unbeliever in Lolth. Ironically, this might have saved Vizeran's life, CHAPTER 12 I THE TOWER OF VENGEANCE

l6l

As long as Vizeran possesses the gem. the death slaatl must obey him and can't be charmed. G RIN O USSTYL

The only other person in Araj is Grin Ousstyl, Vizeran’s drow mage apprentice. A clever troublemaker from an out-of-favor house, Grin worked his way into the outlawed alliance of draw mages known as Lhe Council of Spiders, but was careless and nearly executed for his ambition. Exiled from Menzoberranzan, he was taken in by Vizeran, who plays the role of a shadowy patron of the council. The young drow has continued his magical training under the archmage’s tutelage. Grin is loyal to his master but not well suited to such a solitary existence, fie longs for the opportunity to return to Menzoberranzan. supporting the notion of an uprising to overthrow the matron mothers and end their rule. He is less enthused about the potential of turning his old home into a battlefield for the demon lords, however, and he eventually betrays Vizeran’s confidence

to the adventurers in an effort to prevent that outcome (see chapter 15, "‘The City of Spiders”). O T H E R I N H A B I T AN T S

No other living creatures dwell in Araj, but the tower features a number of magical inhabitants the adventurers might interact with. Each level of the tower has a permanent unseen servant in effect to attend to Vizeran, Grin, and the archmage’s guests. Two dozen decorative suits of armor are also on display throughout the tower, all of which are suits of animated armor that move and fight at Vizeran’s command. Between one and three suits guard each room and corridor of the tower. If Vizeran is threatened, he uses them to run interference, buying him time to escape or counterattack. A character who pokes around the tower and succeeds on a DC 15 Wisdom (Perception) check notes signs that other humanoid creatures were recently present in Araj including discarded clothing, moldering foodstuffs, and chains and manacles embedded into the walls in some of the tower’s rooms. Vizeran dismisses any questions about such matters, but Grin Ousstyl confides to the characters that Vizeran once kept bound minor demons and humanoid slaves in his service. Vizeran banished the demons with the arrival of the demon lords in the Underdark, fearing some hidden connection between the creatures of the Abyss. The slaves held by the drow archmage (most of them acquired from Gracklstugh) are all dead—cither lost to madness and killed by Vizeran, or sacrificed as part of the preparations for the archmage’s dark ritual. Grin Ousstyl doesn't speak directly of that latter fate, saying only that Vizeran’s work can be hard on his assistants.

V I Z E R A N ’ S T O W E R : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

The following features are found throughout the tower. Light. The cavern outside the tower is dark, for the inhabitants of Araj require no light. Inside the tower, occasional driftglobes shed dim light, with the rest of the place in darkness. Guards and Wards. The interior of the tower is under the effect of a permanent guards and u/ards spell to thwart intruders. Vizeran suspends the spell’s effects for his guests, allowing them to enter unhindered, but those trying to sneak into the tower must deal with the spell’s effects (see “Stealing into Araj”). Additionally, the tower is warded against scrying. Divination spells cast from outside cannot cross the tower's walls unless Vizeran allows it, and he immediately knows if the tower’s wards thwart a divination spell. Levitation Shaft. The central shaft of the tower has a permanent levitate spell in effect, such that any creature that steps into the shaft (or that falls off the stairs) is suspended in midair. A creature that speaks the command word atuhai'kafon (“descend”) drops 20 feet per round until it reaches the bottom of the shaft, I f the word kulam (“rise”) is spoken, a creature rises 20 feet per round until reaching the top level. Movement stops immediately if the creature says ilkalik (“halt”). While in the tower, Vizeran can deactivate or reactivate the levitation effect as an action.

CHAPTER 12 I THE TOWF.R OF VENGEANCE

lf>2

VIZERAN’S SCHEME

_____________

Vizeran DeVir invites guests to settle into his studywhile unseen servants bring trays of dried mushrooms, smoked rothe meat, and goblets of spicy liquor. The drow archmage takes a cup for himself and makes a point of drinking first, although he scoffs at any suggestion that he would try to poison his guests, given all the trouble he has taken to arrange their meeting. Within the safe haven of his tower, Vizeran continues the discussion he began with the characters back at Gravenhollow, speaking more on what he knows of the demon lords. “The only one of my kind who could ever match me in the Art is Cromph Baenre. I think we knew from the moment we met that we were destined to be rivals. But where I sought only to master the Art, Cromph was also an astute political manipulator. No more devout than I in the service of the Spider Queen, he arranged for my disgrace and exile. Deprived of my considerable skills, my house fell to our rival, House Do'Urden. Cromph became the Archmage of Menzoberranzan under the auspices of his own house, the First House of the Ruling Council. “Cromph and I only ever had two things in common: our passion for the Art, and our hatred of the manner in which our fellow mages suffer at the hands of the matron mothers and mistresses of the drow. Cromph has always hungered

• The demon lords of the Abyss—along with many of their lesser servants and legions—have been set loose in the Underdark following Gromph's ritual. • The presence of the demon lords is warping the fabric of the Underdark. The faerzress that permeates so much of the subterranean realm has become a conduit through which the insanity of the demon lords spreads. ■ Gromph Baenre vanished following the ritual. Vizeran has not been able to detect any trace of his rival archmage using any of the resources at his command. • Demogorgon. the Prince of Demons, arrived in the Claw Rift of Menzoberranzan and rampaged through the city before escaping into the wider Underdark. • The intended purpose of Gromph's ritual is unclear, but Vizeran believes that his rival meant to summon and bind one specific demon lord. Vizeran finds it difficult to believe that even Gromph could be arrogant enough to think he could bind all the demon lords of the Abyss at once. • The fact that the summoning originated in Menzoberranzan remains largely unknown. If the other races of the Underdark knew, they would have already moved against the drow. The dark elves almost certainly wish to keep this information a secret —assuming they even know it themselves. • Vizeran knows of no means by which Gromph Baenre’s ritual can be reversed. However, he believes there might be a different means of sending the demon lords back to the Abyss (see “Vizeran’s Plan”).

for power, and not even becoming Archmage of

WHAT VIZERAN WANTS

Menzoberranzan was enough to satisfy him.

Like any other sane creature, Vizeran has no wish to see the Underdark become home to the denizens of the Abyss. He points out that once the demon lords establish domains here, nothing will stop them from surging up to Facrun to spread their madness and chaos. Indeed, such an outcome is inevitable given enough time. Vizeran wants desperately to destroy his old rival. But even more so. the archmage dreams of thwarting Lolth and of having the Demon Queen of Spiders revealed to the drow as the treacherous creature she is. His deepest, burning desire is to watch Menzoberranzan destroyed by a demonic rampage. Then the ragged survivors of the drow will turn away from Lolth and her priestesses to seek Vizeran’s guidance, letting him take his rightful place as a wise leader among his people.

“From this tower of exile, I kept watch on Cromph's activities. This was no easy task given his suspicious and circumspect nature. Nonetheless, my observations revealed that he was crafting a unique ritual—one that somehow drew on the energy of faerzress to channel incalculable arcane power. When Cromph performed this ritual, the walls between the planes shuddered. Then, as you have by now realized, the demon lords were wrenched from their layers of the Abyss and cast about here in the Underdark. What we all witnessed in Gravenhollow confirms this.”

Vizeran answers questions from the characters as best he can, then makes his proposal. Use the points laid out in the following sections to play out the negotiations, utilizing whatever combination of ability checks and roleplaying you prefer. Vizeran is sincere in his willingness to help, even if his motives are entirely selfish. As such, he’s inclined to reach an accord with the characters.

WHAT VIZERAN OFFERS

Vizeran DeVir offers the adventurers his insight, his arcane power, and various magical resources that can help them deal with the demon lords. This includes the following benefits:

WHAT VIZERAN KNOWS

The characters can learn the following information from Vizeran by asking the right questions: he doles out information sparingly, but a successful DC 20 Wisdom (Insight) check might yield additional information if the archmage becomes cagey: • Lolth is behind the plot to bring the demon lords to the Underdark through her manipulation of Gromph Baenre. The Spider Queen is using the drow as pawns in her schemes to dispose of her demonic rivals and seize power in the Abyss. CHAPTER 12 I THE TOWER OP VENGEANCE

163

• Vizeran offers each character a drow piwafwi (see appendix B). • Each character will be provided with an amulet that can be used one time as a scroll of protection from fiends.

• Vizeran offers the use of Araj as a safe haven in the Underdark, as long as his alliance with the characters lasts. The archmage won't countenance an army being housed within his home, but he opens it to the adventurers and their allies as they need it. • Most important of all, Vizeran can offer a plan to defeat the demon lords—but he needs the adventurers’ help to make it happen (see “Vizeran’s Plan”). Vizeran is willing to negotiate other reasonable agreements, including tutoring wizards and providing them with opportunities to learn spells from his library. However, the archmage uses any such teaching opportunities to attempt to subtly corrupt his students. VIZERAN’S PLAN

At the first sign that the adventurers are open to working with him, the drow archmage explains his plan. "Demons are creatures ruled by madness and hatred, even the greatest and most powerful of them. They war ceaselessly upon each other in the Abyss, and have already begun to do so here. We can play them against each other, and then deal with the weakened victors. “I believe I have the ability to devise and cast a ritual, similar to Cromph’s but nowhere near as dangerous or foolish, that will draw the most powerful demon lords together to the site of the original summoning. Once they are brought together, they will try to destroy each other. But though the demon lords might destroy each other’s physical manifestations here in our world, their essence cannot be extinguished. They will thus be cast back into the Abyss, as effectively as if they had been banished. “The ritual needs certain components to produce the talisman that will draw the demons. Then a rite to empower and activate it. Then blood and battle such as this world has never seen. Any survivors among the demon lords will be sorely weakened, and should be far easier to destroy. “All I need are the necessary ingredients,” Vizeran says, “and, ideally, a look at Gromph’s grimoires and notes from his sanctum." Where the drow archmage watches you, a thin smile curls one corner of his mouth.

The characters can refuse Vizeran at any time, at which point the archmage tells them to leave his home and wishes them good luck surviving in a world dominated by the demon lords. He says he will find other means to deal with the problem on his own. If the adventurers are willing to ally with him, Vizeran further outlines his needs. He explains that the ritual is powered by a unique talisman he calls “the dark

heart.” The talisman's creation requires a number of unique components: • The intact and unhatched egg of a purple worm, for channeling great physical power. • The central eye of a beholder, to break down magical resistance and overcome magical forces. • Six feathers from six different angels—the authority of the celestial realms and a force to enrage fiendish creatures. • The heart of a goristro, to reach and influence the hearts of other demons. • Thirteen timmasks, also known as “devil’s mushrooms,” sprouted from the footprint of a marilith, a balor. or a goristro—a lure to draw demons in. • A few drops of blood or ichor from a demon lord, to connect with the demons the ritual will call. • Gromph Bacnre’s grimoires and notes on his ritual, to assist in better understanding the power that summoned the demon lords. In his research. Vizeran has located potential sources for all these components, and he can direct the characters to retrieve them as detailed in subsequent chapters. The purple worm egg and the eye of the beholder can be found in the Wormwrithings (see chapter 13). The angel feathers and the demon heart can be claimed in the Labyrinth (see chapter 14). The grimoire is found in Menzoberranzan, the City of Spiders (see chapter 15). Being able to acquire the timmask mushrooms and blood from a demon lord depends on the adventurers’ resourcefulness and on the opportunities found in other chapters of the adventure. You can modify the components list if you wish, using the encounters in chapters 13 through 15 as guidelines and opportunities. Additional encounters can easily be inserted into chapters 13 and 14 for any other elements you want to add to the ritual. Vizeran provides the means for the adventurers and their allies to gather the components for the talisman and encourages them to get started immediately. See chapters 13 through 15 for the sources Vizeran has found, then chapters 16 and 17 for the endgame battles against the demon lords. VICTORY

WITHOUT

VIZERAN

It is up to you whether or not the adventurers can succeed against the demon lords without Vizeran's aid. They might be able to implement his plan on their own, particularly once he has supplied them with the necessary components and information. The dark heart talisman to be crafted for the ritual (see chapter 15) can be placed anywhere to draw the demons to it. Likewise, the ritual can be performed in any location in the Underdark imbued with faerzress. Vizeran has kept this information from the adventurers only because he sees the ritual as his chance to destroy Menzoberranzan and take his revenge on the drow who cast him out. A player character spellcaster might be able to reproduce Vizeran’s work to create and perform the ritual, setting up the scenario in chapter 17, "Against the Demon Lords." Regardless of how the plan unfolds. though, the adventurers should get the opportunity to choose what they’ll do about Vizeran when they learn that the drow archmage has not been entirely truthful with them. See chapter 15, “The City of Spiders,” for details.

STEALING

INTO

AR AJ

If the characters don't take warmly to Vizeran's initial offer, they might want to enter Araj covertly instead of at the archmagc's invitation. Likewise, once they realize that they are being used by Vizeran to advance his plan to destroy Menzoberranzan, the characters might decide to steal the archmage’s secrets and resources to use against the demon lords—or even to slay him just for the sake of looting the place. W ARDS

Getting to the tower undetected is all but impossible. Vizeran knows whenever the secret door accessing the passage to Araj opens, by way of a permanent magical effect similar to a powerful alarm spell. Intruders also have to deal with the guards and wards spell active within the tower, which places arcane lock spells on all the doors and sets web spells across the central shaft and stairways. Doors within the Tower of Vengeance (including the main door) have AC 16, 25 hit points, a damage threshold of 5, resistance to thunder damage, and immunity to poison and psychic damage. A magic mouth spell at the entrance to the tower activates when intruders try to open the door, shouting: “You dare to enter here unbidden? Flee for your lives now. while you still can!” Another magic mouth placed outside Vizeran’s sanctum repeatedly calls out: "Intruders! Beware!" when any intruder approaches within 20 feet of the sanctum door. The tower's twenty-four suits of animated armor attack anyone who enters Araj without Vizeran’s permission, and continue attacking until they are destroyed or he calls them off. At the first sign of trouble, the death slaad Kleve stalks intruders invisibly and attempts to attack with surprise. If Kleve is reduced to half its hit points, it retreats to its master’s side. Vizeran casts his protective spells before entering combat, along with invisibility (renewing the death slaad’s invisibility as well if he has time). As a last-ditch escape, Vizeran casts time stop and uses the opportunity to flee or make a risky teleport attempt to a bolt-hole shelter he has hidden in another Underdark location of your choice. In the event the characters have the opportunity to loot Araj. they find the items listed under “What Vizeran Offers." along with other treasure suitable for a foe of the archmage’s power. See chapter 7, “Treasure.” of the Dungeon Master's Guide for guidelines on creating Vizeran’s treasury, keeping in mind that the wily drow has likely trapped his most powerful magic items. If he survives and escapes. Vizeran adds those who dare to threaten him and loot his home to the list of people who will suffer his revenge.

CHAPTER 12 I THE TOWER OF VENGEANCE

165

Two of the components that Vizeran needs to craft the talisman for his ritual (see chapter 12) can be found relatively close to the archmage's tower. The

The nearest purple worm nesting area mapped out for the characters by Vizeran DeVir lies forty-eight miles west of the archmage’s tower. The Vast Oblivium lies some

CHAPTER 13: THE WORMWRITHINGS THE WORM TUNNELS Wormwrithings are a honeycomb of tunnels spanning hundreds of miles in the northern reaches of the Underdark, carved from the rock by enormous purple worms. A purple worm nest in the Wormwrithings is an ideal place to find an unhatched purple worm egg. Additionally, Vizeran has heard rumors of a beholder living in the Vast Oblivium, a chasm deep within the Wormwrithings. If the characters didn’t obtain the central eye from Lorthuun or Xazax (the beholders in chapter 9), they can search the Vast Oblivium for the beholder believed to lair there.

twelve miles south of this nursery. Use the guidelines in chapters 2 and 10 as the party travels through the Underdark, but use the Wormwrithings Encounters table instead of the random encounter tables in chapter 2. Foraging is more difficult in the Wormwrithings, requiring successful DC 20 Wisdom (Survival) checks. Faerzress permeates only the fringes of the Wormwrithings. While the party explores this region of the Underdark, spellcasters won’t have to deal with the effects described under “Faerzress" in chapter 2.

The tunnels created by the purple worms are tubular and roughly 10 feet in diameter. A typical stretch of tunnel is ld6 miles long before it intersects with another tunnel or a naturally formed cavern. RANDOM ENCOUNTERS

As the characters explore the Wormwrithings, check for a random encounter once per day. Roll a d20 and consult the Wormwrithings Encounters table to determine what, if anything, the characters and their expeditionary force encounter. When an encounter occurs, roll a d6 to determine how the area is illuminated. A roll of 1 indicates the area is dimly lit by phosphorescent lichen, while a 26 indicates the area is dark. The twisting tunnels of the Wormwrithings give creatures the opportunity to surprise the characters (see “Noticing Threats” in chapter 2). WORMWRITHINGS ENCOUNTERS d20 1-10

Encounter

11

No encounter 1 drider

12 13

Drow hunting party 3d6 dwarf commoners

14 15 16

ld6 ettins 3d6 flumphs Grick nest

17 18 19

1 purple worm 2d 6 troglodytes ld4 trolls 1 umber hulk

20

ETTINS

These ettins used to be orogs until the faerzress and the corrupting influence of Demogorgon transformed them into two-headed giants. Their transformation can't be undone. They are starving and attack the party on sight. FLUMPHS

A cloister of flumphs floats through the tunnels. These peaceful creatures have been disturbed by the powerful thoughts of the demon lords. They warn the characters that these evil thoughts have polluted the Underdark, and that kindness is the only response to such evil. GRICK NEST

The characters stumble upon a naturally formed cyst in a tunnel wall. A grick alpha and 2d4 gricks are using the cyst as a nest, attacking anything that passes by. Treasure. The walls of the cyst have precious crystals growing out of them. Characters can harvest these crystals, collecting 3d6 intact crystals worth 50 gp each. PURPLE WORM

Roll a d6 and consult the Purple Worm Direction table to determine where the purple worm comes from. PURPLE WORM DIRECTION

d6 Direction 1-2 The purple worm comes from behind the party, heading in the same direction and filling the entire tunnel. The party must either stay ahead of the worm or turn and fight it. If they stay ahead of the worm, the tunnel branches after ldfi miles.

3-

4 The purple worm is moving along the tunnel in the opposite direction as the party and appears in front of them. The party must either reverse course or fight the worm. If they reverse course, the tunnel branches after ld6 miles.

5-

6 The purple worm is burrowing through the solid rock on a path that intersects with the party’s tunnel. The worm erupts from the tunnel wall behind the party, then continues on its way, leaving a new tunnel in its wake. The worm’s passage triggers a rockfall in the party’s tunnel, and each party member must succeed on a DC 13 Dexterity saving throw or take 10 (3d6) bludgeoning damage from falling debris.

D RIDER

This creature clings to the ceiling and prefers to make ranged attacks against the party. There is a 25 percent chance that the drider can cast spells (use the spellcasting variant in the Monster Manual). The drider flees if reduced to 30 or fewer hit points. DROW HUNT ING PARTY

A drow mage of House Melarn leads a group of ld6 drow and 2d6 bugbear slaves through the tunnels in search of a purple worm nursery, where they hope to find a purple worm egg as a gift for their matron mother. If the characters have an egg clearly in their possession, the drow party tries to take it. Otherwise, the drow mage is happy to let the characters and their expeditionary force pass by unchallenged. D W AR F C O M M O N E R S

There is a 75 percent chance that these shield dwarves are prospectors from Mithral Hall, hunting for precious stones and minerals. Otherwise, they are refugees who became lost in the Underdark after ores attacked their stronghold and chased them underground. These dwarves are searching for a route to the surface. Treasure. Each dwarf carries 1 d 10 pounds of food, ld4 gallons of water (stored in canteens), and ld6 gems worth 10 gp each.

TROGLODYTES

These troglodytes are heading toward their lair (see “Troglodyte Lair") and attack any other creatures they come across. TROLLS

These ravenous, insane trolls attack the party on sight. UMBER HULK

This creature is hidden behind a wall and uses its tremorsense to detect passing prey, bursting out of a nearby wall to attack the nearest party member. Randomly determine who is attacked, taking into account any NPCs traveling with the characters. CHAPTER 13 I THE WORMWRITHINGS /

167

TROGLODYTE LAIR

Approximately half way between Araj and the worm nursery, the characters' route is blocked by a looming battle between two factions of a troglodyte tribe. A foul stench and a cacophony of faint, hissing voices rises from ahead. The tunnel plunges sharply downward into a vast, open cavern dimly lit by luminous fungi and bisected by an underground stream. Tall reptilian humanoids stand on either side of the stream, waving makeshift weapons and howling threats at each other in a hissing language. The group of creatures closest to you has a captive lashed between two stalagmites atop a low rise in the cavern floor. That floor is some twenty feet below you, down a steep but navigable tunnel whose walls are piled high with rubble. The creatures are preoccupied with their conflict and haven't noticed you yet.

The reptilian humanoids are troglodytes that worship a lesser god called Laogzed—a reptilian horror that dwells in the Abyss. Although Laogzed isn’t a demon lord (and so has not been summoned to the Underdark), troglodytes are being drawn across the Underdark to sites where the demon lords have manifested. Any character who understands the troglodytes quickly learns what drives the conflict. Otherwise, a successful DC 13 Wisdom (Insight) check can provide a general sense of what's going on. The troglodytes ambushed and killed a drow scouting party whose leader wielded a magic sword that S'slaar, the troglodyte chieftain, claimed as a trophy. However, S’slaar's war marshal, H'slaat, was the one who killed the drow leader, and who now claims the right to wield the blade. The disagreement blossomed into a full-fledged conflict, and the other troglodytes quickly chose sides. On one side of the stream, troglodytes loyal to H'slaat seized S’slaar’s mate and are threatening her, hoping to force the chieftain to back down. On his side of the stream, S'slaar is wildly swinging the magic sword and screaming, as the troglodytes loyal to him shout insults and taunts at the other side. The characters can turn back without being spotted and find an alternate route bypassing the troglodytes, but doing so adds forty-eight miles (and an increased chance of random encounters) to the distance they must travel before they reach the purple worm nursery. If the characters simply watch the standoff unfold, see “Resolving the Standoff" later in this section. L ENTRANCE TUNNEL

The worm tunnel the adventurers are traveling through opens up atop a steep slope leading 15 feet down into the open cavern. The slope is difficult terrain. As long as the adventurers aren’t calling attention to themselves, they can remain undetected here indefinitely. The troglodytes are too distracted by their CHAPTER 13 I THE WORMWRtTHtNGS

168

standoff to notice them. Rubble is piled up along the walls on either side of the tunnel. The rubble on the east side of the tunnel conceals a hidden passageway. Any character with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 15 or higher notices the hidden passage. Anyone actively searching the rubble finds it with a successful DC 10 Wisdom (Perception) check. Adventurers who head into the passage beyond the rubble discover the hidden entry way to area 5 at the end of the tunnel.

2. C AVE F LOOR

H’slaat, a troglodyte champion of Laogzed (see appendix C), and twenty-two troglodytes are arrayed in a rough battle line along the south bank of a freshwater stream that nearly bisects the cavern. The stream runs west to east, tumbling down a short waterfall and forming a small pool (area 9). The stream is about 15 feet wide and 3 feet deep at its deepest point. It can be crossed on foot but is difficult terrain. The troglodytes are so distracted that it’s possible to sneak through this area undetected as long as the adventurers stay close to the cavern walls. Each character must succeed on a DC 10 Dexterity (Stealth) check or be noticed by the troglodytes. DEVELOPMENT

Any wounded creature entering the stream attracts the swarm of quippers from area 11.

3. R ISE

This upthrust section of the cavern floor is edged by a steep slope to the southwest and a 6-foot-high cliff elsewhere. The cliff requires a successful DC 11 Strength (Athletics) check to climb. Five troglodytes loyal to H'slaat are stationed here. In addition to their regular attacks, they are armed with javelins that they throw from a pile of twenty-five javelins on the cavern floor near them. Javelin. Melee or Ranged Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, reach 5 ft. or range 30/120 ft., one target. Hit: 3 (ld6) piercing damage.

H'hoort, a troglodyte and Chieftain S’slaar’s mate, is lashed between two stalagmites here. Another troglodyte stands guard next to her. Releasing H’hoort won't earn the adventurers a respite from the opportunistic troglodytes, but if the characters hold her captive, both sides are reluctant to attack them.

4. B ASIN The area north of the stream is dominated by a 5-footdeep basin. A 10-foot-wide furrow on the east side of the basin slopes down toward area 9. The troglodyte chieftain has arrayed his forces along the narrow strip of high ground between the basin and the stream. Chieftain S'slaar is a troglodyte with 20 hit points and a +2 longsword. While he wields the sword, S’slaar gains the following action option:

+2 Longsword. Ranged Weapon Attack: +6 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target. Hit: 8 (ld8 + 4) slashing damage, or 9 (1 dl0 + 4) slashing damage if used with two

hands.

S'slaar is accompanied by five troglodytes with 20 hit points each and three ordinary troglodytes. TREASURE S’slaar’s +2 longsword is of drow manufacture (see the

“Drowcraft Items” sidebar in appendix B). It has a cross guard shaped like a stylized spider with tiny gems for eyes. Etched into its blade are the words Oloth tlu malla. which is a drow expression meaning "Darkness be praised.”

5. S UPPLIES

AND C APTIVES This area is held by H’slaat’s forces. One troglodyte guards the cave. A character can sneak past the guard with a successful DC 12 Dexterity (Stealth) check. The cave floor is strewn with gnawed bones—the remains of dead dwarves and drow. A circular pit, nine feet deep, holds six captives—two drow and four shield dwarf commoners. These unfortunates were separated from larger groups (see “Random Encounters” earlier in this chapter) and captured by the troglodytes. Every couple of days, one of them is eaten

by the tribe. The captives are filthy and weak; each has four levels of exhaustion and 1 hit point remaining. Any of the captives can explain the nature of the conflict between H'slaat and S’slaar. If freed, the drow immediately flee into the Underdark, but the dwarves offer to join the expeditionary force if the adventurers liberate them. The drow are male members of House Melarn and are named Rinil and Xol. The shield dwarves hail from the Silver Marches and are named Dauthorn Brightmantle (male), Traldak Xornbane T R O G L O D Y T E L A I R : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

Characters notice commonly recurring features as they explore the troglodyte lair. Light. Nightlights (see "Fungi of the Underdark" in chapter 2) and other luminous fungi dimly illuminate the caves and tunnels throughout the troglodyte lair. Ceilings. The main cavern has a 90-foot-high ceiling. Smaller side caverns have 60-foot-high ceilings. Unless noted otherwise, all ceilings have stalactites hanging from them. Stench. The troglodytes’ foul musk can be smelled throughout the lair, although the stench is not strong enough to have any detrimental effect on visitors.

CHAPTER 13 I THE WORMWRITHINGS

169

(male), Zulia Stonewhisper (female), and Hargritt Hammerhome (female). Rubble is piled up along the south wall of Lhe cavern, concealing a hidden passageway to area 1. Anyone with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 15 or higher notices the passage. Anyone actively searching the rubble must succeed on a DC 10 Wisdom (Perception) check to find it. TREASURE

Within the cave, four zurkhwood boxes hold a 50-foot length of spider-silk rope, four flasks of oil. twenty pounds of rancid food, a pile of moldy blankets, six maces and sixteen javelins (all battered but usable), four casks of unspoiled wine worth 10 gp each, and a locked tribute chest. It takes a successful DC 15 Dexterity check using thieves' tools to open the chest, which contains 180 gp (minted in Menzoberranzan and Gracklstugh), three gems each worth 50 gp each, a potion of gaseous form, and a +1 dagger with silvery, weblike filigree worked into the hilt. The dagger is of drow manufacture (see the “Drowcraft Items” sidebar in appendix B). The crude litters that the troglodytes use to bear these goods arc propped up against the cave wall.

6. S TEAM V ENT _______________________ A thick jet of hot steam spews forth from a crack in the door near the east wall of this cavern. Growing around the steam vent is a patch of fire lichen (see ‘'Fungi of the Underdark" in chapter 2). Anyone with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 13 or higher notices a vein of precious gems embedded in the rock wall behind the steam vent. Anyone actively searching the cavern spots the gem deposit automatically. The gems can't be reached without entering a 10-foot-by-10-foot-by-l0-foot cloud of hot steam. Any creature that enters the area or starts its turn there takes ld8 fire damage. The litters in area 5 or a similar object can be used to block the steam emerging from the vent for 1 round before weakening and falling apart. TREASURE

For each round spent digging at the wall, a character has a 10 percent chance of extracting a gemstone worth 100 gp. The chance increases to 20 percent if the character has a mining background and a miner’s pick. After ten such gems are extracted, the deposit is depleted. For each round that any number of characters dig at the wall, there is a 10 percent cumulative chance that the sound attracts the attention of any troglodytes remaining in areas 5 or 7.

7. T ROGLODYTE O UTPOST ______________ H'Slaat stationed four troglodytes here to watch for any of S’Slaar’s forces that might try to make their way into attack position through the outer caverns. These guards are always on alert. One of them carries a horn that it sounds in the event of an attack. If the horn is blown, eight of the troglodytes in area 2 come through area 5

170

CHAPTER 13

I THE WOKA1WRTTHINGS

and into this cave to investigate and shore up the defenses. 8. R OPER L AIR ________________________ This small cavern is filled with stalactites and stalagmites, making the cave floor difficult terrain. No phosphorescent lichen grows here, so the cave is dark. Two of the stalagmites are ropers, while four of Lhe stalactites are piercers (the ropers' offspring). While lying in wait, the creatures are virtually undetectable. Any party memher with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 20 or higher notices something unusual about the rock formations in the cave. Unless they are recognized, the ropers and piercers surprise anyone entering the area. TREASURE

Searching the cave reveals the remains of a half-eaten male drow lying against one wall. The drow carries a small pouch containing 30 gp and two spell scrolls (shield and phantasmal force) written on sheets of trillimac (see "Fungi of the Underdark” in chapter 2). If the ropers are killed and cut open, the adventurers hnd 25 pp in the gizzard of one. and a ring of protection in the gizzard of the other.

9. S UNKEN P OOL ______________________ Water from the stream pours into this 15-foot-deep grotto, forming a 10-foot-deep pool with a narrow crack in the bottom. The pool’s water is safe to drink, and growing around the pool’s edge are 3d6 waterorbs (see “Fungi of the Underdark” in chapter 2).

10. R UINS

This large cavern is strewn with zurkhwood beams— enough to make a raft. An old bridge made of moldy zurkhwood planks spans an underground stream in one of the tunnels to Lhe north.

11. S PAWNING P OOL ___________________ The underground stream passes through this cave, traveling west to east. The adventurers can hear something splashing in the water as soon as they enter this area. Any character who enters the stream is immediately attacked by the swarm of quippers that has spawned here.

12. G EOTHERMIC VENTS The adventurers feel the heal emanating from this area as they approach. Thick cracks, some as wide as 2 feet, crisscross the cavern floor, opening up to a pool of molten rock 25 feet beneath the cavern. The dull orange glow of the lava below bathes this area in dim light. At the end of every minute the adventurers spend here, roll a d6. On a roll of 1. Id4 magma mephits emerge from a crack in the floor and attack. No more than twelve mephits appear in a given 24-hour period.

13. E MPTY C AVE

Rocks and small boulders are piled up along the north wall of this otherwise empty cave. The rubble conceals a passageway to area 14, buried during a rockslide.

Anyone with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 15

CHAPTER 13 I THE WORMWRITHINGS

171

or higher notices the hidden passage. Anyone actively searching the rubble must succeed on a DC 10 Wisdom (Perception) check to find it.

14.

RALLY P OINT _______________________ S'slaar's cavalry troops are gathered in this cavern, waiting for their master's order to attack. Six troglodytes arc mounted on six giant lizards. Rocks and small boulders are piled up along the south wall. The rubble conceals a tunnel to area 13. Anyone with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 15 or higher notices the hidden passage. Anyone actively searching the rubble must succeed on a DC 10 Wisdom (Perception) check to find it. DEVELOPMENT

When the order comes to attack, S'slaar's cavalry bursts through the hidden passageway on the south wall of the cave (see "Resolving the Standoff").

15. E XIT T UNNEL This purple worm tunnel leads back into the Wormwrithings. Unless they're being pursued, the characters can safely leave the troglodytes behind when they reach this area.

R ESOLVING

THE S TANDOFF H'slaat orders his followers to commence their attack 20 minutes after the characters arrive at area 1. Unless the characters intervene, the conflict plays out as follows: • H'slaat orders his fellow troglodytes in area 2 to rush across the stream while the troglodytes in area 3 rain javelins down on the chieftain's forces. Meanwhile, H’Slaat grabs H'hoort from area 3. • H’slaat crosses the stream, dragging her behind him. He threatens to kill her unless the chieftain meets him in battle. • The troglodytes in areas 5 and 7 try to make their way through the side caverns to attack the chieftain's forces in area 4 from the rear. However, if the ropers and piercers in area 8 have not already been killed by the adventurers, the troglodytes are surprised and massacred. • S’slaar's cavalry in area 14 makes its way through the western side caves and altack H'slaat's forces from behind. If the adventurers don’t intervene in any way, the battle lasts approximately 20 rounds and ends when H'slaat kills the chieftain in the basin at area 4. Half the troglodytes on both sides are killed in the conflict. Those who remain accept H’slaat as their new chieftain. While the battle is underway, a character can sneak through an area occupied by troglodytes with a successful DC 10 Dexterity (Stealth) check. As tense as the standoff between H'slaat and S’slaar might be. the troglodytes quickly forget their conflict and unite against common threats, such as the characters and their unwelcome expeditionary force.

adventurers can continue on toward the purple worm nursery. However, within six miles of the nursery they come across an unexpected presence in the darkness. The remnants of a rockfall have opened up a small vaulted cavern along the passageway. Apart from the occasional glowing insect scuttling along the walls, the cavern is dark. Suddenly, a loud voice booms out all around you in Undercommon: “Turn back or suffer a death so horrible you cannot imagine! You have been warned!"

The voice is actually a minor illusion cantrip, ff no one in the party understands Undercommon, the dire warning is just loud gibberish to them. The cantrip was cast by Hanne Hallen. a young drow allied with House Mizzrym. Hanne has the statistics of a drow. with the following modifications: • Hanne's AC is 12, or 15 with mage armor. She doesn't wear a chain shirt. • Her Intelligence is 17 (+3). • Add Arcana +5 and Investigation +5 to her skills. • Add Common to her list of known languages. Hanne also has the following Spellcasting feature: Spellcasting. Hanne is a fst-level spellcaster. Her spellcasting ability is

Intelligence (spell save DC 13. +5 to hit with spell attacks). She has the following wizard spells prepared: Cantrips (at will): minor illusion, ray of frost 1 st Level (2 slots): shield, mage armor

Hanne's mother, Zhora Hallen, leads the Dark Hunters —drow explorers who steal purple worm eggs. These eggs are prized by wizards, who use them in various arcane rituals. Hanne was on her first egg run with her mother's team when a passing purple worm burst into the tunnel they were traveling through, separating her from the rest of the group. Convinced that her mother and the rest of the Dark Hunters were killed by the purple worm, the headstrong and half- starved young mage-in-training is attempting to make her way back to Menzoberranzan. Hanne spotted the adventurers as they approached and tried to scare them away. She's hiding in the rubble along the cavern wall but can be spotted with a successful DC 15 Wisdom (Perception) check. If the adventurers decide to turn back, finding another tunnel going in the right direction adds twenty miles to their journey to the worm nursery. If they press ahead, the voice shouts in Undercommon again: “Fools! Flee now! This is your final warning!” Once the adventurers enter the cavern, Hanne can be spotted with a DC 10 Wisdom (Perception) check. If spotted. Hanne threatens the party with her “powerful magic," but drops her hostile attitude if offered food and water. She can be convinced to tell her story with a successful DC 12 Charisma (Persuasion) check.

VOICE IN THE DARK

After dealing with or avoiding the troglodytes, the CHAPTER 13 I THE WORMWRITHINGS 17!

If the characters attack Hanne, she fights to the best of her ability. If the adventurers are friendly toward her, Hanne is willing to travel with them for safety.

WORM NURSERY

As the characters near the nursery, they get a view of one of its guardians—and might take an unexpected fall. As you make your way through a long tunnel, everything around you begins to shake and rumble. Suddenly, the tunnel floor gives way at your feet.

The tunnel through which the characters travel is directly above area 1 of the nursery. The burrowing of a nearby purple worm weakens the tunnel floor, causing a 10-foot section of it to break apart and collapse. Any character in the area must make a successful DC 15 Dexterity saving throw or fall 25 feet into area 1 below.

1. E NTRY C AVERN

Any characters dropped into this dark cave have time to recover, while characters who avoided falling can anchor ropes to the edge of the tunnel floor above, then climb down into the cave. In any event, the characters hear more rumbling off in the distance.

2. F UNGUS C AVE

A variety of fungi blankets this dark, 15-foot-high cavern. Every 10 minutes spent foraging here yields ld3 pounds of edible fungi per forager (to a maximum of 30 pounds). W O R M N U R S E R Y : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

The characters encounter the following features in the purple worm nursery. Light. All tunnels and chambers are dark unless the text states otherwise. Purple Worm Tunnels. The tunnels marked Tl, T2, and T3 on the map do not exist when the characters first enter the nursery. They are created by purple worms after the party arrives, as noted here: ■ Fifteen minutes after the party enters area 1, a purple worm digs into area 1, then travels through area 3 and creates tunnel Tl to enter area 8. • Ten minutes after the first worm arrives, a second purple worm enters through the tunnel in area 7. It makes its way through the adjoining echo chamber, then into area 8. Then it digs tunnel T2 into the eastern echo chamber before exiting through the worm tunnel in area 14. • Fifteen minutes after the second worm arrives, another purple worm enters through the tunnel in area 7, digs tunnel T3 from the southern echo chamber into the eastern echo chamber, then exits through the worm tunnel in area 14. Visiting worms are heralded by a low rumbling sound 2 minutes before they appear. (The bats in area 9 also swarm and flee their roost 1 minute before a purple worm appears.) Purple worms ignore intruders except those in areas 5 or 8, but they won't pursue anyone fleeing from those areas.

The passage to area 3 is a steep slope leading 10 feet upward, and covered in small rocks and gravel. Moving up the slope requires a successful DC 12 Dexterity (Acrobatics) check. On a failed check, a character slips and tumbles down to the bottom of the slope, taking no damage. If someone at the top of the slope lowers a rope CHAPTER 13 | THE WORMWRITHINGS

to help other characters climb, no check is necessary.

3. O SSUARY This 30-foot-high chamber is dimly lit by luminescent lichen. Thousands of bones carpet the cavern floor, including many recognizable as humanoid (primarily dwarf, elf, and goblin) and some belonging to strange and unidentifiable creatures. Exactly where the bones came from is a mystery. A crack in the south wall leads to area 4. The tunnel marked Tl on the map doesn’t exist until a purple worm creates it fifteen minutes after the party discovers area 1 (see the “Worm Nursery: General Features" sidebar). Thus, the characters won’t be able to reach area 8 until the tunnel is formed.

4. C HASM This 30-foot-high unlit cavern has a twenty-foot-wide pit in its center, which descends a thousand feet. Thirty feet down is a small ledge holding the skeletal remains of a moon elf adventurer clad in moldering leather armor. Scaling the chasm walls without gear requires a successful DC 15 Strength (Athletics) check. TREASURE

The skeleton still wears a ring of free action on one bony finger.

5. E CHO C HAMBERS These three 60-foot-high caverns, hollowed out and expanded by purple worms, are set around area 8 as a defensive measure. Using their saliva, the worms have created thick, resinous strands that stretch from wall to wall. These strands are 2 feet thick and suspended some 50 feet above the floor. Any noise in one of these chambers (including a normal speaking voice or metal striking metal) causes the strands to reverberate, creating a loud humming that echoes throughout the surrounding caverns, alerting the purple worms to the presence of trespassers. DEVELOPMENT

If the adventurers set off a humming in one of these echo chambers, a distant rumbling can be heard and felt as a purple worm burrows toward the egg chamber, arriving there in ld4 minutes (see area 8 for details).

6. C ARETAKER ’ S Q UARTERS

Phosphorescent lichen clings to the walls of this 30-foothigh cavern. Stronk, a brutish fomorian. lairs here. Somehow the giant formed a bond with the purple worms, becoming a caretaker of their eggs. He regular!) checks the eggs, brushes fungus off them, and defends them against predators.

Stronk is sleeping on a pile of skins and loudly snoring when the adventurers arrive. Characters looking

around the room can see the remnants of the fomorian's grim meals—travelers lost in the Wormwrithings or egghunting adventurers. Venturing into Stronk’s lair without waking him requires a successful DC 12 Dexterity (Stealth) check. If awakened, the fomorian shouts out about “killing egg thieves" and “protecting my precious ones." then fights to defend the nesting area and protect the eggs. If Stronk is reduced to half his hit points or fewer, he charges into the adjoining echo chamber (area 5) and bellows to summon a purple worm before rejoining the battle. TREASURE

All the treasure Stronk has taken from his victims has been placed under his sleeping skins for safekeeping: 40 pp, an electrum brooch worth 120 gp. six gems worth 50 gp each, two potions of greater healing, and a book of drow poetry worth 100 gp.

7. E NTRY C HAMBER

This cavern rises to a height of 50 feet and contains many stalagmites and stalactites. A purple worm tunnel

leads out into the Wormwrithings through this area, but the tunnel’s mouth is 40 feet above the cavern door. Scaling the rock wall to reach the tunnel requires a

successful DC 15 Strength (Athletics) check. DEVELOPMENT

Zhora Hallen and her Dark Hunters enter the purple worm nursery by scaling down the rock wall here shortly after the adventurers arrive (see “Dark Hunters,” below). Characters can also leave the nursery and return to the Wormwrithings via this route.

8. E GG C HAMBER The ceiling of this cavern is 80 feet high. A pair of purple worms have laid their eggs here, cementing them together and anchoring them to the cavern walls with their resinous saliva. Seven clusters hold six eggs each, as noted on the map. Each egg is a silvery sphere 3 feet in diameter. Its shell is tough (AC 20), but an egg is destroyed if it takes any amount of damage. Two of the four resin strands anchoring the network of egg dusters to the cavern walls feature stray threads that drop all the way down to the cave floor. It’s possible to climb up to the strands at these points to reach the eggs. Traversing the strands is slow' going; each 1 foot

CHAPTER 13 I THE WORMWRITHINGS

CHAPTER 13 | THE WORMWRITHINGS

of distance costs 3 feet of movement. Anyone fighting or taking strenuous action atop a strand must succeed on a DC 10 Dexterity (Acrobatics) check to avoid falling off. An adventurer who reaches an egg cluster and has a suitable cutting tool (such as a dagger, sword, or axe) can carefully hack an egg out in 2d4 minutes. The upper reaches of the egg chamber are covered in webs spun by the giant spiders in area 11. Some of these webs reach all the way down to the. egg clusters. For every five minutes the adventurers spend in this room, check for a random encounter by rolling a d20 and consulting the Egg Chamber Encounters table. E cc

CHAMBER ENCOUNTERS

d20 Encounter 1-15 No encounter 16-18 1 giant spider from area 11 1920 Ipurpleworm

damage. DEVELOPMENT

When the purple worm that caused the bats to swarm exits the nursery, the bats return to this cave to roost 10 minutes later.

10. S LOP C AVE The floor of this dark. 60-foot-high cavern is covered in a thick layer of viscous purple worm saliva. Consequently, the floor is difficult terrain. As they enter, adventurers notice dozens of glinting objects in the goo beneath their feet. Further inspection reveals the sparkling objects are precious gems. For every minute the adventurers spend in this cave, there is a 25 percent chance they attract the attention of ld4 giant spiders from area 11. The spiders scuttle along the walls and ceiling, avoiding the gooey floor. TREASURE

The giant spider walks on the ceiling and surprises the adventurers unless someone in the party has a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 14 or higher. If a purple worm appears, it enters the nursery through the tunnel in area 7 and circles the outside of the cavern. Any party member in the egg chamber can try to hide with a successful DC 10 Dexterity (Stealth) check. A failed check means the party member attracts the worm's attention. The purple worm attacks anyone it detects in the chamber except the giant spiders from area 11 and the fomorian from area 6. It won't pursue fleeing characters anywhere except into the adjoining echo chambers (area 5) or the slop cave (area 10). If it doesn’t detect any intruders, the purple worm exits the complex through the tunnel in area 7, passing through the nearest echo chamber along the way.

9. B AT C AVE This cave is thick with stalactites and stalagmites, and home to thousands of bats. The cavern floor is covered in a thick layer of guano, making the floor difficult terrain. The bats spend most of their time clinging to the cavern's 60-foot-high ceiling, but the noise of the purple worms drives them into a shrieking, flapping frenzy. Whenever a purple worm enters the area 8 (whether as a random encounter or in response to an alarm from area 5, or as noted in the “Worm Nursery; General Features” sidebar), a swarm of bats flies out of the cave 1 minute before the worm appears. Roll a d6 to determine which way the bats go. On a roll of 1 3. the HANNE’S HELP

Educated by her mother, Hanne Hallen (see “Voice in the Dark”) knows quite a bit about purple worms. If she’s traveling with the characters, she realizes that they are in a worm nursery as soon as she enters area 8. She also recognizes the echo chambers (area 5) and understands their function, Hanne won't want to leave the nursery without an egg of her own. If necessary, she'll sneak away from the rest of the party to try to obtain one.

bats take the shortest route to the tunnel in area 7 and exit through that tunnel. On a roll of 4 6, the bats take the shortest route to the tunnel in area 14 and exit through that tunnel. The swarm doesn’t attack unless threatened, but any creature that occupies an area the swarrn passes through is buffeted by scores of baLs, taking ld4 bludgeoning

174

CHAPTER 13 I THE WORMWRITHINGS

If the adventurers take 10 minutes to search through the goo, they can retrieve a total of twenty 50 gp gems.

11. S PIDER N EST Giant spiders enjoy a symbiotic relationship with purple worms and are frequently found lairing in purple worm nurseries. The multitude of predators that seek out the worms' eggs provide the spiders with easy prey, while the presence of the spiders provides additional protection for the hatchery. The eastern half of this cavern floor is covered in webs stretching up to the ceiling. See “Dungeon Hazards” in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide for rules about webs. Eight giant spiders lurk in the nest, minus any killed elsewhere in the nursery.

12. C HASM A chasm cuts across this cavern, stretching from wall to wall. The chasm is 10 feet wide, 200 feet deep, and slopes down to the southwest at a sixty degree angle. The chasm’s slope can be climbed with a successful DC 15 Strength (Athletics) check. A creature that fails the check by 5 or more goes tumbling down the slop to the bottom of the chasm, taking damage from the fall as normal. TREASURE

At the bottom of the chasm lie the skeletons of two svirfneblin who tried to leap across the chasm while being chased by a purple worm. Lying near the remains are two miner’s picks and a small leather pouch containing a gem of brightness.

13. EXIT TUNNEL_________________ Characters can exit the worm nursery and return to the Wormwrithings via this purple worm tunnel.

THE DARK HUNTERS The Dark Hunters consist of Zhora Hallen (a drow elite warrior) and ten drow. Each carries adventuring equipment (bedroll, rope, a flask of oil), three days' worth of food and water rations, and 2d6 x 10 gp. Zhora and her comrades survived the purple worm attack that separated them from Hanne (see “Voice in the Dark"). Zhora believes that Hanne is dead. Twenty minutes after the characters first enter the purple worm nursery through area 1, Zhora and her Dark Hunters enter these caverns through the tunnel in area 7, then scale down to the cavern floor. They spend a few minutes regrouping and making their way through the southern echo chamber, then arrive in area 8 and scale the resin strands to grab two purple worm eggs. If they encounter the adventurers and Hanne isn’t present, the drow are hostile, though they might be convinced to enter a temporary truce with a successful DC 20 Charisma (Persuasion) check. If Hanne is with the party and has been well treated, she and her mother have a quiet reunion. Zhora gravely promises the adventurers that she will repay the debt she owes them however she can.

DEVELOPMENT_____________________ If the characters reunite Zhora and Hanne, this act of benevolence could lead to Zhora potentially aiding the adventurers in chapter 15, “The City of Spiders." See that chapter for details.

THE VAST OBLIVIUM Following Vizeran’s directions, the characters find the chasm known as the Vast Oblivium—the lair of the beholder Karazikar—twelve miles from the purple worm nursery. The beholder created the Vast Oblivium using its disintegration eye ray. This lair consists of a central chasm known as "Karazikar's Maw,” surrounded by ten vertical shafts. These are interconnected with horizontal tunnels resembling “spokes" and honeycombed with small caves used by the beholder's followers and slaves. A weh of rope bridges crisscrosses the maw. connecting passages on different levels. I N H A B I T AN T S

across, spanned by bridges made of gut and zurkhwood that are anchored to metal rings in the rock walls of the tunnel entrances. The tunnels are staggered so that the bridges cross over each other at different points. From any bridge, a character can climb or drop 10 feet to reach a bridge leading to a tunnel on an adjacent level. Chasm. The chasm of Karazikar's Maw extends some five hundred feet below the lowest bridged tunnels, plunging into darkness. A fall into the chasm deals 20d6 bludgeoning damage. Shafts. The ten vertical shafts around the perimeter of the chasm are each 30 feet wide and 100 feet from top to bottom. They're located 100 feet from the edge of the chasm and connected to it by tunnels. Each shaft features side chambers and small caverns, and has rope ladders for Karazikar’s slaves to move up and down them.

arcane device known as the Maze Engine, capable of shifting the gears or reality. During the last Great Modron March, Karazikar captured a pentadrone and afterward became convinced the Maze Engine existed in the Underdark. Unfortunately, the modron’s axiomatic mind couldn’t be broken, and it perished rather than reveal anything. Since then, the beholder has made it known that it's interested in certain “curiosities.” and it rewards anyone who brings it more modrons or hints about the existence or location of the Maze Engine (which is described in chapter 14). The beholder’s favorite slave is a human named Shedrak of the Eyes. As Karazikar’s "high priest.” he leads other slaves in worship of their master and carries out the beholder's commands. Formerly an adventurer from the surface world, Shedrak and his companions delved too deeply into the Wormwrithings. His companions became Karazikar’s playthings for a time, but Shedrak alone was able to resist and withstand all ten of the beholder’s eye rays. Impressed by this feat of extraordinary luck, Karazikar made the human his acolyte after breaking his mind and his will. Shedrak is completely mad, considers Karazikar a god, and brooks no defiance or disrespect toward his “divine master.” SHEDRAK OF THE EYES

SLAVES

One hundred slaves of various humanoid races serve the beholder. Some were captured while wandering too far from their Underdark settlements, while others were purchased in the slave bazaars of Menzoberranzan. The youngest slaves were born in the Vast Oblivium and raised here, knowing no other life. Many of the beholder's slaves worship it, particularly those born here, their minds warped by the aberration's charm rays and their lifelong captivity. All of the slaves fear Karazikar. and the notion of acting against the beholder seems impossible to them. However, witnessing the bravery of the adventurers has

Karazikar considers itself the master of all it surveys. The beholder doesn't live alone, though, keeping its lair well stocked with disposable servants. KARAZIKAR THE EYE TYRANT

Like most of its kind, this beholder is hateful and paranoid, trusting no one. Its servants are keenly aware that failure to please their master means death or petrification. Karazikar has goals beyond simply ruling over its domain. Long ago, the beholder heard rumors of an T H E V A S T O B L I V I U M : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

The characters encounter the following features in the aiien andscape of the Vast Oblivium. Light. The tunnels and chambers of the Vast Oblivium are dimly lit by glowing fungi and lichen. Bridges. The central chasm of Karazikar’s Maw is 100 feet CHAPTER 13

I THE WORMWRITHINGS

'75

a chance to sway them. If the characters demonstrate their willingness to challenge the beholder (including by killing Shedrak), surviving slaves can be convinced to aid them with a successful DC 16 Charisma (Persuasion) check. On a failed check, slaves either attack the characters or hide from them, waiting for Karazikar to deal with them. A R R I VAL When the characters come within a mile of the Vast Oblivium, they feel a growing sense of being watched. They catch glimpses of eyes peering out of the shadows. These eyes close and vanish when anyone tries to focus on them, and adventurers who search for signs of what caused them must succeed on a DC 11 Wisdom saving throw or gain one level of madness (see “Madness” in chapter 2). The characters' tunnel ends at the top of one of the exterior shafts of the Vast Oblivium (see “The Vast Oblivium: General Features" sidebar). Characters can use the rope ladders to reach the bottom of the shaft, and from there make their way to the chasm known as Karazikar’s Maw. W ELCOME TO K ARAZIKAR ’ S M AW

Shedrak meets visitors at the chasm, greeting them in the name of his master, the great Karazikar, and asking their business. Use the mage statistics to represent Shedrak. with the following modifications: • Shedrak is chaotic evil. • He has ten small eyes tattooed on his bald head that allow him to see invisible creatures and objects as if they were visible. • He carries a nonmagical staff topped with a varnished beholder eye. Karazikar can see through this eye and treats it as one of its own eyes for the purpose of using its eye rays. Breaking the staff renders the eye inert and prevents Karazikar from using this property. • He carries a potion of healing, a potion of poison, and a spell scroll of globe of invulnerability. As long as the adventurers are respectful toward Shedrak and his master—and particularly if they claim to carry messages or items of possible interest to the beholder—Shedrak agrees to lead them to Karazikar. If the characters become hostile, Shedrak orders them to depart, lest they provoke the wrath of his all-powerful master. If attacked, he uses his globe of invulnerability scroll, casts fly on himself, and flies into the chasm. Shedrak allows up to ten party members accompany him, demanding that the rest of the expeditionary force remain behind. Shedrak then leads the smaller group across a bridge into the middle of Karazikar’s Maw. Whether they’re escorted by Shedrak or make their own way into Karazikar’s Maw, the adventurers first encounter the beholder as they cross the chasm. The beholder descends from the shadowy ceiling, staying at least 20 feet away from the bridge. A UDIENCE WITH K ARAZIKAR

If the characters have come to talk, Karazikar hears them out. The beholder is supremely arrogant, and it speaks and understands only Deep Speech and Undercommon. If any of the characters bluff about having information of interest to the beholder. Karazikar mentions the Maze Engine, cither to see if the adventurers know of it. or in a scoffing tone to suggest they can't possibly know anything that it has not already learned. Killing Karazikar is the only way to claim the beholder's central eye for Vizeran. At the first hint of violence, the beholder uses its disintegration ray to disintegrate a 10-foot section of the bridge, hoping to plunge one of more party members into the chasm. It then targets enemies with its other eye rays and makes full use of its lair actions (see the Monster Manual). Against characters who attempt to hide from it, the beholder uses a lair action to cause an eye to open up on a wall with line of effect to a hiding creature, then attacks with one of its eye rays. Karazikar's slaves fearfully scatter during any confrontation, but if Shedrak is alive, he protects his “god" as best he can. If the beholder is reduced to 45 or fewer hit points, it attempts to flee, ordering Shedrak (if he's still alive) to cover its retreat. When the beholder is reduced to 0 hit points, its corpse slowly sinks, falling 10 feet at the start of every turn until it reaches the bottom of the chasm. A character within reach of the beholder can use an action to gouge out its central eye. There is also a 10 percent chance at the end of each turn that the beholder's corpse lands on a bridge. F REED S LAVES

If Karazikar and Shedrak are defeated, the beholder’s slaves emerge from various tunnels, file out onto the bridges, and kneel in supplication, worshiping their liberators as gods. Each slave bears the brand of Karazikar on its forehead a scar shaped like an open eye. The slaves are unarmed and include the following: • 21 shield dwarf commoners • 17 human commoners • 11 moon elf commoners • S female drow and 1 male drow • 5 deep gnomes • 23 goblins ■ 15orogs All of the slaves have four levels of exhaustion (see appendix A of the Player's Handbook) and can't do much more than cat and follow simple instructions. They join the party's expeditionary force if urged or ordered to do so. but they aren't effective combatants until they’ve rested and reduced their exhaustion level. The slaves know several intriguing bits of information: • Karazikar hid its treasure in the uppermost reaches of the chasm. The only way to reach the treasury is by levitation or flight. ■ The beholder was preoccupied with finding an arcane contraption called the Maze Engine. • The beholder recently captured a strange mechanical

creature that might know where the Maze Engine is LOST FRIENDS The liberation of the Vast Oblivium makes a useful bit of backstory for introducing or reintroducing a character into the party. If an adventurer or NPC was lost in the Underdark, or if you want an NPC left behind at a settlement to put in a reappearance, have that character appear as a slave taken by Karazikar. Depending on the circumstances, the character might even join up with the adventurers during the final battle to defeat the beholder. Similarly, a new player character joining the party might start out as a prisoner of the beholder, now freed.

located (see “Modron Prisoner" below). The creature is locked in a room sealed with a rolling stone door. The beholder used its telekinesis eye ray to open and close the door. Any slaves that don't join the party arc anxious to make their way to the nearest peaceful Underdark settlement. The drow are eager to return to Menzoberranzan, the deep gnomes to Blingdenstone. If the characters urge the slaves to leave the Vast Oblivium and make their own way home, they are all killed while trying to escape from the Wormwrithings. if the characters assign members of their expeditionary force to lead the slaves out of the Wormwrithings, the slaves stand a much better chance of making it to safety. M ODRON P RISONER

One or more slaves can lead characters to a small room on the uppermost level of the complex. The room is sealed off with a 6-inch-thick circular stone door that can be rolled aside with a DC 20 Strength check or opened with a knock spell or similar magic. The room holds a damaged duodrone that Karazikar recently captured in the hopes of unlocking more information about the Maze Engine. The duodrone has 1 hit point remaining and speaks its own language of clicks and whirs, always referring to itself as “we" or “us." The demonic madness as scrambled its memory, but if a greater restoration spell is cast on it. the modron remembers two things: • "We were part of a great march. We were separated. Then we were lost. Then we were captured. Then we started freaking out. Then you found us.” • “We know nothing about a ‘Maze Engine.' However, we can detect an Orderer approximately 289 miles south of our present location." (The "Orderer," claims the modron. is a device that brings order to chaos. It is, in fact, what others refer to as the Maze Engine.) T REASURE

The beholder used its disintegration eye ray to carve a rough likeness of itself in the ceiling of Karazikar's Maw a great stone beholder face glaring down upon the gaping chasm, its central eye a hollow shaft that leads up to a hemispherical vault where the beholder hides its considerable hoard: 15.000 gp, 1.300 pp, ten assorted gems worth 500 gp each, a gem of seeing, a necklace of adaptation, and a robe of eyes.

CHAPTER 13 I THE WORMWRITHINGS

CHAPTER 14: THE LABYRINTH More of the components needed for Vizeran’s demon summoning ritual can be found in the depths of the Labyrinth—a snarl of twisting tunnels and caves extending approximately 240 miles from north to south and 120 miles east to west. Navigating the Labyrinth is a nightmare, since most tunnels follow a straight path only a short distance before doubling back on themselves or ending abruptly, Baphomet the Horned King appeared in the Labyrinth when the demon lords were summoned to the Underdark, At the same time, Baphomet's rival Yeenoghu, Demon Lord of Gnolls, has taken to hunting the twisting passages of Baphomet’s new domain. Vizeran tells the characters to find the Gallery of Angels, a location in the heart of the Labyrinth lies some three hundred miles from Araj. it is the one place where Vizeran knows the characters can find the angel feathers required for his ritual's talisman. The Maze Engine lies forty-eight miles deeper into the Labyrinth if the characters choose to follow up on clues leading there (see the “March to Nowhere” and “Maze Engine” sections for details). The adventurers will also find a few unexpected opportunities to aid in the fight against the demon lords along the way.

17*

CHAPTER 14 I THE LABYRINTH

Long ago, the Labyrinth was much like any other part of the Undcrdark, consisting largely of natural

caverns connected by tunnels and underground rivers. The discovery of precious metals and gemstones led dwarves and others to excavate, extending its tunnels and expanding its caves. The results of those efforts saw an insignificant corner of the Underdark transformed into a vast, sprawling network of passages. Abandoned settlements within the Labyrinth are common, marked out by rusting iron rails and scattered ore carts. Dark mine shafts descend into the unknown depths, while tunnels stretch off in random directions. Rifts both small and large also appear throughout. Many a tunnel ends abruptly at a rift, as if the way ahead was simply sheared off to leave a vast, yawning chasm. Some of these rifts run to depths of a few hundred feet. Others ascend and descend for miles. Many of the rifts show their age by the presence of carved switchback staircases along their walls, or weathered bridges spanning their gaps. Characters in the Labyrinth can easily become lost. Traveling through this area follows the rules under “Navigating” in chapter 2, but it takes a successful DC 12 Wisdom (Survival) check to avoid becoming lost, rather than a DC 10 check. Spellcasters must contend with the effects of the faerzress for as long as they are in the Labyrinth, also as discussed in chapter 2.

CHAPTER 13 I THE WORMWRITHINGS

L ABYRINTH E NCOUNTERS This ehapLer features a number of set encounters. Either as the characters journey to the Labyrinth or return to Vizeran's tower, you can run the “Adamantine Tower” encounter. Once the characters reach the edge of the Labyrinth, go to the “Spiral of the Horned Lord" encounter. Within the Labyrinth, the characters take on the encounters “Filthriddens," "March to Nowhere,” "Yeenoghu’s Hunt." and "Gallery of Angels" (their intended destination). They might also take on “The Maze Engine” encounter, inspired by knowledge gained in chapter 13 and an encounter with some modrons in the Labyrinth.

communicate with them about the nearby threats, but it is up to the characters whether they wish to engage those threats. G NOLL P ACK

A gnoll fang ofYeenoghu named Kurr made his way into the Labyrinth shortly after Yeenoghu was summoned to the Undcrdark. Kurr brought with him a pack of hyenas and had them feast on the corpses of his slain victims. This heinous act transformed the hyenas into ten gnolls. Kurr's pack now prowls the Labyrinth in search ofYeenoghu, slaughtering anything and anyone they happen upon.

R A N D O M E N C O U N T E R S ________________________

Twice each day that the party spends in the Labyrinth (whether traveling or resting), roll a d20 and consult the Labyrinth Encounters table to determine what, if anything, they encounter. This table replaces the random encounter tables in chapter 2 for as long as the party remains in the Labyrinth. LABYRINTH ENCOUNTERS d20

Encounter

1-10 No encounter 1 behir 11 12 13 14

2d4 flumphs Gnoll pack ld4 grells

15

1d4 hezrous

16 17

4d8 manes 2d4 minotaurs

18

1 monodrone

19

2d6 quaggoths ld4 shriekers

20 B EHIR

This long-bodied reptile is either prowling a tunnel or resting in a cave when the characters encounter it. The behir retreats if reduced to 80 or fewer hit points. F LUMPHS

This cloister of flumphs feeds on the psychic energy they detect from a nearby mind flayer that has enslaved 2d4 quaggoths. The flumphs warn adventurers who

Unknown to his gnoll progeny, Kurr has succumbed to a form of madness that quells his feral demeanor. He's lost his appetite for carnage and is overcome with guilt for all of the creatures he has slain. When his pack happens upon the party, he sends his gnolls into battle but doesn't partake of the violence, hoping that the characters slaughter his brethren. Once they are. dead. Kurr bows his head solemnly, begs Yeenoghu’s forgiveness (first in his own language and then in Abyssal), and then throws himself at the party’s mercy. Kurr is suffering from a form of indefinite madness (see “Madness" in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide) which, if cured, reverts him to a typically feral gnoll. While afflicted with madness, Kurr can’t bring himself to kill any living creature except in selfdefense. If the characters spare his life. Kurr can act as a guide, R AN D O M E NC OU N TE R L O C ATIO N S

Random encounters in the Labyrinth take place in one of the following environments, modified as you wish to suit the creatures in the encounter. Caves. Most caves in the Labyrinth are small (up to 30 feet in diameter), with uneven floors featuring stalagmites, columns, or pools of standing water. A cave has a 10 percent chance of featuring luminescent growth on the walls that fill it with dim light. In addition to the tunnel through which the characters enter, there are ld3 additional tunnels leading out. These tunnels can exit the cave through the floor, ceiling, or at odd angles. Tunnels. Most tunnels in the Labyrinth are 5 to 10 feet wide, with ceilings ld8 + 3 feet high. A tunnel follows a straight path for no more than 2d4 x 10 feet before it turns. Rifts. The Labyrinth is shot through with rifts and chasms formed by upheavals in the earth. Slocks of stone thrust up in some places to hinder movement through passages and caverns, while other areas drop off suddenly, forming escarpments hundreds of feet high. In some places, the earth has shifted horizontally, creating tunnels that end suddenly only to continue hundreds of feet away. Any rift the characters encounter has a 75 percent chance of featuring a bridge or staircase constructed to navigate it.

CHAPTER 14 | THE LABYRINTH 17ft

for he has explored a great deal of the Labyrinth and can lead the characters along a safe route to an Underdark shanty town (see "Filthriddens”). Characters have no random encounters if they follow Kurr along this route, although they periodically stumble upon the corpses and bones of Underdark creatures slain by his gnolls. The encounter with Kurr’s pack occurs only once. Any subsequent occurrence of this encounter is with a pack of 3d6 gnolls. These gnolls came to the Underdark with Yeenoghu. They cackle and scream the demon lord's name as they tear into their prey.

A DAMANTINE T OWER

The adventurers come across a tower haunted by forces of darkness. '

Vaulted chambers bristle with stalactites and stalagmites, slowing your passage as you wend your way across uneven floors. Moving through a narrow passage, you enter a cavern dimly lit by phosphorescent fungi —and are met by the sight of a dark metal tower perched on the edge of a cliff that drops away into darkness.

G RF . LLS

The square tower is twenty feet on a side and thirty feet

The grells drop from an overhead shaft to feed.

high, with arrow slits in each wall. A battlement crowns its

H EZROUS

top, with a stone gargoyle peering over each side. Set into

These demons are tearing apart an iron ore cart, a rusted section of mining track, or some other old fixture. Party members can attempt to slip past the demons without arousing their attention. Doing so requires a successful DC 11 Dexterity (Stealth) check. On a failed check, the demons detect the party member and attack.

the middle of the wall facing you is a sturdy-looking door

M ANES

Characters can hear the mewling of this vile mob long before it appears. The manes scour the Labyrinth for easy prey and move like a tide of putrid flesh. MlNOTAURS

These minotaurs roams the Labyrinth, slaying creatures in the name of Baphomet. M ONODRONE

This modron has become separated from its fellows (see “March to Nowhere"), and there is a 75 percent chance that it is looking to rejoin them. If the characters can understand its language, the monodrone repeatedly says, “We are on the march!” A monodrone that doesn't want to rejoin its fellows is a rogue modron, made so by the chaotic energies suffusing the Underdark. This rogue monodrone gladly joins the party, saying “Down with Primus!" in its own language over and over. Its alignment is chaotic neutral, and it can only follow one simple task at a time. Q UAGGOTHS

These quaggoths are hungry and attack the party regardless of its size. If there are five or more quaggoths in the group, one of them is a quaggoth thonot (see the “Variant: Quaggoth Thonot” sidebar in the “Quaggoth” entry of the Monster Manual). If the thonot dies, the other quaggoths immediately break off their attack and begin feasting on the thonot's remains, hoping to gain its psionic power. S HRIEKERS

The shriekers sound off when bright light or a creature is within 30 feet of them. Their shrieking has a 75 percent chance of attracting other monsters, in which case roll again on the Labyrinth Encounters table, treating another shrieker encounter as “no encounter.”

made of the same dark metal as the rest of the tower. "

i

No ordinary structure, the tower is a Daerns instant fortress (see chapter 7, “Treasure," of the Dungeon Master’s Guide). Made entirely of adamantine, the twostory tower has remained sealed since its last owner retreated inside and locked the door behind her—but nct before a pair of shadow demons slipped in as well. The demons killed the owner and left her remains on the first floor. The tower can't be tipped over or otherwise moved from its position, and the arrow slits on each level are too narrow for anything bigger than a Tiny creature to squeeze through. A character can learn the tower’s command words by casting an identify spell on it. The command word to open the front door or the trap door on the roof is "mimsy.” The command word to transform the tower into a one-inch metal cube is “brillig," but speaking it has no effect since the shadow demons are still inside. To return the tower to its cube form, the adventurers must first empty it of any creatures. Four gargoyles perch atop the tower. They remain motionless as the characters enter the cavern, attacking only if anyone attempts to enter, climb, or damage the tower. This cavern's rough floor has been flattened where the tower stands, while the floor behind the tower has collapsed into a shaft 300 feet deep and 100 feet in diameter. Several tunnels branch off from the roughwalled shaft at various points, allowing the characters to continue their journey after climbing down. They can move around the tower easily if they wish to ignore it. FIRST FLOOR

The first floor of the tower is an open room. A ladder affixed to the back wall leads up through a trapdoor to the floor above, A pile of bones and moldering clothes lies in the corner the remains of the tower’s former owner. T REASURE

Searching through the remains turns up Iwo empty potion bottles and a potion of mind reading. CHAPTER 1+ I THE LABYRINTH

l8l

SECOND FLOOR

the piles of heads to either side of it. Its filthy body is bent

This empty chamber has a ladder affixed to one wall that climbs to an adamantine trap door leading to the roof. The trap door is closed and locked, though the proper command word (“mimsy") can open it. The two shadow demons lurk in the darkness of this room and aLtack the first character who enters, likely taking their prey by surprise.

and covered with tatters of clothing and scraps of blood-

B ATT L E M E N T S

The top of the tower features an open space surrounded by a crenelated wall. If the four gargoyles have not yet attacked the adventurers, they do so here.

S PIRAL OF THE H ORNED K ING Minotaurs have roamed the tunnels of the Labyrinth for ages, but as Baphoinet's influence grows, so too has the ferocity of his chosen servants. The waxing of Baphomet's power has not gone unnoticed by the packs of gnolls rampaging through the Underdark. The gnolls have begun making inroads into minotaur territory. The latest battlefield in the ancient feud between Baphomet and Yeenoghu is a maze of passages that grant access to the deeper passages of the Labyrinth.

crusted armor. The creature looks you over with one good eye, the other lost in a mass of scar tissue.

This wretched gnoll is named Gash. Thanks to treachery he committed against his kind, the minotaurs spared his life. However, their mercy comes with regular abuse and torment. The gnoll now sees himself as a loyal and willing servant of the brutes, and he is eager to lead gnolls and anyone else to his minotaur masters. Gash is a gnoll with the following modifications: ■ Gash has 11 hit points. • He has a walking speed of 25 feet. • He has disadvantage on Wisdom checks and Wisdom saving throws because of the physical and mental abuse he has suffered, A lesser restoration spell rids him of these effects. Cringing and mewling, Gash approaches the party with arms out and head down. He speaks in both Gnoll and Abyssal. If the characters can't understand him. he pantomimes helpful gestures and beckons them to follow him. "Powerful masters," the gnoll whines. ‘‘You honor us by your presence. Seek you passage through the maze? The

The tunnel you have been following gradually widens until

Spiral of the Great Horned King? I can help. Yes. Trust

it opens into a cave with a high ceiling overhead. Patches

Gash and he will see you through the maze, he will,"

of glowing fungi cling to the walls and fill the chamber with dim light. Columns of stone support the ceiling, the rock marbled with veins of glittering crystal. Across the chamber, a great deft is ringed by a profusion of sigils and glyphs. Stacked to either side of the opening are two mounds of severed heads.

The cleft leads to the Spiral of the Horned King—a maze of tunnels and caves along the outer edge of the Labyrinth. Though other routes can be found into Lhe Labyrinth, this entrance is the easiest to find. Invocations to Baphomet. dire curses, and the inverted names of the gods arc scrawled around the cleft in dried blood, and continue on down the tunnel walls. Anyone who can read the Abyssal tongue can tell that this place has been consecrated in the name of Baphomet, Lhe Horned King and lord of minotaurs. The minotaurs tear off their victims' heads, then leave them to “watch" the entrance for intruders. Most of the heads are from gnolls, though different Underdark races can be found if any character wants to sift through the piles. GASH

THE

GNOLL

Minutes after the characters arrive, they hear the sounds of footsteps approaching. A few moments later, a gnoll slinks from the tunnel ahead. A gnoll creeps out of the shadows, glancing cautiously at CHAPTER 14 | THE LABYRINTH t8o

Any aggressive action sends Gash skittering back into the maze and to his masters. If the characters capture him, he shrieks and screams, drawing one minotaur to investigate the racket. Accepting Gash's offer transforms the cringing gnoll into a dutiful guide. He leads the characters through passage after passage, choosing directions seemingly at random until the characters encounter the minotaurs. If the battle turns against the minotaurs. Gash flees. If the adventurers show pity or kindness. Gash becomes confused, as he has never experienced such things. A character can befriend the gnoll with a successful DC 20 Charisma (Persuasion) check. If any character uses magical healing on Gash, the check is automatically successful. If the characters befriend Gash, he warns them to turn back, lice, and never return. lie says his masters are vile minotaurs who wait in the maze, eager to kill all trespassers. If asked, Gash explains that the minotaurs spared his life in exchange for leading travelers into the maze. If the characters insist on entering the maze, Gash goes with them, trying to keep his new friends safe. If the characters defeat the minotaurs and move deeper into the Labyrinth, Gash can accompany them as a follower and guide, giving the characters advantage on Wisdom (Survival) checks to avoid becoming lost in the Labyrinth.

INTO

THE

M A Z E _____________________________________

The minotaurs’ maze fills a region of the Underdark one mile on each side. A network of corridors climbing up to higher levels and descending to lower ones byway of ramps, the maze requires time, attention, and patience to navigate. The corridors are 10 feet wide and tall, faced with stone blocks mortared into place. Bits of flesh and bone litter the floor, and splashes of blood cover the walls. When the characters enter the maze, have them choose their pace (fast, normal, or slow). It takes 1 hour to navigate the maze at a fast pace. 2 hours at a normal pace, or 3 hours at a slow pace. Halfway through the journey, the navigator must make a DC 15 Wisdom (Survival) check. A fast pace imposes a -5 penalty to the check. A slow pace grants a +5 bonus. On a success, the characters find their way out. On a failure, the characters must start the journey from the beginning. The longer it takes the characters to navigate through the maze, the greater the risk of encountering the creatures within it. Every 30 minutes the party spends in the maze, roll a d20 and consult the Maze Encounters table to see what, if anything, the characters meet. If Gash was attacked by the characters and fled into the maze, he does his best to bring threats down on them, in which case roll two d20s and take the higher result. If Gash is friendly to the party and accompanying them, he tries to steer them away from danger, in which case roll two d20s and take the lower result.

M AZE E NCOUNTERS d20

Encounter

1-10 11-12 13-14

No encounter Corpse Gnawed bones

15-17

2d4 gnolls

18-20

ld6 minotaurs

C ORPSE

The characters stumble upon the headless remains of a butchered corpse belonging to a dead dwarf, gnoll, human, or svirfneblin. G NAWED B ONES

A pile of cracked and gnawed bones is laid out around a pool of dried blood. G NOLL P ACK

A frenzied group of 2d4 gnolls is lost in the maze. The gnolls attack any creatures they see. M INOTAURS

These bloodthirsty minotaurs are hunting gnolls but attack any other creatures they happen upon. Treasure. The first time the characters fight the minotaurs, one of them carries 32 ep and 22 cp in a pouch made from a human face with the eyes and mouth sewn shut. The second time the characters encounter minotaurs, one of them wears silver caps (worth 25 gp each) on the ends of its horns.

F I LTH R I D D E N S Filthriddens was, until recently, a shanty town of Underdark exiles and refugees. The greatest threat to inhabitants—apart from food shortages—was the minotaurs that raided the settlement from time to time, dragging off screaming prisoners to meet a grisly fate. The recent arrival of the demon lords changed things. A group of minotaurs was on its way to raid Filthriddens when Yeenoghu and a pack of his frenzied followers tore through this part of the Labyrinth, catching the minotaurs off guard and slaughtering them. The sole witness to this carnage was Grisha, an escaped human slave of the drow. Yeenoghu's intercession saved him from the minotaurs. Yeenoghu and his pack moved on, but Grisha took the head of a slain minotaur and brought it back to Filthriddens. The skull became a talisman as Grisha named Yeenoghu as the new protector and patron of Filthriddens. Residents who opposed this dark worship were exiled or executed in short order. The cult of Yeenoghu now controls the settlement, and Grisha rules with an iron fist. He senses the power of Yeenoghu in all things—and particularly in the way in which cultists have begun to rise as undead ghouls after death. GRISHA’S GREETING

Filthriddens lies 48 miles from the Spiral of the Horned King, deeper in the Labyrinth. Kurr (see “Random Encounters”) or Gash (see “Gash the Gnoll") might lead CHAPTER 14 | THE LABYRINTH

182

the characters here if they don’t find it on their own.

CHAPTER 14 i THE LABYRINTH

183

The cavern that opens up ahead looks like a settlement,

high.

with tents and crudely built shanties lining its irregular

A curious procession of creatures marches along the

walls. It appears deserted except for a lone human male

tunnel below your position. Twelve of the creatures are

kneeling within a circle of burning torchstalk mushrooms

identical. Each has a round body, spindly arms and legs, a

in the center of the cave and two ragged figures lurking

pair of fluttering wings rising above its arms, and a single

near a zurkhwood door set into a wall thirty feet distant.

eye staring out over a wide, smiling mouth. At the

The figure in the circle is praying over a rotting minotaur

column's head stands a creature that looks like an inverted

head but stands when he sees you. He's a thin human, and

pyramid held up by six legs. It scuttles like a crab. On

his face and arms are streaked with dry blood.

each side of its body, an eye is set above a mouth. Under

"Friends,” he says, "I have heard the call and I

the mouth, a single arm grips a spear in its hand.

hope you have too. With my own eyes, I saw our Great Lord Yeenoghu slaughterthe minotaurs that had plagued us. Now we are free and strong with his blessings. We feast while we live, and thanks to our lord, we will also feast when we are dead, Ifyou've heard the call, come, join my pack and feel the strength of Yeenoghu." The figure smiles as he speaks, revealing teeth filed to sharp points.

Filthriddens is contained within a cave roughly 100 feet long and 60 feet wide. The characters enter from a natural tunnel along one of the shorter walls, with another tunnel exiting on the opposite side. Much of the cave is taken up with crude shanties. Most of them stand empty, their inhabitants either exiled or dead. Grisha (see appendix C) can recount the history of Filthriddens and how Yeenoghu saved its denizens from the oppression of the minotaurs. He can also reveal how he spent years as a slave of the drow. Grisha seeks new disciples to grow his cult's power. Twelve cultists (a mix of shield dwarves, halflings, and humans) support Grisha if a fight breaks out. Ten of them are hidden in the shanties. Two more stand next to a zurkhwood door, beyond which lies a small side cave where cultists who have died and risen as undead are kept. If battle erupts, the cultists open the door and release six ghouls. The ghouls ignore the cultists as long as there are other creatures to feed on.

MARCH TO NOWHERE The Labyrinth is aptly named, for even the most resolute of explorers can become lost in its depths, as a number of modrons discovered to their dismay. Separated long ago from their fellows during the Great Modron March, these modrons have been wandering the Underdark for a longtime. As the party travels deeper into the Labyrinth, any character with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 15 or higher hears the sounds of marching feet off in the distance. To investigate the source of the noise, the characters must travel for 15 minutes through cramped tunnels requiring as much climbing as crawling. At the end of this time, the adventurers emerge onto a shelf 15 feet up the wall of a hroad, straight tunnel some 20 feet

Twelve monodrones and a tridrone have been wandering the Labyrinth since the last Great Modron March. The modrons became separated from their fellows and trapped here. Unable to find their way back to Mechanus, the modrons have been pressing on (and on), knowing that they must find their way back or he. destroyed in the process. The extended march has taxed the modrons to their limit. Most show signs of the frustration of being unable to fulfill their mission. The tridrone has managed to keep the group together, but it feels responsible for their collective fate and their failure to return home. Even if the characters have the ability to communicate with the modrons, the monodrones' ability to communicate is all but spent (see the “Roleplaying the Modrons" sidebar). The tridrone can be very communicative -provided the characters have a w!ay to speak with it and can allay its suspicions. A character can persuade the tridrone of the parry's good intentions with a successful DC 15 Charisma (Persuasion) check. They have advantage on the check if the party includes one or more modrons. Once convinced of the characters' friendly intentions, the tridrone tells them that it and its fellows are on a mission of supreme importance, though it doesn't reveal the nature of that mission. A character can puzzle out the reason why the modrons might be here by making a DC 20 Intelligence (Arcana) check. Success indicates that the character recalls stories about the Great Modron March, which occurs every 289 years and sees a vast army of modrons marching across the Outer Planes. If the check succeeds by 5 or more, the character also knows the last march happened over two R O LE PL AYIN G TH E M OD RO N S

Modrons have no sense of individuality. They are a collective and refer to themselves as "we” or "us." As a result, modrons don't understand individuality in others. When speaking to a group, the tridrone might focus its attention on the adventurer it believes to be at the top of the party's hierarchy even while talking to another. Monodrones can normally relay messages up to fortyeight words long. However, years of wandering have degraded these creatures so that they can speak only a few words or phrases before sputtering off into clicking and popping noises. Among the words the monodrones repeat are “march,” “Mechanus,” “seventeen" (the number of cycles of the plane of Mechanus that mark the Great Modron March), and “lost.”

CHAPTER 14 i THE LABYRINTH

184

hundred years ago, and that these modrons are likely remnants of that march. The tridrone doesn't admit this (not wanting to acknowledge its failure), though it might be convinced to follow the characters if they offer to lead the modrons out of the Labyrinth. Additionally, the tridrone knows the Labyrinth well, and befriending the modrons grants characters a +5 bonus to Wisdom (Survival) checks made to navigate the region. The tridrone warns the characters to avoid the center of the Labyrinth, explaining that a malfunctioning “Orderer" is there. The characters might know the device by its other name: the Maze Engine. Because the device was built on Mechanus, its magical energy resonates with the modrons. The tridrone explains that an Orderer is designed to bring order to chaos by altering reality. A malfunctioning Orderer can be very dangerous, however, altering reality in unexpected ways. The tridrone knows exactly how far it is from the device. Because its knowledge of magic is limited and its focus on rejoining the Great Modron March is all-consuming, the tridrone has never thought about whether the Orderer might provide a solution to the modrons' predicament. If the characters express an interest in investigating this possibility, the tridrone leads the party to the center of the Labyrinth where the Maze Engine is found.

Y EENOGHU ’ S H UNT About twelve miles from their encounter with the modrons, as they travel through the Labyrinth, the characters hear sounds of howling in the distance off and on over the course of many hours. Sometimes the sounds get closer or fade away, echoing strangely through the surrounding tunnels. Eventually, the characters enter a smaller tunnel leading upward. As they move forward, they can clearly hear the sound of fighting ahead. Bestial howls and yips can be heard, along with deeper roaring. A successful DC 13 Intelligence check recognizes the language of the battle cries as Gnoll. The characters can retreat HUNTED BY YEENOCHU

If you'd like Yeenoghu to play more of a role in this chapter of the adventure, it’s easy to do so. When the gnolls killed by the characters do not rejoin the hunt, the demon lord circles back to the site of the goristro’s demise and discovers his slain minions—and also picks up the scent of the adventurers. Later in the adventure, Yeenoghu hunts down the characters to make them pay for their impudence (ideally when they are much higher in level). Before the final confrontation, give the characters hints that they have become the demon lord’s prey. They might face an increasing number of gnoll ambushes, for example. One or more of their attackers might refer to them as “prey of Yeenoghu," or otherwise taunt them by speaking of their impending doom. The characters should have time to prepare for the fight they know is coming, and to think about tactics other than facing Yeenoghu in straight-up combat. For example, becoming the demon lord’s quarry might work to their advantage later in the campaign, making them the perfect bait to lure Yeenoghu into a trap in chapter 17, “Against the Demon Lords."

1*4

CHAPTER 14 I THE LABYRINTH

away from the sounds of combat, but doing so means backtracking for six miles to find another route. If they continue ahead, they are confronted with a grisly scene. Though the characters likely have no firsthand experience of a goristro, they recognize the creature from the information provided to them by Vizeran DeVir. As you move forward, the sounds of furious battle grow louder. The tunnel ends at a ledge twenty feet above the floor of a large cavern, giving you a perfect view of the conflict below. On the shores of an underground lake, a pack of frenzied gnolls and hyenas surrounds a demon standing nearly twenty feet tall, with massive arms, clawed hands, cloven hooves, and the head of a bull. This is a goristro, whose heart Vizeran DeVir has instructed you to claim. Leading the gnolls is a figure of fearful countenance, twelve feet tall with the head of a snarling, amber-eyed hyena. He wields a massive triple flail, whose whirling heads smash into the larger goristro. The gnolls howl their master’s name as he strikes swiftly, again and again: “Yeenoghu! Yeenoghu!” The larger demon roars, slashing with its bull’s horns and flailing with its claws, but to no avail. Yeenoghu evades or shrugs off its attacks, even as gnoll archers pepper it with arrows. Then the gnolls swarm the goristro as it begins to falter, bringing it crashing to the ground. In less than a minute, the battle is won. The demon lord Yeenoghu pulls back the goristro’s head by the horns and rips out its throat with his teeth. He throws back his head and his howl of triumph echoes through the chamber, shaking the stones themselves. Several hyenas nipping at Yeenoghu's heels leap onto the goristro’s corpse and begin feasting on its flesh. As you watch, these hyenas transform into gnolls.

Any adventurer witnessing this horrible tableau must succeed on a DC 12 Wisdom saving throw or gain one level of madness (see “Madness" in chapter 2). If this causes the character to suffer a bout of indefinite madness, determine the nature of the madness using the Indefinite Madness of Yeenoghu table in appendix D. Yeenoghu (see appendix D) has been wandering the Underdark since he was first summoned, and the adventurers have run across him and his pack. The characters' only advantage at this moment is that they haven’t yet been detected. Considering their level at this stage of the adventure, the players might be creating new characters quite soon if they dare confront the demon lord. If the characters stay hidden and observe, Yeenoghu leaves in short order. He is restless and eager for new prey. Yeenoghu gathers up most of the gnolls and hyenas and leads them down a tunnel on the right side of the cavern. Eight gnolls led by a gnoll pack lord remain in

the cavern, feasting on the goristro’s corpse.

1*4

CHAPTER 14 I THE LABYRINTH

If the characters want to continue forward, the gnolls and hyenas need to be dealt with. Alternatively, if the characters are indecisive or spend too long debating the best course of action, the gnoll pack lord sniffs out the intruders. When it realizes that enemies arc present, the pack lord howls to draw the attention of its followers. DEVELOPMENT

Another tunnel on the opposite side of the cavern heads off in a different direction than where Yeenoghu led his pack. Characters who defeat the remaining gnolls can continue on their way without losing any more time. The close brush with Yeenoghu pays dividends to the adventurers by delivering two components of Vizeran’s ritual into their hands. The first is the heart of the goristro, which the characters can remove from its corpse. The massive heart is the size of a small trunk and weighs nearly one hundred pounds. Any characters close to it while it is being transported imagine that they can occasionally hear it beating. A character who carries the heart, even in a bag of holding or similar extradimensional space, makes saving throws against madness with disadvantage. The second component takes the form of a few spatters of a demon lord’s blood. A successful DC 10 Wisdom (Perception) check finds some of Yeenoghu's black blood on the fallen goristro’s horns.

G ALLERY OF A NGELS

This cavern lies deep inside the Labyrinth and contains another ritual component that Vizeran needs. The passage you follow climbs upward as it corkscrews through stone, finally emerging through the floor of a large cavern. The ceiling arches sixty feet overhead, bristling with stalactites that drip water onto stalagmites rising from the uneven and broken floor. Here and there between the stalagmites, several statues of winged humanoids are set in

endless torment of their fate have driven them mad. No spell can undo the angels' curse or free them from their petrified state. F AL LEN AN G ELS

The angels can communicate, albeit in a limited fashion, with living creatures that touch them. A character who makes physical contact with an angel (even through gloves or some other protective covering) knows that angel's name and experiences the effect described below. If you wish, you can roll a d8 to determine w’hich angel a character touches, rerolling any repeat results. Unless specified otherwise, Lhe effect is instantaneous. While there's no limit to the number of creatures that can touch an angel and be affected by it, a creature that touches an angel and triggers its effect can’t trigger that particular angel's effect again until 24 hours have elapsed. A N A YA

This angel reaches toward the ceiling, its face a mask of hatred. A creature that makes contact with this angel must make a DC 15 Wisdom saving throw, taking 3d6 psychic damage on a failed save or half as much damage on a successful one. B A AT R A L

This angel appears to be reaching out as if offering something. A character making contact with the angel must succeed on a DC 15 Charisma saving throw or become charmed for 1 minute. While the character is charmed, the angel has a telepathic link with the character as long as it and the character remain on the same plane of existence. The angel issues commands to the character, and the character does its best to obey those commands if it is conscious. The angel typically commands a character to kill, maim, rob. or otherwise harm its companions. Each time an affected character takes damage, he or she makes a new Charisma saving throw against the effect. If the saving throw succeeds, the effect on it ends.

poses of suffering and anguish. Some cover their faces, while others daw at them. Others reach toward the ceiling, their faces twisted into expressions of longing.

This chamber houses the petrified remains of eight fallen angels, condemned by the gods to pass the ages in the dark depths. Each appears to have been carved from stone in some position of fear, suffering, hatred, or longing. Each statue is spotted with lichen and marred by mineral deposits, which have crystallized out of the water dripping from the ceiling over uncounted years. Even though they are transformed into stone statues, the fallen angels remain very much alive, their petrified bodies having become prisons for their minds and souls. They remember who they were. They know what they did and why they are here. They know everything transpiring around them. Yet they can do nothing. They are trapped forever, and the isolation, darkness, and

HAR AJIN

This angel points at a spot on the cavern wall, and its mouth hangs open in horror. A character who makes contact with the angel hears horrific screaming and must succeed on a DC 15 Wisdom saving throw or gain one level of madness (see “Madness" in chapter 2). L ORABELIOS

This angel stands feet apart, head downcast, arms at its sides. A character making contact with the angel hears a soft voice say in Common. “Do not lose hope." The character’s next Wisdom saving throw is made with advantage. NEMEVON

This angel holds its hands to its face, concealing its visage. Upon making contact with this angel, the character hears a soft voice repeating two words over and over in the Celestial language: “Kill me." There is no obvious way for the characters to do so, however. The CHAPTER 1+ I THE LABYRINTH

t8g

voice persists even if the angel is shattered.

CHAPTER 14 ITHE LABYRINTH

T87

SlbNIA

This angel covers its eyes with its arm but appears to be smiling. A character who touches the angel must make a DC 15 Wisdom saving throw. On a failed save, terrifying nightmares haunt the character’s sleep during his or her next long rest. The character derives no benefits from that rest and, upon waking, takes 3d6 psychic damage. T AMIEL

This angel kneels on the floor and buries its face in its arms. A character making contact with the angel hears a soft voice say in Common, “What would you know? Ask and 1 shall answer.” The character must make a DC 15 Intelligence saving throw. On a failed save, the character takes 3d6 psychic damage and gains one level of madness. On a success, the character can ask two questions. The angel replies as if the character had successfully cast the contact other plane spelt. Z AROD

This angel claws at its eyes, and its face appears torn and rent. When a character makes contact with the angel, it invites the character to ask a single question concerning a specific goal, event, or activity to occur within seven days. The angel replies as if the character had successfully cast the divination spell. D E V E L O P M E N T _________________________________

The adventurers can chisel or break oft’ stone feathers from the angels' wings. One each from six different

angels fulfills the requirements for Vizeran’s ritual, although characters can take more feathers if they want. Other creatures in the Labyrinth avoid this cavern, making it a safe place for the party to take a long rest.

T HE M AZE E NGINE Deep within the Labyrinth lies the Maze Engine—a mechanical, magically powered device capable of altering reality. Modrons refer to the device as an Orderer because it was designed is to bring order to chaos. If the characters activate the Maze Engine, it has the potential to aid their fight against the demon lords. The engine looks like a working model of the Great Wheel (see chapter 2, “Creating a Multiversein the Dungeon Master's Guide). It’s a 20-foot-diameter sphere built of 1-foot-wide bands of magically hardened and shaped bronze, engraved with arcane symbols. Gaps in the bands show various gears and articulation arms within the sphere, which rotate and shift to represent the relationships between the various known planes of existence. Characters might learn about the existence of the Maze Engine from the beholder Karazikar (see chapter 13) or from Vizeran, who has heard rumors about an ancient reality-altering device. Characters might also learn about the engine from Karazikar’s modron prisoner or from the modrons lost in the Labyrinth (see “March to Nowhere”). Information about the Maze Engine can also be found in Gravenhollow (see chapter 11). The characters could

SHAKING LOOSE

experience a vision of a journey to the Labyrinth in the library, or read an account of the device in its archives. REACHING

THE

ENGINE

Located forty-eight miles southeast of the Gallery of Angels, the Maze Engine is wedged halfway down a 20foot-wide, 100-foot-deep crevasse located in the middle of a large cavern. The bottom of the crevasse is filled with magma. A shimmering curtain of heat rises from the crevasse and makes the cavern hot and dry. The roughly spherical engine is 40 feet below the top of the crevasse and 40 feet above the magma. It can be reached by magic or by climbing down to it. The sheer sides of the crevasse require a successful DC 12 Strength (Athletics) check to climb. On a failed check, a character makes no progress and dislodges loose stones that clatter down the crevasse into the magma. If the check fails by 5 or more, the climber falls into the magma. Any creature that enters the magma or starts its turn there takes 42 (12d6) fire damage. Every foot moved in the magma costs 5 feet of movement. S LAUGHTERTUSK

Having just recently found the Maze Engine, Baphomet has set a nalfeshnee named Slaughtertusk to watch over the crevasse and prevent any creature from approaching the device. Slaughtertusk would rather be helping the Horned King track down and kill Yeenoghu. The nalfeshnee is bored with its assigned task, although it knows better than to disobey the Horned King. Still, rather than immediately destroying any intruders, it toys with them for as long as possible. Slaughtertusk is happy to let a fight drag on, feasting on its enemies' pain before finally slaying them. If reduced to fewer than 100 hit points, it uses its Summon Demon feature (see the “Variant: Demon Summoning" sidebar in the “Demons" entry of the Monster Manual) and tries to summon ld6 vrocks. It has a 50 percent chance of succeeding. Slaughtertusk is a bully at heart and begs for its life if the adventurers have it at their mercy, promising to tell them the secrets of the Maze Engine or anything else they want. At the first opportunity, it teleports away, summoning demonic aid to cover its retreat if possible. A C T I VATI N G

THE

E N G I N E _______________________

A successful DC 15 Intelligence (Arcana) check is needed to activate the device by puzzling out its array of gears and levers. It then takes 12 rounds for the engine to "align itself” and activate its magical effect. If an initiative order hasn’t already been established by the time the engine activates, have everyone in the party roll initiative. If the tridrone from “March to Nowhere" accompanies the characters, it can instruct them howto activate the Maze Engine without a check and inform them of how long it takes for the magical effect to occur.

The engine, which weighs two tons, is ordinarily set on a solid stone surface. Being wedged partway down a crevasse makes its operation more problematic. When the engine is activated, the vibration of its clacking gears sends showers of loose stones down the crevasse walls. Once the engine has been activated, it “acts" on initiative count 15. M EPHIT M ADNESS

On the round after the Maze Engine activates, two magma mephits fly out of the magma on initiative count 10. Two more magma mephits emerge from the magma each round thereafter on the same initiative count, until a dozen mephits have appeared. The mephits attack anyone on or near the Maze Engine. AND R OLL At the end of its turn during round 3, the engine shifts. Any creature standing on it must make a DC 10 Dexterity saving throw. If the save fails by 5 or more, the creature is knocked off the engine into the magma. Otherwise, a creature failing its save slides down the spherical side of the engine but automatically grabs one of its bands before falling. The creature can use an action to try to climb back onto the engine, doing so with a successful DC 10 Strength (Athletics) check. At the end of its turn during round 6, the engine shifts again. The effect is the same as described above, except that a creature hanging onto one of the engine's bands has disadvantage on the saving throw. If a creature falls from the Maze Engine, another creature adjacent to the falling creature and hanging onto one of the engine's bands can attempt to use a free hand to grab the Falling creature, doing so with a successful DC 10 Dexterity saving throw. A creature saved in this manner can use its action to try to climb back onto the engine, doing so with a successful DC 13 Strength (Athletics) check. If the check fails and She creature’s weight exceeds the carrying capacity of the creature that grabbed it (see "Lifting and Carrying” in chapter 7 of the Player's Handbook), the creature grabbing it must succeed on a DC 15 Strength check at the start of iLs next turn or lose its grip on the fallen creature, which then plunges into the magma. At the end of each of its turns starting on round 9, the Maze Engine slides down the crevasse, dropping 10 feet toward the magma each round. Any creature on the engine must make a successful DC 15 Dexterity saving throw each time it drops down to avoid being thrown off. Resolve the effects as described above. On its turn during round 13, the Maze Engine sinks into the magma and is destroyed.

S HAKE , R ATTLE ,

SHUTTING DOWN

THE

ENGINE

The engine shuts down if any part of it comes into contact with an antimagic field or if it is targeted by a successful dispel magic (DC 19), Otherwise, it can only be shut down by a wish spell or divine intervention. CHAPTER 14 ITHE LABYRINTH

T87

M A Z E E N G I N E E F F E C T S ________________________

The Maze Engine was damaged when the crevasse opened underneath it and swallowed it up. The engine can't be repaired, and once activated, it does strange and unpredictable things on each of its turns until it is deactivated or destroyed. dlOO 36-39

40-43

44-48

49-52

53-57

58-60

61-66 67-70

71-76 77-80

81-00

Effect Loud whispers emanate from the hollow interior of the engine. Each character in direct contact with the engine can increase one ability score of his or her choice by 2, to a maximum of 24. Multicolored arcs oflight play across the surface of the engine, which casts a polymorph spell (save DC 18) on each creature within 20 feet of it. Any creature that fails the saving throw is polymorphed into a flying The engine spits out multicolored gemstones. Any character within 20 feet of the engine can use his or her reaction to catch a 500 gp gem with a free hand. The rest of the gemstones fall into the magma and are The engine emits a flash of yellowish-white light. A randomly determined magic item appears in a safe location within 120 feet of the engine. Roll on Magic Item Table C in the Dungeon Master's Guide to determine what appears. The engine emits a flash of green light. Each creature in direct contact with the engine must succeed on a DC 18 Constitution saving throw or take 10d6 + 40 force damage. If this damage reduces the target to 0 hit points, it is disintegrated. A disintegrated creature and everything it is wearing and carrying, except artifacts, are The engine flickers with blue light and casts faerie fire, targeting all creatures within 20 feet of it (save DC 18). The spell’s effect has a duration of! minute. The engine spews harmless, multicolored sparks until the start of its next turn. The engine emits a flash of violet light. Each creature within 20 feet of the engine must succeed on a DC 18 Constitution saving throw or be petrified until the engine's next The engine plays calliope music. The next time this result is rolled, the music stops. The engine makes a horrible grinding noise. All lawful creatures within 30 feet of it regain all of their hit points. The engine emits a flash of violet-white light. All extraplanar creatures within 100 miles of the engine instantly return to their native planes of existence.

D EVELOPMENT

If you want to add tension to the end of this encounter, have the Maze Engine trigger a minor eruption after it | THE LABYRINTH sinksCHAPTER into the 14 magma, causing the magma to bubble up 188 out of the crevasse, spill into the cavern and nearby tunnels, and force the adventurers and their allies to stay ahead of the magma surge.

On each of the engine's turns, roll a dlOO and consult the Maze Engine Effects table to determine what the engine does. MAZE ENGINE EFFECTS dlOO Effect 01 The engine emits a flash of golden light. All magic items within 300 feet of the engine are destroyed, except for artifacts, which are cast into the Astral Plane. 208 Arcs of white light play across the surface of the engine until the end of its turn. 910 The engine emits a bright flash of white light. All player characters are transported back in time, as they are now, to the moment when the adventure began. They appear in Velkynvelve's slave pen, unshackled and unbound, with all of their experience points, abilities, equipment, and memories. 11-15 The engine makes a loud “WHAAAH” sound until the start of its next turn. For as long as the sound lasts, the engine projects an antimagic field (as the spell) around itself. 16-19 The hollow interior of the engine flickers with crimson light until the end of its turn, whereupon one dead character or NPC of the DM’s choice is restored to life, as though subjected to a resurrection spell. The revived creature appears in a safe, unoccupied space within 120 feet of the engine. 20-22 The engine spews slippery goo that splatters across its outer surface. Saving throws to avoid being knocked off the engine and ability checks made to climb the engine have disadvantage until the engine's next turn. 23-27 The engine crackles with lightning. All creatures within 30 feet of the engine must make a DC 18 Dexterity saving throw or take 10d6 lightning damage. A target made primarily of metal or wearing metal armor has disadvantage on its saving throw. 28-32 The engine hums until the end of its turn, at which point a green slaad appears in a safe space within 120 feet of the engine, The slaad rolls initiative and, on its turn, attacks any other creatures it sees. 33-35 The engine groans loudly and turns each creature within 120 feet of it invisible. A creature's invisibility lasts until it attacks or casts a spell.

C HAPTER

15: T HE C ITY OF S PIDERS G OALS

The center of the chaos and madness now spreading throughout the Underdark is the great drow city of Menzoberranzan. Few of the city's drow residents know that the Demon Queen of Spiders is behind the summoning ritual that brought the demon lords to the Underdark and that the reward for their faith in Lolth might well be their destruction. Menzoberranzan was the site of Demogorgon's appearance in the Underdark, and the lash of his tentacles and the crushing tread of his clawed feet left a trail of broken buildings, bodies, and minds. Unfortunately for the drow. the worst may be yet to come if the renegade drow archmage Vizeran DeVir won the adventurers' support for his plan to use a powerful ritual to draw the demon lords and their fiendish servants out of the Underdark and set them against each other. As the demon lords destroy each other in the material world, their dark essences will be drawn back to the Abyss once more. But one of the key parts of Vizeran's plan involves the characters' making sure that the City of Spiders plays host to this final, devastating battle.

If the characters are working with Vizeran DeVir. they have two goals in the City of Spiders: obtain Gromph Baenre's demon summoning grimoire. and place Vizeran’s talisman in Menzoberranzan to draw the demon lords there for an epic showdown. PLACING

THE

“ D A R K H E A RT

After their adventures in the Wormwrithings and the Labyrinth, the characters can return to Araj to deliver the components they have collected to Vizeran DeVir. Over ten days, the drow archmage uses those components to craft a talisman that looks and feels like a five-pound black heart carved of black stone. Imbued with arcane and fiendish power, the dark heart talisman acts as a beacon when Vizeran’s ritual is performed, drawing all demons presently loose in the Underdark. The talisman radiates faint conjuration magic even before it is activated, but it’s primarily a focus for the power of the ritual rather than a source of power itself.

Vizeran’s plan calls for the adventurers to place the dark heart in Menzobcrranzan. Vizeran would prefer for the dark heart to be left wherever the characters find

Gromph Baenre's grimoire in Sorcere the center of wizardly training in Menzoberranzan. However, Vizeran tells the characters that placing the talisman anywhere in the City of Spiders will do. O B T AI N I N G G R O M P H ’ S G R I M O I R E

Gromph Baenre’s grimoire contains notes and references for his ill-fated demon summoning. Vizeran knows from research at Gravenhollow that the grimoire is in Gromph’s sanctum in the tower of Sorcere. To reach the grimoire, the characters need to penetrate one of the most important and well-protected places in the City of Spiders. Fortunately for the characters, Vizeran isn’t without allies in the city. The Council of Spiders is a secret alliance of drow mages who want to overthrow Lolth's priestesses. The council has infiltrated Sorcere, the city's academy for arcane magic, and has sympathizers among male drow wizards. Vizeran has already contacted his allies, who have agreed to help the party gain access to the tower and Gromph's sanctum (see “Sorcere" later in this chapter).

G OING TO M ENZOBERRANZAN Seventy-two miles of twisting passageways separate Araj from Menzoberranzan. Vizeran has a secret route between the two, which he allows the characters to use if they agree to follow his plan. Otherwise, the characters must travel to Menzoberranzan by commonly known routes monitored by drow scouts, patrols, and outposts. If the characters opt to use Vizeran’s secret route, the drow archmage’s apprentice, Grin Ousstyl (see chapter 12), accompanies the characters at Vizeran’s behest, serving as their guide. Vizeran strongly suggests that the characters leave their expeditionary force at Araj, asserting that a small team has the best chance of infiltrating the drow city. S T AT I S T I C A L M O D I F I C A T I O N S F O R D R O W

NP C S

When using the generic stat blocks in appendix B of the Monster Manual to represent drow NPCs, assume that the drow are neutral evil and speak Elvish and Undercommon. Also give those NPCs the following additional features. Fey Ancestry. The drow has advantage on saving throws against being charmed, and magic can’t put the drow to sleep. Innate Spellcasting. The drow's innate spellcasting ability is

Charisma (spell save DC equal to 10 + the drow's Charisma modifier). The drow can innately cast the following spells, requiring no material components: At will: dancing lights 1 /day each: darkness, faerie fire, levitate (self only) Sunlight Sensitivity. While in sunlight, the drow has

disadvantage on attack rolls, as well as on Wisdom (Perception) checks that rely on sight. CHAPTER 15 I THE CITY OF SPIDERS

VIZERAN’S SECRET ROUTE

Grin Ousstyl shows the characters a secret door in the cavern wall outside of Vizeran's tower. Beyond this door is a long and winding tunnel that took Vizeran centuries to create using stone-shaping spells. The passage, which is free of monsters and hazards, ends at a secret door at the bottom of the Westrift in Menzoberranzan. The trip from Araj to the city takes twelve days on foot, during which time Grin says very little. Any character who succeeds on a DC 15 Wisdom (Insight) check can tell that the drow mage is troubled by something, although he refuses to share his private thoughts and concerns. If the characters read Grin’s thoughts or compel him to speak using magic or torture. Grin reveals that he has misgivings about Vizeran's plan. Though he has no affection for the matron mothers and priestesses that govern Menzoberranzan, Grin has no wish to see his birthplace- and its people—destroyed. If Grin sees firsthand the destruction wrought by Demogorgon's rampage through the city, he becomes even more reluctant to see Vizeran's plan through (sec “A Change of Heart" later in this chapter). If the characters prod Grin for information about Menzoberranzan and what they can expect to find there, he relates the information contained in “The Way of Lolth” section. He can also describe the major districts of the city. OTHER ROUTES

Characters who can’t avail themselves of Vizeran’s secret route or choose not to use it must find another way to Menzoberranzan. There are many routes to choose from, such that the party can approach the City of Spiders from literally any direction. However, all of these routes are known to the drow. The characters might have encountered a drow force on a previous attempt to reach the city (see “March on Menzoberranzan" in chapter 10). If so, they already know what they’re up against. Even if they decline to use Vizeran’s secret route, the drow archmage recommends that the characters take Grin Ousstyl with them, not so much as a guide but to help the party talk its way past drow patrols. The demonic invasion has put Menzoberranzan's defenses on high alert, making it even harder than normal for non-drow to approach the city safely by any known route. While the characters are within 18 miles (three days' travel) of the city, use the Drow Patrols table to determine random encounters instead of using the tables in chapter 2. Once every hour, roll a d20 and consult the table to determine what, if anything, the party encounters. DROW DEFENSES d20 Encounter I- 10 No encounter II- 14 Drow patrol A 15-17 Drow patrol B 1819 Drow patrol C 20 Drow patrol D

D ROW P ATROL A

The standard patrol consists of two drow scouts mounted on giant riding lizards (use the statistics at the end of chapter 8). Characters who can see out to a range of 120 or more and are moving at a normal pace spot the drow scouts with a successful DC 16 Wisdom (Perception) check. If the characters arc moving at a fast pace, they take a -5 penalty to their checks. Unless the characters are moving at a slow pace and being stealthy, the drow spot them with their darkvision and withdraw to an outpost located a mile away. Defending the drow outpost are a female drow elite warrior (the commander), a male drow mage, and sixteen drow, The outpost is a four-story tower carved out of a 60-foot-tall, 15-foot wide column in the middle of a 75-foot-diameter cavern. Both the cavern and the outpost are unlit. A secret door in the column's base leads to the tower interior, but finding it requires a thorough search and a successful DC 20 Wisdom (Perception) check. Arrow slits on each floor allow the drow to cast spells and make ranged attacks in every direction while enjoying three-quarters cover against attacks from the cavern. If the drow scouts escape and the characters don't follow them, the scouts report to the outpost commander, who organizes a hunting party consisting of her and eight drow (leaving the mage and eight drow lo staff the outpost). Use the drow pursuit rules in chapter 2, and assume a pursuit level of 4. DROW PATROL B The characters encounter a drow elite warrior and ld8 drow lighting a hezrou demon. The hezrou has 2dl0 + 45 hit points remaining, while each drow has 2d6 hit points remaining. The drow elite warrior isn't wounded. Without interference, the drow slay the demon, with the drow elite warrior and ld4 - 1 drow surviving the encounter. If the characters get involved, the encounter becomes a three-way fight, as neither the drow nor the demon are interested in forming an alliance. Characters can keep their distance and avoid the altercation. 1 lowevcr, any drow who survive the battle head to the nearest drow outpost ld4 miles away. After hearing the survivors' report, the outpost commander organizes a hunting party to search for the characters, as described in “Drow Patrol A.” DROW PATROL C The characters encounter a draw patrol consisting of a drow mage. 2d4 drow, and a group of slaves. Roll a d8 and consult the Draw Slaves table to determine what slaves are present. Trolls fight to the death: other slaves attempt to flee if all the drow are killed. D R O W S L AVE S d8 Slaves 1-2 3d6 derro (see appendix C) 3-4 3d6 goblins 5-6 3d6 ores 7-8 2d6 quaggoths 9-10 ld6 trolls

DROW PATROL D The characters encounter a drow mage riding on the back of a stone golem carved from stone and shaped like a giant spider. The mage rides in a howdah that provides half cover against attacks from the ground. Escorting the mage are 2d4 drow elite warriors mounted on giant riding lizards (use the statistics at the end of chapter 8). These drow light to the death to protect their territory. Treasure. The spider golem’s eight eyes are six-inchdiameter red crystal orbs worth 1.000 gp each.

M ENZOBERRANZAN Population; 20,000 drow plus thousands of slaves (of various races) Government: Matriarchal theocracy worshiping Lolth. the Demon Queen of Spiders Defense: Large standing army of trained drow warriors and mages, bolstered by armed slaves and magical wards: the citizens of the city create a formidable militia Commerce: Well-trained slaves; various fungi, molds, and exotic creatures for food; poisons, potions, oils, and elixirs; jewelry, perfume, and silk Organizations: The Ruling Council (comprised of the matron mothers of the eight most powerful drow noble houses in the city), the Church of Lolth (based in Arach-Tinilith), Bregan D’acrthe (company of drow spies, mercenaries, and assassins) The City of Spiders is carved out of and built within a great cavern the drow cal! Araurilcaurak, its vault soaring a thousand feet above the stone floor. Drow dwellings and strongholds are carved from massive stalagmites and stalactites, connected with delicatelooking bridges of hardened spider silk and lit with coldly glowing eldritch fires. M E N Z O B E R R A N Z A N : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

The following features can be found throughout the City of Spiders. Light. Most streets and buildings are lit by eldritch green, blue, and violet lights as bright as torches (created with continual fame spells). Other areas are dark. Shielded City. The drow have locked down their city in the wake of Demogorgon's rampage. For the duration of this adventure, creatures can’t teleport into or out of Menzoberranzan. In addition, creatures, objects, and spaces within the city can't be targeted by divination spells or perceived through scrying sensors created by divination spells. The Stone Curse. The “stone curse" is an ancient enchantment woven by the wizards of Sorcere to protect the city from cave-ins. Any character casting earthquake, move earth, or similar magic within the city triggers a reverse gravity spell (save DC 18) centered on the caster, which takes effect before the triggering spell is completed. The reverse gravity lasts for 1 minute, and is accompanied by a peal of thunder that alerts everyone nearby. The caster of the triggering spell must make a successful DC 18 Constitution saving throw to maintain concentration. On a failed check, the triggering spell fails.

CHAPTER 15 I THE CITY OF SPIDERS

191

T H E D A R K D O M I N I O N __________________________

The rock surrounding the city is honeycombed with tunnels and passageways forming the Dark Dominion, a territory claimed by the drow but not part of the cityproper. Home to all manner of Underdark denizens, this maze forms part of Mcnzoberranzan’s defenses as well as its underworld—a dangerous place for dark dealings and clandestine meetings. The Dark Dominion is a great place for random encounters. When it suits you, roll a d20 and consult the Dark Dominion Encounters tabic to determine what the party encounters, or choose an encounter that you like. DARK DOMINION ENCOUNTERS d20

Encounter

1-2

2d4 bugbears

3-4 5

Clandestine meeting ld4 driders

6-10 Drow patrol 11-12 ld4 + 1 drow spore servants (see appendix C) 13-14 Escaped slaves 15-16 1 d4 + 1 goblins 17-19 Glyph of warding 20

ld4 intellect devourers

out of the range of melee weapons. A drider retreats if reduced to 60 hit points or fewer. D ROW P ATROL

The characters encounter a patrol consisting of 2d4 drow led by a drow elite warrior. The patrol stops and questions any non-drow who aren't slaves, as well as drow they deem suspicious. It might take roleplaying or a successful DC 15 Wisdom (Deception or Persuasion) check to convince the patrol not to attack the party. If Grin Ousstyl is with the party, he quietly suggests that the characters offer the drow a bribe of at least 50 gp. If they do, the characters gain advantage on checks made to talk their way past the patrol. Any sign of a large, armed, and potentially hostile group causes the patrol to retreat and seek reinforcements. If the characters remain in the area, the patrol returns with two additional patrols Id 10 minutes later. D ROW S PORE S ERVANTS

These drow became infected with Zuggtmoy’s spores and have transformed into spore servants. They silently observe the party but don't attack the characters unless threatened. E SCAPED S LAVES

B UGBEARS

The bugbears are branded with the mark of a drow house, identifying them as slaves. They try to sneak up on the party and score an easy kill. C LANDESTINE M EETING The party happens upon a

meeting between a drow house representative and some outside business interest. The drow is escorted by ld4 1 bugbear bodyguards. The individual w ith whom the drow is meeting can be any of the following. Duergar Alchemist. This duergar is trying to procure rare alchemical ingredients or equipment (see the “Duergar Alchemist” sidebar in chapter 4 for statistical modifications). Duergar Spy. This duergar from Gracklstugh is trying to bribe a drow for information about who is responsible for the demonic invasion. Human Assassin. This assassin does dirty work for the drow and is being hired to eliminate someone on the surface world. Khalessa Draga. If the characters haven’t already encountered this Lords' Alliance spy, Khalessa (see “March on Menzoberranzan" at the end of chapter 10) is in her drow disguise, buying information of value to the alliance. When she sees the party, she ends her meeting and tries to find out why the characters are here. If the party includes one or more members of the Lords' Alliance, she offers to heip them complete their mission. Otherwise, she is unwilling to break her cover. D RIDERS

These outcasts perch atop high ledges or cling to the high ceiling, attacking with their bows while staying

CHAPTER 15 | THE CITY OF SPIDERS .

A group of ld4 commoners (of any race) attempts to hide from the approaching party. If spotted, they beg the characters for mercy, explaining that they have escaped from their drow masters following “the great demon's rampage" and have been hiding in the tunnels ever since. The slaves can provide the characters with a detailed description of the attack, confirming that the demon lord Demogorgon was behind the destruction. The slaves are desperate to escape from the drow and pitifully grateful for any aid offered. G OBLINS

The goblins beg for food. If the characters give them food or otherwise treat the goblins well, they show the party a secret door that opens into a forgotten tunnel. Roll a dlO and consult the Goblin Tunnel table to determine where the tunnel leads. GOBLIN TUNNEL dlO Tunnel Destination 1-2 Kyorbbiivvin (see “Kyorbblivvin”) 34 A hidden cave containing ld4 mind flayers 5-6 A hidden cave in which the party can rest without having to worry about random encounters 7-8 A hidden cave containing 4d8 goblins and a goblin boss, who will trade a magic item in its possession for the equivalent of 30 days of rations (to determine the item, roll once on Magic Item Table C in chapters of the Dungeon Master’s Guide) 9-10 A trap door near the Bazaar (see “The Bazaar”)

G LYPH

OF

W ARDING

Drow priestesses are fond of placing glyphs of warding in the tunnels surrounding Menzoberranzan. Such a

ArjchTinilith'ttT \ ■ ■! loii sen jUo'Urd1^

*WEST*WAU.'

A TIER

M ENZOBERRANZAN

J

JBRECHE

tT HE'BAZ A'AJU

a.'SKRa*# \.I rhcmdcl

DCTHCLOIM

'HEJBH'AERY 'NARBONDELLYV

NI EASTMYR'

j^DONIGARTEN,

glyph allows drow to pass safely but triggers whenever a non-drow passes by it. A drow glyph of warding has a spell save DC of 13 and an explosive runes effect (see the spell’s description in the Player’s Handbook). I NTELLECT D EVOURERS

Mind flayers like to send intellect devourers into the Dark Dominion in search of hosts, using them as spies to keep an eye on the drow city. These intellect devourers creep up behind the party and use their Devour Intellect attack against party members in the rear of the marching order.

CITY LOCATIONS

Characters who infiltrate Menzoberranzan might find themselves in one or more of the following areas or districts. THE BAZAAR

This 750-foot-wide circle of bare bedrock is a crowded,

untidy labyrinth of stalls, many of which were flattened or torn asunder by Demogorgon. Merchants who survived the attack are slowly returning to the Bazaar

and cleaning up the mess, but little business is happening here at present. Drow commoners go quietly about their business, heads down and hoods drawn, as drow patrols brutally stamp dowrn anything that resembles theft or looting. Characters moving through the Bazaar have at least one encounter with a drow patrol consisting of two drow mounted on giant riding lizards (see the end of chapter 8 for statistics). If one or more party members appear to be anything other than drow' or slaves in the company of its drow master, the patrol immediately calls for reinforcements, which arrive in ld4 rounds. These reinforcements consist of 3d4 drow on foot and 2d4 giant spiders that scuttle down from nearby rooftops. THE BRAERYN

The Braeryn (also known as "the Stenchstrccts") is a shantytown of ramshackle structures overlooking garbage-choked alleyways, inhabited by the dregs of drow society. Fallen priestesses, bankrupt merchants, escaped slaves, and the homeless or maimed are common here, as are visitors to the city who wish to go unnoticed.

The population of the Stenchstreets has swelled in the wake of Demogorgon’s rampage. Drow who have lost homes or businesses find what shelter they can here, scratching out a meager existence among the roughest folk in Menzoberranzan. The Braeryn is a great place to find allies or meet an untimely end. Roll for random encounters as the characters explore this district. You can roll a d20 and consult the Encounters in the Braeryn table, or choose an encounter that you like. The party can avoid random encounters in the Braeryn by succeeding on a DC 15 Dexterity (Stealth) group check. ENCOUNTERS IN THE BRAERYN

d20 Encounter 1-2 ld4 + 2 bugbears 3-8 Drow adolescents 9-10 Drow pickpocket 11-12 3d6 giant wolf spiders 13-14 Infected drow 1516 Mad drow 17-18 1 shield dwarf berserker 19-

20 Svirfneblin lure

B UGBEARS

These bugbears skulk through the streets, murdering lone travelers or small groups for food. If the party outnumbers them, they follow the characters in the hopes that one or more of them become separated from the larger group, whereupon the bugbears attack. D ROW ADOLESCENTS

This roving gang consists of ld6 + 6 drow bandits. If the gang outnumbers the party, the drow attack. Otherwise, they make lewd hand gestures at the party but retreat if accosted. D ROW P ICKPOCKET

This homeless drow commoner tries to pick the pockets of a random party member. The drow has a Sleight of Hand skill modifier of +2. G IANT W OLF S PIDERS

These spiders are hungry and crawl out of buildings or descend from rooftops to attack the party. I NFECTED D ROW

that “Demons will consume you all!" The mad drow wears an amulet made from a dead spider. S HIELD D WARF B ERSERKER

This chaotic neutral dwarf a former slave of the drow sees nonexistent enemies everywhere, swinging his or her greataxe at the empty air. If a character engages the dwarf in battle or conversation, the dwarf attacks. S VIRFNEBLIN L URE

A homeless deep gnome serves as host to an intellect devourer. It tries to lure one or more characters to a “secret enclave where enemies of the drow plot to overthrow Menzoberranzan." A successful DC 15 Wisdom (Insight) check reveals something indcscribabh odd or untrustworthy about the gnome. If the characters follow the possessed gnome, they are led to a cramped cave under a dilapidated building. The cave is the secret lair of another 2d4 intellect devourers. D O N I G A RTE N

Donigarten is the name given a large lake and the surrounding farmland that dominates the eastern part of the cavern. Herds of rothe cattle graze the island at the center of the lake, whose northern and western shores hold broad stretches of slave-tended fungi fields that feed much of Menzoberranzan. The dark, cold waters of the lake have a sinister reputation, dating back to days when notable leaders of the great houses and their honored heroes were cast into the lake, dressed in full regalia and weighed down with stone spars. Many less important drow have been sent by rivals to the bottom of the lake as well, whose depths are suffused with faerzress that makes them impenetrable to scrying and divination spells. Donigarten was spared from Demogorgon’s rampage. Although it is sparsely populated, the area is so vital to the city’s survival that drow patrols are common here. Roll for random encounters as the characters cross this district. You can roll a d20 and consult the Donigarten Encounters table, or choose an encounter that you like. The party can avoid random encounters in Donigarten by succeeding on a DC 11 Dexterity (Stealth) group check. DONIGARTEN ENCOUNTERS

d20 1-5

Encounter Drow patrol

6-8 2d4 + 2 drow spore servants (see appendix C) This drow has been infected with Zuggtmoy’s spores (see chapter 5) and will succumb to the infestation in ldl2 9-10 Escaped slaves 11-14 ld6 + 2 giant wolf spiders hours. Strange fungi has already begun sprouting from the 15-20 Slave farmers draw’s head and limbs. The drow offers a 500 gp gemstone in exchange for the party’s protection and tries to stay as close to the characters as possible, hoping to infect them with his or her spores when the time comes. D ROW P ATROL This patrol consists of two drow mounted on giant riding M AD D ROW lizards (see the end of chapter 8 for statistics). If one or This drow commoner suffers from a form of indefinite more party members appear to be anything other than madness (see “Madness” in chapter 2 of the Dungeon drow or slaves in the company of its drow master, the Master's Guide). The drow believes he or she is the true patrol immediately calls for reinforcements, which arrive voice of Lolth, tasked by the Demon Queen of Spiders to in ld4 + 2 rounds. The reinforcements consist of ld4 admonish everyone for their lack of devotion, warning similar drow patrols. CHAPTER

15 | THE CITY OF SPIDERS

194

D ROW S PORE S ERVANTS

These drow fell prey to Zuggtmoy's spores and were drawn to the fungi fields of Donigarten, where they now roam as a pack, attacking intruders on sight. E SCAPED S LAVES

A group of ld4 commoners (of any race) lied their masters when Demogorgon attacked and took refuge here. The characters find them hiding in the fields or a nearby building. The slaves can provide the characters with a detailed description of the attack, confirming that Demogorgon was behind the destruction. The slaves are desperate to escape from the drow and pitifully grateful for any aid offered. G IANT W OLF S PIDERS

These spiders lurk in burrow's under the spongy ground, leaping out to attack the party as it passes by. Party members with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 17 or higher aren't surprised by the spiders. O RC S LAVE F ARMERS

The drow use orc slaves to farm their fungi fields. The ores pour water into carefully irrigated dung fields, renewing and expanding the fields with w'agonloads of excrement brought in from the city proper. The ores are so disciplined that they can be relied upon to perform their tasks w ith minimal or no supervision. The characters encounter 3d6 ore commoners. The ores are chaotic evil and have darkvision out to a range of 60 feet, but they don't attack draw' or anyone accompanied by a drow. There's a 25 percent chance that ld4 draw' guards are standing w'ithin 120 feet of the ores, quietly resenting the fact that they’ve been assigned to “watch ores till our waste." If the ores come under attack, the draw' rush in to protect them.

■ There is no god or goddess other than Lolth, Arty who follows the dictates of another entity will be slain, preferably as a sacrifice to Lolth. • Ritual worship of any entity other than Lolth is forbidden within the city’s vault. Non-drow who violate this tenet are fined and expelled from the city. Second offenders or any drow who do so are slain. • Slaves have no rights, and there are no limits to the punishments or duties that can be set for them. Treatment of slaves is the affair of their owners. It is a capital offense for a slave to refuse any order from a drow of the house that owns the slave. • A commoner or student of the Academy who refuses to obey a priestess can be punished as the offended priestess sees fit. up to and including death. If the offender is the property of another house and the noble of that house is present and objects, the two must agree on a punishment (usually flogging). • Any drow who falsely wears the colors of another house or who deliberately alters his or her appearance to masquerade as one of a different station will be slain. • Any non-drow who adopts the appearance of a particular drow, a drow of a noble rank, or a drow of a house other than his or her own will be slain, • If it can be proved that two or more houses attacked another house, all the houses that participated in the attack will be destroyed jointly by the remainder.

B REGAN D’ AERTHE S PY

A male drow spy takes an interest in the characters and begins shadowing them, attempting to remain unseen. Characters keeping an eye out for trouble spot the drow with a successful Wisdom (Perception) check contested by the draw’s Dexterity (Stealth) check. The drow is a member of Bregan D’aerthc (see "Unexpected Allies” later in this chapter) and reveals as much if the characters confront him. ff the characters reveal that they’re trying to banish the demon lords back to the Abyss, he offers Bregan D’aerthe’s assistance. If they’re amenable, he leads them to a Bregan D’aerthc safe house until a meeting with Jarlaxle, the leader of PUTHCLOIM________________________________ Bregan D’aerthe. can be arranged. While escorted by the Known commonly as "Manyfolk," the area surrounding spy, the characters have no hostile random encounters. the Bazaar and bordered by the Clawrift to the east is Development. The Bregan D’aerthe safe house is a home to Menzoberranzan’s merchants, tradesfolk, and three-story stone tower guarded by four members of crafters. Dutheloim features small inns, taprooms, and Bregan D’aerthe (male drow elite warriors) and pleasure houses catering to locals, visitors, and highmaintained by one or more freed slaves (use the status drow seeking distraction. Parts of Dutheloim were commoner statistics). While in the safe house, the damaged or destroyed after Demogorgon emerged from characters have no hostile encounters. the Clawrift. Nevertheless, business has been booming as If the characters agree to a meeting with jarlaxle. the drow celebrate Ihe deaths of rivals. Bregan D’aerthe spy tells them that a draw' operative If you wrant a random encounter to occur as the named Krilelyn H’Kar will fetch them when the time characters make their way through the Dutheloim district, comes (see “Private Meetings"). The spy then leaves the roll a d20 and consult the Dutheloim Encounters table, or characters alone. choose an encounter that you like. The party can avoid random encounters in Dutheloim by succeeding on a DC D ROW F OOT P ATROL This patrol consists of 2d4 drow. ff one or more party 13 Dexterity (Stealth) group check. members appear to be anything other than draw' or slaves in the company of its draw' master, the patrol confronts DUTHCLOIM ENCOUNTERS d20 Encounter the party and starts asking questions. If any 1-4 58

Bregan D'aerthe spy Drow foot patrol

9-12 Drow priestess of Lolth 13-16 Spider nest 17-20 Statue of Lolth THE WAY OF LOLTH Menzoberranzan’s principle law is the Way of Lolth. Its tenets are as follows:

CHAPTER 15 | THF, CTTY OF SPIDERS '95

of the answers arouse suspicion or come across as insolent, the drow attack. if combat erupts, reinforcements arrive every ld4 rounds. Each wave of reinforcements consists of 2d4 drow plus ld4 giant spiders that crawl down from rooftops. D ROW P RIESTESS

OF

L OLTH

A drow priestess of Loith accompanied by a drow elite warrior and 2d4 drow is out surveying damaged sections of the city. Merchants and crafters who confront the priestess, claiming to have lost everything in Demogorgon's attack, are banished to the Braelyn. Locals driven mad by the demonic invasion are brought before the priestess and put to death. If the characters approach the priestess claiming to have vital information about the demon attack, they can, with a successful DC 20 Charisma (Persuasion) check, convince the priestess to escort them to Matron Mother Quenthel Baenre (see “Private Meetings” later in this chapter). If the check fails by 5 or more, the priestess and her escort attack the party. S PIDER N EST

The characters stumble upon a spiders' nest containing 4d6 giant spider eggs with soft, sticky shells. Each egg weighs 20 pounds and has AC 6 and 1 hit point. Disturbing the eggs attracts ld4 giant spiders, which descend from nearby rooftops to defend the nest. S TATUE

OF

L OLTH

See “Duthcloim” for more information. C ULT

OF

“Y”

Eastmyr has become a haven for a group of drow driven mad by Demogorgon’s rampage. These drow carve the symbol of Demogorgon—a Y with curled ends—into their palms and foreheads, and they can hear the twin voices of the Prince of Demons talking to them, telling them that they will rise from the dregs of drowr society to greatness once the nobility is cast down. The characters encounter a group of ld4 + 4 drow cultists wearing cloaks and cowls in the midst of kidnapping a low-ranking drow noble. If the characters kill four or more cultists, the rest flee like rats. Sounds of combat attract the attention of a drow foot patrol (see "Duthcloim" for more information), which arrives in ld6 rounds. Any cultists that escape flee to a crumbling tenement a block away that the cult has converted into a shrine to Demogorgon. The shrine contains ld4 shadow demons as well as 2d4 drow cultists. each of whom has a “second head” (in the form of a severed drow head on a pole) that the cultist has lashed to his or her body. Painted in wet blood on the shrine's floor is a familiar “Y” symbol. Development. The drow noble offers no reward to his or her rescuers and chastises the drow patrol for not arriving sooner. If the characters demand a reward, the noble frowns and gives them an insignia bearing the mark of his or her house, then instructs the characters to visit the noble’s estate "when the light of Narbondel reaches its zenith" to receive their “reward.” If the characters visit the noble’s estate in Narbondellyn at the appointed time, they are set upon by the house guards, who have orders to eliminate them and dispose of the remains (see “Narbondellyn” for more information on drow noble estates).

The characters stumble upon a 9-foot-tall statue of Lolth depicted in her drow form. There is a 25 percent chance that the statue was toppled during Demogorgon’s rampage, in which case it lies in pieces on the ground. If an intact statue is touched by a non-drow or otherwise defiled, the statue opens its mouth and disgorges a swarm of insects (spiders). These spiders crawl down the statue and attack whoever touched or defiled the D ROW F OOT P ATROL statue. Once the statue disgorges a swarm, its mouth closes, and it can’t release another swarm until 1 hour has See “Duthcloim" for more information. passed. S CROLL

FROM

N ARBONDEL ’ S S HADOW

A cloaked half-drow spy named Shinzi approaches the EASTMYR characters when they are alone and gives them a scroll Eastmyr bridges the gap between prosperous Duthcloim bearing an advertisement for Narbondel’s Shadow, the and the down-and-out despair of the Braeryn. It is home “finest rooming house in Menzoberranzan.” If the party to common merchants, tradesfolk, mercenaries, and includes non-drow. Shinzi says that non-drow are “more crafters either making their way up the social ladder or than welcome at the Shadow.” The advertisement doesn't trying to slow the downward descent of shifting fortunes. list any prices, but on the back of the scroll is a map Though this area suffered relatively little damage during marking the location of the rooming house in northeastern Demogorgon’s rampage, its population has swelled with Eastmyr, near the Clawrift. formerly high-profile drow forced out of their homes and Development. Narbondel's Shadow, which wasn't holdings. damaged during Demogorgon's rampage, offers some of If you want a random encounter to occur as the the best food and lodging money can buy. but the cost is characters make their way through the Eastmyr district, high: 25 gp per night, per person. A strongheart roll a d20 and consult the Eastmyr Encounters table, or choose an encounter that you like. The party can avoid random encounters in Eastmyr by succeeding on a DC 15 Dexterity (Stealth) group check. EASTMYR ENCOUNTERS

d20 Encounter 1-5

Bregan D’aerthe spy 610 Cult of "Y" 11-15 Drow foot patrol 1620 Scroll from Narbondel’s Shadow

B REGAN D’ AERTHE S PY CHAPTER 15 | THE CTTY OF SPIDERS

196

B LACK P UDDING

Thanks to the growing influence of Juiblex, this ooze has an Intelligence of 6 (-2). It uses its newfound intelligence to hide inside a bloated, hollowcd-out giant mushroom. Characters can see viscid black goo oozing from the mushroom’s stalk. Disturbing the mushroom causes the pudding to burst forth and attack.

halfling commoner named Dalfred Noakes owns and runs the establishment. Dalfred had a violent encounter with a young Hunzrin noble, which left him scarred and without his left ear. He has never forgotten nor forgiven the noble. To this day, he uses a small cave system that D ROW S PORE S ERVANTS doesn't connect with the Dark Dominion to smuggle These drow fell prey to Zuggtmoy's spores and were goods and hide people fleeing angry drow nobles. If the characters look like they could use his help, Dalfred does drawn to the fungi fields of Kyorbblivvin. where they now roam as a pack, attacking intruders on sight. whatever he can to assist them. The orphaned daughter of a drow merchant and a human slave, Shinzi was adopted by Dalfred and is one of E LITE D ROW F OOT P ATROL his many spies. She has darkvision out to a range of 60 feet, as well as the Fey Ancestry and Innate Spellcasting or slaves in the company of such a drow, the patrol features of a drow (see the “Statistical Modifications to attacks. Each drow carries a horn that it can blow (as Drow NPCs” sidebar). However, she doesn’t have the an action) to summon reinforcements. The first wave Sunlight Sensitivity feature. of reinforcements arrives in ld4 +- 4 rounds and consists of another 2d4 elite drow warriors. The KYORBBLIVVIN second wave arrives after ten minutes and consists Kyorbblivvin is a spider-haunted forest of giant of 3d 6 elite drow warriors mounted on giant riding mushrooms that spreads across the northern portion of the lizards (see the end of chapter 8 for statistics). Qu'ellarz'orl plateau. Members of the great houses use Kyorbblivvin as a private hunting domain. Drow warriors patrol the forest, alert for poachers and intruders. Check for random encounters in Kyorbblivvin once every hour. Roll a d20 and consult the Kyorbblivvin Encounters table to determine what, if anything, the characters encounter. The party can avoid random encounters in Kyorbblivvin by succeeding on a DC 15 Dexterity (Stealth) group check. KYORBBLIVVIN ENCOUNTERS d20 1-10 11 12 13

Encounter No encounter 1 black pudding 3d6 drow spore servants (see appendix C) Elite drow foot patrol

14 15 16

Exotic fungi ld4 giant spiders ld4 gricks

17 18

Hunting party 1 shrieker

19

3d6 stirges ld4 -t-1 violet fungi

20

E XOTIC F UNGI

The characters find a patch of exotic fungi (see “Fungi of the Underdark” in chapter 2). Roll a d6 and consult the Exotic Fungi table to determine what they find. EXOTIC FUNGI

d6 1 unlit) 2 3 4 5 6

Fungi ld6 nightlights (50 percent chance they are 2d6 ld6 2d6 ld6 3d6

Nilhogg’s noses patches of ormu timmasks tongues of madness torchstalks

G IANT S PIDERS

There is a 50 percent chance that the giant spiders have a nest nearby (see “Duthcloim” earlier in this section). In addition to the eggs, characters find a ld4 - 1 manshaped cocoons containing the exsanguinated corpses of escaped slaves (of any race). G RICKS

Drow nobles unleash these creatures in the forest and hunt them for sport. The gricks fight until slain.

This patrol consists of 2d4 drow elite warriors. If one or more party members appear to be anything other than drow belonging to one of the eight ruling houses. CHAPTER 15 I THE CITY OF SPIDERS "97

COMMON DROW PHRASES The following are a few key drow phrases you can use when roleplaying dark elves, Oloth plynn dos! (“Darkness take you!”), a common drow curse. Ssussan! (“Light!"), another drow curse. Xan izil dos phuul quortheri, lueth dro. (“Do as you are ordered, and live.”) Lolth tin matta. ("Lolth be praised.") Lil alnrl velve zhah HI velkyn nss. (“The best knife is an unseen one.”) Khaless nan ass. (“Trust no one.")

N A R B O N D E L LYN _____________________

The estates of the various drow houses are clustered beneath the plateau of Qu'ellarz’orl in an area called Narbondellyn. allowing the superiors of those drow to literally look down upon them. Largely untouched during Demogorgon’s rampage, the so-called “Broad Streets" district remains the bright center of Menzoberranzan. as the lesser houses vie to outdo each other in shows of wealth, power, and influence. Soaring stalagmite towers and great manors rise across the area, which is also home to luxury shops, pleasure houses, and discriminating HUNT ING PARTY merchants. The characters happen upon a group of ld4 + 2 drow A noble estate in Narbondellyn maintains its own from one of the eight ruling houses that live atop the militia, consisting of fifty or more highly disciplined drow plateau. These "lesser nobles" wear the insignia of their warriors and drow elite warriors, with one elite warrior for house and are hunting gricks for sport. They try to make every ten drow warriors. I n addition, an estate holds 3d6 short work of any trespassers they encounter. Roll a d8 drow nobles and scores of slaves. and consult the Drow Ruling Houses table to determine 6d6 of which can be pressed into defending the house. which house they belong to. If the result is House These fighting slaves are usually bugbears, ogres, ores, or Do’Urden, the drow are actually Bregan D’aerthe initiates quaggoths. Doors and windows are protected with glyph of on a training exercise (see “House Do’Urden” later in this warding spells (spell save DC 13), and 2d6 gargoyles chapter). watch for trouble from ledges and rooftops. If you want a random encounter to occur as the DROW RULING HOUSES characters make their way through the Narbondellyn d8 House district, roll a d20 and consult die Narbondellyn Encounters table, or choose an encounter that you like. 1 Baenre The party can avoid random encounters in Narbondellyn 2 Barrison Del'Armgo by succeeding on a DC 13 Dexterity (Stealth) group 3 Faen Tlabbar check. 4 Mizzrym 5 6 7 8

Fey- Branche

Melarn Vandree

Do'Urden

SHRIEKER

NARBONDELLYN ENCOUNTERS

d20 Encounter 1-3 Beholder 47 Bregan D'aerthe mercenaries 8-12 Elite drow patrol 13-16 Noble entourage 17- 20 Statue of Lolth

The shrieking of this fungus might attract other nearby creatures, which arrive in 2d4 rounds. Roll again on the Kyorbblivvin Encounters table to determine what, if anything, shows up Treat an “exotic fungi” encounter as "no encounter.”

B EHOLDER

S TIRGES

B REGAN D’ AERTHE M ERCENARIES Bregan D'aerthe was

These bloodsucking pests lair in the cap of a giant mushroom, fluttering out to attack when they detect light or motion within 20 feet of their roost.

This monster is passing through the city. The drow give it a wide berth.

instrumental in driving the demons out of Menzoberranzan. Since the incursion, Bregan D’aerthe mercenaries have taken to patrolling the streets of the wealthier districts, accepting payments from drow nobles V IOLET F UNGI for the added security. These fungi extrude their branches and attack when the The characters encounter a group of 3d4 male drow characters pass between them. elite warriors all members of Bregan D’aerthe. Unlike most drow patrols, this group is gregarious and NARBONDEL jovial. The mercenaries stop the characters to ask their The most dominant feature within the city, Narbondel is a business, but more to alleviate boredom than to throw their weight around. Unless the characters brazenly 1,000-foot-tall column of rock that helps support the cavern ceiling. At the same time each day, the city’s Arch declare their intention to attack a noble house, the Bregan mage (or a representative from Sorcere) magically heats D'aerthe leader flips them a platinum coin and cheerfully Narbondel's base, causing the stone to glow. The hand of sends them on their way after concluding his “interrogation.” warm light rises slowly up the column to mark the passage of time, taking twenty-four hours to reach the top. The Archmage of Menzoberranzan, Gromph Baenre. has fled the city in Ihe wake of Demogorgon’s attack, leaving the task of lighting Narbondel to a host of other wizards.

CHAPTER 15 I THE CITY OF SPIDERS

198

The Bregan D’aerthe leader carries a gem-studded minotaur horn. If the characters attack the mercenaries, the leader blows his horn, which can be heard throughout the district. All noble houses go on high alert as reinforcements arrive every round for the next Id8 rounds. Each wave of reinforcements consists of an elite drow patrol (see below) and U14 gargoyles. Treasure. The gem-studded horn carried by the Bregan D'aerthe leader is worth 2,500 gp. In addition, each drow mercenary has a pouch containing 2dl0 pp. E LITE D ROW P ATROL

This patrol consists of two drow elite warriors mounted on giant riding lizards (see the end of chapter 8 for statistics). If one or more party members appear to be anything other than drow or slaves in the company of its drow master, the patrol immediately calls for reinforcements, which arrive in U14 + 2 rounds. The reinforcements consist of ld4 similar drow patrols. N OBLE E NTOURAGE

The characters encounter a drow noble traveling with eight drow warriors bearing the symbol and colors of their noble house. There is a 25 percent chance that a succubus or incubus accompanies the noble in drow form, and a 75 percent chance that the noble is being carried around in a palanquin by unarmed slaves. Roll a d6 and consult the Drow House Slaves table to determine what kind of slaves and how many.

QU’ELLARZ ’ORL

Untouched by Demogorgon's rampage, the high southern plateau of Menzoberranzan is home to many of the oldest and greatest noble houses, with House Baenre situated at the plateau’s highest point, to the east. At the west end of Qu’ellarz'orl is a small cavern containing a sculpted stalagmite tower. Within this tower rests the Chamber of the Ruling Council, where the matron mothers of the eight great drow houses gather and meet. Each noble estate in Qu’ellarz'orl maintains its own militia, consisting of several hundred highly disciplined drow warriors and drow elite warriors, with one elite warrior for every ten drow warriors. In addition, an estate holds 3dl2 drow nobles and scores of slaves, lOdlO ofwhich can be pressed into defending the house These fighting slaves are usually bugbears, ogres, orogs. or quaggoths. Doors and windows are protected with glyph of warding spells (spell save DC 13). and cither 3d6 gargoyles or 3d6 giant spiders watch for trouble from ledges and rooftops. These gargoyles and giant spiders have truesight out to a range of 120 feet, enabling them to spot invisible trespassers. Roll for random encounters as the characters cross this district. You can roll a d20 and consult the Qu'ellarz’orl Encounters table, or choose an encounter that you like. The party can avoid random encounters in Qu'ellarz'orl by succeeding on a DC 15 Dexterity (Stealth) group check. QU’ELLARZ’ORL ENCOUNTERS d 20 Encounter 1-5 Elite drow patrol 68 2d4 gargoyles 9-10 ld6 + 2 giant wolf spiders 11-14 Groundskeepers 15-20 Slave parade

DROW HOUSE SLAVES d6 Slaves 1-2 6 shield dwarf commoners 3-4 6 moon elf commoners 56 6 human commoners

Treasure. Each noble carries a pouch that contains 2d

10 pp and wears ld3 pieces of fine jewelry worth 250 gp each. Development. If the characters do anything to antagonize the nobles, they order their guards to attack. If the guards are defeated, the nobles offer the party a bribe in exchange for iheir lives.

E LITE D ROW P ATROL

This patrol consists of two drow elite warriors mounted on giant riding lizards (see the end of chapter 8 for statistics). If one or more party members appear to be anything other than drow of one of the eight ruling houses, or slaves in the company of such a drow, the patrol calls for reinforcements, which arrive in ld4 2 rounds and consist of ld4 similar drow patrols.

S TATUE OF L OLTH

See ‘‘Dutheloim” for more information. DROW RULING HOUSES OF M E N Z O B E R R A N Z A N Rank 1

2 3 4 5 6 7 8

House Baenre Barrison Del'Armgo Faen Tlabbar Mizzrym Fey-Branchs Melarn Vandree Do'Urden

Matron Mother Quenthel Baenre Mez'Barris Armgo Vadalma Tlabbar MizTi Mizzrym Byrtyn Fey Zhindia Melarn Fiirnel'ther Vandree Dahlia Sin'felle

Notes Controls all three branches of the Academy (see "Tier Brecbe”) Has the largest number oftrained wizards and mercenaries-for-hire Fanatically devoted to Lolth Dominates Menzoberranzan's slave trade Skilled at forging alliances Devoted to rooting out drow apostates, particularly within the nobility Vicious and vindictive house determined to rise to the top Newly resurrected and disgraced vassal house under the firm control of House Baenre, with Dahlia (a moon elf prisoner) as its figurehead

CHAPTER 15

I THE

CITY OF SPIDERS

■99

OLD ENEMIES

It is possible that the adventurers’ drow jailers or pursuers from Velkynvelve (chapter 1) managed to survive to this point in the campaign, and that they have returned to Menzoberranzan in the wake of Demogorgon’s attack and the ongoing chaos. If so, they might be on hand for an unfortunate encounter with the party. If you are looking to throw a twist into the events in the City of Spiders, having an old foe turn up at the least opportune moment to denounce the characters as escaped prisoners and enemies of the drow could well be it. ----------------------------------------------------------------------------w G ARGOYLES

These creatures are loyal to House Baenre and have magically bestowed truesight out to a range of 120 feet. As they fly over the plateau, they keep a watchful eye on everyone and everything. However, they don't attack unless House Baenre's holdings are in jeopardy. If the characters drawn attention to themselves, the gargoyles fly back to House Bacnrc and report what they’ve seen. Matron Mother Quenthel Baenre, believing that the characters arc potentially of use to her. dispatches eight elite drow patrols (see above) to bring them to her at once. If the characters allow themselves to be brought before the^nost powerful individual in the

s'L.

____

city, see the “Private Meetings” section for tips on how to roleplay the encounter with Matron Mother Quenthel. GIANT WOLF SPIDERS

These spiders lurk in burrows beneath the gardens, leaping out to attack the party as it passes by. Party members with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 17 or higher aren't surprised by the spiders. G ROUNDSKEEPERS

The characters happen upon ld8 drow commoners tending the decorative fungi fields and gardens that surround the various noble estates. These drow are lowranking members of their house. They give strangers unpleasant looks but pose little threat. There is a 25 percent chance that one of the drow groundskeepers is actually a young drow noble who's being punished for some infraction or political misstep. This noble is bold enough to approach the characters and demand to know their business. The noble also seizes any opportunity to reverse his or her recent misfortune, perhaps by rooting out enemy spies or using the characters to dispose of a rival. This noble is treacherous, however, and doesn’t make good on any promises or bribes. •

S LAVE P ARADE

To impress its neighbors and rivals, one of the ruling houses organizes a parade of its choicest slaves. The characters encounter the parade as it meanders along the boulevards of Qu'cllarz’orl. Dozens of naked and chained slaves form the parade, their bodies painted with dyes and perfumes. Leading the slave parade is a drow noble, while order is maintained by 4d6 drow warriors in full ceremonial house regalia. THE RIFTS

Three large chasms score the floor of the cavern of Menzoberranzan. C LAWRIFT

The Clawrift's uncharted depths have long been rumored to extend into the Abyss. This legend was seemingly proven true when the demon lord Demogorgon emerged from the Clawrift, obliterating the rope bridges that once extended across it. Bregan D'aerthe spies are assessing the damage from their base in a ruined drow compound overlooking the Clawrift. (The compound was once House Oblodra, a powerful drow house that was destroyed by Lolth over one hundred years ago during the Time of Troubles.) M ISTRIFT

This long gorge at the city's center earned its name from the rolling clouds of steam that forever billow up from below. A number of subterranean streams flow out of the Mistrift’s vertical walls, their icy waters cascading down into the darkened void below. Half a mile down, the runoff collects in an ancient aquifer, its waters superheated by an adjacent magma flow. Arcane watermills collect water from the falls, diverting it to an underground cistern that the drow can tap into. W ESTRIFT

The newest of the city’s large clefts, Westrift swallowed up three drow houses and a score of lesser dwellings when it opened its yawning maw three centuries ago. fn more recent years, the rift has become home to hundreds of giant arachnitis, which have filled much of the cleft with their webs and nests—to the extent that anyone falling into the rift has a 75 percent chance of being caught in a web. taking no damage from the fall but attracting ld4 + 1 hungry giant spiders. See "Dungeon Hazards" in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master's Guide for rules on escaping webs. Characters entering Menzoberranzan by means of Vizeran DeVir’s secret tunnel come to a secret door that pulls open to reveal a narrow ledge 60 feet below the lip of the rift. Characters can scale the cleft wall with a successful DC 10 Strength (Athletics) check, as there are abundant handholds. Any character who fails the check by 5 or more falls.

TIER BRECHE______________________ The Great Starr of Tier Breche rises from the floor of Menzoberranzan to the cavern housing the three branches of the Academy: Melee-Magthere.

a pyramid-shaped edifice where draw warriors arc trained; Arach-Tinilith, a spider-shaped cathedral where drow priestesses worship their demon goddess; and Sorcere. a magnificent tower where drow mages learn to master the magical arts. Non-drow are forbidden from entering this part of the city. The stone steps are some three hundred feet wide and rise nearly the same distance. A pair of giant jade spiders flanks the stairway at the top, ready to animate to attack non-drow that climb the steps. The two jade spiders have the statistics of stone golems with the following statistical modifications: • The jade spiders have 250 hit points each. • They have a climbing speed of 30 feet. • They have truesight out to a range of 120 feet. Roll for random encounters as the characters explore the Academy grounds. You can roll a d20 and consult the Tier Breche Encounters table, or choose an encounter that you like. The party can avoid random encounters by succeeding on a DC 17 Dexterity (Stealth) group check. Sounds of battle are common at the Academy; however, drow guards are trained to tell the difference between training exercises and the sound of real combat. The latter attracts reinforcements in the form of ld4 elite drow warriors every round until the perceived threat is eliminated. TIER BRECHE ENCOUNTERS

d20

Encounter

1-6 Draw acolytes 7—12 Drow mages 13-20 Drow warriors D ROW ACOLYTES

The. characters encounter 2d6 female drow acolytes out for a walk. There is a 25 percent chance that a drow priestess of Lolth is with them, filling the young devotees’ heads with wisdom and instructing them on the Way of Lolth (see "The Way of Lolth” sidebar). If they come under attack, the acolytes withdraw to ArachTinilith while the priestess stands her ground. D ROW M AGES

The characters encounter ld3 drow mages out for a walk. There is a 50 percent chance that these mages are members of the Council of Spiders and of a mind to help the characters infiltrate Sorcere, should the characters reveal that they are in league with Vizeran DeVir. These mages offer to cast greater invisibility spells on visible characters and escort the party to Gromph’s sanctum in the tower. As long as the characters are under the protection of these mages, they have no hostile encounters until they enter Gromph’s sanctum (see "Sorcere" for details). DROW WARRIORS

The characters encounter 4d6 drow warriors on a training exercise. There is a 50 percent chance that ld4 drow elite warriors are with them, providing instruction and discipline. If they spot non-drow on Academy grounds, the drow try to kill any intruder. CHAPTER 15 | THE CITY OF SPIDERS .... 201

W E S T W A L L ___________________________________

West Wall (also called “the Old Quarter”) is a primarily residential neighborhood. Largely untouched by Demogorgon's assault on the city, West Wall is a quiet district, as its residents like to keep their dark schemes and vile indulgences behind closed doors. Amid the twisted streets and quiet mansions of West Wall stand scores of stone monuments dedicated to important figures and moments in the city's history, as well as numerous statues and graven images of Lolth. Between West Wall and Narbondellyn is a residential neighborhood called Lolth’s Web. Its residents built their homes upward, crafting streets of magically calcified strands of spider silk from the cavern floor to the vaulted roof above. Hollow, cocoon-like dwellings are constructed both above and below the layers of webbing. Roll for random encounters as the characters cross this district. You can roll a d20 and consult the West Wall Encounters table, or choose an encounter that you like. The party can avoid random encounters in West Wall by succeeding on a DC 13 Dexterity (Stealth) group check. WEST WALL ENCOUNTERS

d20 1-3

Encounter Bandersnatches

4-7

Bregan D'aerthe spy Drow foot patrol 15-17 Slave abuse

8-14

18-20 Statue of Lolth

B ANDERSNATCHES

The characters draw the unwanted attention of the Bander snatches, a gang of young, demon-worshiping drow who. in the wake of Demogorgon’s attack, are eager to create further unrest in the city. Gang members send coded messages to one another by tapping hollow rocks together, creating eerie clicking sounds that echo throughout the otherwise quiet neighborhood. Initially, ld4 drow bandits follow the party, scuttling through dark alleys and across web-strung rooftops while tapping their stones, urging more gang members to converge on the party’s location. At the end of each round of clicking stones, another ld4 drow bandits appear. If the number of gang members grows to twenty or more, the bandits surround the party and demand payment of 100 gp per party member for safe passage. If the characters kill four or more bandits, the rest flee before a drow patrol (see below) shows up. Development. The consequence of killing one or more bandits is retaliation. The gang organizes a hunting party to find and kill one party member for every gang member slain. This hunting party is bold enough to leave the West Wall district, and you might have the Bandersnatches try to ambush the characters as they make their way out of Mcnzoberranzan. The hunting party consists of the gang’s leader, her quasit advisor, and thirty drow bandits. The leader of the Bandersnatches is a capricious and nihilistic female drow named Viln Tirin. She has the statistics of a bandit captain with the following modifications: • Viln is chaotic evil and has drow features (see the CHAPTER 15 | THE CITY OF SPIDERS

202

“Statistical Modifications to Drow IS PCs" sidebar). • She wields a scimitar of speed and can make one attack with it as a bonus action on her turn. All of Viln’s attacks with the weapon are +7 to hit and deal 8 (ld6 + 5) slashing damage on a hit. • Viln carries four daggers coated with purple worm poison (see “Poisons" in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide). The poison on a dagger's blade is good for one hit only, whether the poison takes effect or not. • She has a challenge rating of 5 (1,800 XP). B REGAN D’ AERTHE S PY

See “Duthcloim” for more information. D ROW F OOT P ATROL

This patrol consists of 2d4 drow. if one or more party members appear to be anything other than drow or slaves in the company of its drow master, the patrol confronts the party and starts asking questions. If any of the answers arouse suspicion or come across as insolent, the drow attack. S LAVE ABUSE

The characters see a drow noble flogging one of a handful of slaves (commoners of any race) while ld4 bugbear bodyguards keep an eye out for trouble. Unless the characters intervene, the merciless noble has the slave dragged to the Westrift and unceremoniously tossed into it. The poor slave falls 3d6 x 10 feet before being caught in a web and cocooned by a giant spider (to be devoured later). If the characters come to the slave’s defense, the bugbears attack them. S TATUE OF L OLTH

See “Duthcloim” for more information.

U NEXPECTED A LLIES

As hostile as Menzoberranzan seems to outsiders, there are powerful figures within the city who want the demon lords expelled from the Underdark and are willing to help the characters accomplish this goal. H O U S E B A E N R E ________________________________

The matron mother of House Baenre is the voice of Lolth in Menzoberranzan, and despite recent events, maintains absolute control of the city. Quenthcl knows how Demogorgon made his way from the Abyss to the City of Spiders. She wasn't surprised to learn that her brother Gromph—the Archmage of Menzoberranzan— was hehind it, for she’s seen evidence of his growing unhappiness in recent months, and she also knows that Lolth was behind it. Quenthel assumes that Lolth is making some sort of power play in the Abyss. If Quenthel learns that adventurers are trying to rid the Lndcrdark of its demon lord menace, she doesn't stand in their way (see “Private Meetings”) and even allows them to travel through the city unmolested.

B R E G A N D ’ A E RTH E ____________________________

demon lords into the Underdark, and no one claims

Bregan D'aerthe is a mercenary company with more power and influence in Menzoberranzan than all the lesser noble houses combined. Bregan D'aerthe benefits from its close ties with House Baenre. The company's founder and leader. Jarlaxlc, is brother to both Matron Mother Quenthel Baenre and Archmage Gromph Baenre, though this fact isn’t widely known. Jarlaxlc doesn’t care what the demon lords do in the Underdark, but he's worried about the future of Menzoberranzan as well as his secret holdings on the surface world. He wants to know how the demon lords arrived and how to send them back, and members of Bregan D'aerthe will support characters who claim to have those answers. COUNCIL

OF

S P I D E R S ___________________________

Many drow wizards have long sought a means of increasing their power and influence, frustrated that the arcane arts are viewed as secondary to the divine magic of Lolth’s priestesses. A secret cabal of noble wizards calling itself the Council of Spiders works to see wizards represented on the Ruling Council overturning thousands of years of tradition while remaining true to Lolth’s will. The disappearance of Gromph Baenre and the involvement of Vizeran DeVir in fending off the demonic invasion offers wizards of the council an unparalleled opportunity to advance their agenda. Vizeran has cultivated his role as a patron and ally of the council to gain influence among its members—while giving them no hint of his desire to destroy the draw’s obsessive worship of Lolth. Vizeran has told council members that adventurers are helping him banish Lhe demon lords back to the Abyss, and that they might come to Menzoberranzan seeking lore from Gromph’s sanctum in Sorcerc. The council stands ready to disable the magical wards on the tower, should this come to pass.

P RIVATE M EETINGS If House Baenre and Bregan D’aerthe get wind of the party's presence in the city, the characters are confronted by drow tasked with escorting them to a private meeting with the leader of each faction. Jarlaxlc sends a devilishly charming and sarcastic male drow elite warrior named Krilelyn H'Kar, tasked with leading characters to the ruins of House Do’Urden in the West Wall district. Matron Mother Quenthel Baenre sends thirty dour drow elite warriors mounted on giant riding lizards (see the end of chapter 8 for statistics), with six gargoyles providing aerial support. They have orders to escort the party to House Baenre atop Qu’ellarz'orl. M ATR O N M O T H E R Q U E N T H E L B A E N R E ____________________________

Matron Mother Quenthel Baenre is absolutely loyal to Lolth. but she has suspected for some time that her brother Gromph is not. The archmage has been missing since the disastrous summoning ritual that pulled the

CHAPTER 15 i THE CITY OF SPIDERS

Council of Spiders Mace

to know his whereabouts. The matron mother and her closest allies have carefully covered up the truth about Gromph's disappearance, proclaiming that the archmage is hard at work investigating the demonic invasion and seeking the means to send the demon lords back to the Abyss. Quenthel doesn't know if Gromph is alive or dead. She knows only that she can’t hide his disappearance forever—even as she must ensure that no damage comes to her house as a result of his actions. Quenthel doesn't care that the adventurers are fighting to send the demon lords back to the Abyss, or that Menzoberranzan might suffer under another demon lord assault. She's concerned only about House Baenre. By the matron mother’s addled logic, Lolth is using the demon lords to test the strength of House Baenre and lay waste to the enemies of the drow. However, the matron mother doesn't want Gromph’s spell or damning evidence of his actions falling into the wrong hands. Whether the characters are brought in by force or arrive willingly, read the following when they meet Quenthel Baenre. A vast web of heavy metallic strands forms a kind of fence around a sprawling compound of structures laid out on the plateau at the top of Menzoberranzan's great cavern. Dozens of massive stalagmites and stalactites have been carved and shaped into towers, girded with balconies and walkways, and connected with delicate- looking ramps and bridges, All the compound is lit with blazing light in pale shades of violet, green, and blue. Dozens of drow warriors are stationed on the overlooks and walkways, ever vigilant as they watch your approach.

When the characters are taken into the compound, the matron mother welcomes them in her throne room- a

CHAPTER 15 i THE CITY OF SPIDERS

massive chamber that occupies the entire fourth level of one tower. She sits upon a throne carved from a single black sapphire, with large diamonds set into its arms shedding light at the matron's command. Quenthel doesn’t know that Vizeran DeVir is still alive, and any mention of him piques her interest, although she doesn't consider him a threat. After Gromph disappeared, she sent underlings to Sorcere to rid his sanctum of any incriminating evidence. They found none. The matron mother doesn't know about Gromph's secret inner sanctum or the grimoire hidden there. If the characters explain the broad strokes of their goal to get the grimoire out of the city. Quenthel allows and supports their mission—even as she secretly plans to manufacture evidence that the adventurers were behind the ritual that brought the demon lords to the Underdark if they are caught with the grimoire in their possession. She grants permission for the characters to enter Sorcere and instructs the tower's inhabitants not to impede their investigation. As a Chosen of Lolth, Quenthel Baenre is, by herself, a threat comparable to any demon lord. Surrounded by the well-trained guards and magical wards of House Baenre, she could annihilate the adventurers without breaking a sweat. If the characters attack her, use the statistics of the drow priestess of Lolth with the following modifications: • Quenthel has an Armor Class of 19 (+3 scale mail) and 132 (24d8 + 24) hit points. • She has an Intelligence of 18 (+4) and a Wisdom of 20 (+5). Her saving throw' bonuses are as follows: Con +8, Wis +12, Cha +11. Her skill bonuses are as follows: Insight +12, Perception +12, Religion +11, Stealth +9. • She’s an 20th-level spellcaster who can cast any cleric spell up to 9th level at will (save DC 20, +12 to hit with spell attacks). • She wields a tentacle rod. • While seated on her throne, Quenthel can use an action on her turn to cast disintegrate (save DC 19). A target that fails its saving throw takes 10d6 + 40 force damage. If this damage reduces the target to 0 hit points, it is disintegrated. • She has a challenge rating of 22 (41,000 XP). XP A WARDS If the party gains the support of Quenthel Baenre. award each character 2,000 XP. JARLAXLE BAENRE

OF

B RE GAN D’AERTHE _______________ The dashing and dapper commander of the Bregan D’acrthe mercenary company. Jarlaxle Baenre is a drow warrior with centuries of experience. A nonconformist in a culture where failure to conform usually means death or exile, he has learned to walk the line between being too defiant to be part of drow society and being too useful to get rid of. In addition to witnessing first hand the destruction

204

CHAPTER 15 I THE CITY OF SPIDERS

wrought in Menzoberranzan, Jarlaxle understands the terrible implications of the demon lords’ arrival in the Underdark, and he knows that his brother Gromph is responsible. Jarlaxle knows that Gromph is hiding in the city of Luskan on the Sword Coast, but he doesn't share this information under any circumstances. Jarlaxle has eyes and ears everywhere in Menzoberranzan, and he takes an interest in the adventurers particularly if they travel with Grin Ousstyl. If the characters agree to meet with Jarlaxle in House Do'Urden. read the follow'ing when they first arrive.

i,

• A drow house stands alone and forlorn with its back against the west wall of Menzoberrarzan’s great vault. Its towers are dark, its walls crumbling and in desperate need of repair. The old fortress has the countenance of a haunted ruin, but here and there you glimpse signs of life: drow in black leather armor standing guard in the shadows and magical flames dancing in the stone braziers that flank the entrance. As you are led inside, a pillared hall strewn with broken statuary looms all around you. Leaning against a cracked pillar is a drow with an eyepatch and a wide-brimmed hat. A saber hangs from his hip, and he cuts a dashing figure. “Well met!" he says with a smile.

.I

When Matron Mother Quenthel Baenre resurrected House Do’Urden, she ordered her brother Jarlaxle to look after the long-abandoned Do'Urden estate. He now uses the ruined drow house as a Bregan D’aerthe base. Most of the house is off-limits to visitors, and Jarlaxle won’t allow the characters to stay long. Jarlaxle doesn’t want the demon lords rampaging through the Underdark or making it to the surface world. If the characters reveal that their ultimate goal is to send the demon lords back to the Abyss, Jarlaxle gives them whatever aid he can short of doing their "dirty work” for them. If the characters mention Vizeran DeVir. Jarlaxle's interest is piqued, for he thought Vizeran was dead. He warns them not to trust that “relit of a bygone house.” If the characters mention Vizeran's plan to make Menzoberranzan the site for the final showdown with the demon lords, Jarlaxle insists that the characters choose a different battleground, warning them that Bregan D’aerthe will oppose any effort to visit further destruction upon the city. If the characters claim to be looking for a safe way into Sorcere, Jarlaxle arranges for a member of the Council of Spiders to visit the party at a Bregan D’aerthe safe house in West Wall. This male drow mage brings scrolls of greater invisibility— one for each party member —and also gives the characters a password that temporarily bypasses the tower's defenses. Characters who speak the password while inside the tower won't have to deal with the tower's guards and wards effect for a period of 1 hour (see “Sorcere” later in this chapter). Bregan D’aerthe makes sure that the characters have no

hostile encounters as they make their way to the Academy. Once he becomes aware of Gromph’s grimoire, Jarlaxle does everything in his power to make sure the characters get the grimoire out of the city. Once

205

CHAPTER 15 I THE CITY OF SPIDERS

Vizeran’s ritual is complete, Jarlaxle plans to send Bregan D’aerthe spies to find Vizeran and steal the grimoire. so that he has evidence he can lord over his brother. Vizeran’s plan is appealing to Jarlaxle because it doesn’t cost him anything. As long as the adventurers are committed to driving the demon lords back to the Abyss. Jarlaxle keeps his Bregan D’aerthe forces on the sidelines, ready to defend Menzoberranzan.

XP A WARDS

If the party gains the support of Jarlaxle Baenre, award each character 1,500 XP.

A Change of Heart At some point as the characters explore Menzoberranzan. Grin Ousstyl confesses that his master Vizeran has not been entirely truthful with the adventurers. (If Grin didn’t accompany the characters to the city, he pursues and eventually catches up with them to share what he knows.) Grin has studied Vizeran's work in crafting the dark heart talisman and its associated ritual to draw the demon lords together, and he believes that the ritual will have its intended effect regardless of where the talisman is placed. It doesn't nce.d to be placed in Sorcere, or even in Menzoberranzan. Placing the talisman there only ensures that the drow city becomes the site of the demon lords' battle—and might well be laid waste in the process. If pressed. Grin admits that he isn’t absolutely certain that Vizeran’s ritual will work if the talisman is placed elsewhere. He’s not as learned or powerful as his master. Grin encourages the adventurers place the dark heart elsewhere and, in so doing, arrange a different battlefield for the demon lord showdown. He refuses to go along with any effort to leave [he talisman in Menzoberranzan. If the characters intend to place the dark heart as planned, they need to find some way to convince Grin or ensure his silence. Alternatively, Grin can betray them to the nearest drow patrol, disclosing Vizeran’s plan in the hope of saving the city.

EPS* '■ 'va

SORCERE The information the adventurers need to better understand the ritual that summoned the demon lords into the Underdark is in Gromph Baenre's sanctum within Sorcere, Menzoberranzan's academy of wizardry. The archmage's quarters have been declared off limits by Matron Mother Qucnthel Bacnre. who’s trying to cover up Gromph’s involvement in the devastating attack on Menzoberranzan. The adventurers can safely enter Sorcere with the aid of Matron Mother Quenthel Baenre, Jarlaxle Baenre, or members of the Council of Spiders. Once inside, the characters on their own, as none of these NPCs or their agents want to be connected to the adventurers if things go awry. GUARDS

AND

WARDS

The whole tower is protected by permanent guards and wards spells. The tower's drow residents are immune to the effects, but intruders are not. If the characters have the support of the Council of Spiders, members of the council give them a password which, when spoken aloud inside the tower, grants the speaker immunity to the spells' effect for 1 hour. After that, the password magically changes, and any characters still in the tower must deal with the guards and wards effect. RANDOM ENCOUNTERS

IN

SORCERE

Inside Sorcere, the characters might encounter clrowr wizards as well as their apprentices, familiars, and other magical creatures. If they enter with Quenthel Baenre’s permission, they can avoid most trouble with the tower's inhabitants. Otherwise, stealth and caution will be important. Have the characters make four DC 13 Dexterity (Stealth) group checks from the moment they enter the tower to when they reach the arch mage's sanctum. Each failed group check results in an encounter from the Sorcere Encounters table. The characters make the same checks while exiting the tower.

[f the tower goes on alert (as indicated in some of the encounter descriptions), all characters have disadvantage when making their group Dexterity (Stealth) checks.

Sorcere Encounters d20 Encounter 1-6 ld4 drow mages 1 giant spider 7-8 9-10 1 invisible quasit 11-121 mad drow mage 13- 1 shadow demon 14 15-18 ld4 slaves 19-20 1 succubus or incubus

the characters are trespassers, or if they're threatened or attacked, they flee and call for help. If any slaves escape the encounter, the tower goes on alert. S UCCUBUS OR I NCUBUS

A sometime lover and ally of one of the tower's wizards. Ihis fiend adopts the form of a slave (your choice of racer Curious to see the inside of Gromph’s sanctum, the “slave” offers to guide the characters there, taking them along a route that avoids other random encounters. The fiend tries to steal Gromph’s grimoire if the opportunity presents itself, first by using its Charm ability to convince a character to part with the book, and then by using Etherealness to disappear with it. GROMPH’S OUTER SANCTUM

D ROW M AGES

There is a 50 percent chance that these mages have been forewarned of the party's arrival, either by Vizeran DeVir or by Matron Mother Quenthcl Baenre. in which case they let the characters pass. Otherwise, the drow mages assume the characters are intruders and attack unless Grin Ousstyl ts with them. If the characters declare that they have Qucnthel Baenre's permission to be here, they can convince the mages to stand down with a successful DC 12 Charisma (Deception or Persuasion) check. If one or more mages fall in battle, the rest use greater invisibility spells to turn invisible and retreat, putting the tower on alert if it isn't already.

The black tnarhle door to Gromph Bacnre's chambers is etched with silvery runes around its edge and closed with an arcane lock keyed to him. Picking the lock requires a successful DC 23 Dexterity check using thieves' tools, while forcing the door open requires a successful DC 25 Strength check, A knock spell also opens the door, and Grin Ousstyl can have the spell prepared if none of the adventurers knows it. 1

The chamber beyond the door is floored in black marble, lined with shelves laden with books and scrolls, and dominated by a broad desk of polished bone. A plush chair covered with lizard hide sits behind the desk, while a

C IANT S PIDER

smaller and simpler zurkhwood chair sits facing it on the

This giant spider crawls along the walls or ceiling. Tt ignores the characters unless they take hostile action against it, in which case it attacks.

opposite side. A seven-foot-tall obsidian statue of a four armed, sword-wielding drow warrior stands behind the desk against one wall. Burning red candles are set about the room in holders made from skeletal hands.

I NVISIBLE Q UASIT

A drow wizard’s quasit familiar invisibly haunts the halls and chambers of the tower. It follows and observes the characters to find out what they’re up to, leaving to alert its master (a drow mage) if they enter Gromph’s sanctum or are seen leaving it. If the demon escapes, the tower goes on alert. M AD D ROW M AGE

This drow is afflicted with a form of indefinite madness. Roll on the Indefinite Madness table in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master's Guide to determine how the madness is expressed. S HADOW D EMON

A bound servant of a drow mage, this demon attempts to hide from the characters, then follows to learn what they’re up to. It fights the characters only if they attack it. fleeing if reduced to 10 or fewer hit points. If the demon escapes, the tower goes on alert. S LAVES

These commoners (your choice of race) are on an errand for their drow mage master when they run into the party by accident. If the characters state that they have legitimate business in Sorcere, the slaves answer questions about the tower if asked. If the slaves suspect CHAPTER 15 | THE CITY OF SPIDERS

ao6 y

1

______________________

>

*

Continual flame spells have been cast on the dozen

candles in the room, filling the area with bright light. If anyone other than Gromph enters the chamber without speaking the word tyrnae (“quench"), a fire elemental appears and attacks the intruders. Casting dispel tnagi< (DC 15) on the door before it opens disables this trap, but the elemental can't be dispelled once it appears. If anyone tampers with the desk or the shelves' contents, or attempts to remove anything from the room the four-armed statue animates and attacks, it has the statistics of a stone golem, but replace its Multiattack and Slam action options with the following: Multiattack. The golem makes four sword attacks. Sword. Melee Weapon Attack: +10 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target Hit: 10 (ld8 + 6) slashing damage.

Anyone speaking the statue's name (Szashune) aloud isn't attacked by it. T RAPPED S ECRET D OOR

Any party member with a passive Wisdom (Perception) score of 20 or higher notices a secret door in the wall, while a character searching the room for secret doors must succeed on a DC 15 Wisdom (Perception) check

to find it. Any creature with 12 Hit Dice or fewer that approaches within 5 feet of the secret door without speaking the word khaless (“trust") triggers an imprisonment spell (save DC 17). On a failed save, the creature is trapped in minimus containment inside a gemstone in Gromph's inner sanctum (described in the next section). The trap ceases to exist once a creature becomes imprisoned. A successful dispel magic (DC 19) cast on the secret door removes the trap. Opening the secret door requires a knock spell or a successful DC 20 Intelligence (Arcana) check to assess and manipulate its magic. Beyond it lies a dark void that can’t be dispelled or destroyed. Anyone or anything that touches the void is instantly transported to a labyrinthine dcmiplane similar to that created by a maze spell. A creature that succeeds on the DC 20 Intelligence check to escape the maze reappears in the middle of the outer sanctum. However, if a creature casts a spell of 5th level or higher while in the demiplane, all creatures and objects in the demiplane instantly appear in Gromph’s inner sanctum instead. T REASURE

The collection of rare books and scrolls in the archmage's chambers is worth 15,000 gp, assuming the characters have the means to haul it out. A character who spends 10 minutes poring over the collection can make a DC 15 Intelligence (Arcana) check. On a successful check, the character confirms that Gromph’s grimoire isn't among the books in the collection and also identifies the collection's five most valuable tomes, worth 1,000 gp each. However, one of these valuable works is trapped with a glyph of warding that triggers the third effect of bestow curse (save DC 17), and which lasts until dispelled. The drawers of the desk are sealed with arcane lock spells. Picking a drawer's lock requires thieves' tools and a successful DC 23 Dexterity check. A knock spell or a successful dispel magic (DC 15) cast on a drawer removes its magical lock. When opened, the drawers are empty. An effect similar to Lcomund's secret chest shifts the drawers' contents into an extradimensional space when anyone other than Gromph opens them. GROMPH’S INNER SANCTUM

Read the following text to players whose characters escape Gromph’s demiplane (see “Gromph's Outer Sanctum”) and appear in the archmage's inner sanctum. This circular chamber is lit by magic candles and floored in black stone, engraved and inlaid with magical diagrams in silver and gold. A female drow stands in the center of one magic circle, hands resting orr her hips. Behind her, shelves and cabinets hold ceramic pots, glass vials, and other arcane paraphernalia, while a tome bound in black leather lies open on a lectern, its pages covered in spidery glyphs. The only exit appears to be an archway filled with a black void.

Any creature that touches the dark void is whisked away to the demiplane that separates Gromph's inner and outer sanctums (see the previous section for details). A yochlol demon in drow form—Lolth’s messenger to Gromph—is imprisoned within the magic circle. It pretends to be a drow priestess named Y'lara for as long as the disguise is useful, claiming to have been trapped in the circle by the archmage after failing to convince Gromph not to cast his spell (a tie). The demon tries to get the characters to free it by breaking the circle, whereupon it attacks and tries to kill them. As long as the circle is intact, the demon can't leave it and doesn't have line of effect to anything outside of the circle. The yochlol does whatever it can to prevent the adventurers from leaving with Gromph’s grimoire (see "Treasure”). The characters can bargain with the trapped or defeated demon. It is reluctant to tell them what it knows, but angrily answers questions in exchange for its freedom. The demon tries to convince the characters to release it before it tells them wThat it knows, and any promises it makes are forgotten once it is freed. The yochlol was sent by Lokh to “assist" Gromph with his ritual, knowing that it wouldn't work as intended. When Gromph lost control of the ritual, he fled the city, but not before trapping the yochlol. The yochlol knows that Gromph's inability to harness the faerzress is the reason why the ritual failed, but it doesn't know Gromph's present whereabouts. If the characters ask “YTara” what Lolth stands to gain from Gromph casting the ritual, the demon replies, "Chaos." If the yochlol is killed, a character who investigates the grimoire can confirm beyond doubt that Gromph was responsible for bringing the demon lords to the Underdark. T REASURE

Gromph's grimoire rests atop the lectern near the circle and bears the title Zhaun'ol'leal (“The Book of the Eight" in Elvish) and describes rituals for summoning and binding powerful demons. It's open to a chapter that talks about the summoning of Demogorgon. The various arcane components and ritual items in the workroom are worth 1.000 gp total. A 6,000 gp diamond also sits on a small stand atop a workbench. It contains any creature trapped by the imprisonment spell that guards the secret door in Gromph's Outer Sanctum.

XP A WARDS

If the party' acquires Gromph's grimoire. award each character 1.500 XP.

D EVELOPMENTS By the end of this chapter, characters should have Gromph's grimoire and certain knowledge of the archmage's ritual in their possession. Given Grin Ousstyl's information, the characters are faced with a grim choice—place Vizeran's dark heart talisman in Menzoberranzan or in some other location. If they decide to leave it in Menzoberranzan, they must also decide how to deal with Grin, and possibly the wrath of Jarlaxle Baenre as well.

CHAPTER 15 I THE CITY OF SPIDERS

yPys*

PTER

16: THE FETID WEDDING

Zuggtmoy. Demon Queen of Fungi, plots to “wed" Araumycos, an enormous fungus occupying a large area of the Underdark. After uniting their powers in an unholy mockery of matrimony—in truth, a demonic rite of domination—Zuggtmoy will gain the power to transform the whole of the Underdark into her new Abyssal domain. The only things in her way are a core of resistance in the myconid community, the rage of her rival Juiblex, and the determination of the adventurers. The characters receive a warning about Zuggtmoy's plans from Basidia, one of the myconid sovereigns of Neverlight Grove. After traveling to the caverns of Araumycos, they reach out to Araumycos's alien mind with the aid of Basidia’s rapport spores, and try to free it from Zuggtmoy's demonic influence. Juiblex seizes the opportunity to crash the wedding, and the two demon lords do battle. When the characters sever Zuggtmoy’s link with Araumycos, Juiblex destroys her material form, leaving the adventurers to face the remaining (and weakened) demon lord in battle.

W EDDING I NVITATION The adventurers become caught up in Zuggtmoy’s plots when they experience a vision from the rebel myconids of Neverlight Grove, delivered by Sovereign Basidia. The characters know of Basidia and the myconids’ struggles if they visited Neverlight Grove (see chapter 5) . Otherwise, the myconids reach out to them if they sheltered Stool or Rumpadump for a time. Basidia's vision can come at any point, whether the characters are asleep or awake. You can choose to have the vision affect all or some of the player characters, or to have some of their NPC followers affected as well. Read the following text aloud, making adjustments as necessary if the characters have not met Sovereign Basidia. A soft, glowing light rises from ahead, emanating from a vast cavern. The entire surface of the cave—floor, walls, and ceiling—is blanketed in moss and fungi, all in shades of white and soft pastels of pink, violet, green, and pale blue. The diffuse light the mushrooms shed makes the vista waver as if seen through mist.

CHAPTER 16 | THE FETID WEDDING

208

"Araumycos," a voice says in your mind. You turn and see a myconid sovereign standing beside you where there was no one before, recognizing Basidia of Neverlight Grove, “The largest and greatest being of our world," the myconid says sadly. “All that you see before you is Araumycos; all this and much more. All is in danger from the corruption that will claim the whole of the world if you do not help us.”

Although myconids can normally use their rapport spores only over short distances. Basidia explains that Zuggtrnoy has been spreading her own spores throughout the Underdark, channeling faerzress. By tapping into this growing presence, the myconid sovereign can rapport over great distances to ask the characters for their help. Zuggtrnoy, the demon queen who has corrupted the myconids. has made her intentions clear. She is leading her new followers to the vast cavern complex occupied by Araumycos, the largest life-form in the Underdark and perhaps in all the world. There, the two will be bonded in a demonic ceremony, giving Zuggtrnoy dominion over a fungal kingdom larger and greater than any surface-world realm. To that end, she and her followers have been performing rituals and releasing spores to lull the great Araumycos into a kind of charmed sleep. The full implications are unclear to Basidia and the myconids, but as Araumycos is the oldest and most powerful being known to them, they greatly fear what Zuggtrnoy's corruption of it will bring. Fortunately, there is hope. Basidia believes it can assist in creating a rapport between the adventurers and Araumycos's vast, sleeping mind. The characters can help to awaken it and aid its struggle against the demon queen's influence. Or. if there’s no other choice, they can destroy Araumycos before Zuggtrnoy can claim the great creature as her own. If Stool or Rumpadump have met the characters and are still alive, they join the rapport between Basidia and the characters, offering their support and encouragement as they implore the adventurers to intervene. If the characters saw the hideous Garden of Welcome in Neverlight Grove—or, worse yet. glimpsed the horrors of Yggmorgus the myconids remind them that the whole world might become like that if Zuggtrnoy unites Araumycos’s power with her own. Basidia proposes that the characters travel quickly to Araumycos. where the myconid sovereign will temporarily immunize them against the effects of the demon-tainted spores released by myconids under Zuggtrnoy’s influence. Basidia will then initiate a rapport with Araumycos while Zuggtrnoy and her followers are preoccupied with the wedding ceremony. Basidia and its followers can meet the adventurers within Araumycos's vast cavern complex. The sovereign is too closely watched to slip away and meet them before that, and it recommends that the characters avoid contact with other myconids on their travels. Basidia can use the extended rapport link to fix on the

characters' location, and promises to find them when they are near the center of Araumycos. The vision then ends.

M YCONID M ARCH Shortly after the party receives Basidia's vision and warning, myconids and fungal creatures throughout the Underdark fall under the influence of Zuggtrnoy s spreading spores, making a slow and steady march toward Araumycos, their "queen’s betrothed.” Thousands are on the move, and the procession has a bizarrely festive air, the fungi capering, dancing, and skipping as they celebrate the impending nuptials. That behavior alone is alarming enough. However, under the demon queen’s influence, the myconids and other fungi release clouds of spores as they move through the tunnels of the Underdark. Strange perfumes and scents fdl the air. The marching myconids sow chaos as they move through the Underdark, passing around the Darklakc. Other intelligent Underdark creatures give the procession a wide berth. Characters making their way toward Araumycos can avoid much of the risk by following Basidia's advice and staying away from the myconid march. If not, they run the risk of falling under Zuggtmoy’s sway (see “Random Encounters" in this chapter). U N I N V I T E D G U E S T S ____________________________

The fungi of the Underdark aren't the only ones on the move.Juiblex the Faceless Lord has caught wind of its rival Zuggtrnoy's intentions and mobilized an army of oozes now making its way toward Araumycos, The demon lord wants to slow Zuggtrnoy's progress toward her goal. More importantly, though, Juiblex seeks the opportunity to appear at the ceremony, either to thwart its rival s intentions, take advantage of Araumycos’s vulnerability, or both. Though Araumycos represents the perfect mate to Zuggtrnoy. Juiblex sees it only as a living feast of tremendous proportions. With both forces on the move, outbreaks of violence between oozes and fungi become more common, although the followers of Zuggtrnoy outnumber the Faceless Lord's creatures. A R A U M Y C O S : G E N E R A L F E ATU R E S

The domain of Araumycos is a bizarre fungal realm in the heart of the Underdark. Light. Araumycos's tunnels and caverns are dimly lit by phosphorescent fungi. Terrain. Fungal life fills the caverns and passageways in the region, with visitors literally walking upon and within Araumycos upon entering its domain. The floor is carpeted with thick mold and fungus, creating patches of difficult terrain throughout. In some tunnels and caves, fungi growths obstruct passage. Characters either have to climb or hack their way through the fungal growth. In other places, the fungus covering the floor is soft enough that characters can sink into it with no warning. Use the quicksand rules in chapters. “Adventure Environments," of the Dungeon Master's Guide for such areas. Creatures that fail to escape become food for Araumycos.

CHAPTER 16 I THF. FETID WEDUIN’G

209

A RAUMYCOS

Some forty miles southeast of the Darklake lies the vast territory of Araumycos (see the Underdark overviewmap in chapter 2). RANDOM ENCOUNTERS As the characters travel toward Araumycos, use the Creature Encounters tabic in this section rather than the Creature Encounters table in chapter 2. Once the characters enter Araumycos's territory, use the Araumycos Encounters table instead of the random encounter tables in chapter 2. While the characters are in Araumycos’s domain, check for a random encounter twice per day: once while they are traveling, and again while they are camped or resting. C R E ATU R E E N C O U N T E R S d20 Encounter

1 2-6

Death tyrant Demons

7-8 9-10

Gnoll pack Gricks

11-14 Myconid parade 15-18 Oozes 19-20 Two-headed trolls ARAUMYCOS ENCOUNTERS

This encounter occurs only while the characters are traveling; otherwise, treat it as “no encounter.” The party happens upon a cave overgrown with fungi. Roll a d6 and consult the Fungi table to determine what special type of fungi can be found here. If this encounter takes place in Araumycos’s domain, an overabundance of fungi cover all of the other cave exits, requiring the characters to hack or blast their wa\ through (or find a route around). FUNGI

d6 1 2 3-4 5-6

Fungi ld6 gas spores 1d6 violet fungi 3d6 edible fungi(choose from the varietiesin "Fungi of the Underdark” in chapter 2) 3d6 exotic fungi(choose from the varietiesin "Fungi of the Underdark" in chapter 2)

GNOLL PACK

A hunting pack consisting of one gnoll pack lord and 3d6 gnolls has been driven into a frenzy by the presence of Yeenoghu in the Underdark. The characters can't be surprised by the gnolls. whose incessant cackling gives them away.

d20 Encounter 1-5 No encounter 6- 10 Fungi 11-14 Mold pit 15-17 Myconid parade 18-20 Oozes

G RICKS

D EATH T YRANT

Dungeon Master’s Guide).

Characters within 1 mile of the death tyrant’s lair feel as if they’re being watched even when they aren't. While defending its cavernous lair, the tyrant avails itself of its lair actions. Treasure. If the characters defeat the death tyrant, they can plunder its hoard: 4d6 * 1,000 gp, 5d6 * 100 pp, 3d6 500 gp gems, and ld6 magic items (determine each one by rolling on Magic Item Table C in chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide). D EMONS

One or more demons encounter the party and attack. Roll a dl2 and consult the Demons table to determine what the characters meet. DEMONS

d20 Demons 1-2 2d4 barlguras 3-4 2d4 chasmes 56 1d4hezrous 7- 8 1 dl 00 manes 9-10 1 nalfeshnee 11-12 2d4vrocks F UNGI

A grick alpha and ld4 + 2 gricks lair in a cave. They spring out from hiding to attack any creature that stumbles into their territory. MOLD PIT

One party member (determined randomly) steps on a pit of soft mold hidden beneath a thin carpel of moss, and sinks into it. The effect is identical to that of quicksand (see chapter 5, “Adventure Environments," of the MYCONID PARADE

The characters stumble upon ld4 myconid adults, 2d6 myconid sprouts, and one or more spore servants. Roll a d8 and consult the Spore Servants table to determine what kind of spore servants are present. S P O R E S E R VA N T S

d8 Spore Servants 1-2 IdS chuul spore servants (see appendix C) 3-4 ld6 drow spore servants 1d6 duergar spore servants (see appendix C for both) 5-6 ld6 drow spore servants (see appendix C) and 1d6 quaggoth spore servants 7-8 1d6 hook horror spore servants (see appendix C)

Subjects of Zuggtmoy. the myconids and their spore servants caper and dance madly to music only they can hear. The myconids insist that all other creatures they meet join them, releasing a cloud of spores if anyone refuses to do so. They can release this cloud once, and any creature within 30 feet of one or more of the

myconids when the cloud is released must succeed on a DC 11 Constitution saving throw or become charmed. While charmed in this way, a creature can do nothing other than dance and use its movement to follow the myconid parade. The creature can repeat the saving throw at the end of each hour, ending the effect on itself on a success. Casting lesser restoration, greater restoration, remove curse, or similar magic on a creature also ends the effect on it. The myconids and their spore servants attack only if they’re attacked or prevented from continuing on their march. OOZES

The characters encounter one or more oozes. Roll a d4 and consult the Oozes table to determine what kinds of oozes the characters encounter.

1 2 3 4

OOZE SPIES_______________________ Once Basidia has explained the plan to the characters, read the following boxed text aloud to the players.

OOZES

d4

where Zuggtmoy's ritual is set to take place. When they are sufficiently close to the epicenter of the ritual, the characters will be able to enter rapport with Araumycos. Basidia's rapport spores help facilitate the process, but Araumycos's sleeping mind isn’t in full control of the defenses of its body, and might interpret the characters' presence as an attack. Basidia warns the characters that they must he on their guard for a reaction from the vast fungus. Once the characters have entered rapport, they must seek out Araumycos's sleeping mind and awaken it to the danger it faces. Basidia doesn’t know if Zuggtmoy will become aware of what the characters are doing, but if she does, they will have only a limited amount of time before the demon queen tries to stop them.

Oozes 1 black pudding and

ld6 gray oozes

1 black pudding and ld4 ochre jellies 3d6 black puddings

2d4 gelatinous cubes

If the encounter occurs en route to Araumycos, the oozes are slithering toward the giant fungus. Otherwise, the oozes are feasting on Araumycos itself. In either event, the oozes fight only in self-defense. TWO-HEADED TROLLS

Warped by Demogorgon’s presence in the Underdark, these trolls have each grown a second head. As part of its Multiattack routine, a two-headed troll can make a Bite attack as a bonus action on its turn. The party encounters ld4 +■ 1 of these hungry creatures, which otherwise have the statistics of a normal troll.

E NTER THE G ROOM In the time it takes the characters to reach Araumycos’s caverns after receiving Basidia's message, Zuggtmoy and her fungal entourage arrive at the site of the ceremony, near the center of those caverns. The entourage includes hundreds of myconid adults and myconid sprouts, accompanied by awakened zurkhwoods and bridesmaids of Zuggtmoy (both from appendix C), as well as ambulatory fungi such as violet fungi and gas spores. Various spore servants fill out Zuggtmoy's entourage (see the "Myconids” entry of the Monster Manual and appendix C of this adventure). B A S I D I A ’ S A I D _______________________________

As the characters approach the center of Araumycos’s great cavern complex, Basidia meets them with a small detachment of loyal myconids. The myconid sovereign explains that it can infuse the characters with rapport spores and neutralized servitor spores, enabling them to blend in with the fungal servitors accompanying Zuggtmoy. The characters then have a few hours to make their way to the center of Araumycos's territory

Even as the myconid sovereign’s thoughts fill your mind, you become aware ofa faint hissing and fizzing sound. The fungus around you dissolves to a formless goo as something moves in the undergrowth to surround youl

A pair of regenerating black puddings, spies for Juiblex. slither through the undergrowth to attack the party'. The characters’ myconid allies fall back from the fray, desperate to protect Sovereign Basidia and pleading for the adventurers’ aid through the telepathic rapport they share. Empowered by Juiblex. these regenerating black puddings have an Intelligence of 6 (-2) and the following feature, which increases each pudding's challenge rating to 5 (1,800 XP), Regeneration. The pudding regains 10 hit points at the start of

its turn. If the pudding takes fire damage, this trait doesn't function at the start ofthe pudding's next turn. The pudding dies only if it starts its turn with 0 hit points and doesn't regenerate.

ACROSS

THE

FUNGAL FIELDS

Once the characters receive Basidia's spores and overcome Juiblex’s black pudding spies, they should set out at once for the depths of Araumycos as Lhe rapport takes hold, Unfortunately, they have no means of assuring the slumbering fungal entity of their intentions, and the growing threat posed by Zuggtmoy and the demon lords has roused Araumycos’s defenses. The pastel colors of fungi transform the caverns you pass through into softly glowing meadows. The floor is spongy, and the myconid spores are making you start to fee! drowsy—at least, you hope that's what’s behind this strange sensation. Then you feel the ground beneath you shift as something moves—a number of a thick, spiky tendrils bursting from the CHAPTER 16 | THE FETID WEDDING

211

ground.

CHAPTER 16 | THE FETID WEDDING

212

Two fungal creatures resembling otyughs rise up and attack the characters. Created by Araumycos to perfectly duplicate the abilities, traits, and actions of otyughs, these creatures are plants rather than aberrations. They attack until slain, whereupon each bursts into a cloud of sweet-smelling spores as its body dissolves back into the larger mass of fungi filling the cavern. Read the following to the players when the final creature is defeated.

Receiving the myconid's impressions, you become aware of a huge crowd of fungal creatures and spore servants— hundreds, perhaps thousands of them— watching as a grotesque procession makes its way through them. Myconids of all sizes caper madly before a troupe of giant animated mushrooms, bearing a mossy litter upon which sits the Demon Queen of Fungi in all her terrible splendor. Zuggtmoy is draped and veiled in molds and fruiting

The creature bursts like an overfull wineskin,

mushrooms woven into a grotesque gown. Vaguely

releasing a clear ichor and a cloud of dusty spores.

humanoid figures set with clusters of luminescent lichen

The deflating bulk of its body sinks back beneath the

and tumescent fungal growths follow her like bridesmaids,

shimmering fungal field where you stand. Your

carrying a veil and train of lacy mycelia. Stepping off the

vision starts to swim, and you feel dizzy and faint.

litter as her followers set it down, the Demon Queen of

Your limbs are numb and your legs no longer support

Fungi rises to tower above all the creatures around her.

you.

“My betrothed," she intones, the meaning of her words clear within the vision. “I am here at last.”

A successful DC 13 Intelligence (Arcana or Nature) check confirms that the characters are in no physical danger but are entering rapport with Araumycos. The adventurers are paralyzed as the myconid spores fully take effect. Even creatures immune to sleep and paralysis are affected as the spores seep into mind and body. The characters collapse harmlessly to the soft surface of Araumycos. its fungus quickly spreading across them as the rapport begins. When this happens, continue with “Into the Gray Dream.”

I NTO THE G RAY D REAM

The rapport with Araumycos affects the adventurers like an astral projection spell, sending their astral bodies out into the Astral Plane where Araumycos's vast, dreaming mind resides. Their bodies remain unconscious in suspended animation while they are projected into the Astral Plane. Read the following aloud to the players. You are floating, weightless, adrift. A gray, silvery light spreads around you like the dawn of a cloudy day, illuminating a peculiar realm. All of you are floating in a silvery haze that shimmers with swirls of color. Objects drift past in the distance, but whether they are small stones or rocks the size of mountains, you can't say for certain. Your moment of reverie is broken by the sound of Basidia’s voice in your mind. "It begins.” 1

i

ii The adventurers, now psychically linked with both the myconid sovereign and Araumycos, are aware of the demon queen and her minions performing Zuggtmoy’s demonic ritual. Through your link with Basidia, you sense that Zuggtmoy's wedding ceremony has begun. CHAPTER 16 | THE FETID WEDDING

213

THE MIND

OF

AR AU M YC O S

Navigating on the Astral Plane is largely a matter of thought and perception. The characters feel a psychic "pull” in the right direction as they seek out the consciousness of Araumycos with their own minds. A creature flies through the Astral Plane at a speed in feet equal to 3 x its Intelligence score, but a feeling of timelessness on the plane makes it difficult to judge the length of the journey. The characters' thoughts draw them toward a distant, floating object. It appears to be a hemisphere, until its slow rotation reveals its true form: a giant skull missing its jawbone, formed out of some kind of pale rock. As the characters draw closer, the skull reveals itself to be the size of a small mountain. Its surface is covered in lichens and broad patches of mold, the colors resembling those of Araumycos on the Material Plane. Through the empty eye sockets of the skull, the adventurers can see that its interior is hollow and filled with a bewildering variety of giant fungi. Tendrils and growths extend outward, twining together to form a mass suspended in the middle of the open space—a brainshaped fungus the size of a castle. The closer the characters come to the floating skull, the more strongly they feel a presence—the mind of Araumycos, to which they are linked. That consciousness is largely unaware of them, lulled by the insidious influence of Zuggtmoy’s spores and unable to resist the demon queen’s presence.

WEDDING CRASHERS

When any character enters the skull or touches its surface, the mind of Araumycos stirs—and the Demon Queen of Fungi senses it. Read the following to the players as Zuggtmoy uses the connection of the rapport spores to push into Araumycos's mind. "Who dares?” a voice shouts in your mind. “Who dares disturb my intended nuptials?" Spores and tendrils erupt from the surface of the skull, coalescing before your eyes into the image of the Demon Queen of Fungi, her dead eyes glaring with inhuman fury.

Zuggtmoy projects her psychic presence to confront the characters, while at the same time maintaining limited control over her material form. She intends to complete the ritual necessary to grant her full power over Araumycos. needing only to delay or destroy the intruders in order to succeed. The split in the Demon Queen’s attention works in their favor, as Zuggtmoy's demonic rival Jtiiblex chooses that moment to launch its attack and claim Araumycos for its own. Before Zuggtmoy acts against the adventurers, the demon queen is distracted, turning away to glance at something they can't see. She hisses the name “Juiblex” like a curse, then recoils as if struck. Her image then vanishes. THE SLEEPER WAKES

As the psychic din awakens Araumycos from its trance, the shimmering colors piercing the silver of the Astral Plane flare even brighter. The following round, Araumycos enters into full rapport with the characters and their myconid allies. The entity reveals that Zuggtmoy has already infected its mind with her demonic influence, which Araumycos can feel growing in strength. It’s only a matter of time before it falls to the demon queen's will. Focused but fearful, the entity asks the adventurers to cut out and destroy the diseased part of its mind before it’s too late. The characters are guided to the far side of the suspended fungus cluster inside the skull, where a dark mass is spreading. The first time any character comes within 20 feet of the dark mass, it erupts with the effect of an Evard's black tentacles spell. The infected area of Araumycos's mind has AC 13, 100 hit points, and vulnerability to necrotic and psychic damage. When the infected area first takes damage, Zuggtmoy senses it and turns her attention away from Juiblex in an attempt to stop the characters. As she exerts her will over Araumycos, a burst of spores spreads out in a cloud from the infected area. Any creature within 20 feet of the infected area must make a successful DC 19 Constitution saving throw or take 3d6 poison damage and become poisoned. While poisoned in this way. the creature takes 3d6 poison damage at the start of each of its turns. A poisoned creature can repeat the saving throw on each of its turns, ending the effect on itself on a success.

As the characters destroy more of the infected area, the view beyond the bounds of the skull chamber begins to darken. When the area reaches 0 hit points, a powerful psychic wind howls through the area. Each character must make a successful DC 15 Intelligence saving throw to avoid the mental effect of a psychic wind (see “The Astral Plane" in chapter 2 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide). This psychic wind has no location effect, as the rapport ends thereafter and the characters awaken back in their physical bodies. Physical damage and ongoing effects suffered by their astral forms aren't carried over to the characters’ physical bodies.

L ET T HEM S PEAK N OW ... If the characters free Araumycos from Zuggtmoy’s influence, they weaken the power of the Demon Queen of Fungi, fatally distracting her. With the loss of many of her fungal minions and the amount of power she has expended to perform her ritual, Zuggtmoy is weakened to the point that Juiblex overwhelms her, destroying and consuming her material form and casting her essence back into the Abyss. Characters reduced to 0 hit points in the battle on the Astral Plane are catapulted back to their bodies on the Material Plane. Their rapport with Araumycos is broken, and they are helpless to intervene further in the conflict going on within the entity’s mind. You can have a group of oozes or spore servants from the Araumycos Encounters table appear in the cavern where the adventurers entered into rapport with Araumycos, so that characters shunted out of that rapport can defend their compatriots’ helpless bodies while the fight continues. If all the characters are defeated on the Astral Plane, the awakened Araumycos remains conscious enough to resist Zuggtmoy with a final effort, sufficient to distract the Demon Queen of Fungi and thereby allowing Juiblex to overwhelm her. In any event, the characters can hear the battle between Juiblex and Zuggtmoy unfolding in the ritual cavern just a few minutes ahead of them. R E T R E AT !

If the adventurers retreat from the sounds of baule, they barely escape from a partial collapse of their local section of Araumycos’s cavern complex. They race ahead of a small horde of Zuggtmoy’s minions, which are crushed by falling rock that also seals off the characters’ escape route. Basidia and some of the myconid rebels survive, and will accompany the adventurers out of Araumycos's caverns before returning to Neverlight Grove to root out any remainder of the demon queen’s infestation.

To B ATT L E !

__________

If the adventurers head toward the battle between the two demon lords after awakening from their rapport, they arrive just in time to see the grotesque display of the Faceless Lord slurping up the defeated Zuggtmoy into the mass of its body, enveloping and dissolving her before turning its attention toward the newcomers. CHAPTER

16 I THE FETID WEDDING ___. / 213

F IG H T IN G T H E F A C E LE S S L O R D Under normal circumstances, Juiblex (see appendix D) would be an overwhelming foe. Fortunately for the adventurers, the Faceless Lord’s battle with Zuggtmoy has weakened it. The characters might also have aid from allies, the newly freed myconids, and Araumycos in overcoming the demon lord. Apply the following penalties tojuiblex: ■ Its current hit points are 200. • It has no more uses of Legendary Resistance for the day. • Its Eject Slime action has been used and must recharge. • It has no lair actions or regional effects,

those myconids afflicted by demonic corruption. The myconids also declare their intention to cleanse their home of Zuggtmoy's lingering influence. The removal of Juiblex from the Underdark causes most oozes and related creatures to revert to their normal state. If the Pudding King survived this long, he retreats to Blingdenstone. but it’s a far easier matter for the deep gnomes to deal with him and his oozing minions without Juiblex around.

D E V E LO P M E N T S

Basidia rallies thirty myconid adults and thirty-two drow spore servants (see appendix C) to fight alongside die characters. Their attacks are incapable of harming Juiblex. However, as they swarm around the demon lord, one time per round (as agreed upon by the players), a character who would be hit by an attack can have a myconid or a spore servant hit by the attack instead. The myconids can also fight off oozes, allowing the adventurers to focus their attention on the demon lord. If the adventurers freed it from Zuggtmoy's influence, Araumycos aids them by releasing spores into the cavern, granting all living creatures in the area immunity to poison damage and the poisoned condition.

Even if Araumycos survives, its fate is unclear. The entity’s mind has clearly been damaged by both the necessity of cutting away its corruption and the buffeting force of the psychic wind that followed. Basidia and the myconids offer to meld with Araumycos to try to heal it and guide it back to wholeness. Though not as serious as death, the trauma still causes a significant amount of fungal die-off in areas of the creature’s domain, potentially uncovering lost ruins or other hidden sites. In addition to possible victory over one or two demon lords, the adventurers receive one last bequest from the mind of Araumycos. A puff of rapport spores or a lingering psychic connection informs them of one or more of the secrets of the Underdark gathered during the entity’s vast existence. If you want to provide the players with any remaining information about virtually anything in the adventure, this is an excellent opportunity to do so.

V IC T O RY O R D E FE AT

TREASURE___________________

The characters might overcome two demon lords if they are successful in this chapter. If they fail, terrible consequences unfold for the myconids and other creatures of the Underdark, though the adventurers wall get another chance to take the fight to Zuggtmoy, Juiblex. and all the other demon lords in chapter 17.

Escaping Defeat If the characters lose their battle against Juiblex, their best hope lies in Vizcran DeVir’s ritual. In the worstcase scenario where one or more heroes fall in the fight against the Faceless Lord, their allies might be able to carry them to safety so that they can be healed or restored to life. If the adventurers flee from Juiblex, the demon lord pursues them. However, Araumycos (or Its death throes) triggers a cave-in, allowing defeated characters to barely escape. Juiblex then turns its attention to feeding on Araumycos and is one of the demon lords drawn into battle by Vizeran’s ritual in chapter 17.

Achieving Victory ___________________

If the adventurers succeed, they achieve a great victory with two demon lords banished back to the Abyss. The creatures under the demon lords' influence eventually return to normal. Neither Zuggtmoy nor Juiblex is truly destroyed, however. Each demon lord reforms on its layer of the Abyss, never forgetting those responsible for its defeat. The elimination of the Demon Queen of Fungi wins the adventurers the eternal gratitude of the surviving myconids of Neverlight Grove. Basidia quickly assumes leadership of the grove, taking steps to heal the minds of CHAPTER 16 | THE FETID WEDDING

In addition to (or instead of) providing information to the adventurers, the last connection to the surviving Araumycos can bestow a charm of heroism to all the player characters (see “Other Rewards" in chapter 7 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide). Additionally, the thirteen timmask mushrooms on the list of required components that Vizeran needs to create his dark heart talisman (see chapter 12) can be found in the aftermath of the failed wedding ceremony, sprouting in locations touched by Zuggtmoy or Juiblex. Tfthe characters didn’t collect traces of Yeenoghu’s blood from the fallen goristro in chapter 14. any successful weapon attack against Juiblex in this chapter leaves traces of the Faceless Lord’s blood on a character’s weapon. Collecting this blood for Vizeran DeVir provides another component he needs to craft his dark heart talisman.

XP AWARDS_______________________I If the characters rid Araumycos’s mind of its demonic infection, award each of them 2,000 XP. If the party delivers to Vizeran all of the components he needs to craft his dark heart talisman, award each character an additional 2,500 XR

I

Chapter 17: Against the Demon Lords In the culmination of Out of the Abyss, the heroes implement Vizeran DeVir's scheme to take on the demon lords. The arch mage's ritual draws the demon lords together to fight to the death, leaving Demogorgon victorious but weakened as the adventurers face off against the Prince of Demons. Even wounded and weakened, though. Demogorgon is a legendary foe, and the fate, of the Undcrdark and all Faerun rests on the adventurers' final battle.

R E A D Y IN G T H E P L A N

Over the course of their adventures, the characters have collected the components needed to create the talisman at the center of Vizeran DeVir's summoning ritual: The intact and unhatched egg of a purple worm (from the worm hatchery in chapter 13) The central eye of a beholder (from Karazikar in the Vast Oblivium in chapter 13, or some other source). Six feathers from six different angels (from the petrified angels in the Labyrinth in chapter 14) The heart of a goristro (from the demon slain by Yeenoghu in chapter 14) Thirteen timmasks sprouted from the footprint of a

greater demon (from Araumycos’s cavern in chapter 16. or elsewhere) Grornph Baenre's grirnoire (from Sorcere in chapter 15)

• A few drops of blood or ichor from a demon lord (from Yeenoghu's battle with the goristro in chapter Id, or from fightingjuiblex in chapter 16) After Vizeran DeVir uses these components to create the talisman known as the dark heart to draw forth the exiled demon lords from across the Underdark, he expects the adventurers to plant it in Mcnzoberranzan. Having learned from Vizeran's apprentice Grin Ousstyl of the archmagc's secret goal to see the city destroyed, the characters might decide to place the dark heart talisman elsewhere, determining the battlefield for their confrontation with the demon lords (see "Let This Be Their Battlefield").

E N A C T IN G T H E P LA N

Once the dark heart is in place, the ritual can begin. The adventurers and their allies take up a position not far from the dark heart, close to where the demons will appear. Where exactly depends on the placement of the talisman and the adventurers' own tactics and plans. They can use a sending spell to signal Vizeran to begin the ritual once the talisman is in place. (If none of the characters can cast sending. Vizeran can provide the spell on a spell scroll). ----.___

CHAPTER 17 | AGAINST THE DEMON LORDS 2

lb

I

S T AY I N G B E H I N D OPTION: THE LESSER OF TWO EVILS

If you want to pose a moral dilemma for the characters, have Vizeran tell them that the ritual needs a final component, to be delivered while it Is performed: the sacrifice of an innocent sentient being, whose blood will fuel and activate the ritual’s fiendish magic. Will the adventurers willingly sacrifice one life to stop the demon lords from threatening the Underdark and the whole of Faerun? This kind of moral dilemma can add significant drama to the story. However, it can also be played out as a red herring—-by having it be something Vizeran asks for even though it’s not necessary. The drow archmage might be testing the characters to see how far they’ll go, or he could be afflicted with madness that makes him believe such a sacrifice is necessary even though it isn’t. A character can figure out the truth with a DC 20 Intelligence (Arcana) check, or by consulting Gromph Baenre’s grimoire (see chapter 15). Alternatively, Grin Ousstyl can tell the characters the truth, enraging his master as a result.

Vizeran (assisted by Grin if the apprentice is available), performs the complex ritual in the sanctum of his tower. The ritual causes the dark heart to radiate a summons throughout the Underdark using the faerzress—an irresistible call drawing the demons toward it. When the ritual reaches its conclusion at the end of nine hours, portals of faerzress form. All the

One or more of the characters might choose to stay with Vizeran during the nine-hour performance of the ritual, whether to guard against treachery or to reclaim Cromph's grimoire once the ritual is done. If this is the case, you can add some action for those who remain behind by having a small number of the demons summoned by the ritual attracted to the site of the ritual rather than the location of the dark heart talisman. Alternatively, agents of Quenthel Baenre or Jarlaxle can attack Araj when the ritual is complete, wanting to silence Vizeran before he can reveal what he knows about Cromph Baenre (see chapter 15). Vizeran might also learn of Grin Ousstyl’s betrayal of information to the adventurers, and choose to eliminate him immediately after he’s served his purpose in assisting with the ritual. This might lead some characters back to Araj to aid the drow apprentice.

demons and demon lords in the Underdark are drawn through those portals, appearing together in the. area around the dark heart talisman. Enraged by being forcibly summoned yet again by a ritual, the demons fly into a frenzy once they see each other, beginning a battle to the death. As each demon's material form is destroyed, its essence is banished back into the Abyss. The task of the adventurers is to be close at hand but not get caught up in the battle until one demon lord is left standing, weakened and spent from the conflict. That becomes the adventurers' cue to attack and destroy the last demon lord, banishing it to the Abyss if they succeed. L E T T H I S B E T H E I R B ATT L E F I E L D

I II

IThe players can choose where their characters

confront the demon lords by deciding where to set the dark heart talisman. Vizeran’s preference is anywhere in Menzoberranzan, because he wants all drow to see the poisoned fruits of their misplaced worship of Lollh. However, from what Grin Ousstyl tells them in chapter II the adventurers should learn that the talisman can be placed in any location. Wherever the players decide to place the talisman, their characters must travel to that location while Vizeran makes his final preparations for the ritual. Given their experiences in the Underdark, the adventurers should be able to think of a number of likely sites for the final battle. A few likely options are discussed here. ARAUMYCOS

At the center of the network of caves and passages inhabited by Araumycos. the cavern where Juiblex and Zuggtmoy battled in chapter 16 is a good potential site. If the vast fungal colony is already dead or badly damaged by its abuse at Zuggtmoy's hands, it’s in no position to object. Otherwise, it opposes becoming a battlefield out of a sense of self-preservation. Unleashing the demons within Araumycos does considerable damage to the fungal colony, but doesn't destroy it.

---------------------------------------------- ---BROKEN HEART

If the characters lose or destroy the dark heart, they either have to go through the process of gathering the necessary components to make a replacement, or abandon Vizeran's plan. See "Loose Threads" later in this chapter for ideas about what to do if the plan never gets off the ground. NEVERLIGHT GROVE

If the characters inform the myconids of their need for a place to stage a daring last battle, Sovereign Basidia or another myconid representative might offer Neverlight Grove. The ranks of the myconids have been decimated by Zuggtmoy's depredations and the fetid wedding, and many fear their beloved caverns are corrupted. They are willing to seek a new home (perhaps in the caverns of Araumycos) and grateful enough to the heroes that they will sacrifice their old home to help them. S LOOBLUDOP

The ruins of the kuo-toa settlement (see chapter 3) could become the site of the final fight against the demon lords. Shuushar the Awakened can be convinced to help evacuate the remaining inhabitants if asked. The nearby Darklake creates its own challenges, particularly given the presence of ixitxachitl loyal to Demogorgon. A RAJ

Characters looking to double-cross Vizeran or those with a sense of poetic justice -might hide the dark heart somewhere in the drow archmage’s tower or the surrounding cavern. This reduces the number of bystanders, contains the demons and their battle, and ensures Vizeran’s enmity. CONFRONTING

THE

DEMON LORDS

The demon lords are some of the most powerful foes a party of adventurers could face. Indeed, any one of them at full strength could wipe out a group of 15th-level characters with ease. Fortunately for the heroes, Lhe goal of Vizeran’s plan isn't to fight multiple demon lords, but to turn them against each other. With the right combination of preparation, timing, and execution, the characters set the trap that Vizeran springs with his ritual—and hope whichever demon lord survives is weakened enough for them to destroy it. A LLIED F ORCES

OPTION: JIMJAR’S LAST GAMBLE

If the adventurers need some extra help in their epic final battle at the end of the campaign, consider the following option involving Jimjar, the deep gnome gambler they met in the drow slave pen in chapter 1 of the adventure. “jimjar” isn’t at all who he appears. He is, in fact, a god or other great power in disguise—or the Chosen of such a power—and has been watching the heroes since their first encounter in Velkynvelve. His reasons for doing this are his own, but when push comes to shove, he can give the heroes some help in overcoming the demon lords. At an opportune moment, Jimjar shows up (even returning from death if he appeared to perish earlier in the adventure) and gives the characters a vote of encouragement, telling them, “I bet you can do this." Each character gains inspiration and a blessing of wound closure (see “Other Rewards" in chapter 7 of the Dungeon Master's Guide), jimjar disappears afterward, potentially putting in one last appearance at the end of the adventure to hint as to his true nature before vanishing into the Underdark. Who is Jimjar really? That depends on your characters and the campaign, but one ofthe characters' patron deities is a good possibility. He might also be a gnomish god such as Garl Glittergold or Callarduran Smoothhands, known tricksters and shapeshifters, and foes of demons and their ilk. The more important thing is that he serves as a “lucky charm" for the characters when they need him. This option works particularly well if the adventurers have been kind to the sometimes annoying deep gnome over the course of the campaign, earning his respect and gratitude.

Healing Support. A character regains 2d6 hit points at the end of each of his or her turns, provided the character has at least 1 hit point remaining. Tactical Losses. Once each round, when a player character would be hit by an attack, a supporting ally is hit by the attack instead. The adventurers can use this option ten times before their allies are too weakened or depleted to provide assistance. H EROIC S ACRIFICE

Players should never have to think about sacrificing their characters, but you should be prepared for the possibility of one or more of the heroes giving up their lives in order to defeat the evil that has arisen in the Underdark. It’s up to you how to handle such a high-stakes event, but consider treating it as an extreme variation of “Success at a Cost” from chapter 8 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide. At the very least, a player deliberately sacrificing his or her character's life in a final, selfless heroic effort the antithesis of the selfishness and evil of the Abyss - should grant all the character’s allies inspiration. The sacrifice might not be enough to win the day on its own, but it can help turn the tide.

Vizeran is needed to perform the ritual, placing him far from the battle and leaving him with three levels of exhaustion (see appendix A of the Player’s Handbook) once the ritual is completed. He is thus unwilling to aid the characters during the fight. The archmage prefers to keep Grin Ousstyl to assist him, so the drow mage is likewise unable to assist. However, the adventurers have a number of other allies willing to fight alongside them in this last battle. Most of the heroes’ allies are of limited use against the demon lords—creatures immune to many forms of attack, including nonmagical weapons. Rather than dealing with the ineffectual attacks of allies or a dozen or more additional actions each round, give characters backed up by a group of allies the following benefits.

CH APTER 17 i AG AINST THE DEMON LORDS 17

with the sole remaining demon lord.

R AGE OF D EMONS Once the dark heart talisman is placed and the characters signal Vizeran, there’s no turning back. The waiting is the hard part. Time seems to drag as you remain alert, weapons drawn, every nerve singing with the tension in the air all around you. Finally, a swirling light begins to flare in the darkness. A barely audible humming shakes you to the core, rising and falling like a vast heartbeat in the depths. The glow of faerzress gathers and brightens, creating swirling pools like holes torn in the air. A roar

DEMON SORTIE

Rampaging lesser demons discover one or more of the characters where they wait out the battle, attacking at once. Roll a d4 to determine the demons involved.

Demon Sortie Force d4 Demon Sortie 1 2 3 4

4 barlguras 4 chasmes 2 hezrous 3 vrocks

sounds from far away as shadows move in the depths of those pools of

DEMON THIEF

light. The demons are coming.

An invisible quasit tries to steal a small, valuable item from a party member. The target must succeed on a DC 13 Wisdom (Perception) check to notice the theft as it happens. On a failed check, the quasit makes off with the item undetected. You can make the search for the item a loose thread for the conclusion of the adventure. Alternatively, have the quasit killed during the battle, with the stolen item turning up in the aftermath.

The demon lords described in appendix D of this adventure all appear in the final battle, with the following exceptions: • If Fraz-UrbTuu was not sent back to the Abyss in chapter 9, his gemstone is hurled into the fray by Vizeran’s ritual. Unless the characters retrieve it, another demon lord steps on the gem, destroys it. and sends FrazUrbTuu's spirit back to the Abyss. • If Juiblex and Zuggtmoy were sent back to the Abyss in earlier parts of the adventure, they are not present. • Baphomet and Yeenoghu are absent if the characters activated the Maze Engine (see chapter 14) and the 81 100 result on the Maze Engine Effects table came up. Numerous other demons also pour through the portals. For a brief moment, all of the demons and demon lords are disoriented as they attempt to get their bearings after being pulled across the Underdark. Then as their gazes fall upon each other, they roar, bellow, or shriek with a hatred too deep for mortals to truly comprehend, and the terrible battle begins. O P T I O N : P L AYI N G O U T T H E B ATT L E

Rather than focusing on the adventurers biding their time and dealing with the fallout of the titanic battle between the demon lords, you can shift focus for this part of the adventure. Consider having the players take control of the various demon lords from appendix D, then play out the conflict between them. Assign each player an available demon lord, or allow players to choose one demon lord to control during the battle. You manage any of the remaining demon lords. If there aren't enough demon lords for all the players, you can use balors or other powerful demons to round out their numbers. The players control the demons in their battle to the death, with the only restriction being that they can’t withdraw from the combat. Brief tactical retreats are permissible, but Vizeran's ritual has filled the demon lords with the rage to do battle. The demonic victor of this battle, its hit points and other resources sufficiently depleted, is the foe that the adventurers must overcome in the final confrontation. DEMON SHOWDOWN

Ideally, the adventurers and their allies remain hidden from the battling demons, letting them fight it out among themselves. Still, there are challenges for the characters to overcome as they wait. Feel free to include as many of the following as you wish while narrating the struggle between the demon lords and their minions, keeping in mind that the characters will have no time for even a short rest before taking on the main challenge of this encounter—a fight

E N D AN G E R E D AL LI E S

If any of the player characters' allies are accompanying them, a demon sortie (see above) attacks the NPCs. The characters must decide whether or not to break cover to aid their allies against the demons. If they do. another demon sortie attacks them ld4 rounds later. NEAR MISS

The battle between the demon lords shifts dangerously close to the characters. Roll a d6 and consult the Near Miss table to determine the result.

Near Miss d6 Event 1-2 Explosion. Each creature within 20 feet of a point you choose must make a DC 13 Dexterity saving throw. On a failure, the creature takes 3d6 fire damage, or half as much damage on a success. 3-4 Flying Debris. Each creature within 30 feet of a point you choose must make a DC 13 Dexterity saving throw, taking 3d6 bludgeoning damage and falling prone on a failure. 5-6 Close Call. A character you choose must make a successful DC 13 Dexterity saving throw to dodge a stray attack. On a failed save, the character takes 3d6 bludgeoning damage. THREATENED BYSTANDERS If the battle takes place in a

populated area such as Mcnzoberranzan, the characters spot bystanders under attack by lesser demons that prefer to take on easy prey rather than fighting against their own kind. A dozen dretches or manes (50 percent chance of either) attack, killing and consuming their mortal victims unless the adventurers intervene.

A GAINST D EMOGORGON

After running any events you wish from “The Battle," the struggle between the demon lords comes to an end as Demogorgon proves why he is known as the Prince of Demons. CHAPTER 17 | AGAINST THE DEMON LORDS

The sounds of battle finally die away, the ground before you stained black and red with demonic blood and ichor. In the terrible grip of Demogorgon, even the mighty Orcus looks almost small. Tentacles hold the Demon Prince of Undeath in a crushing grip, slithering across the maggot-riddled flesh of the horned demon, as they tighten inexorably. A strangled gasp issues from the demon lord's throat as a horrific crunching sound echoes throughout the cavern and his skull-topped wand clatters onto the floor. Demogorgon casts aside the limp form, which melts away as Orcus returns to the Abyss that spawned him. The Prince of Demons throws back his two heads and roars his triumph. As he does, his nearer head turns, burning eyes raking across the battlefield. Filled with bloodlust and battle rage, the demon lord searches for another target.

Determine the characters’ starting positions based on their actions during the battle. Demogorgon should be at least 80 feet away from them initially, unless the players specifically stated they were remaining close to the demon lord. Demogorgon has been wounded during the fight, giving the characters an edge in the battle to come. Apply the following penalties to the Demogorgon stat block in appendix D: ■ Demogorgon has 290 hit points remaining and can't regain hit points due to the disruptive nature of Vizeran’s faerzress-empowered ritual. • He has only one use of Legendary Resistance remaining for the day. ■ His feeblemind innate spell is expended, as are all but one use each of dispel magic, fear, and telekinesis, • With all the other demon lords banished back to the Abyss, Demogorgon becomes the focus of the disruptive power of Vizeran’s ritual. This imposes a -5 penalty to his attack rolls, ability checks, and saving throws. Even in his weakened state, the demon lord remains a terrifying opponent, attacking the adventurers in a howling fury as battle is joined. A LTE R N ATI V E S H O W D O W N

If you prefer, a demon lord other than Demogorgon could be the victor of the demonic showdown and the final foe of the campaign. This is particularly appropriate if the adventurers earned the ire of a specific demon lord during the adventure (including Juiblex or Yeenoghu). Alternatively, one or more of the characters' backgrounds might be tied to a particular demon lord.

WAND

OF

O R C U S _______________________________

When Orcus is defeated, he drops the Wand of Orcus (see chapter 7 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide), which falls to the ground. A party member can try to grab the wand before Demogorgon seizes it as a trophy, but any such theft draws the attention and ire of the Prince of Demons. Angry at its master's defeat, the Wand of Orcus tries to attune itself to the first willing creature other than Demogorgon that touches it. The attunement is instantaneous, allowing the wand’s properties to be used during the battle. DESTROYING DEMOGORGON

If the characters reduce the Prince of Demons to 0 hit points, they disrupt and destroy his material form. CHAPTER 17 | AGAINST THE DEMON LORDS

Shrieking and gibbering, the Prince of Demons disintegrates as his foul essence is cast back into the Abyss, ending the demonic threat to the Underdark. If the characters fail to destroy Demogorgon, see “Demon Lords Triumphant.”

L OOSE T HREADS

The conclusion of Out of the Abyss can be relatively quick and straightforward if Vizeran’s scheme is successful and the heroes are victorious. The survivors of the battle against the demon lords can make their way out of the Undertlark to report to a grateful alliance of surface-world factions ihat the threat is ended. Major loose threads left hanging at the end of the final battle include the following. G R O M P H ’ S G R I M O I R E ___________________________

After recovering Gromph Baenre's grimoire from Sorcere in chapter 15, the characters might think about what to do with the dark tome once the threat of the demon lords is ended. The knowledge and power the book represents are dangerous in anyone's hands— especially Vizcran DeVir's, given what the characters know of him. However, the drow archmage doesn't give up the grimoire willingly. Finding a means to get rid of Gromph's grimoire once and for all could be the basis for continued adventures, perhaps even leading characters into the Abyss (see “Into the Demonweb Pits"). Alternatively, if you arrange for the book to be stolen from Vizeran before the characters can deal with it, they might need to recover it to ensure its powers are never misused again. If you prefer to tie tip loose ends concerning the grimoire, you can have it banished into the Abyss along with the demon lords. It might be reclaimed by Lolth or

lost somewhere within the infinite depths of that plane, at least until it resurfaces again.

MENZOBERRANZAN

One or more of the demon lords might remain in the Underdark or on the Material Plane by the end of the campaign, having managed to avoid being drawn into Vizeran's trap. Graz'zt is a good possibility. In this case, a continuing campaign might be necessary' for the high- level heroes to acquire the resources they need to take on any remaining demon lords, since the trick with the dark heart isn't going to work a second time. The characters* continuing adventures could involve further cooperation with Vizeran DeVir (if he survives) or delving deeper into the Underdark for legendary weapons or magic. The characters might even venture out into the other planes of existence with the aid of Araumycos or the librarians of Gravenhollow, seeking allies, lore, and resources to combat the demon lords and return them to the Abyss.

If the City of Spiders is the site of the demon lords’ battle, it is damaged even more than it was by Demogorgon's arrival. Word of the city's misfortune spreads throughout the Undcrdark, with other races and factions trying to claim some of the power long held by the drow. Despite Vizeran's best efforts, not all drow believe that Lolth is responsible for the disaster, instead blaming a lack of faith in the Demon Queen of Spiders, as well as the power of the wizards. Chaos and agitation for change embroil the city, forcing the already weakened ruling houses to put down challenges to their power even as they make concessions to their rivals. A civil war between the drow isn't likely to remain contained within Menzoberranzan—or even the Underdark —as different sides look for resources and advantages. The adventurers could get involved on either side of the conflict, or might aid surface-world factions intent on containing the war in the Underdark until it eventually winds down.

INTO

G A U N T L G R YM

L I N G E R I N G E V I L _______________________________

THE

DEMONWEB PITS

Ambitious adventurers might decide to take the fight to Lolth, seeking to punish her for what she unleashed on the Material Plane and to undo whatever her scheme might have gained her. Vizeran will be inclined to help them find a way to reach the Demonweb (Lolth’s layer of the Abyss), since the drow archmage hates the Demon Queen of Spiders and her subjugation of bis race. As they travel through the Abyss, the characters might discover that the demon lords they defeated in the Underdark are potential allies in this new quest. Those demon lords want their own revenge upon Lolth for her scheme, and it might suit their mad whims to use the adventurers as their agents to achieve it. Tf and when the characters confront Lolth, they find her pregnant and surrounded by thousands of eggs—her unborn young. When the eggs hatch, the Demon Queen of Spiders plans to send her offspring throughout the Abyss, creating a new generation of demon lords under her sway. How the heroes thwart Lolth's mad scheme remains to be seen! DEMON LORDS TRIUMPHANT

In the event the heroes were not successful, a potential new campaign could take place in a Faeruri threatened— or even ruled—by demon lords with access to the surface world. In addition to their summoned armies of demons and fiendish creatures, they gather worldly forces of chaos and evil to their banners to launch a war against all civilized lands. A world under the assault or rule of the demon lords is a world in need of heroes. G R O M P H B A E N R E ______________________________

The fate of Gromph Baenre, instigator of chaos and Vizeran’s rival, remains a mystery, Tf he yet lives, his role in recent events earns him many new enemies. Matron Mother Quenthel Baenre handpicks a new Archmage of Menzoberranzan to replace her troublesome brother, knowing Gromph will not be found until he chooses to reappear. CHAPTER 17 I AGAINST THE DEMON LORDS

220

Even if the heroes eliminate the threat the demon lords represent to Gauntlgrym, the Underdark remains in a state of chaos. The defenders of Gauntlgrym need aid to rebuild and strengthen the city's defenses, and to remain vigilant for new threats gathering in the dark depths of the world. King Bruenor might offer the triumphant heroes noble titles and positions of power in his kingdom in the hope of enlisting their aid against the troubles to come. The adventurers might get the opportunity to earn those titles all over again when an Undcrdark army marches on the dwarf kingdom, determined to claim Gauntlgrym and the power of the primordial bound within its Great Forge. VIZERAN DEVIR

Although he's nominally the parly’s ally during much of this adventure, Vizeran DeVir can’t be underestimated. Once the immediate threat is dealt with, the drow archmage turns his attention to other goals—claiming what he considers his rightful place of power among the drow, and overthrowing the tyrannical rule of Lolth and her priestesses. Vizeran might start a civil war among the dark elves one that could easily drag in the other civilizations of the Underdark and parts of Faerun as well. Although Vizeran won’t immediately turn against his former allies, the adventurers would be fools to trust him. He seizes any opportunity to increase his own power and prestige, including holding on to Gromph's grimoire and any ritual components or trinkets the adventurers might have acquired for him. If the adventurers thwarted Vizeran's revenge scheme by placing the dark heart talisman somewhere other than Menzoberranzan, they earn the drow arch mage's enmity. Vizeran’s plots expand to include the adventurers as well as his own people, and the next great challenge the heroes face might come from the archmage as he plans his revenge.

Appendix A: Modifying Backgrounds This appendix provides alternative background features and bonds for player characters, with options that are strongly connected to the NPCs, themes, and events of this adventure.

S UBSTITUTE B ONDS

S UBSTITUTE F EATURES

Substitute Bonds dlO Bond

A player can choose one of the following features to replace the feature normally granted by his or her character's background.

This table provides alternative bonds that characters can have instead of the bonds from their backgrounds.

1

O PTIONAL F EATURE : D EEP D ELVER You have a knack

for making your way in the deep places of the world. You can recall the twists and turns of passageways and tunnels such that you can always retrace your steps underground. You’re also well acquainted with foraging and survival in the Underdark, and can determine when sources of food and water arc safe to consume. You can always find sufficient food and water for yourself and up to five other people in the Underdark, as long as sustenance is available in the area.

2

3

4

O PTIONAL F EATURE : U NDERDARK E XPERIENCE You

are no casual visitor to the Underdark, but instead have spent considerable time there learning its ways. You are familiar with the various races, civilizations, and settlements of the Underdark, as well as its major routes for travel. If you fail an Intelligence check to recall some piece of Underdark lore, you know a source you can consult for the answer unless the DM rules that the lore is unknown.

5

6

7

8

9

10

You were once lost in the Underdark, and a group of kuo-toa helped you find your way out. You learned that there are kindly folk even among that otherwise mad race, and remain indebted to them for their aid. You once had the opportunity to meet a circle of myconids— the mushroom folk of the Underdark. They offered you shelter and a chance to “meld" using their telepathic spores, and you have yearned ever since to repeat that experience. One of your best friends in your youth was Morista Malkin, a shield dwarf and member of the Emerald Enclave. Though you haven’t seen her in years, you heard she found her way to the reclaimed dwarf hold of Gauntlgrym. You once worked for Davra Jassur, a Zhentarim "troubleshooter” recruiting promising new talent for the Black Network. She helped you get your start as an adventurer, and you Owe her for that, You have long had a curious recurring dream about visiting a vaulted stone library in the depths of the Underdark, and becoming lost in the endless lore it holds. You studied with a deep gnome alchemist and miner named Kazook Pickshine, who saved your life once when a magical experiment went awry. Last you heard, his family controlled some of the largest mines in the deep gnome settlement of Blingdenstone. What little you know about the Underdark, you learned from living and fighting alongside the Feldrun dan of dwarves. You swore an honor debt to the dan before they joined the forces retaking Gauntlgrym and established themselves there. Years ago, a vicious noble named Ghazrim DuLoc was implicated in the death of someone you cared about. The crime was covered up, though, and DuLoc disappeared. Rumor has it the Zhentarim aided his escape, but you've sworn to find him one day. Years ago, you lost people you loved in a raid by creatures from the Underdark. They disappeared without a trace, either slain or taken into the depths, and you've always wondered whether they might still be alive and held as prisoners. You know the dwarf hold of Gauntlgrym well, having fought alongside the dwarves to help reclaim it. King Bruenor Battlehammer congratulated you on your valor, and you know the price the dwarves paid in blood to regain their home.

APPENDIX A | MODIFYING BACKGROUNDS

221

A PPENDIX B: M AGIC I TEMS Player characters can find a number of unusual magic items over the course of this adventure, including creations of the drow. the deep gnomes, and other inhabitants of the Underdark. D AWNBRINGER Weapon (longsword), legendary (requires attunement by a creature of non-evil alignment) Lost for ages in the Underdark, Dawnbringer appears to

be a gilded longsword hilt. While grasping the hilt, you can use a bonus action to make a blade of pure radiance spring from the hilt, or cause the blade to disappear. Dawnbringer has all the properties of a sun blade (see chapter 7. “Treasure,” of the Dungeon Master's Guide). While holding the weapon, you can use an action to touch a creature with the blade and cast lesser restoration on that creature. Once used, this ability can't be used again until the next dawn. Senffence. Dawnbringer is a sentient neutral good weapon with an Intelligence of 12, a Wisdom of 15, and a Charisma of 14. It has hearing and darkvision out to a range of 120 feet. The sword can speak, read, and understand Common, and it can communicate w'ith its wielder telepathically. D AW N B R I N G E R

PlWrtFwi

APPENDIX B I MAGIC ITEMS 22

2

Its voice is kind and feminine. It knows every language you know while you're attuned to it. Personality. Forged by ancient sun worshipers. Dawnbringer is meant to bring light into darkness and to fight creatures of darkness. It is kind and compassionate to those in need, but fierce and destructive to its enemies. Long years lost in darkness have made Dawnbringer frightened of both the dark and abandonment. It prefers that its blade always be present and shedding light in areas of darkness, and it strongly resists being parted from its wielder for any length of time. P IWAFWI (C LOAK OF E LVENKIND ) Wondrous item, uncommon (requires attunement)

This dark spider-silk cloak is made by drow. It is a cloak of elvenkind (see chapter 7. “Treasure,” of the Dungeon Master's Guide). It loses its magic if exposed to sunlight for 1 hour without interruption. P IWAFWI OF F IRE R ESISTANCE Wondrous item, rare (requires attunement) This cloak is a cloak of elvenkind (see chapter 7, “Treasure," of the Dungeon Master’s Guide). It also grants you

resistance to fire damage while you wear it. It loses its magic if exposed to sunlight for 1 hour without interruption.

APPENDIX B I MAGIC ITEMS 22

2

plants (3 charges).

SPELL GEM

Wondrous item, rarity varies (attunement optional) A spell gem can contain one spell from any class’s spell

DROWCRAFT ITEMS

list. You become aware of the spell when you learn the gem's properties. While holding the gem, you can cast the spell from it as an action if you know the spell or if the spell is on your class's spell list. Doing so doesn't require any components and doesn’t require attunement. The spell then disappears from the gem. If the spell is of a higher level than you can normally cast, you must make an ability check using your spellcasting ability to determine whether you cast it successfully. The DC equals 10 + the spell's level. On a failed check, the spell disappears from the gem with no other effect. Each spell gem has a maximum level for the spell it can store. The spell level determines the gem’s rarity and the stored spell's saving throw DC and attack bonus, as shown in the Spell Gem table. You can imbue the gem with a spell if you’re attuned to it and it’s empty. To do so. you cast the spell while holding the gem. The spell is stored in the gem instead of having any effect. Casting the spell must require either 1 action or 1 minute or longer, and the spell’s level must be no higher than the gem's maximum. If the spell belongs to the school of abjuration and requires material components that are consumed, you must provide them, but they can be worth half as much as normal. Once imbued with a spell, the gem can't be imbued again until the next dawn. Deep gnomes created these magic gemstones and keep the creation process a secret. S TONESPEAKER C RYSTAL Wondrous item, rare (requires attunement)

Created by the stone giant librarians of Gravenhollow, this nineteen-inch-long shard of quartz grants you advantage on Intelligence (Investigation) checks while it is on your person. The crystal has 10 charges. While holding it, you can use an action to expend some of its charges to cast one of the following spells from it: speak with animals (2 charges), speak with dead (4 charges), or speak with SPELL GEM

Magic items crafted by the drow—and often other races of tne Underdark—use components and rites never meant to see the light of day. Many such items, including drow armor, weapons, and piwajwi cloaks, permanently lose their magic if they are exposed to sunlight for 1 hour without interruption. Charged items such as a wand of viscid globs are destroyed after 1 hour’s exposure to sunlight.

When you cast a divination spell, you can use the crystal in place of one material component that would normally be consumed by the spell, at a cost of 1 charge per level of the spell. The crystal is not consumed when used in this way. The crystal regains ld6 + 4 expended charges daily at dawn. If you expend the crystal's last charge, roll a d20. On a 1, the crystal vanishes, lost forever. W AND OF V ISCID G LOBS Wand, rare (requires attunement)

Crafted by the drow, this slim black wand has 7 charges. While holding it, you can use an action to expend 1 of its charges to cause a small glob of viscous material to launch from the tip at one creature within 60 feet of you. Make a ranged attack roll against the target, with a bonus equal to your spellcasting modifier (or your Intelligence modifier, if you don’t have a spellcasting ability) plus your proficiency bonus. On a hit. the glob expands and dries on the target, which is restrained for 1 hour. After that time, the viscous material cracks and falls away. Applying a pint or more of alcohol to the restrained creature dissolves the glob instantly, as does the application of oil of etherealness or universal solvent. The glob also dissolves instantly if exposed to sunlight. No other nonmagical process can remove the viscous material until it deteriorates on its own. The wand regains ld6 + 1 expended charges daily at midnight. If you expend the wand's last charge, roll a d20. On a 1, the wand melts into harmless slime and is destroyed. A wand of viscid globs is destroyed if exposed to sunlight for 1 hour without interruption.

Max. Spell Level

Gemstone

Rarity

Save DC

Attack Bonus

Cantrip 1st 2nd 3rd 4th 5th

Obsidian Lapis lazuli Quartz Bloodstone Amber Jade

Uncommon Uncommon Rare Rare Very rare Very rare

13 13 13 15 15 17

+5 +5 +5 +7 +9 +9

6th 7th 8th 9th

Topaz Star ruby Ruby Diamond

Very rare Legendary Legendary Legendary

17 18 18 19

+10 +10 +10 +11

A P P E N D I X C: C R E ATU R E S This appendix presents new monsters and NPCs encountered in this

adventure. APPENDIX B I MAGIC ITEMS

223

MONSTERS AND R ATI N G

NPCs B Y

Monster

CHALLENGE Challenge

Bridesmaid of Zuggtmoy Drow spore servant

1/8 1/8

Derro Ixitxachitl Male steeder Duergar spore servant Duergar soulblade Female steeder Awakened zurkhwood Chamberlain of Zuggtmoy

1/4 1/4 1/4 1/2 1 1 2 2 2 2 2

Droki (NPC) Duergar darkhaft Duergar kavalrachni Duergar Keeper of the Flame Duergar Stone Guard Duergar xarrorn Grisha (NPC) Narrak (NPC) Vampiric ixitxachitl Derro savant

2 2

Hook horror spore servant Troglodyte champion of Laogzed Chuul spore servant

3 3 4

The Pudding King (NPC) Yestabrod (NPC)

4 4

2 2 2 2 3

Second-Class Citizens. Derro create no settlements of their own. Instead, they form small, isolated enclaves in non-derro settlements throughout the Underdark, where they are treated as vermin or slaves. Their own cutthroat politics prevent the derro from mounting any effective resistance against such exploitation. Derro Weapons. The derro wield special weapons. They use a hooked shortspear, which is a martial melee weapon that deals ld4 piercing damage, weighs 2 pounds, and has the light weapon property (see chapter 5, “Equipment," of the Player’s Handbook). It doesn't possess the thrown or versatile weapon properties of a normal spear. On a hit with this weapon, the wielder can forgo dealing damage and attempt to trip the target, in which case the target must succeed on a Strength saving throw or fall prone. The DC is 8 + the wielder’s Strength modifier + the wielder’s proficiency bonus. The derro also use a light repeating crossbow fitted with a cartridge that can hold up to six crossbow bolts. This weapon is similar to a light crossbow except that it has half the range (40/160 feet) and doesn't have the loading property. It automatically reloads after firing until it runs out of ammunition. Reloading the cartridge takes an action. Derro

D ERRO

The derro are degenerate Underdark humanoids that resemble small dwarves. Cruel and insane, they take delight in tormenting others—even their own kind. Derro have blue-gray skin and straight hair that is white or yellow in color. Their uniformly pale white eyes lack both irises and pupils. Unnatural Origin. Derro believe they were created by their god, Diirinka, but they are actually the result of cruel experiments on dwarves by mind flayers. Like duergar, the derro were a slave race to the mind flayers, but eventually freed themselves. Born to Madness. The process of their creation rendered the derro irrevocably insane. They cooperate with each other only out of necessity and when riled up by a charismatic leader. Life of Attrition. Derro can live to be one hundred and fifty years old, but they mature and breed quickly. When their elders deem that their numbers are becoming unmanageable, the derro declare war on some other race and surge forth in a reckless horde, fighting until their population dwindles to a tolerable size. These ghastly purges weed out the weak among the derro and are referred to as “Uniting Wars." APPENDIX C | CREATURES

224-

Small humanoid (derro), chaotic evil Armor Class 13 (leather armor) Hit Points 13 (3d6 + 3) Speed 30 ft. STR DEX CON INT WIS CHA 9 (-1) 14 (+2) 12 (+1)

11 (+0)

5 (-3)

9 (-1)

Skills Stealth +4 Senses darkvision 120 ft., passive Perception 7 Languages Dwarvish, Undercommon Challenge 1/4 (50 XP) Insanity. The derro has advantage on saving throws against

being charmed or frightened. Magic Resistance. The derro has advantage on saving throws

against spells and other magical effects. Sunlight Sensitivity. While in sunlight, the derro has disadvantage

on attack rolls, as well as on Wisdom (Perception) checks that rely on sight.

Actions_______________________________ Hooked Shortspear. Melee Weapon Attack: +2 to hit, reach 5 ft., one

target. Hit: 1 (ld4 - 1) piercing damage. If the target is a creature, the derro can choose to deal no damage and try to trip the target instead, in which case the target must succeed on a DC 9 Strength saving throw or fall prone. Light Repeating Crossbow. Ranged Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, range 40/160 ft., one target. Hit: 6 (ld8 + 2) piercing damage.

IXITXACHITL Ixitxachitl (pronounced ick-z/f-zah-chit-ul) are aquatic creatures resembling manta rays, with small, clawed hands at the ends of their “wings” and black eyes gleaming with sinister intelligence. Many creatures mistake ixitxachitl for common manta rays, but this can prove a deadly mistake. The ixitxachitl are as evil as they are cunning, leading to their common nickname “demon rays." They inhabit bodies of fresh and salt water, but their violent nature means that little is known of them. Struggle for Survival. Ixitxachitl emerge from eggs as tiny creatures little more than a hand span in width. From that time onward, they struggle to survive at all costs, growing throughout their lives. Those ixitxachitl that master the secrets of survival gain powers of regeneration and feed on the life force of other creatures. All Consuming. Ixitxachitl hollow out coral reefs or other natural aquatic formations to create labyrinthine dens, often compelling aid from captured aquatic species they enslave. They typically strip an area bare before moving on to new fertile grounds, leaving their abandoned dens behind. Schools of ixitxachitl often war on other aquatic creatures to claim feeding grounds and territory. Demon Worshipers. The ixitxachitl venerate and serve various demons, particularly Demogorgon, whom they consider their patron and creator. They have an intense rivalry with the merrow over which of them are the greatest and most favored servants of the Prince of Demons. Ixitxachitl Small aberration, chaotic Armor Class 15 evil (natural armor) Hit Points 18 (4d6 + 4) Speed 0 ft., swim 30 ft.

STR DEX CON INT WIS CHA 12 (+1) 16 (+3) 13 (+1)

Variant: Derro Savant Derro savants Have an affinity for arcane magic. A derro savant has the same statistics as a derro. except that it has 49 (11 d6 + 11) hit points, a Charisma of 14 (+2), and a challenge rating of 3 (700 XP). The savant also gains the following additional feature.

12 (+1)

13 (+1)

7 (-2)

Senses darkvision 60 ft., passive Perception 11 Languages Abyssal, Ixitxachitl Challenge 1/4 (50 XP) 1st level (4 slots): burning hands, chromatic orb, sleep 2nd level (3 slots): invisibility, spider climb 3rd level (2 slots): blink, lightning bolt

Spellcasting. The derro is a 5th-level spellcaster. Its

spellcasting ability is Charisma (save DC 12, +4 to hit with spell attacks). The derro knows the following sorcerer spells: Cantrips (at will): acid splash, light, mage hand, message, ray of frost APPENDIX C I CREATURES

225

Actions________________________________

Reactions______________________________

Bite. Melee Weapon Attack: +3 to hit, reach 5 ft., one

Barbed Tail. When a creature provokes an opportunity attack

target.

from the ixitxachitl, the ixitxachitl can make the following attack instead of using its bite. Melee Weapon Attack: +5 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target. Hit: 7 (ld8 + 3) piercing damage.

Hit: 4 (ld6 + 1) piercing damage.

APPENDIX C | CREATURES

226-

VARIANT: IXITXACHITL CLERIC

Some ixitxachitl and vampiric ixitxachitl are able to cast divine spells. Such a creature gains the following feature. Spellcasting. The ixitxachitl is a 5th-level spellcaster

that uses Wisdom as its spellcasting ability (spell save DC 11, +3 to hit with spell attacks). The ixitxachitl has the following cleric spells prepared: Cantrips (at will): guidance, thaumaturge 1st Level (4 slots): charm person, create or destroy water 2nd Level (3 slots): hold person, silence 3rd Level (2 slots): dispel magic, tongues

C REATURE V ARIATIONS This section introduces variations of monsters that are described in the Monster Manual. DUERGAR

The Monster Manual provides statistics for the typical armed duergar. However, characters meet other kinds of duergar in the course of this adventure. D UERGAR D ARKHAFT

The darkhafts are the members of the Deepking's secret corps of psionic agents. The duergar darkhaft has the same statistics as the duergar in the Monster Manual. except that its challenge rating is 2 (450 XP) and it has the following additional feature.

Vampiric Ixitxachitl Medium aberration, chaotic evil

Armor Class T6 (natural Hit Points 44 (8dS + 8)

armor)

Innate Spellcasting (Psionics). The darkhaft's innate spellcasting

Speed 0 ft., swim 30 ft. 14 (+2)

SIR DEX CON INT WIS CHA 18 (+4) 13 (+1) 12 (+1) 13 (+1)

ability is Intelligence (spell save DC 10). It can innately cast the following spells, requiring no components 7 (-2)

Senses darkvision GO ft., passive Perception 11 Languages Abyssal, Ixitxachitl Challenge 2 (450 XP)

At Wi\\: friends, mage hand 1 /day each: disguise self, sleep

D UERGAR K AVALRACHNI Regeneration. The ixitxachitl regains 10 hit points at the start of

its turn. The ixitxachitl dies only if it starts its turn with 0 hit points.

Actions_________________________________ Vampiric Bite. Melee Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, reach 5 ft., one

target. Hit: 6 (ld8 + 2) piercing damage. The target must succeed on a DC 11 Constitution saving throw or its hit point maximum is reduced by an amount equal to the damage taken, and the ixitxachitl regains hit points equal to that amount. The reduction lasts until the target finishes a long rest. The target dies if its hit point maximum is reduced to 0.

Reactions ______________________________ Barbed Tail. When a creature provokes an opportunity attack

from the ixitxachitl, the ixitxachitl can make the following attack instead of using its bite. Melee Weapon Attack: +6 to hit, reach 10 ft., one target. Hit: 9 (ldlO + 4) piercing damage.

The vicious kavalrachni are the duergar cavalry of Gracklstugh, riding giant tarantulas known as steeders (see the female steeder stat block in this appendix). The duergar kavalrachni has the same statistics as the duergar in the Monster Manual, except that its challenge rating is 2 (450 XP) and it has the following Cavalry Training feature and Heavy Crossbow action Cavalry Training. When the duergar hits a target with a melee

attack while mounted on a female steeder, the steeder can make a melee attack against the same target as a reaction Heavy Crossbow. Ranged Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, range 100/400

ft., one target, Hit: 5 (ldlO) piercing damage. OF THE F LAME The Keepers of the Flame is a well-respected order of psionic clerics that serves the red dragon Themberchaud in Gracklstugh. and whose members are advisors to the Deepking.

D UERGAR K EEPER

APPENDIX C

227

I CREATURES

The duergar Keeper of the Flame uses the same statistics as the duergar in the Monster Manual, except that its challenge rating is 2 (450 XP) and it has the following additional features.

APPENDIX C I CREATURES

228

Innate Spellcasting (Psionics). The Keeper of the Flame's innate

spellcasting ability is Wisdom (spell save DC 12), It can innately cast the following spells, requiring no components: At w\\\: friends, message 3/day; command

possible in the space available. Create Soulblade. The duergar creates a visible, shortsword sized blade of psionic energy. The weapon appears in the duergar’s hand and vanishes if it leaves the duergar’s grip, or if the duergar dies or is incapacitated. Invisibility (Recharges after a Short or Long Rest). The duergar

Spellcasting. The Keeper of the Flame is a 3rd-level spellcaster.

Its spellcasting ability is Wisdom (spell save DC 12, +4 to hit with spell attacks). The Keeper of the Flame has the following cleric spells prepared:

magically turns invisible for up to 1 hour or until it attacks, it casts a spell, it uses its Enlarge, or its concentration is broken (as if concentrating on a Spell). Any equipment the duergar wears or carries is invisible with it. Soulblade. Melee Weapon Attack: +5 to hit, reach 5 ft,, one target.

Cantrips (at will): guidance, mending, sacred fame 1st level (4 slots): bane, infict wounds, shield of faith 2nd level (2 slots): enhance ability, spiritual weapon

Hit. 1 6 (ld6 + 3) force damage, or 10 (2d6 ■+ 3) force damage while enlarged. If the soulblade has advantage on the attack roll, the attack deals an extra 3 (ld6) force damage,

D UERGAR S OULBLADE

Duergar soulblades are assassins with the ability to manifest blades of psionic energy.

Duergar Stone Guard

Medium humanoid (dwarf), lawful evil

Armor Class 18 (chain mail, shield) Hit Points 39 (6d8 + 12) Speed 25 ft.

D UERGAR S TONE G UARD

The Stone Guards are veteran warriors who serve the Deepking as bodyguards, elite troops, and secret police, D UERGAR X ARRORN

The xarrorn arc duergar warriors of Clan Xardclvar trained to wield lances that spew alchemical fire.

18 (+4)

STR DEX CON INT WIS CHA 11 (+0) 14 (+2) 11 (+0) 10 (+0)

9 (-1)

Damage Resistances poison Senses darkvision 120 ft., passive Perception 10 Languages Dwarvish, Undercommon Challenge 2 (450 XP) Duergar Resilience. The duergar has advantage on saving throws

against poison, spells, and illusions, as well as to resist being charmed or paralyzed.

Duergar Soulblade

Medium humanoid (dwarf), lawful evil

Phalanx Formation. The duergar has advantage on attack rolls

and Dexterity saving throws while standing within 5 feet of a duergar ally wielding a shield.

Armor Class 14 (leather armor) Hit Points 18 (4d8) Speed 25 ft.

Sunlight Sensitivity. While in sunlight, the duergar has

STR 11 (+0)

DEX 16 (+3)

CON 10 (+0)

INT 11 (+0)

WIS 10 (+0)

CHA 12 (+1)

Damage Resistances poison Senses darkvision 120 ft,, passive Perception 10 Languages Dwarvish, Undercommon Challenge 1 (200 XP)

Duergar Resilience. The duergar has advantage on saving throws

against poison, spells, and illusions, as well as to resist being charmed or paralyzed. Innate Spellcasting (Psionics). The duergar’s innate spellcasting

ability is Wisdom (spell save DC 12, +4 to hit with spell attacks). It can innately cast the following spells, requiring no components:

disadvantage on attack rolls, as well as on Wisdom (Perception) checks that rely on sight.

Actions________________________________ Enlarge (Recharges after a Short or Long Rest). For 1 minute the

duergar magically increases in size, along with anything it is wearing or carrying. While enlarged, the duergar is Large, doubles its damage dice on Strength-based weapon attacks (included in the attacks), and makes Strength checks and Strength saving throws with advantage. If the duergar lacks the room to become Large, it attains the maximum size possible in the space available. King's Knife (Shortsword). Melee Weapon Attack: -t-6 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target. Hit: 7 (ld6 + 4) piercing damage, or 11 (2d6 + 4) piercing damage while enlarged. Javelin. Melee or Ranged Weapon Attack: +6 to hit, reach 5 ft. or range 30/120 ft., one target. Hit: 7 (ld6 + 4) piercing damage,

At will: blade ward, true strike 3/day each: jump, hunter's mark

or 11 (2d6 + 4) piercing damage while enlarged.

Sunlight Sensitivity. While in sunlight, the duergar has

magically turns invisible for up to 1 hour or until it attacks, it casts a spell, it uses its Enlarge, or its concentration is broken (as if concentrating on a spell). Any equipment the duergar wears or carries is invisible with it.

disadvantage on attack rolls, as well as on Wisdom (Perception) checks that rely on sight.

Actions _______________________________________________

Invisibility (Recharges after a Short or Long Rest). The duergar

Enlarge (Recharges after a Short or Long Rest). For 1 minute, the

duergar magically increases in size, along with anything it is wearing or carrying. While enlarged, the duergar is Large, doubles its damage dice on Strength-based weapon attacks (included in the attacks), and makes Strength checks and Strength saving throws with advantage. If the duergar lacks the room to become Large, it attains the maximum size APPENDIX C I CREATURES

229

Duergar Xarrorn Medium humanoid (dwarf), lawful evil Armor Class 18 (plate mail) Hit Points 26 (4d8 + 8) Speed 25 ft. STR 16 (+3)

DEX 11 (+0)

CON 14 (+2)

INT WIS 11 (+0) 10 (+0)

CHA 9(-l)

Damage Resistances poison Senses darkvision 120 ft., passive Perception 10 Languages Dwarvish, Undercommon Challenge 2 (450 XP)

Duergar Resilience. The duergar has advantage on saving throws

against poison, spells, and illusions, as well as to resist being charmed or paralyzed. Sunlight Sensitivity. While in sunlight, the duergar has

disadvantage on attack rolls, as well as on Wisdom (Perception) checks that rely on sight.

Actions _______________________________ Enlarge (Recharges after a Short or Long Rest). For 1 minute, the

duergar magically increases in size, along with anything it is wearing or carrying. While enlarged, the duergar is Large, doubles its damage dice on Strength-based weapon attacks (included in the attacks), and makes Strength checks and Strength saving throws with advantage. If the duergar lacks the room to become Large, it attains the maximum size possible in the space available. Fire Lance. Melee Weapon Attack: +5 to hit (with disadvantage if

the target is within 5 feet of the duergar), reach 10 ft., one target. Hit: 9 (ld!2+ 3) piercing damage plus 3 (ld6) fire damage, or 16 (2dl2 + 3) piercing damage plus 3 (ld6) fire damage while enlarged.

releases spores that burst out in a cloud that fills a 10-foot-radius sphere centered on it, and the cloud lingers for 1 minute. Any flesh-and-blood creature in the cloud when it appears, or that enters it later, must make a Constitution saving throw. The save DC is 8 + the myconid’s Constitution modifier + the myconid’s proficiency bonus. On a successful save, the creature can't be infected by these spores for 24 hours. On a failed save, the creature is infected with a disease called the spores of Zuggtmoy and also gains a random form of indefinite madness (determined by rolling on the Madness of Zuggtmoy table in appendix D) that lasts until the creature is cured of the disease or dies. While infected in this way, the creature can't be reinfected, and it must repeat the saving throw' at the end of every 24 hours, ending the infection on a success. On a failure, the infected creature’s body is slowly taken over by fungal growth, and after three such failed saves, the creature dies and is reanimated as a spore servant if it’s a type of creature that can be (see the ’’Myconids” entry in the Monster Manual). Euphoria Spores (1/Day). The myconid releases a cloud of spores in a 20-foot-radius sphere centered on itself. Other creatures in that area must each succeed on a Constitution saving throw or become poisoned for 1 minute. The save DC is 8 + the myconid’s Constitution modifier + the myconid's proficiency bonus. A creature can repeat the saving throw at the end of each of its turns, ending the effect early on itself on a success. When the effect ends on it. the creature gains one level of exhaustion.

Fire Spray (Recharge 5-6). From its fire lance, the duergar shoots

S P O R E S E RVAN T S

a 15-foot cone of fire or a line of fire 30 feet long and 5 feet wide. Each creature in that area must make a DC 12 Dexterity saving throw, taking 10 (3d6) fire damage on a failed save, or half as much damage on a successful one.

Statistics for four new kinds of spore servants are presented here. Chuul Spore Servant Large plant, unaligned

Invisibility (Recharges after a Short or Long Rest). The duergar

magically turns invisible for up to 1 hour or until it attacks, it casts a spell, it uses its Enlarge, or its concentration is broken (as if concentrating on a spell). Any equipment the duergar wears or carries is invisible with it.

MYCONIDS

Myconids that embrace Zuggtmoy can develop new. more destructive kinds of spores. Myconid adults can have two of the following spore effects. Myconid sovereigns have all these spore effects. Caustic Spores (1/Day). The myconid releases spores in a 30-foot cone. Each creature inside the cone must succeed on a Dexterity saving throw or take ld6 acid damage at the start of each of the myconid’s turns. A creature can repeat the saving throw at the end of its turn, ending the effect on itself on a success. The save DC is 8 + the myconid's Constitution modifier + the myconids proficiency bonus. Infestation Spores (1/Day). The myconid APPENDIX C I CREATURES

230

Armor Class 16 (natural armor) Hit Points 93 (lldl0 + 33) Speed 30 ft., swim 30 ft. STR 19 (+4)

DEX 10 (+0)

CON 16 (+3)

INT 2 (-4)

WIS 6 (-2)

CHA 1 (-5)

Damage Immunities poison Condition Immunities blinded, charmed, frightened, paralyzed, poisoned Senses blindsight 30 ft. (blind beyond this radius), passive Perception 8 Languages — Challenge 4 (1,100 XP)

Actions________________________________ Multiattack. The spore servant makes two pincer attacks. Pincer. Melee Weapon Attack: +6 to hit, reach 10 ft., one target Hit:

11 (2d6 + 4) bludgeoning damage. The target is grappled (escape DC 14) if it is a Large or smaller creature and the

spore servant doesn't have two other creatures grappled.

APPENDIX C I CREATURES

231

Drow Spore Servant

Troglodyte_____________________________

Medium plant, unaligned

Armor Class 15 (chain shirt) Hit Points 13 (3d8) Speed 20 ft.

10

(+0) 14 (+2)

10 (+0)

STR DEX CON INT WIS CHA 2 (-4) 6 (-2) 1 (-5)

Condition Immunities blinded, charmed, frightened, paralyzed Senses blindsight 30 ft. (blind beyond this radius), passive Perception 8 Languages — Challenge 1/8 (25 XP)

Actions______________________________ Shortsword. Melee Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target. Hit: 5 (1 d6 + 2) piercing damage.

Duergar Spore Servant

The Monster Manual provides statistics for the typical troglodyte. Once in a while, a troglodyte tribe produces an unusually smart and strong specimen that can spew acid—what many troglodytes consider blessings from Laogzed, their demonic god. These hulking troglodyte champions make excellent chieftains.

Troglodyte Champion of Laogzed Medium humanoid (troglodyte), chaotic evil

Armor Class 14 (natural armor) Hit Points 59 (7d8 + 28) Speed 30 ft. STR 18 (+4)

DEX CON 12 (+1) 18 (+4)

INT 8 (-1)

WIS CHA 12 (+1) 12 ( + 1)

Skills Athletics +6, Intimidation +3, Stealth +3 Senses darkvision 60 ft., passive Perception 11 Languages Troglodyte Challenge 3 (700 XP)

Medium plant, unaligned

Armor Class 16 (scale armor, shield) Hit Points 26 (4d8 + 8) Speed 15 ft.

14 (+2)

11 (+0)

STR DEX CON INT WIS CHA 14 (+2) 2 (-4) 6 (-2) 1 (-5)

Damage Resistances poison Senses blindsight 30 ft. (blind beyond this radius), passive Perception 8 Condition Immunities blinded, charmed, frightened, paralyzed Languages — Challenge 1/2 (100 XP)

Actions______________________________ War Pick. Melee Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target.

Hit: 6 (1 d8 + 2) piercing damage.

Hook Horror Spore Servant

Chameleon Skin. The troglodyte has advantage on Dexterity (Stealth) checks made to hide.

Stench. Any creature other than a troglodyte that starts its turn within 5 feet of the troglodyte must succeed on a DC 14 Constitution saving throw or be poisoned until the start of the creature’s next turn. On a successful saving throw, the creature is immune to the stench of all troglodytes for 1 hour.

Sunlight Sensitivity. While in sunlight, the troglodyte has disadvantage on attack rolls, as well as on Wisdom (Perception) checks that rely on sight.

Actions________________________________ Multiattack. The troglodyte makes three attacks: one with its bite and two with either its claws or its greatclub.

Medium plant, unaligned

Bite. Melee Weapon Attack: +6 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target.

Armor Class 15 (natural armor) Hit Points 75 (10dl0+ 10) Speed 20 ft., climb 20 ft.

Claw. Melee Weapon Attack: +6 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target.

18 (+4)

10 (+0)

Hit: 6 (1 d4 + 4) piercing damage.

15 (+2)

STR DEX CON INT WIS CHA 2 (-4) 6 (-2) 1 (-5)

Hit: 6 (ld4 + 4) slashing damage.

Creatclub.

Melee Attack: +6 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target. Hit: 8 (ld8 + 4) bludgeoning damage.

Acid Spray (Recharge 6). The troglodyte spits acid in a line 15 feet long and 5 feet wide. Each creature in that line must make a DC 14 Dexterity saving throw, taking 10 (3d6) acid damage on a failed save, or half as much damage on a successful one.

Actions_______________________________ Multiattack. The spore servant makes two hook attacks. Hook. Melee Weapon Attack: +6 to hit, reach 10 ft., one target. Hit: 11 (2d6 + 4) piercing damage. APPENDIX C I CREATURES ______________ 9 I

A... , I

Senses blindsight 30 ft. (blind beyond this radius), passive Perception 8 Condition Immunities blinded, charmed, frightened, paralyzed Languages — Challenge 3 (700 XP)

M ISCELLANEOUS C REATURES

This section contains statistics for various weird creatures and critters that appear in the adventure. P L A N T C R E ATU R E S

______________________

Zuggtmoy has several fungal bridesmaids and a chamberlain to help her prepare for her wedding to Araumycos. Meanwhile, her myconid servants use awakened zurkhwoods to guard their fungal groves.

Awakened Zurkhwood This creature is an ordinary zurkhwood mushroom (see “Fungi of the Underdark” in chapter 2) given sentience and mobility. An awakened zurkhwood can be created by casting the awaken spell on a normal zurkhwood mushroom. A myconid sovereign can create one by performing a lengthy ritual. An awakened zurkhwood has the same statistics as an awakened tree (see appendix A of the Monster Manual), with the following modifications: • The awakened zurkhwood has darkvision out to a range of 120 feet. • If the awakened zurkhwood was created by a myconid sovereign, it can’t speak. • The awakened zurkhwood's False Appearance feature allows it to be mistaken for a normal zurkhwood mushroom (instead of a tree).

Bridesmaid of Zuggtmoy

creature in the cloud when it appears, or that enters it later, must make a DC 10 Constitution saving throw. On a successful save, the creature can’t be infected by these spores for 24 hours. On a failed save, the creature is infected with a disease called the spores of Zuggtmoy and also gains a random form of indefinite madness (determined by rolling on the Madness of Zuggtmoy table in appendix D) that lasts until the creature is cured of the disease or dies. While infected in this way, the creature can't be reinfected, and it must repeat the saving throw at the end of every 24 hours, ending the infection on a success. On a failure, the infected creature’s body is slowly taken over by fungal growth, and after three such failed saves, the creature dies and is reanimated as a spore servant if it’s a type of creature that can be (see the “Myconids'' entry in the Monster Manual).

The bridesmaids of Zuggtmoy are plant creatures with vaguely humanoid forms. Their frail bodies arc covered with clusters of luminescent lichen and crusty, tumescent growths.

Chamberlain of Zuggtmoy Large plant, chaotic evil

Armor Class 13 (natural armor) Hit Points 45 (6dl0+ 12) Speed 20 ft. STR 17 (+3)

DEX 7 (-2)

CON 14 (+2)

INT 11 (+0)

WIS 8 (-1)

CHA 12 (+1)

Damage Resistances bludgeoning, piercing Senses darkvision 60 ft., passive Perception 9 Languages Abyssal, Undercommon Challenge 2 (450 XP)

Medium plant, chaotic evil

Armor Class 13 (natural armor) Hit Points 22 (5d8) Speed 20 ft,

Mushroom Portal. The chamberlain counts as a mushroom for

the Fungus Stride feature of the bridesmaid of Zuggtmoy. Poison Spores. Whenever the chamberlain takes damage, it

STR DEX CON INT WIS CHA 14 (+2) 11 (+0) 11 (+0)

14 (+2)

8 (-1)

18 (+4)

Senses darkvision 60 ft., passive Perception 9 Languages understands Abyssal but can't speak Challenge 1/8 (25 XP) Fungus Stride. Once on its turn, the bridesmaid can use 10 feet of its movement to step magically into one living mushroom or fungus patch within 5 feet and emerge from another within 60 feet of the first one, appearing in an unoccupied space within 5 feet of the second mushroom or fungus patch. The mushrooms and patches must be Large or bigger.

Actions _______________________________ Hallucination Spores. The bridesmaid ejects spores at one

creature it can see within 5 feet of it. The target must succeed on a DC 10 Constitution saving throw or be poisoned for 1 minute. While poisoned in this way, the target is incapacitated. The target can repeat the saving throw at the end of each of its turns, ending the effect on itself on a success. Infestation Spores (1/Day). The bridesmaid releases spores that

burst out in a cloud that fills a 10-foot-radius sphere centered on it, and the cloud lingers for 1 minute. Any flesh-and-blood APPENDIX C

230

I CREATURES

releases a cloud of spores. Creatures within 5 feet of the chamberlain when this happens must succeed on a DC 12 Constitution saving throw or be poisoned for 1 minute. A creature can repeat the saving throw at the end of each of its turns, ending the effect on itself on a success.

Actions________________________________ Multiaitack.-The chamberlain makes two slam attacks. Slam. Melee Weapon Attack: +5 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target Hit: 10 (2d6 + 3) bludgeoning damage. Infestation Spores (1/Day). The chamberlain releases spores that

burst out in a cloud that fills a 10-foot-radius sphere centered on it, and the cloud lingers for 1 minute. Any flesh- andblood creature in the cloud when it appears, or that enters it later, must make a DC 12 Constitution saving throw. On a successful save, the creature can't be infected by these spores for 24 hours. On a failed save, the creature is infected with a disease called the spores of Zuggtmoy and also gains a random form of indefinite madness (determined by rolling on the Madness of Zuggtmoy table in appendix D) that lasts until the creature is cured of the disease or dies. While infected in this way, the creature can’t be reinfected, and it must repeat the saving throw at the end of every 24 hours, ending the infection on a success. On a failure, the infected creature's body is

1

slowly taken over by fungal growth, and after three such failed saves, the creature dies and is reanimated as a spore servant if it's a type of creature that can be (see the “Myconids" entry in the Monster Manual).

A chamberlain of Zuggtmoy looks like a vaguely bipedal mass of blue mold with the barest hint of a face nested deep inside a mossy cowl. It pummels enemies with its mossy fists.

STEEDERS_________________________ Duergar breed and train these giant Underdark-dwelling tarantulas. Male steeders are as big as ponies and used by the duergar as beasts of burden. The larger females are trained and used as mounts. Steeders don’t spin webs, but they exude a sticky substance from their legs that lets them walk on walls and ceilings without trouble, as well as snare prey.

Male Steeder

Medium beast, unaligned

Armor Class 12 (natural armor) Hit Points 13 (2d8 + 4) Speed 30 ft., climb 30 ft.

15 (+2)

STR DEX CON INT WIS CHA 12 (+1) 14 (+2) 2 (-4) 10 (+0)

3 (-4)

Skills Stealth +5 Senses darkvision 120 ft., passive Perception 10 Languages — Challenge 1/4 (50 XP)

Spider Climb, The steeder can climb difficult surfaces, including upside down on ceilings, without needing to make ar, ability check.

Female Steeder

Leap. The steeder can expend all its movement on its turn to

Armor Class 14 (natural armor) Hit Points 30 (4d10 + 8)

Actions ________________________________

jump up to 60 feet vertically or horizontally, provided that its speed is at least 30 feet.

Large beast, unaligned

Speed 30 ft., climb 30 ft. STR DEX CON INT WIS CHA 15 (+2) 16 (+3) 14 (+2)

2 (-4)

10 (+0)

3 (-4)

Skills Stealth +7 Senses darkvision 120 ft., passive Perception 10 Languages — Challenge 1 (200 XP)

Spicier Climb. The steeder can climb difficult surfaces, including upside down on ceilings, without needing to make an ability check.

Leap.

The steeder can expend all its movement on its turn to jump up to 90 feet vertically or horizontally, provided that its speed is at least 30 feet.

Actions_________________________________________________ Bite. Melee Weapon Attack: +5 to hit, reach 5 ft., one creature. Hit: 7 (1 d8 + 3) piercing damage, and the target must make a DC 12 Constitution saving throw, taking 9 (2d8) acid damage on a failed save, or half as much damage on a successful one.

Sticky Leg (Recharges u/hen the Steeder Has No Creatures Grappled). Melee Weapon Attack: +5 to hit, reach 5 ft., one Medium or smaller creature. Hit: The target is stuck to the steeder's leg and

Bite. Melee Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, reach 5 ft., one creature. Hit: 7 (ld8 + 2) piercing damage, and the target must make a DC 12 Constitution saving throw, taking 4 (IdS) acid damage on a failed save, or half as much damage on a successful one Sticky Leg (Recharges when the Steeder Has No Creatures Grappled). Melee Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, reach 5 ft., one Small or Tiny creature. Hit; The target is stuck to the steeder's leg and grappled until it escapes (escape DC 12).

N ONPLAYER C HARACTERS This section presents statistics fur several unique NPCs encountered in the adventure.

Droki

Small humanoid (derro), chaotic evil

Armor Class 15 (studded leather) Hit Points 31 (7d6 + 7) Speed 30 ft. (60 ft. with boots of speed) STR 11 (+0)

DEX CON 16 (+3) 13 (+1)

INT 10 (+0)

WIS 5 (-3)

CHA 16 (+3)

Skills Stealth +5 Senses darkvision 120 ft., passive Perception 7 Languages Dwarvish. Undercommon Challenge 2 (450 XP)

grappled until it escapes (escape DC 12).

Special Equipment. Droki wears boots of speed. Insanity. Droki has advantage on saving throws against being charmed or frightened.

Innate Spellcasting. Droki's innate spellcasting ability is Charisma (spell save DC 13). He can innately cast the following spells, requiring no material components:

At will: minor illusion 1/day each: darkness, fear, shatter APPENDIX C | CREATURES

231

Magic Resistance. Droki has advantage on saving throws against

spells and other magical effects. Sneak Attack (1 /Turn). Droki deals an extra 7 (2d6) damage when

he hits a target with a weapon attack and has advantage on the attack roll, or when the target is within 5 feet of an ally of Droki that isn't incapacitated and Droki doesn't have disadvantage on the attack roll. Sunlight Sensitivity. While in sunlight, Droki has disadvantage on

attack rolls, as well as on Wisdom (Perception) checks that rely on sight.

Actions______________________________________________

Narrak

Small humanoid (derro), chaotic evil Armor Class 12 (15 with 40 (9d6 + 9) Speed 30 ft.

mage armor) Hit Points

STR DEX CON INT WIS CHA 9 (-1) 14 (+2) 13 (+1) 14 (+2) 5 (-3)

16 (+3)

Saving Throws Dex +4, Cha +5 Skills Arcana +4, Stealth +4 Senses darkvision 120 ft., passive Perception 7 Languages Dwarvish, Undercommon Challenge 2 (450 XP)

Multiattack. Droki makes two attacks with his shortsword.

Melee Weapon Attack: +5 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target. Hit: 6 (ld6 + 3) piercing damage. The sword is

Insanity. Narrak has advantage on saving throws against being

coated with serpent venom that wears off after the first hit. A target subjected to the venom must make a DC 11 Constitution saving throw, taking 10 (3d6) poison damage on a failed save, or half as much damage on a successful one.

Magic Resistance. Narrak has advantage on saving throws

Shortsword.

Reactions____________________________________________ Parry. Droki adds 3 to his AC against one melee attack that

would hit him. To do so, Droki must see the attacker and be wielding a melee weapon.

Grisha

Medium humanoid (Damaran human), chaotic evil Armor Class 18 (chain mail, shield) Hit Points 33 (6d8 + 6) Speed 30 ft.

14 (+2)

STR DEX CON INT WIS CHA 12 (+1) 12 (+1) 11 (+0) 14 (+2) 16 (+3)

Saving Throws Wis +4, Cha +5 Skills Persuasion +5, Religion +2 Senses passive Perception 12 Languages Common, Undercommon Challenge 2 (450 XP)

Spellcasting. Grisha is a Sth-level spellcaster. His spellcasting

ability is Wisdom (spell save DC 12, +4 to hit with spell attacks), He has the following cleric spells prepared:

Cantrips (at will): guidance, light, sacred flame, thaumaturgy 1st level (4 slots): cure wounds, divine favor, inflict wounds, protection from good, shield of faith 2nd level (3 slots): continual fame, hold person, magic weapon, spiritual weapon 3rd level (3 slots): bestow curse, dispel magic, spirit guardians Actions____________________________________________ Multiattack. Grisha makes two attacks with his +7 fail. +7 Flail. Melee Weapon Attack: +5 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target. Hit: 7 (ld8 + 3) bludgeoning damage.

APPENDIX C | CREATURES

charmed or frightened. against spells and other magical effects. Spellcasting. Narrak is a Sth-level spellcaster. His spellcasting

ability is Charisma (save DC 13, +5 to hit with spell attacks). Narrak has two 2nd-level spell slots, which he regains after finishing a short or long rest, and knows the following warlock spells:

Cantrips (at will): eldritch blast, friends, poison spray 1st level: armor of Agathys, charm person, hex 2nd level: hold person, ray of enfeeblement, spider climb Sunlight Sensitivity. While in sunlight, Narrak has disadvantage

on attack rolls, as well as on Wisdom (Perception) checks that rely on sight.

Actions_________________________________________________ Armor of Shadows (Recharges after a Short or Long Rest).

mage armor on himself. Shortsword. Melee Weapon Attack: +4 to hit, reach 5 ft., one creature. Hit: 5 (1 d6 + 2) piercing damage. Narrak casts

One with Shadows. While he is in dim light or darkness, Narrak

can become invisible. He remains so until he moves or takes an action or reaction.

The Pudding King Small humanoid (gnome, shapechanger), chaotic evil Armor Class 13 (16 with armor) mage Hit Points 49 (9d6+ 18)

Speed 30 ft. STR

10 (+0)

DEX CON 16 (+3)

14 (+2)

INT

12 ( + 1)

WIS CHA 8(-l)

17 (+3)

Saving Throws Con +5, Cha +6 Yestabrod Large monstrosity, chaotic evil Armor Class 15 (natural armor) Hit Points 75 (lOdlO + 20) Speed

30 ft.

STR

12 (+1)

DEX CON

10 (+0)

14 (+2)

INT

WIS

13 (+1) 15 (+2)

CH A

10 (+0)

Change Shape. The Pudding King magically transforms into an ooze, or back into his true form. He reverts to his true form if he dies. Any equipment he is wearing or carrying is absorbed by the new form. In ooze form, the Pudding King retains his alignment, hit points, Hit Dice, and Intelligence, Wisdom, and Charisma scores, as well as this action. His statistics and capabilities are otherwise replaced by those of the new form. Create Creen Slime (Recharges after a Long Rest). The Pudding King

Skills Arcana +4, Perception +2, Stealth +6, Survival +2 Damage Resistances acid, poison Condition Immunities poisoned Senses darkvision 60 ft., passive Perception 12 Languages Abyssal, Gnomish, Terran, Undercommon Challenge 4 (1,100 XP)

creates a patch of green slime (see "Dungeon Hazards” in chapter 5 of the Dungeon Master’s Guide). The slime appears on a section of wall, ceiling, or floor within 30 feet of the Pudding King. Damage Immunities poison Condition Immunities poisoned Senses darkvision 120 ft., passive Perception 12 Languages Abyssal, telepathy 60 ft. Challenge 4 (1,100 XP)

Stone Camouflage. The Pudding King has advantage on

Legendary Resistance (l/Day). If Yestabrod fails a saving throw, it

Dexterity (Stealth) checks made to hide in rocky terrain.

can choose to succeed instead.

Gnome Cunning. The Pudding King has advantage on Intelligence, Wisdom, and Charisma saving throws against magic.

Actions_______________________________________________ Slam. Melee Weapon Attack: +3 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target. Hit: 8 (3d4 + 1) bludgeoning damage plus 7 (3d4)

Innate Spellcasting. The Pudding King’s innate spellcasting

poison damage,

ability is Intelligence (spell save DC 12). He can innately cast the following spells, requiring no material components:

Caustic Spores (1/Day). Yestabrod releases spores in a 30-foot

nondetection (self only) 1/day each: blindness/deafness, blur, disguise self At will:

Insanity. The Pudding King has advantage on saving throws

against being charmed or frightened. Spellcasting, The Pudding King is a 9th-level spellcaster, His

spellcasting ability is Charisma (spell save DC 14, +6 to hit with spell attacks). The Pudding King knows the following sorcerer spells:

Cantrips (at will): acid splash, light, mage hand, poison spray, prestidigitation 1st level (4 slots):/oise life, mage armor, ray of sickness, shield 2nd level (3 slots): crown of madness, misty step 3rd level (3 slots): gaseous form, stinking cloud 4th level (3 slots): blight, confusion 5th level (1 slot): cloudkill Actions_______________________________________________ War Pick. Melee Weapon Attack: +3 to hit, reach 5 ft., one target. Hit: 4 (ld8) piercing damage.

cone. Each creature in that area must succeed on a DC 12 Dexterity saving throw or take ld6 acid damage at the start of each of Yestabrod’s turns, A creature can repeat the saving throw at the end of each of its turns, ending the effect on itself on a success. Infestation Spores (1/Day). Yestabrod releases spores that burst

out in a cloud that fills a 10-foot-radius sphere centered on it, and the cloud lingers for 1 minute. Any flesh-and-blood creature in the cloud when it appears, or that enters it later, must make a DC 12 Constitution saving throw. On a successful save, the creature can’t be infected by these spores for 24 hours. On a failed save, the creature is infected with a disease called the spores of Zuggtmoy and also gains a random form of indefinite madness (determined by rolling on the Madness of Zuggtmoy table in appendix D) that lasts until the creature is cured of the disease or dies. While infected in this way, the creature can't be reinfected, and it must repeat the saving throw at the end of every 24 hours, ending the infection on a success. On a failure, the infected creature’s body is slowly taken over by fungal growth, and after three such failed saves, the creature dies and is reanimated as a spore servant if it’s a type of creature that can be (see the "Myconids” entry in the Monster

Manual). Legendary Actions__________________________________ APPENDIX C

I CREATURES

233

Yestabrod can take 2 legendary actions, choosing from the options below. Only one legendary action option can be used at a time and only at the end of another creature's turn, Yestabrod regains spent legendary actions at the start of its turn.

Core, offal, and acid erupt from a corpse within 20 feet of Yestabrod. Creatures within 10 feet of the corpse must succeed on a DC 12 Dexterity saving throw or take 7 (2d6) acid damage. Foul Absorption. Yestabrod absorbs putrescence from a corpse within 5 feet of it, regaining ld8 + 2 hit points. Corpse Burst.

APPENDIX D | DEMON LORDS

234

Appendix D: Demon Lords Here are game statistics for the demon lords who have roles to play in this story. Beware! They are formidable opponents.

teeth like a beast.

B APHOMET Civilization is weakness and savagery is strength in the credo of Baphomet. the Horned King and the Prince of Beasts. He rules over minotaurs and others with savage hearts. He is worshiped by those who want to break the confines of civility and unleash their bestial natures, for Baphomet envisions a world without restraint, where creatures live out their most savage desires. Cults devoted to Baphomet use mazes and complex knots as their emblems, creating secret places to indulge themselves, including labyrinths of the sort their master favors. Bloodstained crowns and weapons of iron and brass decorate their profane altars. Over time, Baphomet’s cultists become tainted by his influence, gaining bloodshot eyes and coarse, thickening hair. Small horns eventually sprout from the forehead. In lime, a devoted cultist might transform entirely into a minotaur—considered the greatest gift of the Prince of Beasts. Baphomet himself appears as a great, black-furred minotaur. 20 feet tall with six iron horns. An infernal light burns in his red eyes. Although filled with bestial bloodlust, there lies within a cruel and cunning intellect devoted to subverting all of civilization. Baphomet wields a great glaive called Heartcleaver. lie sometimes casts this deadly weapon aside so that he can charge his enemies and gore them with his horns, trampling them into the earth and rending them with his

Baphomet’s Lair Baphomet's lair is his palace, the Lyktion which is on the layer of the Abyss called the Endless Maze. Nestled within the twisting passages of the plane-wide labyrinth, the Lyktion is immaculately maintained and surrounded by a moat constructed in the fashion of a three-dimensional maze. The palace itself is a towering structure whose interior is as labyrinthine as the plane on which it resides, populated by minotaurs, goristros, and quasits.

Lair Actions

On initiative count 20 (losing initiative ties), Baphomet can take a lair action to cause one of the following magical effects; he can’t use the same effect two rounds in a row: • Baphomet seals one doorway or other en try way within the lair. The opening must be unoccupied. It is filled with solid stone for 1 minute or until Baphomet creates this effect again. * Baphomet chooses a room within the lair that is no larger in any dimension than 100 feet. Un-

Bapho met

the next initiative count 20, gravity is reversed within that room. Any creatures or objects in the room when this happens fall in the direction of the new pull of gravity, unless they have some means of remaining aloft. Baphomet can ignore the gravity reversal if he's in the room, although he likes to use this action to land on a ceiling to attack targets flying near it. • Baphomet casts mirage arcane, affecting a room within the lair that is no longer in any dimension than 100 feet. The effect ends on the next initiative count 20.

R EGIONAL E FFECTS

The region containing Baphomet's lair is warped by his magic, creating one or more of the following effects: • Plant life within 1 mile of the lair grows thick and forms walls of trees, hedges, and other flora in the form of small mazes. • Beasts within 1 mile of the lair become frightened and disoriented, as though constantly under threat of being hunted, and might lash out or panic even when no visible threat is nearby. • If a humanoid spends at least 1 hour within 1 mile of the lair, that creature must succeed on a DC 18 Wisdom saving throw or descend into a madness determined by the Madness of Baphomet table. A creature that succeeds on this saving throw can't be affected by this regional effect again for 24 hours. If Baphomet dies, these effects fade over the course of Id 10 days.

MADNESS

OF

BAPHOMET

If a creature goes mad in Baphomet's lair or within line of sight of the demon lord, roll on the Madness of Baphomet table to determine the nature of the madness, which is a character flaw that lasts until cured. See the Dungeon Master's Guide for more on madness. MADNESS OF BAPHOMET dlOO Flaw (lasts until cured) 01-20 "My anger consumes me. I can't be reasoned with when my rage has been stoked. I ' 2140 "I degenerate into beastly behavior, seeming more like a wild animal than a thinking being.” 41-60 "The world is my hunting ground. Others are my prey." 61-80 “Hate comes easily to me and explodes into rage ” 81-00 “I see those who oppose me not as people, but as beasts meant to be preyed upon.”

I /day each: feeblemind, project image Legendary Resistance (3/Day), If Demogorgon fails a saving

throw, he can choose to succeed instead. Magic Resistance. Demogorgon has advantage on saving throws

against spells and other magical effects. Magic Weapons. Demogorgon’s weapon attacks are magical. Two Heads. Demogorgon has advantage on saving throws

against being blinded, deafened, stunned, and knocked unconscious. A CTIONS _________________________________________________ Multiattack. Demogorgon makes two tentacle attacks.

Baphomet Huge fiend (demon), chaotic evil Armor Class 22 (natural armor) Hit Points 333 (23dl2+ 184) Speed 40 ft. STR DEX CON INT WIS CHA 30 (+10) 14 (+2) 26 (+8) 18 (+4) 24 (+7)16 (+3) Saving Throws Dex +9, Con +15, Wis +14 Skills Intimidation +17, Perception +14 Damage Resistances cold, fire, lightning Damage Immunities poison; bludgeoning, piercing, and slashing that is nonmagical

Condition Immunities charmed, exhaustion, frightened, poisoned

Senses truesight 120 ft., passive Perception 24 Languages all, telepathy 120 ft. Challenge 23 (50,000 XP) Charge. If Baphomet moves at least 10 feet straight toward a target and then hits it with a gore attack on the same turn, the target takes an extra 22 (4dl0) piercing damage. If the target is a creature, it must succeed on a DC 25 Strength saving throw or be pushed up to 10 feet away and knocked prone. Innate Spellcasting. Baphomet's spellcasting ability is Charisma (spell save DC 18). He can innately cast the following spells, requiring no material components. At will: detect magic 3/day each: dispel magic, dominate beast, hunter’s mark, maze, wall of stone 1/day each: teleport

Labyrinthine Recall. Baphomet can perfectly recall any path he has traveled, and he is immune to the maze spell. Legendary Resistance (3/Day). If Baphomet fails a saving throw, he can choose to succeed instead.

Magic Resistance. Baphomet has advantage on saving throws against spells and other magical effects. Magic Weapons. Baphomet's weapon attacks are magical.

Reckless. At the start of his turn. Baphomet can gam advantage on all melee weapon attack rolls during that turn, but attack rolls against him have advantage until the start of his next turn.

Actions________________________________ Multiattack. Baphomet makes three attacks: one with Heart cleaver, one with his bite, and one with his gore attack.

Heartcleaver. Melee Weapon Attack: +17 to hit, reach 15 ft., one target. Hit: 24 (4d6 + 10) slashing damage. Bite. Melee Weapon Attack: +17 to hit, reach 10 ft., one target. Hit: 19 (2d8 + 10) piercing damage. Core. Melee Weapon Attack: +17 to hit, reach 10 ft., one target. Hit: 21 (2dl0 + 10) piercing damage. Frightful Presence. Each creature of Baphomet’s choice within 120 feet ofhim and aware of him must succeed on a DC 18 Wisdom saving throw or become frightened for 1 minute. A frightened creature can repeat the saving throw at the end of each of its turns, ending the effect on itself on a success. These later saves have disadvantage if Baphomet is within line of sight of the creature. If a creature succeeds on any of these saves or the effect ends on it, the creature is immune to Baphomet’s Frightful Presence for the next 24 hours.

Legendary Actions_______________________ Baphomet can take 3 legendary actions, choosing from the options below. Only one legendary action option can be used at a time and only at the end of another creature’s turn. Baphomet regains spent legendary actions at the start of his turn.

Heartcleaver Attack. Baphomet makes a melee attack with Heartcleaver.

Charge (Costs 2 Actions). Baphomet moves up to his speed, then makes a gore attack.

APPENDIX D I DEMON LORDS -

..

/ 235

D EMOGORGON Prince of Demons, the Sibilant Beast, and Master of the Spiraling Depths, Demogorgon is the embodiment of chaos, madness, and destruction, seeking to corrupt all that is good and undermine order in the multiverse, to see everything dragged howling into the infinite depths of the Abyss. The demon lord is a meld of different forms, with a saurian lower body and clawed, webbed feet, as well as suckered tentacles sprouting from the shoulders of a great apelike torso, surmounted by two hideous simian heads, named Aamcul and Hathradiah, both equally mad. Their gaze brings madness and confusion to any who confront it.

Demogorgon Huge fiend (demon), chaotic evil Armor Class 22 (natural armor) Hit Points 496 (34dl2 + 272) Speed 50 ft., swim 50 ft. STR DEX CON INT WIS CH 29 (+9) 14 (+2)26 (+8) 20 17 (+3)25A (+5) (+7) Saving Throws Dex +10, Con +16, Wis +11, Cha +15 Skills Insight +11, Perception +19 Damage Resistances cold, fire, lightning Damage Immunities poison; bludgeoning, piercing, and slashing that is nonmagical Condition Immunities charmed, exhaustion, frightened, poisoned Senses truesight 120 ft., passive Perception 21 Languages all, telepathy 120 ft. Challenge 26 (90,000 XP) I 1

IInnate Spellcasting. Demogorgon's spellcasting ability is Charisma (spell save DC 23). Demogorgon can innately cast the following spells, requiring no material components: At will: detect magic, major image 3/day each: dispel magic, fear, telekinesis APPENDIX D | DEMON LORDS

236

Similarly, the spiraling Y sign of Demogorgon's cult can inspire madness in those who contemplate it for too long. All the followers of the Prince of Demons go mad. sooner or later. DEMOGORGON’S LAIR

Demogorgon makes his lair in a palace called Abysm, found on a layer of the Abyss known as the Gaping Maw, Demogorgon’s lair is a place of madness and duality; the portion of the palace that lies above water takes the form of two serpentine towers, each crowned by a skull-shaped minaret. There, Demogorgon's heads contemplate the mysteries of the arcane while arguing about how best to obliterate their rivals. The bulk of this palace extends deep underwater, in chill and darkened caverns.

Tentacle. Melee Weapon Attack: +17 to hit, reach 10 Ft., one target. Hit: 35 (4dl2 + 9) bludgeoning damage. If the target is a creature, it must succeed on a DC 23 Constitution saving throw or its hit point maximum is reduced by an amount equal to the damage taken. This reduction lasts until the target finishes a long rest. The target dies if its hit point maximum is reduced to 0. Core, Demogorgon turns his magical gaze toward one creature that he can see within 120 feet of him. That target must make a DC 23 Wisdom saving throw. Unless the target is incapacitated, it can avert its eyes to avoid the gaze and to automatically succeed on the save. If the target does so, it can’t see Demogorgon until the start of his next turn. If the target looks at him in the meantime, it must immediately make the save. If the target fails the save, the target suffers one of the following effects of Demogorgon’s choice or at random: 1. Beguiling Caze. The target is stunned until the start of Demogorgon’s next turn or until Demogorgon is no longer within line of sight. 2. Hypnotic Caze. The target is charmed by Demogorgon until the start of Demogorgon’s next turn. Demogorgon chooses how the charmed target uses its actions, reactions, and movement. Because this gaze requires Demogorgon to focus both heads on the target, he can’t use his Maddening Gaze legendary action until the start of his next turn. 3. Insanity Caze. The target suffers the effect of the confusion spell without making a saving throw. The effect lasts until the start of Demogorgon’s next turn. Demogorgon doesn't need to concentrate on the spell. Legendary Actions_______________________ Demogorgon can take 2 legendary actions, choosing from the options below. Only one legendary action option can be used at a time

and only at the end of another creature's turn. Demogorgon regains spent legendary actions at the start of his turn. Tail. Melee Weapon Attack: +17 to hit, reach 15 ft., one target. Hit: 31 (4dl0 + 9) bludgeoning damage plus 22 (4dl0) necrotic damage. Maddening Caze. Demogorgon uses his Caze action, and must choose either the Beguiling Gaze or the Insanity Caze effect.

APPENDIX D | DEMON LORDS

237

Lair Actions On initiative count 20 (losing initiative ties), Demogorgon can take a lair action to cause one of the following effects: Demogorgon can't use the same effect two rounds in a row:

Demogor gon • Demogorgon creates an illusory duplicate of himself, which appears in his own space and lasts until initiative count 20 of the next round. On his turn, Demogorgon can move the illusory duplicate a distance equal to his walking speed (no action required). The first time a creature or object interacts physically with Demogorgon (for example, hitting him with an attack), there is a 50 percent chance that it is the illusory duplicate that is being affected, not Demogorgon himself, in which case the illusion disappears. * Demogorgon casts the darkness spell four times at its lowest level, targeting different areas with the spell. Demogorgon doesn't need to concentrate on the spells, which end on initiative count 20 of the next round. R EGIONAL E FFECTS

The region containing Demogorgon's lair is warped by his magic, creating one or more of the following effects:

APPENDIX D | DEMON LORDS

238

MADNESS

OF

DEMOGORGON

If a creature goes mad in Demogorgon's lair or within line of sight of the demon lord, roll on the Madness of • The area within 6 miles of the lair becomes overpopulated with lizards, poisonous snakes, and other venomous beasts. • Beasts within 1 mile of the lair become violent and crazed—even creatures that are normally docile. • If a humanoid spends at least 1 hour within 1 mile of the lair, that creature must succeed on a DC 23 Wisdom saving throw or descend into a madness determined by the Madness of Demogorgon table. A creature that succeeds on this saving throw can’t be affected by this regional effect again for 24 hours. If Demogorgon dies, these effects fade over the course

Demogorgon table to determine the nature of the madness. which is a character flaw that lasts until cured. See the Dungeon Mister's Guide for more on madness.

of ldlO days.

MADNESS OF DEMOGORGON

dlOO Flaw (lasts until cured) 01-20 "Someone is plotting to kill me. 1 need to strike first to stop them!” 21-40 "There is only one solution to my problems: kill them all!" 41-60 “There is more than one mind inside my head." 61-80 “If you don’t agree with me. I'll beat you into submission to get my way." 81-00 "1 can’t allow anyone to touch anything that belongs to me. They might try to take it away from me!"

APPENDIX D | DEMON LORDS

239

FRAZ-URB’LUU All demons are liars, but Fraz-Urb’luu is the Prince of Deception and Demon Lord of Illusions. He uses every trick, every ounce of demonic cunning, to manipulate his enemies—mortal and fiend alike—to do his will. FrazUrb’luu can create dreamlands and mind-bending fantasies able to deceive the most discerning foes. Once imprisoned for centuries below Castle Greyhawk on the world of Oerth, Fraz-Urb'luu has slowly rebuilt his power in the Abyss. He seeks the pieces of the legendary staff of power taken from him by those who imprisoned him, and commands his servants to do likewise. The Prince of Deception’s true form is like that of a great gargoyle, some 12 feet tall, with an extended, muscular neck and a smiling face framed by long, pointed ears and lank, dark hair, and bat-like wings are furled against his powerful shoulders. He can assume other forms, however, from the hideous to the beautiful. Often the demon lord becomes so immersed in playing a role that he loses himself in it for a time. Many of the cultists of Fraz-Urb'luu aren't even aware they serve the Prince of Deception, believing their master is a beneficent being and grantor of wishes, some lost god or celestial, or even another fiend. Fraz-Urb'luu wears all these masks and more. He particularly delights in aiding demon-hunters against his demonic adversaries, driving the hunters to greater and greater atrocities in the name of their holy cause, only to

Fraz-Urb’luu

Large fend (demon), chaotic evil

Armor Class 18 (natural armor) Hit Points 350 (28dl0 + 196) Speed 40 ft., fly 40 ft. STR DEX CON INT WIS CHA 29 (+9) 12 (+1)25 (+7) 26 (+8) 24 (+7) 26 (+8) Saving Throws Dex +8, Con +15, lnt+15, Wis +14 Skills Deception +15, Perception +14, Stealth +8 Damage Resistances cold, fire, lightning Damage Immunities poison; bludgeoning, piercing, and slashing that is nonmagical

Condition Immunities charmed, exhaustion,

eventually reveal his true nature and claim their souls as his own. FRAZ-URB’LUU’S LAIR

Fraz-Urb’luu’s lair lies within the Abyssal lair known as Hollow's Heart, a featureless plain of white dust with few structures on it. The lair itself is the city of Zoragmelok, a circular fortress surrounded by adamantine walls topped with razors and hooks. Corkscrew towers loom above twisted domes and vast amphitheaters, just a few examples of the impossible architecture that fills the city. The challenge rating of Fraz-Urb’luu is 24 (62.000 XP) when he’s encountered in his lair. LAIR ACTIONS

On initiative count 20 (losing initiative ties), FrazUrb'luu can take a lair action to cause one of the following effects; he can’t use the same effect two rounds in a row: • Fraz-Urb’luu causes up to 5 doors within the lair to be come walls, and an equal number of doors to appear on walls where there previously were none. • Fraz-Urb’luu chooses one humanoid within the lair and instantly creates a simulacrum of that creature (as if created with the simulacrum spell). This simulacrum obeys Fraz-Urb’luu's commands and is destroyed on the next initiative count 20.

Challenge 23 (50,000 XP) Magic Resistance. Fraz-Urb'luu has advantage on I II

saving throws against spells and other magical effects.

Magic Weapons Fraz-Urb’luu's weapon attacks are magical.

Undetectable. Fraz-Urb'luu can't be targeted by divination magic, perceived through magical scrying sensors, or detected by abilities that sense demons or fiends.

Actions________________________________ Multiattack. Fraz-Urb’luu makes three attacks: one with his bite and two with his fists.

Bite. Melee Weapon Attack: +16 to hit, reach 10 ft., one target. Hit: 23 (4d6 + 9) piercing damage.

Fist. Melee Weapon Attack: +16 to hit, reach 10 ft., one target. Hit: 27 (4d8 + 9) bludgeoning damage.

Legendary Actions_______________________

frightened, poisoned

Senses truesight 120 ft., passive Perception 24 Languages all, telepathy 120 ft.

IInnate Spellcasting. Fraz-Urb’luu’s spellcasting ability is Charisma (spell save DC 23). Fraz-Urb’luu can innately cast the following spells, requiring no material components: At will: alter self (can become Medium-sized when changing his appearance), detect magic, dispel magic, phantasmal force 3/day each: confusion, dream, mislead, programmed illusion, seeming II /day each: mirage arcane, modify memory, project image Legendary Resistance (3/Day). If Fraz-Urb’luu fails a saving

throw, he can choose to succeed insteady.

Fraz-Urb’luu can take 3 legendary actions, choosing from the options below. Only one legendary action option can be used at a time and only at the end of another creature's turn. Fraz- Urb’luu regains spent legendary actions at the start of his turn.

Tail. Melee Weapon Attack: +16 to hit, reach 15 ft., one target. Hit: 31 (4dl0 + 9) bludgeoning damage. If the target is a

Large or smaller creature, it is also grappled (escape DC 24). The grappled target is also restrained. Fraz-Urb’luu can grapple only one creature with his tail at a time.

Phantasmal Killer (Costs 2 Actions). Fraz-Urb’luu casts phantasmal killer, no concentration required.

Fra/ l rh'luu creates a wave of anguish. Each creature he can see